F-1/A
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 19, 2021.

Registration No. 333-260003

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Amendment No. 1

to

Form F-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

UNDER

THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

 

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 

Cayman Islands   3674   98-0604079
(State or Other Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or Organization)
  (Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

400 Stonebreak Road Extension

Malta, NY 12020

(518) 305-9013

(Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Registrant’s Principal Executive Offices)

 

 

Corporation Service Company

251 Little Falls Drive

Wilmington, DE 19808

(800) 927-9801

(Name, Address, Including Zip Code, and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Agent For Service)

 

 

Copies to:    

 

David Lopez, Esq.

Gamal M. Abouali, Esq.

Adam Fleisher, Esq.

Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP

One Liberty Plaza

New York, New York 10006

(212) 225-2000

 

Tad J. Freese, Esq.

Matthew T. Bush, Esq.

Latham & Watkins LLP

140 Scott Drive

Menlo Park, California 94025

(650) 328-4600

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

If any of the securities being registered on this form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.  ☐

If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  ☐

If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  ☐

If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  ☐

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an emerging growth company as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act of 1933.  ☐

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act.  ☐

 

The term “new or revised financial accounting standard” refers to any update issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board to its Accounting Standards Codification after April 5, 2012.

 

 

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

 

 

Title Of Each Class Of
Securities To Be Registered
  Amount
of Securities
to be
Registered(1)
  Proposed
Maximum
Offering Price(2)
  Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price(1)(2)
  Amount Of
Registration Fee(3)

Ordinary shares, par value US$0.02 per share

  63,250,000   US$47.00   US$2,972,750,000   US$275,573.93

 

 

 

(1)

Includes 8,250,000 ordinary shares that the underwriters may purchase, including pursuant to the option to purchase additional shares, if any.

(2)

Estimated solely for the purpose of computing the amount of the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(a) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

(3)

The Registrant previously paid US$92,700 of the registration fee in connection with the initial filing of this Registration Statement.

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

 

 


Table of Contents

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. Neither we nor Mubadala may sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

 

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED OCTOBER 19, 2021

 

LOGO

55,000,000 Ordinary Shares

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

 

This is an initial public offering of the ordinary shares, US$0.02 par value per share, of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., or the company. We are offering 33,000,000 of the ordinary shares to be sold in this offering. Mubadala Investment Company PJSC (“Mubadala”) is offering 22,000,000 of the ordinary shares to be sold in the offering. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of ordinary shares by Mubadala. Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our ordinary shares. It is currently estimated that the initial public offering price per ordinary share will be between US$42.00 and US$47.00. We have applied to list our ordinary shares on the Nasdaq under the symbol “GFS.”

 

 

Following the completion of this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement referred to below, we will be a “controlled company” as defined under the Nasdaq corporate governance requirements. Our shareholder, Mubadala, through its wholly owned subsidiaries Mubadala Technology Investment Company (“MTIC”) and MTI International Investment Company LLC (“MTIIIC”), will beneficially own 89.4% of our issued and outstanding ordinary shares and control approximately 89.4% of the voting power of our issued and outstanding ordinary shares following this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional ordinary shares. See “Principal and Selling Shareholder.”

Certain funds and accounts managed by subsidiaries of BlackRock, Inc., certain funds and accounts managed by Columbia Management Investment Advisers, LLC, certain entities affiliated with Fidelity Management & Research Company LLC, certain affiliates of Koch Strategic Platforms, LLC, an affiliate of Koch Industries, Inc., and Qualcomm Incorporated (collectively, the “cornerstone investors”) have indicated an interest in purchasing ordinary shares with an aggregate purchase price of approximately $1.05 billion in this offering at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. These indications of interest have been made severally but not jointly. The underwriters will receive the same underwriting discount on any ordinary shares purchased by the cornerstone investors as they will on any other ordinary shares sold to the public in this offering. However, because indications of interest are not binding agreements or commitments to purchase, the underwriters may determine to sell more, fewer or no ordinary shares in this offering to any or all of the cornerstone investors, or any or all of these cornerstone investors may determine to purchase more, fewer or no shares in this offering. Certain funds affiliated with Silver Lake Technology Management, L.L.C. (“Silver Lake”) have agreed to purchase ordinary shares from us with an aggregate purchase price of approximately $75.0 million in a concurrent private placement transaction at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price (the “Concurrent Private Placement”). The Concurrent Private Placement is contingent upon, and is expected to close immediately following, the closing of this offering as well as the satisfaction of customary closing conditions. See “Recent Developments—Concurrent Private Placement.”

 

 

Investing in our ordinary shares involves risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 23 of this prospectus.

 

 

 

      

Per Ordinary Share

      

Total

 

Initial public offering price

       US$                              US$                      

Underwriting discounts and commissions(1)

       US$                              US$                      

Proceeds to us, before expenses

       US$                              US$                      

Proceeds to Mubadala, before expenses

       US$                              US$                      

 

(1)

See “Underwriters” for additional information regarding total underwriter compensation.

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 2,750,000 ordinary shares, or up to 5% of the shares offered by us and Mubadala in this offering, for sale at the initial public offering price through a directed share program to certain employees and other related persons identified by us. See the section titled “Underwriters—Directed Share Program.”

Mubadala has granted an option to the underwriters, exercisable for 30 days after the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to 8,250,000 additional ordinary shares at the public offering price, less underwriting discounts and commissions.

Neither the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

The underwriters expect to deliver the ordinary shares against payment in New York, New York on or about                , 2021, through the book-entry facility of The Depository Trust Company.

 

 

 

MORGAN STANLEY   BofA SECURITIES   J.P. MORGAN
CITIGROUP     CREDIT SUISSE
DEUTSCHE BANK SECURITIES  

HSBC

 

JEFFERIES

BAIRD   COWEN   NEEDHAM & COMPANY   RAYMOND JAMES   WEDBUSH SECURITIES
DREXEL HAMILTON   SIEBERT WILLIAMS SHANK   IMI - INTESA SANPAOLO

PROSPECTUS DATED                , 2021


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

     Page  

Prospectus Summary

     1  

Risk Factors

     23  

Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

     59  

Industry and Market Data

     61  

Use of Proceeds

     62  

Dividend Policy

     63  

Capitalization

     64  

Dilution

     65  

Management’s Discussion and Analysis Of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

     66  

Business

     93  

Management

     126  

Executive Compensation

     136  
     Page  

Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions

     141  

Principal and Selling Shareholder

     146  

Description of Share Capital

     147  

Shares Eligible for Future Sale

     163  

Taxation

     165  

Underwriters

     169  

Expenses of the Offering

     178  

Legal Matters

     179  

Experts

     179  

Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant

     181  

Where You Can Find Additional Information

     182  

Index to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-1  
 

 

 

You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus or contained in any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us or to which we have referred you. We and Mubadala have not, and the underwriters have not, authorized anyone to provide any information or make any representations other than those contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us or to which we have referred you. We and Mubadala take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. We and Mubadala are offering to sell, and seeking offers to buy, ordinary shares only in jurisdictions where offers and sales are permitted. The information contained in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date of this prospectus, regardless of the time of delivery of this prospectus or of any sale of the ordinary shares. Our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects may have changed since such date.

Through and including             , 2021 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers effecting transactions in the ordinary shares, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This delivery requirement is in addition to a dealer’s obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.

For investors outside of the United States: neither we, Mubadala, nor any of the underwriters have done anything that would permit this offering or possession or distribution of this prospectus in any jurisdiction where action for that purpose is required, other than in the United States. Persons outside of the United States who come into possession of this prospectus must inform themselves about, observe any restrictions relating to, the offering of ordinary shares and this distribution of this prospectus outside of the United States.

 

i


Table of Contents

PRESENTATION OF FINANCIAL AND OTHER INFORMATION

We report under International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), as adopted by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”). Our financial statements were not prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. We present our consolidated financial statements in U.S. dollars. References in this prospectus to “US$” or “$” refer to U.S. dollars, the official currency of the United States.

Use of Non-IFRS Financial Measures

Certain parts of this prospectus contain the following non-IFRS financial measures: adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share.

Adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share are used by our management to monitor the underlying performance of the business and its operations. These measures are used by different companies for differing purposes and are often calculated in ways that reflect the circumstances of those companies. You should exercise caution in comparing these measures as reported by us to the same or similar measures as reported by other companies. Adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share may not be comparable to similarly titled metrics of other companies. These measures are unaudited and have not been prepared in accordance with IFRS or any other generally accepted accounting principles.

Adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share are not measurements of performance under IFRS or any other generally accepted accounting principles, and you should not consider them as an alternative to loss for the period, operating loss or other financial measures determined in accordance with IFRS or other generally accepted accounting principles. These measures have limitations as analytical tools, and you should not consider them in isolation.

 

ii


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

This summary highlights selected information that is presented in greater detail elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary does not contain all of the information you should consider before investing in our ordinary shares. You should read this entire prospectus carefully, including the sections titled “Risk Factors” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus, before making an investment decision. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “GF,” “the company,” “we,” “us” and “our” in this prospectus refer to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

Overview

We are one of the world’s leading semiconductor foundries. We manufacture complex, feature-rich integrated circuits (“ICs”) that enable billions of electronic devices that are pervasive throughout nearly every sector of the global economy. With our specialized foundry manufacturing processes, a library consisting of thousands of qualified circuit-building block designs (known as intellectual property (“IP”) titles or IP blocks), and differentiated transistor and device technology, we serve a broad range of customers, including the global leaders in IC design, and provide optimized solutions for the function, performance and power requirements of critical applications driving key secular growth end markets. As the only scaled pure-play foundry with a global footprint that is not based in China or Taiwan, we help customers mitigate geopolitical risk and provide greater supply chain certainty. We define a scaled pure-play foundry as a company that focuses on producing ICs for other companies, rather than those of its own design, with more than $2 billion of annual foundry revenue.

Technology megatrends including internet of things (“IoT”), 5G, cloud, artificial intelligence (“AI”) and next-generation automotive are reshaping the global economy and driving a new golden age for semiconductors—a market that is expected to grow to more than $1 trillion by the end of this decade, from close to $0.5 trillion in 2021, according to VLSI Research. Semiconductors have become ubiquitous, powering a broad range of applications from consumer devices to enterprise and industrial applications. Semiconductor innovation is essential to the growth and development of many parts of the technology ecosystem. This includes the software and AI revolution and data collection, transmission and processing at an unprecedented scale, as well as increasing use of advanced driver-assistance systems (“ADAS”) and electrification of automobiles, with electric vehicle penetration, consisting of hybrid-full, hybrid-mild and battery electric vehicle propulsion systems, expected to increase from 19% in 2021 to 55% in 2027, according to IHS Markit from July 2021. Semiconductor innovation is also essential for many industrial applications. As the manufacturing backbone of the semiconductor industry, foundries are the bedrock of the global technology ecosystem, and, by extension, the world economy. Foundries such as GF drive innovation by providing advances in process technologies, materials science and IC design IP within the global supply chain to enable customers to develop ICs, accelerate time-to-market and offer value-added services.

We provide differentiated foundry solutions that enable the era for data-centric, connected, intelligent and secure technologies. We are redefining the foundry model with feature-rich solutions that enable our customers to develop innovative products for an increasingly wide variety of applications across broad and pervasive markets. We unlock value for our customers by helping drive technology in multiple dimensions, making their products more intelligent and intuitive, more connected and secure, and more powerful and energy-efficient. Our objective is to be the global leader in feature-rich semiconductor manufacturing—the foundry of choice for the pervasive semiconductor market. We have a large and growing market opportunity with an estimated serviceable addressable market (“SAM”) of $54 billion in 2020, which reflects the sum of all foundry revenues excluding memory and revenues from <12nm wafers, as estimated by Gartner. Our SAM is supported by significant opportunities in our core markets of Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing.


 

1


Table of Contents

Since our founding in 2009, we have invested over $23 billion in our company to build a global manufacturing footprint with multiple state-of-the-art facilities across three continents, offering customers the flexibility and security their supply chains require. As semiconductor technologies become more complex with advanced integration requirements, we are also able to offer comprehensive, state-of-the-art design solutions and services that provide our customers with a high-quality, cost-effective and faster path to market. We have over 50 ecosystem partners spanning IP, electronic design automation, outsourced assembly and test and design services. Building on an existing library of more than 4,000 IP titles, we currently have more than 950 IP titles in active development across 26 process nodes and 34 IP partners.

We focus on feature-rich devices that include digital, analog, mixed-signal, radio frequency (“RF”), ultra-low power and embedded memory solutions that connect, secure and process data, and efficiently power the digital world around us. As the semiconductor and technology industries become more complex, we expect to become an even more vital partner to fabless semiconductor design companies, integrated device manufacturers (“IDMs”) and original equipment manufacturers (“OEMs”), bringing their designs to life in physical hardware. Our core technology portfolio includes a range of differentiated technology platforms, including our industry-leading RF Silicon-on-Insulator (“SOI”) solutions, advanced high-performance Fin Field-Effect Transistor (“FinFET”), feature-rich Complementary Metal-Oxide Semiconductor (“CMOS”), our proprietary Fully-Depleted SOI (“FDXTM”), high-performance Silicon Germanium (“SiGe”) products and Silicon Photonics (“SiPh”), all of which can be purposely engineered, innovated and designed for a broad set of demanding applications. Customers depend on us for feature-rich solutions based on these differentiated technologies in a growing number of applications that require low power, real-time connectivity and on-board intelligence.

The combination of our highly-differentiated technology and our scaled manufacturing footprint enables us to attract a large share of single-sourced products and long-term supply agreements, providing a high degree of revenue visibility and significant operating leverage, resulting in improved financial performance and bottom line growth. As of the date of this prospectus, the aggregate lifetime revenue commitment reflected by these agreements amounted to approximately $20 billion, including more than $10 billion during the period from 2022 through 2023 and more than $2.5 billion in advanced payments and capacity reservation fees. These agreements include binding, multi-year, reciprocal annual (and, in some cases, quarterly) minimum purchase and supply commitments with wafer pricing and associated mechanics outlined for the contract term. Through an intense focus on collaboration, we have built deep strategic partnerships with a broad base of more than 200 customers as of December 31, 2020, many of whom are the global leaders in their field. In the first six months of 2021, our top ten customers, based on wafer shipment volume, included some of the largest semiconductor companies in the world: Qualcomm Inc. (“Qualcomm”), MediaTek Inc. (“MediaTek”), NXP Semiconductors N.V. (“NXP”), Qorvo, Inc. (“Qorvo”), Cirrus Logic, Inc. (“Cirrus Logic”), Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. (“AMD”), Skyworks Solutions, Inc. (“Skyworks”), Murata Manufacturing Co., Ltd. (“Murata”), Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. (“Samsung”) and Broadcom Inc. (“Broadcom”). A key measure of our position as a strategic partner to our customers is the mix of our wafer shipment volume attributable to single-sourced business, which represented approximately 61% of wafer shipment volume in 2020, up from 47% in 2018. We define single-sourced products as those that we believe can only be manufactured with our technology and cannot be manufactured elsewhere without significant customer redesigns. Approximately 80% of our more than 350 design wins in 2020 were for single-sourced business, a record-breaking year in terms of number of design wins, up from 69% in 2018. We define a design win as the successful completion of the evaluation stage, where a customer has assessed our technology solution, verified that it meets its requirements, qualified it for their products and confirmed to us their selection.

In addition to our highly-differentiated technology platforms, our capital-efficient, scaled manufacturing footprint spanning three continents gives us the flexibility and agility to meet the dynamic needs of our customers around the globe, help them mitigate geopolitical risk and provide greater supply chain certainty. We are also one of the most advanced accredited foundry providers to the U.S. Department of Defense (“DoD”) and


 

2


Table of Contents

have the ability to extend this high-assurance model to serve commercial customers and to enhance supply chain security and resilience at a time when they are becoming more critical to national and economic security. Since foundry production is concentrated in China and Taiwan, we believe our global manufacturing footprint is a key differentiator that makes us the ideal partner for local and regional government stakeholders at a time when many regions, in particular the United States and Europe, are contemplating significant funding to secure and grow domestic semiconductor manufacturing capabilities.

We currently operate five manufacturing sites in the following locations: Dresden, Germany; Singapore; Malta, New York; Burlington, Vermont; and East Fishkill, New York. Subsequent to our transfer of our East Fishkill facility (the “EFK facility”) (see “Business—Manufacturing and Operations”), we will have four world-class manufacturing sites on three continents, providing the scale, technology differentiation and geographic diversification that we believe are critically important to our customers’ success, with total 300mm equivalent capacity in 2020 of approximately 1,920 kilo wafers per annum (“kwpa”).

Industry Background

Technology Megatrends Are Reshaping the Global Economy

The global economy’s dependency on technology is greater today than ever before. Consumer devices played a significant role in technological advances over the last decade, triggering a wave of innovation in design and manufacturing, as evidenced by the evolution of the smartphone since the introduction of the iPhone in 2007. The number of connected devices worldwide increased from 13.3 billion in 2015 to 21.6 billion in 2020, according to IoT Analytics. The latest generations of smartphone devices have integrated and improved the functionality of dozens of applications, including the Global Positioning System (“GPS”), camera, camcorder, music player, recorder, measuring devices, remote controller, car keys and credit cards, which in turn has spawned increased innovation in myriad electronic devices across numerous markets. Several megatrends including IoT, 5G, cloud, AI and next-generation automotive are poised to lead the next decade of technology advances, redefining how we use electronic devices to live, work and interact as a global society. These megatrends are reshaping nearly every industry in the global economy and rely on advances in semiconductor technology across multiple innovation vectors.

A New Golden Age for Semiconductors

Semiconductors are the core building blocks of electronic devices and systems, including those used in mobile devices, automobiles, consumer electronics, wearables, smart home devices, 5G wireless infrastructure, robotics, personal computers (“PCs”), cloud computing, data networking and others. Historically, semiconductor innovation was driven by a few select compute-centric applications—initially PCs and later the internet and mobile phones. Mobile devices have evolved from a convenient communication appliance to a feature-rich, always-connected device, enabling users to do and control nearly everything in their lives. This has driven significant growth in semiconductor demand. According to Gartner, mobile phone semiconductor revenue in 2021, excluding memory, is expected to increase by approximately 16% from 2020, which is primarily attributable to the shift from 4G to 5G phones. Similarly, the use of semiconductors in automobiles is expected to dramatically increase from 2015 to 2025 as innovation in driver safety, electrical vehicles and infotainment applications increase.

Another significant driver of semiconductor demand has been, and we believe will continue to be, the tremendous growth in the deployment of intelligent software, which is increasingly transforming a wide variety of business functions across all sectors. Semiconductors enable the functionality that software delivers. With wide-scale adoption of mobile devices and software solutions, society has grown to expect high-speed connectivity, convenience and security in all applications, providing a catalyst for increased semiconductor content in nearly every industry.


 

3


Table of Contents

Semiconductors have become mission-critical to the functionality, safety, transformation and success of many industries. As a result, the diversification of semiconductor demand across a wide range of industries has made the sector more foundational and central to the broader economy and in turn less vulnerable to cyclicality.

Foundries Are the Bedrock of the Technology Ecosystem

Semiconductor manufacturing is now a critical part of the electronics value chain by providing the foundation for innovation by fabless semiconductor design companies and OEMs, enabling broad-ranging products addressing almost every commercial sector. As a result, access to manufacturing has become a supply chain, economic and, ultimately, a national security concern.

Prior to the 1980s, the semiconductor industry was vertically integrated and semiconductor companies owned and operated their own manufacturing facilities. The market demand for continued electronics innovation, combined with the technical and financial barriers to entry in manufacturing, led to the proliferation of fabless semiconductor companies that outsourced manufacturing to foundry players. Over time, foundries, with their continued process technology innovation, coupled with the proliferation of product-focused fabless semiconductor companies, have been the engines driving the growth of the $0.5 trillion semiconductor market in 2021.

Today, it is increasingly difficult for IDMs to profitably scale manufacturing in-house, resulting in more outsourcing of manufacturing to foundries. In 2020, more than 33% of semiconductor manufacturing was outsourced to foundries, compared to approximately 9% in 2000, according to IC Insights. As manufacturing costs have continued to increase, only foundries have enough manufacturing volume to generate a return on the capital investment required, making outsourcing critical to any IDM’s strategy. Today, almost all of the remaining IDMs use foundry services for some of their products.

Geopolitical Environment and Growing Importance of Supply Security

Over the past three decades, semiconductor manufacturing has shifted toward Asia. Since 1990, the share of global semiconductor manufacturing capacity produced in major commercial fabs using leading wafer sizes in the United States and Europe declined from 81% to 21% in 2020, according to the Boston Consulting Group (“BCG”) and the Semiconductor Industry Association (“SIA”). Over the same period, production capacity in China and Taiwan increased from close to zero to 37% of total global capacity, driven in large part by significant local government subsidies and support.

There are currently only five foundries of significant scale: GF, Samsung, Semiconductor Manufacturing International Corporation (“SMIC”), Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Limited (“TSMC”) and United Microelectronics Corporation (“UMC”). Collectively, these five foundries accounted for the vast majority of worldwide foundry revenue in 2020, according to a March 2021 Gartner Semiconductor Foundry Worldwide Market Share report. More importantly, approximately 77% of foundry revenue in 2020 was from wafers manufactured in Taiwan or China, with SMIC, TSMC and UMC accounting for approximately 72% of foundry revenue in 2020. These trends have not only created trade imbalances and disputes, but have also exposed global supply chains to significant risks, including geopolitical risks. The U.S. and European governments are increasingly focused on developing a semiconductor supply chain that is less dependent on manufacturing based in Taiwan or China.

In particular, the concentration of semiconductor production in countries such as Taiwan, a resource-constrained island susceptible to natural disasters and geopolitical tension, additionally exposes global supply chains to significant risk. Given the ubiquitous nature of semiconductor technology, these imbalances and associated risks are considered by countries to be a threat to economic and national security, with many industry experts equating the importance of semiconductor supply today to that of oil in the twentieth century.


 

4


Table of Contents

The Global Semiconductor Supply Shortage

While technology megatrends have been driving increased semiconductor demand, the COVID-19 pandemic accelerated demand trends already underway, including remote work, learning and medicine, driving sustainable demand for electronic devices such as networking and infrastructure to maintain a distributed environment. As a result, demand has outstripped supply across most of the semiconductor industry. Meanwhile, other industries, such as the automotive sector, which were initially hard-hit by the pandemic, began to halt new purchases and depleted existing inventories of semiconductor chips. As some parts of the world have started to re-open, these impacted sectors have seen significant increases in new demand, which, when coupled with underlying megatrends not related to the COVID-19 pandemic, such as the electrification of vehicles, have resulted in a significant imbalance between demand and supply. Although the supply-demand imbalance is expected to improve over the medium-term, the semiconductor industry will require a significant increase in investment to keep up with demand, with total industry revenue expected to double over the next eight to ten years.

Government Incentives to Secure Supply

Against this backdrop, governments have been proposing bold new incentives to fund and secure their local semiconductor manufacturing industries. The United States Congress recently authorized the Creating Helpful Incentives to Produce Semiconductors for America (“CHIPS”) Act, which, when funded, as proposed by the United States Innovation and Competition Act, will provide for more than $52 billion in funding to the domestic semiconductor industry, with approximately two-thirds directed toward semiconductor manufacturing. In Europe, a program referred to as the Important Projects of Common European Interest (“IPCEI”) includes a large aid package to strengthen the European Union’s (“EU”) semiconductor industry. These programs are designed to bring back share in the semiconductor industry to the United States and Europe by encouraging manufacturers such as GF to increase their local capacities in these regions.

Similarly, we believe that foundry customers are increasingly seeking to diversify and secure their semiconductor supply chains, and are looking for foundry partners with manufacturing footprints in Europe, the United States and Asia, outside of China and Taiwan. Fabless companies and IDMs increasingly view their foundry relations as highly strategic and are looking to secure long-term capacity contracts by paying to access capacity expansions at their foundry partners. This trend has the potential to help balance the geographical distribution of manufacturing and drive increased long-term visibility and profitability of the foundry industry.

Evolution to Pervasive, Broadly Diversified End Markets

Historically, processor-centric compute was the foundation of the semiconductor industry, and technological innovation in end products was driven by an evolution to smaller feature sizes and greater processing capability per unit produced. This was appropriate when narrow application requirements were centered on raw processing power, and led to a cyclical industry predominantly focused on highly digital, compute-oriented verticals. Today, robust feature sets such as wireless connectivity, low power and thermal efficiency, human interfaces and security have become mission-critical to the functionality, safety, transformation, security and success of many industries. In addition, virtually all electronic systems require a combination of compute capability and features such as digital, analog, mixed-signal, RF and embedded memory to enable breakthrough functionality across wide-ranging end markets and applications. The ICs that serve these applications comprise the pervasive semiconductor market, consisting of feature-rich digital, analog and mixed-signal semiconductors. The market for, and manufacturing of, ICs for pervasive semiconductors is very different and less cyclical than the market for traditional processor-centric compute semiconductors, which have higher operating and capital costs and a narrower customer set.

The pervasive semiconductor market represented 73% of the total semiconductor foundry market, as well as 33% of the total semiconductor foundry capital expenditure in 2020, according to the Gartner Forecast,


 

5


Table of Contents

Semiconductor Foundry Revenue Supply and Demand Worldwide 2Q21 Update, July 2021. The pervasive semiconductor market is driving breakthrough innovation across broad applications such as longer battery life for mobile devices, always-on access to connected devices, high data throughput for work from home, streaming, gaming and augmented reality / virtual reality (“AR/VR”), powerful sensing for safe and comfortable autonomous driving and embedded memory for secure cryptographic credentials. Unlike processor-centric compute devices, pervasive semiconductor performance is driven more by circuit design, specialty materials and specialized manufacturing processes. Innovation in pervasive ICs is measured in terms of precision, accuracy, bandwidth, efficiency and sensitivity. When combined with greater breadth and diversity of customers and end markets, these factors tend to result in more stable demand and pricing for pervasive semiconductors than processor-centric compute semiconductors.

Our Journey

History

Since our inception, we have grown through a combination of acquisitions, greenfield expansions and strategic partnerships. We were established in 2009 when a subsidiary of Mubadala acquired AMD’s manufacturing operations in Dresden, Germany, and a fab project site in Malta, New York. In 2010, we combined with Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing, the third-largest foundry by revenue at the time, forming the basis for our Singapore manufacturing hub. In 2015, we acquired International Business Machines Corporation’s (“IBM”) Microelectronics division with manufacturing facilities in New York and Vermont, adding distinctive technology capabilities, including more than 2,000 IBM engineers. By 2017, we had successfully ramped our most advanced manufacturing site in Malta, New York. Through our organic and strategic growth initiatives, we increased manufacturing capacity twelvefold from 2009 to 2020 and now have a global footprint with five manufacturing sites on three continents with approximately 15,000 employees and approximately 10,000 worldwide patents. In 2020, we shipped approximately 2 million 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers. With this level of market presence and capability, our technologies are found across most semiconductor end markets in devices used on a daily basis.

Strategic Repositioning

Beginning in 2018, we embarked on a new strategy to significantly reposition our business to better align with our customers’ needs, drive margin expansion and accelerate value creation for our stakeholders. Today, we focus on and are growing sales of foundry solutions for the pervasive semiconductor market, where we are trusted to reliably innovate and deliver premium performance, functionality, efficiency and quality, rather than focusing merely on transistor density and processing speed.

Key elements of our strategy include:

 

   

Focus on feature-rich solutions. In August 2018, we shifted our focus to address the pervasive foundry market opportunity and the growing demand for specialized process technologies in emerging high-growth markets.

 

   

Market-based customer engagement strategy. In order to better address and capture the pervasive semiconductor foundry market opportunity, we restructured our go-to-market organizations to better align with the growing opportunities in Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. We supplemented our existing workforce with talented executives holding deep domain expertise in these growing markets.

 

   

Optimized portfolio. We took a number of steps to streamline and optimize our business and manufacturing footprint to improve our bottom line and return on capital. In 2019, we divested three assets that were not aligned with our strategic priorities.


 

6


Table of Contents
   

Resized and refocused cost structure. We have realigned our engineering, sales and marketing organizations toward higher-margin, higher-return products and opportunities to drive our improved bottom line.

 

   

Disciplined, capital-efficient expansion strategy. Since our repositioning, we have focused on a capital-efficient expansion strategy that is based on long-term demand certainty and partnerships with our customers. In addition, by repositioning to focus on differentiated technologies, we have been able to efficiently add features to our existing platforms while significantly reducing overall capital expenditures. Additionally, this strategy provides us with the opportunity to pursue highly accretive investments to meet market demand.

Our Market Opportunity

According to Gartner, the total addressable market (“TAM”) for the overall semiconductor device market was $466 billion in 2020, while the TAM for the foundry market, excluding memory, was $74 billion. Of this total, we estimate that our SAM represented $54 billion, which included $22 billion for Smart Mobile Devices, $18 billion for Home and Industrial IoT, $9 billion for Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, $4 billion for Automotive and $1 billion for Personal Computing opportunities.

Smart Mobile Devices

According to Gartner, the smart mobile devices semiconductor market, excluding memory, is expected to grow at 6.3% compound annual growth rate (“CAGR”) from 2020 to 2025. By 2025, semiconductor devices for mobile applications, such as phones, tablets and wearables, are expected to account for approximately 28% of total semiconductor demand, excluding memory. Within smart mobile devices, we expect particularly rapid growth in mobile devices connected to phones, such as smart watches (with an expected CAGR of 22% from 2020 to 2025, according to Gartner). RF content in 5G mobile devices is also expected to be more than 700% higher than that of 4G devices by 2025, according to IDC. We anticipate rapid growth in wearables, such as smart watches, mesh sensors and tracking devices, as well as AR/VR headsets, as these technologies continue to mature. Our technology platforms are designed to capture this opportunity as they address key challenges that need to be solved to drive improved customer experience and adoption.

Home and Industrial IoT

According to Gartner, the home and industrial IoT semiconductor market is expected to grow at 7.6% CAGR, with industrial automation markets expected to grow at 11% CAGR from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Our Home and Industrial IoT opportunity consists of solutions for a wide variety of applications, including factory automation, test and measurement, smart city, healthcare, transportation, connected home and others. According to Gartner, IoT applications are expected to account for approximately 22% of total annual semiconductor demand in 2025, excluding memory. We are well-positioned to capture future growth in IoT applications, as we believe these applications will increasingly combine ultra-low power chips, a variety of sensors, improved displays and cameras, multi-sensor human-machine interfaces, connectivity and intelligence at the edge.

Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter

According to Gartner, the communications infrastructure & datacenter market is expected to grow at 5.4% CAGR, with wireless infrastructure and enterprise networking markets expected to grow at 12% CAGR, and 9% CAGR, respectively, from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Our Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter opportunity consists of solutions for wired and wireless network infrastructure, datacenter applications and satellite communications. We believe we are well-positioned in RF, switching, optical, compute and storage


 

7


Table of Contents

solutions for these key end markets. Our leading capability in SiPh increases throughput and dramatically reduces power consumption through the use of light instead of electrons. Our millimeter wave (“mmWave”) technology serves the evolving needs of mobile networks, such as micro-cells for 5G mmWave, while our breadth of power applications enable our customers to design more efficient solutions for the RF networks of the future.

Automotive

According to Gartner, the automotive semiconductor devices, ADAS applications, and EV/HEV applications markets are expected to grow at 14.2% CAGR, 20% CAGR and 28% CAGR respectively, from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Many of the innovations underway in the automotive industry, such as electric and autonomous vehicles, advanced infotainment, connectivity and security, are driven by increased adoption of semiconductors in cars. Semiconductor content per vehicle is expected to increase dramatically in the coming years. The number of semiconductor devices per car is expected to double between 2016 and 2027, to over 2,000 ICs per car, according to IHS Markit from July 2021.

We expect the recent growth of semiconductor content in the automotive industry to continue, and we have been regularly evolving our technologies to serve these needs. We have developed many technologies that are well-positioned to be the semiconductor backbone of fully autonomous vehicles, such as our FDXTM platform for mmWave RADAR applications and SiGe for battery management.

Personal Computing

According to Gartner, the personal computing market is expected to grow at 2.5% CAGR from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Additionally, clamshell ultra-mobile devices and video game consoles are expected to grow at 9% CAGR and 12% CAGR, respectively, within that same time period, excluding memory. By 2025, semiconductor devices for personal computing, such as laptops and desktops are expected to account for approximately 16% of total semiconductor demand, excluding memory. In 2020 and 2021, the volume of personal computing devices has experienced strong growth, driven by work from home, remote learning and other trends related to the COVID-19 pandemic. We expect demand will continue to be sustained with the increasing use of compute in an increasing range of human activities (e.g., education and health), including in geographies that had limited access in the past.

While a large portion of the end market is driven by central processing units / graphics processing units (“CPU/GPUs”) that are progressively transitioning to technologies we do not serve following our pivot in 2018, we will continue to support our customers across a variety of applications where our technology platforms can provide meaningful differentiation for their devices. These devices include chipsets (e.g., platform controller hub (“PCH”) or I/O die (“IOD”)), Wi-Fi, power delivery, display drivers, re-drivers and audio amplifiers. Many of our technologies offer best-in-class performance for these applications, including FinFET, CMOS and BCDLiteTM.

Key Strengths

We have several distinct advantages that differentiate us from our peers:

 

   

Scaled manufacturing capabilities. According to Gartner, in 2020, we were the third largest foundry in the world based on external sales. In 2020, we shipped approximately 2 million 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers. We believe that our scaled global manufacturing footprint enables our customers to leverage the security of our fabrication facilities (“fabs”) and ensure a trusted supply of critical semiconductors.

 

   

Differentiated technology platforms and ecosystem. We deliver highly-differentiated solutions to meet customer demand for superior performance, lower power consumption and better thermal


 

8


Table of Contents
 

efficiency for mission-critical applications across IoT, 5G, cloud, AI, next-generation automotive and other secular growth markets that are driving the economy of the future.

 

   

Diversified and secure geographic footprint. Our scaled global manufacturing footprint helps mitigate geopolitical, natural disaster and competitive risks. We are the only U.S.-based scaled semiconductor foundry with a global footprint. We believe that this geographic diversification is critical to our customers as well as governments around the world as they look to secure semiconductor supply. Furthermore, a significant number of our technology platforms are qualified across our manufacturing footprint, providing our customers with a geographically diverse one-stop supply chain solution.

 

   

Market-centric solutions driving deep customer relationships. We are pioneering a new sustainable foundry relationship with fabless companies, IDMs and OEMs by partnering with customers to redefine the supply chain and economics for the entire value chain. The insights we gain through our market-centric approach enable us to focus on and invest in the markets and applications in which we believe we can achieve a clear leadership position.

 

   

High degree of revenue and earnings visibility. Our combination of highly-differentiated technology, significant number of single-sourced products and customer supply agreements provides a high degree of revenue and earnings visibility.

 

   

Capital-efficient model. Our focus on the pervasive semiconductor market results in lower capital requirements compared to foundries that focus on processor-centric compute semiconductors and are therefore obligated to invest significant capital to transition from node to node. Additionally, as the only scaled pure-play foundry with existing manufacturing capacity in the United States and Europe, we are well-positioned to benefit from government support, as governments around the world implement or contemplate large aid packages to encourage manufacturers such as us to increase their local capacities in these regions.

 

   

World-class team and focus on sustainability. We have a highly technically proficient, talented and experienced management team of executive officers and key employees with average industry experience of 25 years. We are dedicated to ethical and responsible business practices, the personal and social well-being of our diverse and highly-skilled employee base, and supply chain and environmental stewardship. As of December 31, 2020, we employed approximately 15,000 employees, and approximately 65% of our employees were engineers or technicians.

Our Differentiated Technology Platforms

We offer a wide range of feature-rich solutions that can address the needs of mission-critical applications in Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. To solve our customers’ most complex challenges, we have developed a broad range of sophisticated technology platforms that leverage our extensive patent portfolio and deep technical expertise in digital, analog, mixed-signal, RF and embedded memory.

We devote the majority of our research and development (“R&D”) efforts to our six primary differentiated technology platforms:

 

   

RF SOI: Our industry-leading RF SOI technologies are utilized in high-growth, high-volume wireless and Wi-Fi markets and are optimized for low power, low noise and low latency/high frequency applications that enable longer battery life for mobile applications and high cellular signal quality. Our RF SOI technologies are found in almost all cellular handsets from major manufacturers and in cellular ground station transceivers.


 

9


Table of Contents
   

FinFET: Our FinFET process technology is purpose-built for high-performance, power-efficient Systems-on-a-Chip (“SoCs”) in demanding, high-volume applications. Advanced features such as RF, automotive qualification, ultra-low power memory and logic provide a best-in-class (12 to 16 nanometer (“nm”)) combination of performance, power and area, and are well-suited for compute and AI, mobile/consumer and automotive processors, high-end IoT applications, high performance transceivers and wired/wireless networking applications.

 

   

Feature-Rich CMOS: Our CMOS platforms combined with foundational and complex IP and design enablement offer mixed-technology solutions on volume production-proven processes and are well-suited for a wide variety of applications. Technology features include Bipolar-CMOS-DMOS (“BCD”) for power management, high-voltage triple-gate oxide for display drivers, and embedded non-volatile memory for micro-controllers.

 

   

FDXTM: Our proprietary FDXTM process technology platform is especially well-suited for efficient single-chip integration of digital and analog signals delivering cost-effective performance for connected and low-power embedded applications. A full range of features, such as Ultra-Low Power (“ULP”), Ultra-Low Leakage (“ULL”), RF and mmWave, embedded Magnetoresistive Random Access Memory (“MRAM”) and automotive qualification, makes our FDXTM process technology platform especially well-matched for IoT/wireless, 5G (including mmWave), automotive radar, and satellite communications applications.

 

   

SiGe: Our SiGe Bipolar CMOS (“BiCMOS”) technologies are uniquely optimized for either power amplifier applications or very-high-frequency applications for optical and wireless networking, satellite communications and communications infrastructure. Our SiGe technologies are performance-competitive with more costly compound semiconductor technologies while taking full advantage of being integrated with conventional Silicon CMOS (“Si CMOS”).

 

   

SiPh: Our SiPh platforms address the increasing need for data centers to handle ever higher data rates and volumes with greater power efficiency, as conventional copper wire connections are becoming prohibitive from a power consumption perspective. Our SiPh platforms integrate photonics components with CMOS logic and RF to enable a fully integrated, monolithic electrical and optical computing and communications engine. Our SiPh technologies are also being extended to applications such as Light Detection and Ranging (“LiDAR”), quantum computing and consumer optical networks.

Our Growth Strategies

Key elements of our growth strategies include:

 

   

Deepen relationships with key customers. We operate a customer-focused partnership model in which we work closely with our customers to better understand their requirements in order to invest in and develop tailored solutions to suit their specific needs. We intend to expand our customer base and increase market share by leveraging our core IP, comprehensive portfolio, scale and flexibility to redefine the fabless-foundry model.

 

   

Expand portfolio of differentiated, feature-rich technologies. We believe that maintaining and enhancing our leadership position in differentiated technologies is critical to attracting and retaining customers, which increasingly rely on specific silicon features to differentiate their products. We will continue to invest in R&D across our six key technology platforms, which we believe provide room for continued innovation and growth within our addressable market for the foreseeable future.

 

   

Disciplined capacity expansion. We believe that we have a capital-efficient model that allows us to expand capacity in a disciplined and economically attractive manner. Our focus on the pervasive semiconductor market requires lower capital intensity than that of the compute-focused foundries to drive revenue growth.


 

10


Table of Contents
   

Strengthen government partnerships. We intend to continue expanding our existing footprint by building on the strength of our public/private investment partnerships. As regions around the world work to establish domestic semiconductor supply, we believe governmental funding to secure local manufacturing will continue.

 

   

Continued operational excellence. We delivered more than $1 billion in cost savings from 2018 to 2020 through intensive management focus on operational efficiency and are continuing to implement additional efficiency measures aimed at expanding margins, improving our bottom line, and generating higher returns on investment. We expect our business model to provide significant bottom line benefits as revenue scales at each of our existing locations.

Recent Developments

Recent Operating Results (Preliminary and Unaudited)

We have not yet performed certain closing procedures and are in the process of finalizing our results for the three months ended September 30, 2021. We have presented below certain preliminary results representing our estimates for the three months ended September 30, 2021, which are based only on currently available information and do not present all necessary information for an understanding of our results of operations for the three months ended September 30, 2021. This financial information has been prepared by and is the responsibility of our management. Such preliminary results are subject to the finalization of financial and accounting review procedures (which have yet to be performed) and should not be viewed as a substitute for full quarterly financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS. We have provided ranges, rather than specific amounts, for the preliminary estimates for the unaudited financial data described below primarily because our financial closing procedures for the three months ended September 30, 2021 are not yet complete and, as a result, our final results upon completion of our closing procedures may vary from the preliminary estimates. Neither our independent registered public accounting firm nor any other independent registered public accounting firm has audited, reviewed or performed any procedures with respect to this preliminary financial data or the accounting treatment thereof. Our independent registered public accounting firm does not express an opinion or any other form of assurance with respect thereto. We expect to complete our interim financial statements for the three months ended September 30, 2021 subsequent to the completion of this offering.

There can be no assurance that final third quarter results will not differ materially from these estimated results when we report the final results for the quarter. Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on such preliminary unaudited operating results, which constitute forward-looking statements. These preliminary estimates are not necessarily indicative of any future period and should be read together with “Risk Factors”, “Forward-Looking Statements”, and our consolidated financial statements and related notes included herein. Adjusted EBITDA is a supplemental measure that is not calculated and presented in accordance with IFRS. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis Of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Key Financial and Operating Metrics—Non-IFRS Financial Metrics” below for the definition of adjusted EBITDA.

 

     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2021
     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2020
 

(dollars in millions)

   Low
(estimated)
     High
(estimated)
        

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data (unaudited)

        

Net revenues(1)

   $ 1,695      $ 1,700      $ 1,091  

Gross profit (loss)(2)

   $ 290      $ 300      $ (134

Net profit (loss) from continuing operations(2)

   $ —        $ 5      $ (293

Non-IFRS Financial Data (unaudited)

        

Adjusted EBITDA(2)(3)

   $ 490    $ 500      $ 275  

 

11


Table of Contents
(1)

In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Had the change in terms not occurred, net revenues for the period ended September 30, 2020 would have been an estimated $309 million higher than reported results.

(2)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had an impact on gross profit (loss), net profit (loss) from continuing operations and adjusted EBITDA for the period ended September 30, 2020, estimated to be $10 million.

(3)

The following table presents a reconciliation of net profit (loss) from continuing operations to adjusted EBITDA:

 

     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2021
     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2020
 

(dollars in millions)

   Low
(estimated)
     High
(estimated)
        

Net profit (loss) from continuing operations

   $ —        $ 5      $ (293

Adjustments to net loss from continuing operations:

        

Depreciation and amortization

   $ 415      $  415      $  612  

Finance expense

   $ 27      $  27      $  34  

Provision for income taxes

   $ 22      $  22      $ (56

Share-based compensation

   $ 26      $  29      $  

Restructuring and corporate severance

   $ —        $  1      $ 2  

(Gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses(1)

   $  —        $  1    $ (24
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 490      $  500      $  275  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

See the table below for the composition of (gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses adjustment for each period presented:

 

     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2021
     Three Months Ended
September 30, 2020
 

(dollars in millions)

   Low
(estimated)
     High
(estimated)
        

(Gain) on transactions

   $ —        $ —        $ (32

Legal settlements

     —          —          —    

Transaction expenses

     —          1      8  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total (gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses

   $ —        $ 1      $ (24
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

We expect total net revenues to increase by $604 million to $609 million for the three months ended September 30, 2021 compared to the three months ended September 30, 2020, driven by continued strong wafer demand.

We expect total gross profit (loss) to increase by $424 million to $434 million for the three months ended September 30, 2021 compared to the three months ended September 30, 2020, as a result of an increase in net revenues and a decrease in depreciation expense.


 

12


Table of Contents

We expect net profit (loss) from continuing operations of $— million to $5 million for the three months ended September 30, 2021 compared to net profit (loss) from continuing operations of $(293) million for the three months ended September 30, 2020, driven by gross profit growth as well as a decrease in operating costs as a result of our cost saving initiatives.

We expect adjusted EBITDA of $490 million to $500 million for the three months ended September 30, 2021 as compared to adjusted EBITDA of $275 million for the three months ended September 30, 2020.

Revolving Credit Facility

On October 13, 2021, we entered into an amendment to our undrawn $398 million revolving credit facility to, among other things, extend its maturity to 2026 and increase the commitments available thereunder to $1 billion (the “RCF Upsize”), in order to provide additional available liquidity for general corporate purposes. The effectiveness of such amendment is subject to a number of customary closing conditions, including the closing of this offering. Subject to the effectiveness of the RCF Upsize and the closing of this offering, we intend to terminate our undrawn $400 million revolving credit agreement with Mubadala Treasury Holding Company LLC (“MTHC”).

Concurrent Private Placement

We have entered into a stock purchase agreement with Silver Lake, pursuant to which Silver Lake has agreed to purchase $75 million of our ordinary shares from us at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, Silver Lake would purchase 1,685,393 of our ordinary shares. The Concurrent Private Placement is expected to close immediately following the closing of this offering and is subject to customary closing conditions, including the completion of this offering pursuant to which the issuance and sale of ordinary shares by us, together with the issuance and sale of ordinary shares pursuant to the Concurrent Private Placement, results in aggregate gross proceeds of at least $1.25 billion. None of our ordinary shares to be sold in the Concurrent Private Placement will be registered and sold in this offering.

RISK FACTORS SUMMARY

Our business is subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, including those highlighted in the section titled “Risk Factors” immediately following this prospectus summary. These risks include the following:

Risks Related to our Business and Industry

 

   

Global economic and political conditions could materially and adversely affect us.

 

   

We have long-term supply agreements with certain customers that obligate us to meet specific production requirements, which may expose us to liquidated and other damages, require us to return advanced payments, require us to provide products and services at reduced or negative margins and constrain our ability to reallocate our production capacity to serve new customers or otherwise.

 

   

Our strategy of securing and maintaining long-term supply contracts and expanding our production capacity may not be successful.

 

   

We depend on a small number of customers for a significant portion of our revenues and any loss of this or our other key customers, including potentially through further customer consolidation, could result in significant declines in our revenues.


 

13


Table of Contents
   

We rely on a complex silicon supply chain and breakdowns in that chain could affect our ability to produce our products.

 

   

Reductions in demand and average selling prices for our customers’ end products (e.g., consumer electronics).

 

   

Our competitors have announced expansions and may continue to expand in the United States and Europe, which could materially and adversely affect our competitive position.

 

   

Sales to government entities and highly regulated organizations are subject to a number of challenges and added risks, and we could fail to comply with these heightened compliance requirements, or effectively manage these challenges or risks.

Risks Related to Manufacturing, Operations and Expansion

 

   

If we are unable to manage our capacity and production facilities effectively, our competitiveness may be weakened.

 

   

Our manufacturing processes are highly complex, costly and potentially vulnerable to impurities and other disruptions, and cost increases, that can significantly increase our costs and delay product shipments to our customers.

 

   

Our profit margin may substantially decline if we are unable to continually improve our manufacturing yields, maintain high shipment utilization or fail to optimize the process technology mix of our wafer production.

 

   

If we are unable to obtain adequate supplies of raw materials in a timely manner and at commercially reasonable prices our revenue and profitability may decline.

Risks Related to Intellectual Property

 

   

Any failure to obtain, maintain, protect or enforce our intellectual property and proprietary rights could impair our ability to protect our proprietary technology and our brand.

 

   

There is a risk that our trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information will be stolen, used in an unauthorized manner, or compromised.

 

   

The laws of some foreign countries may not be as protective of intellectual property rights as those in the United States, and mechanisms for enforcement of intellectual property rights may be inadequate.

 

   

Our success depends, in part, on our ability to develop and commercialize our technology without infringing, misappropriating or otherwise violating the intellectual property rights of third parties and we may not be aware of such infringements, misappropriations or violations.

 

   

We may be unable to provide technology to our customers if we lose the support of our technology partners.

 

   

We have been and may continue to become subject to intellectual property disputes, which are costly and may subject us to significant liability and increased costs of doing business.

Political, Regulatory and Legal Risks

 

   

Environmental, health and safety laws and regulations expose us to liability and risk of non-compliance, and any such liability or non-compliance may adversely affect our business.


 

14


Table of Contents
   

We are subject to governmental export and customs compliance requirements that could impair our ability to compete in international markets or subject us to liability if we violate the controls.

 

   

We are currently and may in the future become subject to litigation that could result in substantial costs, divert or continue to divert management’s attention and resources.

Risks Related to Our Status as a Controlled Company and Foreign Private Issuer

 

   

Mubadala will continue to have substantial control after this offering, which could limit your ability to influence the outcome of key transactions, including a change of control, and otherwise affect the prevailing market price of our ordinary shares.

 

   

We are a foreign private issuer and, as a result, are not subject to U.S. proxy rules but are subject to reporting obligations that, to some extent, are more lenient and less frequent than those of a U.S. issuer.

CORPORATE INFORMATION

We are an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability on October 7, 2008. Our principal executive offices are located at 400 Stonebreak Road Extension, Malta, New York 12020, United States, and our telephone number is (518) 305-9013. Our website address is www.gf.com. Information contained on, or that can be accessed through, our website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus, and you should not consider information on our website to be part of this prospectus.

The GF design logo, “GF” and our other registered or common law trademarks, service marks, or trade names appearing in this prospectus are the property of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. Other trade names, trademarks and service marks used in this prospectus are the property of their respective owners.


 

15


Table of Contents

OUR OFFERING

 

Ordinary shares offered by us

  

33,000,000 shares

Ordinary shares offered by us in the Concurrent Private Placement

  


1,685,393 shares (based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus)

Ordinary shares offered by Mubadala

  

22,000,000 shares (or 30,250,000 shares if the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option in full)

Ordinary shares to be outstanding after this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement

  


534,685,393 shares (based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus)

Option to purchase additional shares

  

Mubadala has granted an option to the underwriters, exercisable for 30 days after the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to 8,250,000 additional shares at the public offering price, less underwriting discounts and commissions.

Use of proceeds

  

We estimate that our net proceeds from this offering will be approximately $1.4 billion from the sale of the shares of ordinary shares offered by us in this offering, based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

 

 

We intend to use the anticipated net proceeds from this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement for capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes. We may use a portion of the net proceeds for acquisitions of technologies or businesses that complement our business, although we have no present commitments or agreements to enter into any such acquisitions or investments. See “Use of Proceeds” for additional information.

 

We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of ordinary shares by Mubadala in this offering.

Indications of interest

  

The cornerstone investors have indicated an interest in purchasing ordinary shares with an aggregate purchase price of approximately $1.05 billion in this offering at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. Because these indications of interest are not binding agreements or commitments to purchase, the cornerstone investors may decide to purchase more, less or no ordinary shares in this


 

16


Table of Contents
  

offering, or the underwriters may decide to sell more, less or no ordinary shares in this offering to the cornerstone investors. The underwriters will receive the same discount from any ordinary shares sold to the cornerstone investors as they will from any other ordinary shares sold to the public in this offering.

Dividend policy

  

We currently intend to retain all available funds and any future earnings to fund the development and growth of our business. Therefore, we do not anticipate declaring or paying any cash dividends to our shareholders in the foreseeable future. See “Dividend Policy” for additional information.

Directed share program

  

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 2,750,000 ordinary shares, or up to 5% of the shares offered by us and Mubadala in this offering, for sale at the initial public offering price through a directed share program to certain employees and other related persons identified by us.

 

The number of ordinary shares available for sale to the general public will be reduced to the extent that such persons purchase such reserved shares. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered by this prospectus. Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC will administer our directed share program.

 

See the sections titled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions,” “Shares Eligible for Future Sale,” and “Underwriters—Directed Share Program.”

Risk factors

  

You should read the section titled “Risk Factors” for a discussion of factors to consider carefully before deciding to invest in our shares.

Concurrent private placement

  

We have entered into a stock purchase agreement with Silver Lake, pursuant to which Silver Lake has agreed to purchase $75 million of our ordinary shares from us at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, Silver Lake would purchase 1,685,393 of our ordinary shares. The Concurrent Private Placement is expected to close immediately following the closing of this offering and is subject to customary closing conditions, including the completion of this offering pursuant to which the issuance and sale of ordinary shares by us, together with the issuance and sale of ordinary shares pursuant to the Concurrent Private Placement, results in aggregate gross proceeds of at least $1.25 billion. None of our ordinary shares to be sold in the Concurrent Private Placement will be registered and sold in this offering.


 

17


Table of Contents

Proposed Nasdaq symbol

  

“GFS”

The number of our ordinary shares to be outstanding after this offering is based on 500,000,000 ordinary shares outstanding as of October 13, 2021. Unless otherwise indicated, all information contained in this prospectus assumes no exercise of the option granted to the underwriters to purchase up to 8,250,000 additional ordinary shares at the public offering price, less underwriting discounts and commissions.

The number of ordinary shares to be outstanding after this offering does not take into account an aggregate of 27,550,470 ordinary shares available for future issuance under the 2018 Equity Plan, the Equity Plan and the ESPP (as defined under “Executive Compensation”), 21,811,038 ordinary shares subject to outstanding share options and 638,493 restricted share unit (“RSU”) awards granted under the 2018 Equity Plan, and 54,655 ordinary shares subject to outstanding share options granted under the 2017 LTIP.

In addition, except as otherwise noted, all information in this prospectus reflects our reverse share split, which was effective September 12, 2021, to reclassify:

 

   

all 1,153,804,300, 1,000,000,000 and 1,000,000,000 of our ordinary shares outstanding as of December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020 respectively, to 576,902,150, 500,000,000 and 500,000,000 ordinary shares, respectively; and

 

   

all 1,000,000,000 of our ordinary shares outstanding as of June 30, 2021 to 500,000,000 ordinary shares.


 

18


Table of Contents

SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

The following table summarizes our historical consolidated financial data at the dates and for the periods indicated. We have derived our summary consolidated statements of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, and for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, and our summary consolidated balance sheet data as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, and June 30, 2021 from our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. We prepare our annual financial statements in accordance with IFRS, as adopted by the IASB. We prepare our unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standard IAS No. 34 “Interim Financial Reporting,” or IAS 34. The financial information presented below may not be indicative of our future performance. The summary historical consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

    For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
(dollars in millions, except for share amounts)       2018             2019             2020             2020             2021      

Consolidated Statement of Operations data

         

Net revenues(1)

  $ 6,196     $ 5,813     $ 4,851     $ 2,697     $ 3,038  

Cost of revenues

    (6,646     (6,345     (5,563     (3,058     (2,708
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit (loss)(2)

    (450     (532     (713     (361     330  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Research and development expenses

    (926     (583     (476     (243     (235

Selling, general and administrative expenses

    (453     (446     (445     (210     (293
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    (1,379     (1,029     (921     (453     (528
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring charges

    (112                        

Impairment charges

    (582     (64     (23     2        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other operating charges

    (694     (64     (23     2        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations(2)

    (2,523     (1,625     (1,656     (815     (198

Finance income

    10       11       3       2       3  

Finance expenses

    (165     (230     (154     (82     (58

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

    7       8       4       2       2  

Gain on sale of a fabrication facility and application specific integrated circuit business

          615          

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

    61       74       440       395       (20
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes from continuing operations

    (2,610     (1,147     (1,363     (498     (271

Income tax (expense) benefit

    (16     (224     12       (36     (30
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss from continuing operations

    (2,626     (1,371   $ (1,351     (534     (301

Discontinued operations

         

Loss from discontinued operations, net of tax $1

    (148                        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss(2)

  $ (2,774   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to:

         

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

  $ (2,702   $ (1,371   $ (1,348   $ (533   $ (299

Non-controlling interest

    (72           (3     (1     (2
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss for the period

  $ (2,774   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301

Loss per share attributable to the equity holders of the company:

         

Basic and diluted loss per share:

         

From continuing operations

  $ (4.56   $ (2.72   $ (2.70   $ (1.06   $ (0.60

From discontinued operations

  $ (0.14   $     $     $     $  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share

  $ (4.70 )    $ (2.72   $ (2.70   $ (1.06   $ (0.60

 

19


Table of Contents

 

(1)

In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. For more information, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates—Revenue Recognition.” This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Had the change in terms not occurred, our net revenues in 2020 would have been an estimated $810 million higher than reported results. In addition, we divested our Application Specific Integrated Circuit (“ASIC”) business, Avera Semiconductor, in 2019. This business generated $391 million of revenue in 2019 and $402 million in 2018.

(2)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.

 

     Years Ended December 31,     Six Months Ended June 30,  
(dollars in millions)    2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows data

          

Net cash provided by operating activities

   $ 279     $ 497     $ 1,006     $ 539     $ 582  

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

     (1,167     344       (366     (166     (462

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     1,132       (684     (733     (99     (224

 

     As of December 31,      As of
June 30,

2021
 
(dollars in millions)    2019      2020  

Consolidated Balance Sheet data

        

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 997      $ 908      $ 805  

Total current assets

     3,514        2,987        3,008  

Total assets

     14,498        12,322        12,397  

Total current liabilities

     2,336        1,896        2,146  

Total liabilities

     5,478        5,080        5,464  

Total stockholder’s equity

     9,019        7,242        6,932  

We use non-IFRS financial information and believe it is useful to investors as it provides additional information to facilitate comparisons of historical operating results, and identify trends in our underlying operating results, and it provides additional insight and transparency on how we evaluate the business. These non-IFRS measures are used by both our management and our board of directors, together with the comparable IFRS information, in evaluating our current performance and planning future business activities. We have detailed the non-IFRS adjustments that we make in our non-IFRS definitions below. The adjustments generally fall within the categories of non-cash items, acquisition and integration costs, business transformation initiatives and financing-related costs. We believe the non-IFRS measures should always be considered along with the related IFRS financial measures. We have provided the reconciliations between the IFRS and non-IFRS financial measures below. For more information, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”


 

20


Table of Contents

The following table reconciles gross profit (loss) to adjusted gross profit (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, and the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively:

Adjusted gross profit (loss)

 

     For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
(dollars in millions)    2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      

Gross profit (loss) for the period(1)

   $ (450   $ (532   $ (713   $ (361   $ 330  

Share-based compensation

                             36  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted gross profit (loss)

   $ (450   $ (532   $ (713   $ (361   $ 366  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.

The following table reconciles loss from operations to adjusted loss from operations for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, and the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively:

Adjusted loss from operations

 

     For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
(dollars in millions)    2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      

Loss from operations for the period(1)

   $ (2,523   $ (1,625   $ (1,656   $ (815   $ (198

Share-based compensation

     5             1       1       144  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted loss from operations

   $ (2,518   $ (1,625   $ (1,655   $ (814   $ (54
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.

The following table reconciles net loss from continuing operations to adjusted EBITDA for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, and for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively:

Adjusted EBITDA

 

     For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
(dollars in millions)    2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      

Net loss from continuing operations(1)

   $ (2,626   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301

Adjustments to net loss from continuing operations:

          

Depreciation and amortization

     2,948       2,678       2,523       1,285       785  

Finance expense

     165       230       154       82       58  

Provision for income taxes

     16       224       (12     36       30  

Share-based compensation

     5             1       1       144  

Restructuring and corporate severance programs

     125             16       3       10  

(Gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses(2)

     21       (607     (356     (339     34  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

   $ 654     $ 1,154     $ 976     $ 535     $ 760  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

21


Table of Contents

 

(1)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.

(2)

See the table below for the composition of (gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses adjustment for each period presented:

 

     For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
(dollars in millions)    2018      2019     2020         2020             2021      

(Gain) on transactions(a)

   $      $ (682   $ (98   $ (63   $  

Legal settlements(b)

                  (294     (294     34  

Transaction expenses(c)

     21        75       36       18        
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total (gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses

   $ 21      $ (607   $ (356   $ (339   $ 34  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (a)  

As part of our strategic repositioning, for the year ended December 31, 2019, we recognized $615 million of gains related to the sale of the ASIC business and Singapore fabrication facility. Additionally, we recognized a gain on tool and equipment sales of $67 million, $98 million and $63 million for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, and the six months ended June 30, 2020, respectively. We exclude these gains as they are not representative of our ongoing business and impact investors’ ability to evaluate our business.

  (b)  

Represents $294 million gain directly associated with a patent legal settlement with a competitor for the year ended December 31, 2020, and $34 million related to a provision for a settlement with Chengdu, China local government (“CD”), regarding its request for the company to share in CD’s alleged losses and related costs incurred to support the parties’ joint venture for the six months ended June 30, 2021. We exclude these legal settlements as they are not representative of our ongoing business and impact investors’ ability to evaluate our business.

  (c)  

Represents transaction expenses for professional services rendered in connection with business combinations and dispositions. We exclude these charges because they are not reflective of our ongoing business and results of operations.

The following table reconciles net loss from continuing operations to adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, and for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively:

Adjusted net loss from continuing operations

 

     For the Years Ended
December 31,
    For the Six Months
Ended June 30,
 
(dollars in millions)    2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      

Net loss from continuing operations(1)

   $ (2,626   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301

Share-based compensation

     5             1       1       144  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted net loss from continuing operations

   $ (2,621   $ (1,371   $ (1,350   $ (533   $ (157
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted loss per share

   $ (4.54   $ (2.72   $ (2.70   $ (1.06   $ (0.32
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.


 

22


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

A description of the risks and uncertainties associated with our business and ownership of our shares is set forth below. You should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below, together with all of the other information in this prospectus, including the section titled “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Result of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus, before making a decision to invest in our shares. Our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects could also be harmed by risks and uncertainties that are not presently known to us or that we currently believe are not material. If any of the risks actually occur, our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects could be materially and adversely affected. In that event, the market price of our shares could decline and you could lose all or part of your investment.

Risks Related to our Business and Industry

Global economic and political conditions could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

The semiconductor industry relies on a global supply chain and is considered strategically important by major trading countries, including the United States, China, and countries in the EU. Political, economic and financial crises have in the past negatively affected and in the future could negatively affect the semiconductor industry and its end markets. Our business may also be materially affected by the impact of geopolitical tensions and related actions. In recent years, there have been political and trade tensions among, and between, a number of the world’s major economies, most notably in our industry between the United States and China, with Hong Kong and Taiwan implicated in the tensions. These tensions have resulted in the implementation of trade barriers, including the use of economic sanctions and export control restrictions against certain countries and individual companies. For example, over the past two years, the U.S. Department of Commerce’s Bureau of Industry and Security (“BIS”) placed one of the largest mobile handset and 5G infrastructure providers in the world, Huawei, and China’s largest semiconductor foundry, SMIC, on the BIS Entity List. Violations of these economic sanctions and export control restrictions can result in significant civil and criminal penalties. These trade barriers have had a particular impact on the semiconductor industry and related markets. Prolonged or increased use of trade barriers may result in a decrease in the growth of the global economy and semiconductor industry and could cause turmoil in global markets, which in turn often results in declines in our customers’ electronic products sales and could decrease demand for our products and services. Also, any increase in the use of economic sanctions or export control restrictions to target certain countries and companies could impact our ability to continue supplying products and services to those customers and our customers’ demand for our products and services, and could disrupt semiconductor supply chains.

Any future systemic political, economic or financial crisis or market volatility, including interest rate fluctuations, inflation or deflation and changes in economic, trade, fiscal and monetary policies in major economies, could cause revenue or profits for us or the semiconductor industry as a whole to decline dramatically. If the economic conditions in the markets in which our customers operate or the financial condition of our customers were to deteriorate, the demand for our products and services may decrease and impairments, write-downs and other accounting charges may be required, which could reduce our operating income and net income. Further, in times of market instability, sufficient external financing may not be available to us on a timely basis, on commercially reasonable terms or at all. If sufficient external financing is not available when we need such financing to meet our demand-driven capital requirements, we may be forced to curtail expansion, modify plans and delay the deployment of new or differentiated technologies, products, or services until we obtain such financing. Further escalation of trade tensions, the increased use of economic sanctions or export control restrictions or any future global systemic crisis or economic downturn could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

 

23


Table of Contents

We have long-term supply agreements with certain customers that obligate us to meet specific production requirements, which may expose us to liquidated and other damages, require us to return advanced payments, require us to provide products and services at reduced or negative margins and constrain our ability to reallocate our production capacity to serve new customers or otherwise.

In response to the current global semiconductor supply shortage and in connection with our focus on differentiated technology platforms and deeper customer engagements, we have entered into multiple long-term supply agreements that provide for significant customer commitments in return for capacity reservation commitments from us. In many cases, in connection with these arrangements we have received, or will receive, customer advanced payments and capacity reservation fees. If we are unable to satisfy our obligations under these contracts, we may be forced to return such payments which could result in significant cash expenditures. Under most of our long-term supply agreements, we must maintain sufficient capacity at our manufacturing facilities to meet anticipated customer demand for our proprietary products. From time to time, this requires us to invest in expansion or improvements of those facilities, which often involves substantial cost and other risks, such as delays in completion. Such expanded manufacturing capacity may still be insufficient, or may not come online soon enough, to meet customer demand and we may have to limit the amount of products we can supply to customers, forgo sales or lose customers as a result. Further, capacity reserved for certain customers could cause us to breach obligations to other customers due to capacity constraints, or prevent us from serving new customers. If we are unable to satisfy our obligations under our customer agreements, we may be subject to significant liquidated damages or penalties, which could result in significant cash expenditures and require us to raise additional capital. Conversely, if we overestimate customer demand or a customer defaults on its purchase or payment obligations to us, we could experience underutilization of capacity at these facilities without a corresponding reduction in fixed costs. Our inability to maintain appropriate capacity could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Our strategy of securing and maintaining long-term supply contracts and expanding our production capacity may not be successful.

We have undertaken, and will continue to undertake, various business strategies to sell a significant portion of our production capacity through long-term supply contracts, grow our production capacity, and improve operating efficiencies and generate cost savings. We cannot assure you that we will successfully implement those business strategies or that implementing these strategies will sustain or improve and not harm our results of operations. In particular, our ability to implement our strategy to enter into long-term supply contracts successfully is subject to certain risks, including:

 

   

customers defaulting on their obligations to us, which may include significant payment obligations;

 

   

our defaulting on our obligations to our customers (for example, due to raw materials shortages or production disruptions), which could result in us owing substantial penalties to our customers;

 

   

customers seeking to renegotiate key terms of their contracts, such as pricing and specified volume commitments, in the event market conditions change during the contract term; and

 

   

our inability to extend contracts when they expire.

As a result, we cannot assure you that we will successfully implement this strategy or realize the anticipated benefits of these contracts.

Additionally, the costs involved in implementing our strategies may be significantly greater than we currently anticipate. For example, our ability to complete production capacity expansions or make other operational improvements as planned may be delayed, interrupted or made more costly by the need to obtain environmental and other regulatory approvals, the availability of semiconductor manufacturing equipment, labor and materials, unforeseen hazards, such as weather conditions, and other risks customarily associated with construction projects. Moreover, the cost of expanding production capacity could have a negative impact on our financial results until shipment utilization is sufficient to absorb the incremental costs associated with the expansion.

Our ability to successfully implement these strategies depends on a variety of factors, including, among other things, our ability to finance our operations, maintain high-quality and efficient manufacturing operations,

 

24


Table of Contents

respond to competitive and regulatory changes, access semiconductor manufacturing equipment or quality raw materials in a cost-effective and timely manner, and retain and attract highly skilled personnel. Further, some of our long-term supply agreements constrain our ability to change product mix within short time frames, given “end of life” provisions in our agreements that require substantial notice periods before we can cease production of existing products. Since 2018, we have been in the process of pivoting our development resources to focus on differentiated technologies, based an analysis of market dynamics and our competitive strengths. Any failure to continue implementing this strategic pivot in a timely and cost-effective manner could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We depend on a small number of customers for a significant portion of our revenues and any loss of this or our other key customers, including potentially through further customer consolidation, could result in significant declines in our revenues.

We have been largely dependent on a small number of customers for a substantial portion of our business. Our ten largest customers in 2018, 2019 and 2020 accounted for approximately 75%, 73% and 73% of our wafer shipment volume, respectively. We expect that a significant portion of our revenue will continue to come from a relatively limited number of customers. We cannot assure you that our revenue generated from these customers, individually or in the aggregate, will reach or exceed historical levels in any future period. Loss or cancellation of business from, significant changes in scheduled deliveries to, or decrease of products and services sold to any of these customers could significantly reduce our revenue. Additionally, the increasing trend in mergers and acquisition activities in the semiconductor industry could reduce the total available customer base.

We rely on a complex silicon supply chain and breakdowns in that chain could affect our ability to produce our products and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We rely on a small number of suppliers for wafers, which is a key input into our products. In particular, only a limited number of companies in the world are able to produce SOI wafers. If there is an insufficient supply of wafers, particularly SOI wafers, to satisfy our requirements, we may need to limit or delay our production, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. If our limited source suppliers and suppliers for wafer preparation were to experience difficulties that affected their manufacturing yields or the quality of the materials they supply to us, it could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. In particular, we depend on Soitec S.A. (“Soitec”), our largest supplier of SOI wafers, for the timely provision of wafers in order to meet our production goals and obligations to customers. We have entered into multiple long-term agreements with Soitec across a wide spectrum of SOI products. Soitec supplied 52% of our SOI wafers in 2020. In April 2017, we entered into a multi-year materials supply agreement with Soitec that expires in 2022, with automatic annual extensions unless terminated by either party. In that same year, we agreed to an addendum to the materials supply agreement for FDXTM wafers, in particular, as amended and restated in 2021. In November 2020, we agreed to an addendum to our original materials supply agreement to secure supply for 300 mm RF SOI, partially-depleted SOI and SiPh wafers. Our supply agreements with Soitec impose mutual obligations, in the form of capacity requirements, minimum purchase requirements and supply share percentages. We may be subject to penalties if we fail to comply with such obligations. If we are unable to obtain 300mm SOI wafers from Soitec for any reason, we expect that it would be challenging, if not infeasible, to find a replacement supplier on commercially acceptable terms in the near term. While we are in the process of developing relationships with alternate suppliers, we do not expect to be able to acquire a significant amount of SOI wafers from those suppliers in the near term, and there is no assurance that we will ever be able to do so.

The ability of our suppliers to meet our requirements could be impaired or interrupted by factors beyond their control, such as earthquakes or other natural phenomena, labor strikes or shortages, or political unrest or failure to obtain materials for their suppliers. For example, Soitec is reliant on third-party providers to obtain raw silicon wafers—difficulties in obtaining raw silicon wafers may result in Soitec’s inability to produce SOI

 

25


Table of Contents

wafers. In the event one of our suppliers is unable to deliver products to us or is unwilling to sell materials or components to us, our operations may be adversely affected. Further, financial or other difficulties faced by our suppliers, or significant changes in demand for the components or materials they use in the products they supply to us, could limit the availability of those products, components, or materials to us. Any breakdown of our wafer supply chain could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Reductions in demand and average selling prices (“ASPs”) for our customers’ end products (e.g., consumer electronics) and increases in inflation may decrease demand for our products and services and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

The substantial majority of our revenue is derived from customers who use our products in intelligent and highly connected devices in markets such as Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. A deterioration or a slowdown in the growth of such end markets resulting in a substantial decrease in the demand for overall global semiconductor foundry services, including our products and services, could adversely affect our revenue and profit margins. Semiconductor manufacturing facilities require substantial investment to construct and are largely fixed-cost assets once they are in operation. Because we own our manufacturing facilities, a significant portion of our operating costs are fixed. In general, these costs do not decline when customer demand or our shipment utilization rate drops, and thus declines in customer demand, among other factors, may significantly decrease our profit margins. Our costs may also increase as a result of, among other things, inflation, which may have a greater impact on our profit margins than ASPs. In the past, there have been periods of sustained decline in ASPs of our customers’ end products and applications. A return to historical trends could place downward pressure on the prices of the components, including our products, that go into such end products and applications. If ASPs decline and our cost reduction programs and actions do not offset the decrease or our costs increase due to inflation or otherwise and are not offset by an increase in ASPs, our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects may be materially and adversely affected.

The seasonality and cyclical nature of the semiconductor industry and periodic overcapacity make us vulnerable to significant and sometimes prolonged economic downturns.

The semiconductor industry has exhibited cyclicality in the past and, at various times, has experienced downturns. Fluctuations in our customers’ demand drive significant variations in order levels for our products and services and can result in volatility in our revenues and earnings. Because our business is, and will continue to be, largely dependent on the requirements of both consumer and industrial high-end technology product suppliers for our services, downturns in this broad industry will likely lead to reduced demand for our products and services.

Demand for our customers’ end products is affected by seasonal variations in market conditions that contribute to the fluctuations of demand and prices for semiconductor services and products. The seasonal sales trends for semiconductor services and products closely mirror those for automotive, consumer electronics, communication and computer sales. These seasonal variations, and seasonal variation changes that we cannot anticipate, may result in increased volatility in our results of operation and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Overcapacity in the semiconductor industry may reduce our revenues, earnings and margins.

The prices that we can charge our customers for manufacturing services are significantly related to the overall worldwide supply of ICs and semiconductor products. The overall supply of semiconductors is based in part on the capacity of other companies, which is outside of our control. For example, in light of current market conditions, we and some other companies, including competitors with access to material government support, have announced plans to increase capacity expenditures significantly. Additionally, some nations, including

 

26


Table of Contents

China, are investing heavily in developing additional domestic capacity for semiconductor fabrication. We believe such plans, if carried out as planned, will increase the industry-wide capacity and could result in overcapacity in the future. In periods of overcapacity, if we are unable to offset the adverse effects of overcapacity through, among other things, our technology and product mix, we may have to lower the prices we charge our customers for our services and/or we may have to operate at significantly less than full capacity. Such actions could reduce our margin and profitability and weaken our financial condition and results of operations. We cannot give any assurance that an increase in the demand for foundry services in the immediate and short-term will not lead to overcapacity in the future, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

If we are unable to attract customers with our technology, respond to fast-changing semiconductor market dynamics or maintain our leadership in product quality, we will become less competitive.

The semiconductor industry and the technologies it brings to market are constantly being created and evolving. We compete by developing process technologies that incorporate increasingly higher performance and advanced features, offering increasing functionality depending upon the customer’s application requirements. If we do not anticipate these changes in technology requirements and fail to rapidly develop new and innovative solutions to meet these demands, we may not be able to provide foundry services on competitive terms with respect to cost, schedule or volume manufacturing capacity. There is a risk that our competitors may successfully adopt new or more differentiated technology before we do, resulting in us losing design wins (including in cases in which we have expended significant resources to pursue design wins) and market share. If we are unable to continue to offer differentiated services and processes on a competitive and timely basis, we may lose customers to competitors providing similar or better technologies.

A key differentiator in the marketplace is to significantly reduce the time in which technology products or services are launched into the market. If we are unable to meet the shorter time-to-market requirements of our customers or fail to impress them with our newer technology solutions or are unable to allocate or develop new production capacity to meet those customers’ demands in a timely manner, we risk losing their business and not generating the market adoption needed to pay for our development efforts. These factors have also been intensified by the shift of the global technology market to consumer-driven products and increasing concentration of customers and competition. Further, the increasing complexity of technology also imposes challenges for achieving expected product quality, cost and time-to-market expectations. If we fail to maintain quality, it may result in loss of revenue and additional cost, as well as loss of business or customer trust. If we are unable to meet the expected production yields of a new technology, we will not be able to meet the expected costs of that technology. In addition, the market prices for technology and services tend to fall over time, except in times of extreme supply shortage. As a result, if we are unable to offer new differentiated services and processes on a competitive and timely basis, we may need to decrease the prices that we set for our existing services and processes. If we are unable to innovate new and differentiated technologies and bring them to a cost-competitive volume manufacturing scale that meets the demand of our customers, we may become less competitive and our revenue and margins may decline significantly.

External risks also exist that can impact our position as a technology leader. Differentiated technology offerings may rely upon unique or specialized materials as compared to our competitors, including specialized wafers upon which some of our technologies are currently manufactured, raw materials for wafer fabrication, and materials used in the packaging of ICs to enable them to be used in the end products. A disruption in the availability of or quality of these new or unique materials during technology development can impact time-to-market, or have impact on the quality or cost of finished goods in the marketplace. Similarly, our technology roadmap relies on externally sourced design tools and component circuit designs that allow our end customers to more readily realize their products in our technologies, and disruption or delays in our ability to obtain those resources may impair our ability to compete effectively and serve our customers.

The rapidly changing nature of advanced semiconductor technology can also culminate in the emergence of highly disruptive or unconventional technologies and new disruptive solutions using existing technologies, which

 

27


Table of Contents

can create a rapid inflection point leaving those on a conventional technology roadmap path at a significant disadvantage and unprepared to react in a timely manner.

If we are unable to compete effectively with other sophisticated players in the highly competitive foundry segment of the semiconductor industry, we may lose customers and our profit margins and earnings may decrease.

The foundry market is comprised of five major pure-play foundries that accounted for the vast majority of worldwide foundry revenue in 2020, according to a March 2021 Gartner Semiconductor Foundry Worldwide Market Share report. TSMC at $46 billion of wafer revenue in 2020 accounted for more than 58% of the total market, while the next four players combined made up only 27% of the market. Other key competitors include SMIC and UMC, as well as the foundry operation services of some integrated device manufacturers, such as Samsung and, more recently, Intel Corporation (“Intel”). IDMs principally manufacture and sell their own proprietary semiconductor products but may also offer foundry services. Other smaller dedicated foundry competitors include X-FAB Silicon Foundries, Tower Semiconductor Ltd., Vanguard International Semiconductor Corporation (“Vanguard”) and WIN Semiconductors Corp. Some of our competitors may offer more advanced or differentiated technologies than we do and some have greater access to capital and substantially greater production capacity, R&D, marketing and other resources, including access to government subsidies and economic stimulus (including protective demand-side measures), than we do. As a result, these companies may be able to compete more aggressively over a longer period of time than we can.

The principal elements of competition in the wafer foundry market include:

 

   

scale and the ability to access capital to fund future growth;

 

   

capacity utilization;

 

   

technical competence, including internal and access to external design enablement capabilities;

 

   

technology leadership and differentiation;

 

   

price;

 

   

time-to-volume production and cycle time;

 

   

time-to-market;

 

   

investment in R&D and related quality of results;

 

   

manufacturing yields;

 

   

optimization of the technology mix of wafer production at particular process technology nodes;

 

   

design/technology interaction and resulting chip reliability;

 

   

customer service and design support;

 

   

management expertise; and

 

   

strategic alliances and geographic diversification.

Our ability to compete successfully also depends on factors partially outside of our control, including component supply, intellectual property, including cell libraries that our customers embed in their product designs, and industry and general economic trends.

Our competitors have announced expansions and may continue to expand in the United States and Europe, which could materially and adversely affect our competitive position.

TSMC, Samsung and Intel have recently announced plans to develop new fabs and substantially increase their manufacturing capacity in the United States, and other competitors may seek to do likewise. Similarly, our

 

28


Table of Contents

competitors may seek to develop new fabs in Europe and substantially increase their manufacturing capacity. Such expansions may increase the attractiveness of our competitors to customers who wish to utilize fabs located in the United States or Europe, use geographically dispersed suppliers or mitigate risks posed by geopolitical tensions and export controls. Further, it may lead to increased competition for funding and talent in those jurisdictions. This increased competition could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

The semiconductor industry is capital-intensive and, if we are unable to invest the necessary capital to operate and grow our business, we may not remain competitive.

To remain competitive and comply with evolving regulatory requirements, we must constantly improve our facilities and process technologies and carry out extensive R&D, each of which requires investment of significant amounts of capital. The costs of manufacturing facilities and semiconductor manufacturing equipment continue to rise. We expect to incur additional capital expenditures in connection with our revenue expansion plans to expand our fabs in Dresden, Germany; Malta, New York; and Singapore. On June 22, 2021, we announced plans to spend approximately $4.0 billion to expand our Fab 7 operations in Singapore, and on July 19, 2021 announced fab expansion plans in Malta, New York involving approximately $1.0 billion, with the construction of a new fab on the same campus to follow. Our actual expenditures may exceed our planned spend due to global economic and industry-wide equipment or material price increases during the long lead time to build capacity. Given the fixed-cost nature of our business, we have in the past incurred, and may in the future incur, operating losses if our revenues do not adequately offset the impact of our capital expenditures and the cost of financing these expenditures. Additionally, a significant portion of any operating income we do generate is needed to service our outstanding debt.

We invest significantly in R&D, and to the extent our R&D efforts are unsuccessful, our competitive position may be harmed and we may not be able to realize a return on our investments. To compete successfully, we must maintain a successful R&D effort, develop new product technologies, features and manufacturing processes, and improve our existing products and services, technologies and processes. Our R&D efforts may not deliver the benefits we anticipate. To the extent we do not timely introduce new technologies and features relative to competitors, we could face cost, product performance, and time-to-market disadvantages, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Financing, including equity capital, debt financing, customer co-investments and government subsidies, may not be available on commercially acceptable terms or at all. Any additional debt financing we may undertake could require debt service and financial and operational requirements that could adversely affect our business. If we are unable to generate sufficient cash or raise sufficient capital to meet both our debt service and capital investment requirements, or if we are unable to raise required capital on favorable terms when needed, we may be forced to curtail revenue expansion plans or delay capital investment, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may not be able to implement our planned growth and development or maintain the differentiation of our solutions if we are unable to recruit and retain key executives, managers and skilled technical personnel.

We rely on the continued services and contributions of our management team and skilled technical and professional personnel. In this industry, the competitive pressures to find and retain the most talented personnel are intense and constant. The top talent in the industry is often well-known and pursued by competitors. In addition, with the speed of technological and business change, skills need to be constantly refreshed and built upon. Our business could suffer if we are unable to fulfill and sustain resource requirements with qualified individuals in required positions globally. Fulfilling new resource needs on a timely basis continues to be a challenge in this highly competitive market for semiconductor talent. Competition for talent exists in all of our operating regions, emphasizing the importance of strong employee retention, and if we fail to attract and retain top talent, our business and results of operations could be materially adversely impacted.

 

29


Table of Contents

We receive subsidies and grants in certain countries and regions in which we operate, and a reduction in the amount of governmental funding available to us or demands for repayment could increase our costs and affect our results of operations.

As is the case with other large semiconductor companies, we receive subsidies and grants from governments in certain countries and regions in which we operate. In response to increased geopolitical tensions, national security and supply chain concerns, as well as recent supply shortages, government funding such as the proposed United States Innovation and Competition Act in the United States, which includes the CHIPS Act and the R&D funding in the Endless Frontiers Act, and the “second” IPCEI in Europe are in the process of being adopted or funded, resulting in potentially significant new sources of capital and R&D investment for our industry. Historically, we have benefitted from government investment programs, and we intend to continue to benefit from government programs to help fund our expansion efforts. However, we may be unable to secure government funding at the levels we expect or at all, and the availability of government funding is outside our control. Moreover, should we terminate any activities or operations related to government funds that we receive or upon which government funds have been conditioned, we may face adverse consequences. In particular, government agencies could seek to recover subsidies or grants from us, seek repayment of loans, or could cancel, reduce or deny our requests for future subsidies or grants. This could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Strong government support in China for capacity expansion, combined with weaker demand from and strained economic relations with that country, could lead to underutilization or significant ASP erosion for fab fill.

China’s aggressive investment in its “buy from China” initiatives have inflated the capital available for technology development in China and resulted in an expansion of fabrication capacity for semiconductors. China’s decision to build capacity for China, to be sourced primarily from indigenous suppliers like SMIC, will have the effect of limiting the Chinese market for other global suppliers like us. Increases in China’s fabrication capacity for semiconductors may also significantly increase the competition we face globally, which may make it more difficult for us to retain and obtain new customers and lead to material reductions in ASPs.

Any outbreak of contagious disease, such as the recent COVID-19 pandemic, could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Any outbreak of contagious disease, including, but not limited to, COVID-19, Zika virus, Ebola virus, avian or swine influenza or severe acute respiratory syndrome, may disrupt our ability to adequately staff our business and may generally disrupt our operations. The recent outbreak of COVID-19 has slowed economic growth, including in regions of the world where we, our customers and suppliers operate, and has negatively impacted the global supply chain, market and economies. We have significant operations in the United States, Europe, and Singapore, including supply chain and manufacturing facilities and sales and marketing channels and information technology (“IT”) design and other support services in these countries and regions as well as other countries such as Japan, India, Bulgaria, Taiwan and China.

If the COVID-19 outbreak worsens or continues longer term, or new outbreaks of COVID-19 or other contagious diseases occur, we may experience material adverse effects on our business, including, among other things:

 

   

declines in sales activities and customer orders;

 

   

significant fluctuations in demand for our products and services, which could in turn cause uncertainty for our capacity planning, production delays and reduced workforce availability;

 

   

difficulties in domestic and international travel and communications and interruption;

 

   

delays in our planned expansion in Singapore, including from temporary governmental work stoppage orders to control COVID-19 infection rates or as a result of border closures with Malaysia, both of which have occurred;

 

30


Table of Contents
   

delays in other potential expansion plans; or

 

   

slowdown of R&D activities.

Likewise, such an outbreak of disease could slow or suspend the operations of our suppliers and cause them to be unable to deliver needed raw materials as required. Any of these factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Sales to government entities and highly regulated organizations are subject to a number of challenges and added risks, and our failure to comply with these heightened compliance requirements, or effectively manage these challenges or risks, could impact our operations and financial results.

We currently sell to the U.S. federal government and to customers in highly regulated industries, and may sell to state and local governments and to foreign governmental agency customers in the future. Sales to such entities are subject to a number of compliance challenges and risks, including regarding access to and required protection of classified information. Failure to comply with Foreign Ownership, Control or Influence, or “FOCI”, agreements could lead to a loss of our security clearance and certain government business and reputational harm. Selling to governmental and highly regulated entities can be highly competitive, expensive and time-consuming, often requiring significant upfront time and expense without any assurance that these efforts will generate a sale. Government contracting requirements may change and in doing so restrict our ability to sell into the government sector until we have attained any revised necessary certification or authorization. Government demand and payment for our products and services are affected by public sector budgetary cycles and funding authorizations, with funding reductions or delays adversely affecting public sector demand for our products and services. Such sales are made more difficult by the fact that many of our product design and life cycles are very long, compared to public fiscal budget calendars.

Further, governmental and highly regulated entities may demand contract terms that differ from our standard commercial arrangements, and those contract terms may be in some respects less favorable than terms agreed to by private sector customers. Governments routinely retain certain rights to IP developed in connection with government contracts. Such entities may have statutory, contractual or other legal rights to terminate contracts with us or our partners for convenience or for other reasons that are out of our control or influence. Any such terminations, or other adverse actions, may materially adversely affect our ability to contract with other government customers, as well as our reputation, results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. In addition, our U.S. government contracts obligate us to comply with various cybersecurity requirements. These requirements include ongoing investment in systems, policies and personnel, and we expect these requirements to continue to impact our business in the future by increasing our legal, operational and compliance costs.

Certain of our government contracts require us to notify the applicable governmental actor and discuss options with the governmental actor before making certain potential transfers of intellectual property developed under those contracts, and certain of our government contracts impose specific limitations on our use and licensing of certain of our intellectual property. Additionally, production of sensitive, export-controlled products for governmental and highly regulated entities requires adherence to strict export and security controls. In the event of a breach or other security event involving one of these products, we may be subject to investigations to determine the extent and impact to such products, regulatory proceedings, litigation, mitigation and other actions, as well as penalties, fines, increased insurance premiums, indemnification expenditures and administrative, civil and criminal liabilities and reputational harm, each of which could negatively impact operations for multiple products and future business, cause production and sales delays and materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may be exposed to liabilities if it is determined that our compensation arrangements do not comply with, or are not exempt from, Section 409A of the Code.

Section 409A (“Section 409A”) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (“the Code”), sets forth the rules governing non-qualified deferred compensation arrangements. Section 409A contains many technical,

 

31


Table of Contents

complicated and ambiguous rules and regulations, including proposed but not yet finalized regulations that do not currently have the force of law, making compliance with Section 409A difficult to assess and to ensure. While we have attempted to structure our compensation arrangements (including our equity incentive awards) so that they either comply with, or are exempt from, Section 409A, it is possible that some of these compensation arrangements are not so exempt or compliant. In some instances, we have determined that amendments to certain of our compensation arrangements were advisable in order to mitigate or eliminate potential Section 409A non-compliance risk, though there can be no assurance that such amendments will mitigate or eliminate any such risk. If it is determined that any of our compensation arrangements are neither compliant with, nor exempt from, Section 409A, we may be subject to significant liabilities and costs, including penalties for failing to properly report deferred compensation arrangements under Section 409A and to withhold taxes payable by our service providers, including our employees, and we may be required to pay to the applicable governmental authorities the amount of taxes we should have withheld and related interest and penalties. In addition, those of our service providers, including our employees, participating in such arrangements may experience significant adverse tax consequences under Section 409A, including a 20% federal penalty tax imposed on the amount of compensation involved (and, as applicable, similar excise taxes under state law or foreign law). These liabilities may be significant and the imposition of such liabilities may materially affect our employee relations. In addition, in the event any such liabilities were imposed on our service providers, including our employees, we could decide to take remedial action, including making cash payments to adversely affected service providers, including our employees. Any amounts so paid by us could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

The market data and forecasts included in this prospectus may prove to be inaccurate, and you should not unduly rely on such market data and forecasts.

The market data and forecasts included in this prospectus are subject to significant uncertainty and are based on assumptions and estimates that may not prove to be accurate. Such reports speak as of their respective publication dates and the opinions expressed in such reports are subject to change, including as a result of the impact of COVID-19 on the global economy. Accordingly, potential investors in our ordinary shares should not place undue reliance on such forecasts and market data.

Improper disclosure of confidential information could negatively impact our business.

In the ordinary course of our business, we maintain sensitive data on our networks, including our intellectual property and proprietary or confidential business information relating to our business and that of our customers and business partners. In addition, we regularly enter into confidentiality obligations with our customers, suppliers and parties that we license intellectual property to or from. The secure maintenance of this information is critical to our business and reputation. We have put in place policies, procedures and technological safeguards designed to protect the security of this information. However, we cannot guarantee that this information will not be improperly disclosed or accessed. Disclosure of this information could harm our reputation, subject us to liability under our contracts and harm our relationships with key counterparties, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Risks Related to Manufacturing, Operations and Expansion

If we are unable to manage our capacity and production facilities effectively, our competitiveness may be weakened.

We perform long-term market demand forecasts for our products to manage, and plan for, our overall capacity. Because market conditions are dynamic, our market demand forecasts may change significantly at any time. During periods of decreased demand, certain manufacturing lines or tools in some of our manufacturing facilities may be idled or shut down temporarily, to save costs while preserving capacity. However, if subsequent demand increases rapidly, we may not be able to restore the capacity in a timely manner to take advantage of the

 

32


Table of Contents

upturn. In light of market demand forecasts, we have recently been adding capacity to meet market needs for our products. Expansion of our capacity will increase our costs. For example, we will need to purchase additional equipment, and hire and train additional personnel to operate the new equipment. If demand does not increase as planned, we may not increase our net revenues accordingly, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Because we own and operate high-tech manufacturing facilities, our operations have high costs that are fixed or difficult to reduce in the short term, including our costs related to utilization of existing facilities, facility construction and equipment, R&D, and the employment and training of a highly skilled workforce. To the extent demand decreases or we fail to forecast demand accurately, we could be required to write off inventory or record underutilization charges, which would lower our gross margin. To the extent any demand decrease is prolonged, our manufacturing capacity could be underutilized, and we may be required to write down our long-lived assets, which would increase our expenses. We may also be required to shorten the useful life of under-used facilities and equipment and accelerate depreciation.

Our manufacturing processes are highly complex, costly and potentially vulnerable to impurities and other disruptions, and cost increases, that can significantly increase our costs and delay product shipments to our customers.

Our semiconductor manufacturing processes are highly complex, require advanced and costly equipment, and are continuously being modified to improve manufacturing yields and product performance intended to improve or protect our ability to achieve our revenue and profit plan. Disruptions in manufacturing operations could be caused by numerous issues including impurities in our raw materials (such as chemicals, gases and wafers), facilities issues (such as electrical power and water outages), equipment failures (such as performance issues or defects) or IT issues (such as down computer systems and viruses). Any of these issues, and others, could lower production yields or interrupt manufacturing, which could result in the loss of products in process that could cause delivery delays, reduced revenue, increased cost or reduced quality delivered to our customers. These factors could significantly affect our financial results as well as our ability to attract new and retain existing customers.

In the past, we have encountered, among other issues:

 

   

capacity constraints due to changes in product mix or the delayed delivery of equipment critical to our production;

 

   

construction delays during expansions of our clean rooms and other facilities;

 

   

difficulties in upgrading or expanding existing facilities;

 

   

failure of manufacturing execution system or automatic transportation systems;

 

   

unexpected breakdowns in manufacturing equipment and/or related facilities;

 

   

disruptions in connection with changing or upgrading our process technologies;

 

   

raw materials shortages and impurities; and

 

   

delays in delivery or shortages of spare parts used in the maintenance of our equipment.

If the above issues recur or we face similar challenges in the future, we may suffer delays in our ability to deliver our products, which could have a material and adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. In addition, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to increase our manufacturing capacity and efficiency in the future to the same extent as in the past. Additionally, increases in the costs of key inputs to fabs, including raw materials, electric power and water, could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

 

33


Table of Contents

We are subject to risks associated with the development and implementation of new manufacturing technologies.

Production of ICs is a complex process. We are continually engaged in the development of new manufacturing process technologies and features. Forecasting our progress and schedule for developing new process technologies and features is challenging, and at times we encounter unexpected delays due to the complexity of interactions among steps in the manufacturing process, challenges in using new materials, and other issues. We may expend substantial resources on developing new technologies that are ultimately not successful, which may result in our recognizing significant impairment charges. Diagnosing defects in our manufacturing processes often takes a long time, as manufacturing throughput times can delay our receipt of data about defects and the effectiveness of fixes. We are not always successful or efficient in developing or implementing new technologies and manufacturing processes.

Our profit margin may substantially decline if we are unable to continually improve our manufacturing yields, maintain high shipment utilization or fail to optimize the process technology mix of our wafer production.

Our ability to maintain our profit margin depends, in part, on our ability to:

 

   

maintain high capacity utilization;

 

   

maintain or improve our production yields; and

 

   

optimize the technology mix of our production by increasing the number of wafers manufactured by utilizing different processing technologies.

Our shipment utilization affects our operating results because a large percentage of our operating costs is fixed. Our manufacturing yields directly affect our ability to attract and retain customers, as well as the prices of our services. Different technologies load the available capacity differently, and an increase of lower margin product demand could lower the financial performance of a factory while still fully utilizing the available capacity. If we are unable to continuously maintain high capacity utilization, improve our manufacturing yields or optimize the technology mix of our wafer production, our profit margin may substantially decline.

Our manufacturing processes are highly complex, require advanced and costly equipment and are continuously being modified in an effort to improve yields and product performance. Minute impurities or other difficulties in the manufacturing process can lower yields. Further, at the beginning of each semiconductor technological upgrade, the manufacturing yield utilizing the new technology may be lower than the yield under current technology. Our manufacturing efficiency is an important factor in our profitability, and we cannot assure you that we will be able to maintain our manufacturing efficiency or increase manufacturing efficiency to the same extent as our competitors.

In addition, as is common in the semiconductor industry, we have from time to time experienced difficulty in effecting transitions to new manufacturing processes. As a consequence, we may suffer delays in product deliveries or reduced yields. We may experience manufacturing problems in achieving acceptable yields or experience product delivery delays in the future as a result of, among other things, capacity constraints, upgrading or expanding our existing facilities or changing our process technologies, any of which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may be unable to obtain manufacturing equipment in a timely manner and at a reasonable cost that is necessary for us to remain competitive.

Our operations and ongoing revenue expansion plans depend on our ability to obtain complex and specialized manufacturing equipment and related services from a limited number of suppliers in a market that is characterized from time to time by limited supply and long delivery cycles. During such times, supplier-specific or industry-wide lead times for delivery can be as long as twelve months or more. Further, growing complexities

 

34


Table of Contents

of the most valuable equipment may delay the timely delivery of such equipment and parts needed to capitalize on time-sensitive and perishable business opportunities. Industry-wide demand increases for this equipment could increase its market price as well as the market price of replacement parts and consumable materials needed to operate the equipment. As a result of demand driven by the semiconductor supply shortage, as well as significant new sources of funding in China as well as potentially other governments (such as Korea, the United States and Europe), the current demand for semiconductor manufacturing equipment and equipment supply constraints are resulting in longer than normal lead times for such equipment. If we are unable to obtain equipment in a timely manner to fulfill our customers’ demand on technology and production capacity, or at a reasonable cost, we may be unable to meet commitments under our contracts with customers, which could expose us to substantial liquidated damages and other claims and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

If we are unable to obtain adequate supplies of raw materials in a timely manner and at commercially reasonable prices our revenue and profitability may decline.

Our production operations require that we obtain adequate supplies of raw materials, such as silicon wafers, gases, chemicals and photoresist, on a timely basis and at commercially reasonable prices, many of which are not commodities easily replaced with substitutions. In the past, shortages in the supply of some materials, whether by specific vendors or by the industry generally, have resulted in occasional industry-wide price adjustments and delivery delays. Moreover, major natural disasters, trade barriers and political or economic turmoil occurring within the country of origin of such raw materials may also significantly disrupt the availability of such raw materials or increase their prices. Further, since we procure some of our raw materials from sole-sourced suppliers, there is a risk that our need for such raw materials may not be met or that back-up supplies may not be readily available. In addition, recent trade tensions between the United States and China could result in increased prices or the unavailability of raw materials, including rare earth metals used in our products. Tariffs, export control or other non-tariff barriers, due to global or local economic conditions could also affect material cost and availability.

Certain raw materials and other inputs, such as electricity and water, necessary for our production operations may experience substantial price volatility. Hedging transactions for many of those raw materials and other inputs are not available to us, or are not available on terms we believe are commercially acceptable. Hedges that we enter into with respect to certain inputs, such as electricity, may not be effective. Additionally, once our prices with a customer are negotiated, we are generally unable to revise pricing with that customer until our next regularly scheduled price adjustment. As a result, if market prices for essential components increase, we will often be unable to pass the price increases through to our customers for products purchased under an existing agreement. Consequently, we are exposed to the risks associated with the volatility of prices for these components and our cost of revenues could increase and our gross margins could decrease in the event of price increases. Recently, as a result of demand driven by the semiconductor supply shortage, the costs of raw wafers as well as certain other raw materials are relatively high. Failure to obtain adequate supplies could result in our being unable to meet commitments under our contracts with customers, which could expose us to substantial liquidated damages and other claims, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Failure to adjust our supply chain volume due to changing market conditions or failure to estimate our customers’ demand could adversely affect our sales and could result in additional charges for obsolete or excess inventories or non-cancelable purchase commitments.

We make significant decisions, including determining the levels of business that we will seek and accept, production schedules, personnel needs and other resource requirements, based on our estimates of customer requirements. The possibility of rapid changes in demand for our customers’ products reduces our ability to accurately estimate our customers’ future requirements for our products. On occasion, our customers may require rapid increases in production, which can challenge our resources. We may not have sufficient capacity at any

 

35


Table of Contents

given time to meet our customers’ demands. Conversely, downturns in the semiconductor industry have in the past caused and may in the future cause our customers to significantly reduce the amount of products ordered from us. Because many of our sales, R&D, and manufacturing expenses are relatively fixed, a reduction in customer demand may decrease our gross margins and operating income, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

In addition, we base many of our operating decisions, and enter into purchase commitments, on the basis of anticipated sales, which are highly unpredictable. Some of our purchase commitments are not cancelable, and in some cases we are required to recognize a charge representing the amount of material or capital equipment purchased or ordered that exceeds our actual requirements. For example, we have non-cancelable purchase commitments with vendors and long-term supply agreements with certain of our third-party wafer fabrication partners, under which we are required to purchase a minimum number of wafers per year or face financial penalties. These types of commitments and agreements could reduce our ability to adjust our inventory to address declining market demands. If demand for our products is less than we expect, we may experience additional excess and obsolete inventories and be forced to incur additional charges. If sales in future periods fall substantially below our expectations, or if we fail to accurately forecast changes in demand mix, we could again be required to record substantial charges for obsolete or excess inventories or non-cancelable purchase commitments.

Moreover, during a market upturn, we may not be able to purchase sufficient supplies or components to meet increasing product demand, which could prevent us from taking advantage of opportunities and reduce our sales. In addition, a supplier could discontinue a component necessary for our design, extend lead times, limit supply or increase prices due to capacity constraints or other factors. Our failure to adjust our supply chain volume or estimate our customers’ demands could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Until recently, as a result of current market conditions, we did not typically operate with any significant backlog, except in periods of capacity shortage. The historic lack of significant backlog and the unpredictable length and timing of semiconductor cycles made it more difficult for us to accurately forecast revenue in future periods. Additionally, as we now face more significant backlog, it may not necessarily be indicative of actual sales for any succeeding period. Moreover, our expense levels are based in part on our expectations of future revenue, and we may be unable to fully adjust costs in a timely manner to compensate for revenue shortfalls.

Certain of our debt agreements contain covenants that may constrain the operation of our business, and our failure to comply with these covenants could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Restrictive covenants in our credit facilities may prevent us from pursuing certain transactions or business strategies, including by limiting our ability to, in certain circumstances:

 

   

incur additional indebtedness;

 

   

pay dividends or make distributions;

 

   

acquire assets or make investments outside of the ordinary course of business;

 

   

sell, lease, license, transfer or otherwise dispose of assets;

 

   

enter into transactions with our affiliates;

 

   

create or permit liens;

 

   

guarantee indebtedness; and

 

   

engage in certain extraordinary transactions.

 

36


Table of Contents

Failure to comply with any of the covenants in our debt agreements, including due to events beyond our control, could result in an event of default. The holders of the defaulted debt could terminate commitments to lend and accelerate amounts outstanding to be due and payable immediately. This could also result in cross-defaults under our other debt instruments, significantly impacting our liquidity and ability to fund our operations. Any of these occurrences could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Aging infrastructure, power grids and risks to the supply of fresh water or natural gas could interrupt production.

The semiconductor fabrication process requires extensive amounts of fresh water and a stable source of electricity and natural gas. In addition, it requires effective facilities to manage wastewater. As our production capabilities and our business grow, our requirements for these factors will grow substantially. Although we have not, to date, experienced any instances of lack of sufficient supplies of water or natural gas or material disruptions in the electricity supply to, or wastewater processing capacity of, any of our fabs beyond temporary or short-term stoppages, we may not have access to sufficient supplies of water, natural gas, electricity or wastewater processing capacity to accommodate our planned growth. Droughts, pipeline interruptions, power interruptions, electricity shortages or government intervention, particularly in the form of rationing, are factors that could restrict our access to these utilities in the areas in which our fabs are located. If there is an insufficient supply of fresh water, natural gas, electricity or wastewater processing capacity to satisfy our requirements, we may need to limit or delay our production. In addition, a power outage, even of very limited duration, could result in a loss of wafers in production and a deterioration in yield. Any of these occurrences could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may be subject to the risk of loss due to fire because the materials we use in our manufacturing processes are highly flammable.

We use highly flammable materials such as silane and hydrogen in our manufacturing processes and may therefore be subject to the risk of loss arising from fires. The risk of fire associated with these materials cannot be completely eliminated. We maintain insurance policies to reduce losses caused by fire, including business interruption insurance. However, our insurance coverage is subject to deductibles and self-insured retention and may not be sufficient to cover all of our potential losses. If any of our fabs were to be damaged or cease operations as a result of a fire, our manufacturing capacity would be reduced, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Our operations are subject to the risks of earthquakes, fires, floods, severe weather incidents and other natural catastrophic events, and to interruption by man-made problems such as power disruptions, industrial accidents, or terrorism.

Significant natural disasters such as earthquakes, fires, floods, severe weather incidents or acts of terrorism occurring in any of our manufacturing or office locations, or where a business partner, such as a customer or supplier, is located, could adversely affect our operational and financial performance. In addition, natural disasters, spills or hazardous exposure incidents, accidents and acts of terrorism could cause disruptions in our business or our suppliers’ or customers’ businesses, national economies or the global economy as a whole, and we may not have insurance coverage for these matters. Our operations, as well as our computing systems, are vulnerable to interference, or interruption from terrorist attacks, natural disasters or pandemics (including COVID-19), the effects of climate change (such as sea level rise, drought, flooding, wildfires, and increased storm severity), power loss, telecommunications failures, criminal fraud or impersonation, inadvertent or intentional actions by our employees, or other attempts to harm or access our systems. In the event of a major disruption caused by a natural disaster or any of the foregoing, we may be unable to continue our operations and may endure system interruptions, reputational harm, delays in our development activities, lengthy interruptions in service, breaches of data security and loss of critical data or personal information, any of which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. We are also at risk of data breaches, as further described below.

 

37


Table of Contents

The risk of cyberattacks and other data security breaches requires us to incur significant costs to maintain the security of our networks and data, and, in the event of such breaches, may expose us to liability, adversely affect our operations, damage our reputation, and affect our net revenues and profitability, and our efforts to combat breach and misuse of our systems and unauthorized access to our data may not be successful.

We rely on our IT systems and those of our service providers to conduct much of our business operations. Our and our service providers’ IT and computer systems store and transmit customer information, trade secrets, corporate data and personal information, and are otherwise essential to the operation of our production lines, which may make us a target for cyberattacks. In addition, our accreditation as a Trusted Foundry by the Defense Microelectronics Activity (“DMEA”) and our processing of sensitive information may make us an attractive target for attacks, including industrial or nation-state espionage, organized criminals, and terrorist cyberattacks. Hackers may seek to disrupt our operations, blackmail us to regain control of our systems, or spy on us for sensitive information. Further, we depend on our employees and the employees of our service providers to appropriately handle confidential and sensitive data and deploy our IT resources in a safe and secure manner that does not expose our network systems to security breaches or the loss of data. However, there is always a risk that inadvertent disclosure or actions or internal malfeasance by our employees or those of our service providers could result in a loss of data or a breach or interruption of our IT systems.

We are making significant investments in cybersecurity and data security, as well as other efforts to combat breach and misuse of our systems and unauthorized access to our and our customers’ data by third parties. While we seek to continuously review and assess our cybersecurity policies and procedures to ensure their adequacy and effectiveness, all IT and computer systems are vulnerable to attacks, especially via methods that have not been observed yet or quickly evolve. The risk of security breaches may be higher during times of a natural disaster or pandemic (including COVID-19) due to remote working arrangements. We cannot guarantee that our IT and computer systems which control or maintain vital corporate functions, such as our manufacturing operations and enterprise accounting, would be immune to cyberattacks. In the event of a serious cyberattack, our systems may lose important customer information, trade secrets, corporate data or personal information or our production lines may be shut down pending the resolution of such an attack.

In addition, we employ certain third-party service providers for us and our affiliates worldwide with whom we need to share highly sensitive and confidential information to enable them to provide the relevant services. While, to date, we have not been subject to cyberattacks which, individually or in the aggregate, have been material to our operations or financial conditions, some of our third-party service providers have experienced cyberattacks of which we have been made aware. Despite requiring certain third-party service providers to comply with the confidentiality and security requirements in our service agreements with them, there is no assurance that each of them will strictly fulfill any of their obligations or that they will be successful in preventing further cyberattacks. The on-site network systems and the off-site cloud computing networks such as servers maintained by these service providers and/or their contractors are also subject to risks associated with cyberattacks. While we attempt to take prompt action once we are alerted to a cyberattack against one of our third-party service providers and implement steps designed to mitigate associated risks to our systems and data, we may in the future not be made aware of such events in a timely manner or may be unable to successfully sever network connectivity or otherwise limit the risk to our own systems.

If we or our service providers are not able to timely contain, remediate and resolve the respective issues caused by cyberattacks and data breaches, or ensure the integrity and availability of our systems and data (or data belonging to our customers or other third parties) or control of our or our service providers’ IT or computer systems, then such attacks, breaches or failures could:

 

   

disrupt the proper functioning of these networks and systems and, therefore, our operations and/or those of certain of our customers;

 

   

result in the unauthorized access to, and destruction, loss, theft, misappropriation or release of, proprietary, confidential, sensitive or otherwise valuable information of ours, our customers or our

 

38


Table of Contents
 

employees, including trade secrets, which could be used to compete against us or for disruptive, destructive or otherwise harmful purposes and outcomes;

 

   

result in litigation and governmental investigation and proceedings that could expose us to civil or criminal liabilities;

 

   

compromise national security and other sensitive government functions;

 

   

require significant management attention and resources to remedy the damages that result;

 

   

result in our incurring significant expenses in implementing remedial and improvement measures to enhance our IT network or computer systems;

 

   

result in costs which exceed our insurance coverage and/or indemnification arrangements;

 

   

subject us to claims for contract breach, damages, credits, penalties or termination; and

 

   

damage our reputation with our customers (including the U.S. government) and the general public.

Further, remediation efforts may not be successful and could result in interruptions, delays or cessation of service, unfavorable publicity, damage to our reputation, customer allegations of breach-of-contract, possible litigation, and loss of existing or potential customers that may impede our sales or other critical functions. Additionally, any such attack or unauthorized access may require spending resources on correcting the breach and indemnifying the relevant parties and litigation, regulatory investigations, regulatory proceedings, increased insurance premiums, lost revenues, penalties fines and other potential liabilities, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Compliance with applicable data security and data privacy laws and regulations may be costly and, in the case of a breach of applicable law, could harm our reputation.

In the United States, federal and state laws impose limits on, or requirements regarding the collection, distribution, use, security and storage of personal information of individuals, and there has been increased regulation of data privacy and security particularly at the state level, including the California Consumer Privacy Act (effective on January 1, 2020), and the California Privacy Rights Act (expected to take effect on January 1, 2023). Currently, many states are actively considering or enacting similar laws and we operate in many of these jurisdictions. Outside the United States, the European Union and other countries in which we operate also have privacy and data protection laws, regulations and standards.

The interpretation and application of many of these existing or recently enacted laws and regulations are increasingly complex, uncertain and fluid, and could be inconsistent with our existing data management practices. For example, recent developments in Europe have created complexity and uncertainty regarding transfers of personal data from the EEA and the UK to the United States and other jurisdictions. Furthermore, the long-term regulation of data transfers between the EEA and the UK is uncertain, as a relevant adequacy decision enabling such transfers is due to expire. These developments could lead to substantial costs, require significant changes, divert the attention of our technology personnel, adversely affect our margins, increase costs and subject us to additional liabilities. If we are unable to transfer personal data between and among countries and regions in which we operate, it could affect the geographical location or segregation of our relevant systems and operations, and could adversely affect our financial results. In addition, the existing EU and UK privacy laws on cookies and e-marketing are also in flux and are likely to be replaced by new regulations, which may introduce more stringent requirements for using cookies and similar technologies for direct marketing and significantly increase fines for non-compliance in-line with the General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”). Stricter enforcement of such laws could limit the effectiveness of our marketing activities, divert the attention of our technology personnel, increase costs and subject us to additional liabilities.

 

39


Table of Contents

Inappropriate disclosure of personal and other sensitive data, even if inadvertent, or other actual or perceived violations of or noncompliance with such laws and regulations could expose us to significant administrative, civil or criminal liability as well as reputational harm. For example, a breach of the GDPR could result in fines of up to 20 million euros (“EUR”) under the European GDPR or British pound sterling (“GBP”) 17.5 million under the U.K. GDPR or up to 4% of the annual global revenues of the infringer, whichever is greater, as well as regulatory investigations, reputational damage, orders to cease or change our processing of personal data, enforcement notices and/or assessment notices (for a compulsory audit). Privacy-related claims or lawsuits initiated by governmental bodies, employees or other third parties, whether meritorious or not, could be time-consuming, result in costly regulatory proceedings, litigation, penalties and fines, or require us to change our business practices, sometimes in expensive ways, or other potential liabilities.

Additionally, a failure to comply with the National Institute of Standards and Technology Special Publication 800-171 or the DoD’s cybersecurity requirements, including the Cyber Security Material Model Certificate (“CMMC”), which will require all contractors to receive specific third-party cybersecurity certifications to be eligible for contract awards, could restrict our ability to bid for, be awarded and perform on DoD contracts. The DoD expects that all new contracts will be required to comply with the CMMC by 2026, and initial requests for information and for proposal have already begun. We are in the process of evaluating our readiness and preparing for the CMMC. To the extent we, or our subcontractors or other third parties on whom we rely are unable to achieve certification in advance of contract awards that specify the requirement, we may be unable to bid on contract awards or follow-on awards for existing work with the DoD, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. We will also be required to go through a recertification process every two years. In addition, any obligations that may be imposed on us under the CMMC may be different from or in addition to those otherwise required by applicable laws and regulations, which may cause additional expense for compliance.

Our products may contain defects that could harm our reputation, be costly to correct, delay revenues and expose us to litigation.

Our products are highly complex and sophisticated and, from time to time, may contain defects, errors, hardware failures or other failures that are difficult to detect and correct. Errors, defects and other failures may be found in new solutions, products or services or improvements to existing solutions, products or services after delivery to our customers. If these defects, errors and failures are discovered, we may not be able to successfully correct them in a timely manner or otherwise mitigate or eliminate the impact of the error or failure. The occurrence of errors, defects and other failures in our products could result in the delay or the denial of market acceptance of our products and alleviating such errors, defects and other failures may require us to make significant expenditure of our resources. Our products are often used for critical business processes and as a result, any defect in or failure of our products may cause customers to reconsider renewing their contract with us, cause significant customer dissatisfaction and possibly giving rise to claims for indemnification or other monetary damages. The harm to our reputation resulting from errors, defects and other failures may be material. Any claims for actual or alleged losses to our customers’ businesses may require us to spend significant time and money in litigation or arbitration or to pay significant settlements or damages. Defending a lawsuit, regardless of merit, can be costly and divert management’s attention and resources. Accordingly, any such claim could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Any problem in the semiconductor outsourcing infrastructure could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Many of our customers depend on third parties to provide assembly, testing and other related services. Many of these services are geographically concentrated primarily in Asia. If these customers cannot timely obtain those services on reasonable terms, they may not order foundry products and services from us, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

 

40


Table of Contents

Risks Related to Intellectual Property

Any failure to obtain, maintain, protect or enforce our intellectual property and proprietary rights could impair our ability to protect our proprietary technology and our brand.

Our success depends to a significant degree on our ability to obtain, maintain, protect and enforce our intellectual property rights. We rely on a combination of patents, trade secrets, copyrights, trademarks, service marks, and other forms of intellectual property, contractual restrictions and confidentiality procedures to establish and protect our proprietary rights. However, the steps we take to obtain, maintain, protect and enforce our intellectual property rights may be inadequate. We may not be able to protect our technology, know-how, and/or brand if we are unable to enforce our rights for whatever reason or if we do not detect unauthorized use of our intellectual property rights. If we fail to protect our intellectual property rights adequately, our competitors may gain access to our proprietary technology and develop and commercialize substantially similar products, services or technologies, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We have filed various applications for certain aspects of our intellectual property in the United States and other countries, and we have built a comprehensive patent portfolio of approximately 10,000 worldwide patents. In the future, we may acquire additional patents or patent portfolios, license patents from third parties or agree to license the technology of third parties, which could require significant cash expenditures. Our patents do not cover all of our technologies, systems, products and product components and our competitors or others may design around our patented technologies. Further, when we seek patent protection for a particular technology, there is no assurance that the applications we file will result in issued patents or that if patents do issue as a result that they will be found to be valid and enforceable or that they will effectively block competitors from creating competing technology. In addition, we may need to license technology from third parties to develop and market new products and we cannot be certain that we could license that technology on commercially reasonable terms or at all. Our inability to license this technology could harm our ability to compete and materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Some of our know-how or technology is not patented or patentable and may constitute trade secrets. To protect our trade secrets, we have a policy of requiring our employees, consultants, advisors and other collaborators who contribute to our material intellectual property to enter into confidentiality agreements. We also rely on customary contractual protections with our suppliers and customers, and we implement security measures intended to protect our trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information. However, no assurances can be given that those contracts will not be breached. Further, those contracts and arrangements may be ineffective in protecting our intellectual property and may not prevent unauthorized disclosure. See also “There is a risk that our trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information will be stolen, used in an unauthorized manner, or compromised, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.” In addition, third parties may independently develop technologies that may be substantially equivalent or superior to our technology.

There is a risk that our trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information will be stolen, used in an unauthorized manner, or compromised, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Our trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information may be stolen, used in an unauthorized manner, or compromised through a direct intrusion by private parties or foreign actors, including those affiliated with or controlled by state actors, through cyber intrusions into our computer systems, physical theft through corporate espionage or other means, or through more indirect routes, including by joint venture partners, licensees that do not honor the terms of the license, potential licensees that were ultimately not licensed, or other parties reverse engineering our company’s solutions, products or components. Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

 

41


Table of Contents

The laws of some foreign countries may not be as protective of intellectual property rights as those in the United States, and mechanisms for enforcement of intellectual property rights may be inadequate.

The absence of internationally harmonized intellectual property laws and different enforcement regimes makes it more difficult to ensure consistent protection of our proprietary rights. Our strong international presence may lead to increased exposure to unauthorized copying and use of our manufacturing technologies and proprietary information. Moreover, policing unauthorized use of our technologies, trade secrets, and intellectual property may be difficult, expensive and time-consuming, particularly in foreign countries where the laws may not be as protective of intellectual property rights as those in the United States and where mechanisms for enforcement of intellectual property rights may be weak. Accordingly, despite our efforts, we may be unable to prevent third parties from infringing upon, misappropriating or otherwise violating our intellectual property rights. Our inability to secure or enforce our intellectual property rights could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We have been and may continue to become subject to intellectual property disputes, which are costly and may subject us to significant liability and increased costs of doing business.

The semiconductor industry is subject to claims of infringement by patent assertion entities and is characterized by frequent litigation regarding patent rights. From time to time, we receive communications from third parties that allege that our products or technologies infringe their patent or other intellectual property rights and we have had patent infringement lawsuits filed against us claiming that certain of our products, services, or technologies infringe the intellectual property rights of others. We may continue to become subject to such intellectual property disputes in the future. Further, we have entered into licenses, including patent licenses with third parties in settlements of claims or in order to avoid intellectual property disputes and the loss of license rights, including as a result of a termination or expiration of such licenses, may limit our ability to use certain technologies in the future, which could cause us to incur significant costs, prevent us from commercializing certain of our products or otherwise have a material adverse effect on us. In addition, there may be issued patents held by third parties that, if found to be valid and enforceable, could be alleged to be infringed by our current or future technologies or products. There also may be pending patent applications of others that may result in issued patents, which could be alleged to be infringed by our current or future technologies or products.

In order to protect our intellectual property rights, we may be required to spend significant resources to monitor and protect those rights. Litigation brought to protect and enforce our intellectual property rights could be costly, time-consuming and distracting to management. Further, our efforts to enforce our intellectual property rights may be met with defenses, counterclaims and countersuits attacking the validity and enforceability of our intellectual property rights, and if such defenses, counterclaims or countersuits are successful, we could lose valuable intellectual property rights. Our inability to protect our proprietary technology against unauthorized copying or use, as well as any costly litigation or diversion of our management’s attention and resources, could delay the implementation of our manufacturing technologies, delay introductions of new solutions or injure our reputation and could have a material and adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Further, many of our agreements with our customers and partners, the terms of which often survive termination or expiration of the applicable agreement, require us to defend such parties against certain intellectual property infringement claims and indemnify them for damages and losses arising from certain intellectual property infringement claims against them, which have in the past resulted, and could in the future result, in increased costs for defending such claims or significant damages if there is an adverse ruling in any such claims. These defense costs and indemnity payments could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. Such customers and partners may also discontinue the use of our products, services, and solutions, as a result of injunctions or otherwise, which could result in loss of revenues and adversely affect our business. We may also have to seek a license for the technology, which may not be available on reasonable terms, if at all, and may significantly increase our operating expenses or may require us to restrict our business activities and limit our ability to develop and deliver our products. As a result,

 

42


Table of Contents

we may also be required to develop alternative non-infringing technology, which could require significant effort and expense or which may not be possible, which could negatively affect our business. Moreover, intellectual property indemnities provided to us by our suppliers, when obtainable, may not cover all damages and losses suffered by us and our customers arising from intellectual property infringement claims. Even if we were to prevail in such a dispute, any litigation regarding our intellectual property could be costly and time-consuming and divert the attention of our management and key personnel from our business operations.

Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Our success depends, in part, on our ability to develop and commercialize our technology without infringing, misappropriating or otherwise violating the intellectual property rights of third parties and we may not be aware of such infringements, misappropriations or violations.

Third parties may bring claims alleging infringement, misappropriation or violation of intellectual property rights. We cannot guarantee that we have not, do not or will not infringe, misappropriate or otherwise violate the intellectual property rights of others. Our technologies may not be able to withstand any third-party claims against their use. In addition, some companies may have the capability to dedicate substantially greater resources to enforce their intellectual property rights and to defend claims that may be brought against them. Furthermore, third parties have and may continue to assert infringement claims against us in the future, including the sometimes aggressive and opportunistic actions of non-practicing entities whose business model is to obtain patent-licensing revenues from operating companies such as us. Regardless of the merit of such claims, any claim that we have violated intellectual property or other proprietary rights of third parties, whether or not it results in litigation, is settled out of court or is determined in our favor, could be expensive and time-consuming, and could divert the time and attention of management and technical personnel from our business. The litigation process is subject to inherent uncertainties, and we may not prevail in litigation matters regardless of the merits of our position. In some jurisdictions, plaintiffs can also seek injunctive relief that may limit the operation of our business or prevent the marketing and selling of our services that infringe or allegedly infringe on the plaintiff’s intellectual property rights. If a third party is able to obtain an injunction preventing us from using our technology, accessing third-party intellectual property rights, or if we cannot license or develop alternative technology for any infringing aspect of our business, we could be forced to limit or stop manufacturing activities or sales of our products or cease other business activities related to such intellectual property. To resolve these claims, we may enter into licensing agreements with restrictive terms or significant fees, stop selling our products or services or be required to implement costly or inferior redesigns to the affected products or services, or pay damages to satisfy contractual obligations to others. If we do not resolve these claims in advance of a trial, there is no guarantee that we will be successful in court. These outcomes could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may be unable to provide technology to our customers if we lose the support of our technology partners.

Enhancing our manufacturing process technologies is critical to our ability to provide services for our customers. We intend to continue to advance our process technologies through internal R&D and alliances with other companies. In addition to our internal R&D focused on developing new and improved semiconductor manufacturing process technologies, our business involves collaboration, including customization and other development of technologies and intellectual property, with and for our customers, vendors and other third parties. We frequently enter into agreements with customers, vendors, equipment suppliers and others that involve customization and other development of technologies and intellectual property. As a result of these agreements, we may be required to limit use of, or refrain from using, certain technologies and intellectual property rights in parts of our business. Determining inventorship and ownership of technologies and intellectual property rights resulting from development activities can be difficult and uncertain.

Disputes may arise with customers, vendors and other third parties regarding ownership of and rights to use and enforce these technologies and intellectual property rights or regarding interpretation of our agreements with

 

43


Table of Contents

these third parties, and these disputes may result in claims against us or claims that intellectual property rights are not owned by us, are not enforceable, or are invalid. The cost and effort to resolve these types of disputes, or the loss of rights in technologies in intellectual property rights if we lose these types of disputes, could harm our business and financial condition. In addition, our customers, vendors and other third parties may suffer delays, quality issues, or other problems affecting their development activities and ability to supply us with certain technology and intellectual property, which could adversely affect our business and operating results. Further, if we are unable to continue any of our joint development arrangements or other agreements, on mutually beneficial terms, or if we cannot re-evaluate the technological and economic benefits of such relationships with these partners, vendors or suppliers in a timely manner sufficient to support our ongoing technology development, we may be unable to continue providing our customers with leading edge or differentiated mass-producible process technologies and may, as a result, lose important customers, which could have a materially adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition, businesses and prospects.

Risks Related to Strategic Transactions

We are in the process of divesting our EFK facility to ON Semiconductor as part of a transaction we entered into in 2019. Failure to successfully manage the divestment of that asset in a timely manner may adversely affect our operations and have a material impact on our cost savings initiatives.

In April 2019, we entered into an Asset Purchase Agreement with Semiconductor Components Industries, LLC (“ON Semiconductor”) pursuant to which we agreed to transfer substantially all the assets and employees related to our EFK facility in return for $400 million in consideration and $30 million for a technology license. ON Semiconductor paid $100 million upon signing, which included $30 million for the technology license, and an additional $100 million in 2020. We expect the completion of the sale will occur, subject to regulatory approvals, at the end of 2022. The transaction excluded the transfer of our commercial customer arrangements. Since the transaction was entered into, we have transferred a number of technologies from the EFK facility to our other global manufacturing sites to ensure continuous supply to key customers. In order to facilitate these transfers, we and ON Semiconductor have agreed to provide transition services, including reciprocal supply agreements and technology transfer and intellectual property licensing agreements. Pursuant to the Asset Purchase Agreement, we also agreed to transition approximately 1,000 employees to ON Semiconductor. While we do not anticipate issues related to the transfer and anticipate satisfying all the conditions to closing as set forth in the agreements, the divestment has taken and will continue to require management time and attention and, if for any reason, we fail to complete the transfer on a timely manner or at all or ON Semiconductor fails to fulfill its obligations under the applicable agreements, we may not be able to realize our anticipated benefits, including cost savings, related to the divestment, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We may make strategic acquisitions, and such acquisitions may introduce significant risks and uncertainties, including risks related to integrating the acquired companies, assets or businesses.

We have in the past sought, and may in the future seek, to acquire or invest in businesses, joint ventures and technologies that we believe could complement or expand our capacity, enhance our technology offerings or otherwise offer growth opportunities. These efforts may divert the attention of management and cause us to incur various expenses in identifying, investigating and pursuing suitable opportunities, whether or not the transactions are completed, and may result in unforeseen operating difficulties and expenditures. Our integration efforts may periodically expose deficiencies in the controls and procedures relating to cybersecurity and the compliance with data privacy and protection laws, regulations and standards of an acquired company or business that were not identified in our due diligence undertaken prior to consummating the acquisition. Additionally, we may encounter difficulties assimilating or integrating the businesses, technologies, products, personnel or operations of any acquired companies, particularly if the key personnel of an acquired company cannot be retained, or we have difficulty preserving the customers of any acquired business. Any such transactions that we are able to complete may not result in the synergies or other benefits we expected to achieve, which could result in substantial impairment charges. These transactions could also result in dilutive issuances of equity securities or

 

44


Table of Contents

the incurrence of debt, which could adversely affect our results of operations. Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Political, Regulatory and Legal Risks

Environmental, health and safety laws and regulations expose us to liability and risk of non-compliance, and any such liability or non-compliance could adversely affect our business.

In each jurisdiction in which we operate, our operations are subject to diverse environmental, health and safety laws and regulations that govern, among other things, emissions of pollutants into the air, wastewater discharges, the use and handling of hazardous substances, waste disposal, the investigation and remediation of soil and ground water contamination and the health and safety of our employees. Semiconductor manufacturing depends on a wide array of process materials, including hazardous materials that are subject to local, state, national or international regulations. These materials, our manufacturing operations and our products and services are subject to diverse environmental, health and safety laws, regulations and regulatory requirements. Sourcing of materials could also present reputational risks if our direct or indirect suppliers are found to be in violation of environmental health and safety regulations, or of ethical or human rights regulations or standards.

Regulatory changes, including restrictions on new or existing materials critical to our manufacturing processes, such as per- and polyfluoroalkyl substances, increased restrictions related to wastewater, air emissions and hazardous substances, or changes to necessary permitting requirements, could cause disruptions to our operations or necessitate additional costs or capital expenditures, such as those associated with identifying and qualifying substitute materials or processes, or with installing additional controls related to wastewater, air emissions or waste management. Regulatory limitations or restrictive covenants at contaminated properties could affect our ability to expand manufacturing operations or capacities and may affect our ability to import materials or equipment.

Industrial accidents or releases, including those associated with storage, use, transportation or disposal of hazardous materials or wastes, could expose us to liabilities or remediation obligations and we may not have insurance coverage for such matters. Non-compliance with environmental, health and safety regulations or associated permit requirements may result in liabilities or monetary penalties. Non-compliance with or public controversy regarding environmental, health and safety matters could result in reputational harm.

Certain environmental laws, including the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act and state equivalents, make us potentially liable on a strict, joint and several basis for the investigation and remediation of contamination at, or originating from, facilities that are currently or formerly owned or operated by us and third-party sites to which we send or have sent materials for disposal or materials for recycling, along with related natural resources damages. We could become subject to potential material liabilities for the investigation and cleanup of historic contamination on the U.S. properties where we operate should the currently responsible parties cease their ongoing remediation efforts notwithstanding their contractual obligations to us.

Regulations and customer-imposed requirements in response to climate change could result in additional costs related to changes in process materials, control of process emissions, “carbon taxes” or related fees, and sourcing of energy supplies. Increased frequency of extreme weather events, and chronic conditions like higher temperatures and droughts could cause disruptions to our manufacturing facilities, non-manufacturing operations and supply chain.

Although we have policies, controls, and procedures designed to help ensure compliance with applicable laws, there can be no assurance that our employees, contractors, suppliers or agents will not violate such laws or our policies. Violations of these laws and regulations can result in fines, criminal sanctions against us, our officers, or our employees, prohibitions on the conduct of our business, and damage to our reputation.

 

45


Table of Contents

Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We are subject to anti-corruption, anti-bribery, anti-money laundering, counter-terrorist financing laws and similar laws and regulations, and non-compliance with such laws, regulations and standards can subject us to administrative, criminal or civil liability and harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and reputation.

We are subject to the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act of 1977, as amended, U.S. anti-bribery laws and other anti-corruption, anti-bribery, anti-money laundering and counter-terrorist financing laws and regulations in the countries in which we conduct business. Anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws have been enforced aggressively in recent years and are interpreted broadly to generally prohibit companies, their employees and their third-party intermediaries from authorizing, offering or providing, directly or indirectly, improper payments or benefits to recipients in the public or private sectors. In connection with our international sales and business and sales to the public sector, we may engage with business partners and third-party intermediaries to market our products and services and to obtain necessary permits, licenses, and other regulatory approvals. In addition, our third-party intermediaries, or other business partners, may have direct or indirect interactions with officials and employees of government agencies or state-owned or affiliated entities. We can be held liable for corrupt or other illegal activities of these third-party intermediaries or other business partners, their employees, representatives, contractors, partners, and agents, even if we do not explicitly authorize such activities. Although we have policies and procedures to address compliance with such laws and regulations, there is a risk that our employees and agents will take actions in violation of our policies and applicable law, for which we may be ultimately held responsible.

Detecting, investigating and resolving actual or alleged violations of anti-corruption laws can require a significant diversion of time, resources and attention from senior management. In addition, noncompliance with anti-corruption, anti-bribery, anti-money laundering or counter-terrorist financing laws and regulations could subject us to whistleblower complaints, investigations, sanctions, settlements, prosecution, enforcement actions, fines, damages, other civil or criminal penalties or injunctions, suspension or debarment from contracting with certain persons, reputational harm, adverse media coverage and other collateral consequences. If any subpoenas or investigations are launched, or governmental or other sanctions are imposed, or if we do not prevail in any possible civil or criminal proceeding, our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects could be materially and adversely affected. Even in the event of a positive outcome in such an investigation or proceeding, the cost of the investigation or defense could be significant and negatively affect our financial performance.

These laws, regulations and standards are driving the review and updating of many corporate policies and systems, often at significant expense. Until there is a settling of a consistent and stable global approach, our company, with customers and employees around the world, will be exposed to financial risk in complying with these requirements. Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

We are subject to governmental export and customs compliance requirements that could impair our ability to compete in international markets or subject us to liability if we violate the controls.

Our products and technology are subject to export controls in the jurisdictions where we do business. For example, in the United States, we are subject to the Export Administration Regulations and the International Traffic in Arms Regulations (“ITAR”). Under these regulations, certain commodities, software and technology may be exported only with the required export authorizations. Some technology and software that we create or possess is controlled under these regulations, and in certain cases, we are required to maintain controls limiting the access to such technology and software, even among our own employees. Furthermore, our activities are subject to economic sanctions laws and regulations, including U.S. economic sanctions laws and regulations

 

46


Table of Contents

administered by the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control that prohibit or restrict dealings that are within U.S. jurisdiction with, in or involving certain jurisdictions subject to comprehensive U.S. sanctions and certain designated persons and entities. We have corporate policies and procedures in place reasonably designed to ensure compliance with all applicable export control and economic sanctions laws and regulations.

In some cases, our compliance obligations may result in the loss of sales opportunities. In other cases, we may experience delays in our ability to conduct business as we await government authorization. Violations of economic sanctions or export control regulations can result in significant administrative fines or penalties or even criminal prosecution.

We are currently and may in the future become subject to litigation that could result in substantial costs, divert or continue to divert management’s attention and resources, and materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

On June 7, 2021 we filed a complaint in the Supreme Court of New York seeking declaratory judgment that we had not violated certain agreements entered into with IBM relating to our acquisition of IBM’s Microelectronics division in 2015, and subsequent development and research activities and sales of our products to IBM. On June 8, 2021, IBM filed a complaint in the Supreme Court of New York asserting intentional breach of contract and fraudulent misrepresentation claims under the same set of agreements. IBM argues that it is entitled to a return of its $1.5 billon payment to the company and at least $1 billion in damages. On September 14, 2021, the Court granted our motion to dismiss IBM’s claims of fraud, unjust enrichment and breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing. Our complaint seeking declaratory judgment was dismissed. The case will proceed based on IBM’s breach of contract and promissory estoppel claims. We believe, based on discussions with legal counsel, that we have meritorious defenses against IBM’s claims. We dispute IBM’s claims and intend to vigorously defend against them.

In 2017, we and CD entered into a set of agreements related to the establishment of a joint venture in Chengdu, China to establish and operate a greenfield wafer production site in Chengdu. The parties contemplated that the manufacturing operations would be implemented in two phases. Due to a variety of factors, including unanticipated market conditions, the manufacturing operations did not proceed as planned and the parties have been working to wind-down operations of the joint venture. On April 26, 2021, we received a claim from CD requesting that we share in CD’s alleged losses and related costs incurred to support the joint venture. We and CD are engaged in negotiations to settle the claim and we recorded a provision of $34 million in June 2021.

In addition, we are, and may become subject to, legal proceedings and claims that arise in the ordinary course of business, such as claims brought by our customers in connection with commercial disputes, product liability claims, employment claims made by our current or former employees or claims of infringement raised by intellectual property owners, in connection with the technology used in our manufacturing operations. The risk of such litigation may increase due to use of our products in safety-related systems of other advanced technologies, including automobiles.

Any existing or future disputes, claims or proceedings could result in substantial costs and may divert management’s attention and resources. Insurance might not cover such claims, might not provide sufficient payments to cover all the costs to resolve one or more such claims and might not continue to be available on terms acceptable to us. A claim brought against us that is uninsured or underinsured could result in unanticipated costs, potentially harming our business, financial position and results of operations. Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects. Further, negative publicity arising from disputes, claims or proceedings may damage our reputation and adversely affect the image of our brand and our products. In addition, if any verdict or award is rendered against us, we could be required to pay significant monetary damages, assume other liabilities and even to suspend or terminate related business ventures or projects.

 

47


Table of Contents

If regular or statutory consultation processes with employee representatives such as works councils fail or are delayed, or if our employees were to engage in a strike or other work stoppage, our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects could be materially and adversely affected.

We may be required to consult with our employee representatives, such as works councils, on items such as work hours, restructurings, acquisitions and divestitures. Although we believe that our relations with our employees, employee representatives and works councils are satisfactory, no assurance can be given that we will be able to successfully extend or renegotiate these agreements as they expire from time to time or, in the case of transactions, to conclude potential consultation processes in a timely way. Also, if we fail to extend or renegotiate our labor agreements and social plans, if significant disputes with unions arise, or if our workers engage in a strike or other work stoppage, we could incur higher ongoing labor costs or experience a significant disruption of operations. Recently, we have experienced minor work stoppages involving a small number of employees at our Dresden, Germany manufacturing facility. Although those work stoppages did not materially impact production, future work stoppages, if more frequent or on a larger scale, could impact our production and our ability to timely provide products to our customers. Any of the foregoing factors could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

Currency and Interest Rate Risks

We are exposed to foreign currency risk, which could materially adversely affect our cost of expenses and profit margins and could result in exchange losses.

The majority of our sales are denominated in U.S. dollars, and therefore, our revenue is not subject to foreign currency risk. However, an increase in the value of the U.S. dollar can increase the real cost to our customers of our products and services in those markets outside of the United States where we sell in U.S. dollars. Conversely, a weakened U.S. dollar can increase the cost of expenses such as our direct labor, raw materials and overhead that are incurred outside of the United States. These operating expenses are denominated in foreign currencies and are subject to fluctuations due to changes in foreign currency exchange rates. Additionally, this could impact our capital expenditures with foreign suppliers we pay in non-U.S. dollar currencies. We also engage in financing activities in local currencies. Our hedging programs may not be able to effectively offset any, or more than a portion, of the impact of currency exchange rate movements. As a result, unfavorable changes in exchange rates could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

LIBOR and certain other interest “benchmarks” may be subject to regulatory guidance and/or reform that could cause interest rates under our current or future debt agreements to perform differently than in the past or cause other unanticipated consequences.

Because a majority of our debt is primarily based on the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) and certain other benchmarks, fluctuations in interest rates could have a material effect on our business. We currently utilize, and may in the future utilize, derivative financial instruments such as interest rate swaps or interest rate caps to hedge some of our exposure to interest rate fluctuations, but such instruments may not be effective in reducing our exposure to interest fluctuations, and we may discontinue utilizing them at any time. As a result, we may incur higher interest costs if interest rates increase. These higher interest costs could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and the levels of cash we maintain for working capital.

In addition, LIBOR and certain other interest “benchmarks” may be subject to regulatory guidance and/or reform that could cause interest rates under our current or future debt agreements to perform differently than in the past or cause other unanticipated consequences. The United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority, which regulates LIBOR, has announced that it intends to stop encouraging or requiring banks to submit LIBOR rates after 2021, and it is unclear if LIBOR will cease to exist or if new methods of calculating LIBOR will evolve. On March 5, 2021, ICE Benchmark Administration announced that all LIBOR settings will either cease to be provided by any benchmark administrator, or no longer be representative immediately after December 31, 2021

 

48


Table of Contents

for all GBP, EUR, Swiss franc (“CHF”) and Japanese yen (“JPY”) LIBOR and for one-week and two-month U.S. dollar (“USD”) LIBOR tenors, and immediately after June 30, 2023 for the remaining USD LIBOR tenors. Notwithstanding this extension, a joint statement by key regulatory authorities called on banks to cease entering into new contracts that use LIBOR as a reference rate by no later than December 31, 2021. If LIBOR ceases to exist or if the methods of calculating LIBOR change from their current form, interest rates on our current or future debt obligations may be adversely affected.

If a published USD LIBOR rate is unavailable, we may be required to substitute an alternative reference rate, such as a different benchmark interest rate or the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”), in lieu of LIBOR. The Alternative Reference Rates Committee has proposed SOFR as its recommended alternative to LIBOR and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York began publishing SOFR rates in April 2018. SOFR is intended to be a broad measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight that is collateralized by U.S. Treasury securities. However, because SOFR is a broad U.S. Treasury repo financing rate that represents overnight secured funding transactions, it differs fundamentally from LIBOR. For example, SOFR is a secured overnight rate, while LIBOR is an unsecured rate that represents interbank funding over different maturities. In addition, because SOFR is a transaction-based rate, it is backward-looking, whereas LIBOR is forward-looking. Because of these and other differences, there is no assurance that SOFR will perform in the same way as LIBOR would have performed at any time, and there is no guarantee that it is a comparable substitute for LIBOR. SOFR may fail to gain market acceptance. A change from LIBOR to any of the proposed alternative reference rates could result in interest obligations that are more than or that do not otherwise correlate over time with the payments that would have been made on this debt if USD LIBOR were available in its current form. Any of these proposals or consequences could have a material adverse effect on our financing costs. Moreover, the phase-out of LIBOR may adversely affect our assessment of effectiveness or measurement of ineffectiveness for accounting purposes of any future interest rate hedging agreements indexed to LIBOR.

Risks Related to Changes in Effective Tax Rate and Accounting Principles

Changes in our effective tax rate or tax liability may have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

Our effective tax rate could increase due to several factors, including, but not limited to:

 

   

changes in the relative amounts of income before taxes in the various jurisdictions in which we operate that have differing statutory tax rates;

 

   

changes in tax laws, tax treaties and regulations or the interpretation of them;

 

   

changes to our assessment about our ability to realize our deferred tax assets that are based on estimates of our future results, the prudence and feasibility of possible tax planning strategies, and the economic and political environments in which we do business;

 

   

the outcome of current and future tax audits, examinations or administrative appeals; and

 

   

limitations or adverse findings regarding our ability to do business in some jurisdictions.

Changes, such as these, that affect our effective tax rate could materially and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

Our international operations subject us to potentially adverse tax consequences.

We generally conduct our international operations through subsidiaries and report our taxable income in various jurisdictions worldwide based upon our business operations in those jurisdictions. Our intercompany relationships are subject to complex transfer pricing regulations administered by taxing authorities in various jurisdictions. The relevant taxing authorities may disagree with our determinations as to the value of assets sold or acquired or income and expenses attributable to specific jurisdictions. If such a disagreement were to occur, and our position were not sustained, we could be required to pay additional taxes, interest, and penalties, which could result in one-time tax charges, higher effective tax rates, reduced cash flows, and lower overall profitability of our operations.

 

49


Table of Contents

There is also a high level of uncertainty in today’s tax environment stemming from both global initiatives put forth by the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development, or the OECD, and unilateral measures being implemented by various countries due to a historic lack of consensus on these global initiatives. As an example, the OECD has put forth two proposals—Pillar One and Pillar Two—that revise the existing profit allocation and nexus rules (profit allocation based on location of sales versus physical presence) and ensure a minimal level of taxation, respectively. If these proposals are passed, it is likely that we will have to pay higher income taxes in countries where such rules are applicable.

Our reported financial results may be adversely affected by changes in accounting principles.

IFRS, as adopted by the IASB, is subject to interpretation by the IASB and various bodies formed to promulgate and interpret appropriate accounting principles. A change in these principles or interpretations could have a significant effect on our reported results of operations, financial position and cash flows and could affect the reporting of transactions already completed before the announcement of a change.

Risks Related to Our Status as a Controlled Company and Foreign Private Issuer

Our shareholder, Mubadala, will continue to have substantial control after this offering, which could limit your ability to influence the outcome of key transactions, including a change of control, and otherwise affect the prevailing market price of our ordinary shares.

After this offering, our shareholder, Mubadala, will beneficially own, in the aggregate, approximately 89.4% of our outstanding ordinary shares, and approximately 87.35% of our outstanding ordinary shares if the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of ordinary shares in this offering is exercised in full. See “Principal and Selling Shareholder.” In addition, as described in more detail under “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions,” prior to the consummation of this offering, we intend to enter into a shareholder’s agreement with Mubadala, which will entitle Mubadala, subject to the level of Mubadala’s beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares, to certain consent rights and director nomination rights. As a result, Mubadala will continue to have significant influence over the management and affairs of our company, as well as the ability to control the outcome of matters submitted to our shareholders for approval, including the election of directors and the approval of significant corporate transactions, including any merger, consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets and the issuance or redemption of equity interests in certain circumstances. The interests of Mubadala may not always coincide with, and in some cases may conflict with, our interests and the interests of our other shareholders. For instance, Mubadala could attempt to delay or prevent a change in control of our company, even if such change in control would benefit our other shareholders, which could deprive our shareholders of an opportunity to receive a premium for their ordinary shares. This concentration of ownership may also affect the prevailing market price of our ordinary shares due to investors’ perceptions that conflicts of interest may exist or arise, and because Mubadala may sell, or investors may perceive that Mubadala is likely to sell, a significant amount of our ordinary shares.

As a foreign private issuer and a controlled company, we are not subject to certain corporate governance rules applicable to U.S. listed companies.

As a foreign private issuer that has applied to list our ordinary shares on the Nasdaq, we rely on a provision in the Nasdaq corporate governance listing standards that allows us to follow Cayman Islands law with regard to certain aspects of corporate governance. This allows us to follow certain corporate governance practices that differ in significant respects from the corporate governance requirements applicable to U.S. companies listed on the Nasdaq.

For example, we are exempt from Nasdaq regulations that require a listed U.S. company to:

 

   

have a majority of the board of directors consist of independent directors;

 

   

require non-management directors to meet on a regular basis without management present;

 

50


Table of Contents
   

have an independent compensation committee;

 

   

have an independent nominating committee; and

 

   

seek shareholder approval for the implementation of certain equity compensation plans and issuances of ordinary shares.

As a foreign private issuer, we are permitted to follow home country practice in lieu of the above requirements. Our audit, risk and compliance committee is required to comply with the provisions of Rule 10A-3 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), which is applicable to U.S. companies listed on the Nasdaq. Therefore, we intend to have a fully independent audit, risk and compliance committee within one year from effectiveness of our initial public offering registration statement, in accordance with Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act. However, because we are a foreign private issuer, our audit, risk and compliance committee is not subject to additional Nasdaq corporate governance requirements applicable to listed U.S. companies, including the requirements to have a minimum of three members and to affirmatively determine that all members are “independent,” using more stringent criteria than those applicable to us as a foreign private issuer.

We are a foreign private issuer and, as a result, are not subject to U.S. proxy rules but are subject to reporting obligations that, to some extent, are more lenient and less frequent than those of a U.S. issuer.

We are a non-U.S. company with foreign private issuer status. Because we qualify as a foreign private issuer under the Exchange Act, and although we follow the laws and regulations of the Cayman Islands with regard to such matters, we are exempt from certain provisions of the Exchange Act that are applicable to U.S. public companies, including: (i) the sections of the Exchange Act regulating the solicitation of proxies, consents or authorizations in respect of a security registered under the Exchange Act, (ii) the sections of the Exchange Act requiring insiders to file public reports of their stock ownership and trading activities and liability for insiders who profit from trades made in a short period of time and (iii) the rules under the Exchange Act requiring the filing of quarterly reports on Form 10-Q containing unaudited financial and other specified information, or current reports on Form 8-K, upon the occurrence of specified significant events. Foreign private issuers are required to file their annual report on Form 20-F within four months after the end of each fiscal year. Foreign private issuers are also exempt from the Regulation Fair Disclosure, aimed at preventing issuers from making selective disclosures of material information. As a result of the above, you may not have the same protections afforded to shareholders of companies that are not foreign private issuers. This may be the case even though we intend to make interim reports available to our shareholders, copies of which we are required to furnish to the SEC on a Form 6-K, and even though we are required to file reports on Form 6-K disclosing whatever information we have made or are required to make public pursuant to Cayman Islands law or distribute to our shareholders and that is material to us.

We are a Cayman Islands company and, because judicial precedent regarding the rights of shareholders is more limited under Cayman Islands law than that under U.S. law, you may have less protection for your shareholder rights than you would under U.S. law.

Our corporate affairs are governed by our Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association (the “Memorandum and Articles of Association”), as amended and restated from time to time, the Cayman Islands Companies Act (as amended) (the “Cayman Companies Act”) and the common law of the Cayman Islands. The rights of shareholders to take action against the directors, actions by minority shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of our directors to us under Cayman Islands law are to a large extent governed by the common law of the Cayman Islands. The common law of the Cayman Islands is derived in part from comparatively limited judicial precedent in the Cayman Islands as well as that from English common law, which has persuasive, but not binding, authority on a court in the Cayman Islands. The rights of our shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of our directors under Cayman Islands law are not as clearly defined as they would be under statutes or judicial precedent in some jurisdictions in the United States. In particular, the Cayman Islands has a less prescriptive body of securities laws than the United States. In addition, some U.S. states, such as Delaware, have more fulsome and judicially interpreted bodies of corporate law than the Cayman Islands.

 

51


Table of Contents

As a result of all of the above, public shareholders may have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions taken by management, members of the board of directors or controlling shareholders than they would as shareholders of a corporation incorporated in a jurisdiction in the United States.

Our officers and directors presently have, and any of them in the future may have, additional fiduciary or contractual obligations to other entities, and, accordingly, may have conflicts of interest in determining to which entity a particular business opportunity should be presented.

Our directors and officers presently have, and any of them in the future may have, additional fiduciary or contractual obligations to other entities pursuant to which such officer or director is or will be required to present a business opportunity to such entity, subject to his or her fiduciary duties under Cayman Islands law. Accordingly, they may have conflicts of interest in determining to which entity a particular business opportunity should be presented. These conflicts may not be resolved in our favor and a potential business opportunity may be presented to another entity prior to its presentation to us, subject to their fiduciary duties under Cayman Islands law.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law: (i) no individual serving as a director or an officer shall have any duty, except and to the extent expressly assumed by contract, to refrain from engaging directly or indirectly in the same or similar business activities or lines of business as us; (ii) we renounce any interest or expectancy in, or in being offered an opportunity to participate in, any potential transaction or matter which may be a corporate opportunity for any director or officer, on the one hand, and us, on the other; and (iii) no individual serving as a director or an officer shall have a duty to communicate or offer any such corporate opportunity to us, nor shall such individuals be liable to us for a breach of fiduciary duty solely by reason of the fact that such party pursues or acquires such corporate opportunity for himself or herself, directs such corporate opportunity to another person, or does not communicate information regarding such corporate opportunity to us.

For a complete discussion of our executive officers’ and directors’ business affiliations and the potential conflicts of interest that you should be aware of, please see “Management” and “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

The Cayman Islands Economic Substance Law may affect our operations.

The Cayman Islands has recently enacted the International Tax Co-operation (Economic Substance) Law (2020 Revision), or the Cayman Economic Substance Law. The Cayman Economic Substance Law generally requires legal entities domiciled or registered in the Cayman Islands to have demonstrable substance in the Cayman Islands. The Cayman Economic Substance Law was introduced by the Cayman Islands to ensure that it meets its commitments to the European Union, as well as its obligations under the OECD’s global Base Erosion and Profit Shifting initiatives. We are required to comply with the Cayman Economic Substance Law. As we are a Cayman Islands company, compliance obligations include filing annual notifications for us, which need to state whether we are carrying out any relevant activities and, if so, whether we have satisfied economic substance tests to the extent required under the Cayman Economic Substance Law. As it is a relatively new regime, it is anticipated that the Cayman Economic Substance Law will evolve and be subject to further clarification and amendments. We may need to allocate additional resources to keep updated with these developments, and may have to make changes to our operations in order to comply with all requirements under the Cayman Economic Substance Law. Failure to satisfy these requirements may subject us to penalties under the Cayman Economic Substance Law. The Cayman Islands Tax Information Authority shall impose a penalty of CI$10,000 (or US$12,500) on a relevant entity for failing to satisfy the economic substance test or CI$100,000 (or US$125,000) if it is not satisfied in the subsequent financial year after the initial notice of failure. Following failure after two consecutive years the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands may make an order requiring the relevant entity to take specified action to satisfy the economic substance test or ordering it that it is defunct or be struck off.

 

52


Table of Contents

Risks Related to Operating as a Public Company

We will incur increased costs and expenses as a result of operating as a public company and our management will be required to devote substantial time to compliance with our public company responsibilities and corporate governance practices.

As a public company, we will incur greater legal, accounting and other expenses than we incurred as a private company. After this offering, we will be subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (“SOX”), the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), and the rules and regulations of the Nasdaq, which impose various requirements on public companies, including establishment and maintenance of effective disclosure and financial controls and corporate governance practices. These requirements will increase our legal, accounting, and financial compliance costs and will make some activities more difficult, time-consuming, and costly, and place significant strain on our personnel, systems and resources. For example, we expect these rules and regulations to make it more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to accept reduced policy limits and coverage or incur substantially higher costs to maintain the same or similar coverage.

We are evaluating these rules and regulations and cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur or the timing of such costs. These rules and regulations are often subject to varying interpretations, in many cases due to their lack of specificity, and, as a result, their application in practice may evolve over time as new guidance is provided by regulatory and governing bodies. This could result in continuing uncertainty regarding compliance matters and higher costs necessitated by ongoing revisions to disclosure and governance practices.

We will also need to comply with auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of SOX. In that regard, as we prepare for such compliance, we will need to hire additional accounting and financial staff with appropriate public company experience and technical accounting knowledge. We cannot predict or estimate the amount of additional costs we may incur or the timing of such costs.

If we fail to establish and maintain proper and effective internal control over financial reporting, our operating results and our ability to operate our business could be harmed.

Ensuring that we have adequate internal financial and accounting controls and procedures in place so that we can produce accurate financial statements on a timely basis is a costly and time-consuming effort that needs to be re-evaluated frequently. Our internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. In connection with this offering, we intend to begin the process of documenting, reviewing and improving our internal controls and procedures for compliance with Section 404 of SOX, which will require annual management assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. Implementing any appropriate changes to our internal controls may distract our officers and employees, entail substantial costs to modify our existing processes and take significant time to complete. These changes may not, however, be effective in maintaining the adequacy of our internal controls, and any failure to maintain that adequacy, or consequent inability to produce accurate financial statements on a timely basis, could increase our operating costs and harm our business. In addition, investors’ perceptions that our internal controls are inadequate or that we are unable to produce accurate financial statements on a timely basis may harm the trading price of our ordinary shares following this offering and make it more difficult for us to effectively market and sell our service to new and existing customers.

Risks Related to our Ordinary Shares

There has been no prior public market for our ordinary shares, and an active trading market may never develop or be sustained.

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our ordinary shares. The initial public offering price for our ordinary shares was determined by negotiations between us, Mubadala and the representatives of the

 

53


Table of Contents

underwriters and may not be indicative of prices that will prevail in the trading market following the closing of this offering. Although we have applied to have our ordinary shares listed on the Nasdaq, an active trading market for our ordinary shares may never develop or be sustained following this offering. If an active market for our ordinary shares does not develop, it may be difficult for you to sell shares you purchase in this offering without depressing the market price for our ordinary shares, or at all. An inactive trading market may also impair our ability to raise capital by selling shares of our ordinary shares and enter into strategic partnerships or acquire other complementary products, technologies or businesses by using shares of our ordinary shares as consideration. Furthermore, although we have applied to have our ordinary shares listed on the Nasdaq, even if listed, there can be no guarantee that we will continue to satisfy the continued listing standards of the Nasdaq. If we fail to satisfy the continued listing standards, we could be de-listed, which would negatively impact the value and liquidity of your investment.

The trading price of our ordinary shares following this offering may be volatile, and investors in our ordinary shares may not be able to resell shares of our ordinary shares at or above the price paid, or at all.

The trading price of our ordinary shares following this offering could be volatile and subject to wide fluctuations in response to various factors, many of which are beyond our control, including, but not limited to:

 

   

variations in our actual or anticipated annual or quarterly operating results or those of others in our industry;

 

   

results of operations that otherwise fail to meet the expectations of securities analysts and investors;

 

   

changes in earnings estimates or recommendations by securities analysts, or other changes in investor perceptions of the investment opportunity associated with our ordinary shares relative to other investment alternatives;

 

   

market conditions in the semiconductor industry;

 

   

publications, reports or other media exposure of our products and services or those of others in our industry, or of our industry generally;

 

   

announcements by us or others in our industry, or by our or their respective suppliers, distributors or other business partners, regarding, among other things, significant contracts, price reductions, capital commitments or other business developments, the entry into or termination of strategic transactions or relationships, securities offerings or other financing initiatives, and public reaction thereto;

 

   

additions or departures of key management personnel;

 

   

regulatory actions involving us or others in our industry, or actual or anticipated changes in applicable government regulations or enforcement thereof;

 

   

the development and sustainability of an active trading market for our ordinary shares;

 

   

sales, or anticipated sales, of large blocks of our ordinary shares;

 

   

a significant number of shares of our ordinary shares becoming available for sale in a condensed period of time in connection with the exercise of employee stock options or sales by Mubadala;

 

   

general economic and securities market conditions; and

 

   

other factors discussed in this “Risk Factors” section and elsewhere in this prospectus.

Furthermore, the stock market in general has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of particular companies. Broad market and industry factors may significantly affect the market price of our ordinary shares, regardless of our actual operating performance. These fluctuations may be even more pronounced in the trading market for our ordinary shares shortly following the closing of this offering, including potential volume fluctuations related to the

 

54


Table of Contents

exercise of a significant number of our employee stock options and subsequent sale of shares prior to the end of the calendar year in which our management lock-up expires. The number of options that are currently expected to be exercised in calendar year 2022 is approximately 13.0 million.

These and other factors may cause the market price and demand for our ordinary shares to fluctuate significantly, which may limit or prevent investors from readily selling their shares of ordinary shares and may otherwise negatively affect the liquidity of our ordinary shares. In addition, in the past, when the market price of a stock has been volatile, holders of that stock have sometimes instituted securities class action litigation against the company that issued the stock. If any of our shareholders were to bring a lawsuit against us, we could incur substantial costs defending the lawsuit. Such a lawsuit could also divert the time and attention of our management from our core business operations.

In addition, the cornerstone investors have indicated an interest in purchasing ordinary shares with an aggregate purchase price of approximately $1.05 billion in this offering at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. Because these indications of interest are not binding agreements or commitments to purchase, the cornerstone investors may decide to purchase more, less or no ordinary shares in this offering, or the underwriters may decide to sell more, less or no ordinary shares in this offering to the cornerstone investors. If one or more of the cornerstone investors are allocated all or a portion of the ordinary shares in which they have indicated an interest in this offering or more, and purchase any such ordinary shares, such purchase could reduce the available public float for our ordinary shares if the cornerstone investors hold such ordinary shares long term.

We have broad discretion to use the net proceeds that we receive from this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, and our investment of these proceeds may not yield a favorable return. We may invest such proceeds in ways you disagree with.

Our management has broad discretion as to how to spend and invest the proceeds that we receive from this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, and we may spend or invest these proceeds in ways with which our shareholders may disagree. Accordingly, investors will need to rely on our judgment with respect to the use of these proceeds. We intend to use the proceeds that we receive from this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement for capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes. We could spend the proceeds that we receive from this offering in ways that our shareholders may not agree with or that do not yield a favorable return. You will not have the opportunity as part of your investment decision to assess whether the net proceeds that we receive from this offering are being used appropriately. If we do not use the net proceeds that we receive in this offering effectively, our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects could be materially adversely affected, and the market price of our ordinary shares could decline.

If you purchase our ordinary shares in this offering, you will incur immediate and substantial dilution, and issuance of additional capital stock could lead to further dilution.

The assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share (the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) will be substantially higher than the pro forma net tangible book value per share of our outstanding ordinary shares of $14.02 per share as of June 30, 2021 after this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement. Investors purchasing shares of our ordinary shares in this offering will pay a price per share that substantially exceeds the book value of our tangible assets after subtracting our liabilities. As a result, investors purchasing ordinary shares in this offering will incur immediate dilution of $30.48 per share, based on the assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

This dilution is due to the substantially lower price paid by our existing shareholder who purchased shares prior to this offering as compared to the price offered to the public in this offering. As a result of the dilution to investors purchasing shares in this offering, investors may receive less than the purchase price paid in this offering, if anything, in the event of our liquidation. See “Dilution.”

 

55


Table of Contents

Future sales or distributions of our shares by Mubadala could depress the price of our ordinary shares.

After this offering, and subject to the lock-up period described below, Mubadala may sell all or a portion of the ordinary shares that it owns. Immediately following the offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, Mubadala will own approximately 89.4% of our outstanding ordinary shares (assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional ordinary shares). Sales by Mubadala in the public market or other distributions of substantial amounts of our ordinary shares, or the filing of a registration statement relating to a substantial amount of our ordinary shares, could depress our ordinary share price. Mubadala is not subject to any contractual obligation to maintain its ownership position in our shares, except that it has agreed not to sell or otherwise dispose of any of our ordinary shares for a period ending 180 days after the date of this prospectus without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC on behalf of the underwriters, subject to specified limited exceptions and extensions described in “Underwriters.” Consequently, Mubadala may decide not to maintain its ownership of our ordinary shares once the lock-up period expires. See “Shares Eligible for Future Sale.”

In addition, Mubadala will have the right, subject to certain conditions, to require us to file registration statements covering its shares or to include its shares in other registration statements that we may file. By exercising its registration rights and selling a large number of shares, Mubadala could cause the price of our ordinary shares to decline.

We do not expect to declare or pay any dividends on our ordinary shares for the foreseeable future.

We do not intend to pay cash dividends on our ordinary shares for the foreseeable future. Consequently, investors must rely on sales of their shares of our ordinary shares after price appreciation, which may never occur, as the only way to realize any future gains on their investment. Investors seeking dividends should not purchase shares of our ordinary shares. Any future determination to pay dividends will be at the discretion of our board of directors and subject to, among other things, our compliance with applicable law, and depending on, among other things, our business prospects, financial condition, results of operations, cash requirements and availability, debt repayment obligations, capital expenditure needs, the terms of any preferred equity securities we may issue in the future, covenants in the agreements governing our current and future indebtedness, other contractual restrictions, industry trends and any other factors or considerations our board of directors may regard as relevant. See “Dividend Policy.”

Anti-takeover provisions in our organizational documents and Cayman Islands law may discourage or prevent a change of control, even if an acquisition would be beneficial to our shareholders, which could depress the price of our ordinary shares and prevent attempts by our shareholders to replace or remove our current management.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association contain provisions that may discourage unsolicited takeover proposals that shareholders may consider to be in their best interests. Our board of directors is divided into three classes with staggered, three-year terms. Our board of directors has the ability to designate the terms of and issue preferred shares without shareholder approval. We are also subject to certain provisions under Cayman Islands law that could delay or prevent a change of control. Together these provisions may make more difficult the removal of management and may discourage transactions that otherwise could involve payment of a premium over prevailing market prices for our ordinary shares. See “Description of Share Capital.”

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that the courts of the Cayman Islands will be the exclusive forum for certain disputes between us and our shareholders, which could limit our shareholders’ ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for complaints against us or our directors, officers or employees.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, the courts of the Cayman Islands will, to the fullest extent permitted by the law, have exclusive jurisdiction over any claim or dispute arising out of or in connection with our Memorandum and Articles of

 

56


Table of Contents

Association or otherwise related in any way to each shareholder’s shareholding in us, including but not limited to (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf, (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of any fiduciary or other duty owed by any of our current or former directors, officers or other employees to us or our shareholders, (iii) any action asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Cayman Companies Act or our Memorandum and Articles of Association, and (iv) any action asserting a claim against us governed by the “Internal Affairs Doctrine” (as such concept is recognized under the laws of the United States) and that each shareholder irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the Cayman Islands over all such claims or disputes. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association will provide that, unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the federal district courts of the United States will be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause or causes of action arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“Securities Act”), or Exchange Act, including all causes of action asserted against any defendant named in such complaint.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association also provide that, without prejudice to any other rights or remedies that we may have, each of our shareholders acknowledges that damages alone would not be an adequate remedy for any breach of the selection of the courts of the Cayman Islands as exclusive forum and that accordingly we shall be entitled, without proof of special damages, to the remedies of injunction, specific performance or other equitable relief for any threatened or actual breach of the selection of the courts of the Cayman Islands as exclusive forum.

This choice of forum provision may increase a shareholder’s cost and limit the shareholder’s ability to bring a claim in a judicial forum that it finds favorable for disputes with us or our directors, officers or other employees, which may discourage lawsuits against us and our directors, officers and other employees. Any person or entity purchasing or otherwise acquiring any of our shares or other securities, whether by transfer, sale, operation of law or otherwise, shall be deemed to have notice of and have irrevocably agreed and consented to these provisions. There is uncertainty as to whether a court would enforce such provisions, and the enforceability of similar choice of forum provisions in other companies’ charter documents has been challenged in legal proceedings. It is possible that a court could find this type of provisions to be inapplicable or unenforceable, and if a court were to find this provision in our Memorandum and Articles of Association to be inapplicable or unenforceable in an action, we may incur additional costs associated with resolving the dispute in other jurisdictions, which could have adverse effect on our business and financial performance.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide for indemnification of officers and directors at our expense, which may result in a major cost to us and hurt the interests of our shareholders because corporate resources may be expended for the benefit of officers and/or directors.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association and applicable law of the Cayman Islands provide for the indemnification of our directors and officers, under certain circumstances, against any liability, action, proceeding, claim, demand, costs, damages or expenses, including legal expenses, whatsoever which they or any of them may incur as a result of any act or failure to act in carrying out their functions in connection with our company, other than such liability (if any) that they may incur by reason of their own actual fraud, dishonesty, willful neglect or willful default. We will also bear the expenses of such litigation for any of our directors or officers, upon such person’s undertaking to repay any amounts paid, advanced, or reimbursed by us if it is ultimately determined that any such person shall not have been entitled to indemnification. This indemnification policy could result in substantial expenditures by us that we will be unable to recoup.

We have been advised that, in the opinion of the SEC, indemnification for liabilities arising under federal securities laws is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act, and is, therefore, unenforceable.

 

57


Table of Contents

If equity research analysts or industry analysts do not publish research or reports about our business, or if they change their recommendations regarding our stock adversely, our stock price and trading volume could decline.

The trading market for our ordinary shares, should one develop, will be influenced by the research and reports that industry or equity research analysts publish about us or our business. As a newly public company, we may be slow to attract research coverage and the analysts who publish information about our ordinary shares will have had relatively little experience with us, which could affect their ability to accurately forecast our results and could make it more likely that we fail to meet their estimates. If no or few securities or industry analysts commence coverage of us, the trading price for our ordinary shares will be negatively impacted. In the event we do obtain industry or equity research analyst coverage, we will not have any control over the analysts’ content and opinions included in their reports. If any of the analysts who cover us issue an adverse or misleading opinion regarding us, our business model, financial performance, stock price or otherwise, our stock price would likely decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of our company or fails to regularly publish reports on us, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause our stock price or trading volume to decline and result in the loss of all or a part of your investment in us.

 

58


Table of Contents

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This prospectus contains forward-looking statements that reflect our plans, beliefs, expectations and current views with respect to, among other things, future events and financial performance. The forward-looking statements appear in a number of places in this prospectus including, but not limited to, the sections titled “Prospectus Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business.” Forward-looking statements are based on our management’s beliefs and assumptions and on information currently available to our management.

You can identify some of these forward-looking statements by words or phrases such as “aim,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “continue,” “could,” “estimate,” “expect,” “intend,” “is/are likely to,” “may,” “might,” “plan,” “potential,” “predict,” “shall,” “should,” “target,” “will,” the negative of these words or other similar expressions, or by discussions of strategy, plans or intentions. Known and unknown risks, uncertainties, and other factors, including those listed under “Risk Factors,” may cause our actual results, performance or achievements to be materially different from those expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements. Such risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to:

 

   

general global economic conditions;

 

   

our ability to meet production requirements under long-term supply agreements;

 

   

our business and operating strategies and plans for the development of existing and new businesses, ability to implement such strategies and plans and expected time;

 

   

our reliance on a small number of customers;

 

   

our future business development, financial condition and results of operations, including expected financial results for the three months ended September 30, 2021;

 

   

the seasonality, volatility and cyclical nature of the semiconductor and microelectronics industry;

 

   

expected changes in our revenue, costs or expenditures;

 

   

our dividend policy;

 

   

our assumptions and estimates regarding design wins;

 

   

our expectations regarding demand for and market acceptance of our products and services;

 

   

our expectations regarding our relationships with customers, contract manufacturers, component suppliers, third-party service providers, strategic partners and other stakeholders;

 

   

our expectations regarding our capacity to develop, manufacture and deliver semiconductor products in fulfilment of our contractual commitments;

 

   

our ability to conduct our manufacturing operations without disruptions;

 

   

our ability to manage our capacity and production facilities effectively;

 

   

our ability to develop new technologies successfully and remain a technological leader;

 

   

our ability to maintain control over expansion and facility modifications;

 

   

our ability to generate growth or profitable growth;

 

   

our ability to maintain and protect our intellectual property;

 

   

our ability to hire and maintain qualified personnel;

 

   

our effective tax rate or tax liability;

 

   

whether the Concurrent Private Placement is successfully consummated;

 

   

our ability to acquire required equipment and supplies necessary to meet customer demand;

 

   

the increased competition from other companies and our ability to retain and increase our market share;

 

59


Table of Contents
   

our proposed used of proceeds from this offering;

 

   

the potential business or economic disruptions caused by current and future pandemics, such as the COVID-19 pandemic;

 

   

developments in, or changes to, laws, regulations, governmental policies, incentives and taxation affecting our operations relating to our industry; and

 

   

assumptions underlying or related to any of the foregoing.

We caution you that the foregoing list does not contain all of the forward-looking statements made in this prospectus.

Forward-looking statements are based on current plans, estimates and projections, and therefore you should not place undue reliance on them. Forward-looking statements speak only as of the date they are made, and we undertake no obligation to update them publicly in light of new information or future events, except as required by law. The inclusion of this forward-looking information should not be regarded as a representation by us, the underwriters or any other person that the future plans, estimates or expectations contemplated by us will be achieved. Actual future results may be materially different from what we expect.

You should carefully consider the “Risk Factors” and subsequent public statements, or reports filed with or furnished to the SEC, before making any investment decision with respect to our securities. If any of these trends, risks or uncertainties actually occurs or continues, our business, financial condition or operating results could be materially adversely affected, the trading prices of our securities could decline and you could lose all or part of your investment. All forward-looking statements attributable to us or persons acting on our behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by this cautionary statement.

 

60


Table of Contents

INDUSTRY AND MARKET DATA

This prospectus contains statistical data, estimates and forecasts about our industry and the market in which we operate, including our general expectations and market position, market opportunity and market size. That information is based on our own internal estimates and research, as well as independent industry publications such as those published by Gartner, Inc., Boston Consulting Group, International Data Corporation, IoT Analytics, Dell’Oro Group, Inc. (“Gartner”), IC Insights, U.S. Census Bureau, IHS Markit Ltd., Omdia, VLSI Research and the Semiconductor Industry Association, and is subject to a number of assumptions and limitations. The Gartner content described herein (the “Gartner Content”) represents research opinion or viewpoints published, as part of a syndicated subscription service, by Gartner, and are not representations of fact. Gartner Content speaks as of its original publication date (and not as of the date of this prospectus), and the opinions expressed in the Gartner Content are subject to change without notice.

Although we are responsible for all of the disclosure contained in this prospectus and we believe the information from the industry publication and other third-party sources included in this prospectus is reliable, neither we nor the underwriters have independently verified market and industry data from third-party sources. While we believe our internal company research is reliable and the definitions of our market and industry are appropriate, neither this research nor these definitions have been verified by any independent source.

The industry in which we operate is subject to a high degree of uncertainty and risk due to a variety of factors, including those described in the section titled “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus. These and other factors could cause results to differ materially from those expressed in the estimates made by the independent parties and by us.

 

61


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

We estimate that the net proceeds from the sale of 33,000,000 ordinary shares that we are selling in this offering will be approximately $1.4 billion, based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. We will not receive any proceeds from the sale of ordinary shares by the selling shareholder in the offering.

Each $1.00 increase or decrease in the assumed initial public offering price would increase or decrease, respectively, the net proceeds to us by approximately $33 million, assuming the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions. Similarly, a change in the number of ordinary shares we sell would increase or decrease our net proceeds. We do not expect that a change in the initial price to the public or the number of shares by these amounts would have a material effect on uses of the proceeds from this offering, although it may accelerate the time at which we will need to seek additional capital.

The principal purposes of selling our ordinary shares in this offering are to obtain additional capital, to create a public market for our ordinary shares and to facilitate our future access to the public equity markets. We intend to use the net proceeds from this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement for capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes. We may also use a portion of the net proceeds for the acquisition of, or investment in, businesses or technologies that complement our business, although we have no present commitments or agreements to do so.

We have not yet determined our anticipated expenditures and therefore cannot estimate the amounts to be used for each of the purposes discussed above. The amounts and timing of any expenditures will vary depending on the amount of cash generated by our operations, competitive and technological developments and the rate of growth, if any, of our business. Accordingly, our management will have significant flexibility in applying the net proceeds from this offering, and investors will be relying on the judgment of our management regarding the application of these net proceeds. Pending the uses described above, we intend to invest the net proceeds from this offering in short-term, interest-bearing obligations, investment-grade instruments, certificates of deposit or direct or guaranteed obligations of the U.S. government. The goal with respect to the investment of these net proceeds will be capital preservation and liquidity so that these funds are readily available to fund our operations.

 

62


Table of Contents

DIVIDEND POLICY

We currently intend to retain all available funds and any future earnings to fund the development and growth of our business. Therefore, we do not anticipate declaring or paying any cash dividends to our shareholders in the foreseeable future. Any future determination as to the declaration and payment of dividends, if any, will be at the discretion of our board of directors, subject to applicable laws, and will depend on a number of factors, including our business prospects, results of operations, financial condition, cash requirements and availability, debt repayment obligations, capital expenditure needs, covenants in the agreements governing our current and future indebtedness, other contractual restrictions, industry trends and any other factors or considerations our board of directors may regard as relevant.

Under Cayman Islands law, dividends may be declared and paid only out of funds legally available therefor, namely out of either profit or distributable reserves, including our share premium account, and provided further that a dividend may not be paid if this would result in us being unable to pay our debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.

For additional information, see “Risk Factors—We do not expect to declare or pay any dividends on our ordinary shares for the foreseeable future” and “Description of Share Capital—Dividends.”

 

63


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

The following table sets forth our capitalization as of June 30, 2021:

 

   

on an actual basis; and

 

   

on an as adjusted basis to reflect the sale of ordinary shares by us pursuant to this offering.

This table should be read in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus, and with other financial information contained in this prospectus.

 

     June 30, 2021  
     (dollars in thousands)  
     Actual     As Adjusted  

Cash and cash equivalents(1)(2)

   $ 804,688     $ 1,839,476  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long term debt, including current portion

    

USD Term Loan A due 2025

     646,405       646,405  

2019 EUR Dresden Equipment Financing due 2026

     466,475       466,475  

2019 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing due 2024

     232,147       232,147  

2019 USD Dresden Equipment Financing due 2024

     197,534       197,534  

2020 USD Equipment Financing due 2025

     240,698       240,698  

EUR Term Loan A due 2025

     98,162       98,162  

Other long term debt

     294,424       294,424  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt(3)

   $ 2,175,845     $ 2,175,845  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Shareholder’s equity

    

Share capital(4)

     10,000       10,694  

Additional paid-in capital(1)(2)(4)

     11,848,304       23,437,085  

Loan from shareholder(2)

     10,554,687        

Accumulated deficit

     (15,517,963     (15,517,963

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (24,590     (24,590
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity (deficit) attributable to the company

   $ 6,870,438     $ 7,905,226  

Non-controlling interests

   $ 61,295     $ 61,295  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

   $ 6,932,363     $ 7,967,151  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capitalization

   $ 9,108,208     $ 10,142,996  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The As Adjusted column further reflects the proceeds from the sale of 34,685,393 of our ordinary shares in this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement at an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting estimated underwriting discounts of $36,713 thousand and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us of $30,000 thousand, for $1,476,788 thousand of net proceeds.

(2)

We entered into loan facilities with Mubadala in 2012 to 2016 (collectively, the “Shareholder Loans”). After June 30, 2021, $442 million of cash payments were made. On October 3, 2021, we executed the conversion of the entire Shareholder Loans balance of $10,112,687 thousand into additional paid-in-capital (“the Conversion”), which did not have an impact on shares outstanding or have any dilutive effects, as no additional shares were issued.

(3)

On September 3, 2021, we entered into a loan agreement with a lender, which provided for loan facilities with maximum drawdown of SGD1,541,000 thousand (US$1,148,500 thousand) at fixed interest rates. No amounts have been drawn down on the facility. See Note 37 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 17 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for additional details. This facility is not reflected in the table above.

(4)

Reflects the issuance of 34,685,393 shares with a par value of $0.02 associated with this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement.

 

64


Table of Contents

DILUTION

If you invest in our ordinary shares in this offering, your ownership interest will be diluted to the extent of the difference between the initial public offering price per share and the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share of our ordinary shares immediately after this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement. Dilution results from the fact that the initial public offering price per share is substantially in excess of the book value per share attributable to the existing shareholder for our presently outstanding ordinary shares.

As of June 30, 2021, we had a historical net tangible book value of $6,458,960 thousand, or $12.92 per share. Pro forma net tangible book value per share represents the amount of our total tangible assets of $11,925,408 thousand less our total liabilities of $(5,464,148) thousand and deferred IPO costs of $(2,300) thousand, divided by the number of our ordinary shares outstanding as of June 30, 2021, after giving effect to the completion of this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement assuming an initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. Total assets of $12,396,511 thousand less goodwill and intangible assets of $471,103 thousand represents the amount of our total tangible assets of $11,925,408 thousand as of June 30, 2021.

After giving effect to the sale of 34,685,393 ordinary shares that we are offering and the Concurrent Private Placement at an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after the cash payments of $442 million on our Shareholder Loan, and deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions, of $36,713 thousand and estimated offering expenses payable by us of $30,000 thousand, our pro forma net tangible book value as of June 30, 2021 would have been $7,493,748 thousand, or $14.02 per share. This amount represents an immediate increase in pro forma net tangible book value of $1.10 per share to our existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in pro forma net tangible book value of $30.48 per share to new investors purchasing ordinary shares in this offering. The following table illustrates this per share dilution:

 

Assumed initial public offering price

   $ 44.50  

Historical net tangible book value per share as of June 30, 2021

   $ 12.92  

Increase in pro forma net tangible book value per share attributable to new investors

   $ 1.10  
  

 

 

 

Pro forma net tangible book value per share after this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement

   $ 14.02  
  

 

 

 

Dilution per share to new investors

   $ 30.48  

Dilution is determined by subtracting pro forma net tangible book value per share after the offering and the Concurrent Private Placement from the initial public offering price per share.

The following table sets forth, on a pro forma basis, as of June 30, 2021, the number of ordinary shares purchased from us, the total consideration paid (not including our Shareholder Loans), or to be paid, and the average price per share paid, or to be paid, by the existing shareholder, by the new investors and Silver Lake, at an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, the midpoint of the range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, before deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses:

 

     Shares Purchased     Total Consideration     Average
Price
Per Share
 
     Number      Percent     Amount     Percent  

Existing shareholder

     478,000,000        89.4   $ 11,336,538,624 (1)      81.8   $ 23.72  

New investors

     55,000,000        10.3   $ 2,447,500,000       17.7   $ 44.50  

Private Placement

     1,685,393        0.3   $ 75,000,000       0.5   $ 44.50  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     534,685,393        100   $ 13,859,038,624       100   $ 25.92  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Total consideration for the ordinary shares held by the existing shareholder represents share capital and additional paid-in capital attributable to such shares as of June 30, 2021.

The foregoing tables assume no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option or of outstanding share options or settlement of outstanding restricted share units (“RSUs”) after October 13, 2021. At October 13, 2021, 22,504,185 ordinary shares were subject to outstanding options and outstanding RSUs. The weighted average exercise price of outstanding share options is $10.03. To the extent these options are exercised or these RSUs are settled there will be further dilution to new investors. See Note 33 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 16 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for additional details.

 

65


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with the section titled “Summary Consolidated Financial Data” and the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results could differ materially from those discussed below. Factors that could cause or contribute to such differences include, but are not limited to, those identified below and those discussed in the section titled “Risk Factors” included elsewhere in this prospectus.

Overview

We are one of the world’s leading semiconductor foundries. We manufacture complex, feature-rich ICs that enable billions of electronic devices that are pervasive throughout nearly every sector of the global economy. With our specialized foundry manufacturing processes, a library consisting of thousands of IP titles, and differentiated transistor and device technology, we serve a broad range of customers, including the global leaders in IC design, and provide optimized solutions for the function, performance and power requirements of critical applications driving key secular growth end markets. As the only scaled pure-play foundry with a global footprint that is not based in China or Taiwan, we help customers mitigate geopolitical risk and provide greater supply chain certainty. We define a scaled pure-play foundry as a company that focuses on producing ICs for other companies, rather than those of its own design, with more than $2 billion of annual foundry revenue.

Technology megatrends including IoT, 5G, cloud, artificial intelligence and next-generation automotive are reshaping the global economy and driving a new golden age for semiconductors. As the manufacturing backbone of the semiconductor industry, foundries are the bedrock of the global technology ecosystem. We provide differentiated foundry solutions that enable the era for data-centric and connected technologies. We have a large and growing market opportunity with an estimated SAM of $54 billion in 2020, which reflects the sum of all foundry revenues excluding memory and revenues from <12nm wafers, as estimated by Gartner. Our SAM is supported by significant opportunities in our core markets of Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. Our combination of highly-differentiated technology and large share of single-sourced products and long-term supply agreements provides a high degree of revenue visibility and significant operating leverage, resulting in improved financial performance and bottom line growth.

Since our founding in 2009, we have achieved the following key milestones:

 

 

LOGO

 

66


Table of Contents

Strategic Repositioning

Beginning in 2018, we embarked on a new strategy to significantly reposition our business to better align with our customers’ needs, drive margin expansion and accelerate value creation for our stakeholders. Today, we focus on and are growing sales of foundry solutions for the pervasive semiconductor market, where we are trusted to reliably innovate and deliver premium performance, functionality, efficiency and quality specifically developed for customer applications, rather than focusing merely on transistor density and processing speed.

Key elements of our strategy include:

 

   

Focus on feature-rich solutions. In August 2018, we shifted our focus to address the pervasive foundry market opportunity and the growing demand for specialized process technologies in emerging high-growth markets.

 

   

Market-based customer engagement strategy. In order to better address and capture the pervasive semiconductor foundry market opportunity, we restructured our go-to-market organizations to better align with the growing opportunities in Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. We supplemented our existing workforce with talented executives holding deep domain expertise in these growing markets.

 

   

Optimized portfolio. We took a number of steps to streamline and optimize our business and manufacturing footprint to improve our bottom line and return on capital. In 2019, we divested three assets that were not aligned with our strategic priorities.

 

   

Resized and refocused cost structure. We have realigned our engineering, sales and marketing organizations toward higher-margin, higher-return products and opportunities to drive our improved bottom line. We have moved toward product offerings that require lower capital expenditure while still creating significant value. Additionally, we have focused on feature rich-solutions that help us better partner with our customers to create long-term relationships. Our pivot has begun to contribute to a higher gross profit, with a gross profit percentage of 11% for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to (15)% for the year ended December 31, 2020.

 

   

Disciplined, capital-efficient expansion strategy. Since our repositioning, we have focused on a capital-efficient expansion strategy that is based on long-term demand certainty and partnerships with our customers. In addition, by repositioning to focus on differentiated technologies, we have been able to efficiently add features to our existing platforms while significantly reducing overall capital expenditures. Additionally, this strategy provides us with the opportunity to pursue highly accretive investments to meet market demand.

How We Generate Revenue

We generate the vast majority of our revenue from wafer fabrication and sales of finished semiconductor wafers, which accounted for approximately 92% of our net revenues in 2020. We derived the remainder of our revenue primarily from photomask manufacturing and sourcing services and post-fab manufacturing services.

In 2020, our net revenues were $4.9 billion, which included a one-time, non-recurring reduction in revenue due to our moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis, as a result of amendments to the majority of our customer contractual terms. See “—Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates—Revenue Recognition.” Had the change in terms not occurred, net revenues in 2020 would have been an estimated $810 million higher than reported results and 2020 cost of revenues would have likewise been higher by an estimated $634 million, with a commensurate decrease in our inventories. In addition, we divested our ASIC business in 2019. The divested business generated $391 million of revenue in 2019 and $402 million in 2018.

Key Financial and Operating Metrics

We monitor the following key metrics to help us evaluate our business, identify trends affecting our business, measure our performance, formulate business plans and make strategic decisions. We believe the

 

67


Table of Contents

following metrics are useful in evaluating our business but should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for IFRS financial measures. Certain judgments and estimates are inherent in our processes to calculate these metrics.

Wafer Shipment Volume

We define wafer shipment volume as the number of finished wafers shipped in a period expressed in 300mm equivalent wafers. We manufacture semiconductors on silicon wafers based on proprietary circuitry designs provided by and developed in conjunction with our customers.

 

     Year Ended December 31,      Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2018      2019      2020          2020              2021      
     (shipments in thousands)  

Wafer shipment volume

     1,863        1,758        2,030        957        1,143  

Non-IFRS Financial Metrics

We believe that in addition to our results determined in accordance with IFRS, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations, and adjusted loss per share are useful in evaluating our business and the underlying trends that are affecting our performance. These non-IFRS financial measures provide supplemental information regarding our operating performance that excludes certain gains, losses and non-cash charges that occur relatively infrequently and/or that we consider to be unrelated to our core operations. These non-IFRS measures are used by both our management and our board of directors, together with the comparable IFRS information, in evaluating our current performance and planning future business activities.

We believe that these non-IFRS measures, when used in conjunction with our IFRS financial information, also allow investors to better evaluate our financial performance in comparison to other periods and to other companies in our industry. However, non-IFRS financial information is presented for supplemental informational purposes only and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for financial information presented in accordance with IFRS. Our presentation of non-IFRS measures should not be construed as an inference that our future results will be unaffected by unusual or nonrecurring items. Other companies in our industry may calculate these measures differently, which may limit their usefulness as a comparative measure.

See “Summary Consolidated Financial Data” for reconciliation to the most directly comparable financial measure stated in accordance with IFRS.

 

     Year Ended December 31,     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2018     2019     2020     2020     2021  
     (dollars in millions, except per share data)  

Net revenues(1)

   $ 6,196     $ 5,813     $ 4,851     $ 2,697     $ 3,038  

Gross profit (loss)(2)

   $ (450   $ (532   $ (713   $ (361   $ 330  

Adjusted gross profit (loss)(3)

   $ (450   $ (532   $ (713   $ (361   $ 366  

Loss from operations(2)

   $ (2,523   $ (1,625   $ (1,656   $ (815   $ (198

Adjusted loss from operations(4)

   $ (2,518   $ (1,625   $ (1,655   $ (814   $ (54

Net loss from continuing operations(2)

   $ (2,626   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301

Adjusted net loss from continuing operations(5)

   $ (2,621   $ (1,371   $ (1,350   $ (533   $ (157

Adjusted EBITDA(6)

   $ 654     $ 1,154     $ 976     $ 535     $ 760  

Adjusted loss per share(7)

   $ (4.54   $ (2.72   $ (2.70   $ (1.06   $ (0.32

 

(1)

In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer

 

68


Table of Contents
 

Shipment basis. This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Had the change in terms not occurred, net revenues in 2020 would have been an estimated $810 million higher than reported results. In addition, we divested our ASIC business, Avera Semiconductor, in 2019. The divested business generated $391 million of revenue in 2019 and $402 million in 2018.

(2)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had a one-time impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, and adjusted net loss in 2020, estimated to be $176 million.

(3)

We define adjusted gross profit (loss) for a particular period as gross profit (loss) before share-based compensation expense.

(4)

We define adjusted loss from operations for a particular period as loss from operations before share-based compensation expense.

(5)

We define adjusted net loss from continuing operations for a particular period as net loss before share-based compensation expense.

(6)

We define adjusted EBITDA as net income (loss) from continuing operations, excluding the impact of finance expense, tax expense, depreciation, amortization adjusted for share-based compensation expense, one-time transaction gains and associated expenses, one-time restructuring charges and litigation settlements.

(7)

We define adjusted loss per share for a particular period as adjusted net loss from continuing operations divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the particular period.

Adjusted Gross Profit (Loss)

We regularly monitor adjusted gross profit (loss) to assess our manufacturing efficiency and pricing strategy. We define adjusted gross profit (loss) for a particular period as gross profit (loss) before share-based compensation expense. Adjusted gross profit (loss) has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider it in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under IFRS.

Adjusted Loss from Operations

We regularly monitor adjusted loss from operations to assess our operating performance. We define adjusted loss from operations for a particular period as loss from operations before share-based compensation expense. Adjusted loss from operations has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider it in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under IFRS.

Adjusted EBITDA

We regularly monitor adjusted EBITDA to assess our operating performance. We define adjusted EBITDA as net income (loss) from continuing operations, excluding the impact of finance expense, tax expense, depreciation, amortization adjusted for share-based compensation expense, one-time transaction gains and associated expenses, one-time restructuring charges and litigation settlements. Adjusted EBITDA is used to facilitate a comparison of the ordinary, ongoing and customary course of our operations on a consistent basis from period to period and provides an additional understanding of factors and trends affecting our business. Adjusted EBITDA has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider it in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under IFRS.

Adjusted Net Loss from Continuing Operations and Adjusted Loss Per Share

We regularly monitor adjusted net loss from continuing operations to assess our operating performance. We define adjusted net loss from continuing operations for a particular period as net loss from continuing operations before share-based compensation expense. We define adjusted loss per share for a particular period as adjusted net loss from continuing operations divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the particular period. Adjusted net loss from continuing operations and adjusted loss per share have

 

69


Table of Contents

limitations as analytical tools, and you should not consider them in isolation or as substitutes for analysis of our results as reported under IFRS.

Key Factors and Trends Affecting Our Operating Results

Our financial condition and results of operations have been, and will continue to be, affected by numerous factors and trends, including the following:

Global Demand for Semiconductor Products

Demand for our products is dependent on market conditions in the end markets in which our customers operate, which are generally subject to seasonality, cyclicality and competitive conditions. Additionally, we derive a portion of our net revenues from sales to customers that purchase large volumes of our products. Customers generally provide periodic forecasts of their requirements, but these forecasts do not commit such customers to minimum purchases except when long-term contracts are in place.

Increasing Design Wins with New and Existing Customers

We believe that we provide highly-differentiated solutions that enable our customers to innovate and deliver exceptional products to the marketplace. A key measure of our success is customer design wins, and we have secured more than $32 billion in design wins from 2018 to 2020. As our number of design wins has increased, our customer base has become larger and more diverse, having grown from only one customer, AMD, in 2009, to a global base of more than 200 customers as of December 31, 2020. As design wins for our highly-differentiated solutions are put into production and generate revenue, we expect significant benefits to our bottom line as our core solutions sell at premium pricing. We define a design win as the successful completion of the evaluation stage, where a customer has assessed our technology solution, verified that it meets its requirements, qualified it for their products and confirmed to us their selection.

Increasing Single-sourced Revenue Mix

We manufacture products based on a combination of our own technologies and our customers’ IP, resulting in a significant number of products that can only be sourced from us. Our sales and marketing strategy centers on deepening relationships with top customers and investing in technologies to become their single-source supplier for mission-critical applications. We believe a key measure of our success as a differentiated technology partner to our customers is the mix of our wafer shipment volume attributable to single-sourced business, which represented approximately 61% of wafer shipment volume in 2020, up from 47% in 2018. We define single-sourced products as those that we believe can only be manufactured with our technology and cannot be manufactured elsewhere without significant customer redesigns. Approximately 80% of our more than 350 design wins in 2020 were for single-sourced business, a record-breaking year in terms of number of design wins, up from 69% in 2018.

Technology Solution Mix and Pricing

Product mix is among the most important factors affecting revenue and margins, as our wafer price varies significantly across technology platforms. The value of a wafer is determined principally by the uniqueness and complexity of the technology, performance characteristics, yield and defect density. Devices with richer feature sets, higher performance, better yields and greater system-level integration require more substantial R&D investments and more complex manufacturing expertise and equipment, and thus generally command higher wafer prices.

Pricing and margins depend on the volumes and features of the solutions we deliver. We continually monitor and work to reduce the cost of our products and improve the potential value that our solutions deliver to

 

70


Table of Contents

our customers as we target new design win opportunities. While individual product prices may decline, we believe our R&D investments, differentiated product and single-sourced strategy should lead to improvements in pricing mix and overall ASPs if we compete effectively. We establish pricing levels for specific periods of time with our customers, some of which are subject to adjustment during the course of that period to take into account market conditions and other factors. We believe our efforts to provide a wide range of highly-differentiated solutions support our premium position in the marketplace.

Customer Advanced Payments

We recently began to more frequently enter into multiple long-term supply agreements with leading companies in the industry. Many of these contracts include customer advanced payments and capacity reservation fees in order to secure future supply. We have in place multiple long-term supply agreements with approximately $20 billion in aggregate lifetime revenue commitment. These revenue commitments provide significant visibility for our company.

Government Policy and Grants

We have received investment grants from the Federal Republic of Germany, the State of Saxony, various agencies of the Government of Singapore and the Empire State Development Corporation in New York. These grants are primarily provided in connection with construction and operation of our wafer manufacturing facilities, employment and R&D. We incorporate committed government grants into our planning process for future expansions.

Shipment Utilization

Beginning in 2020, our shipment utilization rates began to increase significantly compared to prior years, as we have optimized and streamlined our manufacturing footprint. We define shipment utilization as the ratio of wafer shipment volume divided by our estimated total capacity for wafer manufacturing in a specified period. Shipment utilization remains a very important factor in driving our financial performance, as we incur significant costs regardless of the number of wafers we actually produce. These fixed costs include staffing, electricity, infrastructure, depreciation and maintenance costs at each fab.

Our average shipment utilization rate across our 300mm fabs was 80%, 70% and 84% for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, respectively. Factors affecting shipment utilization rates include efficiency in production facilities, complexity and mix of wafer types ordered by customers, including the impact of export controls and other regulatory changes affecting customers and competitors. Our production capacity is determined based on the capacity ratings of the equipment in the fab, adjusted for expected down time due to set up for production runs and maintenance and R&D.

Impact of COVID-19 on Our Business

All of our manufacturing facilities continue to remain open and are operating at normal production levels. We have been classified as an essential business in the United States, Germany and Singapore and we expect our facilities to remain open throughout the COVID-19 pandemic. Our manufacturing sites are limited to essential personnel only and we are able to maintain appropriate staffing levels to support production. We are also taking all appropriate measures to protect our workforce and community.

At the beginning of the pandemic, we increased the frequency of monitoring our cash flows and working capital, and to date we have seen no impacts. In March 2020, we drew down a $235 million revolving credit facility as a safeguard measure in case of pressure on the banking system, which was fully paid back in July 2020. Our suppliers continue to support our business without material impacts from the pandemic.

 

71


Table of Contents

We are also evaluating and participating in government initiatives as appropriate. To date, we have benefited from approximately $29 million from payroll tax deferrals in the United States and approximately $26 million in grants from the government of Singapore.

Our customers have not signaled material demand shifts at this point and non-cancellable revenue coverage is within the normal historical range. We continue to closely monitor the business environment for changes and are prepared to adjust capital and operational spending as appropriate.

Components of Results of Operations

Net Revenues

We generate the majority of our revenue from volume production and sales of semiconductor wafers, which are priced on a per-wafer basis for the applicable design. We also generate revenue from pre-fabrication services such as rendering of non-recurring engineering (“NRE”) services, mask production and post-fabrication services such as bump, test, and packaging. Pricing is typically agreed prior to production and then updated based on subsequent period negotiations.

We recognize the vast majority of our revenue upon shipment of finished wafers to our customers. Prior to 2020, we recognized wafer revenue primarily on a Percentage-of-Completion basis. In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Our net revenues in 2020 were $4.8 billion, and had the change in terms not occurred, net revenues would have been an estimated $810 million higher than reported results. In addition, we divested our ASIC business in 2019. The divested business generated $391 million and $402 million of revenue in 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Cost of Revenues

Cost of revenues consists primarily of material expenses, depreciation and amortization, employee-related expenses, facility costs and costs of fixed assets, including maintenance and spare parts. Costs related to NRE services are also included within the cost of revenues.

Material expenses primarily include the costs of raw wafers, test wafers, photomasks, resists, process gases, process chemicals, other operating supplies and external service costs for wafer manufacturing. Depreciation and amortization charges primarily include the depreciation of clean room production equipment. We depreciate equipment on a straight-line basis over a two- to ten-year period and buildings on a straight-line basis over up to 26 years (or the remaining lease term of related land on which the buildings are erected, if shorter). Prior to 2021, we depreciated equipment on a straight-line basis over a two- to eight-year period. Employee-related expenses primarily include employee wages and salaries, social security contributions and benefits costs for operators, maintenance technicians, process engineers, supply chain, IT production, yield improvement and health and safety roles. Facility costs primarily consist of the costs of electricity, water and other utilities and services.

Operating Expenses

Our operating expenses consist of R&D and selling, general and administrative expenses. Personnel costs are the most significant component of our operating expenses and consist of salaries, benefits, bonuses, share-based compensation, and commissions.

Research and Development (“R&D”)

Our R&D efforts are focused on developing highly-differentiated process technologies and solutions. As part of our strategic repositioning, we shifted our R&D efforts to focus on technologies where we can deliver a

 

72


Table of Contents

highly-differentiated solution and discontinued our R&D-intensive single-digit node program. Our R&D expense includes personnel costs, materials costs, software license and intellectual property expenses, facility costs, supplies, professional and consulting fees, and depreciation on equipment used in R&D activities. Our development roadmap includes new platform investments, platform features and extensions, and investments in emerging technology capabilities and solutions. We expense R&D costs as incurred. We believe that continued investment in our technology portfolio is important for our future growth and acquisition of new customers. We expect our R&D expense as a percentage of revenue to moderately decline over time as revenue increases.

Selling, General and Administrative (“SG&A”)

SG&A expenses consist primarily of personnel-related costs, including sales commissions to independent sales representatives and professional fees, including the costs of accounting, audit, legal, regulatory and tax compliance. Additionally, costs related to advertising, trade shows, corporate marketing and allocated overhead costs are also included in SG&A expenses.

We expect our SG&A expenses to decrease as a percentage of net revenues. We anticipate that we will incur increased accounting, audit, legal, regulatory, compliance and director and officer insurance costs as well as investor and public relations expenses associated with becoming and operating as a public company.

Other Operating Charges

Restructuring Charges

During the year ended December 31, 2018, we committed to a company-wide transformation program that resulted in the reorganization of our global business infrastructure. The company-wide transformation program resulted in restructuring charges relating to employee separation costs, which include one-time termination benefits that were recognized as a liability at estimated fair value at the time of communication to employees. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we also undertook transformation programs in targeted areas that resulted in restructuring charges related to employee separation costs.

Impairment Charges

We review, at each reporting date, or upon occurrence of a triggering event, the carrying amount of our property, plant and equipment and finite lived intangible assets to determine whether there is any indication that those assets have suffered an impairment loss. If it is determined that impairment of an asset has occurred, impairment losses are recognized in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss to the extent that the recoverable amount, measured at the present value of discounted cash flows attributable to the assets, is less than its carrying value.

Finance Expense

Finance expense consists primarily of interest on borrowings, amortization of debt issuance costs under our term loans, revolving credit facility, finance leases and the other credit facilities we maintain with various financial institutions.

Share of Profit from Joint Ventures and Associates

Share of profit from joint ventures and associates relates to our portion of profit and loss in investments that we do not consolidate. See Note 16 in our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 4 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements for more information.

Gain on Sale of a Fabrication Facility and ASIC Business

Gain on sale of a fabrication facility and ASIC business relates to the sale of Fab 3E facility in Singapore in December 2019, and the sale of our ASIC business in November 2019.

 

73


Table of Contents

Other Income (Expense), net

Other income (expense), net consists of one-time gains and losses and other miscellaneous income and expense items unrelated to our core operations. Included are payments received related to a recent legal settlement as part of a patent dispute with one of our competitors, as well as one-time gains related to a remeasurement of existing equity interests.

Income Tax Benefit (Expense)

Income tax expense consists primarily of income taxes in certain foreign jurisdictions in which we conduct business, which mainly include Germany, Singapore and U.S. federal and state income taxes.

Results of Operations

The following table sets forth our consolidated statements of operations data for the periods indicated:

 

     Year Ended December 31,     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2018     2019     2020         2020             2021      
     (dollars in millions)  

Net revenues

   $ 6,196     $ 5,813     $ 4,851     $ 2,697     $ 3,038  

Cost of revenues(1)(2)

     6,646       6,345       5,563       3,058       2,708  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit (loss)

     (450     (532     (713     (361     330  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses:

          

Research and development(1)(2)

     926       583       476       243       235  

Selling, general and administrative(1)(2)

     453       446       445       210       293  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expense

     1,379       1,029       921       453       528  

Restructuring charges

     112                          

Impairment charges

     582       64       23       2        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other operating charges

     694       64       23       2        
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

     (2,523     (1,625     (1,656     (815     (198

Finance Income

     10       11       3       2       3  

Finance Expense

     (165     (230     (154     (82     (58

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

     7       8       4       2       2  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gains on sale of a fabrication facility and ASIC business

           615                    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

     61       74       440       395       (20
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (2,610     (1,147     (1,363     (498     (271

Income tax (expense) benefit

     (16     (224     12       (36     (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss from continuing operations

   $ (2,626   $ (1,371   $ (1,351   $ (534   $ (301
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Includes amortization of acquired intangibles:

 

     Years Ended December 31,      Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
        2018             2019              2020              2020              2021      
     (dollars in millions)  

Cost of revenues

   $   102      $ 92      $   100      $   41      $   55  

Research and development

   $ 114      $   104      $ 99      $ 44      $ 38  

Selling, general and administrative

   $ 49      $ 46      $ 85      $ 43      $ 11  

 

74


Table of Contents
(2)

Includes share-based compensation expense as follows:

 

     Years Ended December 31,      Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
        2018             2019              2020              2020              2021      
     (dollars in millions)  

Cost of revenues

   $   —      $   —      $   —      $   —      $   36  

Research and development

   $      $      $      $      $ 11  

Selling, general and administrative

   $ 5      $      $ 1      $ 1      $ 97  

Net Revenues

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change      % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Net revenues

   $ 2,697      $ 3,038      $ 341        12.6

Net revenues increased by $341 million, or 12.6%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. The growth was attributable to a $234 million increase in wafer fabrication revenue, with approximately $155 million of the increase related to wafer shipment growth, driven by our Smart Mobile Devices end-market. Also, approximately $80 million of the wafer fabrication revenue growth was due to shipments with more favorable product mix and higher ASPs. In addition, $29 million of the increase was attributable to a forfeiture of a customer rebate, and $28 million increase related to engineering and other pre-fabrication services, mainly driven by an increase in reticle revenue.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Net revenues

   $ 5,813      $ 4,851      $ (962     (16.6 )% 

Net revenues decreased by $962 million, or 16.6%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Had the change in terms not occurred, our net revenues in 2020 would have been an estimated $810 million higher than reported results. In addition, we divested our ASIC business, which generated $391 million of revenue in 2019. These changes were offset by an increase in wafer shipment volume of approximately 272,000.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Net revenues

   $ 6,196      $ 5,813      $ (383     (6.2 )% 

Net revenues decreased by $383 million, or 6.2%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. Wafer fabrication revenue declined $270 million due to 105 thousand lower

 

75


Table of Contents

wafer shipments, driven by reductions in our Smart Mobile Devices and Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter end-markets. In addition, approximately $70 million of the period-to-period decrease was driven by a reduction in demand for our ASIC business.

Cost of Revenues

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change     % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Cost of revenues

   $ 3,058      $ 2,708      $ (350     (11.4 )% 

Cost of revenues decreased by $350 million, or 11.4%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This decrease was due to an approximately $390 million reduction in depreciation and amortization expense, as well as approximately $120 million of savings in other costs driven by productivity initiatives. These decreases were partially offset by an approximately $90 million increase in costs related to a 19% period-over-period increase in wafer shipments, as well as $36 million in share-based compensation expense in 2021.

Approximately $300 million of the $390 million reduction in depreciation and amortization was related to a change in the first quarter of 2021 in the estimated useful lives of manufacturing equipment. For more information, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates—Property, Plant and Equipment.”

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Cost of revenues

   $ 6,345      $ 5,563      $ (782     (12.3 )% 

Cost of revenues decreased by $782 million, or 12.3%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. The decrease was attributable to the change in our customer contractual terms, which were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. Had the change in terms not occurred, our cost of revenues in 2020 would have been an estimated $634 million higher than reported results, with a commensurate decrease in inventories. In addition, we divested our ASIC business in 2019. Cost of revenues related to this business was approximately $150 million in 2019.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Cost of revenues

   $ 6,646      $ 6,345      $ (301     (4.5 )% 

Cost of revenues decreased by $301 million, or 4.5%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. The decrease was primarily attributable to a $121 million reduction in depreciation expense, $92 million related to our Technology Cooperation Agreement (“TCA”), which ended in 2018, and approximately $60 million due to a reduction in wafer shipments of 105,000.

 

76


Table of Contents

Research and Development Expenses

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change     % Change  
       2020          2021    
     (dollars in millions)  

Research and development expenses

   $ 243      $ 235      $ (8     (3.3 )% 

Research and development expenses decreased by $8 million, or 3.3%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This decrease was attributable to a $26 million decrease in depreciation and amortization expense, which was partially offset by an $11 million increase in share-based compensation expense.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Research and development expenses

   $ 583      $ 476      $ (107     (18.4 )% 

Research and development expenses decreased by $107 million, or 18.4%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was due to the sale of our ASIC business, which incurred research and development expenses of $91 million in 2019, and a $9 million increase in grants and NRE, reducing R&D.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Research and development expenses

   $ 926      $ 583      $ (343     (37.1 )% 

Research and development expenses decreased by $343 million, or 37.1%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. This decrease was related to a $152 million decrease related to a reduction in headcount, a $69 million decrease in indirect materials spend (purchase of raw materials used in the manufacturing of wafers), and a $115 million reduction in professional and other services fees. These reductions were largely as a result of our suspension of 7nm development in 2018.

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change      % Change  
       2020          2021    
     (dollars in millions)  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   $ 210      $ 293      $ 83        39.5

Selling, general and administrative expenses increased by $83 million, or 39.5%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This increase was attributable to share-based compensation expense of $97 million in the second quarter of 2021.

 

77


Table of Contents

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   $ 446      $ 445      $ (1     (0.2 )% 

Selling, general and administrative expenses decreased by $1 million, or 0.2%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was due to a reduction in administrative expenses related to the ASIC business which was sold to Marvell Technology Group Ltd. (“Marvell”).

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   $ 453      $ 446      $ (7     (1.6 )% 

Selling, general and administrative expenses decreased by $7 million, or 1.6%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. This decrease was due to a reduction in professional and marketing expenses.

Other operating charges

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change     % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other operating charges

   $ 2      $ 0      $ (2     NM  

Other operating charges decreased by $2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020 due to an impairment charge that did not occur in 2021.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other operating charges

   $ 64      $ 23      $ (41     (64.1 )% 

Other operating charges decreased by $41 million, or 64.1%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was due to lower impairment charges in 2020 related to equipment held for sale.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other operating charges

   $ 694      $ 64      $ (630     Not meaningful (“NM”

 

78


Table of Contents

Other operating charges decreased by $630 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. This decrease was due to lower impairment charges in 2019, compared to 2018. In 2018, we recorded $494 million of impairment charges related to our 7nm assets and $112 million of restructuring-related charges.

Finance income

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change      % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance income

   $ 2      $ 3      $ 1        50.0

Finance income increased by $1 million, or 50.0%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance income

   $ 11      $ 3      $ (8     NM  

Finance income decreased by $8 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was due to lower cash balances and lower interest rates in 2020 compared to 2019, resulting in a decrease of interest earned.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance income

   $ 10      $ 11      $ 1        10.7

Finance income increased by $1 million, or 10.7%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This increase was due to higher cash balances in 2019, compared to 2018, resulting in an increase of interest earned.

Finance expense

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change     % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance expenses

   $ 82      $ 58      $ (24     (29.3 )% 

 

79


Table of Contents

Finance expenses decreased by $24 million, or 29.3%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This decrease was driven by the maturity of several loans in 2020, as well as lower interest rate from the refinancing of our Term Loan B with a term loan facility.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance expenses

   $ 230      $ 154      $ (76     (32.9 )% 

Finance expenses decreased by $76 million, or 32.9%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was driven by lower outstanding loan balances, and matured loans refinanced with lower interest rates.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Finance expenses

   $ 165      $ 230      $ 65        39.4

Finance expenses increased by $65 million, or 39.4%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. This increase was due to higher interest expense following a modification of one of our credit facilities and new financing.

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
     Change      % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

   $ 2      $ 2      $ 0        NM  

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates for the six months ended June 30, 2021 was consistent with the six months ended June 30, 2020.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

   $ 8      $ 4      $ (4     NM  

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates decreased by $4 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was due to the consolidation of our AMTC (as defined below) mask operations joint venture in Germany.

 

80


Table of Contents

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

   $ 7      $ 8      $ 1        13.9

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates increased by $1 million, or 13.9%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018.

Gain on Sale of a Fabrication Facility and ASIC Business

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change     % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Gain on sale of a fabrication facility and application specific integrated circuit business

   $ 615      $      $ (615     NM  

In 2019, we recorded a $197 million gain on sale of Fab 3E and a $418 million gain on the sale of our ASIC business.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Gain on Sale of a Fabrication Facility and ASIC Business

   $      $ 615      $ 615        NM  

As discussed above, we recorded gains in 2019 related to the sale of Fab 3E and our ASIC business.

Other Income (Expense), net

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Change     % Change  
     2020      2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other income (expense), net

   $ 395      $ (20   $ (415     NM  

Other income (expense), net decreased by $415 million for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This decrease was attributable to a $395 million gain related to a legal settlement and remeasurement of existing equity interests, as well as gains on the sale of tools in 2020.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2019      2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other income (expense), net

   $ 74      $ 440      $ 366        NM  

 

81


Table of Contents

Other income (expense), net increased by $366 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This increase was due to gains of $333 million related to a legal settlement and remeasurement of existing equity interests in 2020.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2018      2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Other income (expense), net

   $ 61      $ 74      $ 13        21.3

Other income (expense), net increased by $13 million, or 21.3%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018, due to a decrease in interest related to lease expenses.

Income tax benefit (Expense)

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2021 and June 30, 2020

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Change      % Change  
     2020     2021  
     (dollars in millions)  

Income tax benefit (expense)

   $ (36   $ (30   $ 6        16.6

Income tax expense decreased by $6 million, or 16.6%, for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to the six months ended June 30, 2020. This decrease was due to a $31 million decrease in withholding tax related to a legal settlement that occurred in 2020, partially offset by $22 million increase in income tax expense related to Singapore.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
     Change      % Change  
     2019     2020  
     (dollars in millions)  

Income tax benefit (expense)

   $ (224   $ 12      $ 236        NM  

We had an income tax benefit of $12 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to an income tax expense of $224 million for the year ended December 31, 2019. This change was due to the one-time 2019 deferred tax asset write-down of $190 million in Germany, and a one-time reduction in Singapore deferred tax liabilities of $64 million in 2020, after satisfying investment conditions necessary for an extension of a lower tax rate incentive during the year. This combined year-to-year expense reduction of $254 million was partially offset by a $33 million withholding tax expense on a negotiated lawsuit settlement in 2020.

Comparison of Year Ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
    Change     % Change  
     2018     2019  
     (dollars in millions)  

Income tax benefit (expense)

   $ (16   $ (224   $ (208     NM  

 

82


Table of Contents

Income tax (expense) increased by $208 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. This increase was due to a $190 million asset write-down by a German subsidiary associated with a change in transfer price approach.

Quarterly Financial Information

The following table sets forth, for the three-month periods indicated, selected financial data from our unaudited consolidated statements of operations, as well as non-IFRS metrics. The information for each of these quarters has been prepared on the same basis as the audited annual consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus and, in the opinion of management, includes all adjustments, which consist only of normal recurring adjustments, necessary for the fair presentation of the results of operations for these periods. This data should be read in conjunction with our annual consolidated financial statements and unaudited consolidated interim condensed financial statements, and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The results of historical periods are not necessarily indicative of the results in any future period and the results of a particular quarter or other interim period are not necessarily indicative of the results for a full year.

 

    Three Months Ended  
    March 31,
2020
    June 30,
2020
    September 30,
2020
    December 31,
2020
    March 31,
2021
    June 30,
2021
 
    (dollars in millions, except per share data)  

Net revenues(1)

  $ 1,379     $ 1,318     $ 1,091     $ 1,062     $ 1,418     $ 1,620  

Gross profit (loss)(2)

  $ (178   $ (183   $ (134   $ (218   $ 99     $ 231  

Share-based compensation

  $     $     $     $     $     $ 36  

Adjusted gross profit (loss)(3)

  $ (178   $ (183   $ (134   $ (218   $ 99     $ 267  

Loss from operations(2)

  $ (404   $ (411   $ (350   $ (491   $ (95   $ (103

Share-based compensation

  $     $ 1     $     $     $     $ 144  

Adjusted loss from operations(3)

  $ (404   $ (410   $ (350   $ (491   $ (95   $ 41  

Net loss from continuing operations(2)

  $ (297   $ (237   $ (293   $ (524   $ (127   $ (174

Share-based compensation

  $     $ 1     $     $     $     $ 144  

Adjusted net loss from continuing operations(3)

  $ (297   $ (236   $ (293   $ (524   $ (127   $ (30

Adjusted EBITDA(3)(4)

  $ 277     $ 258     $ 275     $ 166     $ 294     $ 466  

Net loss per share

  $ (0.59   $ (0.47   $ (0.58   $ (1.05   $ (0.25   $ (0.35

Adjusted loss per share(3)

  $ (0.59   $ (0.47   $ (0.58   $ (1.05   $ (0.26   $ (0.06

 

(1)

In 2020, the majority of our customer contractual terms were amended in a manner that resulted in moving from recognizing wafer revenue on a Percentage-of-Completion basis to recognizing revenue on a Wafer Shipment basis. This resulted in a one-time, non-recurring reduction in net revenues recognized in 2020. Had the change in terms not occurred, net revenues for the periods ended September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2020 would have been an estimated $309 million and $501 million higher than reported results, respectively.

 

(2)

The change in customer contract terms and associated revenue recognition also had an impact on adjusted EBITDA, adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, and adjusted net loss from continuing operations for the periods ended September 30, 2020 and December 31, 2020, estimated to be $10 million and $166 million, respectively.

 

(3)

See “Key Financial and Operating Metrics—Non-IFRS Financial Metrics” above for definitions of these metrics. Adjusted gross profit (loss), adjusted loss from operations, adjusted EBITDA, adjusted net loss from continuing operations, and adjusted loss per share are Non-IFRS metrics.

 

(4)

The following table presents a reconciliation of net loss from continuing operations to adjusted EBITDA:

 

83


Table of Contents
    Three Months Ended  
    March 31,
2020
    June 30,
2020
    September 30,
2020
    December 31,
2020
    March 31,
2021
    June 30,
2021
 
    (dollars in millions)  

Net loss from continuing operations

  $ (297   $ (237   $ (293   $ (524   $ (127   $ (174

Adjustments to net loss from continuing operations:

           

Depreciation and amortization

  $ 642     $ 643     $ 612     $ 626     $ 377     $ 408  

Finance expense

  $ 39     $ 43     $ 34     $ 38     $ 29     $ 29  

Provision for income taxes

  $     $ 36     $ (56   $ 8     $ 10     $ 20  

Share-based compensation

  $     $ 1     $     $     $     $ 144  

Restructuring and corporate severance programs

  $ 3     $     $ 2     $ 11     $ 5     $ 5  

(Gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses(1)

  $ (110   $ (228   $ (24   $ 7     $     $ 34  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

  $ 277     $ 258     $ 275     $ 166     $ 294     $ 466  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

See “Summary Consolidated Financial Data” for composition of (Gain) on transactions, legal settlements and transaction expenses.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

We have financed operations primarily through cash generated from our business operations, debt and government funding. As of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, our principal source of liquidity was our cash balance of $908 million and $805 million, respectively, as well as an undrawn $398 million revolving credit facility, which is subject to the RCF Upsize following completion of this offering. See “Recent Developments—Revolving Credit Facility.” We believe that our operating cash flow, cash balance, revolving credit facilities and proceeds of this offering will be sufficient to support working capital and capital expenditure requirements for at least the next 12 months. We also have a $400 million revolving credit facility which was made available to us by Mubadala, which we intend to terminate subject to the effectiveness of the RCF Upsize and the closing of this offering. In addition to our available revolvers, which were undrawn as of December 31, 2020, and June 30, 2021, we had $2,338 million and $2,176 million of debt outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively, which was primarily comprised of multiple term loans in various currencies.

The following table shows a summary of our term loan facilities, other debt facilities, which consist primarily of equipment financing and accounts receivable factoring, and our committed undrawn revolvers.

 

     As of December 31,      As of June 30,  
     2019      2020      2021  

Term loan facilities

   $ 1,838      $ 1,771      $ 1,691  

Other debt facilities

   $ 891      $ 566      $ 485  

Revolvers

   $ 639      $ 803      $ 807  

See Note 23 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 17 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for additional details, including in respect of the loan agreement we entered into on September 3, 2021, which provides for loan facilities with maximum drawdown of SGD1,541 million (US$1,149 million) at fixed interest rates.

Additionally, we entered into the Shareholder Loans. The Shareholder Loans were non-interest bearing and principal repayment, in whole or in part, was entirely at our discretion. The Shareholder Loans had no maturity date. Further, there were no contingent settlements in the agreements. Since the Shareholder Loans did not contain any contractual obligations to deliver cash, but rather allowed us to make repayment at our absolute discretion and further prohibited Mubadala from demanding repayment, we classified the Shareholder Loans as equity within the consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, we had $10,681 million and $10,555 million of Shareholder Loans, respectively. On October 1, 2021, our board approved the Conversion, and on October 3, 2021, we executed the Conversion. The Conversion did not have an impact on shares outstanding or have any dilutive effects, as no additional shares were issued.

 

84


Table of Contents

We also rely on government grants as a key capital resource. Those grants are primarily provided in connection with construction and operation of our wafer manufacturing facilities, employment and R&D. For the years ended December 31, 2019, 2020 and six months ended June 30, 2021, we received $335 million, $312 million and $51 million, respectively, in proceeds from government grants.

We monitor capital using a gearing ratio, which is net debt divided by total capital plus net debt. Our policy is to keep the gearing ratio within a range to meet our business needs. Our future capital requirements will depend on many factors, including our revenue growth rate, the timing and the amount of cash received from customers, the timing and extent of spending to support development efforts, the introduction of new and enhanced products and solutions, and the continuing market adoption of our platform. We may from time to time seek to raise additional capital to support our growth. Any equity financing we may undertake could be dilutive to our shareholders, and any additional debt financing we may undertake could require debt services and financial and operational requirements that could adversely affect our business. We cannot provide any assurance that we would be able to obtain future financing on favorable terms or at all.

Cash Flows

The following table shows a summary of our cash flows for the periods presented:

 

     Years Ended December 31,     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2018     2019     2020       2020         2021    
     (in millions)              

Cash provided by operating activities

   $ 279     $ 497     $ 1,006     $ 539     $ 582  

Cash provided by (used in) investing activities

     (1,167     344       (366     (166     (462

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     1,132       (684     (733     (99     (224
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (1     (4     4       (3     1  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

   $ 243     $ 153     $ (89   $ 271     $ (103
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating Activities

Cash provided by operating activities for the six months ended June 30, 2021 of $582 million primarily related to our net loss of $301 million, adjusted for $785 million of depreciation and amortization of intangible assets. Other drivers for the period relate to $144 million of share-based compensation expense and associated payroll taxes, and $33 million of deferred income taxes, offset by $16 million amortization of government grants and an $11 million gain on sale of property, plant equipment. Changes in assets and liabilities were $39 million, which included a $246 million increase in receivables, prepayments and other assets and an $86 million increase in inventory, which was offset by a $290 million increase in trade and other payables and a $3 million increase in income tax payable.

Cash provided by operating activities for the six months ended June 30, 2020 of $539 million primarily related to our net loss of $534 million, adjusted for $1,285 million of depreciation and amortization of intangible assets. Other drivers for the period relate to a decrease related to a $45 million gain on sale of plant equipment, $38 million gain on remeasurement of existing equity interests and $27 million amortization of government grants. Changes in assets and liabilities were $64 million, which included a $137 million decrease in receivables, prepayments and other assets and a $224 million decrease in trade and other payables.

Cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2020 of $1,006 million primarily related to our net loss of $1,351 million, adjusted for $2,523 million of depreciation and amortization of intangible assets. Other drivers for the period relate to $154 million of finance expenses, offset by a decrease related to a $79 million gain on sale of plant equipment, and $51 million amortization of government grants.

 

85


Table of Contents

Changes in assets and liabilities were $59 million, which included a decrease in receivables, prepayments and other assets of $753 million and an increase of $21 million of income tax payable, offset by a $560 million increase in inventory and $155 million decrease in trade and other payables. The changes in inventory and prepayments and receivables, prepayments and other assets are primarily driven by impacts related to the change in method of revenue recognition from Percentage-of-Completion basis to Wafer Shipment basis.

Cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2019 of $497 million primarily related to our net loss of $1,371 million, adjusted for $2,678 million of depreciation and amortization of intangible assets. The main drivers of the cash provided by operating activities relate to a $615 million gain on transaction-related proceeds primarily consisting of sale of our ASIC business and Fab 3E facility in Singapore as well as changes in working capital, which primarily related to a $144 million increase in receivables, prepayments and other assets, and decrease in trade and other payables of $97 million.

Cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2018 of $279 million primarily related to our net loss of $2,774 million, adjusted for $2,948 million of depreciation and amortization of intangible assets and $582 million of impairment charges related to our underutilized fabrication tools resulting from our strategic shift. This was offset by $180 million increase in amortization of deferred income from government grants, as well as changes in working capital, including a $188 million increase in receivables, prepayments and other assets, a $69 million decrease in trade and other payables, and $168 million increase in deferred revenue relating to technology cooperation agreements.

Investing Activities

Cash used in investing activities was $462 million for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to $166 million of cash used in investing activities for the six months ended June 30, 2020, reflecting a $296 million increase. This increase was primarily driven by a $458 million increase in capital expenditures and was offset by $170 million increase in advances and proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets, including $15 million of advances and proceeds from the sale of a fabrication facility and the ASIC business.

Cash used in investing activities was $366 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to $344 million of cash provided by investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2019, reflecting a decrease of $710 million year-over-year. This is primarily attributable to lower capital expenditures of $181 million (2020 capital expenditures of $592 million and 2019 capital expenditures of $773 million) offset by lower proceeds of $865 million from transaction-related activities and asset sales.

Cash provided by investing activities was $343 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to $1,167 million cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2018. The year-over-year change is primarily attributable to lower spending on capital expenditures of $556 million (2019 capital expenditures of $773 million and 2018 capital expenditures of $1,329 million) and $833 million of proceeds from transaction-related activities in 2019.

Capital Expenditures

We define capital expenditures as purchases of property, plant, and equipment and purchases of intangible assets. Capital expenditures were $725 million for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to $267 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020, reflecting a $458 million increase. This increase was primarily driven by factory capacity expansion to support increased customer demand related to long-term agreements.

Capital expenditures were $592 million for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to $773 million for the year ended December 31, 2019. Capital expenditures decreased by $181 million, or 23.4%, for the year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the year ended December 31, 2019. This decrease was primarily driven by increased management focus on capital expenditure efficiency and completion of factory construction costs related to our new Malta fab facility in the year ended December 31, 2019.

 

86


Table of Contents

Capital expenditures were $773 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to $1,329 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. Capital expenditures decreased by $556 million, or 41.8%, for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to the year ended December 31, 2018. The decrease was primarily attributable to reduction in factory construction costs and reduction in 7nm investments as a result of our 2018 strategic pivot.

Financing Activities

Cash used in financing activities was $224 million for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to $99 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020. This change was primarily attributable to a $336 million decrease in repayments of loans and borrowings from our shareholder, and a $225 million reduction of debt and lease obligation payments, and a $54 million decrease in net accounts receivable financing. This was offset by a $586 million decrease in proceeds from borrowings and a $193 million decrease in proceeds from government grants. The $586 million decrease in proceeds from borrowings was partially attributable to a $235 million draw down on a revolving credit facility in 2020 to safeguard available liquidity due to the COVID-19 pandemic. We repaid the $235 million in July 2020.

Cash used in financing activities was higher by $49 million for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2020, compared to the same period in 2019. This change was primarily due to the refinancing of existing debt obligations.

Cash used in financing activities was $684 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, compared to $1,132 million of cash provided by financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2018. This change was primarily due to repayment of debt obligations in 2019 as well as a return of capital and repayment of near-term debt to Mubadala, totaling approximately $650 million.

Contractual Obligations

As of December 31, 2020, we had $1,997 million of unconditional purchase commitments, $952 million of which related to contracts for capital expenditures, and $1,045 million of contracts related to operating expenditures. Of the total balance as of December 31, 2020, $1,316 million is due within the next 12 months. As of June 30, 2021, we had $4,704 million of unconditional purchase commitments, $1,655 million of which related to contracts for capital expenditures, and $3,048 million of contracts related to operating expenditures. Of the total balance as of June 30, 2021, $2,032 million is due within the next 12 months. See Note 30 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 14 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for additional details.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

During the periods presented, we did not have, and we do not currently have, any off-balance sheet financing arrangements or any relationships with unconsolidated entities or financial partnerships, including entities sometimes referred to as structured finance or special purpose entities, that were established for the purpose of facilitating off-balance sheet arrangements or other contractually narrow or limited purposes.

Qualitative and Quantitative Disclosures about Market Risk

We are exposed to market risks in the ordinary course of our business. Market risk represents the risk of loss that may impact our financial position due to adverse changes in financial market prices and rates. Our market risk exposure is primarily the result of fluctuations in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates. See Note 34 to our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for additional details.

Interest Rate Risk

Our exposure to market risk for changes in interest rates relates primarily to interest-earning financial assets and interest-bearing financial liabilities. Our interest-earning financial assets are mostly highly liquid investments

 

87


Table of Contents

and consist of primarily money market funds and time deposits. As these financial assets are mainly short-term in nature, our exposure to mark-to-market risk is limited. Our interest-bearing financial liabilities include fixed and floating rate loans and lease obligations. Floating rate loans bear interest at base rate or LIBOR or Euro Interbank Offered Rate (“EURIBOR”) plus a premium, which is fixed. We use pay-fixed / receive-float interest rate swaps to protect against adverse fluctuations in interest rates and to reduce our exposure to variability in cash flows on our forecasted floating-rate debt facility to the extent that it is practicable and cost-effective to do so. As of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, a hypothetical 1,000 basis point change in interest rates would not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

Foreign Currency Exchange Risk

As a result of foreign operations, we have costs, assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies, primarily the euro, the Singapore dollar and the Japanese yen. Therefore, movements in exchange rates could cause foreign currency-denominated expenses to increase as a percentage of net revenues, which are denominated in U.S. dollars, affecting profitability and cash flows. We use foreign currency forward contracts to reduce exposure to foreign currency fluctuations. We also incur a certain portion of our interest expense in euro, exposing us to exchange rate fluctuations between U.S. dollar and euro. We use cross currency swaps to reduce our exposure to variability from foreign exchange impacting cash flows arising from our foreign currency-denominated debt cash flows to the extent that it is practicable and cost effective to do so. As of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, we do not believe that a hypothetical 1,000 basis point increase or decrease in the relative value of the U.S. dollar to currencies other than the euro would have a material effect on our operating results.

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus are prepared in accordance with IFRS. The preparation of consolidated financial statements also requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenue, costs and expenses, and related disclosures. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ significantly from the estimates made by management. To the extent that there are differences between our estimates and actual results, our future financial statement presentation, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows will be affected.

We believe that the accounting policies described below involve a greater degree of judgment and complexity. Accordingly, these are the policies we believe are the most critical to aid in fully understanding and evaluating our consolidated financial condition and results of operations.

Revenue Recognition

We recognize revenue when control of the promised goods or services is transferred to customers for an amount that reflects the consideration that we expect to receive in exchange for those goods or services. Generally, our customers obtain control at the point of shipment from our facilities for wafers, and over time for pre-fabrication services such as non-recurring engineering services and mask production based on a percentage of costs incurred over total expected costs. Sales taxes collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are accounted for on a net basis and therefore excluded from revenues in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Prior to 2021, we concluded that we met the criteria to recognize revenue for wafers over time upon the initial application of IFRS 15, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers” in 2018, on the basis that we fabricated customized wafers to customers’ specifications and had contractual enforceable right to payment including a reasonable profit (due to the existence of cancellation clauses for each arrangement). Thus, we previously recognized wafer revenue over time during the manufacturing process, based on a percentage of wafer costs

 

88


Table of Contents

incurred over total expected wafer costs (“Percentage-of-Completion basis”). Cost of revenues was recognized in the same period as related revenue. During the year ended December 31, 2020, we modified the cancellation terms of our contracts with customers that are applicable to wafer products. As a result, we no longer met the criteria to account for revenue recognition from contracts with customers over time on the outstanding purchase orders at the contract modification date, and future orders thereafter. Consequently, we now recognize revenue on the impacted outstanding wafers orders and future orders at the point at which control of the wafers is transferred to the customer, which we determined to be at the point of wafer shipment from our facilities (“Wafer Shipment basis”). Cost of revenues is recognized at the same time as related revenue, at the point of shipment. Prior to the point of shipment, inventories are increased to reflect costs incurred.

We recognize revenue at transaction prices that we determine using contractual prices reduced by sales returns and allowances, which we estimate based on historical experience having determined that a significant reversal in the amount of cumulative revenue recognized is not probable to occur. We recognize refund liabilities for estimated sales returns and allowances based on the customer complaints, historical experience and other known factors.

We recognize accounts receivable when we transfer control of the goods or services to customers and have a right to an amount of consideration that is unconditional. Such accounts receivable are short term and do not contain a significant financing component. For certain contracts that do not provide us unconditional rights to the consideration, and the transfer of controls of the goods or services has been satisfied, we recognize contract assets and revenue.

We account for consideration received from customers prior to having satisfied our performance obligations as contract liabilities which are transferred to revenue after the performance obligations are satisfied. We recognize costs to fulfill a contract when the costs relate directly to the contract, generate or enhance resources to be used to satisfy performance obligations in the future, and are expected to be recovered. We recognize the costs and revenue when we satisfy our performance obligations to customers upon transfer of control of promised goods and services.

Inventory Valuation

As a build-to-order foundry, we procure raw materials based on forecasted demand and produce work-in-progress and finished goods inventory against specific customer purchase orders. We state inventories at the lower of cost or net realizable value for finished goods, work-in-progress, raw materials, and spare parts. We make inventory write-downs on an item-by-item basis, except where it may be appropriate to group similar or related items.

A significant amount of our manufacturing cost is fixed because our global footprint of manufacturing facilities that are the source of our production capacity require substantial investment for construction and fit up. These are largely fixed-cost assets once they become operational. Utilization of these assets can have a material impact on product cost of revenues and inventory valuations. Our objectives for inventory are to maintain high levels of customer service, maintain stable and competitive lead times, minimize inventory obsolescence and optimize manufacturing asset utilization.

We value work-in-process and finished goods product cost based on a standard costing approach. We base standard cost on the planned utilization of installed factory capacity and adjust it annually as factory capacity conditions change and cost efficiencies are realized. We make allowances for saleability quarterly based on the aging characteristics of our inventory. Additionally, we make allowances where necessary to ensure saleable inventory is valued at a realizable value based on customer pricing agreements.

Realization of Deferred Income Tax Assets

When we have temporary differences in the amount of tax expenses recorded for tax purposes and financial reporting purposes, we may be able to reduce the amount of tax that we would otherwise be required to pay in

 

89


Table of Contents

future periods. We generally recognize deferred tax assets to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable income will be available in the future to utilize such assets. We record the income tax benefit or expense when there is a net change in our total deferred tax assets and liabilities in a period. The ultimate realization of the deferred tax assets depends upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which the temporary differences may be utilized. Specifically, the realization of deferred income tax assets is impacted by our expected future revenue growth and profitability, tax holidays and the amount of tax credits that can be utilized within the statutory period. In determining the amount of deferred tax assets as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, we considered past performance, the general outlook of the semiconductor industry, business conditions, future taxable income and prudent and feasible tax planning strategies.

Because the determination of the amount of deferred tax assets that can be realized is based, in part, on our forecast of future profitability, it is inherently uncertain and subjective. Changes in market conditions and our assumptions may cause the actual future profitability to differ materially from our current expectation, which may require us to increase or decrease the deferred tax assets that we have recorded. As of December 31, 2018, 2019, 2020 and June 30, 2021, deferred tax assets were $627 million, $408 million, $444 million and $419 million, respectively.

Property, Plant and Equipment

We make estimates and assumptions when accounting for property, plant and equipment. We compute depreciation using the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of the assets, and our depreciation expense is highly dependent on the assumptions we make about the estimated useful life of our assets. We estimate the useful life of our property, plant and equipment based on our experience with similar assets and our estimate of the usage of the asset. Whenever events or circumstances occur that change the estimated useful life of an asset, we account for the change prospectively. We must also make judgments about the capitalization of costs. We capitalize costs of major improvements, while we charge costs of normal repairs and maintenance to expense as incurred. If an asset or asset group is disposed or retired before the end of its previously estimated useful life, we may be required to accelerate our depreciation expense or recognize a loss on disposal.

During the first quarter of 2021, we revised the estimated useful life of certain production equipment and machinery from a range of five to eight years, to ten years. We made this change to better reflect the expected pattern of economic benefits from the use of the equipment and machinery over time, based on an analysis of production equipment’s current use, historical age patterns, and future plans and technology roadmaps, as well as an analysis of industry trends and practices. The analysis concluded that an increase in useful lives was warranted, and consistent with the Company’s continuing portfolio shift from leading-edge to feature-rich trailing edge technologies. The change in estimated useful life is a change in accounting estimate that was applied prospectively from January 1, 2021.

Share-Based Payment

We measure and recognize compensation expense related to share-based transactions, including employee, consultant, and non-employee director share option awards, in the consolidated financial statements based on fair value. We estimate the date that an initial public offering (“IPO”) is probable based on facts and circumstances that indicate there is a greater than 50% likelihood that an IPO will occur, at which point compensation expense is recognized for options that have vested as of the IPO probable date. We deemed an IPO to be probable on June 30, 2021, and recognized share-based compensation expense of $144 million, inclusive of $3 million of associated taxes, based on the graded vesting of the awards outstanding as of the IPO probable date. For any awards that do not have an IPO vesting condition, we will recognize the expense in accordance with the terms of individual agreements. We estimate the share option fair value at the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model, which requires management to make certain assumptions of future expectations based on historical and current data. The assumptions include the expected term of the share option, expected volatility,

 

90


Table of Contents

dividend yield, and risk-free interest rate. The expected term represents the amount of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding, based on forecasted exercise behavior. The risk-free rate is based on the rate at grant date of zero-coupon U.S. Treasury notes with a term comparable to the expected term of the option. We estimate expected volatility based on the historical volatility of comparable public entities’ share price from the same industry. We base our dividend yield on forecasted expected payments, which we expect to be zero for the immediate future. We recognize compensation expense over the vesting period of the award on a graded attribution basis, and we estimate forfeitures.

We will continue to use judgment in evaluating the assumptions related to our share-based compensation on a prospective basis. As we continue to accumulate additional data related to our ordinary shares, we may have refinements to our estimates, which could materially impact our future share-based compensation expense.

See Note 33 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 16 to our interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for more information.

Ordinary Shares Valuations

The fair value of the ordinary shares underlying our share-based awards has been determined by our board of directors, with input from management and third-party valuations. We believe that our board of directors has the relevant experience and expertise to determine the fair value of our ordinary shares. Given the absence of a public trading market of our ordinary shares, and in accordance with the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Practice Aid, Valuation of Privately-Held Company Equity Securities Issued as Compensation, our board of directors exercised reasonable judgment and considered numerous objective and subjective factors to determine the best estimate of the fair value of our ordinary shares at each grant date. These factors include:

 

   

valuations of our ordinary shares performed by independent third-party specialists;

 

   

lack of marketability of our ordinary shares;

 

   

our actual operating and financial performance;

 

   

current business conditions and projections;

 

   

likelihood of achieving a liquidity event, such as an IPO or a merger or acquisition of our company given prevailing market conditions;

 

   

the market performance of comparable publicly traded companies; and

 

   

the U.S. and global capital market conditions.

In valuing our ordinary shares, our board of directors determined the equity value of our business using various valuation methods including combinations of income and market approaches with input from management. The income approach estimates value based on the expectation of future cash flows that a company will generate. These future cash flows are discounted to their present values using a discount rate derived from an analysis of the cost of capital of comparable publicly traded companies in our industry or similar business operations as of each valuation date and is adjusted to reflect the risks inherent in our cash flows.

Application of these approaches involves the use of estimates, judgment, and assumptions that are highly complex and subjective, such as those regarding our expected future revenue, expenses, and future cash flows, discount rates, market multiples, the selection of comparable companies, and the probability of possible future events. Changes in any or all of these estimates and assumptions or the relationships between those assumptions impact our valuations as of each valuation date and may have a material impact on the valuation of our ordinary shares.

 

91


Table of Contents

For valuations after the completion of this offering, our board of directors will determine the fair value of each share of underlying ordinary shares based on the closing price of our ordinary shares as reported on the date of grant. Future expense amounts for any particular period could be affected by changes in our assumptions or market conditions.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

See Note 3 to our annual consolidated financial statements and Note 2 to or interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 

92


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

Overview

We are one of the world’s leading semiconductor foundries. We manufacture complex, feature-rich ICs that enable billions of electronic devices that are pervasive throughout nearly every sector of the global economy. With our specialized foundry manufacturing processes, a library consisting of thousands of IP titles, and differentiated transistor and device technology, we serve a broad range of customers, including the global leaders in IC design, and provide optimized solutions for the function, performance and power requirements of critical applications driving key secular growth end markets. As the only scaled pure-play foundry with a global footprint that is not based in China or Taiwan, we help customers mitigate geopolitical risk and provide greater supply chain certainty.

Technology megatrends including IoT, 5G, cloud, AI and next-generation automotive are reshaping the global economy and driving a new golden age for semiconductors—a market that is expected to grow to more than $1 trillion by the end of this decade, from close to $0.5 trillion in 2021, according to VLSI Research. Semiconductors have become ubiquitous, powering a broad range of applications from consumer devices to enterprise and industrial applications. Semiconductor innovation is essential to the growth and development of many parts of the technology ecosystem. For example, semiconductors are expected to drive the software and AI revolution by enabling data collection, transmission and processing at an unprecedented scale. In 2020, the world generated 64 zettabytes of data. According to IDC, global data creation and replication will grow at a 23% CAGR from 2020 to 2025. Semiconductors are also revolutionizing how this data is transmitted, with 5G expected to deliver 500 times the bandwidth and more than 10 times lower latency than the 3G networks that supported the first generation of iPhones just 14 years ago. Finally, this technology revolution is expected to fully penetrate automobiles with the accelerating adoption of electric and hybrid vehicles. Electric vehicle penetration, consisting of hybrid-full, hybrid-mild and battery electric vehicle propulsion systems, is expected to increase from 19% in 2021 to 55% in 2027, according to IHS Markit from July 2021. Semiconductor innovation is also essential for many industrial applications. As the manufacturing backbone of the semiconductor industry, foundries are the bedrock of the global technology ecosystem, and, by extension, the world economy. Foundries such as GF drive innovation by providing advances in process technologies, materials science and IC design IP within the global supply chain to enable customers to develop ICs, accelerate time-to-market and offer value-added services.

We provide differentiated foundry solutions that enable the era for data-centric, connected, intelligent and secure technologies. We are redefining the foundry model with feature-rich solutions that enable our customers to develop innovative products for an increasingly wide variety of applications across broad and pervasive markets. We unlock value for our customers by helping drive technology in multiple dimensions, making their products more intelligent and intuitive, more connected and secure, and more powerful and energy-efficient. Our objective is to be the global leader in feature-rich semiconductor manufacturing—the foundry of choice for the pervasive semiconductor market. We have a large and growing market opportunity with an estimated SAM of $54 billion in 2020, which reflects the sum of all foundry revenues excluding memory and revenues from <12nm wafers, as estimated by Gartner. Our SAM is supported by significant opportunities in our core markets of Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing.

Since our founding in 2009, we have invested over $23 billion in our company to build a global manufacturing footprint with multiple state-of-the-art facilities across three continents, offering customers the flexibility and security their supply chains require. As semiconductor technologies become more complex with advanced integration requirements, we are also able to offer comprehensive, state-of-the-art design solutions and services that provide our customers with a high-quality, cost-effective and faster path to market. We have over 50 ecosystem partners spanning IP, electronic design automation, outsourced assembly and test and design services. Building on an existing library of more than 4,000 IP titles, we currently have more than 950 IP titles in active development across 26 process nodes and 34 IP partners.

 

93


Table of Contents

We focus on feature-rich devices that include digital, analog, mixed-signal, RF, ultra-low power and embedded memory solutions that connect, secure and process data, and efficiently power the digital world around us. As the semiconductor and technology industries become more complex, we expect to become an even more vital partner to fabless semiconductor design companies, IDMs and OEMs, bringing their designs to life in physical hardware. Our core technology portfolio includes a range of differentiated technology platforms, including our industry-leading RF SOI solutions, advanced high-performance FinFET, feature-rich CMOS, our proprietary FDXTM, high-performance SiGe products and SiPh, all of which can be purposely engineered, innovated and designed for a broad set of demanding applications. Customers depend on us for feature-rich solutions based on these differentiated technologies in a growing number of applications that require low power, real-time connectivity and on-board intelligence.

The combination of our highly-differentiated technology and our scaled manufacturing footprint enables us to attract a large share of single-sourced products and long-term supply agreements, providing a high degree of revenue visibility and significant operating leverage, resulting in improved financial performance and bottom line growth. As of the date of this prospectus, the aggregate lifetime revenue commitment reflected by these agreements amounted to approximately $20 billion, including more than $10 billion during the period from 2022 through 2023 and more than $2.5 billion in advanced payments and capacity reservation fees. These agreements include binding, multi-year, reciprocal annual (and, in some cases, quarterly) minimum purchase and supply commitments with wafer pricing and associated mechanics outlined for the contract term. Through an intense focus on collaboration, we have built deep strategic partnerships with a broad base of more than 200 customers as of December 31, 2020, many of whom are the global leaders in their field. In the first six months of 2021, our top ten customers, based on wafer shipment volume, included some of the largest semiconductor companies in the world: Qualcomm, MediaTek, NXP, Qorvo, Cirrus Logic, AMD, Skyworks, Murata, Samsung and Broadcom. A key measure of our position as a strategic partner to our customers is the mix of our wafer shipment volume attributable to single-sourced business, which represented approximately 61% of wafer shipment volume in 2020, up from 47% in 2018. We define single-sourced products as those that we believe can only be manufactured with our technology and cannot be manufactured elsewhere without significant customer redesigns. Approximately 80% of our more than 350 design wins in 2020 were for single-sourced business, a record-breaking year in terms of number of design wins, up from 69% in 2018. We define a design win as the successful completion of the evaluation stage, where a customer has assessed our technology solution, verified that it meets its requirements, qualified it for their products and confirmed to us their selection.

In addition to our highly-differentiated technology platforms, our capital-efficient, scaled manufacturing footprint spanning three continents gives us the flexibility and agility to meet the dynamic needs of our customers around the globe, help them mitigate geopolitical risk and provide greater supply chain certainty. We are also one of the most advanced accredited foundry providers to the DoD and have the ability to extend this high-assurance model to serve commercial customers and to enhance supply chain security and resilience at a time when they are becoming more critical to national and economic security. Since foundry production is concentrated in China and Taiwan, we believe our global manufacturing footprint is a key differentiator that makes us the ideal partner for local and regional government stakeholders at a time when many regions, in particular the United States and Europe, are contemplating significant funding to secure and grow domestic semiconductor manufacturing capabilities.

Industry Background

Technology Megatrends Are Reshaping the Global Economy

The global economy’s dependency on technology is greater today than ever before. Consumer devices played a significant role in technological advances over the last decade, triggering a wave of innovation in design and manufacturing, as evidenced by the evolution of the smartphone since the introduction of the iPhone in 2007. The number of connected devices worldwide increased from 13.3 billion in 2015 to 21.6 billion in 2020, according to IoT Analytics. The latest generations of smartphone devices have integrated and improved the

 

94


Table of Contents

functionality of dozens of applications, including GPS, camera, camcorder, music player, recorder, measuring devices, remote controller, car keys and credit cards, which in turn has spawned increased innovation in myriad electronic devices across numerous markets. At the same time, these devices have been increasingly coupled with companion devices such as smart watches, Bluetooth headphones, location tags and more, collectively driving a significant acceleration of consumer spending on personal technology. The value of wearable device shipments grew 28% from $52 billion in 2019 to $67 billion in 2020, according to IDC. These devices, in-turn, have driven a massive increase in the demand for and creation of data and content, which has prompted innovation in wireless and wired communication infrastructure in homes, workplaces, factories and the cellular and satellite-based networks that enable them.

Several megatrends including IoT, 5G, cloud, AI and next-generation automotive are poised to lead the next decade of technology advances, redefining how we use electronic devices to live, work and interact as a global society. Mobility continues to drive digital transformation throughout the global economy and enhanced connectivity continues to transform the way we communicate and share data, fueling a new era of widespread machine-to-machine communication around the world. Next-generation automotive capabilities, which we expect to further expand as adoption of electric and autonomous vehicles accelerates, are driving industry implementation of sophisticated safety systems, including sensors, advanced connectivity and analytics capabilities. Additionally, embedded AI functionality and the move to edge AI are bringing data storage and computation closer to the end devices, increasing the need for high speed, high bandwidth connectivity, combined with efficient power management and security.

These megatrends are reshaping nearly every industry in the global economy and rely on advances in semiconductor technology across multiple innovation vectors.

A New Golden Age for Semiconductors

Semiconductors are the core building blocks of electronic devices and systems, including those used in mobile devices, automobiles, consumer electronics, wearables, smart home devices, 5G wireless infrastructure, robotics, PCs, cloud computing, data networking and others. Historically, semiconductor innovation was driven by a few select compute-centric applications – initially PCs and later the internet and mobile phones. Mobile devices have evolved from a convenient communication appliance to a feature-rich, always-connected device, enabling users to do and control nearly everything in their lives. This has driven significant growth in semiconductor demand. According to Gartner, mobile phone semiconductor revenue in 2021 is expected to increase by approximately 16% from 2020, which is primarily attributable to the shift from 4G to 5G phones. Similarly, the use of semiconductors in automobiles is expected to dramatically increase from 2015 to 2025 as innovation in driver safety, electrical vehicles and infotainment applications increase. With continued development of new features such as augmented reality (“AR”), advanced audio and video communication and requirements for more powerful and multi-protocol connectivity (e.g., 5G mmWave cellular, Wi-Fi, Bluetooth, Near-Field Communication (“NFC”), Ultra-Wideband (“UWB”) and others) advancement in feature-rich semiconductor content will be needed to continue to satisfy consumer requirements. For example, we expect a continued focus on power efficiency to improve battery life, improved sensors to enable facial recognition in all light environments and 3D sensing, all of which will increasingly rely on differentiated semiconductor solutions.

Another significant driver of semiconductor demand has been, and we believe will continue to be, the tremendous growth in the deployment of intelligent software which is increasingly transforming a wide variety of business functions across all sectors. Semiconductors enable the functionality that software delivers. With wide-scale adoption of mobile devices and software solutions, society has grown to expect high-speed connectivity, convenience and security in all applications, providing a catalyst for increased semiconductor content in nearly every industry. These trends were accelerated by the COVID-19 pandemic, which emphasized the criticality of connectivity to allow the world to continue to work, communicate, educate, and deliver goods and services. For example, e-commerce accelerated dramatically in the United States in 2020, growing almost as much in the first two quarters of the year (more than 5% of total retail sales) as it had in the previous 10 years (more than 6% from

 

95


Table of Contents

2009 to 2019), according to the U.S. Census Bureau. We believe that accelerated adoption of technologies such as video conferencing, telemedicine, e-education and e-commerce will serve to drive increased requirements for these technologies going forward.

Semiconductors are enabling the transformation of other sectors of the economy as well. According to IHS Markit from July 2021, total semiconductor shipments for the automotive industry are expected to more than double between 2016 and 2026, driven by demand for advanced safety systems, battery management and other applications, such as infotainment, navigation, temperature control, RADAR, LiDAR and 5G connectivity. Semiconductor shipments for ADAS applications are expected to increase by more than 370% over the same time period, according to IHS Markit from July 2021. In particular, autonomous driving applications are driving a sharp increase in semiconductor sensors. Semiconductors are increasingly integral to the performance, safety and comfort of vehicles, and we believe the continued electrification of automobiles will only further accelerate this trend.

Semiconductors have become mission-critical to the functionality, safety, transformation and success of many industries in addition to the automotive industry. As a result, the diversification of semiconductor demand across a wide range of industries has made the sector more foundational and central to the broader economy and in turn less vulnerable to cyclicality.

Foundries Are the Bedrock of the Technology Ecosystem

Semiconductor manufacturing is now a critical part of the electronics value chain by providing the foundation for innovation by fabless semiconductor design companies and OEMs, enabling broad-ranging products addressing almost every commercial sector. As a result, access to manufacturing has become a supply chain, economic and, ultimately, a national security concern.

According to Gartner, the global electronics market generated approximately $2 trillion in annual revenue in 2020. Of that, the global semiconductor market represented $466 billion and the foundry market, excluding memory, represented approximately $74 billion. As a result of this increasing relevance, regions around the world are competing to increase domestic semiconductor manufacturing. According to Gartner, the overall semiconductor and foundry markets are expected to grow at 7.9% CAGR and 10.1% CAGR, respectively, from 2019 to 2025.

 

 

LOGO

 

96


Table of Contents

Prior to the 1980s, the semiconductor industry was vertically integrated and semiconductor companies owned and operated their own manufacturing facilities. The market demand for continued electronics innovation, combined with the technical and financial barriers to entry in manufacturing, led to the proliferation of fabless semiconductor companies that outsourced manufacturing to foundry players. Over time, foundries, with their continued process technology innovation, coupled with the proliferation of product-focused fabless semiconductor companies, have been the engines driving the growth of the $0.5 trillion semiconductor market in 2021.

It is increasingly difficult for IDMs to profitably scale manufacturing in-house, resulting in more outsourcing of manufacturing to foundries. In 2020, more than 33% of semiconductor manufacturing was outsourced to foundries, compared to approximately 9% in 2000, according to IC Insights. As manufacturing costs have continued to increase, only foundries have enough manufacturing volume to generate a return on the capital investment required, making outsourcing critical to any IDM’s strategy. Today, almost all of the remaining IDMs use foundry services for some of their products. Intel and Samsung are the only remaining digital logic IDMs with manufacturing capabilities for nodes smaller than 28nm, and we expect the trend of increased outsourcing of manufacturing to foundries to continue. Additionally, hyper-scalers such as Google, Amazon, Facebook and Microsoft, as well as Tier 1 automotive suppliers are increasingly developing their semiconductor design capabilities, broadening the role foundries play in the technology ecosystem. As evidence of the increasing importance of foundries, foundry market revenue growth has consistently exceeded, and is expected to continue to exceed, that of the broader semiconductor industry from 2019 to 2025.

Geopolitical Environment and Growing Importance of Supply Security

Over the past three decades, semiconductor manufacturing has shifted toward Asia. Since 1990, the share of global semiconductor manufacturing capacity produced in major commercial fabs using leading wafer sizes in the United States and Europe declined from 81% to 21% in 2020, according to BCG and SIA. Over the same period, production capacity in China and Taiwan increased from close to zero to 37% of total global capacity, driven in large part by significant local government subsidies and support.

 

 

LOGO

There are currently only five foundries of significant scale: GF, Samsung, SMIC, TSMC and UMC. Collectively, these five foundries accounted for the vast majority of worldwide foundry revenue in 2020,

 

97


Table of Contents

according to a March 2021 Gartner Semiconductor Foundry Worldwide Market Share report. More importantly, approximately 77% of foundry revenue in 2020 was from wafers manufactured in Taiwan or China, with SMIC, TSMC and UMC accounting for approximately 72% of foundry revenue in 2020. These trends have not only created trade imbalances and disputes, but have also exposed global supply chains to significant risks, including geopolitical risks. The U.S. and European governments are increasingly focused on developing a semiconductor supply chain that is less dependent on manufacturing based in Taiwan or China.

Recent regulatory and trade tensions between the United States and China have led to export controls, historically used sparingly to address national security concerns, being used to control the flow of critical technology. For example, over the past two years, the BIS placed one of the largest mobile handset and 5G infrastructure providers in the world, Huawei, and China’s largest semiconductor foundry, SMIC, on the BIS Entity List. The concentration of semiconductor production in countries such as Taiwan, a resource-constrained island susceptible to natural disasters and geopolitical tension, additionally exposes global supply chains to significant risk. Given the ubiquitous nature of semiconductor technology, these imbalances and associated risks are considered by countries to be a threat to economic and national security, with many industry experts equating the importance of semiconductor supply today to that of oil in the twentieth century.

The Global Semiconductor Supply Shortage

While technology megatrends have been driving increased semiconductor demand, the COVID-19 pandemic accelerated demand trends already underway, including remote work, learning and medicine, driving sustainable demand for electronic devices such as networking and infrastructure to maintain a distributed environment. As a result, demand has outstripped supply across most of the semiconductor industry. Meanwhile, other industries, such as the automotive sector, which were initially hard-hit by the pandemic, began to halt new purchases and depleted existing inventories of semiconductor chips. As some parts of the world have started to re-open, these impacted sectors have seen significant increases in new demand, which, when coupled with underlying megatrends not related to the COVID-19 pandemic, such as the electrification of vehicles, have resulted in a significant imbalance between demand and supply. Although the supply-demand imbalance is expected to improve over the medium-term, the semiconductor industry will require a significant increase in investment to keep up with demand, with total industry revenue expected to double over the next eight to ten years.

Government Incentives to Secure Supply

Against this backdrop, governments have been proposing bold new incentives to fund and secure their local semiconductor manufacturing industries. The United States Congress recently authorized the CHIPS Act, which, when funded as proposed by the United States Innovation and Competition Act, will provide for more than $52 billion in funding to the domestic semiconductor industry, with approximately two-thirds directed toward semiconductor manufacturing. In Europe, a program referred to as the IPCEI includes a large aid package to strengthen the EU’s semiconductor industry. These programs are designed to bring back share in the semiconductor industry to the United States and Europe by encouraging manufacturers such as GF to increase their local capacities in these regions.

Similarly, we believe that foundry customers are increasingly seeking to diversify and secure their semiconductor supply chains, and are looking for foundry partners with manufacturing footprints in Europe, the United States and Asia, outside of China and Taiwan. Fabless companies and IDMs increasingly view their foundry relations as highly strategic and are looking to secure long-term capacity contracts by paying to access capacity expansions at their foundry partners. This trend has the potential to help balance the geographical distribution of manufacturing and drive increased long-term visibility and profitability of the foundry industry.

 

98


Table of Contents

Evolution to Pervasive, Broadly Diversified End Markets

Historically, processor-centric compute was the foundation of the semiconductor industry, and technological innovation in end products was driven by an evolution to smaller feature sizes and greater processing capability per unit produced. This was appropriate when narrow application requirements were centered on raw processing power, and led to a cyclical industry predominantly focused on highly digital, compute-oriented verticals. Today, robust feature sets such as wireless connectivity, low power and thermal efficiency, human interfaces and security have become mission-critical to the functionality, safety, transformation, security and success of many industries. In addition, virtually all electronic systems require a combination of compute capability and features such as digital, analog, mixed-signal, RF and embedded memory to enable breakthrough functionality across wide-ranging end markets and applications. The ICs that serve these applications comprise the pervasive semiconductor market, consisting of feature-rich digital, analog and mixed-signal semiconductors. The market for, and manufacturing of, ICs for pervasive semiconductors is very different and less cyclical than the market for traditional processor-centric compute semiconductors, which have higher operating and capital costs and a narrower customer set.

Processor-centric compute semiconductors are primarily used for processing information and storing data. Their performance is generally evaluated by speed, density and overall power efficiency, where improvements and evolution have been defined by shrinking transistor size and increasing transistor density with each successive generation of process technology. This segment of the semiconductor industry has been governed by Moore’s Law, which forecasted a doubling of the number of transistors that could fit on a chip every 18 to 24 months. This focus has resulted in a trend in which feature size reduction is the most significant technological differentiator among processor-centric compute ICs. Foundries that manufacture processor-centric compute ICs need to produce them in higher volumes or at increasingly higher prices to support the substantial growth in capital expenditures necessary to continually improve processing capabilities. Substantial increases in manufacturing cost and complexity have made this segment of the market increasingly challenging to serve, resulting in shrinking application use cases.

The performance enhancements of moving to lower digital nodes often fail to offset the increasing cost and complexity of IC design at these lower nodes, which has become cost-prohibitive for many companies. Many sectors beyond processor-centric compute no longer need the latest digital logic devices, and even the processor-centric compute sector has started to design elements of their processors (referred to as chiplets) on ³12nm technologies to avoid these added costs. We believe there are only three foundries (GF, Samsung and TSMC) with at-scale production of complex FinFET technologies ³12nm. Samsung and TSMC are the only remaining foundries serving the market at lower nodes, which require capital investments of approximately $20 billion to ramp and scale a new fab, plus additional R&D expenses, to serve this additional, smaller portion of the overall market. All of this combined has further slowed down the advancement of Moore’s Law.

Unlike processor-centric compute semiconductors, digital, analog, mixed-signal and RF devices do not require single nanometer features. Mixed-signal devices embed both digital and analog circuitry onto a single IC, enabling digital processing of real-world occurrences on a single chip. Mixed-signal semiconductors are often developed using high levels of customization and tailored to the specific requirements of a particular end product. Production of these devices typically requires manufacturers that can accommodate a wide range of technologies and production processes that can be adapted to specific design requirements. Changes to the design can drive significant increases in engineering costs, which tends to support stickier relationships between foundries and their customers.

The pervasive semiconductor market represented 73% of the total semiconductor foundry market, as well as 33% of the total semiconductor foundry capital expenditure in 2020, according to the Gartner Forecast, Semiconductor Foundry Revenue Supply and Demand Worldwide 2Q21 Update, July 2021. The pervasive semiconductor market is driving breakthrough innovation across broad applications such as longer battery life for mobile devices, always-on access to connected devices, high data throughput for work from home, streaming, gaming and AR/VR, powerful sensing for safe and comfortable autonomous driving and embedded memory for secure cryptographic credentials. Unlike processor-centric compute devices, pervasive semiconductor performance is driven more by circuit design, specialty materials and specialized manufacturing processes.

 

99


Table of Contents

Innovation in pervasive ICs is measured in terms of precision, accuracy, bandwidth, efficiency and sensitivity. When combined with greater breadth and diversity of customers and end markets, these factors tend to result in more stable demand and pricing for pervasive semiconductors than processor-centric compute semiconductors. Additionally, capital expenditure requirements are generally significantly lower for manufacturers of pervasive semiconductors.

 

 

LOGO

Our Journey

History

Since our inception, we have grown through a combination of acquisitions, greenfield expansions and strategic partnerships. We were established in 2009 when a subsidiary of Mubadala acquired AMD’s manufacturing operations in Dresden, Germany, and a fab project site in Malta, New York. In 2010, we combined with Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing, the third-largest foundry by revenue at the time, forming the basis for our Singapore manufacturing hub. In 2015, we acquired IBM’s Microelectronics division with manufacturing facilities in New York and Vermont, adding distinctive technology capabilities, including more than 2,000 IBM engineers. By 2017, we had successfully ramped our most advanced manufacturing site in Malta, New York. Through our organic and strategic growth initiatives, we increased manufacturing capacity twelvefold from 2009 to 2020 and now have a global footprint with five manufacturing sites on three continents with approximately 15,000 employees and approximately 10,000 worldwide patents. In 2020, we shipped approximately 2 million 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers. With this level of market presence and capability, our technologies are found across most semiconductor end markets in devices used on a daily basis.

Strategic Repositioning

Beginning in 2018, we embarked on a new strategy to significantly reposition our business to better align with our customers’ needs, drive margin expansion and accelerate value creation for our stakeholders. Today, we focus on and are growing sales of foundry solutions for the pervasive semiconductor market, where we are trusted to reliably innovate and deliver premium performance, functionality, efficiency and quality, rather than focusing merely on transistor density and processing speed.

 

100


Table of Contents

Our Strategic Repositioning

 

 

LOGO

Key elements of our strategy include:

 

   

Focus on feature-rich solutions. In August 2018, we shifted our focus to address the pervasive foundry market opportunity and the growing demand for specialized process technologies in emerging high-growth markets. We accelerated our efforts to develop and commercialize feature-rich solutions including our advanced RF, FDXTM, SiGe, embedded memory, and other technology platforms, working hand-in-hand with our customers to tailor performance, features and the availability of foundational and complex IP blocks to support their requirements. We discontinued our R&D and capital-intensive focus on 7nm FinFET associated with processor-centric compute semiconductors and the pursuit of Moore’s Law scaling. While many of our competitors focus on a node-based strategy, we continue to focus on transitioning our revenues to a richer product mix and ramping higher-margin products, we expect significant benefits to our gross and operating profit margins.

 

   

Market-based customer engagement strategy. In order to better address and capture the pervasive semiconductor foundry market opportunity, we restructured our go-to-market organizations to better align with the growing opportunities in Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and Personal Computing. We supplemented our existing workforce with talented executives holding deep domain expertise in these growing markets. For the past several years, these executives, and their respective technology development teams, have helped refine and deliver relevant feature-rich solutions to our core end markets, helping to enable our customers to win in their respective markets. A key measure of our success as a differentiated technology partner is the mix of our revenue attributable to single-sourced business with such revenue increasing to approximately 61% of our wafer shipment volume in 2020, up from approximately 47% in 2018. Another key measure of our success is the willingness of our customers to engage with us in long-term partnerships. We have multiple long-term supply agreements with lifetime revenue commitments of approximately $20 billion. We believe that these deeper, more intimate, customer engagements make us unique in our industry and we also believe that our market-based engagement strategy enables us to deliver longer-lived solutions with better demand visibility and, ultimately, higher lifetime profitability.

 

   

Optimized portfolio. We took a number of steps to streamline and optimize our business and manufacturing footprint to improve our bottom line and return on capital. In 2019, we divested three assets that were not aligned with our strategic priorities. We sold our ASIC business, Avera Semiconductor, which had a single-digit node roadmap, to Marvell to focus on our core foundry strategy. We sold our Fab 3E facility in Tampines, Singapore to Vanguard, allowing us to consolidate

 

101


Table of Contents
 

our Singapore operations into one campus and focus our efforts on technologies where we have clear differentiation. Additionally, we agreed to transfer ownership of our sub-scale EFK facility to ON Semiconductor by the end of 2022, allowing us to refocus investment into differentiated technologies in our three world-scale 300mm sites in New York, Germany and Singapore.

 

   

Resized and refocused cost structure. We have realigned our engineering, sales and marketing organizations toward higher-margin, higher-return products and opportunities to drive our improved bottom line. We have moved toward product offerings that require lower capital expenditure while still creating significant value. Additionally, we have focused on feature rich-solutions that help us better partner with our customers to create long-term relationships. Our pivot is beginning to contribute to a higher gross profit, with a gross profit percentage of 11% for the six months ended June 30, 2021, compared to (15)% for the year ended December 31, 2020. Additionally, we have streamlined our manufacturing operations resulting in significant efficiency improvements that have helped us deliver more than $1 billion in cost savings from 2018 to 2020.

 

   

Disciplined, capital-efficient expansion strategy. Since our repositioning, we have focused on a capital-efficient expansion strategy that is based on long-term demand certainty and partnerships with our customers. In addition, by repositioning to focus on differentiated technologies, we have been able to efficiently add features to our existing platforms while significantly reducing overall capital expenditures. Additionally, this strategy provides us with the opportunity to pursue highly accretive investments to meet market demand. We built our existing infrastructure in a modular way, enabling us to expand capacity in existing facilities by installing tooling, which will allow us to more cost-effectively and quickly add new capacity. As a result of the initiatives mentioned above, our net capital expenditures (capital expenditures, net of government subsidies) decreased from $1.4 billion in 2017 to $476 million in 2020. In 2021, we intend to increase our capital expenditures in a disciplined manner.

Our Market Opportunity

According to Gartner, the TAM for the overall semiconductor device market was $466 billion in 2020, while the TAM for the foundry market, excluding memory, was $74 billion. Of this total, we estimate that our SAM represented $54 billion, which included $22 billion for Smart Mobile Devices, $18 billion for Home and Industrial IoT, $9 billion for Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, $4 billion for Automotive and $1 billion for Personal Computing opportunities.

2020 SAM

 

 

LOGO

 

102


Table of Contents

Smart Mobile Devices

According to Gartner, the smart mobile devices semiconductor market, excluding memory, is expected to grow at 6.3% CAGR from 2020 to 2025. By 2025, semiconductor devices for mobile applications, such as phones, tablets and wearables, are expected to account for approximately 28% of total semiconductor demand, excluding memory. Within smart mobile devices, we expect particularly rapid growth in mobile devices connected to phones, such as smart watches (with an expected CAGR of 22% from 2020 to 2025, according to Gartner). Historically, handset unit volume growth drove demand, but today users’ desire for increased functionality, speed and performance is driving significant increases in semiconductor content per device. IDC estimates that semiconductor content per mobile device has increased by more than 100% over the last five years. 5G implementation is driving the next wave of content growth as higher data rates and an increased number of bands require more RF circuits to amplify, transmit and receive signals. Our differentiation and expertise in RF technology positions us well in the smart mobile devices market as we help our customers deliver cellular, Wi-Fi, Bluetooth and other RF-based solutions. To date, we have shipped more than 80 billion RF chips into the smartphone market, and GF content is present in smart phone brands that cover 85% of the smartphone market, including many top models. In addition to RF technologies, we believe we are well-positioned to deliver audio, display, optical imaging and power solutions for the smart mobile devices market. As a foundry supplier, we produce more square inches of silicon in RF front-end, audio and NFC per smartphone than any other semiconductor manufacturer in the world.

 

LOGO

RF content in 5G mobile devices is also expected to be more than 700% higher than that of 4G devices, by 2025, according to IDC. We anticipate rapid growth in wearables, such as smart watches, mesh sensors and tracking devices, as well as AR/VR headsets, as these technologies continue to mature. Our technology platforms are designed to capture this opportunity as they address key challenges that need to be solved to drive improved customer experience and adoption, including battery-life, smart audio, reliable multi-protocol connectivity, such as 5G, Wi-Fi 6, Bluetooth and NFC, security through LiDAR and imaging.

Home and Industrial IoT

According to Gartner, the home and industrial IoT semiconductor market is expected to grow at 7.6% CAGR, with industrial automation markets expected to grow at 11% CAGR from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Our Home and Industrial IoT opportunity consists of solutions for a wide variety of applications, including factory automation, test and measurement, smart city, healthcare, transportation, connected home and others. According to Gartner, IoT applications are expected to account for approximately 22% of total annual semiconductor demand in 2025, excluding memory. Our SoC, wireless, imaging, power and audio solutions are

 

103


Table of Contents

well-suited to deliver the functionality needed to drive the next generation of home, workplace and factory automation. We believe these secular trends will continue and accelerate as the era of the intelligent edge increases in importance and overall size relative to the global economy.

 

 

LOGO

We are well-positioned to capture future growth in IoT applications, as we believe these applications will increasingly combine ultra-low power chips, a variety of sensors, improved displays and cameras, multi-sensor human-machine interfaces, connectivity and intelligence at the edge.

Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter

According to Gartner, the communications infrastructure & datacenter market is expected to grow at 5.4% CAGR, with wireless infrastructure and enterprise networking markets expected to grow at 12% CAGR, and 9% CAGR, respectively, from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Our Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter opportunity consists of solutions for wired and wireless network infrastructure, datacenter applications and satellite communications. Key growth drivers include 5G wireless infrastructure deployment and continued buildout of cloud computing capabilities. According to Omdia, 5G infrastructure spend is expected to grow at a high single-digit rate through 2025 and account for more than 80% of mobile infrastructure spend by 2025. Additionally, according to a July 2021 report by Gartner, data center capital expenditures by cloud service providers are expected to grow at an approximately 14% CAGR from 2020 to 2025, driven by overall cloud migration and transformation, as well as by work and learn from home trends. We believe we are well-positioned in RF, switching, optical, compute and storage solutions for these key end markets.

 

104


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

We believe that significant technological breakthroughs will be required to handle the substantial growth in data and elevated levels of power consumption. According to IDC, the total 64 zettabytes of data generated in 2020 is expected to grow at a 23% CAGR from 2020 to 2025. Our leading capability in SiPh increases throughput and dramatically reduces power consumption through the use of light instead of electrons.

Our mmWave technology serves the evolving needs of mobile networks, such as micro-cells for 5G mmWave, while our breadth of power applications enable our customers to design more efficient solutions for the RF networks of the future. Our RF capability is also well-suited to serve the emerging and fast growing Low Earth Orbit (“LEO”) networks that aim to bring connectivity to the entire planet. This end market is likely to experience rapid growth from satellites, base towers and end-devices, all three of which our technologies currently serve.

Automotive

According to Gartner, the automotive semiconductor devices, ADAS applications, and EV/HEV applications markets are expected to grow at 14.2% CAGR, 20% CAGR and 28% CAGR, respectively, from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Many of the innovations underway in the automotive industry, such as electric and autonomous vehicles, advanced infotainment, connectivity and security, are driven by increased adoption of semiconductors in cars. Semiconductor content per vehicle is expected to increase dramatically in the coming years. The number of semiconductor devices per car is expected to double between 2016 and 2027, to over 2,000 ICs per car, according to IHS Markit from July 2021. Significant content increases are being driven primarily by mandates for reduced emissions, improved safety and electrification. Semiconductor devices are now an integral component of engines, batteries, dashboard displays, safety systems and infotainment. We are well-positioned in RF and wireless for connectivity and communication as well as automotive microcontrollers (“MCUs”), power management, RADAR and LiDAR.

 

105


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

We expect the recent growth of semiconductor content in the automotive industry to continue, and we have been regularly evolving our technologies to serve these needs. For example, the weight of vehicles is a critical driver of range and performance, but as the amount of in-vehicle technology increases, so does the weight of the wiring and connections. Our SiPh platform applied to In-Vehicle-Networking (“IVN”) has the potential to drive a massive reduction in that weight, while improving speed and latency.

As the race for self-driving vehicles continues, we have developed many technologies that are well-positioned to be the semiconductor backbone of fully autonomous vehicles, such as our FDXTM platform for mmWave RADAR applications and SiGe for battery management. Our fabs have been producing automotive semiconductors for more than 15 years. In 2019 alone, we produced 107 products for 22 customers worldwide. Most of our facilities are IATF 16949:2016 certified and meet the mandatory global automotive industry quality management standards. In addition, we offer a range of feature-rich automotive technologies that span traditional CMOS, FinFET, high-voltage BiPolar CMOS for electrification and our proprietary FDXTM processes. Each of these technologies meets or exceeds the robust AEC-Q100 standards required by automotive OEMs. Additionally, our geographic diversity positions us well as the automotive industry seeks to localize its supply chain. For example, our Fab 1 in Dresden is the only 300mm foundry in Europe. We believe the proximity of Fab 1 to the German automotive innovation hubs in Saxony and Bavaria provides our customers with an advantage in supplying German OEMs.

Personal Computing

According to Gartner, the personal computing market is expected to grow at 2.5% CAGR from 2020 to 2025, excluding memory. Additionally, clamshell ultra-mobile devices and video game consoles are expected to grow at 9% CAGR and 12% CAGR, respectively, within that same time period, excluding memory. By 2025, semiconductor devices for personal computing, such as laptops and desktops are expected to account for approximately 16% of total semiconductor demand, excluding memory. In 2020 and 2021, the volume of personal computing devices has experienced strong growth, driven by work from home, remote learning and other trends related to the COVID-19 pandemic. We expect demand will continue to be sustained with the increasing use of compute in an increasing range of human activities (e.g., education and health), including in geographies that had limited access in the past.

 

106


Table of Contents

 

LOGO

While a large portion of the end market is driven by CPU/GPUs that are progressively transitioning to technologies we do not serve following our pivot in 2018, we will continue to support our customers across a variety of applications where our technology platforms can provide meaningful differentiation for their devices. These devices include chipsets (e.g., PCH or IOD), Wi-Fi, power delivery, display drivers, re-drivers and audio amplifiers. Many of our technologies offer best-in-class performance for these applications, including FinFET, CMOS and BCDLiteTM.

Key Strengths

We have several distinct advantages that differentiate us from our peers:

 

   

Scaled manufacturing capabilities. According to Gartner, in 2020, we were the third largest foundry in the world based on external sales. In 2020, we shipped approximately 2 million 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers. We provide scaled manufacturing capabilities focused exclusively on the pervasive semiconductor market. We currently operate five manufacturing sites, with plans for future expansions and upgrades to deliver more output at all of our locations. We believe that our scaled global manufacturing footprint enables our customers to leverage the security of our fabs and ensure a trusted supply of critical semiconductors.

 

   

Differentiated technology platforms and ecosystem. We deliver highly-differentiated solutions to meet customer demand for superior performance, lower power consumption and better thermal efficiency for mission-critical applications across IoT, 5G, cloud, AI, next-generation automotive, and other secular growth markets that are driving the economy of the future. Our deep portfolio of approximately 10,000 worldwide patents and leadership positions in highly-differentiated technologies such as RF, FinFET, FDXTM and SiGe allow us to be key thought leaders and partners to customers who are developing semiconductors that are shaping the future of technology. Our deep and rich foundry ecosystem of over 50 partners, including industry leaders such as Arm Ltd., Cadence Design Systems, Inc. and Synopsys, Inc., with more than 4,000 IP titles available, enable our customers to accelerate their time-to-market, reduce their design costs and improve their speed of innovation.

 

   

Diversified and secure geographic footprint. Our scaled global manufacturing footprint helps mitigate geopolitical, natural disaster and competitive risks. We are the only U.S.-based scaled semiconductor foundry with a global footprint. We believe that this geographic diversification is critical to our customers as well as governments around the world as they look to secure semiconductor

 

107


Table of Contents
 

supply. Furthermore, a significant number of our technology platforms are qualified across our manufacturing footprint providing our customers with a geographically diverse one-stop supply chain solution. Additionally, we are a member of the DoD’s Trusted Foundry Program, and we believe that our Fab 8 facility is the most advanced ITAR-compliant semiconductor manufacturing facility of its kind in the world. We extend this know-how and capability to offer secure solutions for our commercial customers as part of our GF Shield initiative, which is a comprehensive, company-wide platform to further safeguard and protect our customers’ intellectual property and products.

 

   

Market-centric solutions driving deep customer relationships. We are pioneering a new sustainable foundry relationship with fabless companies, IDMs and OEMs by partnering with customers to redefine the supply chain and economics for the entire value chain. We provide customized and innovative solutions tailored to the specific needs of our customers and key end markets. Through an intense focus on collaboration, we have built strong strategic partnerships with a broad base of more than 200 customers as of December 31, 2020, many of whom are the global leaders in their field. Equipped with a deep understanding of the solutions our customers need, our expert teams work alongside customers to solve their most complex challenges. Our focus on end market applications for our customers drives our process technology decisions, not the other way around. The insights we gain through our market-centric approach enable us to focus on and invest in the markets and applications in which we believe we can achieve a clear leadership position.

 

   

High degree of revenue and earnings visibility. Our combination of highly-differentiated technology, significant number of single-sourced products and customer supply agreements provides a high degree of revenue and earnings visibility. Recently, we entered into multiple long-term supply agreements with leading companies in the industry, totaling approximately $20 billion in aggregate lifetime revenue commitments. Many of these contracts include customer advanced payments and capacity reservation fees.

 

   

Capital-efficient model. Our focus on the pervasive semiconductor market results in lower capital requirements compared to foundries that focus on processor-centric compute semiconductors and are therefore obligated to invest significant capital to transition from node to node. Additionally, as the only scaled pure-play foundry with existing manufacturing capacity in the United States and Europe, we are well-positioned to benefit from government support, as governments around the world implement or contemplate large aid packages to encourage manufacturers such as us to increase their local capacities in these regions. This support includes cash grants or government-backed loans that can significantly reduce the cash funding required for capital expenditures. For example, our Dresden facility was the largest German recipient of the EU’s 2018 IPCEI Microelectronics initiative, receiving a total of approximately $270 million through 2020. Additionally, expansion of our Fab 7 in Singapore, which broke ground and was announced in June 2021, will be funded in-part by the Singapore EDB in the form of long-term developmental loans and grants.

 

   

World-class team and focus on sustainability. We have a highly technically proficient, talented and experienced management team of executive officers and key employees with average industry experience of 25 years. Most members of our management team have served in prior roles at a variety of the world’s leading semiconductor and other high-tech companies, bringing a rich and diverse set of experiences to their roles at GF. Each member of our board of directors is equipped with deep industry and functional expertise. We are dedicated to ethical and responsible business practices, the personal and social well-being of our diverse and highly-skilled employee base, and supply chain and environmental stewardship. As of December 31, 2020, we employed approximately 15,000 employees, and approximately 65% of our employees were engineers or technicians.

Our Differentiated Technology Platforms

We offer a wide range of feature-rich solutions that can address the needs of mission-critical applications in Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive and

 

108


Table of Contents

Personal Computing. To solve our customers’ most complex challenges, we have developed a broad range of sophisticated technology platforms that leverage our extensive patent portfolio and deep technical expertise in digital, analog, mixed-signal, RF and embedded memory.

We work in close collaboration with a broad ecosystem of partners on all areas of customer design enablement. We believe that our extensive partner network is a key differentiator of our technology platforms, allowing us to offer comprehensive, state-of-the art design solutions and services that provide our customers with a high-quality, cost-effective and faster path to market. We have over 50 ecosystem partners spanning IP, electronic design automation, outsourced assembly and test and design services. Building on an existing library of more than 4,000 IP titles, we currently have more than 950 IP titles in active development across 26 process nodes and 34 IP partners, and over the last five years, more than 1,500 customer designs have been enabled by our IP ecosystem. Additionally, we believe that our close collaboration with our partner ecosystem enables a robust quality management system to review the quality of all ecosystem IP and deliver high-quality solutions in an efficient manner.

Our core technology portfolio includes a range of differentiated technology platforms, including our industry-leading RF SOI offering, advanced high-performance FinFET, feature-rich CMOS, our proprietary FDXTM, high-performance SiGe products and SiPh, all of which can be purpose-built for demanding applications.

We devote the majority of our R&D efforts to our six primary differentiated technology platforms:

 

   

RF SOI: Our industry-leading RF SOI technologies are utilized in high-growth, high-volume wireless and Wi-Fi markets and are optimized for low power, low noise and low latency/high frequency applications that enable longer battery life for mobile applications and high cellular signal quality. Our RF SOI technologies are found in almost all cellular handsets from major manufacturers and in cellular ground station transceivers. As one of the industry leaders in RF, we are enabling new levels of connectivity with a portfolio of established and advanced RF SOI platforms targeting low-noise amplifiers, RF switches, phased-array antennas and control function integration in RF front-end modules for advanced 4G LTE, mmWave beamforming and 5G applications.

 

   

FinFET: Our FinFET process technology is purpose-built for high-performance, power-efficient SoCs in demanding, high-volume applications. Advanced features such as RF, automotive qualification, ultra-low power memory and logic provide a best-in-class (12 to 16nm) combination of performance, power and area, and are well-suited for compute and AI, mobile/consumer and automotive processors, high-end IoT applications, high performance transceivers and wired/wireless networking applications. Currently, GF, Intel, Samsung and TSMC are the only foundries that manufacture at scale on FinFET technology. Construction of a new facility with FinFET production capabilities can cost over $10 billion and require advanced lithography tools, which are at greater risk of being subject to export controls, adding uncertainty to the efforts of China-based companies to build FinFET capabilities. The significant cost required to develop and produce FinFET-based devices provides barriers to entry. Features such as RF and high-performance embedded decoupling capacitors enable key market segment penetration.

 

   

Feature-Rich CMOS: Our CMOS platforms combined with foundational and complex IP and design enablement offer mixed-technology solutions on volume production-proven processes and are well-suited for a wide variety of applications. Technology features include BCD for power management, high-voltage triple-gate oxide for display drivers, and embedded non-volatile memory for micro-controllers.

 

   

FDXTM: Our proprietary FDXTM process technology platform is especially well-suited for efficient single-chip integration of digital and analog signals delivering cost-effective performance for connected and low-power embedded applications. A full range of features, such as ULP, ULL, RF and mmWave, embedded Magnetoresistive Random Access Memory (“MRAM”) and automotive qualification, makes our FDXTM process technology platform especially well-matched for IoT/wireless, 5G (including mmWave), automotive radar, and satellite communications applications.

 

109


Table of Contents

22FDXTM Target Applications & Advantages over Traditional 28nm Bulk-CMOS

 

5G, LTE and Wi-Fi

  

IoT / Wearables

  

Automotive mmWave
RADAR, MCU, ADAS

  

Mid/low-Tier Apps
Processor

Enables New RF Architectures

 

•  35-50% die shrink

•  40-50% lower power

  

Lower Power down to 0.4V

 

•  80% lower power than 40nm

  

High-performance Long-range RADAR

 

•  Lower latency

•  Lower power

•  Lower cost

  

Full-node Scaling Benefits

 

•  <60% power

•  1.3x performance

•  ~70% area

 

   

SiGe: Our SiGe BiCMOS technologies are uniquely optimized for either power amplifier applications or very-high-frequency applications for optical and wireless networking, satellite communications and communications infrastructure. Our SiGe technologies are performance-competitive with more costly compound semiconductor technologies while taking full advantage of being integrated with conventional Si CMOS.

 

   

SiPh: Our SiPh platforms address the increasing need for data centers to handle ever higher data rates and volumes with greater power efficiency, as conventional copper wire connections are becoming prohibitive from a power consumption perspective. Our SiPh platforms integrate photonics components with CMOS logic and RF to enable a fully integrated, monolithic electrical and optical computing and communications engine. Our SiPh technologies are also being extended to applications such as LiDAR, quantum computing and consumer optical networks.

Purpose-Built Solutions for Key Markets

We take a market-centric approach, developing differentiated technologies to solve our customers’ most complex challenges. Through our market insights, we have developed a broad range of sophisticated technologies tailored to market-specific needs. Our customers turn to us when superior performance, lower power consumption and better thermal efficiency are critical. We enable unique applications in our five core markets of Smart Mobile Devices, Home and Industrial IoT, Communications Infrastructure & Datacenter, Automotive, and Personal Computing.

Our Five Core Markets

 

 

LOGO

Our Growth Strategies

Our objective is to be the leading foundry partner for mission-critical and pervasive applications. We take a market-centric approach, developing differentiated technologies to solve the industry’s most complex challenges.

 

110


Table of Contents

As the only U.S.-based scaled semiconductor foundry with a global footprint, we provide our customers with increasingly critical supply chain certainty and geopolitical risk mitigation. Key elements of our growth strategies include:

 

   

Deepen relationships with key customers. We operate a customer-focused partnership model in which we work closely with our customers to better understand their requirements in order to invest in and develop tailored solutions to suit their specific needs. We believe this approach is critical to attracting new customers and increasing the use of our technology platforms by existing customers over time. We intend to expand our customer base and increase market share by leveraging our core IP, comprehensive portfolio, scale and flexibility to redefine the fabless-foundry model. As an example of this new, more strategic, customer-focused model, we have recently entered into multiple long-term supply agreements with leading companies in the industry, totaling approximately $20 billion in aggregate lifetime revenue commitments. Many of these contracts include customer advanced payments and capacity reservation fees.

 

   

Expand portfolio of differentiated, feature-rich technologies. We believe that maintaining and enhancing our leadership position in differentiated technologies is critical to attracting and retaining customers, which increasingly rely on specific silicon features to differentiate their products. Through our close cooperation with customers, we generate insights that enable us to solve complex problems as semiconductors become more ubiquitous in a more connected, data-driven world. We will continue to invest in R&D across our six key technology platforms: RF, FinFET, feature-rich CMOS, FDXTM, SiGe (as well as other compound semiconductors such as Gallium nitride-on-Silicon) and SiPh. Our investments cover a broad range of innovation vectors, including materials and substrates, architecture, integration, services, including packaging, and ecosystem. We have deep expertise in all these areas that make us a critical partner in enabling our customers’ product roadmaps. We believe that these platforms provide room for continued innovation and growth within our addressable market for the foreseeable future.

 

   

Disciplined capacity expansion. We believe that we have a capital-efficient model that allows us to expand capacity in a disciplined and economically attractive manner. We are in the process of significantly expanding capacity at our Dresden and Malta facilities and recently broke ground on an expansion in Singapore. Our focus on the pervasive semiconductor market requires lower capital intensity than that of the compute-focused foundries to drive revenue growth.

 

   

Strengthen government partnerships. We intend to continue expanding our existing footprint by building on the strength of our public/private investment partnerships. In addition to the Dresden and Singapore expansions, we have the potential to partner with the U.S. government and customers to expand our Fab 8 location, our most advanced manufacturing facility and headquarter located in Malta, New York. These expansion opportunities will increase the scale and diversity of our global manufacturing footprint, serving to further mitigate geopolitical risks for our customers and partners. As regions around the world work to establish domestic semiconductor supply, we believe governmental funding to secure local manufacturing will continue.

 

   

Continued operational excellence. We delivered more than $1 billion in cost savings from 2018 to 2020 through intensive management focus on operational efficiency and are continuing to implement additional efficiency measures aimed at expanding margins, improving our bottom line, and generating higher returns on investment. We expect our business model to provide significant bottom line benefits as revenue scales at each of our existing locations.

Sales, Marketing and Customers

We are highly focused on helping our customers achieve success through close cooperation and collaboration. As of December 31, 2020, our global, customer-facing sales and marketing teams are organized into three regions, across North America, EMEA and APAC, with more than 300 professionals who promote new

 

111


Table of Contents

solutions, secure design wins and facilitate design realization. Our team of application engineers closely supports our customers to increase design productivity and optimize customer product performance and time-to-market.

We have significantly transformed our customer engagements over the last few years. Prior to 2018, as we competed to win business at the latest digital nodes, we were often forced to accept second-source, lower margin business. Today, our sales and marketing strategy focuses on deepening our existing relationships and growing with new customers and becoming their single-source supplier for mission-critical applications. We are a strategic partner to some of the largest fabless semiconductor companies and IDMs in the world and are also increasingly engaged with hyper-scalers and OEMs.

Our customer base has become more diversified over time, having grown from only one customer, AMD, in 2009 to a diverse base of more than 200 customers as of December 31, 2020. In 2020, AMD and Qualcomm were our only customers exceeding 10% of our net revenues, with percentage contributions of approximately 21% and 11%, respectively.

Historically, the majority of our revenue was tied to purchase orders that could be cancelled without charge prior to wafer start and rolling non-binding demand forecasts made by our customers. Prior to 2020, any significant long-term supply agreements were exceptional and substantially consisted of our long-term agreements with AMD and IBM, which were entered into as part of strategic acquisitions agreed with AMD in 2009, and with IBM in 2015.

More recently, due to our deeper customer engagements, more differentiated technology offerings and the severe global supply shortage, we have entered into more than 20 long-term supply agreements with leading global semiconductor device companies. These agreements include binding, multi-year, reciprocal annual (and, in some cases, quarterly) minimum purchase and supply commitments with wafer pricing and associated mechanics outlined for the contract term. See “Risk Factors—We have long-term supply agreements with certain customers that obligate us to meet specific production requirements, which may expose us to liquidated and other damages, require us to return advanced payments, require us to provide products and services at reduced or negative margins and constrain our ability to reallocate our production capacity to serve new customers or otherwise.”

In addition, many of these customer agreements are further secured through customer advanced payments and capacity reservation fees.

As of the date of this prospectus, the aggregate lifetime revenue commitment reflected by these agreements amounted to approximately $20 billion, including more than $10 billion during the period from 2022 through 2023 and more than $2.5 billion in advanced payments and capacity reservation fees.

 

112


Table of Contents

The following is a summary of our significant long-term supply agreements:

 

   

Year Signed

 

Contract
Duration
(Years)

 

Revenue
Commitment
($ in
billions)(1)

 

Technology

 

Core End Products

Customer 1

  2021   4   >$3.0   FinFET, CMOS, BCD CMOS, FDXTM, RF SOI   Various Mobile Products

Customer 2

  2021   6   >$2.5   eNVM CMOS   NFC and UWB Secure Element, Secure Cards

Customer 3

  2021   3   >$1.5   FinFET   Various Computing Products, Automotive Processors

Customer 4

  2021   4   >$1.5   eNVM CMOS   Automotive MCU, Secure Cards

Customer 5

  2021   4   >$1.5   RF SOI   Various Mobile Products

Customer 6

  2020/2021   4   >$1.5   FinFET, CMOS   High-End Image Sensor and DTV Processor

Customer 7

  2021   5   >$1.5   BCD CMOS   Mobile Audio, Haptic and Power

Customer 8

  2021   5   >$1.0   FinFET   Various Computing Products

Customer 9

  2021   4   >$1.0   CMOS, FDXTM   Various Mobile Products

Customer 10

  2020/2021   5   >$1.0   CMOS   Image Sensor Processors

Customer 11

  2021   4   >$0.5   FinFET   Network and Connectivity Infrastructure Processors

Customer 12

  2021   3   >$0.5   RF SOI, SiGe, BCDLiteTM   Various Mobile Products

 

(1)

Revenue commitment does not reflect any options customers may have to increase purchase orders pursuant to their agreements with us.

 

113


Table of Contents

Manufacturing and Operations

We are one of only five foundries of significant scale. According to Gartner, in 2020, we were the third largest foundry in the world based on external sales. In 2020, we shipped approximately 2 million 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers. We currently operate five manufacturing sites in the following locations: Dresden, Germany; Singapore; Malta, New York; Burlington, Vermont; and East Fishkill, New York.

Scaled Global Footprint

 

LOGO

Our focus on highly-differentiated solutions, quality, security and reliability requires world-class manufacturing capabilities. Since our strategic repositioning in 2018, we have shifted focus to digital, analog, mixed-signal and RF technologies, where we believe we can add significant value. We are streamlining and aligning our manufacturing footprint with this priority.

In 2018, we significantly reduced our contractual obligations under a set of agreements that we entered into with CD and its affiliates related to the establishment of a joint venture in Chengdu. As part of the original agreements, CD agreed to build, own and lease an approximately $1.1 billion clean room to the joint venture for 20 years. The amended agreement entered into in 2018 canceled a portion of the clean room project and terminated the lease agreement.

As part of our strategy to consolidate manufacturing to at-scale sites, on December 31, 2019, we sold our Fab 3E facility and operations in Tampines, Singapore to Vanguard for $236 million.

Furthermore, in April 2019, we agreed to transfer substantially all the assets and employees related to our EFK facility to ON Semiconductor in return for $400 million in consideration and $30 million for a technology license, of which ON Semiconductor paid $100 million upon signing, which included $30 million for the technology license, and an additional $100 million in 2020. This transfer will allow us to refocus investment into differentiated technologies at scale in our three globally diversified 300mm sites in New York, Germany and Singapore. We expect the completion of the asset sale to occur, subject to regulatory approvals, at the end of 2022. Since the transaction was entered into, we have transferred a number of technologies from the EFK facility to our other global manufacturing sites to ensure continuous supply to key customers.

 

114


Table of Contents

Subsequent to our divestiture of Fab 3E and transfer of the EFK facility, we will have four world-class manufacturing sites on three continents, providing the scale, technology differentiation and geographic diversification that we believe are critically important to our customers’ success.

Our manufacturing sites currently occupy an aggregate area of approximately 6.2 million square meters, which equates to approximately 1,170 U.S.-style football fields. The total clean room space is approximately 255,000 square meters spread across five manufacturing sites. Each site is equipped with thousands of highly sophisticated manufacturing equipment and tools. We currently have more than 7,500 tools across all of our fabs. Each site has dedicated power, water, gas and chemical distribution systems.

Our products have applications that span the global markets from mobility to wireless, wired and satellite communication, to automotive, industrial, consumer electronics, to personal computing, data center, to power, power management, photonics and more, with sizes that range from just a few millimeters square to 400 millimeters square, across our six differentiated technology platforms.

Dresden Facility

Our Dresden facility is the largest semiconductor manufacturing site in Europe, with approximately 310,000 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers shipped in 2020. The facility occupies an area of approximately 407,000 square meters, with clean room extending over an area of approximately 63,000 square meters, which is home to our CMOS and FDXTM process technologies from 55nm down to the 28/22nm node.

In Germany and the rest of Europe, we employ approximately 3,350 people from over 37 nations.

 

 

LOGO

 

115


Table of Contents

Singapore Facility

Our Singapore facility is one of the largest semiconductor foundry manufacturing sites in South-east Asia, with approximately 970,000 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers shipped in 2020. The facility occupies an area of approximately 182,000 square meters, with clean room extending over an area of approximately 72,000 square meters, which is home to process technology of 40nm to 0.6um.

In Singapore, we employ approximately 4,800 people, which we believe makes us the second largest semiconductor-related employer and the largest foundry employer in the country.

 

 

LOGO

 

116


Table of Contents

Malta, New York Facility

Our Malta, New York facility is the largest and most advanced 300mm pure-play foundry site in the United States, with approximately 350,000 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers shipped in 2020. The facility occupies an area of approximately 976,000 square meters, with clean room extending over an area of approximately 42,000 square meters, which is home to our FinFET process technology. We believe that our Malta facility is the most advanced ITAR-compliant semiconductor manufacturing facility of its kind in the world.

At our Malta facility, we employ approximately 3,000 people, which we believe makes the facility one of the largest manufacturing employers in the area.

 

 

LOGO

 

117


Table of Contents

Burlington, Vermont Facility

Our Burlington, Vermont facility is the largest 200mm pure-play foundry site in the United States with approximately 260,000 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers shipped in 2020. The facility occupies an area of approximately 2.7 million square meters, with clean room extending over an area of approximately 44,000 square meters, which is home to most of our RF process technologies. Our Burlington facility is an accredited member of the DoD’s Trusted Foundry Program.

In the State of Vermont, we employ approximately 2,300 people, which we believe makes us one of the largest private-sector employers in the state.

 

 

LOGO

 

118


Table of Contents

East Fishkill, New York Facility

Our East Fishkill, New York facility is located in the Hudson Valley. The site has been developing and manufacturing a wide range of technologies in Digital Logic, RF SiPh, and now discrete devices for end-customer applications. This facility shipped approximately 135,000 300mm equivalent semiconductor wafers in 2020. The facility occupies over 2 million square meters, with clean room space extending over an area of approximately 33,000 square meters. We agreed to transfer ownership of this facility to ON Semiconductor by the end of 2022, allowing us to refocus investment into differentiated technologies in our three world-scale 300mm sites in New York, Germany and Singapore.

At the East Fishkill facility, we employ approximately 1,300 people, which we believe makes the facility one of the largest manufacturing employers in the area.

 

 

LOGO

 

119


Table of Contents

The following table describes each of our core manufacturing facilities as of June 30, 2021:

Our Global Manufacturing Footprint

 

    

Key

Technologies(1)

  

Wafer Size
(mm)

  

2020 Shipments
(kwpa, 300mm
equivalent)

  

Fully Equipped
Clean Room
Space (kwpa,
300mm
equivalent)

Malta, New York

   FinFET, RF SOI, SiPh    300    ~350    ~570

Burlington, Vermont

   RF SOI, SiGe    200    ~260    ~275

Dresden, Germany

   FDXTM, NVM, HV, BCDL    300    ~310    ~850

East Fishkill, New York(2)

   HP CMOS, RF SOI, SiPh    300    ~135    N/A

Singapore

   BCD/BCDL, HV, NVM, DDI, RF SOI, LP SiGe    300, 200    ~970    ~1040(3)

 

(1)

NVM refers to Non-Volatile Memory. eNVM refers to embedded non-volatile memory.

(2)

Transfer of ownership of this facility to ON Semiconductor is expected to be completed by the end of 2022.

(3)

Excludes Fab 7 Module 7H 450 kwpa expansion under construction.

In early 2021, we announced plans to accelerate the buildout of capacity within our existing fabs to meet committed customer demand. These investments are expected to add scale with attractive economic returns. For new fab expansions that require additional construction beyond our existing clean rooms, our strategy is to continue to build scale in each of our locations through public/private partnerships, coupled where possible with deep customer commitments, as well as advanced payments and capacity reservation fees to secure supply for our customers.

On June 22, 2021, we announced fab expansion plans in Singapore, with the addition of Module 7H, an extension of our existing 300mm Fab 7 operations. We expect to invest close to $4 billion in capital investments to build and fit out the new module, with construction to be completed by the end of 2023 and first products qualified shortly thereafter. The expansion will be funded in-part by the Singapore EDB in the form of long-term developmental loans and grants. We anticipate hiring an additional 1,000 people to the site, and once fully ramped, we anticipate having an additional 450,000 wafers of 300mm capacity.

On July 19, 2021, we announced fab expansion plans in Malta, New York, including the construction of a new fab on the same campus. We expect to invest approximately $1 billion in capital investments to expand the capacity of the existing fab by approximately 150,000 wafers per year, to be followed by the construction of an additional fab that we expect to double existing capacity. We are planning to fund the expansion through private/public partnerships in the United States.

Raw Materials

One of the most important raw materials used in our production processes is silicon wafers, which is the basic raw material from which integrated circuits are made. In recent years, the silicon substrate market has experienced price volatility and supply shortages. The principal suppliers for our wafers are Soitec, GlobalWafers Singapore Pte. Ltd. (“GlobalWafers”), SK Siltron, Inc., Siltronic AG, Sumco Corporation and Shin-Etsu Handotai (“S.E.H.”). In order to secure a reliable and flexible supply of high-quality wafers, we have entered into multiple long-term agreements with the majority of our principal suppliers, the largest of which is Soitec. We have entered into multiple long-term agreements with Soitec across a wide spectrum of SOI products. Soitec supplied 52% of our SOI wafers in 2020. See also “Risk Factors—We rely on a complex silicon supply chain and breakdowns in that chain could affect our ability to produce our products and could materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.”

Research and Development

We have a strong heritage of innovation, stemming from our roots at AMD, Chartered Semiconductor and IBM, and have built a comprehensive technology portfolio supported by approximately 10,000 worldwide

 

120


Table of Contents

patents, more than double that of other pure-play foundries with similar scale and revenue. As of December 31, 2020, we had approximately 1,400 employees dedicated to R&D.

We have a strong commitment to R&D, and, since our strategic repositioning in 2018, have been able to invest more efficiently, focusing our R&D efforts primarily on delivering a comprehensive and expanded portfolio of highly-differentiated, feature-rich solutions for our customers, including RF, FinFET, feature-rich CMOS, FDXTM, SiGe and SiPh. Our investments cover a broad range of innovation vectors, including materials and substrates, architecture, integration, services, including packaging, and the development of our ecosystem. These resources provide our customers with improved opportunities to develop innovative products to fuel the global economy. In 2018, 2019 and 2020, we spent $926 million, $583 million and $476 million, respectively, on R&D, which represented 15%, 10% and 10% of our net revenues in each respective year. The sequential decline in R&D spending was driven primarily by a reallocation of investment from 7nm development to a focus on expanding and enhancing features of our solutions for the pervasive semiconductor market, where R&D spending has significantly more impact per dollar invested.

Competition

There are substantial barriers to enter the foundry market. Operating an at-scale foundry requires an intricate web of ecosystem partners and IP libraries, mastery of highly complex manufacturing process technology, access to deep know-how and engineering talent, and a global engineering customer-support organization. Even companies with substantial access to capital have struggled to develop these capabilities. Historically, IDMs have attempted to use their excess capacity to provide foundry services, but these efforts have been challenged given the complexities of serving both internal and external customers, limited investment and focus on the necessary ecosystem, technology offering, customer support and process technologies. We believe IDMs will continue to struggle to meaningfully compete with pure-play foundries.

The foundry market is comprised of five major pure-play foundries that accounted for the vast majority of worldwide foundry revenue in 2020, according to a March 2021 Gartner Semiconductor Foundry Worldwide Market Share report. TSMC at $46 billion of wafer revenue in 2020 accounted for more than 58% of the total market, while the next four players combined made up only 27% of the market. In the pervasive semiconductor market in which we compete, we strive to differentiate ourselves with our deep portfolio of patents and leadership positions in technologies such as RF, FinFET, FDXTM and SiGe. Our primary competitors are Samsung, SMIC, TSMC, UMC and other smaller foundries.

 

LOGO

 

121


Table of Contents

We are the only U.S.-based semiconductor foundry with a global footprint. Having a reliable foundry partner outside of China, Taiwan and Korea is becoming increasingly important to ensuring the stability of the global economy, making us a vital player in today’s geopolitical landscape. We have limited exposure to China relative to our competition, as we do not maintain any fab operations in the country and have a diversified customer base with less than 10% of total sales in 2020 originating in China. See “Risk Factors—Our competitors have announced expansions and may continue to expand in the United States and Europe, which could materially and adversely affect our competitive position.”

Intellectual Property

We rely on IP rights, particularly patents and trade secrets, as well as contractual arrangements, to protect our core process and design enablement technologies and provide our customers with protected technology to enable their mission-critical offerings. On average, we file hundreds of new patent applications annually, and approximately 90% of our filed patent applications have successfully been issued as patents (based on U.S. patent applications filed between 2016 and 2020), which reflects the innovation of our engineers. Following our 2018 pivot to focus on differentiated technologies, our recent patent applications have closely tracked our areas of focus, including RF, FDXTM, SiGe, and SiPh. We file our patent applications in the United States and in key countries such as Taiwan, Korea, China and Germany based on the location of other semiconductor manufacturers or major markets.

In addition to patents invented by our engineers, we have also acquired thousands of patents from other leading semiconductor manufacturers, including AMD, Chartered Semiconductor and IBM. We periodically conduct in-depth reviews of our patents and the industry’s manufacturing technologies, and we cull patents having limited or no value, yielding both savings in patent office maintenance fees and a strong, active patent portfolio. As of December 31, 2020, we held approximately 10,000 worldwide patents.

Over the years, we have used our patent portfolio to successfully fend off operating companies seeking to extract patent license fees from us. Additionally, in 2019, we filed patent infringement lawsuits against TSMC in the U.S. International Trade Commission and district courts in the United States and Germany. The case was quickly settled with a patent cross-license. We have also entered into patent cross-licenses with a number of other leading advanced semiconductor companies, including AMD, Samsung and IBM. These cross-licenses provide us with valuable freedom of operation under patents owned or subsequently divested by such companies.

As is the case with many companies in the semiconductor industry, we have from time to time received communications from third parties, in particular, so-called non-practicing entities, asserting patents that allegedly cover certain of our technologies, and we expect to receive similar communications in the future. Some of the patents that others have chosen to assert against us are not valid based on pre-existing prior art, and we have successfully defended ourselves using inter partes review (“IPR”) and other procedures in the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office.

Regardless of the validity or the successful assertion of such claims, we could incur significant costs and devote significant management resources to the defense of these claims, which could seriously harm our company. Additionally, many of our agreements with our customers and partners require us to defend such parties against certain IP infringement claims and indemnify them for damages and losses arising from certain intellectual property infringement claims against them. See “Risk Factors—Intellectual Property—We have been and may continue to become subject to intellectual property disputes, which are costly and may subject us to significant liability and increased costs of doing business.”

 

122


Table of Contents

Corporate Organizational Structure

Prior to this offering, we were wholly owned by Mubadala, which is wholly owned by the Government of Abu Dhabi, through Mubadala’s indirectly held, wholly owned subsidiaries, MTIC and MTIIIC. As depicted in the organizational chart below, following this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, Mubadala will beneficially own 89.4% of our issued and outstanding ordinary shares and control approximately 89.4% of the voting power of our issued and outstanding ordinary shares, assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional ordinary shares.

 

LOGO

 

*

Please refer to Note 1 of our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for more information on our subsidiaries.

(1)

Includes 1,685,393 ordinary shares (based on an assumed initial public offering price of $44.50 per share, which is the midpoint of the price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus) to be sold to Silver Lake pursuant to the Concurrent Private Placement. Those shares are not expected to be freely tradeable until at least six months following this offering.

Employees

We have a highly-skilled employee base and as of December 31, 2020, we employed approximately 15,000

 

123


Table of Contents

employees primarily located at our manufacturing sites. As of December 31, 2020, approximately 46% of our employees were located in North America, approximately 22% in EMEA, and approximately 32% in APAC. We also engage temporary employees and consultants. Overall, we believe we have good relations with our employees.

Our employee base is highly skilled, and in 2020 we invested more than 1.4 million hours in training for our employees. As of December 31, 2020, approximately 65% of our employees were engineers or technicians, and more than 44% of our employees had degrees in engineering, more than 14% had a Master’s degree, and more than 6% had a PhD.

Environmental, Social and Governance (“ESG”)

We are dedicated to ethical and responsible business practices, the personal and social well-being of our employees, and supply chain and environmental stewardship. ESG is fundamental to our culture and our value proposition to our customers, the communities in which we live and do business, and our full range of global stakeholders.

We currently focus our ESG efforts in the following key areas:

Employee Safety, Health and Well-being

Our Journey to Zero commitment is the leading theme of our Global Environmental Health and Safety (“EHS”) Policy and Standards, which serve as the foundation of health and safety programs at each of our manufacturing locations. We strive to continuously reduce occupational injuries and illnesses in all of our operations, and aspire to achieve the goal of zero annual incidents. In November 2020, we received the America’s Safest Companies award from EHS Today. Our enterprise-wide health and safety management system is certified to the ISO 45001:2018 standard.

Sustainable Manufacturing and Operations

Semiconductor manufacturing is generally resource-intensive. Therefore, our Journey to Zero commitment also represents our pursuit of sustainable and environmentally efficient manufacturing operations, seeking to minimize environmental- and climate-related impacts from our operations through pollution prevention and resource conservation. Our Global EHS Policy and Standards establish a continual improvement process and performance requirements that apply throughout the company. Our enterprise-wise environmental management system is certified to the ISO 14001:2015 standard. In August 2021, we launched our Journey to Zero commitment that aims to reduce greenhouse gas emissions by 25% by 2030.

Responsible Sourcing

As a member of the Responsible Business Alliance (“RBA”), we are committed to responsible sourcing practices. We progressively apply the RBA Code of Conduct to our major suppliers and monitor its application. We encourage and support our suppliers to do the same in our continuous pursuit of excellence in corporate responsibility and extension of responsible practices throughout the supply chain.

Technology Solutions for Humanity

We are focused on creating innovations in the largest and most pervasive segments of the semiconductor industry. As power efficiency has become a critical success factor for our industry, we strive to develop solutions that can lower the power consumption of digital technology.

Human Capital: Diversity & Inclusion and Talent Development

We believe that our success rests on empowering employees to bring their whole selves to the company and that building a culture of inclusion drives better business outcomes. As a global company, we recognize and

 

124


Table of Contents

value the wide variety of cultural values, traditions, experiences, education and perspectives of our team and communities. As part of our strategic repositioning in 2018, we established a Diversity & Inclusion office. As of December 31, 2020, we employed a multicultural workforce representing more than 90 nationalities across 13 countries. We believe that our culture of inclusion leads to higher levels of belonging, engagement and ultimately, higher-performing teams. We strive to focus on all aspects of the employee lifecycle, including recruitment, retention, professional development, and advancement of diverse talent. As part of this effort, we established our GLOBALWOMEN initiative in 2013 to have a positive impact on our business through the enrichment of our female employees. We use an annual engagement survey process to help measure employee engagement and our diversity and inclusion strategy progress.

Community Support and Engagement

We have a long history of community involvement, with well-established programs and global and local teams dedicated to enriching the lives of the people in our communities around the world. Through our worldwide GlobalGives program, we provide employees with the opportunity to make a positive impact in their local communities through personal donations, company-matched donations as well as through volunteering their time.

Stakeholder Engagement

Our key stakeholders have a significant interest in our business and help shape our company and the products and services we provide. We regularly engage with our employees, customers, communities, suppliers, and industry peers, sharing perspectives and gaining valuable insight relevant to our business and operations.

Legal Proceedings

On April 28, 2021, IBM sent us a letter alleging for the first time that we did not fulfill our obligations under the contracts we entered into with IBM in 2014 associated with our acquisition of IBM’s Microelectronics division. IBM asserted that we engaged in fraudulent misrepresentations during the underlying negotiations, and claimed we owed them $2.5 billion in damages and restitution. We believe, based on discussions with legal counsel, that we have meritorious defenses against IBM’s claims and on June 7, 2021, we filed a complaint with the New York State Supreme Court seeking a declaratory judgment that we did not breach the relevant contracts. IBM subsequently filed a complaint with the New York State Supreme Court on June 8, 2021. On September 14, 2021, the Court granted our motion to dismiss IBM’s claims of fraud, unjust enrichment and breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing. Our complaint seeking declaratory judgment was dismissed. The case will proceed based on IBM’s breach of contract and promissory estoppel claims. We do not currently anticipate this proceeding to have a material impact on our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

In 2017, we and CD entered into a set of agreements related to the establishment of a joint venture in Chengdu, China to establish and operate a greenfield wafer production site in Chengdu. The parties contemplated that the manufacturing operations would be implemented in two phases. Due to a variety of factors, including unanticipated market conditions, the manufacturing operations did not proceed as planned and the parties have been working to wind-down operations of the joint venture. On April 26, 2021, we received a claim from CD requesting that we share in CD’s alleged losses and related costs incurred to support the joint venture. We and CD are engaged in negotiations to settle the claim and we recorded a provision of $34 million in June 2021.

In addition to the foregoing proceeding, from time to time, we become involved in legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of our business, such as claims brought by our customers in connection with commercial disputes, product liability claims, employment claims made by our current or former employees or claims of infringement raised by intellectual property owners, in connection with the technology used in our manufacturing operations. Based on the information currently available to us, we believe that the outcome of these proceedings would not have a material impact on our results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

 

125


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

The following table sets forth information for our executive officers, directors and key employees as of the date of this prospectus:

 

Name

  

Age

    

Title

Executive Officers

     

Dr. Thomas Caulfield

     62     

Chief Executive Officer, Board Director

David Reeder

     46     

Chief Financial Officer

Kay Chai (KC) Ang

     62     

Senior Vice President

Saam Azar

     45     

Chief Legal Officer

Juan Cordovez

     42     

Senior Vice President

Emily Reilly

     57     

Senior Vice President

Board of Directors

     

Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi

     48     

Chairman

Dr. Thomas Caulfield

     62     

Chief Executive Officer, Board Director

Ahmed Saeed Al Calily

     47     

Board Director

Tim Breen

     43     

Board Director

Glenda Dorchak

     67     

Board Director

Martin L. Edelman

     80     

Board Director

David Kerko

     48     

Lead Independent Director

Jack Lazar

     56     

Board Director

Elissa E. Murphy

     52     

Board Director

Carlos Obeid

     56     

Board Director

Key Employees

     

Gregg Bartlett

     60     

Senior Vice President

Dr. Bami Bastani

     68     

Senior Vice President, General Manager

Michael J. Cadigan

     64     

Senior Vice President

Amir Faintuch

     52     

Senior Vice President, General Manager

Michael Hogan

     56     

Senior Vice President, General Manager

Americo Lemos

     54     

Senior Vice President

Thomas Weber

     52     

Senior Vice President

Executive Officers

Dr. Thomas Caulfield is Chief Executive Officer (CEO) of GF and was elected to the board of directors in March 2018. Dr. Caulfield joined the company in May 2014 as Senior Vice President and General Manager of the company’s Fab 8 semiconductor wafer manufacturing facility in Malta, NY, where he led operations, expansion and the ramp-up of semiconductor manufacturing production. Dr. Caulfield has an extensive career spanning engineering, management and global operational leadership with leading technology companies. Prior to joining GF, Dr. Caulfield served as President and Chief Operations Officer (COO) at Soraa from May 2012 to May 2014, the world’s leading developer of GaN on GaNTM (gallium nitride on gallium nitride) solid-state

 

126


Table of Contents

lighting technology. Before Soraa, Dr. Caulfield served as President and COO of Ausra from 2009 to 2010, a leading provider of large-scale concentrated solar power solutions for electricity generation and industrial steam production. Prior to leading at Ausra, Dr. Caulfield served as Executive Vice President of Sales, Marketing and Customer Service at Novellus Systems, Inc. Before that, Dr. Caulfield spent 17 years at IBM in a variety of senior leadership roles, ultimately serving as vice president of 300mm semiconductor operations for IBM’s Microelectronics division, leading its wafer fabrication operations in East Fishkill, NY. Dr. Caulfield earned a Bachelor of Science in Physics from St. Lawrence University before entering Columbia University’s Fu Foundation School of Engineering and Applied Science, where he earned both his Bachelor and Master of Science in Materials Science and Engineering as well as a Doctorate in Materials Science and Engineering. Dr. Caulfield was also a postdoctoral fellow at Columbia’s Engineering Center for Strategic Materials.

David Reeder is Chief Financial Officer (CFO) of GF, responsible for the company’s financial strategy and leading the global financial organization. He joined GF in August 2020 and has extensive experience in the semiconductor industry and other fields. Previously, he was Chief Executive Officer for Tower Hill Insurance Group from 2017 to 2020. Prior to that, he was President and CEO for Lexmark International, Inc. from 2015 to 2017. Earlier in his career, Mr. Reeder was CFO at Electronics for Imaging from 2014 to 2015 and Cisco’s Enterprise Networking Division from 2012 to 2014, and held executive positions at Broadcom and Texas Instruments. He holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Chemical Engineering from University of Arkansas and a Master of Business Administration degree from Southern Methodist University.

Kay Chai (KC) Ang is Senior Vice President of Global Fab Operations for GF since October 2020. Mr. Ang joined GF in July 2009 and has served in a variety of senior leadership roles for the company including head of all of our Singapore operations from 2012 to 2020 and as head of the Fab 1 manufacturing facility, customer engineering and corporate quality organizations. Mr. Ang has more than 30 years of foundry industry experience with a proven track record in manufacturing operations, fab start-up, and technology transfer. Prior to joining the company, he held senior leadership positions at Chartered Semiconductor Manufacturing from 1988 to 2009, including Senior Vice President of Sales and Marketing with responsibility for global sales, marketing, services, customer support and regional business operations. He also served as Senior Vice President of Fab Operations, where Mr. Ang had responsibility for manufacturing strategy and operational excellence across all of the company’s fabs from 2002 to 2007, including the launching operations at Chartered’s 300mm Fab 7 facility, which was integrated into GF in January 2010. Mr. Ang has held other manufacturing operations roles at Chartered as well as at SilTerra. He is also the SEMI Southeast Asia Regional Advisory Chairman and the Board Advisor to Singapore Semiconductor Industry Association. Mr. Ang holds a bachelor’s degree in Mechanical Engineering from National Taiwan University and a master’s degree in Engineering from University of Texas.

Saam Azar is Chief Legal Officer for GF since January 2017. He oversees all legal, compliance, government relations, strategic transactions and M&A matters worldwide. Mr. Azar also serves as Secretary to the GF board of directors and has been involved with the company since its founding in 2009. Before joining GF as Chief Legal Officer, Mr. Azar worked closely with the GF legal department and GF senior management on various strategic matters, including the IBM Microelectronics Division acquisition. He also served as GF Assistant General Counsel from 2014 to 2015. From 2006 to 2017, Mr. Azar has also served in various roles for GF’s sole shareholder, Mubadala Development Company PJSC, as a senior member of the Legal & Compliance Unit, working primarily on complex, cross border partnerships. Prior to Mubadala, he worked as a corporate associate at the international law firm of Cleary Gottlieb in New York, where he supported numerous corporate transactions with an emphasis on debt and equity capital markets. Mr. Azar holds a J.D. from New York University School of Law and a Bachelor of Science degree in Civil and Environmental Engineering from Duke University.

Juan Cordovez is Senior Vice President of Global Sales for GF since July 2019, leading client-facing functions including sales, commercial operations, field applications and customer engineering. Prior to his current role, Mr. Cordovez led GF’s EMEA and later APAC sales from 2016 to 2019. Prior to that, Mr. Cordovez led GF’s Customer Design Enablement Team including the PDK, device modeling and field applications

 

127


Table of Contents

engineering teams from 2013 to 2016. Prior to joining GF, Mr. Cordovez was founder and Vice President of Sentinel IC Technologies from 2008 to 2013 and Manager of Design Enablement at Jazz Semiconductor from 2002 to 2008. He holds a Master of Science degree in Electrical and Computer Engineering from the University of California, Irvine.

Emily Reilly is Senior Vice President of Human Resources at GF since March 2018 and has worldwide responsibility for all aspects of strategic human resources including talent and leadership development, delivering world-class people solutions, shaping the company’s culture and creating an environment of diversity, inclusion and belonging within GF. A member of GF’s original startup team, she joined the company in 2009 and has been instrumental in GF’s growth into a thriving, global organization of approximately 15,000 employees. Prior to joining GF, as an engineer, she worked in several roles with GE Advanced Materials and Momentive Performance Materials. During the course of her 14-year tenure, Ms. Reilly held leadership roles in both engineering and human resources, including a human resources leadership role for engineering in GE’s energy business. Ms. Reilly is Chair of the company’s People and Sustainability Committee and serves on the Women’s Leadership Council of the Global Semiconductor Association (GSA), providing inspiration and sponsorship for the next generation of women leaders. She holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Industrial Engineering from Cornell University.

Board of Directors

Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi was elected to the board of directors as Chairman in December 2013. Mr. Al Idrissi is currently the Chief Executive Officer of Direct Investments at Mubadala Investment Company (Mubadala) with oversight of the energy, chemicals, technology, life sciences, consumer, industrial and financial services portfolios. Prior to joining Mubadala, Mr. Al Idrissi was a partner at McKinsey & Company, where he co-lead the Principal Investor practice and Managing Partner of the Abu Dhabi practice. He was formerly a Marketing Manager at Procter & Gamble, where he led several flagship brands. He also serves as Chairman of the board of directors of Compañía Española de Petróleos and S.A.U (Cepsa), Chairman of NOVA Chemicals Corporation, and a member of the board of directors of Emirates Global Aluminium PJSC, Mubadala Capital and PCI Pharma Services. Previously, Mr. Al Idrissi served as a board member for Advanced Micro Devices (AMD) from 2012 to 2019. Mr. Al Idrissi holds a Bachelor of Science in Industrial Engineering from École Centrale Paris and a Master of Science in Mechanical Engineering from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.

Dr. Thomas Caulfield is Chief Executive Officer (CEO) of GF and was elected to the board of directors in March 2018. Please see above under “Executive Officers” for a description of the business experience of Dr. Caulfield.

Ahmed Saeed Al Calily was elected to the board of directors in March 2018. Mr. Al Calily is the Chief Strategy & Risk Officer for Mubadala Investment Company (Mubadala), with oversight over portfolio strategy, enterprise risk management, and responsible investing. Prior to that, Mr. Al Calily was the Chief Executive Officer of Energy at Mubadala, where he oversaw the company’s energy assets. Prior to re-joining Mubadala, Mr. Al Calily was director general of the Abu Dhabi Technology Development Committee and Chief Executive Officer and managing director of the Abu Dhabi Ports Company. Mr. Al Calily also served as deputy director of the infrastructure and services unit at Mubadala. He currently serves as a member of the board of directors at Abu Dhabi Future Energy Company (Masdar), Cleveland Clinic Abu Dhabi LLC, Medical Holding Company LLC and Abu Dhabi Commercial Bank PJSC. Mr. Al Calily holds a bachelor’s degree in Economics and Political Science from Boston University.

Tim Breen was elected to the board of directors in January 2018. In 2020, he served as Executive Vice President of Strategy and Business Performance and as senior counselor to the Chief Executive Officer. Prior to that, he served as the Executive Vice President of Strategy and Business Transformation from 2018 to August 2020. He is currently a member of the senior leadership team of Mubadala Investment Company (Mubadala), responsible for the firm’s direct investments in the technology and consumer sectors and serves on the board of directors of several of Mubadala’s North American investments, including NOVA Chemicals Corporation, Truck

 

128


Table of Contents

Hero, Inc. and Equinox Gold Corp. Prior to joining Mubadala, Mr. Breen was a partner with McKinsey & Company in Abu Dhabi. He holds a Master of Business Administration degree from London Business School.

Glenda Dorchak was elected to the board of directors in June 2019. Ms. Dorchak spent over thirty years in operational leadership roles in the technology industry, most recently as Executive Vice President and General Manager of Global Business with Spansion, Inc., a flash memory manufacturer. Her career began at International Business Machines Corporation (IBM) where she held executive positions including General Manager of PC Direct’s Personal Systems Group. Ms. Dorchak went on to become Chairperson and Chief Executive Officer at Value America Inc. before joining Intel Corporation as Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of Intel Communications Group. She also served as Vice President and General Manager of Intel Broadband Products Group and Vice President and General Manager of Intel Consumer Electronics Group. After Intel, Ms. Dorchak was Chairperson and Chief Executive Officer of Intrinsyc Software and Vice Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of VirtualLogix. Ms. Dorchak currently does advisory and board work and serves as a member of the board of directors at ANSYS, Inc., Wolfspeed Inc. and Viavi Solutions Inc. until November 10, 2021.

Martin L. Edelman was elected to the board of directors in February 2017. Mr. Edelman serves as “Of Counsel” in the real estate practice of Paul Hastings LLP. He has been an advisor to Grove Investors and is a partner at Fisher Brothers, a real estate partnership. Mr. Edelman is a Director of Blackstone Mortgage Trust, Inc. and Aldar Properties and currently serves on the boards of various nongovernmental organizations. Previously, Mr. Edelman served as a board member for Advanced Micro Devices (AMD) from 2013 to 2017. He has more than 40 years of experience and concentrates his practice on real estate and corporate mergers and acquisitions transactions. Mr. Edelman holds a Bachelor of Arts degree from Princeton University and a law degree from Columbia Law School.

David Kerko was elected to the board of directors in January 2018. Mr. Kerko is Head of North America Private Equity at Elliott Investment Management L.P. Prior to joining Elliott, Mr. Kerko was an advisor, member and co-head of the Technology Group at Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. Inc. (KKR). Prior to joining KKR, he worked for Gleacher NatWest Inc. on mergers and acquisition transactions and financing. Mr. Kerko is a member of the board of directors of Cubic Corporation. Mr. Kerko holds a Bachelor of Science degree and a Bachelor of Science in Engineering degree, summa cum laude, from the University of Pennsylvania.

Jack Lazar was elected to the board of directors in July 2021. Mr. Lazar has spent over thirty years in operational and finance leadership roles at technology companies across multiple industries, most recently as Chief Financial Officer of GoPro, Inc., which he helped to take public in 2014. Prior to GoPro, Mr. Lazar served as Senior Vice President of Corporate Development and General Manager of Qualcomm Atheros, Inc. From 2003 until the time in which it was acquired by Qualcomm in 2011, he served in a variety of leadership roles at Atheros Communications, Inc. most recently as Chief Financial Officer and Senior Vice President of Corporate Development. In 2004, Mr. Lazar was part of the team that took Atheros public. He also served in leadership roles at NetRatings, Apptitude, and Electronics for Imaging, Inc. (EFI). Mr. Lazar currently serves as a member of the board of directors of several publicly traded companies including Box, Inc., Casper Sleep Inc., Resideo Technologies Inc., Silicon Labs, Inc. and thredUP Inc. He holds a Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree with an emphasis in Accounting from Santa Clara University and is a certified public accountant (inactive).

Elissa E. Murphy was elected to the board of directors in September 2021. Ms. Murphy has served as a Vice President of Engineering at Google, Inc. since 2016. Prior to Google, she was the Chief Technology Officer and Executive Vice President of Cloud Platforms at GoDaddy from 2013 to 2016. Ms. Murphy previously served as Vice President of Engineering at Yahoo! from late 2010 to 2013, where she oversaw the world’s largest private Hadoop cluster, a technology essential to massive-scale computing that is the basis of big data today. Prior to her time at Yahoo!, Ms. Murphy spent 13 years at Microsoft in various engineering positions including part of the original team responsible for Microsoft’s shift to the cloud, which led to the creation of Azure, and as a member of the High Performance Computing team. Ms. Murphy began her technology career designing and building many of the best-selling computer security and system utilities with 5th Generation Systems,

 

129


Table of Contents

Quarterdeck and the Norton Group, a division at Symantec responsible for Norton Antivirus and other Norton products. Ms. Murphy brings expertise in global-scale platforms, big data and predictive analytics to our Board. She currently has over 30 patents issued with several more pending in the areas of distributed systems, cloud, machine learning and security.

Carlos Obeid was elected to the board of directors in January 2012. Mr. Obeid is currently the Chief Financial Officer of Mubadala Investment Company (Mubadala), with oversight of its commercial functions including treasury, investor relations, financial planning, business performance, financial governance and reporting. Before joining Mubadala, Carlos worked with the United Arab Emirates Offset Program Bureau where he led a wide range of initiatives including privatization, utilities and financial services. He serves as the chairman of the board of directors of Mubadala Infrastructure Partners Ltd. and is a member of the board of directors of Cleveland Clinic Abu Dhabi LLC, Bank Audi SAL, Mubadala Capital LLC and Abu Dhabi Commercial Bank PJSC. Carlos holds a Bachelor of Science in Electrical Engineering degree from American University of Beirut, Lebanon, and a Master of Business Administration degree from INSEAD in Fontainebleau, France.

Key Employees

Gregg Bartlett is Senior Vice President of Technology, Engineering and Quality at GF since September 2019. Prior to his current role, he served in various senior executive roles at GF including Head of Technology Development, Chief Technology Officer and Head of the CMOS (complementary metal-oxide-semiconductor) business from 2009 to 2019. Before joining GF, Mr. Bartlett spent 25 years in technical and management positions at Freescale Semiconductor and its predecessor, Semiconductor Products Sector at Motorola. Mr. Bartlett currently serves as a member of the board directors of Carbice Corporation. Mr. Bartlett holds a bachelor’s degree in Chemical Engineering from Kansas State University.

Dr. Bami Bastani is Senior Vice President and General Manager of Mobile and Wireless Infrastructure business unit since September 2019. Prior to this, Dr. Bastani held several business unit senior executive positions from 2015 to 2019. He has more than 35 years of industry experience in the semiconductor industry, including in component-to- system-level radio frequency (RF) technologies. Prior to joining GF, Dr. Bastani was President, CEO and board member of Meru Networks from 2012 to 2015, where he transformed the company from a hardware seller to solution provider. He has also served as President, CEO and member of the board of directors of both Trident Microsystems, Inc. from 2011 to 2012, and ANADIGICS, Inc. from 1998 to 2008, as well as served in executive positions at Fujitsu Microelectronics, National Semiconductor and Intel Corporation. Dr. Bastani holds a Ph.D. and Master of Science degree in Electrical Engineering in Microelectronics from The Ohio State University.

Michael J. Cadigan is Senior Vice President for Customer Design Enablement at GF since August 2019. Mr. Cadigan joined the company in 2015 when it acquired IBM’s Microelectronics division where he was General Manager, overseeing all aspects of the microelectronics business unit, including the technology development alliance activity from 2008 through the acquisition. Prior to that, Mr. Cadigan held several executive positions at IBM across a variety of areas, including supply chain operations, global outsourced manufacturing, systems manufacturing, hard disc drive manufacturing, and ASIC business unit manager from 1997 thru 2008. Prior to 1997, Mr. Cadigan worked across several different IBM divisions and locations as a senior executive. He holds a bachelor’s degree in Mechanical Engineering from the University of Buffalo.

Amir Faintuch is Senior Vice President and General Manager of the Computing, Wired Infrastructure and Silicon Photonics business unit since October 2019. Mr. Faintuch has more than 25 years of experience in the semiconductor industry. Prior to joining GF in 2019, he was Senior Vice President and General Manager at Intel responsible for its worldwide horizontal Research and Development, where he played a key role in leading a major engineering transformation that increased product competitiveness and predictability across silicon products for computing, data centers, Internet of Things (IoT), wireless and connectivity from 2014 to 2019. Mr. Faintuch is also a former Qualcomm executive, where he served as President of Qualcomm Atheros, a large subsidiary of Qualcomm Inc. that develops wireless connectivity, LTE small cell, networking, infrastructure and

 

130


Table of Contents

IoT components from 2012 to 2014. His previous positions also include senior executive positions at Atheros communications and Texas Instruments. Mr. Faintuch holds a joint Master of Business Administration degree from Northwestern University, Kellogg School of Management and the Tel Aviv University, Recanati School of Management, as part of the Kellogg-Recanati International Executive MBA Program, and a bachelor’s degree from the University of Haifa.

Michael Hogan is Senior Vice President and General Manager of Automotive, Industrial and Multi-Market business unit since September 2019. He has more than 35 years of experience in the semiconductor industry. Prior to joining GF in 2019, Mr. Hogan was Senior Vice President and General Manager of IoT (Internet of Things) Compute and Wireless at Cypress Semiconductor from 2016 to 2019. From 2011 to 2016, he held a variety of business line management and strategy roles at Broadcom/Avago across an array of wireless technologies, from Wi-Fi to cellular, prior to co-founding the IoT business that was subsequently divested to Cypress Semiconductor in 2016. Prior to that, he was CEO of PulseCore Semiconductor and Sirific Wireless from 2002 to 2008. Mr. Hogan was the founding General Manager of the WLAN (wireless local area network) business at Texas Instruments, where he held a variety of sales and business unit general manager roles during his 16-year tenure. He holds a bachelor’s degree from Syracuse University.

Americo Lemos is Senior Vice President of Asia Business Development and China Country President for GF since February 2019. He is responsible for growing the company’s business in these critical markets. Prior to joining GF, Mr. Lemos was Senior Vice President at Qualcomm, responsible for its data center business while also serving as Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Huaxintong, a joint venture between Qualcomm and the Guizhou Government in China from 2016 to 2018. Prior to joining Qualcomm, Mr. Lemos was Vice President of Platform Engineering at Intel, responsible for strategic ventures with China semiconductor companies from 2009 to 2015. Before Intel, Mr. Lemos held leadership roles with Texas Instruments, Quanta Computer in Taiwan and Skyworks. He holds a Master of Sciences, Electronics and Computers degree from École Nationale Supérieure de Sciences Appliquées et de Technologie (ENSSAT) in Lannion, France.

Thomas Weber is Senior Vice President of Global Operations Support and Supply Chain for GF since October 2018. Previously, he was a Senior Vice President in McKinsey’s transformation practice where he led business transformations in the United States, Europe and Australia across the technology and resources industries from 2011 to 2018. Prior to McKinsey, he worked in the mobile devices industry developing strategy for Motorola and selling consumer research for Nielsen from 2004 to 2011. Mr. Weber began his career in the U.S. Navy where he flew helicopters and led a division through two deployments. Mr. Weber graduated from the U.S. Naval Academy and has a Master of Science in Engineering degree from the University of Pennsylvania.

Corporate Governance

Composition of our Board of Directors

Our board of directors currently consists of ten members, all of whom were elected pursuant to our Memorandum and Articles of Association. The board is divided into three classes designated as Class I, Class II and Class III, with the members of each class each serving staggered, three-year terms. The terms of our Class I directors will expire at the 2022 annual general meeting of members; the terms of our Class II directors will expire at the 2023 annual meeting of members; and the terms of our Class III directors will expire at the 2024 annual meeting of members. At the expiration of the respective terms of the Class I, Class II and Class III directors, new Class I, Class II and Class III directors will be elected to serve for a full term of the three years respectively.

Dr. Thomas Caulfield, Ahmed Saeed Al Calily, Tim Breen and Glenda Dorchak serve as Class I directors (with terms expiring in 2022). Martin L. Edelman, David Kerko, Jack Lazar and Carlos Obeid serve as Class II directors (with terms expiring in 2023). Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi and Elissa E. Murphy serve as Class III directors (with terms expiring in 2024).

 

131


Table of Contents

While we do not have a formal policy regarding board diversity, our nominating & governance committee and board of directors will consider a broad range of factors relating to the qualifications and background of nominees, which may include diversity (not limited to race, gender or national origin). Our nominating & governance committee’s and board of directors’ priority in selecting board members is identification of persons who will further the interests of our shareholders through their established record of professional accomplishment, the ability to contribute positively to the collaborative culture among board members, knowledge of our business, understanding of the competitive landscape and professional and personal experiences and expertise relevant to our growth strategy. Under a shareholder’s agreement to be entered into with Mubadala through two of its subsidiaries holding our ordinary shares, MTIC and MTIIIC (the “Shareholder’s Agreement”) prior to the consummation of this offering, we will agree to nominate for election to our board of directors a certain number of designees selected by Mubadala. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Shareholder’s Agreement.”

There is no Cayman Islands law requirement that a director must hold office for a certain term and stand for re-election unless the resolutions appointing the director impose a term on the appointment. We do not have any age limit requirements relating to our director’s term of office.

The Shareholder’s Agreement will provide that, for so long as MTIC, MTIIIC and certain of their affiliates (the “Mubadala Entities”), in the aggregate, beneficially own 50% or more of the ordinary shares held by the Mubadala Entities upon consummation of this offering, MTIC will be entitled to nominate a number of designees (the “Mubadala Designees”) to our board of directors representing a majority of our directors. We expect MTIC to designate the following directors as Mubadala Designees as of the date of consummation of this offering: Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi, Ahmed Saeed Al Calily, Tim Breen, Martin L. Edelman, and Carlos Obeid. By making such designation, MTIC retains the right to appoint any additional Mubadala Designees in accordance with the Shareholder’s Agreement and the Memorandum and Articles of Association.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association also provide that our directors may only be removed for cause by an affirmative vote of 75% of our shareholders, provided that (1) a Mubadala Designee may only be removed with or without cause by MTIC, and (2) as long as the Mubadala Entities beneficially own in the aggregate at least 50% of our outstanding ordinary shares, directors other than Mubadala Designees may be removed with or without cause by a majority of shareholders. Any vacancy resulting from an enlargement of our board of directors (which shall not exceed any maximum number stated in our Memorandum and Articles of Association), may be filled by ordinary resolution or by vote of a majority of our directors then in office; provided that any vacancy with respect to a Mubadala Designee may only be filled by a decision of majority of the Mubadala Designees then in office, or if there are none, by MTIC.

Board’s Role in Risk Oversight

Our board of directors oversees the management of risks inherent in the operation of our business and the implementation of our business strategies. Our board of directors performs this oversight role by using several different levels of review. In connection with its reviews of our operations and corporate functions, our board of directors addresses the primary risks associated with those operations and corporate functions. In addition, our board of directors reviews the risks associated with our business strategies periodically throughout the year as part of its consideration of undertaking any such business strategies.

Each of our board committees also oversees the management of our risk that falls within the committee’s areas of responsibility. In performing this function, each committee has full access to management, as well as the ability to engage advisors. Our Chief Financial Officer provides reports to the audit, risk and compliance committee and is responsible for identifying, evaluating and implementing risk management controls and methodologies to address any identified risks. In connection with its risk management role, our audit, risk and compliance committee meets privately with representatives from our independent registered public accounting firm and our Chief Financial Officer. The audit, risk and compliance committee oversees the operation of our

 

132


Table of Contents

risk management program, including the identification of the primary risks associated with our business and periodic updates to such risks, and reports to our board of directors regarding these activities.

Board Committees

Our board of directors has established an audit, risk and compliance committee, a people and compensation committee, a strategy and technology committee and a nominating & governance committee, each of which operates pursuant to a separate charter adopted by our board of directors.

Audit, Risk and Compliance Committee

Glenda Dorchak, Jack Lazar and Carlos Obeid currently serve on the audit, risk and compliance committee, which is chaired by Jack Lazar. Our board of directors has determined that Glenda Dorchak and Jack Lazar are “independent” for audit, risk and compliance committee purposes as that term is defined in the rules of the SEC and the applicable rules of the Nasdaq. We intend to have a fully independent audit, risk and compliance committee within one year from effectiveness of our initial public offering registration statement, as permitted by Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act. The audit, risk and compliance committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

appointing our independent registered public accounting firm, and approving the audit and permitted non-audit services to be provided by our independent registered public accounting firm;

 

   

evaluating the performance and independence of our independent registered public accounting firm;

 

   

monitoring the integrity of our financial statements and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements as they relate to our financial statements or accounting matters;

 

   

reviewing the adequacy and effectiveness of our accounting and internal control policies and procedures;

 

   

establishing and overseeing procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment of accounting-related complaints and concerns;

 

   

reviewing and discussing with the independent registered public accounting firm the results of our year-end audit, and recommending to our board of directors, based upon such review and discussions, whether our financial statements shall be included in our Annual Report on Form 20-F; and

 

   

reviewing all related party transactions for potential conflict of interest situations and approving all such transactions.

We have one financial expert as of the date hereof. Our board of directors has determined that Jack Lazar qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” as defined in SEC rules and satisfies the financial sophistication requirements of the Nasdaq.

People and Compensation Committee

Ahmed Saeed Al Calily, Tim Breen, David Kerko and Elissa E. Murphy currently serve on the people and compensation committee, which is chaired by David Kerko. The people and compensation committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

establishing and reviewing the goals and objectives of our executive compensation plans;

 

   

establishing the goals and objectives relevant to Chief Executive Officer compensation, and making recommendations to our board of directors in evaluating our Chief Executive Officer’s performance in light of these goals and objectives;

 

   

evaluating the performance of our executive officers in light of the goals and objectives of our executive compensation plans and making recommendations to our board of directors with respect to the compensation of our executive officers, including our Chief Executive Officer;

 

   

making recommendations to our board of directors with respect to improvement of existing, or adoption of new, employee compensation plans and programs; and

 

133


Table of Contents
   

retaining and approving the compensation of executive compensation advisors and other advisors advising the people and compensation committee.

Strategy and Technology Committee

Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi, Dr. Thomas Caulfield, Tim Breen, Glenda Dorchak and David Kerko currently serve on the strategy and technology committee, which is chaired by Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi. The strategy and technology committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

assisting our board of directors in reviewing significant investments, divestments, joint ventures, partnerships, and other strategic agreements;

 

   

providing guidance to our board of directors on long range strategy and business plans;

 

   

assisting our board of directors in reviewing our technology road map; and

 

   

assisting our board of directors in reviewing strategic long-term customer and supplier agreements.

Nominating & Governance Committee

Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi, Glenda Dorchak, Martin L. Edelman and David Kerko currently serve on the nominating & governance committee, which is chaired by Martin L. Edelman. The nominating & governance committee’s responsibilities include:

 

   

assisting our board of directors in identifying prospective director nominees and recommending nominees for election by the shareholders or appointment by our board of directors;

 

   

reviewing and assessing the adequacy of our corporate governance guidelines and recommending proposed changes to our board of directors; and

 

   

overseeing the evaluation of our board of directors.

Foreign Private Issuer Status

Nasdaq listing rules include certain accommodations in the corporate governance requirements that allow foreign private issuers, such as us, to follow “home country” corporate governance practices in lieu of the otherwise applicable corporate governance standards of the Nasdaq. The application of such exceptions requires that we disclose each Nasdaq corporate governance standard that we do not follow and describe the Cayman Islands corporate governance practices we do follow in lieu of the relevant Nasdaq corporate governance standard. We currently follow Cayman Islands corporate governance practices in lieu of the corporate governance requirements of the Nasdaq in respect of the following:

 

   

the majority independent director requirement under Section 5605(b)(1) of Nasdaq listing rules;

 

   

the requirement under Section 5605(d) of Nasdaq listing rules that a compensation committee comprised solely of independent directors governed by a compensation committee charter oversee executive compensation;

 

   

the requirement under Section 5605(e) of Nasdaq listing rules that director nominees be selected or recommended for selection by either a majority of the independent directors or a nominations committee comprised solely of independent directors;

 

   

the Shareholder Approval Requirements under Section 5635 of the Nasdaq listing rules; and

 

   

the requirement under Section 5605(b)(2) of Nasdaq listing rules that the independent directors have regularly scheduled meetings with only the independent directors present.

 

134


Table of Contents

Lead Independent Director

Our board of directors has appointed David Kerko to serve as our lead independent director. As lead independent director, Mr. Kerko presides over periodic meetings of our independent directors, serves as a liaison between the chairman of our board of directors and the independent directors and performs such additional duties as our board of directors may otherwise determine and delegate.

Code of Conduct and Code of Ethics

Our board has adopted a code of conduct that applies to all of our directors, officers and employees (the “Code of Conduct”). Our board has also adopted a code of ethics applicable to our executive officers and senior finance executives (the “Code of Ethics”), who must also comply with the Code of Conduct. Both the Code of Conduct and the Code of Ethics will be made available on our website: www.gf.com. We intend to disclose any amendments to the Code of Ethics, and any waivers of the Code of Ethics or the Code of Conduct for our directors, executive officers and senior finance executives, on our website to the extent required by applicable U.S. federal securities laws and the corporate governance rules of the Nasdaq.

Duties of Directors

Under Cayman Islands law, our directors have a duty to act honestly, in good faith and with a view to our best interests. Our directors also have a duty to exercise the care, diligence and skills that a reasonably prudent person would exercise in comparable circumstances (see “Description of Share Capital—Differences in Corporate Law”). In fulfilling their duty of care to us, our directors must ensure compliance with our Memorandum and Articles of Association. We have the right to seek damages if a duty owed by our directors is breached.

The functions and powers of our board of directors include, among others:

 

   

appointing officers and determining the term of office of the officers;

 

   

exercising the borrowing powers of the company and mortgaging the property of the company; and

 

   

executing checks, promissory notes and other negotiable instruments on behalf of the company.

Interested Transactions

No director shall be disqualified by their office from contracting and/or dealing with the company as vendor, purchaser or otherwise, nor shall any such contract or any contract or arrangement entered into by or on behalf of the company in which any director shall be in any way interested be or be liable to be avoided; nor shall any director so contracting or being so interested be liable to be avoided, nor shall any director so contracting or being so interested be liable to account to the company for any profit realized by any such contract or arrangement by reason of such director holding that office or the fiduciary relationship thereby established. However, any such transaction that would constitute a “related party transaction” pursuant to the laws or rules promulgated by the SEC, shall require the review and approval of the audit, risk and compliance committee. The nature of the director’s interest must be disclosed by such director at the meeting of the directors at which the contract or arrangement is considered if the director’s interest then exists, or in any other case, at the first meeting of the directors after the acquisition of his interest.

A director must promptly disclose the interest to all other directors after becoming aware of the fact that the director is interested in a transaction we have entered into or are to enter into. A general notice or disclosure to the board or otherwise contained in the minutes of a meeting or a written resolution of the board or any committee of the board that a director is a shareholder, director, officer or trustee of any specified firm or company and is to be regarded as interested in any transaction which may thereafter be made with such firm or company will be sufficient disclosure, and, after such general notice, it will not be necessary to give special notice relating to any particular transaction. A director may vote in respect of any contract or proposed contract or arrangement notwithstanding that they may be interested therein and if they do so, their vote shall be counted and they may be counted in the quorum at any meeting of the directors at which any such contract or proposed contract or arrangement shall come before the meeting for consideration.

 

135


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Under Cayman Islands law, we are not required to disclose compensation paid to our directors and executive officers on an individual basis and we have not otherwise publicly disclosed this information elsewhere.

For the year ended December 31, 2020, the aggregate compensation paid by us and our subsidiaries for our directors and executive officers for services in all capacities to us and our subsidiaries was $29,000,000, which includes both benefits paid in kind and compensation, as well as the grant of share option awards to purchase, in the aggregate, 1,250,000 ordinary shares with an exercise price equal to $10.00 per ordinary share pursuant to the terms and conditions of our 2018 Equity Plan. Share options awards granted pursuant to our 2018 Equity Plan are exercisable and expire as set forth in “2018 Equity Plan” below.

Of the amounts above, for the year ended December 31, 2020, $71,000 was set aside or accrued by us or our subsidiaries to provide defined contribution retirement benefits or similar benefits to our directors and executive officers.

In addition, some share options are expected to be exercised in calendar year 2022 as a result of our long term incentive plans. The number of share options that are currently expected to be exercised in calendar year 2022 is approximately 13.0 million.

Our executive compensation philosophy includes the following objectives:

 

   

To pay for performance;

 

   

To attract, develop, reward, and retain great talent; and

 

   

To motivate our talent to achieve short-term and long-term goals that lead to sustainable long-term shareholder value creation.

Our executive officers receive fixed and variable compensation. They also receive benefits in line with market practice and with the benefits extended to our broad-based employee population.

The fixed component of compensation consists of base salary. This provides a fixed source of income and acts as foundation for other pay components. The base salary is reflective of executive role, responsibility, and individual performance, and it is designed to be market-competitive and attract and retain critical talent. We review base salaries annually, and make adjustments as appropriate based on market, performance and any change in responsibility.

The variable pay elements of our executive officers’ compensation consist of an annual incentive program (“AIP”) and a long-term share option program.

While none of our directors have service contracts with us or our subsidiaries that provide for benefits upon termination of their services, consistent with market practice, certain of our executive officers are entitled to certain benefits upon termination, including a cash severance payment if we terminate their employment without cause.

Annual Incentive Program

The AIP is a short-term annual cash incentive that incentivizes and rewards our executive officers for achieving critical company financial and operational goals as well as individual goals. Each of our executives has an AIP target opportunity, set as a percentage of their base salary, which is reviewed annually to assure that both our performance and pay opportunities are aligned with competitive practices and that our rewards are reflective of company and individual performance.

In 2020, our executive officers’ awards under the AIP were determined as follows:

 

   

50% based on our financial and operational performance;

 

   

30% based on individual performance on key objectives; and

 

136


Table of Contents
   

20% based on our CEO’s discretion including but not limited to: leadership, employee engagement, diversity & inclusion, collaboration, business process improvement, strategic contributions and business context.

For our CEO and CFO, their 2020 AIP award payout was 75% based on our financial and operational performance and 25% as a discretionary component determined by our board of directors.

2017 LTIP

We maintain a long-term incentive plan (the “2017 LTIP”) pursuant to which a small number of current employees hold vested share options that were granted in 2017. Vested share options granted under the 2017 LTIP become exercisable upon the first anniversary of an IPO or change in control occurring following the vesting date but during the term of the share option. In connection with the establishment and adoption of the 2018 Equity Plan, we ceased making awards under the 2017 LTIP. As of October 13, 2021, there are 54,655 nonqualified share options to buy ordinary shares outstanding under the 2017 LTIP.

2018 Equity Plan

We maintain a long-term equity incentive program (the “2018 Equity Plan”) designed to enable our executives and select other high-performing and high-potential participants to share in the value creation of the company as we execute our business plan and deliver returns to our shareholders. Officers, employees, consultants, advisors and members of our board of directors are eligible to participate in the 2018 Equity Plan. The 2018 Equity Plan is administered by our people and compensation committee, which was delegated authority to administer the 2018 Equity Plan by our board of directors.

Awards under the 2018 Equity Plan may be granted in the form of nonqualified share options, share awards, or share unit awards. The vesting conditions and all other terms of these awards will be determined by the administrator of the 2018 Equity Plan and set out in the applicable award agreements.

Participants in the 2018 Equity Plan typically receive a one-time grant upon hire or promotion into an eligible role. As of October 13, 2021, there are 21,811,038 nonqualified share options to buy ordinary shares outstanding. Generally, awards of share options granted in 2020 or later vest over four years, with 25% of the share options vesting on the later of December 31 of the first four years following the grant date and the six-month anniversary of the consummation of an initial public offering, subject to continued employment through the applicable vesting date (with limited exceptions for certain qualifying terminations). The majority of share options granted in 2019 vest over five years, with 20% of the options vesting on the later of December 31 of the first five years following the grant date and the six-month anniversary of the consummation of an initial public offering, subject to continued employment through the applicable vesting date (with limited exceptions for certain qualifying terminations). Share options held by U.S. taxpayers that vest on the six-month anniversary of the consummation of this offering will be exercisable for a period commencing on the vesting date and ending on a fixed date in 2022. Any outstanding in the money exercisable share options not exercised as of the end of such period will be automatically exercised on the last day of such period. All other outstanding share options held by U.S. taxpayers will become exercisable for a period commencing on January 1 of the year following the year in which such share options vest and ending on a fixed date in such year, with any outstanding exercisable share options not exercised as of the end of such period being automatically exercised as of the last day of such period. Share options held by non-U.S. taxpayers will become exercisable on the date such share options vest and will remain exercisable, pursuant to normal share option exercise procedures under the terms and conditions of the 2018 Equity Plan for the duration of the term of the share option, with any outstanding exercisable share options not exercised before the expiration of such share options in accordance with their terms being automatically exercised as of the expiration date of the share options by means of “net exercise” in order to satisfy the exercise price and applicable taxes due in respect of such share options.

As of October 13, 2021 there are 546,200 restricted share unit awards to our employees outstanding. Generally, awards of share units vest over four years, with 25% of the share units vesting on each of the first four

 

137


Table of Contents

anniversaries of the earlier of the grant date or the participant’s hire or promotion date, subject to continued employment through the applicable vesting date (with limited exceptions for certain qualifying terminations). In addition, in connection with this offering certain current and former non-employee members of our board of directors were granted 92,293 restricted share units awards in the aggregate under the 2018 Equity Plan which generally vest over three years, with 33% of the share units vesting on the first three anniversaries of the grant date, subject to their continued provision of services (whether as a non-employee director or otherwise) to the company through the applicable vesting date.

As of October 13, 2021, there are 2,550,470 ordinary shares that remain available for grant under the 2018 Equity Plan. No awards may be granted under the 2018 Equity Plan after our board of directors terminates the 2018 Equity Plan or ten years from its effective date, whichever is earlier.

Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program

We maintain a bonus program (the “Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program”) pursuant to which eligible optionholders under our 2018 Equity Plan may receive cash awards depending on financial results linked to annual operating cash flow and other financial metrics.

If our board of directors determines that any amounts are to be paid under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program, the aggregate amount of the cash payment to be received by any participant is based on the per share bonus payment amount, a multiple determined by the board and the number of outstanding share options to which the award under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program relates, with the aggregate cash payment pro-rated based on the number of vested share options as of each payment date over the vesting schedule of the share option. Payment of any amounts under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program is independent of and not contingent upon the exercise of any share options.

While awards under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program may be granted in 2021, and payable in the ordinary course in January 2022, no new awards are expected to be granted under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program in respect of calendar year 2022 or beyond and existing awards will continue to be paid out on their current payment schedule. If we issue share awards or share unit awards prior to the consummation of this offering, eligible holders of such awards may also participate in the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program, with the amount of any payment to be received based on the number of outstanding share awards or share unit awards to which the award under the Shareholder Proceeds Bonus Program relates.

2021 Equity Compensation Plan

In connection with, and prior to the consummation of, this offering, our board of directors adopted, and Mubadala is expected to approve, the GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. 2021 Equity Compensation Plan (the “Equity Plan”). Our Equity Plan will be administered by our board of directors or, as applicable, its delegate (the “Equity Plan Administrator”).

The purpose of the Equity Plan is to attract and retain certain employees, non-employee directors, consultants, and advisors. All of our (and our subsidiaries’) employees, non-employee directors and key advisors and consultants who perform services for us are eligible to receive awards under the Equity Plan. The Equity Plan provides for the issuance of incentive share options, non-qualified share options, share awards, share units, share appreciation rights, and other share-based awards.

The Equity Plan Administrator will determine the allocation of awards and all of the terms and conditions applicable to awards under the Equity Plan, except that awards to members of our board of directors must be authorized by a majority of our board of directors.

Subject to adjustment as described below, the maximum aggregate number of our ordinary shares that may be issued or transferred under the Equity Plan with respect to awards will be 17,500,000 ordinary shares; provided that the share reserve under the Equity Plan will, unless otherwise determined by our board of directors, automatically

 

138


Table of Contents

increase on January 1 of each year for 10 years commencing on January 1, 2023 and ending on (and including) January 1, 2032 in an amount equal to 1% of the total number of ordinary shares outstanding on December 31 of the preceding year.

In general, if any share options or share appreciation rights terminate, expire or are canceled, forfeited, exchanged, or surrendered without having been exercised, or if any share awards, share units or other share-based awards are forfeited, terminated, or otherwise not paid in full in our ordinary shares, the shares subject to such awards will again be available for purposes of the Equity Plan. In addition, the maximum aggregate value of our ordinary shares subject to new awards made to any non-employee director pursuant to the Equity Plan, together with any cash fees earned by such non-employee director, for services rendered as a non-employee director during any calendar year, will not exceed $1,500,000, which value will be calculated based on the grant date fair value of such awards for financial reporting purposes.

In connection with certain events affecting the outstanding ordinary shares reserved for issuance as awards, the Equity Plan Administrator will equitably adjust the maximum number and kind of our ordinary shares available for issuance under the Equity Plan, the maximum number and kind of ordinary shares for which any individual may receive awards in any year, the kind and number of shares covered by outstanding awards, the kind and number of shares that may be issued under the Equity Plan, and the price per share or market value of any outstanding awards, and other conditions as the Equity Plan Administrator deems appropriate to prevent the enlargement or dilution of rights under the Equity Plan.

If there is a change in control and awards are not assumed by, or replaced with grants that have comparable terms by, the surviving corporation, all outstanding share options and share appreciation rights will immediately vest and become exercisable, any restrictions on share awards will lapse, and all other awards will become payable as of the date of the change in control. If there is a change in control and we (or our successor) terminate a participant’s employment without cause upon or within one year after the change in control, the participant’s outstanding share options and share appreciation rights will vest and become exercisable, any restrictions on share awards will lapse, and all other awards will become payable. In each of the foregoing events, awards based on performance objectives will vest and be payable in accordance with the terms set forth in the applicable award agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the committee may establish any other terms and conditions relating to the effect of a change in control on awards as the Equity Plan Administrator deems appropriate and take any of the actions enumerated under the terms and conditions of the Equity Plan, without the consent of any participant.

Except as permitted by the committee with respect to non-qualified share options, only a participant may exercise rights under an award during the participant’s lifetime. Upon death, the personal representative or other person entitled to succeed to the rights of the participant may exercise such rights. A participant cannot transfer those rights except by will or by the laws of descent and distribution or pursuant to a domestic relations order. The committee may provide in an award agreement that a participant may transfer non-qualified share options to family members, or one or more trusts or other entities for the benefit of or owned by family members, consistent with applicable securities laws.

Our board of directors may amend or terminate the Equity Plan at any time, except that our shareholders must approve an amendment if such approval is required in order to comply with the Code, applicable laws, or applicable stock exchange requirements. Unless terminated sooner by our board of directors or extended with shareholder approval, the Equity Plan will terminate on the day immediately preceding the tenth anniversary of its effective date.

 

139


Table of Contents

2021 Employee Stock Purchase Plan

In connection with, and prior to the consummation of, this offering, our board of directors adopted, and Mubadala is expected to approve, the GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. 2021 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “ESPP”). Our ESPP will be administered by our board of directors or, as applicable, its delegate (the “ESPP Administrator”).

Any of our employees, or any employees of a subsidiary or affiliate that the ESPP Administrator has designated as eligible to participate in an offering, will be eligible to participate in an offering under the ESPP, other than an employee who owns ordinary shares possessing 5% or more of our voting shares, or the voting shares of a parent or subsidiary, or certain other employees as determined by the ESPP Administrator.

Our ESPP will permit eligible employees to purchase our ordinary shares through contributions in the form of payroll deductions (by timely delivering a subscription agreement to us) or otherwise, as permitted by the ESPP Administrator. The ESPP permits two types of offerings: (1) an offering intended to qualify for favorable U.S. federal tax treatment under Section 423 of the Code; and (2) an offering not intended to be tax qualified under Section 423 of the Code to facilitate participation for employees who are not eligible to benefit from favorable U.S. federal tax treatment and, to the extent applicable, to provide flexibility to comply with non-U.S. law and other considerations. The timing of the offering periods will be determined by the ESPP Administrator.

The terms and conditions applicable to each offering period will be set forth in an offering document adopted by the ESPP Administrator for the particular offering period. We also may choose to issue matching ordinary shares with respect to ordinary shares purchased under the ESPP for an offering period. In that event, on the relevant ESPP purchase date, we will grant to each eligible employee in the ESPP a number of ordinary shares with a fair market value equal to a percentage of the aggregate purchase price paid to exercise the employee’s right to purchase ordinary shares on such purchase date. Such matching percentage for each purchase period shall be established by the ESPP Administrator in an offering document.

Subject to certain equitable adjustments in connection with certain events affecting the outstanding ordinary shares reserved for issuance as awards, the maximum aggregate number of our ordinary shares that may be issued or transferred under the ESPP with respect to awards will be 7,500,000 ordinary shares; provided that the share reserve under the ESPP will, unless otherwise determined by our board of directors, automatically increase on January 1 of each year for 8 years commencing on January 1, 2023 and ending on (and including) January 1, 2031 in an amount equal to 0.25% of the total number of ordinary shares outstanding on December 31 of the preceding year. In no event will the number of ordinary shares that may be issued or transferred pursuant to rights granted under the ESPP exceed 18,750,000, in the aggregate, subject to the adjustments described above.

The ESPP Administrator will have the authority to amend, suspend or terminate the ESPP. However, shareholder approval shall be required to amend the ESPP to increase the aggregate number or change the class of shares that may be sold pursuant to rights under the ESPP (other than an adjustment as provided above) or as may otherwise be required under Section 423 of the Code or as may otherwise be required by applicable stock exchange requirements.

Share Ownership

The shares and any outstanding beneficially owned by our directors and officers and/or entities affiliated with these individuals are disclosed in the section titled “Principal and Selling Shareholder.”

 

140


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Loan and Credit Agreements with MTHC

On March 20, 2017, we entered into a loan agreement with MTHC under which we could borrow up to $580 million. Subsequently, on November 27, 2017 we entered into an amended agreement that reduced the maximum loan amount under the facility to $380 million. The loan matured on December 31, 2020 and had an interest rate of LIBOR plus 2.3%. During the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, we made principal repayments of $112 million and $247 million, respectively.

On June 13, 2017, we entered into a loan agreement with MTHC that provided us a USD facility under which we could borrow up to $860 million for the purpose of acquiring equipment for a 300mm fab in Chengdu High Technology Zone, Chengdu China. We drew down $0 and $26 million during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. As of December 31, 2018, we entered into an amendment to the loan agreement to reduce the maximum loan amount under the facility from $860 million to $31 million and revise the maturity date to December 31, 2019. The loan had an interest rate of LIBOR plus 2.3%.

On June 19, 2018, we entered into a bridge loan agreement with MTHC that provided a USD facility under which we could borrow up to $250 million. The loan matured on August 31, 2018 and had an interest rate of three-month LIBOR plus 2.25% per annum. As of August 14, 2018, we entered into an amendment to the loan agreement to extend the termination date to December 31, 2018. We repaid the loan during the year ended December 31, 2018.

On June 5, 2019, we entered into a credit agreement with Morgan Stanley and several lenders, including MTHC. MTHC provided us facilities under which we could borrow up to $36 million and EUR17 million. We repaid the facilities during the year ended December 31, 2020.

MTHC Revolving Credit Facility

On December 15, 2013, we entered into a revolving credit agreement with MTHC that provided for an aggregate commitment of $600 million. Subsequently, on November 28, 2017, we entered into an amended agreement to reduce the aggregate commitment to $400 million. As further amended on July 27, 2020, the revolving credit agreement terminates on December 31, 2023, unless MTHC elects to terminate the facility upon the company ceasing to be a direct or indirect wholly owned subsidiary of Mubadala. Amounts outstanding under the loan bear interest at LIBOR plus 1.5%. No amounts were drawn down on this facility as of December 31, 2020 and we intend to terminate it in connection with the closing of this offering.

SMP

Silicon Manufacturing Partners Pte Ltd. (“SMP”) is a joint venture with LSI Technology (Singapore) Pte. Ltd. We hold a 49% interest in SMP and manage all aspects of its manufacturing operations. In the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively, we purchased products, primarily wafers, from SMP for an aggregate of $57 million and $62 million. We also reimbursed expenses of and contributed tools to SMP in those periods, with an aggregate expense of $47 million and $51 million, respectively.

AMTC and BAC

On January 1, 2020, we obtained control of the Advanced Mask Technology Centre GmbH & Co. KG (“AMTC”) and Maskhouse Building Administration GmbH & Co. KG (“BAC”) joint venture with Toppan Photomasks, Inc. through an amendment of the joint venture agreement (the “AMTC JV Agreement”), which granted us the determining vote over changes in the business plans of AMTC and BAC. We consolidated the joint venture effective January 1, 2020. We continue to hold 50% of the voting securities in AMTC and BAC. No

 

141


Table of Contents

consideration was paid to the non-controlling shareholder as a result of the amendment to the joint venture agreement. In accordance with the AMTC JV Agreement, AMTC is responsible for performing development and production of advanced masks, and BAC is responsible for the acquisition, administration and leasing of real estate, and is the holder of the land and building that is used by AMTC for its operations.

Transactions with AMTC and BAC prior to January 1, 2020

Under the AMTC JV Agreement, as amended, we are entitled to 70% of AMTC’s manufacturing capacity. We provided AMTC with capital equipment and made unsecured loans to AMTC in order to fund such equipment, which amounted to $166 million and $162 million in the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The loans carried a fixed interest rate of 4.0% and repayments were to be made quarterly over eight years. Additionally, we made unsecured loans to BAC, which amounted to $9 million and $3 million in the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The loans carried a fixed interest rate of 5.081% and repayments were to be made quarterly over five years.

On January 20, 2011, we entered into a tool usage agreement with AMTC (the “Tool Usage Agreement”). Under this agreement, we are providing AMTC with permission to use a certain inspection tool owned by us for the purpose of production and development of masks for us and our affiliates (the “Tool”). The costs and expenses relating to the operation, maintenance or use of the Tool are being charged by AMTC pursuant to the AMTC JV Agreement. We are not charging AMTC for use of the Tool. The Tool Usage Agreement will expire upon the termination of the AMTC JV Agreement.

Mubadala

Shareholder Loan Facilities

We entered into several loan facilities with a subsidiary of Mubadala, none of which currently remain outstanding. Under those loan agreements, we have received the following funds during those years, and repaid the following amounts through August 31, 2021:

 

2012 Shareholder Loan

   $ 1,915,000,000  

2013 Shareholder Loan

     1,780,000,000  

2014 Shareholder Loan

     3,885,000,000  

2015 Shareholder Loan

     3,395,000,000  

2016 Shareholder Loan

     592,687,000  
  

 

 

 
     11,567,687,000  

2019 Repayment

     (400,000,000

2020 Repayment

     (487,000,000

2021 Repayment

     (568,000,000
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 10,112,687,000  
  

 

 

 

Each of the 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015 and 2016 loans from Mubadala (collectively the “Shareholder Loans”) were non-interest bearing and principal repayment, in whole or in part, was entirely at our discretion as explicitly stated in the loan agreements. The Shareholder Loans were subordinated to any claims of other unsubordinated and subordinated creditors, including beneficiaries under guarantees issued, of the company. The Shareholder Loans had no maturity date. On October 1, 2021, our board approved the Conversion, and on October 3, 2021, we executed the Conversion. The Conversion did not have an impact on shares outstanding or have any dilutive effects, as no additional shares were issued.

 

142


Table of Contents

Further Assurances Agreement

On July 1, 2015, in connection with our acquisition of IBM’s Microelectronics division, Mubadala Development Company PJSC (“MDC”), an affiliate of Mubadala, entered into a further assurances agreement (the “Further Assurances Agreement”) with IBM, under which MDC provided a guarantee of our obligations to IBM, which would have been triggered upon certain insolvency events, in an amount not to exceed $375 million. The Further Assurances Agreement expired on July 1, 2019.

Soitec

Douglas Dunn, a member of our board of directors from 2013 to 2019, was also a director of Soitec until July 2018. For information about our transactions with Soitec, see “Business—Raw Materials.”

Secondments

Between January 1, 2018 and the date of this prospectus, Mubadala has seconded seven persons to us. Two secondees, including Tim Breen, who is a member of our board of directors and previously served as an executive officer of the company, continue to be seconded to us as of the date of this prospectus. From January 1, 2018 through December 31, 2020, we paid Mubadala an average annual amount of $1.78 million in consideration of the services provided by the secondees.

Shareholder’s Agreement

Prior to the consummation of this offering, we intend to enter into the Shareholder’s Agreement.

The Shareholder’s Agreement will provide that, for so long as the Mubadala Entities, in the aggregate, beneficially own 50% or more of the ordinary shares held by the Mubadala Entities upon consummation of this offering, MTIC will be entitled to nominate a number of Mubadala Designees to our board of directors representing a majority of our directors. The Shareholder’s Agreement will also specify how such nomination rights will decrease as the Mubadala Entities’ beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares decreases. Specifically, for so long as the Mubadala Entities, in the aggregate, beneficially own (i) 40% or more, but less than 50%, (ii) 30% or more, but less than 40%, (iii) 20% or more, but less than 30%, and (iv) 5% or more, but less than 20%, of the ordinary shares held by the Mubadala Entities upon consummation of this offering, MTIC shall be entitled to Mubadala Designees on our board of directors representing at least 50%, 40%, 30% and 20%, respectively, of our directors. The Shareholder’s Agreement will provide that for so long as MTIC is entitled to nominate at least 30% of our directors, the chairman of our board of directors shall be appointed by a majority vote of the Mubadala Designees directors.

The Shareholder’s Agreement will specify that, where there is a vacant board position in respect of a Mubadala Designee director, such vacancy shall be filled only by a decision of a majority of the Mubadala Designee directors then in office or, if there are no such directors then in office, by MTIC. Additionally, we will include the Mubadala Designees on the slate that is included in our proxy statement relating to the appointment of directors of the class to which such persons belong and provide the highest level of support for the appointment of each such person as we provide to any other individual standing for appointment as a director.

The Shareholder’s Agreement also specifies that until such time as the Mubadala Entities no longer beneficially own at least 30% of our outstanding ordinary shares, we will not, nor will we permit our subsidiaries, to take certain significant actions specified therein without the prior consent of MTIC. These actions include:

 

   

amendments or modifications to, or repealing of, (whether by merger, consolidation or otherwise) any provisions of our organizational documents in a manner that would adversely affect the Mubadala Entities beneficially owning outstanding ordinary shares;

 

   

issuances of equity securities, subject to customary exceptions;

 

143


Table of Contents
   

acquisitions or dispositions in an amount exceeding $300 million in any single transaction or $500 million in any calendar year, other than pursuant to ordinary course transactions;

 

   

mergers, consolidations, or other transactions that would involve a change of control of our company;

 

   

incurring financial indebtedness in an amount exceeding $200 million, subject to certain exceptions;

 

   

hiring or terminating our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer or Chief Legal Officer or designating any replacement thereto;

 

   

liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our company;

 

   

any material change in the nature of the business of our company and our subsidiaries, taken as a whole; or

 

   

changes to the size of our board of directors.

The Shareholder’s Agreement will entitle the Mubadala Entities to certain information rights. The Mubadala Entities will be permitted to share such disclosed information with other Mubadala Entities and their directors, officers, employees, consultants, advisers, and financing providers, provided that the recipient maintain the confidentiality of such disclosed information.

We will agree to use our reasonable best efforts, if permitted by applicable law and regulation (including, in particular, our audit, risk and compliance committee’s responsibilities under U.S. securities laws and regulations) and if in the best interests of the company, to select the same independent certified public accounting firm, or auditor, used by Mubadala (or an affiliate of such auditor) and to provide to Mubadala as much prior notice as reasonably practical of any change in our auditor until the first fiscal year end occurring after the date on which Mubadala and any entities owned by the Government of Abu Dhabi, together with their subsidiaries, no longer own in aggregate at least 25% of the voting power of our then outstanding securities. When selecting our auditor, we have agreed that we will give due consideration to the benefits arising to our company from the use of the same auditor as Mubadala (or an affiliate of such auditor).

The Shareholder’s Agreement will be governed by Cayman Islands law and will terminate on the earlier to occur of (i) such time as the Mubadala Entities, in aggregate, cease to beneficially own 5% or more of our outstanding ordinary shares, and (ii) upon the delivery of a written notice by MTIC to us requesting its termination.

Certain of the provisions of the Shareholder’s Agreement have been included in our Memorandum and Articles of Association.

Registration Rights Agreement

Prior to the consummation of this offering, we intend to enter into a registration rights agreement with MTIC and MTIIIC, pursuant to which those holders of ordinary shares will be entitled to demand the registration of the sale of certain or all of our ordinary shares that they beneficially own (the “Registration Rights Agreement”). Among other things, under the terms of the Registration Rights Agreement:

 

   

Each holder will have an unlimited right, subject to certain conditions and exceptions, to request that we file registration statements with the SEC for one or more underwritten offerings of all or part of our ordinary shares that the holder beneficially owns, and we will be required to cause any such registration statements (a) to be filed with the SEC as promptly as practicable and (b) to use commercially reasonable efforts to cause such registration statements to become effective as soon as reasonably practicable;

 

   

If we propose to file certain types of registration statements under the Securities Act with respect to an offering of equity securities by us, we will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to offer the other parties to the Registration Rights Agreement, if any, the opportunity to register the sale of all or part of their shares on the terms and conditions set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement (customarily known as “piggyback rights”); and

 

144


Table of Contents
   

All expenses of registration under the Registration Rights Agreement, including the legal fees of one counsel retained by or on behalf of the holders, will be paid by us.

The registration rights granted in the Registration Rights Agreement will be subject to customary restrictions such as minimum offering sizes, blackout periods and, if a registration is underwritten, any limitations on the number of shares to be included in the underwritten offering as reasonably advised by the managing underwriter. The rights of the holders under the Registration Rights Agreement will be assignable to certain transferees of the holders’ ordinary shares. The Registration Rights Agreement will also contain customary indemnification and contribution provisions. The Registration Rights Agreement will be governed by New York law.

Directed Share Program

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 2,750,000 ordinary shares, or up to 5% of the shares offered by us and Mubadala in this offering, for sale at the initial public offering price through a directed share program to certain employees and other related persons identified by us. The number of ordinary shares available for sale to the general public will be reduced to the extent that such persons purchase such reserved shares. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered by this prospectus. Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC will administer our directed share program as described in the section titled “Underwriters—Directed Share Program.”

 

145


Table of Contents

PRINCIPAL AND SELLING SHAREHOLDER

The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our ordinary shares as of October 13, 2021, as adjusted to reflect the sale of ordinary shares offered by us and Mubadala in this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase 8,250,000 additional ordinary shares to cover over-allotments, for:

 

   

each of our named executive officers;

 

   

each of our directors;

 

   

all of our directors and executive officers as a group;

 

   

each person known by us to be the beneficial owner of more than 5% of our outstanding shares of ordinary shares; and

 

   

the selling shareholder.

We have determined beneficial ownership in accordance with the rules of the SEC. Unless otherwise indicated below, to our knowledge, based on information furnished to us, the persons and entities named in the table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares that they beneficially own, subject to applicable community property laws. In addition, the following table does not reflect any ordinary shares that may be purchased in this offering or pursuant to our directed share program described under “Underwriters—Directed Share Program.”

 

     Shares Beneficially Owned
Prior to this Offering and
the Concurrent Private
Placement
    Shares Being
Offered
     Shares Beneficially Owned
After this Offering and the
Concurrent Private
Placement
 

Name of Beneficial Owner

   Shares     Percentage      Shares      Percentage  

Mubadala Investment Company PJSC

     500,000,000 (1)(2)      100     22,000,000        478,000,000        89.4

Directors and named executive officers:

            

Dr. Thomas Caulfield

     0       *                      

David Reeder

     0       *                      

Kay Chai (KC) Ang

     0       *                      

Saam Azar

     0       *                      

Juan Cordovez

     0       *                      

Emily Reilly

     0       *                      

Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi

     0       *                      

Ahmed Saeed Al Calily

     0       *                      

Khaled Abdulla Al Qubaisi

     0       *                      

Tim Breen

     0       *                      

Dr. Jin-Yong Cai

     0       *                      

Glenda Dorchak

     0       *                      

Martin L. Edelman

     0       *                      

David Kerko

     0       *                      

Jack Lazar

     0       *                      

Carlos Obeid

     0       *                      

 

(1)

378,273,074 ordinary shares held by MTIC, and 121,726,926 ordinary shares held by MTIIIC, both wholly owned subsidiaries of Mubadala Technology Investments LLC. The address of Mubadala is Mamoura A Building Abu Dhabi, 45005 United Arab Emirates.

(2)

Reflects the effect of the 1-for-2 reverse share split approved by our board of directors on September 9, 2021 and effected on September 12, 2021.

 

*

Certain of our directors and executive officers hold vested options that will become exercisable for a period of time after the expiration of the applicable lock-up period and restricted share units that will vest on certain dates following expiration of the applicable lock-up period.

As of the date of this prospectus, Mubadala through its subsidiaries, MTIC and MTIIIC, is the sole shareholder of the entirety of our share capital, which consists of 500,000,000 ordinary shares. Mubadala is our ultimate parent company.

 

146


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF SHARE CAPITAL

We are an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability on October 7, 2008.

Our corporate purposes are unrestricted and we have the authority to carry out any object not prohibited by any law as provided by Section 7(4) of the Cayman Companies Act.

Our affairs are governed principally by: (1) our Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association (the “Memorandum and Articles of Association”); (2) the Cayman Companies Act; and (3) the common law of the Cayman Islands. As provided in our Memorandum and Articles of Association, subject to Cayman Islands law, we have full capacity to carry on or undertake any business or activity, do any act or enter into any transaction, and, for such purposes, full rights, powers and privileges. Our registered office is c/o Maples Corporate Services Limited, PO Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands.

The following are summaries of material provisions of our Memorandum and Articles of Association and the Cayman Companies Act insofar as they relate to the material terms of our ordinary shares.

These summaries do not purport to be complete and are subject to the Memorandum and Articles of Association.

Throughout the following description of our share capital, we summarized the material terms of our ordinary shares as set forth in the Memorandum and Articles of Association. We have filed a copy of our complete Memorandum and Articles of Association as an exhibit to this registration statement on Form F-1.

Authorized Share Capital

Upon the completion of this offering, our authorized share capital will consist of 1,300,000,000 ordinary shares of US$0.02 per share and 200,000,000 preferred shares with a par value of US$0.02 per share of such class or classes (however designated) as the board of directors may determine in accordance with our Memorandum and Articles of Association.

Ordinary Shares

General

As of October 13, 2021, there were 500,000,000 ordinary shares issued, fully paid and outstanding held by two shareholders of record, which are wholly owned subsidiaries of Mubadala.

Voting Rights

Each ordinary share is entitled to one vote on all matters upon which the ordinary shares are entitled to vote. Voting at any meeting of shareholders is by show of hands unless a poll is demanded. A poll may be demanded by the chairman of the meeting, or by shareholders present in person or by proxy holding at least 10% of the shares giving the right to attend and vote at the meeting before or on the declaration of the result of the show of hands.

A quorum required for any general meeting of shareholders consists of, at the time when the meeting proceeds to business, one or more of our shareholders holding shares which carry in aggregate (or representing by proxy) not less than one-third of all votes attaching to all of our shares in issue and entitled to vote at such general meeting. As a Cayman Islands exempted company, we are not obliged by the Cayman Companies Act to call annual general meetings. Only the board of directors may call an annual general meeting or any

 

147


Table of Contents

extraordinary general meeting. The Cayman Companies Act does not provide shareholders with rights to requisition a general meeting, and does not provide shareholders with any right to put any proposal before a general meeting. However, these rights may be provided in a company’s articles of association. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that upon the requisition of any one or more of our shareholders holding shares which carry in aggregate not less than one-third of all votes attaching to all issued and outstanding shares of our company entitled to vote at general meetings, our board of directors will convene an extraordinary general meeting and put the resolutions so requisitioned to a vote at such meeting. However, our Memorandum and Articles of Association do not provide our shareholders with any right to put any proposals before annual general meetings or extraordinary general meetings not called by such shareholders.

Subject to regulatory requirements, the annual general meeting and any extraordinary general meetings must be called by not less than ten calendar days’ notice prior to the relevant shareholders meeting and convened by a notice discussed below. Alternatively, upon the prior consent of all holders entitled to attend and vote, with regards to the annual general meeting, or the holders of 95% in par value of the shares entitled to attend and vote at an extraordinary general meeting, that meeting may be convened by a shorter notice and in a manner deemed appropriate by those holders.

Generally speaking, an ordinary resolution to be passed by the shareholders at a general meeting requires the affirmative vote of a simple majority of the votes cast by, or on behalf of, the shareholders entitled to vote, present in person or by proxy and voting at the meeting and a special resolution requires the affirmative vote on a poll of no less than two-thirds of the votes cast by the shareholders entitled to vote who are present in person or by proxy at a general meeting. Both ordinary resolutions and special resolutions may also be passed by a unanimous written resolution signed by all of our shareholders, as permitted by the Cayman Companies Act and our Memorandum and Articles of Association.

A special resolution will be required for certain matters such as a change of name, amendments to our Memorandum and Articles of Association, and a reduction in our share capital or any capital redemption reserve fund. Our shareholders may effect certain changes by ordinary resolution, including increasing the amount of our authorized share capital, consolidating and dividing all or any of our share capital into shares of larger amounts than our existing shares, converting all or any of our paid-up shares into stocks and reconverting that stock into paid-up shares of any denomination, subdividing existing shares or dividing the whole or any part of our share capital into shares of smaller amounts or into shares without par value, and cancelling any authorized but unissued shares.

Dividends

The holders of our ordinary shares are entitled to such dividends as may be declared by our board of directors. Under the Cayman Companies Act, a Cayman Islands company may pay a dividend out of either profit or distributable reserves, including our share premium account, provided that in no circumstances may a dividend be paid if this would result in the company being unable to pay its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.

Liquidation

On a winding up of our company, if the assets available for distribution among the holders of our ordinary shares shall be more than sufficient to repay the whole of the share capital at the commencement of the winding up, the surplus will be distributed among the holders of our ordinary shares in proportion to the par value of the ordinary shares held by them at the commencement of the winding up subject to a deduction from those ordinary shares in respect of which there are monies due, of all monies payable to the us for unpaid calls or otherwise.

If our assets available for distribution are insufficient to repay the whole of the issued share capital, such assets will be distributed so that the losses are borne by the holders of our ordinary shares in proportion to the par value of the ordinary shares held by them.

 

148


Table of Contents

The liquidator may, with the sanction of a special resolution of our shareholders and any other sanction required by the Cayman Companies Act, divide among the shareholders in kind the whole or any part of the assets of our company, and may for that purpose value any assets and determine how the division shall be carried out as among our shareholders or different classes of shareholders. The liquidator may, with the same sanction, vest the whole or any part of such assets in trustees upon such trusts for the benefit of the shareholder as the liquidator, with the same sanction, shall think fit, but so that no shareholder shall be compelled to accept any asset upon which there is a liability.

Share Repurchase

The Cayman Companies Act and our Memorandum and Articles of Association permit us to purchase our own shares, subject to certain restrictions. The board of directors may only exercise this power on behalf us, subject to the Cayman Companies Act, our Memorandum and Articles of Association and to any applicable requirements imposed from time to time by the SEC or the applicable stock exchange on which our securities are listed.

Share Options and Restricted Share Unit Awards

As of October 13, 2021, options to purchase an aggregate of 21,811,038 ordinary shares and 638,493 restricted share unit awards were outstanding under the 2018 Equity Plan (and an additional 54,655 options to purchase ordinary shares were outstanding under the 2017 LTIP), and 2,550,740 additional shares of ordinary shares were available for future grant under the 2018 Equity Plan.

Directors

The management of our company is vested in a board of directors. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association, which will become effective upon completion of this offering, provide that the number of directors will be determined by our board of directors. However, for so long as MTIC is entitled to nominate at least one director to the board of directors, the board of directors will not, without MTIC’s prior written consent, include more than twelve directors and until such time as the Mubadala Entities no longer beneficially own in the aggregate at least 30% of our outstanding ordinary shares, the number of directors may not be changed without the prior written consent of MTIC.

In accordance with our Memorandum and Articles of Association, our board of directors will be divided into three classes of directors, with the directors in each class serving staggered three-year terms. The quorum necessary for any meeting of our board of directors shall consist of a simple majority of the members provided that, for so long as the Mubadala Entities are entitled to nominate one Mubadala Designee to our board of directors, the presence of at least one Mubadala Designee shall be required on first call to a meeting of the board of directors.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association will also include certain veto rights in favor of the Mubadala Entities providing that until such time as the Mubadala Entities no longer beneficially own at least 30% of our outstanding ordinary shares, the board of directors will require the prior written consent of MTIC to take, or to permit our subsidiaries to take, the following actions:

 

   

issuances of equity securities, subject to customary exceptions;

 

   

acquisitions or dispositions in an amount exceeding $300 million in any single transaction or $500 million in any calendar year, other than in the ordinary course of business;

 

   

mergers, consolidations, or other transactions that would involve a change of control of our company;

 

   

incurring financial indebtedness in an amount exceeding $200 million, subject to certain exceptions;

 

   

hiring or terminating our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer or Chief Legal Officer or designating any replacement thereto; or

 

149


Table of Contents
   

any material change in the nature of the business of our company and our subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

Corporate Opportunity

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provides that we renounce our interest in any corporate opportunity offered to any of our directors or officers. Additionally, any such director or officer shall be permitted to pursue competing opportunities without any liability to us.

Redemption of Shares

We may issue shares on terms that are subject to redemption, at our option or at the option of the holders, on such terms and in such manner as may be determined by our board of directors.

Register of Shareholders

The ordinary shares will be held through DTC, and DTC or Cede & Co., as nominee for DTC, will be recorded in the shareholders’ register as the holder of the ordinary shares.

Under Cayman Islands law, we must keep a register of shareholders that includes:

 

   

the names and addresses of the shareholders, a statement of the shares held by each member, and of the amount paid or agreed to be considered as paid, on the shares of each member;

 

   

whether voting rights attach to the shares in issue;

 

   

the date on which the name of any person was entered on the register as a member; and

 

   

the date on which any person ceased to be a member.

Under Cayman Islands law, our register of shareholders is prima facie evidence of the matters set out therein (i.e., the register of shareholders will raise a rebuttable presumption) and a shareholder registered in the register of shareholders is deemed as a matter of Cayman Islands law to have prima facie legal title to the shares as set against that person’s name in the register of shareholders. Upon the completion of the proposed transaction, the register of shareholders will be immediately updated to record and give effect to the issuance of new ordinary shares in the proposed transaction. Once the register of shareholders has been updated, the shareholders recorded in the register of shareholders should be deemed to have legal title to the shares set against their name.

However, there are certain limited circumstances where an application may be made to a Cayman Islands court for a determination on whether the register of members reflects the correct legal position. Further, the Cayman Islands court has the power to order that the register of members maintained by a company should be rectified where it considers that the register of members does not reflect the correct legal position. If an application for an order for rectification of the register of members were made in respect of our ordinary shares, then the validity of such shares may be subject to re-examination by a Cayman Islands court.

Exempted Company

We are an exempted company with limited liability under the Cayman Companies Act. The Cayman Companies Act distinguishes between ordinary resident companies and exempted companies. Where the proposed activities of a company are to be carried out mainly outside of the Cayman Islands, the registrant can apply for registration as an exempted company. The requirements for an exempted company are essentially the same as for an ordinary company except for the exemptions and privileges listed below:

 

   

an exempted company does not have to file an annual return of its shareholders with the Registrar of Companies;

 

150


Table of Contents
   

an exempted company’s register of shareholders is not open to inspection;

 

   

an exempted company does not have to hold an annual general meeting;

 

   

an exempted company may obtain an undertaking against the imposition of any future taxation (such undertakings are usually given for 20 years in the first instance);

 

   

an exempted company may register by way of continuation in another jurisdiction and be deregistered in the Cayman Islands;

 

   

an exempted company may register as a limited duration company; and

 

   

an exempted company may register as a segregated portfolio company.

“Limited liability” means that the liability of each shareholder is limited to the amount unpaid by the shareholder on the shares of the company (except in exceptional circumstances, such as involving fraud, the establishment of an agency relationship or an illegal or improper purpose or other circumstances in which a court may be prepared to pierce or lift the corporate veil).

Differences in Corporate Law

The Cayman Companies Act was modelled originally after similar laws in England and Wales but does not follow subsequent statutory enactments in England and Wales. In addition, the Cayman Companies Act differs from laws applicable to U.S. corporations and their shareholders. Set forth below is a summary of the significant differences between the provisions of the Cayman Companies Act applicable to us and the laws applicable to companies incorporated in the United States and their shareholders.

Mergers and Similar Arrangements

The Cayman Companies Act permits mergers or consolidations between two Cayman Islands companies, or between a Cayman Islands company and a company incorporated in another jurisdiction (provided that is facilitated by the laws of that other jurisdiction).

Where the merger or consolidation is between two Cayman Islands companies, the directors of each company must approve a written plan of merger or consolidation, which must then be authorized by (a) a special resolution of the shareholders of each company; and (b) such other authorization, if any, as may be specified in such constituent company’s articles of association. No shareholder resolution is required for a merger between a parent company (i.e., a company that owns at least 90% of the issued shares of each class in a subsidiary company) and its subsidiary company. The consent of each holder of a fixed or floating security interest of a constituent company must be obtained, unless the court waives such requirement. If the Cayman Islands Registrar of Companies is satisfied that the requirements of the Cayman Companies Act (which includes certain other formalities) have been complied with, the Registrar of Companies will register the plan of merger or consolidation. Where the merger or consolidation involves a foreign company, the procedure is similar, save that with respect to the foreign company, the director of the Cayman Islands company is required to make a declaration to the effect that, having made due enquiry, the director is of the opinion that the requirements set out below have been met: (i) that the merger or consolidation is permitted or not prohibited by the constitutional documents of the foreign company and by the laws of the jurisdiction in which the foreign company is incorporated, and that those laws and any requirements of those constitutional documents have been or will be complied with; (ii) that no petition or other similar proceeding has been filed and remains outstanding or order made or resolution adopted to wind up or liquidate the company in any foreign jurisdictions; (iii) that no receiver, trustee, administrator or other similar person has been appointed in any jurisdiction and is acting in respect of the foreign company, its affairs or property or any part thereof; and (iv) that no scheme, order, compromise or similar arrangement has been entered into or made in any jurisdiction whereby the rights of creditors of the foreign company are and continue to be suspended or restricted.

Where the surviving company is the Cayman Islands company, the director of the Cayman Islands company is further required to make a declaration to the effect that, having made due enquiry, the director is of the opinion

 

151


Table of Contents

that the requirements set out below have been met: (i) that the foreign company is able to pay its debts as they fall due and that the merger or consolidated is bona fide and not intended to defraud unsecured creditors of the foreign company; (ii) that in respect of the transfer of any security interest granted by the foreign company to the surviving or consolidated company (a) consent or approval to the transfer has been obtained, released or waived; (b) the transfer is permitted by and has been approved in accordance with the constitutional documents of the foreign company; and (c) the laws of the jurisdiction of the foreign company with respect to the transfer have been or will be complied with; (iii) that the foreign company will, upon the merger or consolidation becoming effective, cease to be incorporated, registered or exist under the laws of the relevant foreign jurisdiction; and (iv) that there is no other reason why it would be against the public interest to permit the merger or consolidation.

Where the above procedures are adopted, the Cayman Companies Act provides for a right of dissenting shareholders to be paid a payment of the fair value of his shares upon their dissenting to the merger or consolidation if they follow a prescribed procedure. In essence, that procedure is as follows:

 

  (a)  

the shareholder must give the shareholder’s written objection to the merger or consolidation to the constituent company before the vote on the merger or consolidation, including a statement that the shareholder proposes to demand payment for the shareholder’s shares if the merger or consolidation is authorized by the vote;

 

  (b)  

within 20 days following the date on which the merger or consolidation is approved by the shareholders, the constituent company must give written notice to each shareholder who made a written objection;

 

  (c)  

a shareholder must within 20 days following receipt of such notice from the constituent company, give the constituent company a written notice of the shareholder’s intention to dissent including, among other details, a demand for payment of the fair value of his shares;

 

  (d)  

within seven days following the date of the expiration of the period set out in paragraph (c) above or seven days following the date on which the plan of merger or consolidation is filed, whichever is later, the constituent company, the surviving company or the consolidated company must make a written offer to each dissenting shareholder to purchase the shareholder’s shares at a price that the company determines is the fair value and if the company and the shareholder agree the price within 30 days following the date on which the offer was made, the company must pay the shareholder such amount; and

 

  (e)  

if the company and the shareholder fail to agree a price within such 30-day period, within 20 days following the date on which such 30-day period expires, the company (and any dissenting shareholder) must file a petition with the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands to determine the fair value and such petition must be accompanied by a list of the names and addresses of the dissenting shareholders with whom agreements as to the fair value of their shares have not been reached by the company. At the hearing of that petition, the court has the power to determine the fair value of the shares together with a fair rate of interest, if any, to be paid by the company upon the amount determined to be the fair value.

Any dissenting shareholder whose name appears on the list filed by the company may participate fully in all proceedings until the determination of fair value is reached. These rights of a dissenting shareholder are not available in certain circumstances, for example, to dissenters holding shares of any class in respect of which an open market exists on a recognized stock exchange or recognized interdealer quotation system at the relevant date or where the consideration for such shares to be contributed are shares of any company listed on a national securities exchange or shares of the surviving or consolidated company.

Moreover, Cayman Islands law also has separate statutory provisions that facilitate the reconstruction or amalgamation of companies. In certain circumstances, schemes of arrangement will generally be more suited for complex mergers or other transactions involving widely held companies, commonly referred to in the Cayman Islands as a “scheme of arrangement,” which may be tantamount to a merger. In the event that a merger is sought pursuant to a scheme of arrangement (the procedures of which are more rigorous and take longer to complete

 

152


Table of Contents

than the procedures typically required to consummate a merger in the United States), the arrangement in question must be approved by a majority in number of each class of shareholders and creditors with whom the arrangement is to be made, and who must in addition represent three-fourths in value of each such class of shareholders or creditors, as the case may be, that are present and voting either in person or by proxy at a meeting, or meetings summoned for that purpose. The convening of the meetings and subsequently the terms of the arrangement must be sanctioned by the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands. While a dissenting shareholder would have the right to express to the court the view that the transaction should not be approved, the court can be expected to approve the arrangement if it satisfies itself that:

 

   

we are not proposing to act illegally or beyond the scope of our corporate authority and the statutory provisions as to majority vote have been complied with;

 

   

the shareholders have been fairly represented at the meeting in question;

 

   

the arrangement is such as a businessman would reasonably approve; and

 

   

the arrangement is not one that would more properly be sanctioned under some other provision of the Cayman Companies Act or that would amount to a “fraud on the minority.”

If a scheme of arrangement or takeover offer (as described below) is approved, any dissenting shareholder would have no rights comparable to appraisal rights, which would otherwise ordinarily be available to dissenting shareholders of U.S. corporations, providing rights to receive payment in cash for the judicially determined value of the shares.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that until such time as the Mubadala Entities no longer beneficially own at least 30% of our outstanding ordinary shares, the board of directors shall not cause our company to merge or consolidate with another entity without the prior written approval of MTIC.

Squeeze-out Provisions

When a takeover offer is made and accepted by holders of 90% of the shares to whom the offer is made within four months, the offer or may, within a two-month period, require the holders of the remaining shares to transfer such shares on the terms of the offer. An objection may be made to the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands but is unlikely to succeed unless there is evidence of fraud, bad faith, collusion or inequitable treatment of the shareholders.

If the arrangement and reconstruction is thus approved, the dissenting shareholder would have no rights comparable to appraisal rights, which might otherwise ordinarily be available to dissenting shareholders of United States corporations and allow such dissenting shareholders to receive payment in cash for the judicially determined value of the shares. However, appraisal rights would also not be available to shareholders of a Delaware target in a business combination transaction if the shares of the target were listed on a national securities exchange and target shareholders receive only shares of a corporation which shares are also listed on a national securities exchange.

Further, transactions similar to a merger, reconstruction and/or an amalgamation may in some circumstances be achieved through other means to these statutory provisions, such as a share capital exchange, asset acquisition or control, through contractual arrangements, of an operating business.

Shareholders’ Suits

A shareholder of a Delaware corporation has the right to bring a derivative action on behalf of the corporation if the shareholder was a shareholder of the corporation at the time of the transaction in question. Derivative actions have been brought in the Cayman Islands courts, and the Cayman Islands courts have confirmed the availability for such actions. In most cases, we will be the proper plaintiff in any claim based on a

 

153


Table of Contents

breach of duty owed to us, and a claim against (for example) our officers or directors usually may not be brought by a shareholder. However, based on English authorities, which would in all likelihood be of persuasive authority and be applied by a court in the Cayman Islands, exceptions to the foregoing principle apply in circumstances in which:

 

   

a company is acting or proposing to act illegally or beyond the scope of its authority;

 

   

the act complained of, although not beyond the scope of the authority, could be effected if duly authorized by more than the number of votes which have actually been obtained; and

 

   

those who control the company are perpetrating a “fraud on the minority.”

A shareholder may have a direct right of action against us where the individual rights of that shareholder have been infringed or are about to be infringed.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that each shareholder agrees to waive any claim or right of action he or she might have, whether individually or by or in the right of our Company, against any director or officer on account of any action taken by such director or officer, or the failure of such director to take any action in the performance of their duties with or for our company. However, such waiver shall not extend to any matter in respect of any dishonesty, actual fraud or willful default which may attach to such director or officer.

Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP, our Cayman Islands counsel, is not aware of any reported class action suits having been brought in a Cayman Islands court. However, a class action suit could nonetheless be brought in the United States courts pursuant to an alleged violation of the securities laws of the United States.

Directors’ Fiduciary Duties

As a matter of Cayman Islands law, a director of a Cayman Islands company is in the position of a fiduciary with respect to the company. Accordingly, directors and officers owe the following fiduciary duties:

 

   

duty to act in good faith in what the director or officer believes to be in the best interests of the company as a whole;

 

   

duty to exercise powers for the purposes for which those powers were conferred and not for a collateral purpose;

 

   

directors should not improperly fetter the exercise of future discretion;

 

   

duty to exercise powers fairly as between different sections of shareholders;

 

   

duty to exercise independent judgment; and

 

   

duty not to put themselves in a position in which there is a conflict between their duty to the company and their personal interests.

However, this obligation may be varied by the company’s articles of association, which may permit a director to vote on a matter in which the director has a personal interest provided that the director has disclosed that nature of his interest to the board of directors. With respect to the duty of directors to avoid conflicts of interest, our Memorandum and Articles of Association vary from the applicable provisions of Cayman Islands law mentioned above by providing that a director must disclose the nature and extent of the director’s interest in any contract or proposed contract or arrangement, and following such disclosure and subject to any separate requirement under applicable law or applicable listing rules, and unless disqualified by the chairman of the relevant meeting, such director may vote in respect of any transaction or arrangement in which the director is interested and may be counted in the quorum at the meeting.

In addition to the above, under Cayman Islands law, directors also owe a duty of care which is not fiduciary in nature. This duty has been defined as a requirement to act as a reasonably diligent person having both the

 

154


Table of Contents

general knowledge, skill and experience that may reasonably be expected of a person carrying out the same functions as are carried out by that director in relation to the company and the general knowledge skill and experience which that director has.

As set out above, directors have a duty not to put themselves in a position of conflict and this includes a duty not to engage in self-dealing, or to otherwise benefit as a result of their position. However, in some instances what would otherwise be a breach of this duty can be forgiven and/or authorized in advance by the shareholders provided that there is full disclosure by the directors. This can be done by way of permission granted in the Memorandum and Articles of Association or alternatively by shareholder approval at general meetings. The Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law: (i) no individual serving as a director or an officer shall have any duty, except and to the extent expressly assumed by contract, to refrain from engaging directly or indirectly in the same or similar business activities or lines of business as us; and (ii) we renounce any interest or expectancy in, or in being offered an opportunity to participate in, any potential transaction or matter which may be a corporate opportunity for any director or officer, on the one hand, and us, on the other. Accordingly, as a result of multiple business affiliations, our officers and directors may have similar legal obligations relating to presenting business opportunities meeting the above-listed criteria to multiple entities. In addition, conflicts of interest may arise when our board evaluates a particular business opportunity with respect to the above-listed criteria. However, under our Memorandum and Articles of Association, we renounced our interest in any corporate opportunity offered to any director or officer. Additionally, any such director or officer shall be permitted to pursue competing opportunities without any liability to us. Furthermore, each of our officers and directors may have pre-existing fiduciary obligations to other businesses of which they are officers or directors.

A director of a Cayman Islands company also owes to the company duties to exercise independent judgment in carrying out his functions and to exercise reasonable skill, care and diligence, which has both objective and subjective elements. Recent Cayman Islands case law confirmed that directors must exercise the care, skill and diligence that would be exercised by a reasonably diligent person having the general knowledge, skill and experience reasonably to be expected of a person acting as a director. Additionally, a director must exercise the knowledge, skill and experience which the director actually possesses.

A general notice may be given to the board of directors to the effect that:

 

   

the director is a member or officer of a specified company or firm and is to be regarded as interested in any contract or arrangement which may after the date of the notice be made with that company or firm; or

 

   

the director is to be regarded as interested in any contract or arrangement which may after the date of the notice to the board of directors be made with a specified person who is connected with the director, will be deemed sufficient declaration of interest.

This notice shall specify the nature of the interest in question. Following the disclosure being made pursuant to our Memorandum and Articles of Association and subject to any separate requirement under applicable law or applicable listing rules, a director may vote in respect of any transaction or arrangement in which the director is interested and may be counted in the quorum at the meeting.

In comparison, under Delaware corporate law, a director of a Delaware corporation has a fiduciary duty to the corporation and its shareholders. This duty has two components: the duty of care and the duty of loyalty. The duty of care requires that a director act in good faith, with the care that an ordinarily prudent person would exercise under similar circumstances. Under this duty, directors must inform themselves of, and disclose to shareholders, all material information reasonably available regarding a significant transaction. The duty of loyalty requires that directors act in a manner they reasonably believe to be in the best interests of the corporation. They must not use their corporate position for personal gain or advantage. This duty prohibits self-dealing by a director and mandates that the best interest of the corporation and its shareholders take precedence over any interest possessed by a director, officer or controlling shareholder and not shared by the shareholders

 

155


Table of Contents

generally. In general, actions of a director are presumed to have been made on an informed basis, in good faith and in the honest belief that the action taken was in the best interests of the corporation. However, this presumption may be rebutted by evidence of a breach of one of the fiduciary duties. Should such evidence be presented concerning a transaction by a director, a director must prove the procedural fairness of the transaction, and that the transaction was of fair value to the corporation.

Shareholder Action by Written Consent

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, a corporation may eliminate the right of shareholders to act by written consent by amendment to its certificate of incorporation. Cayman Islands law and our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that shareholders may approve corporate matters by way of a unanimous written resolution signed by or on behalf of each shareholder who would have been entitled to vote on such matter at a general meeting without a meeting being held.

Shareholder Proposals

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, a shareholder has the right to put any proposal before the annual meeting of shareholders, provided it complies with the notice provisions in the governing documents. The Delaware General Corporation Law does not provide shareholders an express right to put any proposal before the annual meeting of shareholders, but Delaware corporations generally afford shareholders an opportunity to make proposals and nominations provided that they comply with the notice provisions in the certificate of incorporation or bylaws. A special meeting may be called by the board of directors or any other person authorized to do so in the governing documents, but shareholders may be precluded from calling special meetings.

The Cayman Companies Act does not provide shareholders with rights to requisition a general meeting, and does not provide shareholders with any right to put any proposal before a general meeting. However, these rights may be provided in a company’s articles of association. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that upon the requisition of one or more shareholders representing not less than one-third of the voting rights entitled to vote at general meetings, the board will convene an extraordinary general meeting and put the resolutions so requisitioned to a vote at such meeting. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide no other right to put any proposals before annual general meetings or extraordinary general meetings.

Cumulative Voting

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, cumulative voting for elections of directors is not permitted unless the corporation’s certificate of incorporation specifically provides for it. Cumulative voting potentially facilitates the representation of minority shareholders on a board of directors since it permits the minority shareholder to cast all the votes to which the shareholder is entitled on a single director, which increases the shareholder’s voting power with respect to electing such director. As permitted under Cayman Islands law, our Memorandum and Articles of Association do not provide for cumulative voting. As a result, our shareholders are not afforded any less protections or rights on this issue than shareholders of a Delaware corporation.

Removal of Directors

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, a director of a corporation may be removed with the approval of a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote, unless the certificate of incorporation provides otherwise. Under our Memorandum and Articles of Association, directors can be removed for cause by an affirmative vote of at least 75% of shareholders, provided that (1) Mubadala Designees may only be removed with or without cause by MTIC and (2) as long as the Mubadala Entities beneficially own in the aggregate at least 50% of the outstanding shares, directors other than the Mubadala Designees may be removed with or without cause by a majority of shareholders.

 

156


Table of Contents

The notice of general meeting must contain a statement of the intention to remove the director and must be served on the director not less than ten calendar days before the meeting. The director is entitled to attend the meeting and be heard on the motion for his removal.

The office of a director will be vacated automatically if the director:

 

   

becomes prohibited by law from being a director;

 

   

becomes bankrupt or makes an arrangement or composition with the director’s creditors;

 

   

dies or is in the opinion of all the director’s co-directors, incapable by reason of mental disorder of discharging his duties as director;

 

   

resigns the director’s office by notice to us; or

 

   

has for more than six months been absent without permission of the directors from meetings of the board of directors held during that period, and the remaining directors resolve that the director’s office be vacated.

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that any vacancy on the board of directors in respect of a Mubadala Designee may only be filled by a decision of majority of the Mubadala Designees then in office, or if there are none, by MTIC.

Proceedings of the Board of Directors

Our business is to be managed and conducted by the board of directors. The quorum necessary for any meeting of our board of directors shall consist of a simple majority of the members provided that, for so long as the Mubadala Entities are entitled to nominate one Mubadala Designee to our board of directors, the presence of at least one Mubadala Designee shall be required on first call to a meeting of the board of directors.

Subject to the provisions of our Memorandum and Articles of Association, the board of directors may regulate its proceedings as they determine is appropriate.

Subject to the provisions of our Memorandum and Articles of Association, to any directions given by ordinary resolution of the shareholders and applicable listing rules, the board of directors may from time to time at its discretion exercise all of our powers, including, subject to the Cayman Companies Act, the power to issue debentures, bonds and other securities of the company, whether outright or as collateral security for any debt, liability or obligation of our company or of any third party.

Transactions with Interested Shareholders

The Delaware General Corporation Law contains a business combination statute applicable to Delaware corporations whereby, unless the corporation has specifically elected not to be governed by such statute by amendment to its certificate of incorporation, it is prohibited from engaging in certain business combinations with an “interested shareholder” for three years following the date that such person becomes an interested shareholder. An interested shareholder generally is a person or group who owns or owned 15% or more of the target’s outstanding voting shares within the past three years. This has the effect of limiting the ability of a potential acquiror to make a two-tiered bid for the target in which all shareholders would not be treated equally. The statute does not apply if, among other things, prior to the date on which such shareholder becomes an interested shareholder, the board of directors approves either the business combination or the transaction which resulted in the person becoming an interested shareholder. This encourages any potential acquiror of a Delaware corporation to negotiate the terms of any acquisition transaction with the target’s board of directors.

Cayman Islands law has no comparable statute. As a result, we cannot avail ourselves of the types of protections afforded by the Delaware business combination statute. However, although Cayman Islands law does

 

157


Table of Contents

not regulate transactions between a company and its significant shareholders, it does provide that the board of directors owes duties to ensure that these transactions are entered into bona fide in the best interests of the company and for a proper corporate purpose and, as noted above, a transaction may be subject to challenge if it has the effect of constituting a fraud on the minority shareholders.

Dissolution; Winding Up

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, unless the board of directors approves the proposal to dissolve, dissolution must be approved by shareholders holding 100% of the total voting power of the corporation. If the dissolution is initiated by the board of directors it may be approved by a simple majority of the corporation’s outstanding shares. Delaware law allows a Delaware corporation to include in its certificate of incorporation a supermajority voting requirement in connection with dissolutions initiated by the board. Under Cayman Islands law, a company may be wound up by either an order of the courts of the Cayman Islands or by a special resolution of its members or, if the company resolves by ordinary resolution that it be wound up because it is unable to pay its debts as they fall due. The court has authority to order winding up in a number of specified circumstances including where it is, in the opinion of the court, just and equitable to do so.

Under the Cayman Companies Act, we may be dissolved, liquidated or wound up by a special resolution of shareholders (requiring a two-thirds majority vote of those shareholders attending and voting at a quorate meeting). Our Memorandum and Articles of Association also give our board of directors the authority to petition the Cayman Islands Court for our wind up.

Variation of Rights of Shares

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, a corporation may vary the rights of a class of shares with the approval of a majority of the outstanding shares of such class, unless the certificate of incorporation provides otherwise. Under Cayman Islands law and our Memorandum and Articles of Association, if our share capital is divided into more than one class of shares, we may vary the rights attached to any class without the consent of the holders of the issued shares of that class where such variation is considered by the directors not to have a material adverse effect upon such rights. Otherwise, all or any of the special rights attached to any class of shares may be varied with either the written consent of the beneficial holders of two-thirds of the issued shares of that class, or with the approval of a special resolution passed at a general meeting of the holders of the shares of that class.

The rights conferred upon the holders of the shares of any class issued with preferred or other rights shall not, subject to any rights or restrictions for the time being attached to the shares of that class, be deemed to be materially adversely affected by the creation, allotment or issuance of further shares (whether ranking in priority to, pari passu or subordinated to them) pursuant to the board of director’s ability to issue preference shares. The rights of the beneficial holders of the issued shares shall not be deemed to be materially adversely varied by the creation, allotment or issuance of shares with preferred or other rights including, without limitation, the creation of shares with enhanced or weighted voting rights.

Amendment of Governing Documents

Under the Delaware General Corporation Law, a corporation’s governing documents may be amended with the approval of a majority of the outstanding shares entitled to vote, unless the certificate of incorporation provides otherwise. Under Cayman Islands law, our Memorandum and Articles of Association generally (and save for certain amendments to share capital described in this section) may only be amended by special resolution of shareholders (requiring a two-thirds majority vote of those shareholders attending and voting at a quorate meeting).

Indemnification of Directors and Executive Officers and Limitation of Liability

The Cayman Companies Act does not limit the extent to which a company’s articles of association may provide for indemnification of directors and officers, except to the extent that it may be held by the Cayman

 

158


Table of Contents

Islands courts to be contrary to public policy, such as to provide indemnification against civil fraud or the consequences of committing a crime. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that we shall indemnify and hold harmless our directors and officers against any liability, action, proceeding, claim, demand, costs, damages or expenses, including legal expenses, whatsoever which they or any of them may incur as a result of any act or failure to act in carrying out their functions in connection with the company other than such liability (if any) that they may incur by reason of their own actual fraud, dishonesty, willful neglect or willful default. We will also bear the expenses of any reasonable attorneys’ fees and other costs and expenses incurred in connection with the defense of any action, suit, proceeding or investigation involving such director or officer, upon such person’s undertaking to repay any amounts paid, advanced, or reimbursed by us if it is ultimately determined that any such person shall not have been entitled to indemnification. No director or officer shall be liable to our company for any loss or damage incurred by our company as a result (whether direct or indirect) of the carrying out of their functions unless that liability arises through the actual fraud, dishonesty, willful neglect or willful default of such officer or director. This standard of conduct is generally the same as permitted under the Delaware General Corporation Law for a Delaware corporation.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to our directors, officers or persons controlling us under the foregoing provisions, we have been informed that, in the opinion of the SEC, this indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is therefore unenforceable.

Enforcement of Civil Liabilities

We have been advised by Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP, our Cayman Islands legal counsel, that the courts of the Cayman Islands are unlikely (i) to recognize or enforce against us judgments of courts of the United States predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the federal securities laws of the United States or any state in the United States; and (ii) in original actions brought in the Cayman Islands, to impose liabilities against us predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the federal securities laws of the United States or any state in the United States, so far as the liabilities imposed by those provisions are penal in nature. In those circumstances, although there is no statutory enforcement in the Cayman Islands of judgments obtained in the United States, the courts of the Cayman Islands will recognize and enforce a foreign money judgment of a foreign court of competent jurisdiction without retrial on the merits based on the principle that a judgment of a competent foreign court imposes upon the judgment debtor an obligation to pay the sum for which judgment has been given provided certain conditions are met. For a foreign judgment to be enforced in the Cayman Islands, such judgment must be final and conclusive and for a liquidated sum, and must not be in respect of taxes or a fine or penalty, inconsistent with a Cayman Islands judgment in respect of the same matter, impeachable on the grounds of fraud or obtained in a manner, or be of a kind the enforcement of which is, contrary to natural justice or the public policy of the Cayman Islands (awards of punitive or multiple damages may well be held to be contrary to public policy). A Cayman Islands court may stay enforcement proceedings if concurrent proceedings are being brought elsewhere.

We have appointed Corporation Service Company as our agent to receive service of process with respect to any action brought against us in the United States under the federal securities laws of the United States or of any state in the United States arising out of this offering. The address of Corporation Service Company is 251 Little Falls Drive, Wilmington, DE 19808.

Anti-Takeover Provisions

Some provisions of our Memorandum and Articles of Association may discourage, delay or prevent a change in control of our company or management that shareholders may consider favorable, including provisions that:

 

   

our board of directors will be divided into three separate classes, with each class serving for staggered terms, with successors to the class of directors whose term expires at subsequent annual meetings of shareholders following the date of such introduction, being elected for a further fixed term;

 

159


Table of Contents
   

provide that our Memorandum and Articles of Association may be amended only by the affirmative vote of two-thirds of the votes permitted to be cast by persons present and voting in a general meeting at which a quorum is present;

 

   

provide that directors nominated by Mubadala may only be removed with or without cause by MTIC;

 

   

provide that any merger to which we are a party will require the approval of a special resolution and, until such time as the Mubadala Entities no longer beneficially own at least 30% of our outstanding ordinary shares, the prior written approval of MTIC;

 

   

authorize our board of directors to issue preferred shares and to designate the rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions of such preferred shares without any further vote or action by our shareholders; and

 

   

limit the ability of shareholders to requisition and convene general meetings of shareholders and prevent our shareholders from putting any proposals before annual general meetings or extraordinary general meetings not called by such shareholders.

These provisions are expected to discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids. These provisions are also designed to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of the company to first negotiate with the board of directors. It is possible that these provisions could make it more difficult to accomplish transactions that shareholders may otherwise deem to be in their best interests.

Exclusive Forum

Our Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, the courts of the Cayman Islands will, to the fullest extent permitted by the law, have exclusive jurisdiction over any claim or dispute arising out of or in connection with our Memorandum and Articles of Association or otherwise related in any way to each shareholder’s shareholding in us, including but not limited to (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf, (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of any fiduciary or other duty owed by any of our current or former directors, officers or other employees to us or our shareholders, (iii) any action asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the Cayman Companies Act or our Memorandum and Articles of Association, and (iv) any action asserting a claim against us governed by the “Internal Affairs Doctrine” (as such concept is recognized under the laws of the United States) and that each shareholder irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the Cayman Islands over all such claims or disputes. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association will provide that, unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the federal district courts of the United States will be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause or causes of action arising under the Securities Act or Exchange Act, including all causes of action asserted against any defendant named in such complaint. Our Memorandum and Articles of Association also provide that, without prejudice to any other rights or remedies that we may have, each of our shareholders acknowledges that damages alone would not be an adequate remedy for any breach of the selection of the courts of the Cayman Islands as exclusive forum and that accordingly we shall be entitled, without proof of special damages, to the remedies of injunction, specific performance or other equitable relief for any threatened or actual breach of the selection of the courts of the Cayman Islands as exclusive forum.

Rights of Non-Resident or Foreign Shareholders

There are no limitations imposed by our Memorandum and Articles of Association on the rights of non-resident or foreign shareholders to hold or exercise voting rights of our shares. In addition, there are no provisions in our Memorandum and Articles of Association governing the ownership threshold above which shareholder ownership must be disclosed.

 

160


Table of Contents

Inspection of Books and Records

Holders of our shares have no general right under Cayman Islands law to inspect or obtain copies of the list of shareholders or our corporate records. However, our board of directors may determine from time to time whether and to what extent our accounting records and books shall be open to inspection by shareholders.

Handling of Mail

Mail addressed to us and received at our registered office will be forwarded unopened to the forwarding address, which will be supplied by us. None of us, our directors, officers, advisors or service providers (including the organization which provides registered office services in the Cayman Islands) will bear any responsibility for any delay howsoever caused in mail reaching the forwarding address.

Cayman Islands Data Protection

We have certain duties under the Data Protection Act (as amended) of the Cayman Islands (“DPA”), based on internationally accepted principles of data privacy.

Privacy Notice

This privacy notice puts our shareholders on notice that through your investment in us you will provide us with certain personal information which constitutes personal data within the meaning of the DPA, or personal data.

Investor Data

We will collect, use, disclose, retain and secure personal data to the extent reasonably required only and within the parameters that could be reasonably expected during the normal course of business. We will only process, disclose, transfer or retain personal data to the extent legitimately required to conduct our activities on an ongoing basis or to comply with legal and regulatory obligations to which we are subject. We will only transfer personal data in accordance with the requirements of the DPA, and will apply appropriate technical and organizational information security measures designed to protect against unauthorized or unlawful processing of the personal data and against the accidental loss, destruction or damage to the personal data.

In our use of this personal data, we will be characterized as a “data controller” for the purposes of the DPA, while our affiliates and service providers who may receive this personal data from us in the conduct of our activities may either act as our “data processors” for the purposes of the DPA or may process personal information for their own lawful purposes in connection with services provided to us.

We may also obtain personal data from other public sources. Personal data includes, without limitation, the following information relating to a shareholder and/or any individuals connected with a shareholder as an investor: name, residential address, email address, contact details, corporate contact information, signature, nationality, place of birth, date of birth, tax identification, credit history, correspondence records, passport number, bank account details, source of funds details and details relating to the shareholder’s investment activity.

Who this Affects

If you are a natural person, this will affect you directly. If you are a corporate investor (including, for these purposes, legal arrangements such as trusts or exempted limited partnerships) that provides us with personal data on individuals connected to you for any reason in relation your investment in us, this will be relevant for those individuals and you should transmit the content of this Privacy Notice to such individuals or otherwise advise them of its content.

 

161


Table of Contents

How We May Use a Shareholder’s Personal Data

We may, as the data controller, collect, store and use personal data for lawful purposes, including, in particular: (i) where this is necessary for the performance of our rights and obligations under any agreements; (ii) where this is necessary for compliance with a legal and regulatory obligation to which we are or may be subject (such as compliance with anti-money laundering and FATCA/CRS requirements); and/or (iii) where this is necessary for the purposes of our legitimate interests and such interests are not overridden by your interests, fundamental rights or freedoms.

Should we wish to use personal data for other specific purposes (including, if applicable, any purpose that requires your consent), we will contact you.

Why We May Transfer Your Personal Data

In certain circumstances we may be legally obliged to share personal data and other information with respect to your shareholding with the relevant regulatory authorities such as the Cayman Islands Monetary Authority or the Tax Information Authority. They, in turn, may exchange this information with foreign authorities, including tax authorities.

We anticipate disclosing personal data to persons who provide services to us and their respective affiliates (which may include certain entities located outside the US, the Cayman Islands or the European Economic Area), who will process your personal data on our behalf.

The Data Protection Measures We Take

Any transfer of personal data by us or our duly authorized affiliates and/or delegates outside of the Cayman Islands shall be in accordance with the requirements of the DPA.

We and our duly authorized affiliates and/or delegates shall apply appropriate technical and organizational information security measures designed to protect against unauthorized or unlawful processing of personal data, and against accidental loss or destruction of, or damage to, personal data.

We shall notify you of any personal data breach that is reasonably likely to result in a risk to your interests, fundamental rights or freedoms or those data subjects to whom the relevant personal data relates.

 

162


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our ordinary shares. Future sales of substantial amounts of our ordinary shares, including shares issued upon exercise of outstanding share options, in the public market following this offering could adversely affect market prices prevailing from time to time and could impair our ability to raise equity capital in the future.

Upon the completion of this offering and the Concurrent Private Placement, based on the number of our ordinary shares outstanding as of October 13, 2021, we will have a total of 534,685,393 ordinary shares outstanding, assuming 33,000,000 ordinary shares are sold in this offering and 1,685,393 ordinary shares are sold in the Concurrent Private Placement by us. Of these outstanding shares, all of the shares sold in this offering will be freely tradable, except any shares purchased in this offering by our affiliates, as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act, or by certain individuals identified by us in the directed share program. Such shares would only be able to be sold in compliance with the Rule 144 limitations described below. In addition, some options are expected to be exercised in calendar year 2022 as a result of our LTIP plans. See “Executive Compensation” for more information.

The remaining outstanding ordinary shares will be deemed “restricted securities” as defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. Restricted securities may be sold in the public market only if they are registered under the Securities Act and may be resold only after registration under the Securities Act or pursuant to an exemption from such registration, including, among others, the exemptions provided by Rules 144 and 701 under the Securities Act, which rules are summarized below.

Rule 144

In general, under Rule 144, persons who became the beneficial owners of our ordinary shares prior to the completion of this offering may not sell their shares until the earlier of (i) the expiration of a six-month holding period, if we have been subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act and have filed all required reports for at least 90 days prior to the date of the sale, or (ii) a one-year holding period.

At the expiration of the six-month holding period, a person who was not one of our affiliates at any time during the three months preceding a sale is entitled to sell an unlimited number of our ordinary shares provided current public information about us is available, and a person who was one of our affiliates at any time during the three months preceding a sale is entitled to sell within any three-month period only a number of ordinary shares that does not exceed the greater of either of the following:

 

   

one percent of the number of shares of our ordinary shares then outstanding; and

 

   

the average weekly trading volume of our ordinary shares during the four calendar weeks preceding the filing of a notice on Form 144 with the SEC with respect to that sale.

At the expiration of the one-year holding period, a person who was not one of our affiliates at any time during the three months preceding a sale would be entitled to sell an unlimited number of our ordinary shares without restriction. A person who was one of our affiliates at any time during the three months preceding a sale would remain subject to the volume restrictions described above.

Sales under Rule 144 by our affiliates or persons selling shares on behalf of our affiliates are also subject to certain manner of sale provisions and notice requirements and to the availability of current public information about us.

Upon completion of the 180-day lock-up period, all of our outstanding restricted securities will be eligible for sale under Rule 144 subject to limitations on sales by affiliates and other contractual transfer restrictions.

 

163


Table of Contents

Rule 701

In general, under Rule 701, any of our employees, directors, officers, consultants or advisors who purchased shares from us in connection with a compensatory stock or option plan or other written agreement before the effective date of our initial public offering, or who purchased shares from us after that date upon the exercise of options granted before that date, are eligible to resell such shares in reliance upon Rule 144 beginning 90 days after the date of this prospectus. If such person is not an affiliate, the sale may be made without compliance with its holding period or current public information requirement. If such a person is an affiliate, the sale may be made under Rule 144 without compliance with its holding period, but subject to the other Rule 144 restrictions.

Lock-Up Agreements

MTIC and MTIIIC are subject to lock-up agreements or market stand-off provisions that, subject to exceptions described under “Underwriters” below, prohibit them from offering for sale, selling, contracting to sell, pledging, granting any option for the sale of, making any short sale of, transferring or otherwise disposing of any ordinary shares, share options, or any security or instrument related to our ordinary shares or share options for a period of at least 180 days following the date of this prospectus, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC on behalf of the underwriters. These agreements are subject to certain customary exceptions. See “Underwriters” for additional information.

Equity Incentive Plans

In connection with this offering, we intend to file with the SEC a registration statement under the Securities Act registering the issuance and sale of all of the shares of our ordinary shares reserved for issuance under our equity incentive plans. We expect to file this registration statement as soon as permitted under the Securities Act. However, resales of such shares may be subject to the volume limitations and the manner of sale, notice, and public information requirements of Rule 144 and will not be eligible for resale until expiration of any contractual restrictions to which they are subject.

 

164


Table of Contents

TAXATION

Cayman Islands Tax Considerations

The following summary contains a description of certain Cayman Islands tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares, but it does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all the tax considerations that may be relevant to a decision to purchase our ordinary shares. The summary is based upon the tax laws of Cayman Islands and regulations thereunder as of the date hereof, which are subject to change. If you are considering the purchase of our ordinary shares, you should consult your own tax advisors concerning the particular tax consequences to you of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares, as well as the consequences to you arising under the laws of your country of citizenship, residence or domicile.

The following is a discussion of certain Cayman Islands income tax consequences of an investment in our ordinary shares. The discussion is a general summary of present law, which is subject to prospective and retroactive change. It is not intended to be tax advice, does not consider any investor’s particular circumstances, and does not consider tax consequences other than those arising under Cayman Islands law.

Under Existing Cayman Islands Laws

Payments of dividends and capital in respect of our ordinary shares will not be subject to taxation in the Cayman Islands and no withholding will be required on the payment of interest and principal or a dividend or capital to any holder of our ordinary shares, as the case may be, nor will gains derived from the disposal of our ordinary shares be subject to Cayman Islands income or corporation tax. The Cayman Islands currently has no income, corporation or capital gains tax and no estate duty, inheritance tax or gift tax.

No stamp duty is payable in respect of the issue of ordinary shares or on an instrument of transfer in respect of an ordinary share.

We were incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited liability and, as such, has received an undertaking from the Governor in Cabinet of the Cayman Islands in substantially the following form:

The Tax Concessions Law

(1999 Revision)

Undertaking as to Tax Concessions

In accordance with Section 6 of the Tax Concessions Law (1999 Revision) the Governor in Cabinet undertakes with GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.:

 

  (a)  

that no Law which is hereafter enacted in the Islands imposing any tax to be levied on profits, income, gains or appreciations shall apply to us the company or our operations; and

 

  (b)  

in addition, that no tax to be levied on profits, income, gains or appreciations or which is in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax shall be payable:

 

  a.

on or in respect of the shares, debentures or other obligations of the company; or

 

  b.

by way of the withholding in whole or part, of any relevant payment as defined in Section 6(3) of the Tax Concessions Law (20181 Revision).

These concessions shall be for a period of TWENTY years from 21st day of October 2008.

 

165


Table of Contents

U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations

The following is a summary of material U.S. federal income tax considerations that are likely to be relevant to the purchase, ownership and disposition of our ordinary shares by a U.S. Holder (as defined below).

This summary is based on provisions of the Code, and regulations, rulings and judicial interpretations thereof, in force as of the date hereof. Those authorities may be changed at any time, perhaps retroactively, so as to result in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those summarized below.

This summary is not a comprehensive discussion of all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to a particular investor’s decision to purchase, hold, or dispose of ordinary shares. In particular, this summary is directed only to U.S. Holders that hold ordinary shares as capital assets and does not address particular tax consequences that may be applicable to U.S. Holders who may be subject to special tax rules, such as banks, brokers or dealers in securities or currencies, traders in securities electing to mark to market, financial institutions, life insurance companies, tax-exempt entities, regulated investment companies, real estate investment trusts, entities or arrangements that are treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes (or partners therein), holders that own or are treated as owning 10% or more of our stock by vote or value, persons holding ordinary shares as part of a hedging or conversion transaction or a straddle, persons whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, or persons holding our ordinary shares in connection with a trade or business outside the United States. Moreover, this summary does not address state, local or foreign taxes, the U.S. federal estate and gift taxes, the Medicare contribution tax applicable to net investment income of certain non-corporate U.S. Holders, or alternative minimum tax consequences of acquiring, holding or disposing of ordinary shares.

For purposes of this summary, a “U.S. Holder” is a beneficial owner of ordinary shares that is a citizen or resident of the United States or a U.S. domestic corporation or that otherwise is subject to U.S. federal income taxation on a net income basis in respect of such ordinary shares.

You should consult your own tax advisors about the consequences of the acquisition, ownership, and disposition of the ordinary shares, including the relevance to your particular situation of the considerations discussed below and any consequences arising under foreign, state, local or other tax laws.

Taxation of Distributions

Subject to the discussion below under “—Passive Foreign Investment Company Status,” the gross amount of any distribution of cash or property with respect to our shares that is paid out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes) will generally be includible in your taxable income as ordinary dividend income on the day on which you receive the dividend and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction allowed to corporations under the Code.

We do not expect to maintain calculations of our earnings and profits in accordance with U.S. federal income tax principles. U.S. Holders therefore should expect that distributions generally will be treated as dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Subject to certain exceptions for short-term positions, dividends received by an individual with respect to the shares will be subject to taxation at a preferential rate if the dividends are “qualified dividends.” Dividends paid on the shares will be treated as qualified dividends if:

 

   

the shares are readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States or we are eligible for the benefits of a comprehensive tax treaty with the United States that the U.S. Treasury determines is satisfactory for purposes of this provision and that includes an exchange of information program; and

 

166


Table of Contents
   

we were not, in the year prior to the year in which the dividend was paid, and are not, in the year in which the dividend is paid, a passive foreign investment company (a “PFIC”).

The ordinary shares are expected to be listed on the Nasdaq, and will qualify as readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States so long as they are so listed. Based on our audited financial statements and relevant market and shareholder data, we believe that we were not treated as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes with respect to our prior taxable year. In addition, based on our audited financial statements and our current expectations regarding the value and nature of our assets, the sources and nature of our income, and relevant market and shareholder data, we do not anticipate becoming a PFIC for our current taxable year or in the foreseeable future. Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the availability of the reduced dividend tax rate in light of their own particular circumstances.

Dividend distributions with respect to our shares generally will be treated as “passive category” income from sources outside the United States for purposes of determining a U.S. Holder’s U.S. foreign tax credit limitation.

U.S. Holders that receive distributions of additional shares or rights to subscribe for shares as part of a pro rata distribution to all our shareholders generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax in respect of the distributions, unless the U.S. Holder has the right to receive cash or property, in which case the U.S. Holder will be treated as if it received cash equal to the fair market value of the distribution.

Taxation of Dispositions of Shares

Subject to the discussion below under “—Passive Foreign Investment Company Status,” upon a sale, exchange or other taxable disposition of the shares, U.S. Holders will realize gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes in an amount equal to the difference between the amount realized on the disposition and the U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the shares, as determined in U.S. dollars as discussed below. Such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss, and will generally be long-term capital gain or loss if the shares have been held for more than one year. Long-term capital gain realized by a U.S. Holder that is an individual generally is subject to taxation at a preferential rate. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

Gain, if any, realized by a U.S. Holder on the sale or other disposition of the shares generally will be treated as U.S. source income.

Passive Foreign Investment Company Status

Special U.S. tax rules apply to companies that are considered to be PFICs. We will be classified as a PFIC in a particular taxable year if either:

 

   

75% or more of our gross income for the taxable year is passive income; or

 

   

the average percentage of the value of our assets that produce or are held for the production of passive income is at least 50%.

For this purpose, passive income generally includes dividends, interest, gains from certain commodities transactions, rents, royalties and the excess of gains over losses from the disposition of assets that produce passive income.

We believe, and the following discussion assumes, that we were not a PFIC for our taxable year ending December 31, 2020 and that, based on the present composition of our income and assets and the manner in which we conduct our business, we will not be a PFIC in our current taxable year or in the foreseeable future. Whether we are a PFIC is a factual determination made annually, and our status could change depending, among other things, upon changes in the composition of our gross income and the relative quarterly average value of our

 

167


Table of Contents

assets. If we were a PFIC for any taxable year in which you hold ordinary shares, you generally would be subject to additional taxes on certain distributions and any gain realized from the sale or other taxable disposition of the ordinary shares regardless of whether we continued to be a PFIC in any subsequent year. You are encouraged to consult your own tax advisor as to our status as a PFIC, the tax consequences to you of such status, and the availability and desirability of making a mark-to-market election to mitigate the unfavorable rules mentioned in the preceding sentence.

Foreign Financial Asset Reporting

Individual U.S. Holders that own “specified foreign financial assets” with an aggregate value in excess of US$50,000 on the last day of the taxable year or US$75,000 at any time during the taxable year are generally required to file an information statement along with their tax returns, currently on Form 8938, with respect to such assets. “Specified foreign financial assets” include any financial accounts held at a non-U.S. financial institution, as well as securities issued by a non-U.S. issuer that are not held in accounts maintained by financial institutions. Higher reporting thresholds apply to certain individuals living abroad and to certain married individuals. Regulations extend this reporting requirement to certain entities that are treated as formed or availed of to hold direct or indirect interests in specified foreign financial assets based on objective criteria. U.S. Holders who fail to report the required information could be subject to substantial penalties. In addition, the statute of limitations for assessment of tax would be suspended, in whole or part. Prospective investors are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisors regarding the possible application of these rules, including the application of the rules to their particular circumstances.

Backup Withholding and Information Reporting

Dividends paid on, and proceeds from the sale or other disposition of, the shares to a U.S. taxpayer generally may be subject to the information reporting requirements of the Code and may be subject to backup withholding unless the U.S. taxpayer provides an accurate taxpayer identification number and makes any other required certification or otherwise establishes an exemption. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to a U.S. taxpayer will be allowed as a refund or credit against the U.S. taxpayer’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the required information is furnished to the U.S. Internal Revenue Service in a timely manner.

A holder that is not a U.S. taxpayer may be required to comply with certification and identification procedures in order to establish its exemption from information reporting and backup withholding.

 

168


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITERS

Under the terms and subject to the conditions in an underwriting agreement dated the date of this prospectus, the underwriters named below, for whom Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, BofA Securities, Inc. and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC are acting as representatives, have severally agreed to purchase, and we and Mubadala have agreed to sell to them, severally, the number of shares indicated below:

 

Name

  

Number of Shares

 

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC

  

BofA Securities, Inc.

  

J.P. Morgan Securities LLC

  

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

  

Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC

  

Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.

  

HSBC Securities (USA) Inc.

  

Jefferies LLC

  

Robert W. Baird & Co. Incorporated

  

Cowen and Company, LLC

  

Needham & Company, LLC

  

Raymond James & Associates, Inc.

  

Wedbush Securities Inc.

  

Drexel Hamilton, LLC

  

Siebert Williams Shank & Co., LLC

  

Intesa Sanpaolo S.p.A.

  
  

 

 

 

Total:

     55,000,000  
  

 

 

 
  

The underwriters and the representatives are collectively referred to as the “underwriters” and the “representatives,” respectively. The underwriters are offering the ordinary shares subject to their acceptance of the shares from us and Mubadala and subject to prior sale. The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the several underwriters to pay for and accept delivery of the ordinary shares offered by this prospectus are subject to the approval of certain legal matters by their counsel and to certain other conditions. The underwriters are obligated to take and pay for all of the ordinary shares offered by this prospectus if any such shares are taken. However, the underwriters are not required to take or pay for the shares covered by the underwriters’ over-allotment option described below.

The underwriters initially propose to offer part of the ordinary shares directly to the public at the offering price listed on the cover page of this prospectus and part to certain dealers. After the initial offering of the ordinary shares, the offering price and other selling terms may from time to time be varied by the representatives.

Mubadala has granted to the underwriters an option, exercisable for 30 days from the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to 8,250,000 additional ordinary shares at the public offering price listed on the cover page of this prospectus, less underwriting discounts and commissions. The underwriters may exercise this option solely for the purpose of covering over-allotments, if any, made in connection with the offering of the ordinary shares offered by this prospectus. To the extent the option is exercised, each underwriter will become obligated, subject to certain conditions, to purchase about the same percentage of the additional ordinary shares as the number listed next to the underwriter’s name in the preceding table bears to the total number of ordinary shares listed next to the names of all underwriters in the preceding table.

The cornerstone investors have indicated an interest in purchasing ordinary shares with an aggregate purchase price of approximately $1.05 billion in this offering at a price per share equal to the initial public offering price. Because these indications of interest are not binding agreements or commitments to purchase, the cornerstone investors may decide to purchase more, less or no ordinary shares in this offering, or the underwriters may decide to sell more, less or no ordinary shares in this offering to the cornerstone investors. The

 

169


Table of Contents

underwriters will receive the same discount from any ordinary shares sold to the cornerstone investors as they will from any other ordinary shares sold to the public in this offering.

The following table shows the per share and total public offering price, underwriting discounts and commissions, and proceeds before expenses to us and Mubadala. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase up to an additional 8,250,000 ordinary shares.

 

            Total  
     Per
Share
     No Exercise      Full
Exercise
 

Public offering price

   $                    $                    $                

Underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid by:

        

Us

   $        $        $    

Mubadala

   $        $        $    

Proceeds, before expenses, to us

   $        $        $    

Proceeds, before expenses, to Mubadala

   $        $        $    

The estimated offering expenses payable by us, exclusive of the underwriting discounts and commissions, are approximately $30,000,000. We have agreed to reimburse the underwriters for expense relating to clearance of this offering with the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority up to $50,000. The underwriters have agreed to reimburse us for up to $                 of expenses incurred by us in connection with this offering.

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC is acting as placement agent in the Concurrent Private Placement and will receive a customary placement agent fee in connection therewith.

The underwriters have informed us that they do not intend sales to discretionary accounts to exceed 5% of the total number of ordinary shares offered by them.

We have applied to list our ordinary shares on the Nasdaq under the symbol “GFS.”

Evercore Group L.L.C. is acting as our Financial Advisor in connection with this offering. Evercore Group L.L.C. is not acting as an underwriter in connection with this offering.

First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC (“FAB”) and Abu Dhabi Commercial Bank PJS (“ADCB”), of which Mubadala directly or indirectly owns 37.88% and 60.20%, respectively, are acting as our GCC Markets Advisors in connection with this offering. We have agreed to pay FAB and ADCB a fee of up to $                 and $                 , respectively. FAB and ADCB are not acting as underwriters in connection with this offering.

We and all directors and officers and the holders of all of our outstanding stock and share options have agreed that, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC on behalf of the underwriters, we and they will not, and will not publicly disclose an intention to, during the period ending 180 days after the date of this prospectus (the “restricted period”):

 

   

offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant to purchase, lend or otherwise transfer or dispose of, directly or indirectly, any ordinary shares or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for ordinary shares;

 

   

file any registration statement with the Securities and Exchange Commission relating to the offering of any ordinary shares or any securities convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for ordinary shares; or

 

   

enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of the ordinary shares.

Whether any such transaction described above is to be settled by delivery of ordinary shares or such other securities, in cash or otherwise.

In addition, we and each such person agrees that, without the prior written consent of Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC on behalf of the underwriters, we or such other person will not, during the restricted period, make any demand for, or exercise any right with respect to, the registration of any ordinary shares or any security convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for ordinary shares.

 

170


Table of Contents

The restrictions described in the immediately preceding paragraph do not apply to:

 

   

the transfer of ordinary shares to the underwriters pursuant to the underwriting agreement;

 

   

the transfer of ordinary shares or other securities acquired in open market transactions after the completion of this offering, provided that no filing under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act (other than a required Form 5), reporting a reduction in beneficial ownership of such ordinary shares, shall be required or shall be voluntarily made during the restricted period;

 

   

the transfer of ordinary shares as a bona fide gift or as charitable contributions, provided that the donee or donees thereof agree to be bound in writing by the restrictions set forth in the lock-up agreements, and provided further that no filing under the Exchange Act (other than a required Form 5), reporting a reduction in beneficial ownership of ordinary shares, shall be required or shall be voluntarily made during the restricted period;

 

   

the transfer ordinary shares by operation of law;

 

   

distribution of ordinary shares to any corporation, partnership, limited partnership, limited liability company, governmental entity or other entity, in each case, that (i) controls, or is controlled by or is under common control with, the undersigned, or (ii) is directly or indirectly wholly owned by the Government of the Emirate of Abu Dhabi, or (iii) is otherwise an affiliate (as defined in Rule 405 promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended) of a lock-up party, provided that in the case of any such distribution, each distributee shall agree to be subject to the restrictions set forth in the lock-up agreements, and provided further that no filing under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act, reporting a reduction in beneficial ownership of ordinary shares shall be required or shall be voluntarily made during the restricted period;

 

   

any reclassification or conversion of the ordinary shares, provided that any securities received upon such conversion or reclassification will be subject to the restrictions set forth in the lock-up agreements;

 

   

the establishment of a a trading plan pursuant to Rule 10b5-1 under the Exchange Act provided that (i) such plan does not provide for the transfer of ordinary shares during the restricted period and (ii) to the extent a public announcement or filing under the Exchange Act, if any, is required of or voluntarily made by or on behalf of a lock-up party or the company regarding the establishment of such plan, such announcement or filing shall include a statement to the effect that no transfer of ordinary shares may be made under such plan during the restricted period; and

 

   

transfer of ordinary shares pursuant to a bona fide third-party tender offer, merger, consolidation or other similar transaction that is approved by our board of directors (or a duly authorized committee thereof) involving a change of control of the company in which the acquiring party becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 of the Exchange Act) of more than 50% of the total voting power of our voting stock following such transaction.

Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, in its sole discretion, may release the ordinary shares and other securities subject to the lock-up agreements described above in whole or in part at any time.

In order to facilitate the offering of the ordinary shares, the underwriters, pursuant to Regulation M of the Securities Act, may engage in transactions that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of the ordinary shares. Specifically, the underwriters may sell more shares than they are obligated to purchase under the underwriting agreement, creating a short position. A short sale is covered if the short position is no greater than the number of shares available for purchase by the underwriters under the over-allotment option. The underwriters can close out a covered short sale by exercising the over-allotment option or purchasing shares in the open market. In determining the source of shares to close out a covered short sale, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the open market price of shares compared to the price available under the over-allotment option. The underwriters may also sell shares in excess of the over-allotment option, creating a naked

 

171


Table of Contents

short position. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the ordinary shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in this offering. As an additional means of facilitating this offering, the underwriters may bid for, and purchase, ordinary shares in the open market to stabilize the price of the ordinary shares. These activities may raise or maintain the market price of the ordinary shares above independent market levels or prevent or retard a decline in the market price of the ordinary shares. The underwriters are not required to engage in these activities and may end any of these activities at any time.

The underwriters may also impose a penalty bid. This occurs when a particular underwriter repays to the underwriters a portion of the underwriting discount received by it because the representatives have repurchased ordinary shares sold by or for the account of such underwriter in stabilizing or short covering transactions.

We, Mubadala and the underwriters have agreed to indemnify each other against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

A prospectus in electronic format may be made available on websites maintained by one or more underwriters, or selling group members, if any, participating in this offering. The representatives may agree to allocate a number of ordinary shares to underwriters for sale to their online brokerage account holders. Internet distributions will be allocated by the representatives to underwriters that may make Internet distributions on the same basis as other allocations.

The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, investment research, principal investment, hedging, financing and brokerage activities.

Certain of the underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, do perform and may in the future perform in the ordinary course of business various financial advisory, investment banking, commercial banking services and other services for us, Mubadala and their affiliates, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses. Moreover, certain of the underwriters have granted credit facilities to us, Mubadala and their affiliates, including certain of our existing debt facilities and the RCF Upsize, for which they may have received customary fees and expenses.

To the extent any underwriter that is not a U.S. registered broker-dealer intends to effect any offers or sales of any ordinary shares in the United States, it will do so through one or more U.S. registered broker-dealers in accordance with the applicable U.S. securities laws and regulations.

In addition, in the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates may make or hold a broad array of investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers and may at any time hold long and short positions in such securities and instruments. Such investment and securities activities may involve our securities and instruments. The underwriters and their respective affiliates may also make investment recommendations or publish or express independent research views in respect of such securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long or short positions in such securities and instruments.

Pricing of the Offering

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our ordinary shares. The initial public offering price was determined by negotiations between us, Mubadala and the representatives. Among the factors considered in determining the initial public offering price were our future prospects and those of our industry in general, our sales, earnings and certain other financial and operating information in recent periods, and the price-earnings ratios, price-sales ratios, market prices of securities, and certain financial and operating information of companies engaged in activities similar to ours.

 

172


Table of Contents

Directed Share Program

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 2,750,000 ordinary shares, or up to 5% of the shares offered by us and Mubadala in this offering, for sale at the initial public offering price through a directed share program to certain employees and other related persons identified by us. The number of ordinary shares available for sale to the general public will be reduced to the extent that such persons purchase such reserved shares. Except for shares purchased through the directed share program by certain of our officers and directors who have entered into lock-up agreements, shares purchased through the directed share program will not be subject to lock-up restrictions with the underwriters. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as the other shares offered by this prospectus. Other than the underwriting discount described on the front cover of this prospectus, the underwriters will not be entitled to any commission with respect to ordinary shares sold pursuant to the directed share program. We will agree to indemnify the underwriters and their affiliates against certain liabilities and expenses, including liabilities under the Securities Act, in connection with the sale of the shares reserved for the directed share program. Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC will administer our directed share program. In addition, we have requested that the underwriters make issuer directed allocations to certain investors in the aggregate of up to approximately $350 million in our ordinary shares.

Selling Restrictions

European Economic Area

In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area (each, a “Relevant State”), no shares have been offered or will be offered pursuant to the offering to the public in that Relevant State prior to the publication of a prospectus in relation to the shares which has been approved by the competent authority in that Relevant State or, where appropriate, approved in another Relevant State and notified to the competent authority in that Relevant State, all in accordance with the Prospectus Regulation, except that offers of shares may be made to the public in that Relevant State at any time under the following exemptions under the Prospectus Regulation:

 

  (a)  

to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined under Article 2 of the Prospectus Regulation;

 

  (b)  

to fewer than 150 natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined under Article 2 of the Prospectus Regulation), subject to obtaining the prior consent of the representatives for any such offer; or

 

  (c)  

in any other circumstances falling within Article 1(4) of the Prospectus Regulation;

provided that no such offer of shares shall require us or any of our representatives to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Regulation or supplement a prospectus pursuant to Article 23 of the Prospectus Regulation and each person who initially acquires any shares or to whom any offer is made will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged, and agreed to and with each of the underwriters and the company that it is a “qualified investor” within the meaning of Article 2(e) of the Prospectus Regulation. In the case of any shares being offered to a financial intermediary as that term is used in Article 5(1) of the Prospectus Regulation, each such financial intermediary will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged, and agreed that the shares acquired by it in the offer have not been acquired on a non-discretionary basis on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in circumstances which may give rise to an offer of any shares to the public other than their offer or resale in a Relevant State to qualified investors as so defined or in circumstances in which the prior consent of the underwriters have been obtained to each such proposed offer or resale.

For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer to the public” in relation to any shares in any Relevant State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and any shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for any shares, and the expression “Prospectus Regulation” means Regulation (EU) 2017/1129 (as amended).

The above selling restriction is in addition to any other selling restrictions set out below.

In connection with the offering, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, BofA Securities, Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC and Citigroup Global Markets Inc. are not acting for anyone other than

 

173


Table of Contents

the issuer and will not be responsible to anyone other than the issuer for providing the protections afforded to their clients nor for providing advice in relation to the offering.

United Kingdom

No shares have been offered or will be offered pursuant to this offering to the public in the United Kingdom, prior to the publication of a prospectus in relation to the shares which has been approved by the Financial Conduct Authority in the United Kingdom in accordance with the UK Prospectus Regulation and the FSMA, except that the shares may be offered to the public in the United Kingdom at any time:

 

  (a)  

to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined under Article 2 of the UK Prospectus Regulation;

 

  (b)  

to fewer than 150 natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined under Article 2 of the UK Prospectus Regulation), subject to obtaining the prior consent of the representatives for any such offer; or

 

  (c)  

in any other circumstances falling within Section 86 of the FSMA;

provided that no such offer of shares shall require the company or any Manager to publish a prospectus pursuant to Section 85 of the FSMA or Article 3 of the UK Prospectus Regulation or supplement a prospectus pursuant to Article 23 of the UK Prospectus Regulation.

Each person in the United Kingdom who initially acquires any ordinary shares or to whom any offer is made will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed to and with the company and the Underwriters that it is a qualified investor within the meaning of the UK Prospectus Regulation.

In the case of any ordinary shares being offered to a financial intermediary as that term is used in Article 5(1) of the UK Prospectus Regulation, each such financial intermediary will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that the Shares acquired by it in the offer have not been acquired on a non-discretionary basis on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in circumstances which may give rise to an offer to the public other than their offer or resale in the United Kingdom to qualified investors, in circumstances in which the prior consent of the Underwriters has been obtained to each such proposed offer or resale.

The Company, the Underwriters and their affiliates will rely upon the truth and accuracy of the foregoing representations, acknowledgements and agreements.

For the purposes of this provision, the expression an “offer to the public” in relation to the shares in the United Kingdom means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and any shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for any shares. The expression “UK Prospectus Regulation” means Regulation (EU) 2017/1129 as it forms part of domestic law by virtue of the European Union (Withdrawal) Act 2018, and the expression “FSMA” means the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000.

In connection with the offering, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, BofA Securities, Inc., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC and Citigroup Global Markets Inc. are not acting for anyone other than the issuer and will not be responsible to anyone other than the issuer for providing the protections afforded to their clients nor for providing advice in relation to the offering.

This document is for distribution only to persons who (i) have professional experience in matters relating to investments and who qualify as investment professionals within the meaning of Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005 (as amended, the “Financial Promotion Order”), (ii) are persons falling within Article 49(2)(a) to (d) (“high net worth companies, unincorporated associations etc.”) of the Financial Promotion Order, (iii) are outside the United Kingdom, or (iv) are persons to whom an invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of Section 21 of the FSMA) in connection with the issue or sale of any securities may otherwise lawfully be communicated or caused

 

174


Table of Contents

to be communicated (all such persons together being referred to as “relevant persons”). This document is directed only at relevant persons and must not be acted on or relied on by persons who are not relevant persons. Any investment or investment activity to which this document relates is available only to relevant persons and will be engaged in only with relevant persons.

Japan

No registration pursuant to Article 4, paragraph 1 of the Financial Instruments and Exchange Law of Japan (Law No. 25 of 1948, as amended) (the “FIEL”) has been made or will be made with respect to the solicitation of the application for the acquisition of the ordinary shares.

Accordingly, the ordinary shares have not been, directly or indirectly, offered or sold and will not be, directly or indirectly, offered or sold in Japan or to, or for the benefit of, any resident of Japan (which term as used herein means any person resident in Japan, including any corporation or other entity organized under the laws of Japan) or to others for re-offering or re-sale, directly or indirectly, in Japan or to, or for the benefit of, any resident of Japan except pursuant to an exemption from the registration requirements, and otherwise in compliance with, the FIEL and the other applicable laws and regulations of Japan.

For Qualified Institutional Investors (“QII”)

Please note that the solicitation for newly-issued or secondary securities (each as described in Paragraph 2, Article 4 of the FIEL) in relation to the ordinary shares constitutes either a “QII only private placement” or a “QII only secondary distribution” (each as described in Paragraph 1, Article 23-13 of the FIEL). Disclosure regarding any such solicitation, as is otherwise prescribed in Paragraph 1, Article 4 of the FIEL, has not been made in relation to the ordinary shares. The ordinary shares may only be transferred to QIIs.

For Non-QII Investors

Please note that the solicitation for newly-issued or secondary securities (each as described in Paragraph 2, Article 4 of the FIEL) in relation to the ordinary shares constitutes either a “small number private placement” or a “small number private secondary distribution” (each as is described in Paragraph 4, Article 23-13 of the FIEL). Disclosure regarding any such solicitation, as is otherwise prescribed in Paragraph 1, Article 4 of the FIEL, has not been made in relation to the ordinary shares. The ordinary shares may only be transferred en bloc without subdivision to a single investor.

Switzerland

The shares may not be publicly offered in Switzerland and will not be listed on the SIX Swiss Exchange (“SIX”) or on any other stock exchange or regulated trading facility in Switzerland. This document has been prepared without regard to the disclosure standards for issuance prospectuses under art. 652a or art. 1156 of the Swiss Code of Obligations or the disclosure standards for listing prospectuses under art. 27 ff. of the SIX Listing Rules or the listing rules of any other stock exchange or regulated trading facility in Switzerland. Neither this document nor any other offering or marketing material relating to the shares or the offering may be publicly distributed or otherwise made publicly available in Switzerland.

Neither this document nor any other offering or marketing material relating to the offering, the Company, the shares have been or will be filed with or approved by any Swiss regulatory authority. In particular, this document will not be filed with, and the offer of shares will not be supervised by, the Swiss Financial Market Supervisory Authority FINMA (FINMA), and the offer of shares has not been and will not be authorized under the Swiss Federal Act on Collective Investment Schemes (“CISA”). The investor protection afforded to acquirers of interests in collective investment schemes under the CISA does not extend to acquirers of shares.

 

175


Table of Contents

Dubai International Financial Centre

This prospectus relates to an Exempt Offer in accordance with the Offered Securities Rules of the Dubai Financial Services Authority (“DFSA”). This prospectus is intended for distribution only to persons of a type specified in the Offered Securities Rules of the DFSA. It must not be delivered to, or relied on by, any other person. The DFSA has no responsibility for reviewing or verifying any documents in connection with Exempt Offers. The DFSA has not approved this prospectus nor taken steps to verify the information set forth herein and has no responsibility for the prospectus. The shares to which this prospectus relates may be illiquid and/or subject to restrictions on their resale. Prospective purchasers of the shares offered should conduct their own due diligence on the shares. If you do not understand the contents of this prospectus you should consult an authorized financial advisor.

Singapore

This prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, the shares were not offered or sold or caused to be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase and will not be offered or sold or caused to be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, and this prospectus or any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares, has not been circulated or distributed, nor will it be circulated or distributed, whether directly or indirectly, to any person in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor (as defined in Section 4A of the Securities and Futures Act (Chapter 289) of Singapore, as modified or amended from time to time (the “SFA”)) pursuant to Section 274 of the SFA, (ii) to a relevant person (as defined in Section 275(2) of the SFA) pursuant to Section 275(1) of the SFA, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A) of the SFA, and in accordance with the conditions specified in Section 275 of the SFA, or (iii) otherwise pursuant to, and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable provision of the SFA.

Where the shares are subscribed or purchased under Section 275 of the SFA by a relevant person which is:

 

  (a)  

a corporation (which is not an accredited investor (as defined in Section 4A of the SFA)) the sole business of which is to hold investments and the entire share capital of which is owned by one or more individuals, each of whom is an accredited investor; or

 

  (b)  

a trust (where the trustee is not an accredited investor) whose sole purpose is to hold investments and each beneficiary of the trust is an individual who is an accredited investor,

securities or securities-based derivatives contracts (each term as defined in Section 2(1) of the SFA) of that corporation or the beneficiaries’ rights and interest (howsoever described) in that trust shall not be transferred within six months after that corporation or that trust has acquired the shares pursuant to an offer made under Section 275 of the SFA except:

 

  (a)  

to an institutional investor or to a relevant person, or to any person arising from an offer referred to in Section 275(1A) or Section 276(4)(i)(B) of the SFA;

 

  (b)  

where no consideration is or will be given for the transfer;

 

  (c)  

where the transfer is by operation of law; or

 

  (d)  

as specified in Section 276(7) of the SFA.

Canada

The shares may be sold only to purchasers purchasing, or deemed to be purchasing, as principal that are accredited investors, as defined in National Instrument 45-106 Prospectus Exemptions or subsection 73.3(1) of the Securities Act (Ontario), and are permitted clients, as defined in National Instrument 31-103 Registration Requirements, Exemptions and Ongoing Registrant Obligations. Any resale of the shares must be made in accordance with an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the prospectus requirements of applicable securities laws.

 

176


Table of Contents

Securities legislation in certain provinces or territories of Canada may provide a purchaser with remedies for rescission or damages if this prospectus (including any amendment thereto) contains a misrepresentation, provided that the remedies for rescission or damages are exercised by the purchaser within the time limit prescribed by the securities legislation of the purchaser’s province or territory. The purchaser should refer to any applicable provisions of the securities legislation of the purchaser’s province or territory for particulars of these rights or consult with a legal advisor.

Pursuant to section 3A.3 (or, in the case of securities issued or guaranteed by the government of a non-Canadian jurisdiction, section 3A.4) of National Instrument 33-105 Underwriting Conflicts (NI 33-105), the underwriters are not required to comply with the disclosure requirements of NI 33-105 regarding underwriter conflicts of interest in connection with this offering.

Australia

No placement document, prospectus, product disclosure statement or other disclosure document has been lodged with the Australian Securities and Investments Commission (“ASIC”), in relation to the offering. This prospectus does not constitute a prospectus, product disclosure statement or other disclosure document under the Corporations Act 2001 (the “Corporations Act”), and does not purport to include the information required for a prospectus, product disclosure statement or other disclosure document under the Corporations Act.

Any offer in Australia of the shares may only be made to persons (the “Exempt Investors”) who are “sophisticated investors” (within the meaning of section 708(8) of the Corporations Act), “professional investors” (within the meaning of section 708(11) of the Corporations Act) or otherwise pursuant to one or more exemptions contained in section 708 of the Corporations Act so that it is lawful to offer the shares without disclosure to investors under Chapter 6D of the Corporations Act.

The shares applied for by Exempt Investors in Australia must not be offered for sale in Australia in the period of 12 months after the date of allotment under the offering, except in circumstances where disclosure to investors under Chapter 6D of the Corporations Act would not be required pursuant to an exemption under section 708 of the Corporations Act or otherwise or where the offer is pursuant to a disclosure document which complies with Chapter 6D of the Corporations Act. Any person acquiring shares must observe such Australian on-sale restrictions.

This prospectus contains general information only and does not take account of the investment objectives, financial situation or particular needs of any particular person. It does not contain any securities recommendations or financial product advice. Before making an investment decision, investors need to consider whether the information in this prospectus is appropriate to their needs, objectives and circumstances, and, if necessary, seek expert advice on those matters.

Hong Kong

The shares have not been offered or sold and will not be offered or sold in Hong Kong, by means of any document, other than (a) to “professional investors” as defined in the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571) of Hong Kong and any rules made under that Ordinance; or (b) in other circumstances which do not result in the document being a “prospectus” as defined in the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32) of Hong Kong or which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of that Ordinance. No advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares has been or may be issued or has been or may be in the possession of any person for the purposes of issue, whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere, which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public of Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the securities laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” as defined in the Securities and Futures Ordinance and any rules made under that Ordinance.

 

177


Table of Contents

EXPENSES OF THE OFFERING

We estimate that our expenses in connection with this offering, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, will be as follows:

 

Expenses

   Amount  

SEC registration fee

   US$ 275,574  

Nasdaq listing fee

     25,000  

FINRA filing fee

     225,500  

Printing and engraving expenses

      550,000  

Legal fees and expenses

     1,906,000  

Accounting fees and expenses

     2,100,000  

Miscellaneous costs

     24,917,926  
  

 

 

 

Total

   US$ 30,000,000
  

 

 

 

All amounts in the table are estimates except the SEC registration fee, the Nasdaq listing fee and the FINRA filing fee. We will pay all of the expenses of this offering. The underwriters have agreed to reimburse us for up to $                 of our expenses in connection with this offering.

 

178


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain matters of U.S. federal and New York State law will be passed upon for us by Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP and for the underwriters by Latham & Watkins LLP. The validity of the ordinary shares offered in this offering and other legal matters as to Cayman Islands law will be passed upon for us by Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP.

EXPERTS

The consolidated financial statements of the company as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes appearing in this prospectus and the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part, have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP (“EY”), independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing. The offices of EY are located at 275 Shoreline Drive, Redwood City, California 94065.

Prior to the engagement of EY as our independent registered public accounting firm under the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”), certain member firms of Ernst & Young Global Limited (“EYG”) provided non-audit services to certain consolidated subsidiaries and commonly controlled (“sister”) affiliates of the company, described below, which are permissible under the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (“AICPA”) independence rules, but are inconsistent with the SEC and PCAOB independence rules.

 

   

From November 2020 to May 2021, the EYG member firm in Germany provided tax litigation support services (expert services) to two subsidiaries of the company.

 

   

From March 2019 to December 2020, the EYG member firm in the United Arab Emirates (“UAE”) provided internal audit services under a loan staff arrangement to a sister affiliate.

 

   

During certain periods from July 2019 to May 2021, EYG member firms in the UAE, Spain and Austria provided legal services to two sister affiliates.

These non-audit services, which have been completed or terminated, do not impact the consolidated financial statements and internal controls over financial reporting of the company, nor EY’s related audit procedures or judgments. The fees for these non-audit services are not material to the respective parties.

After careful consideration of the facts and circumstances and the applicable independence rules, EY has concluded that (i) the aforementioned matters do not impair its ability to exercise objective and impartial judgment in connection with its audits of our consolidated financial statements, and (ii) a reasonable investor with knowledge of all relevant facts and circumstances would reach the same conclusion. After considering these matters, the company’s management and the audit, risk and compliance committee concur with EY’s conclusions.

The company, which is a controlled portfolio company of Mubadala, was regulated by the Abu Dhabi Accountability Authority, which requires companies to rotate their audit firms every four years under its Statutory Auditor Appointment Rules (“SAAR”). Due to the SAAR rotation requirement, EY was prohibited from serving as auditor for the company for the year ending December 31, 2021. KPMG LLP (“KPMG LLP (Singapore)”) was appointed in March 2021 as auditor of the company for the year ending December 31, 2021, under the independence rules of the Singapore Accounting & Corporate Regulatory Authority and the International Ethics Standards Board for Accountants Code of Ethics (“IESBA Code”). In addition, for the year ending December 31, 2021 and for any subsequent audit periods, KPMG LLP (Singapore) is now required to be independent under SEC and PCAOB independence rules and regulations. The consolidated financial statements

 

179


Table of Contents

of the company for the year ending December 31, 2021 will be audited by KPMG LLP (Singapore), independent registered public accounting firm, and is expected to be stated in its report appearing therein. Such financial statements will be included in that future filing in reliance upon the report of KPMG LLP (Singapore) and upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

During the year ending December 31, 2021 and prior to its appointment as auditor of the company under PCAOB standards, one of KPMG LLP (Singapore)’s affiliates, referred to as a KPMG member firm, provided non-audit services to a consolidated subsidiary of the company. These services consisted of payroll processing and human resource administration, which included a management function, and immigration services, which included a legal service and cash handling, that was impermissible when evaluated under SEC and PCAOB independence rules and regulations. The KPMG member firm that delivered these services did not include KPMG LLP (Singapore) or any of its staff and did not provide any audit services to the company. Under local rules and the IESBA Code, these services were permissible.

These impermissible non-audit services were provided to an immaterial consolidated subsidiary that is a non-significant component for the purposes of the group audit and will have an immaterial impact on the consolidated financial statements. None of the deliverables under the service will be subject to audit procedures performed by KPMG LLP (Singapore) as part of its audit of the company, and the services had no impact on the internal control over financial reporting of the company. In aggregate, the KPMG member firm earned fees of approximately $29,100 in 2021 in connection with these non-audit services. These fees were insignificant to the business of the KPMG member firm and the company. The management of the consolidated subsidiary of the company retained all decision making and ultimate responsibility for the services provided, and the services were terminated in April 2021 (with respect to payroll processing and immigration services) and in June 2021 (with respect to human resource administration).

The company’s audit, risk and compliance committee and KPMG LLP (Singapore) have separately considered the impact that these impermissible non-audit services may have had on KPMG LLP (Singapore)’s objectivity and impartiality with respect to its audit of the company. Both the company’s audit, risk and compliance committee and KPMG LLP (Singapore) have concluded that these non-audit services will not affect KPMG LLP (Singapore)’s ability to exercise objective and impartial judgment on all issues encompassed within the audit engagement to be performed by KPMG LLP (Singapore) for the consolidated financial statements of the company for the year ending December 31, 2021, and that a reasonable investor with knowledge of all relevant facts and circumstances would reach the same conclusion.

 

180


Table of Contents

CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT

Prior to this offering, we were a wholly owned company of Mubadala, and subject to the Abu Dhabi Accountability Authority requirement that companies rotate their audit firms every four years under its SAAR. Due to the SAAR rotation requirement, EY is prohibited from serving as our auditor for the year ending December 31, 2021.

We notified EY on March 4, 2021 that it would be dismissed as our auditor, effective upon the completion of the December 31, 2020 audit. On March 3, 2021, our audit, risk and compliance committee approved the appointment of KPMG LLP (Singapore) as our auditor for the year ending December 31, 2021.

The audit report of EY on our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2020, and 2019, and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020 did not contain any adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion and was not qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principles. During the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the subsequent interim period through March 4, 2021, there was no disagreement with EY on any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreement, if not resolved to their satisfaction, would have caused them to make reference to the subject matter of the disagreement in connection with their report, or any “reportable event” as that term is described in Item 16F(a)(1)(v) of Form 20-F.

We have provided a copy of the above statements to EY and requested that EY furnish us with a letter addressed to the SEC stating whether or not EY agrees with the above disclosure. A copy of that letter, dated September 13, 2021, is filed as Exhibit 16.1 to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part.

Further, during the years ended December 31, 2020, and 2019, and the subsequent interim period through March 3, 2021, we have not consulted with KPMG LLP (Singapore) regarding either (i) the application of accounting principles to a specified transaction, either completed or proposed; or the type of audit opinion that might be rendered with respect to our consolidated financial statements; or (ii) any matter that was either the subject of a disagreement as that term is defined in Item 16F(a)(1)(iv) of Form 20-F or a “reportable event” as described in Item 16F(a)(1)(v) of Form 20-F.

 

181


Table of Contents

WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form F-1 under the Securities Act with respect to the sale of ordinary shares under this prospectus. This prospectus, which constitutes a part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement, some of which is contained in exhibits to the registration statement as permitted by the rules and regulations of the SEC. For further information with respect to us and our ordinary shares, we refer you to the registration statement, including the exhibits filed as a part of the registration statement. Statements contained in this prospectus concerning the contents of any contract or any other document are not necessarily complete descriptions of all terms of such documents. If a contract or document has been filed as an exhibit to the registration statement, please see the copy of the contract or document that has been filed. Each statement in this prospectus relating to a contract or document filed as an exhibit is qualified in all respects by the filed exhibit. The SEC maintains an Internet website that contains reports and other information about issuers, like us, that file electronically with the SEC. The address of that website is www.sec.gov.

We currently do not file periodic reports with the SEC. As a result of this offering, we will become subject to the information and reporting requirements of the Exchange Act that are applicable to foreign private issuers, and, in accordance with this law, will file periodic reports and other information with the SEC. These periodic reports and other information will be available for inspection and copying at the SEC’s public reference facilities and the website of the SEC referred to above. We also maintain a website at www.gf.com. Upon completion of this offering, you may access these materials free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information contained on our website is not a part of this prospectus and the inclusion of our website address in this prospectus is an inactive textual reference only. As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt under the Exchange Act from, among other things, the rules prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements, and our executive officers, directors and shareholders are exempt from the reporting and short-swing profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act. In addition, we will not be required under the Exchange Act to file periodic reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently or as promptly as U.S. companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act.

 

182


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     Pages

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

   F-2

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss

   F-5 to F-6

Consolidated Statements of Financial Position

   F-7

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity

   F-8

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

   F-9 to F-10

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   F-11

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2021

   F-80

Statements of Financial Position as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021

   F-81

Statements of Changes in Equity for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2021

   F-82

Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2021

   F-83-84

Notes to Unaudited Interim Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2021

   F-85-99

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Shareholder and the Board of Directors of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial position of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the consolidated financial statements). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at December 31, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (“PCAOB”) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Critical Audit Matter

The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current period audit of the financial statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that: (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective or complex judgments. The communication of the critical audit matter does not alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.

 

F-2


Table of Contents
IMPAIRMENT ASSESSMENT OF PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

 

Description of the
Matter
  

As of December 31, 2020, the net book value of the Company’s property, plant and equipment was $8.2 billion. As discussed in Notes 3 and 14 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company reviews, at each reporting date, the carrying amount of the Company’s property, plant and equipment to determine whether there is any indication that those assets have suffered an impairment loss.

 

The facilities and equipment utilized in the semiconductor manufacturing processes are highly integrated and inter-dependent in the production process. The recoverable amounts of the individual long-lived assets cannot be determined as the cash inflows are not largely independent of those from other assets. Where it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of an individual assets, the Company estimates the recoverable amount of the cash generating unit (“CGU”) to which the asset belongs. Therefore, the Company has concluded that each of its fabrication facilities constitute a separate CGU. When the carrying amount of a CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, the CGU is considered impaired and is written down to its recoverable amount.

 

The Company bases its impairment calculation on detailed budgets and forecast calculations, which include an approved formal five-year management plan for each of the CGUs to which the individual assets are allocated. The estimated future post-tax cash flows are discounted to their present value using a post-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted.

 

The Company has assessed indicators of impairment for its CGUs and performed impairment assessment during the fourth quarter of the year ended December 31, 2020. Based on this assessment the Company concluded there was no impairment of long-lived assets.

 

Auditing the Company’s impairment assessment was complex due to the high degree of estimation uncertainty in forecasting the future cash flows for each CGU. Specifically, the forecasted cash flows were sensitive to changes in significant assumptions, such as forecast sales volume and prices, and discount rates.

 

F-3


Table of Contents
How We Addressed the
Matter in Our Audit
  

Our testing of the Company’s CGU impairment assessment included, among others, testing the Company’s processes of identifying and assessing indicators that a CGU may be impaired and that an impairment assessment is required. Additionally, we evaluated the appropriateness of the methodology used to estimate the recoverable amount and the completeness, accuracy, and relevance of the underlying data used in the valuation model. We also compared projected cash flows used in the valuation model against the Company’s approved formal five-year management plan for each of the CGUs. We also evaluated the significant assumptions used by management, including the forecasted sales volumes and prices, and discount rates. We evaluated the reasonableness of management’s assumptions by comparing projected revenue by customers to customer contracts or customer demand forecasting, comparing key market related assumptions (including revenue growth rate) used in the model to external data, performing a retrospective comparison of forecasted cash flows to actual past performance and previous forecasts, and performing sensitivity analyses. We also involved our internal valuation specialists to assist in the evaluation of the Company’s discount rate assumptions. Our procedures also included evaluating the Company’s disclosures within Notes 3 and 14 to the consolidated financial statements.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2016.

San Jose, California

August 6, 2021,

except for the fourth and fifth paragraphs of Note 37, as to which the date is

September 13, 2021

 

F-4


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

(Dollars in thousands)

 

          For the Years Ended December 31,  
     Notes    2018     2019     2020  

Net revenues

   4    $ 6,196,039     $ 5,812,788     $ 4,850,505  

Cost of revenues

   5      6,646,090       6,345,032       5,563,225  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross loss

        (450,051     (532,244     (712,720
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Research and development expenses

   6      926,220       582,974       475,769  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

   7      452,747       445,628       444,860  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

        1,378,967       1,028,602       920,629  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring charges

   8      112,026              

Impairment charges

   9      582,246       63,950       22,672  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other operating charges

        694,272       63,950       22,672  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

        (2,523,290     (1,624,796     (1,656,021

Finance income

        10,283       11,379       3,098  

Finance expenses

   10      (164,804     (230,176     (154,387

Share of profit of joint ventures and associates

   16      6,900       7,859       3,876  

Gain on sale of a fabrication facility and application specific integrated circuit business

   11            614,554        

Other income, net

   12      61,331       74,055       440,307  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes from continuing operations

        (2,609,580     (1,147,125     (1,363,127

Income tax (expense) benefit

   17      (16,446     (224,061     12,267  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss from continuing operations

        (2,626,026     (1,371,186     (1,350,860

Discontinued operations

         

Loss from discontinued operations, net tax of $1

   13      (148,020            
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss for the year

      $ (2,774,046   $ (1,371,186   $ (1,350,860
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-5


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

(Dollars in thousands, except share amounts)

 

            For the Years Ended December 31,  
     Notes      2018     2019     2020  

Attributable to:

         

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

      $ (2,701,603   $ (1,371,186   $ (1,347,571

Non-controlling interest

        (72,443           (3,289
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss for the year

      $ (2,774,046   $ (1,371,186   $ (1,350,860

Net loss per share attributable to the equity holders of the Company:

         

Basic and diluted loss per share:

         

From continuing operations

     31      $ (4.56   $ (2.72   $ (2.70

From discontinued operations

     31        (0.14            
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share

      $ (4.70   $ (2.72   $ (2.70

Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax:

         

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss:

         

Effective portion of changes in the fair value of cash flow hedges

     20      $ (21,811   $ 12,351     $ (22,802

Income tax effect

     17        7,629       (1,081     (2,106
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
        (14,182     11,270       (24,908

Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss:

         

Remeasurement of existing equity interests

     16                    6,553  

Share of foreign exchange fluctuation reserve of joint ventures and associates

        (2,038     (566     13,890  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive (loss) income

      $ (16,220   $ 10,704     $ (4,465

Attributable to:

         

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

      $ (16,220   $ 10,704     $ (9,165

Non-controlling interest

                    4,700  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive (loss) income for the year

      $ (16,220   $ 10,704     $ (4,655
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to:

         

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

      $ (2,717,823   $ (1,360,482   $ (1,356,736

Non-controlling interest

        (72,443           1,411  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive loss for the year

      $ (2,790,266   $ (1,360,482   $ (1,355,325
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in Note 37 Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION

(Dollars in thousands)

 

            As of December 31,  
     Notes      2019     2020  

ASSETS

       

Noncurrent assets:

       

Property, plant and equipment, net

     14      $ 9,611,269     $ 8,226,202  

Goodwill and intangible assets, net

     15        634,781       547,942  

Investments in joint ventures and associates

     16        77,331       36,702  

Other noncurrent financial assets

     20        12,558       34,054  

Deferred tax assets

     17        408,050       443,566  

Restricted cash

     21        1,774       1,583  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets*

     18, 32        237,593       44,860  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noncurrent assets

        10,983,356       9,334,909  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current assets:

       

Inventories, net

     19        351,923       919,519  

Other current financial assets

     20        6,798       50,534  

Receivables from government grants

     21        234,140       51,660  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets*

     18, 32        1,887,197       1,022,863  

Restricted cash

     21        32,625       34,071  

Cash and cash equivalents

     21        997,315       908,077  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        3,509,998       2,986,724  

Assets held for sale

        4,152        
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

        3,514,150       2,986,724  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

      $ 14,497,506     $  12,321,633  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

EQUITY AND LIABILITIES

       

Equity:

       

Share capital

       

Ordinary shares, $0.02 par value, 1,500,000 thousand shares authorized, 500,000 thousand shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2019 and 2020

     22      $ 10,000     $ 10,000  

Additional paid-in capital

     22        11,706,535       11,707,515  

Loan from shareholder

     32        11,167,687       10,680,687  

Accumulated deficit

        (13,870,938     (15,218,509

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

        5,846       (3,319
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity attributable to the shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

        9,019,130       7,176,374  

Non-controlling interest

              65,128  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

        9,019,130       7,241,502  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent liabilities:

       

Noncurrent portion of long-term debt*

     23, 32        2,042,254       1,956,148  

Noncurrent portion of finance lease obligations

     24        388,257       333,242  

Deferred tax liabilities

     17        591       8,422  

Noncurrent deferred revenue

     27        45,818       12,112  

Other noncurrent financial liabilities

     20              33,345  

Other noncurrent liabilities

     28        177,319       358,787  

Provisions

     25        337,765       353,308  

Noncurrent portion of deferred income from government grants

     26        150,305       128,697  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noncurrent liabilities

        3,142,309       3,184,061  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

       

Current portion of long-term debt

     23        686,913       381,807  

Current portion of finance lease obligations

     24        130,912       131,270  

Current portion of deferred income from government grants

     26        43,904       40,505  

Current deferred revenue

     27        98,744       94,081  

Other current financial liabilities

     20        5,275       1,318  

Trade and other payables*

     28, 32        1,333,262       1,216,480  

Income tax payable

     17        37,057       30,609  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

        2,336,067       1,896,070  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

        5,478,376       5,080,131  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

      $ 14,497,506     $  12,321,633  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

Includes amounts of related party transactions. See Note 32 for details.

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in Note 37 Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY

(Dollars in thousands)

 

    Equity Attributable to Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.              
    Common Shares     Additional
Paid-In

Capital
    Loan from
Shareholder
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Hedging
Reserve
    Foreign
Currency
Translation

Reserve
    Available-
For-Sale
Investment

Reserve
    Total     Non-
controlling

Interest
    Total
Equity
 
    Shares     Amount  

As of December 31, 2017

    576,902,150     $ 11,538     $ 11,699,467     $ 11,567,687     $ (9,894,380   $ (10,372   $ (1,517   $ 5,887     $ 13,378,310     $ 48,501     $ 13,426,811  

Adoption of IFRS 9 and IFRS 15*

                            96,231       23,251             (5,887     113,595             113,595  

Non-controlling interest

                                                          23,942       23,942  

Share-based payments

                5,530                                     5,530             5,530  

Net loss for the year

                            (2,701,603                       (2,701,603     (72,443     (2,774,046

Other comprehensive loss

                                  (14,182     (2,038           (16,220       (16,220
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2018

    576,902,150       11,538       11,704,997       11,567,687       (12,499,752     (1,303     (3,555           10,779,612             10,779,612  

Surrender of issued shares

    (76,902,150     (1,538     1,538                                                  

Repayment of loan from shareholder

                      (400,000                             (400,000           (400,000

Net loss for the year

                            (1,371,186                       (1,371,186           (1,371,186

Other comprehensive (loss) income

                                  11,270       (566           10,704             10,704  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019

    500,000,000       10,000       11,706,535       11,167,687       (13,870,938     9,967       (4,121           9,019,130             9,019,130  

Share-based payments

                980                               980             980  

Acquisition of subsidiaries

                                                          63,717       63,717  

Repayment of loan from shareholder

                      (487,000                             (487,000           (487,000

Net loss for the year

                            (1,347,571                       (1,347,571     (3,289     (1,350,860

Other comprehensive (loss) income

                                  (24,908     15,743             (9,165     4,700       (4,465
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

    500,000,000     $ 10,000     $ 11,707,515     $ 10,680,687     $ (15,218,509   $ (14,941   $ 11,622     $     $ 7,176,374     $ 65,128     $ 7,241,502  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

IFRS 9 and IFRS 15 are adopted for all years presented. The cumulative effect of adopting IFRS 9 and IFRS is reflected in the opening balance of Accumulated deficit as of January 1, 2018.

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in Note 37 Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(Dollars in thousands)

 

            Years Ended December 31,  
     Notes      2018     2019     2020  

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES

         

Net loss

      $ (2,774,046   $ (1,371,186   $ (1,350,860

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

         

Depreciation

     14        2,683,170       2,435,899       2,238,405  

Amortization of intangible assets

     15        264,754       242,325       284,109  

Impairment charges

     9        582,246       63,950       22,672  

Impairment charge related to discontinued operations

     13        127,403              

Finance income

        (10,427     (11,379     (3,098

Finance expenses

     10        166,930       230,176       154,387  

Amortization of deferred income from government grants

     26        (179,626     (156,793     (51,043

Share of profit of joint ventures and affiliates

     16        (6,900     (7,859     (3,876

Change in fair value of investments in equity instruments

        694             (3,800

Write-off of investment in equity accounted investees

        8,697              

Deferred income taxes

     17        3,693       214,272       (37,749

Foreign currency exchange net loss

  

 

 

 

     842       12,860       28,999  

Gain on disposal of property, plant and equipment

     14        (18,963     (88,319     (79,266

Gain on remeasurement of existing equity interests

     12, 16                    (38,470

Gain on sale of fabrication facilities

     11              (614,554      

(Gain) loss on derivatives

     20        (359     486       (327

Share-based payments

     33        5,530             980  

Other operating activities

        2,204       14,745       (44,672

Change in assets and liabilities:

         

Receivables, prepayments and other assets

     18        (187,952     (143,710     752,862  

Inventories

     19        (28,524     (42,325     (559,876

Trade and other payables

     28        (69,406     (96,868     (154,514

Deferred revenue relating to technology cooperation agreement

        (168,245            

Income tax payable

     17        5,211       (1,942     20,920  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
        406,926       679,778       1,175,783  

Interest received

        9,914       15,196       3,886  

Interest paid

     10        (128,892     (196,351     (145,528

Income tax paid

     17        (8,639     (1,804     (28,244
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

        279,309       496,819       1,005,897  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES

         

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

     14        (1,150,255     (587,934     (449,288

Payments from settlement of hedges

     20        (720     (1,382     (261

Purchases of intangible assets

     15        (178,381     (184,884     (143,200

Cash dividends received from equity accounted investees

     16        1,544       1,962       2,548  

Loans issued to related parties

     28, 32        (29,715     (22,386      

Advances and proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

     14, 15, 16        85,312       252,158       109,052  

 

F-9


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(Dollars in thousands)

 

            Years Ended December 31,  
     Notes      2018     2019     2020  

Advances and proceeds from sale of fabrication facilities and ASIC business

     11              832,627       110,851  

Proceeds from sale of interest in equity investee

     16        36,300              

Purchase and sale of investment in equity securities

     16        29,977       4,020        

Proceeds from settlement of loans issued to joint ventures and associates

     32        38,759       49,568        

Acquisition of subsidiaries

     14                    4,133  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities

        (1,167,179     343,749       (366,165
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES

         

Repayments of shareholder loan

     32              (400,000     (487,000

Proceeds from borrowings from shareholder

     23, 32        358,000              

Repayments of borrowings from shareholder

     23, 32        (250,000     (246,984     (111,516

Proceeds from borrowings

     23        2,542,916       2,860,196       2,816,871  

Payment of debt issuance costs

     23        (15,652     (45,369     (16,082

Repayments of debt and finance lease obligations

     23, 24        (1,814,379     (3,158,861     (3,245,594

Proceeds from government grants

     21        231,467       335,222       311,833  

Contribution from non-controlling interest

     16        25,000              

Decrease (increase) in restricted cash

     21        54,732       (28,036     (1,255
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

        1,132,084       (683,832     (732,743
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     34        (1,301     (3,399     3,773  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     21        242,913       153,337       (89,238

Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the year

     21        601,065       843,978       997,315  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the year

      $ 843,978     $ 997,315     $ 908,077  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncash investing and financing activities:

         

Amounts payable for property, plant and equipment

      $ 272,708     $ 19,644     $ 201,745  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment acquired through lease

      $ 137,192     $ 74,592     $ 8,933  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts payable for intangible assets

      $ 74,680     $ 81,024     $ 159,295  
     

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

1. Organization

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (“GLOBALFOUNDRIES”) is an exempted company with limited liability incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands. The address of GLOBALFOUNDRIES’ registered office is P.O. Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104 Cayman Islands.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES and its subsidiaries (together referred to as the “Company”) is one of the world’s largest pure-play semiconductor foundries and offer a full range of mainstream wafer fabrication services and technologies. The Company manufactures a broad range of semiconductor devices, including microprocessors, mobile application processors, baseband processors, network processors, radio frequency modems, microcontrollers, power management units and microelectromechanical systems.

The consolidated financial statements include the following subsidiaries which are all wholly owned, except for GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Chengdu) Integrated Circuit Manufacturing Co., Limited, Advanced Mask Technology Centre GmbH & Co. KG, Maskhouse Building Administration GmbH & Co. KH, Advanced Mask Technology Center Verwaltungs GmbH, and Maskhouse Building Administration Verwaltungs GmbH:

 

Subsidiary

  Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or
Organization
  December 31,
2018
  December 31,
2019
  December 31,
2020

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Innovation Investments LLC

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Borrower LLC

  United States   X   X   X

Hudson Valley Research Park Sewage Works Corporation

  United States   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH

  Germany   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC & Co. KG

  Germany   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC & Co. KG

  Germany   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH

  Germany   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services LLC & Co. KG

  Germany   X   X   X

Advanced Mask Technology Centre GmbH & Co. KG (50%)

  Germany   N/A   N/A   X

Maskhouse Building Administration GmbH & Co. KH (50%)

  Germany   N/A   N/A   X

Advanced Mask Technology Center Verwaltungs GmbH (50%)

  Germany   N/A   N/A   X

Maskhouse Building Administration Verwaltungs GmbH (50%)

  Germany   N/A   N/A   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Europe Sales & Support GmbH

  Germany   N/A   N/A   X

 

F-11


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Subsidiary

  Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or
Organization
  December 31,
2018
  December 31,
2019
  December 31,
2020

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Engineering Private Limited

  India   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Japan Ltd.

  Japan   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Cooperatief U.A.

  The Netherlands   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V.

  The Netherlands   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V.

  The Netherlands   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Bulgaria EAD

  Bulgaria   N/A   X   X

GF Asia Investments Pte. Ltd.

  Singapore   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

  Singapore   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Taiwan Ltd.

  Taiwan   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Europe Ltd.

  United Kingdom   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Chengdu) Integrated Circuit Manufacturing Co., Limited (51%)

  China   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES China (Beijing) Co., Limited

  China   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES China (Shanghai) Co., Limited

  China   X   X   X

Nanjing APD Technologies Co. Ltd.

  China   X   X   X

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Technologies LLC

  Abu Dhabi   X   N/A   N/A

Avera Semiconductor LLC

  United States   X   N/A   N/A

GLOBALFOUNDRIES is a wholly owned subsidiary of Mubadala Technology Investments LLC (“Shareholder”) through its subsidiaries, Mubadala Technology Investment Company and MTI International Investment Company LLC. Mubadala Technology Investments LLC is a subsidiary of Mamoura Diversified Global Holding PJSC (“MDGH”). Mubadala Investment Company PJSC (“MIC”) is the ultimate parent company. See Note 32 for further discussion of the Company’s related party disclosures including loans with its Shareholder.

On April 15, 2019, the Company entered into an agreement with Semiconductor Components Industries, LLC (“ON Semiconductor”) to sell the Company’s facility in East Fishkill, New York for $400,000, including buildings, facilities, certain equipment, inventories, certain contracts, furniture, employees and $30,000 for a technology license. Under the agreement the Company will manufacture 300mm wafers for ON Semiconductor until the end of 2022 for additional fees, allowing ON Semiconductor to increase its 300mm production at the East Fishkill fab over several years. Under the agreement, ON Semiconductor committed to minimum fixed cost payments in each year from 2020 through 2022. The agreement also includes a technology transfer and development agreement and a technology license agreement. The Company received $100,000 and recognized license revenue of $30,000 for the technology license in 2019. The sale is scheduled to close by the end of 2022 and the Company expects to recognize a gain upon the completion of the sale. The Company also expects to recognize revenue for the manufacture of 300mm wafers for ON Semiconductor. On October 1, 2020, the Company entered into an amendment to the agreement with ON Semiconductor Corporation. ON Semiconductor Corporation agreed to pay the Company an additional $100,000 non-refundable deposit on the purchase price in exchange for a reduction in the minimum fixed cost commitment for 2021. On October 5, 2020, the Company received $100,000 and recorded it as a deposit received. The Company continues to operate the facility until the sale is closed.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The consolidated financial statements were authorized by the GLOBALFOUNDRIES’ Board of Directors on August 5, 2021 to be issued and subsequent events have been evaluated for their potential effect on the consolidated financial statements through August 6, 2021. The Company evaluated the subsequent events for disclosures through October 4, 2021 for the reissuance of these financial statements.

2. Basis of Preparation

Statement of Compliance—The consolidated financial statements of the Company have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of GLOBALFOUNDRIES and its subsidiaries.

Basis of Measurement—The consolidated financial statements have been prepared on a historical cost basis, except for derivative instruments and investments in equity instruments, which have been measured at fair value and assets held for sale, which have been measured at the lower of carrying value and fair value less costs to sell.

Functional and Presentation Currency—The consolidated financial statements are presented in United States (U.S.) dollars ($), which is the Company’s functional and presentation currency.

Foreign Currency Translation—Assets and liabilities of foreign operations having a functional currency other than the U.S. dollar are translated at the rate of exchange prevailing at the reporting date and revenues and expenses at the rate of exchange prevailing at the dates of the transactions during the period. Gains or losses on translation of foreign subsidiaries are included in other comprehensive income (loss). Gains or losses on foreign currency denominated balances are reported in the same manner.

In preparing the consolidated financial statements of the company, foreign currency-denominated monetary assets and liabilities are translated into the functional currency using the closing rate at the applicable consolidated statement of financial position dates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities, denominated in a foreign currency and measured at fair value, are translated at the rate of exchange prevailing at the date when the fair value was determined and non-monetary assets measured at historical cost are translated at the historical rate. Revenues and expenses are measured in the functional currency at the rates of exchange prevailing at the dates of the transactions with gains or losses included in income.

Basis of Consolidation—The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of GLOBALFOUNDRIES and its subsidiaries. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date of acquisition, being the date on which GLOBALFOUNDRIES obtains control, and continue to be consolidated until the date when such control ceases. All intercompany transactions, balances, income and expenses are eliminated in full on consolidation. Wholly owned subsidiaries and controlled entities included in these consolidated financial statements are disclosed in Note 16.

Control is achieved when the Company is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the subsidiary and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the subsidiary. Specifically, the Company controls a subsidiary if, and only if, the Company (a) has a power over the subsidiary, (b) is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with subsidiary, and (c) has the ability to use the power to affect its returns.

Generally, there is a presumption that a majority of the voting rights results in control. To support this presumption and when the Company has less than a majority of the voting or similar rights of a subsidiary, the

 

F-13


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Company considers all relevant facts and circumstances in assessing whether it has power over a subsidiary, including (a) the contractual arrangements with the other vote holders of the subsidiary, (b) rights arising from other contractual arrangements, and (c) the Company’s voting rights and potential voting rights.

The Company re-assesses whether or not it controls a subsidiary if facts and circumstances indicate that there are changes to one or more of the three elements of control. Consolidation of a subsidiary begins when the Company obtains control over the subsidiary and ceases when the Company loses control of the subsidiary. Assets, liabilities, income and expenses of a subsidiary acquired or disposed of during the year are included in the consolidated financial statements from the date the Company gains control until the date the Company ceases to control the subsidiary.

Profit or loss and each component of other comprehensive loss (“OCI”) are attributed to the equity holder of the Company and to the non-controlling interests.

A change in the ownership interest of a subsidiary, without a loss of control, is accounted for as an equity transaction.

If the Company loses control over a subsidiary, it derecognizes the related assets (including goodwill), liabilities, non-controlling interest and other components of equity, while any resulting gain or loss is recognized in profit or loss. Any investment retained is recognized at fair value.

3. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies, Judgements, Estimates and Assumptions

Business Combinations—Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the aggregate of the consideration transferred, which is measured at acquisition date fair value, and the amount of any non-controlling interests in the acquiree. For each business combination, the Company elects whether to measure the non-controlling interests in the acquiree at fair value or at the proportionate share of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred and included in selling, general and administrative expenses.

When the Company acquires a business, assets acquired and liabilities assumed are measured at their respective fair values on the acquisition date. The Company assesses the assets acquired and liabilities assumed for appropriate classification in accordance with the contractual terms, economic circumstances and pertinent conditions as at the acquisition date. This includes the separation of embedded derivatives in host contracts by the acquiree.

Investments in Joint Ventures—Joint ventures are those entities over whose activities the Company has joint control, established by contractual agreement and requiring unanimous consent for strategic financial and operating decisions.

Investments in jointly controlled entities are accounted for using the equity method of accounting (herein after referred to as “equity accounted investees”) and are recognized initially at cost. The consolidated financial statements include the Company’s share of the income and expenses and equity movements of equity accounted investees, after adjustments to align the accounting policies with those of the Company, from the date that joint control commences until the date that joint control ceases. The most recent available financial statements of the equity accounted investees are used in applying the equity method. When the end of the reporting period of the equity accounted investees is different from the Company, and it is impracticable for the equity accounted

 

F-14


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

investees to prepare financial statements as of the same date as the Company, the Company’s share of the income and expenses and equity movements of equity accounted investees may be recorded with up to a one-month lag. After application of the equity method, the Company determines whether it is necessary to recognize an impairment loss on its investment in its joint venture. At each reporting date, the Company determines whether there is objective evidence that the investment in the joint venture is impaired. If there is such evidence, the Company calculates the amount of impairment as the difference between the recoverable amount of the joint venture and its carrying value, and then recognizes the loss as share of profit (loss) of joint ventures and associates in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

When the Company’s share of losses exceeds its interest in an equity accounted investee, the carrying amount of that interest, including any long-term investments, is reduced to zero, and the recognition of further losses is discontinued except to the extent that the Company has an obligation on behalf of the investee.

Cash and Cash Equivalents—Cash and cash equivalents includes cash on hand and balances at banks, deposits held on call with banks, and financial instruments that are not subject to significant risk of changes in value, are readily convertible into cash and have original maturities of three months or less at the time of purchase.

Trade Accounts Receivable—Trade accounts receivable are recognized initially at fair value. A provision for impairment of trade accounts receivable is established when there is objective evidence that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original terms of the receivables.

Financial Instruments:

Category of financial instruments and measurement

Classification and Measurement—All recognized financial assets are measured based on amortized cost or fair value. The classification is based on two criteria: the Company’s business model for managing the assets and whether the instrument’s contractual cash flows represent “solely payments of principal and interest” (“SPPI”) criterion.

The assessment of whether contractual cash flows on debt instruments are solely comprised of principal and interest is made based on the facts and circumstances as at the initial recognition of assets.

Financial assets are recorded at amortized cost when such financial assets are held with the objective to collect contract cash flows that meet the SPPI criterion. This category includes debt, trade and other receivables and loans to related parties included under receivables, prepayments and other assets.

Financial assets recorded at fair value recognized in profit and loss (“FVPL”) comprise unquoted equity instruments which the Company had not irrevocably elected, at initial recognition, to classify at fair value through other comprehensive income (“FVOCI”). This category would also include debt instruments (including loans to related parties) whose cash flow characteristics fail the SPPI criterion or are not held to either to collect contractual cash flows or to both collect contractual cash flows and sell financial assets.

Financial assets recorded at FVOCI comprise unquoted equity investments which the Company irrevocably elects, at initial recognition, to classify at fair value through other comprehensive income when they meet the definition of equity and are not held for trading. The classification is determined on an instrument-by-instrument basis. Gains and losses on these financial assets are never recycled to profit or loss. Dividends are recognized as

 

F-15


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

other income in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income when the right of payment has been established, except when the Company benefits from such proceeds as a recovery of part of the cost of the financial asset, in which case, such gains are recorded in OCI. Equity instruments designated at FVOCI are not subject to impairment assessment.

Impairment of financial assets

The Company will record an allowance for expected credit losses (“ECL”) for all loans and other debt financial assets not recorded at FVPL. ECLs are based on the difference between the contractual cash flows due in accordance with the contract and all the cash flows that the Company expects to receive. The shortfall is then discounted at an approximation to the asset’s original effective interest rate.

The Company estimated its expected credit losses for its contract assets, loans to related parties, trade receivables and other receivables and other receivables at an amount equal to lifetime credit losses.

Offsetting of Financial Instruments—Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the consolidated statements of financial position if there is a currently enforceable legal right to offset the recognized amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realize the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments—The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in active markets at each reporting date is determined by reference to quoted market prices or dealer price quotations (bid price for long positions and ask price for short positions), without any deduction for transaction costs.

For financial instruments not traded in an active market, the fair value is determined using appropriate valuation techniques. Such techniques may include using recent arm’s-length market transactions; reference to the current fair value of another instrument that is substantially the same; a discounted cash flow analysis or other valuation models.

Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedge Accounting—The Company uses derivative financial instruments, such as foreign currency forward contracts, interest rate swaps, cross currency swaps and commodity forward contracts to mitigate the risks associated with changes in foreign currency exchange, interest rates and commodity price. The Company does not use derivative financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes. Derivative financial instruments are initially recognized at fair value on the date on which a derivative contract is entered into and are subsequently remeasured at fair value at each reporting date. Derivatives are carried as financial assets when the fair value is positive and as financial liabilities when the fair value is negative.

In applying its strategy, from time to time, the Company uses foreign currency forward contracts to hedge certain forecasted expenses denominated in foreign currencies, primarily the Euro and Singapore Dollar. The Company hedges future cash flow for capital expenditures denominated in foreign currencies, primarily Euro and Yen. In addition, the Company uses pay-fixed/receive-float interest rate swaps and cross-currency swaps to protect the Company against adverse fluctuations in interest rates and foreign currency rates and to reduce its exposure to variability in cash flows on the Company’s forecasted floating-rate debts and foreign currency-denominated debts. The Company also uses commodity forward contracts to hedge forecasted electricity consumption to minimize the impact of commodity price movements on the reported earnings of the Company and on future cash flows related to fluctuations of the contractually specified, separately identifiable and reliably measurable commodity risk component.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

At the inception of the hedge relationship, the Company documents the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged item along with its risk management objectives and its strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions. Furthermore, at the inception of the hedge, and on an ongoing basis, the Company documents whether a hedging relationship meets the hedge effectiveness requirements under IFRS 9 and whether there continues to be an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument. The Company designates these contracts and swaps as cash flow hedges of forecasted expenses, capital expenditures or floating-rate and foreign currency denominated debts, as applicable, and evaluates hedge effectiveness prospectively.

As such, the effective portion of the gain or loss on these contracts and swaps is reported as a component of OCI and reclassified to the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss in the same line item as the associated forecasted transaction for expenses and in the same period during which the hedged item affects earnings. For hedges of capital expenditures, the amount in OCI is incorporated into the initial carrying amounts of the non-financial assets and depreciated over the average useful life of the underlying assets. Any ineffective portion of hedges for expenses or capital expenditures is immediately recorded in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Hedge accounting is discontinued when the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated, or exercised, or when it no longer meets the criteria for hedge accounting. Any gain or loss recognized in the cash flow hedge reserve remains in equity and is recognized in profit or loss when the forecast transaction is ultimately recognized in profit or loss. When a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the gain or loss accumulated in equity is recognized immediately in profit or loss.

Derecognition of financial assets

The Company derecognizes a financial asset only when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial asset expire, or when it transfers the financial asset and substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of the financial asset to another entity. On derecognition of a financial asset at amortized cost in its entirety, the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the sum of the consideration received and receivable is recognized in profit or loss.

On derecognition of an investment in a debt instrument at FVOCI, the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the sum of the consideration received and receivable and the cumulative gain or loss that had been recognized in other comprehensive income is recognized in profit or loss. However, on derecognition of an investment in an equity instrument at FVOCI, the cumulative gain or loss that had been recognized in other comprehensive income is transferred directly to retained earnings, without recycling through profit or loss.

Current Versus Noncurrent Classification of Derivative Instruments—Derivative instruments are classified as current or noncurrent or separated into a current and noncurrent portion based on an assessment of the facts and circumstances. Derivative financial instruments are classified as current assets or current liabilities where they have maturity period within 12 months. Where derivative financial instruments have a maturity period greater than 12 months, they are classified within either noncurrent assets or noncurrent liabilities.

Where the Company will hold a derivative as an economic hedge (and does not apply hedge accounting) for a period beyond 12 months after the reporting date, the derivative is classified as noncurrent (or separated into current and noncurrent portions) consistent with the classification of the underlying item.

 

   

Embedded derivatives that are closely related to the host contract are classified consistent with the expected timing of the cash flows of the host contract.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

   

Derivative instruments that are designated as, and are effective hedging instruments, are classified based on the settlement date.

Inventories—Inventories are stated at standard cost adjusted to the lower of cost or net realizable value. The cost of raw materials is determined using applicable raw material purchase prices. The cost of supplies is determined based on a weighted-average cost formula. Work in process and finished goods are valued at the cost of direct materials and a proportion of manufacturing labor and overhead costs based on normal operating capacity.

Inventory allowances are made on an item-by-item basis, except where it may be appropriate to group similar or related items. An allowance is made for the estimated losses due to obsolescence based on expected future demand and market conditions. Net realizable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less estimated costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale.

Property, Plant and Equipment—Construction in progress, property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost, net of accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses. The assets’ residual values and useful life are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. Major additions and improvements are capitalized as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item and the cost of the item can be measured reliably; minor replacements and repairs are charged to the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive loss. The Company also capitalizes interest on borrowings related to eligible capital expenditures. Capitalized interest is added to the cost of qualified assets and depreciated together with that asset cost. The Company also records capital-related government grants, not subject to forfeiture, as a reduction to property, plant and equipment.

Depreciation begins when the asset is in the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management (available for use). Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful life of the assets as follows:

 

Building and leasehold/land improvements

  

Up to 26 years (or the remaining lease term of related land on which the buildings are erected, if shorter)

Equipment

  

2 to 8 years

Computers

  

5 years

An item of property, plant and equipment or any significant part initially recognized is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected from its use or disposal. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset) is included in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss when the asset is derecognized.

Intangible Assets—Technology, patent, software licenses and similar rights acquired separately are stated at cost or are adjusted to fair value when impaired. Intangible assets acquired through business combinations which include customer relationships and manufacturing and process technology, are recorded at estimated fair values at the date of acquisition. Intangible assets are amortized based on the pattern in which the economic benefits of the respective intangible asset are consumed, which is in general on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of between three and nine years. The amortization period and the amortization method for an intangible asset with a finite useful life are reviewed at least at the end of each reporting period. Changes in the expected useful life or the expected pattern of consumption of future economic benefits embodied in the asset

 

F-18


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

are considered to modify the amortization period or method, as appropriate, and are treated as changes in accounting estimates. The amortization expense on intangible assets with finite lives is recognized in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss in the expense category that is consistent with the function of the intangible assets.

Impairment of Non-Financial Assets—The Company reviews, at each reporting date, the carrying amount of the Company’s property, plant and equipment and finite lived intangible assets to determine whether there is any indication that those assets have suffered an impairment loss. Factors that the Company considers important in deciding when to perform an impairment review include, but are not limited to:

 

   

Significant underperformance relative to historical or projected future operating results;

 

   

Significant changes in the manner of the Company’s use of the acquired assets or the Company’s overall business strategy; and

 

   

Significant unfavorable industry or economic trends.

If any indication exists, the recoverable amount of the asset is estimated in order to determine the extent, if any, of the impairment loss. Where it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of an individual assets, The Company estimates the recoverable amount of the cash generating unit (“CGU”) to which the asset belongs. The recoverable amount of an asset or CGU is estimated to be the higher of an asset’s or CGU’s fair value less costs to dispose and its value in use. When the carrying amount of an asset or CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, the asset or CGU is considered impaired and is written down to its recoverable amount. The Company also evaluates, and adjusts if appropriate, the asset’s useful lives, at each reporting date or when impairment indicators exist.

In assessing value in use, the estimated future post-tax cash flows are discounted to their present value using a post-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted. The Company bases its impairment calculation on detailed budgets and forecast calculations, which include an approved formal five-year management plan for each of the CGUs to which the individual assets are allocated. In determining fair value less costs to sell, recent market transactions are taken into account. If no such transactions can be identified, an appropriate valuation model is used.

Impairment losses are recognized in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss to the extent of the recoverable amount, measured at the present value of discounted cash flows attributable to the assets, is less than their carrying value.

The Company also performs periodic reviews to identify assets that are no longer used and are not expected to be used in future periods and record an impairment charge to the extent that the carrying amount of the tangible and intangible assets exceeds the recoverable amount.

If the recoverable amount subsequently increases, the impairment loss previously recognized will be reversed to the extent of the increase in the recoverable amount, provided that the increased carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined had no impairment loss been recognized for the asset in prior years. The impairment loss reversal is recognized immediately in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Non-Financial Assets or Disposal Groups Held for Sale—Asset groups are classified as assets held for sale when their carrying amount is to be recovered principally through a sale transaction rather than through

 

F-19


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

continuing use. The asset groups are classified as assets held for sale when the following conditions have been met: management has approved the plan to sell; assets are available for immediate sale; assets are actively being marketed; sale is probable of occurring within one year; price is reasonable in the market and it is unlikely that there will be significant changes in the assets to be sold or a withdrawal of the plan to sell. Asset groups classified as held for sale are reported in current assets in the consolidated statements of financial position at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell. Long-lived assets classified as held for sale are no longer depreciated. When the held for sale accounting treatment requires an impairment charge for the difference between the carrying amount and fair value, such impairment is reflected in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss in the line item “Impairment charges”.

An impairment loss is recognized for any initial or subsequent write-down of the asset to fair value less costs to sell. A gain is recognized for any subsequent increases in fair value less costs to sell off an asset, but not in excess of any cumulative impairment loss previously recognized. A gain or loss not previously recognized by the date of the sale of the noncurrent asset is recognized at the date of derecognition.

A discontinued operation is a component of the entity that has been disposed of or is classified as held for sale and that represents a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations, is part of a single coordinated plan to dispose of such a line of business or area of operations, or is a subsidiary acquired exclusively with a view to resale. The results of discontinued operations are presented separately in the statement of profit or loss.

Provisions—Provisions are recognized when the Company has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events; it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation; and the amount has been reliably estimated. Provisions are mainly made up of site restoration obligations.

The Company records site restoration obligations in the period in which they are incurred at their estimated fair value. Site restoration obligations consist of the present value of the estimated costs of dismantlement, removal, site reclamation and similar activities associated with facilities built on land held under long-term operating leases. The site restoration obligations are recorded as a liability at the estimated present value as of the related long-lived asset’s inception discounted using a pre-tax rate that reflects the current market assessment of the time value of money and risks specific to the site restoration obligations. After initial recognition, the liability is increased for the passage of time, with the increase being reflected as accretion expense in the line item “finance expenses” in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss. The associated site restoration costs are capitalized as part of the carrying amount of the underlying asset and depreciated over the estimated useful life of the related long-lived asset. Subsequent adjustments in the discount rates, estimated amounts, timing and probability of the estimated future costs and changes resulting from the passage of time are recognized as an increase or decrease in the carrying amount of the liability and the related site restoration cost capitalized as part of the carrying amount of the related long-lived asset on a prospective basis. If the decrease in the liability exceeds the remaining carrying amount of the related site restoration costs, the excess is recognized as a credit in the line item selling, general and administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Leasing—

2018

A lease is an agreement whereby a lessor assigns to a lessee the right to use an asset for an agreed period of time in return for a payment or series of payments. Leases were classified as either finance or operating leases.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Leasing transactions that transfer substantially all the risks and rewards associated with ownership of a leased asset to the lessee were classified as finance leases. All other leasing agreements were classified as operating leases.

Leasing arrangements may include arrangements which are not in the legal form of a lease but convey the right to use a tangible asset in return for a payment or a series of payments. Determining whether an arrangement was, or contained a lease, was based on the substance of the arrangement and an assessment of whether the arrangement was dependent on the use of a specific asset or conveyed the right to use the asset. The Company entered into certain arrangements with suppliers with characteristics of leasing arrangements. These arrangements were accounted for as finance leases.

Where the Company was the lessee in a finance lease, the leased asset was capitalized at the lower of the fair value or present value of the minimum lease payments at the beginning of the lease term, and this amount was simultaneously recognized as a financial liability. The minimum lease payments essentially comprised financing costs and the principal portion of the remaining obligation. The leased asset was depreciated by the straight-line method. If subsequent transfer of title to the leased asset was uncertain, it was depreciated over the shorter of its estimated useful life or the lease term. Lease payments were apportioned between finance charges and reduction of the lease liability so as to achieve a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability. Finance charges were recognized in finance expenses in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Where the Company was the lessee in an operating lease, lease payments were generally recognized as an operating expense in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Contingent rentals were charged to expense when they were incurred.

2019 and 2020

On January 1, 2019, the Company adopted IFRS 16, Leases, using the modified retrospective approach by applying the new standard to all leases existing at the adoption date and not restating comparative periods. The Company assesses at contract inception whether a contract is, or contains, a lease. That is, if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration.

Right-of-use assets—The Company recognizes right-of-use assets at the commencement date of the lease (i.e. the date the underlying asset is available for use). Right-of-use assets are reported within property, plant and equipment, and are measured at cost, less any accumulated depreciation and impairment losses, and adjusted for any remeasurement of lease liabilities. The cost of right-of-use assets includes the amount of lease liabilities recognized, initial direct costs incurred, and lease payments made at or before the commencement date less any lease incentives received. Right-of-use assets are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the shorter of the lease term and the estimated useful lives of the assets.

If ownership of the leased asset transfers to the Company at the end of the lease term or the cost reflects the exercise of a purchase option, depreciation is calculated using the estimated useful life of the asset.

Lease liabilities—At the commencement date of the lease, the Company recognizes lease liabilities measured at the present value of the lease payments to be made over the lease term. Only lease payments that are fixed and determinable are considered at the time of commencement. The lease payment includes fixed payments (including in-substance fixed payments) less any lease incentives, variable lease payments that depend on an

 

F-21


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

index or a rate, and amounts expected to be paid under residual value guarantees. The lease payments also include the exercise price of a purchase option reasonably certain to be exercised by the Company and payments of penalties for terminating the lease, if the lease term reflects the Company exercising the option to terminate. Variable lease payments that do not depend on an index or a rate are recognized as expenses (unless they are incurred to produce inventories) in the period in which the event or condition that triggers the payment occurs.

In calculating the present value of lease payments, the Company uses its incremental borrowing rate at the lease commencement date because the interest rate implicit in the lease is not readily determinable. After the commencement date, the amount of lease liabilities is increased to reflect the accretion of interest and reduced for the lease payments made. In addition, the carrying amount of lease liabilities is remeasured if there is a modification, a change in the lease term, a change in the lease payments (e.g., changes to future payments resulting from a change in an index or rate used to determine such lease payments) or a change in the assessment of an option to purchase the underlying assets.

The Company’s lease liabilities are separately reported in the consolidated statements of financial position under noncurrent portion of lease obligations and current portion of lease obligations.

Short-term leases and leases of low-value assets—The Company applies the short-term lease recognition exemption to leases that have a lease term not exceeding 12 months, or for leases of low-value assets. The payment for such leases is recognized in the Company’s consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive loss on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Share-based payments—Share-based payment expense related to share awards is recognized based on the fair value of the awards granted. The fair value of each option award is estimated on the grant date using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. The option pricing model requires the input of highly subjective assumptions, including the estimated fair value of the Company’s stock, expected term of the option, expected volatility of the price of the Company’s shares, risk free interest rate and the expected dividend yield of ordinary shares. The assumptions used to determine the fair value of the option awards represent management’s best estimates. These estimates involve inherent uncertainties and the application of management’s judgment. The Company estimates the expected forfeiture for options utilizing historical data, and only recognizes expense when a defined liquidity event (change in control or IPO) is deemed probable on the number of awards that are expected to vest. After applying a forfeiture estimate during each reporting period for when the options are probable of vesting, the Company recognizes expense on a graded attribution basis for each tranche of the award over the period from the grant date to the later of the one-year anniversary of estimated time following a liquidity event or the legal vesting dates (see Note 33).

Earnings Per Share—Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit or loss attributable to equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.

Diluted earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit attributable to equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding, adjusted for the effects of all dilutive potential ordinary shares. The weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding is increased by the number of additional ordinary shares that would have been issued by the Company assuming exercise of all options with exercise prices below the average market price for the year.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Revenue Recognition—The Company derives revenue primarily from fabricating semiconductor wafers using the Company’s manufacturing processes for the Company’s customers based on their own or third parties’ proprietary integrated circuit designs and, to a lesser extent, from design, mask making, bumping, probing, assembly and testing services.

The Company recognizes revenue from contracts with customers by applying the following steps: (i) identify the contracts with the customers; (ii) identify performance obligations in the contracts; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations per the contracts; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the entity satisfies a performance obligation.

The majority of the Company’s revenue is derived from contracts with customers for wafer fabrication and engineering and other pre-fabrication services such as rendering of non-recurring engineering (“NRE”) services and mask production. The Company accounts for a contract with a customer when it has approval and commitment from parties, the rights and obligations of the parties are identified, payments terms are identified, the contract has commercial substance, and collectability of consideration is probable.

The Company generally requires a purchase order from all of its customers, to which the Company responds with an order acknowledgement and a copy of the Company’s standard terms and conditions. The Company also enters into master supply agreements (“MSA”) with certain of its customers that may specify additional terms and conditions, such as pricing formulas based on volume, volume discounts, calculation of yield adjustments, indemnifications, transfer of title and risk of loss, and payment terms. Under these agreements, volumes are usually not guaranteed. The Company also requires a purchase order from its customers with which it has MSAs for specific products and quantities. As a result, the Company has concluded that the combination of a purchase order and order acknowledgement, including the Company’s standard terms and conditions, and the MSA, if applicable, create enforceable rights and obligations between the Company and its customers.

Typically, goods and services provided under the Company’s contracts are accounted for as a single performance obligation. However, in some contracts, the Company provides multiple distinct goods or services to a customer. In those cases, the Company accounts for the distinct contract deliverables as separate performance obligations at the stated contract value, which appropriately represents the individual performance obligation’s estimated standalone selling price.

The Company fabricates wafers for its customers to the customers’ specifications. Since the wafers in process have no alternative use, and the Company has an enforceable right to payment including a reasonable profit (due to the existence of cancellation clauses for each arrangement), the Company concluded that it met the criteria to recognize revenue over time as a percentage of costs incurred over total expected costs.

As discussed in Note 4, a change in cancellation terms in certain wafer orders during the year ended December 31, 2020 resulted in the Company no longer meeting the criteria to account for revenue recognition from contracts with customers over time. As such, the Company recognizes revenue for such modified wafer orders at the point at which control of the wafers is transferred to the customer, which is determined to be at the point of wafer shipment from the Company’s facilities or delivery to the customer location. This modification did not have an impact to its contracts to provide NRE services. For its contracts to provide NRE services to the customers’ specifications, the Company recognizes revenue as it delivers the service as a percentage of costs incurred over total expected costs.

Certain of the Company’s contracts with its customers include potential price adjustments such as volume rebates and yield adjustments that may be refundable to customers. The Company estimates the variable

 

F-23


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

consideration related to these price adjustments as part of the total transaction price and recognizes revenue in accordance with the pattern applicable to the performance obligation, subject to a constraint. The Company constrains the amount of revenues recognized for these contractual provisions based on its best estimate of the amount which will not result in a significant reversal of revenue in a future period. The Company determines the amounts to be recognized based on the amount of potential refund required by the contract, historical experience and other surrounding facts and circumstances. These obligations are typically settled with the customer after shipment through the issuance of a credit note applied against the customer’s accounts receivable balance. Any difference between the amount accrued upon shipment for potential refunds and the actual amount agreed to with the customer is recorded as an increase or decrease in revenue. These potential price adjustments are accrued and netted against accounts receivable on the consolidated statements of financial position.

The Company’s contracts with its customers also warrant that products and services will meet the specified functionality. Defective products returned by customers are compensated through replacements, repairs or credit notes.

A contract asset (“unbilled accounts receivables”) is recognized when the Company has recognized revenue, but not issued an invoice for payment. The Company has determined that unbilled receivables are not considered a significant financing component of the Company’s contracts. Contract assets are included in receivables, prepayments and other assets and transferred to receivables when invoiced (See Note 18).

A contract liability is recognized when the Company receives payments in advance of the satisfaction of performance obligations and are included in deferred revenue on the consolidated statements of financial position (See Note 27).

Costs to obtain a contract are incremental direct costs incurred to obtain a contract with a customer, including sales commissions, and are capitalized if material. Costs to fulfill a contract include costs directly related to a contract or specific anticipated contract (e.g., certain design costs) that generate or enhance the Company’s ability to satisfy the Company’s performance obligations under these contracts. These costs are capitalized to the extent they are expected to be recovered from the associated contract and are material.

Product Warranties—The Company warrants that products will meet the stated functionality as agreed to in each sales arrangement. The Company provides for the estimated warranty costs under these arrangements based upon historical experience and management’s estimate of the level of future claims, and accrues for specific items at the time their existence is known and the amounts are estimable. Expenses for warranty costs were not significant in any of the periods presented.

Government Grants—The Company has received investment grants from the Federal Republic of Germany, the State of Saxony, various agencies of the Government of Singapore and the Empire State Development Corporation in New York (collectively referred to as “Government Grants”). These grants are primarily provided in connection with construction and operation of the Company’s wafer manufacturing facilities, employment and research and development.

In 2020, the Company has received non-refundable cash grants from the Government of Singapore as part of the Government’s relief measures to help businesses deal with the impact from the COVID-19 pandemic under the Job Support Scheme totaling $29,113, which was recorded as a reduction of staff costs. The Company has received $26,313 in 2020 and the remaining $2,800 will be received in 2021.

Government grants are recognized when there is reasonable assurance that the grant will be received and all attached conditions will be complied with. When the grant relates to an expense item, it is recognized as deferred

 

F-24


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

income and released to the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss over the period necessary to match the grant on a systematic basis to the costs that it is intended to compensate, and is presented as a reduction of those costs. Where the grant relates to an asset, it is recognized as a reduction in the basis of the asset and released as a reduction to depreciation expense in equal amounts over the expected useful life of the related asset.

Research and Development Costs—Research costs are expensed as incurred. Development costs are recognized as intangible assets only when it is probable that expected future economic benefits, attributable to the development activities, will accrue to the Company.

Borrowing Costs—Borrowing costs directly attributable to the construction phase of property, plant and equipment are capitalized as part of the cost of assets which are constructed by the Company and for which a considerable period of time (at least six months) is planned for construction. Borrowing costs are capitalized from the start of construction until the date the asset is ready for its intended use. All other borrowing costs are recognized as an expense in the period in which they are incurred.

Current and Deferred Income Tax—Current income tax assets and liabilities are measured at the amount expected to be recovered from or paid to the taxation authorities. The tax rates and tax laws used to compute the amount are those that are enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.

Deferred income tax is provided using the liability method on temporary differences at the balance sheet date between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts for financial reporting purposes. Deferred income tax liabilities are recognized for all taxable temporary differences, except:

 

   

Where the deferred income tax liability arises from the initial recognition of goodwill or of an asset acquired or liability assumed in a transaction that is not a business combination and, at the time of the transaction, affects neither the accounting profit nor taxable profit or loss; and

 

   

In respect of taxable temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries, associates and interests in joint ventures, where the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences can be controlled and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

Deferred income tax assets are recognized for all deductible temporary differences, carryforward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences, and the carryforward of unused tax credits and unused tax losses can be utilized except in respect of deductible temporary differences associated with investments in subsidiaries, associates and interests in joint ventures, deferred income tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that the temporary differences will reverse in the foreseeable future and taxable profit will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilized.

The carrying amount of deferred income tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to allow all or part of the deferred income tax asset to be utilized. Unrecognized deferred income tax assets are reassessed at each balance sheet date and are recognized to the extent that it has become probable that future taxable profit will allow the deferred tax asset to be recovered.

Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the year when the asset is realized or the liability is settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Deferred income tax relating to items recognized directly in equity is recognized in equity and not in profit or loss, except in the United States where operating losses offset tax otherwise incurred on items booked in equity.

Deferred income tax assets and deferred income tax liabilities are offset, if a legally enforceable right exists to set off current tax assets against current income tax liabilities and the deferred income taxes relate to the same taxable entity and the same taxation authority.

Consumption Taxes—Revenues, expenses and assets are recognized net of the amount of consumption taxes except where the consumption taxes incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not recoverable from the taxation authority, in which case the consumption tax is recognized as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of the expense item as applicable; and receivables and payables are stated with the amount of consumption taxes included. The net amount of consumption tax recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is included as part of receivables or payables in the consolidated statements of financial position.

Current versus noncurrent classification—The Company presents assets and liabilities in the statement of financial position based on current and noncurrent classification. An asset is current when it is:

 

   

Expected to be realized on intended to be sold or consumed in the normal operating cycle;

 

   

Held primarily for the purpose of trading;

 

   

Expected to be realized within twelve months after the reporting period; or

 

   

Cash or cash equivalent unless restricted from being exchanged or used to settle a liability for at least twelve months after the reporting period.

All other assets are classified as noncurrent.

A liability is current when:

 

   

It is expected to be settled in the normal operating cycle;

 

   

It is held primarily for the purpose of trading;

 

   

It is due to be settled within twelve months after the reporting period; or

 

   

There is no unconditional right to defer the settlement of the liability for at least twelve months after the reporting period.

The Company classifies all other liabilities as noncurrent. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as noncurrent assets and liabilities.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements, Adopted:

Amendments to IFRS 7, IFRS 9 and IAS 39 Interest Rate Benchmark Reform (“IBOR”)—The Company considered the impact of IBOR reform on its hedge accounting. The Company adopted the “Amendments to IFRS 7, IFRS 9 and IAS 39 Interest Rate Benchmark Reform” issued in September 2019. In accordance with the transition provisions, the amendments have been adopted retrospectively to hedging relationships that existed at the start of the reporting period or were designated thereafter. The amendments provide temporary relief from applying specific hedge accounting requirements to hedging relationships directly affected by IBOR reform. The

 

F-26


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

reliefs have the effect that IBOR reform should not generally cause hedge accounting to terminate. However, any hedge ineffectiveness will continue to be recorded in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

Furthermore, the amendments set out triggers for when the reliefs will end, which include the uncertainty arising from interest rate benchmark reform no longer being present.

In summary, the reliefs provided by the amendments that apply to the Company are:

 

   

In assessing whether the hedge is expected to be highly effective on a forward-looking basis, the Company has assumed that the LIBOR interest rate on which the cash flows of the interest rate swaps and cross currency swaps that hedges the EUR Equipment Financing, EUR Term Loan B, EUR Term Loan A, USD Equipment Financing, USD Term Loan B and USD Term Loan A is not altered by IBOR reform.

 

   

The Company has assessed whether the hedged LIBOR risk component is a separately identifiable risk only when it first designates the hedge and not on an ongoing basis.

The Company has evaluated the extent to which its cash flow hedging relationships are subject to uncertainty driven by IBOR reform as at December 31, 2020. The Company’s hedged items and hedging instruments continue to be indexed to EURIBOR and LIBOR. These benchmark rates are quoted each day and the IBOR cash flows are exchanged with counterparties as usual.

The Company has also evaluated the extent to which contracts reference IBOR cash flows, whether such contracts will need to be amended as a result of IBOR reform and there has been communication about IBOR reform with counterparties. As of December 31, 2020, there is uncertainty about when and how replacement may occur with respect to the relevant hedged items and hedging instruments. The Company will continue to apply the amendments to IFRS 9 until the uncertainty arising from the IBOR reform with respect to the timing and the amount of the underlying cash flows that the Company is exposed to is no longer present. This uncertainty will not end until the Company’s contracts that reference IBOR are amended to specify the date on which the interest rate benchmark will be replaced, the cash flows of the alternative benchmark rate and the relevant adjustment. This will, in part, be dependent on the introduction of fall back clauses which have yet to be added to the Company’s contracts and the negotiation with the counterparties. No amendment has been made on existing derivative and loan contracts as at December 31, 2020.

The Company has a limited exposure to changes in the IBOR benchmark. The Company has $1,190,752 of interest rate swaps which are in a cash flow hedge relationship of USD Equipment Financing and USD Term Loan A. Also, the Company has EUR503,278 thousand of cross currency swaps which are in cash flow hedge relationships of EUR Equipment Financing and EUR Term Loan A.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The table below indicates the nominal amount and weighted average maturity of derivatives in hedging relationships that will be affected by IBOR reform as financial instruments transition to risk-free rates, analyzed by interest rate basis. The derivative hedging instruments provide a close approximation to the extent of the risk exposure the Company manages through hedging relationships.

 

As of December 31, 2020 Interest rate swaps

   Currency      Nominal amount      Maturity  

Three-month LIBOR

     USD        168,750        2023  

Three-month LIBOR

     USD        794,688        2024  

Six-month LIBOR

     USD        227,314        2026  
     

 

 

    

Total

        1,190,752     
     

 

 

    

Cross currency swaps (in thousand Euro)

                    

Three-month LIBOR

     EUR        83,000        2024  

Six-month LIBOR

     EUR        334,564        2024  

Six-month LIBOR

     EUR        85,714        2026  
     

 

 

    

Total

        503,278     
     

 

 

    

Recent Accounting Pronouncements, Not Yet Adopted:

Interest Rate Benchmark Reform—Phase 2 (Amendments to IFRS 9, IAS 39, IFRS 7, and IFRS 16)—The amendments address issues that might affect financial reporting as a result of the reform of an interest rate benchmark, including the effects of changes to contractual cash flows or hedging relationships arising from the replacement of an interest rate benchmark with an alternative benchmark rate. The amendments provide practical relief from certain requirements in IFRS 9, IAS 39, IFRS 7, and IFRS 16 relating to changes in the basis for determining contractual cash flows of financial assets, financial liabilities and lease liabilities and hedge accounting. Application of the relief is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2021, with early application permitted. The requirements must be applied retrospectively. The Company does not expect that the adoption of these amendments will have a material impact to its consolidated financial statements.

Significant Accounting Judgments, Estimates and Assumptions—The preparation of the consolidated financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses as well as the disclosure of commitments and contingencies. Actual results may differ from these estimates and such differences may be material to the consolidated financial statements.

Enterprise Value. Given the absence of a public trading market of the Company’s ordinary shares, and in accordance with the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Practice Aid, Valuation of Privately-Held Company Equity Securities Issued as Compensation, the Company’s board of directors exercised reasonable judgment and considered numerous objective and subjective factors to determine the best estimate of the fair value of the Company’s ordinary shares at each grant date. These factors include:

 

   

valuations of the Company’s ordinary shares performed by independent third-party specialists;

 

   

lack of marketability of the Company’s ordinary shares;

 

   

the Company’s actual operating and financial performance;

 

   

current business conditions and projections;

 

F-28


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

   

hiring of key personnel and the experience of the Company’s management;

 

   

the history of the Company and the introduction of new products;

 

   

the Company’s stage of development;

 

   

the market performance of comparable publicly traded companies; and

 

   

the U.S. and global capital market conditions.

In valuing the Company’s ordinary shares, the Company’s board of directors determined the equity value of the Company’s business using various valuation methods including combinations of income and market approaches with input from management. The income approach estimates value based on the expectation of future cash flows that a company will generate. These future cash flows are discounted to their present values using a discount rate derived from an analysis of the cost of capital of comparable publicly traded companies in the Company’s industry or similar business operations as of each valuation date and is adjusted to reflect the risks inherent in the Company’s cash flows. For the market approach, the Company reviews the performance of a set of guideline comparable public companies, and considers the guideline companies’ various financial characteristics, including size, profitability, balance sheet strength, and diversification as compared to the Company.    

Application of these approaches involves the use of estimates, judgment, and assumptions that are highly complex and subjective, such as those regarding the Company’s expected future revenue, expenses, and future cash flows, discount rates, market multiples, and the selection of comparable companies. Changes in any or all of these estimates and assumptions or the relationships between those assumptions impact the Company’s valuations as of each valuation date and may have a material impact on the valuation of the Company’s ordinary shares.

Impairment Assessment of Non-Financial Assets—Impairment exists when the carrying value of an asset or CGU exceeds its recoverable amount, which is the higher of its fair value less costs of disposal and its value in use. The fair value less costs to sell calculation is based on a discounted cash flow analysis that a potential buyer would perform in determining a transaction value of the CGU less incremental costs for disposing of the asset. The value in use calculation is based on a discounted cash flow model. When preparing the discounted cash flow analysis, the Company makes subjective judgments in determining the independent cash flows that can be related to a specific CGU based on its asset usage model and manufacturing capabilities in addition to the discount rate used in the analysis. In addition, because subjective judgments are made regarding the remaining useful lives of assets and expected future revenue and expenses associated with the assets, changes in these estimates based on changes in economic conditions or business strategies could result in material impairment charges in future periods. The key assumptions used to determine the recoverable amount for the different CGUs, including sensitivity analysis, are disclosed and further explained in Note 14.

Income Taxes—In determining taxable income for financial statement reporting purposes, management makes certain estimates and judgments specific to taxation issues. These estimates and judgments are applied in the calculation of certain tax liabilities and in the determination of the recoverability of deferred tax assets, which arise from temporary differences between the recognition of assets and liabilities for income tax and financial statement reporting purposes.

Deferred taxes are recognized for unused losses, among other events, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the losses can be utilized.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

This evaluation requires the exercise of judgment with respect to, among other things, benefits that could be realized from available tax strategies and future taxable income, as well as other positive and negative factors. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon, among other things, the Company’s ability to generate future taxable income that is sufficient to utilize loss carry-forwards or tax credits before their expiration or the Company’s ability to implement prudent and feasible tax planning strategies.

If estimates of projected future taxable income and benefits from available tax strategies are reduced as a result of a change in the assessment or due to other factors, or if changes in current tax regulations are enacted that impose restrictions on the timing or extent of the Company’s ability to utilize net operating losses and tax credit carry-forwards in the future, the Company may be required to reduce the amount of total deferred tax assets resulting in a decrease of total assets. Likewise, a change in the tax rates applicable in the various jurisdictions or unfavorable outcomes of any ongoing tax audits could have a material impact on the future tax provisions in the periods in which these changes could occur.

In addition, the calculation of tax liabilities involves dealing with uncertainties in the application of complex tax rules and the potential for future adjustment of uncertain tax positions by the tax authorities in the countries in which the Company operates. If estimates of these taxes are greater or less than actual results, an additional tax benefit or charge may result.

Risk and uncertainty—All of the Company’s manufacturing facilities continue to remain open and are operating at normal production levels. The Company has been classified as an essential business in the United States, Germany and Singapore and facilities are expected to remain open throughout the COVID-19 crisis. The Company’s manufacturing sites are limited to essential personnel only and the Company is able to maintain appropriate staffing levels to support production.

The Company’s customers have not signaled material demand shifts at this point and non-cancellable revenue coverage is within the normal historical range. The Company continues to closely monitor the business environment for changes and is prepared to adjust capital and operational spending as appropriate.

4. Net Revenues

The following table presents the Company’s revenue disaggregated based on revenue source and timing of revenue recognition. The Company believes these categories best depict how the nature, timing, and uncertainty of revenue cash flows are affected by economic factors.

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Type of goods and services:

        

Wafer fabrication

   $ 5,712,583      $ 5,442,550      $ 4,440,291  

Engineering and other pre-fabrication services

     483,456        370,238        410,214  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 6,196,039      $ 5,812,788      $ 4,850,505  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Timing of revenue recognition:

        

Revenue recognized over time

   $ 6,122,478      $ 5,736,926      $ 4,227,448  

Revenue recognized at a point in time

     73,561        75,862        623,057  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 6,196,039      $ 5,812,788      $ 4,850,505  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, due to operational and commercial reasons, the Company modified the cancellation terms of its contracts with customers that are applicable to wafer fabrication products.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

As a result, the Company no longer has an enforceable right to payment covering cost incurred plus a reasonable profit margin for work completed to date when a customer cancels its wafers purchase order at any stage of production. The change was effective to all wafer outstanding purchase orders as at the date of contract modification and future purchase orders thereafter. The contract modification had no impact on the originally agreed wafer volume, the related wafer price, and other terms and conditions of its existing contracts with customers. Likewise, the modification did not have an impact to its contracts to provide NRE services to the customers’ specifications; therefore, the Company continuously recognizes revenue as it delivers the NRE service as a percentage of costs incurred over total expected costs.

Prior to the contract modification, the Company satisfied its performance obligations over time because of the customer’s contractual obligation to pay for work completed to date with a reasonable profit. The change in cancellation terms substantively modified the contracts with customers. As a result, the Company no longer meets the criteria to account for revenue recognition from contracts with customers over time on the outstanding purchase orders at the contract modification date and future orders thereafter. Consequently, the Company recognizes revenue on the impacted outstanding wafers orders and future orders at the point at which control of the wafers is transferred to the customer, which is determined to be at the point of wafer shipment from the Company’s facilities or delivery to the customer location, as determined by the agreed shipping terms.

In 2020, the Company recognized a cumulative decrease in revenue of $315,308 and a corresponding decrease in unbilled accounts receivable, and a cumulative decrease in cost of revenues of $255,557 and a corresponding increase in inventories, with a net decrease in gross margin of $59,751 on the impacted outstanding purchase orders on the date of contract modification.

5. Cost of Revenues

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment(1)

   $ 2,411,565      $ 2,290,531      $ 2,087,376  

Staff costs

     859,105        984,515        1,096,915  

Maintenance costs and utilities

     1,175,898        1,136,492        1,092,566  

Material costs

     881,296        843,807        740,948  

Amortization of intangible assets

     101,904        91,668        99,581  

Subcontractor costs

     68,427        44,920        88,469  

Costs relating to TCA(2)

     91,871                

Inventory changes, facilities costs, and other

     1,056,024        953,099        357,370  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 6,646,090      $ 6,345,032      $ 5,563,225  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Amounts are net of amortization of government grants relating to assets. See Note 14 for the detailed movements of property, plant and equipment.

(2)

Relates to the Company’s Technology Cooperation Agreement (“TCA”), which ended in 2018.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

6. Research and Development Expenses

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Staff costs

   $ 425,658      $ 273,432      $ 202,774  

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment

     149,465        105,113        121,078  

Amortization of intangible assets

     114,114        104,226        99,397  

Material costs

     136,319        67,275        66,124  

Maintenance costs and utilities

     59,870        26,692        27,222  

Other(1)

     40,794        6,236        (40,826
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 926,220      $ 582,974      $ 475,769  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Other primarily includes net (income) expenses related to research funding agreements and wafer, labor, software license costs allocated (to) and from cost of revenues. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company recognized nonrefundable Albany Cooperation Agreement fees of $60,000 in expenses. Following the Company’s announcement of the suspension of its 7nm development program, the Company terminated this arrangement.

7. Selling, General and Administrative Expenses

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Staff costs(1)

   $ 294,019      $ 292,152      $ 297,591  

Amortization of intangible assets

     48,736        46,431        85,131  

Maintenance costs and utilities

     49,453        50,853        42,137  

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment

     29,289        40,255        29,951  

Other(2)

     31,250        15,937        (9,950)  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 452,747      $ 445,628      $ 444,860  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Staff costs include share-based payments of $5,530, $0 and $980 for share options for the year ended December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020, respectively. See Note 3 for further discussion on the timing of expense recognition.

(2)

Other primarily includes net professional charges, marketing expenses and facility costs allocated to and from selling, general and administrative expenses. Real estate transfer taxes are also included in Other.

8. Restructuring Charges

During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company committed to a company-wide transformation program to help bring its operating margin in line with industry peers that resulted in the reorganization of the Company’s global business infrastructure with all sites impacted. Part of the company-wide transformation was to “Pivot” away from a strategy based primarily on investment in leading-edge technology and to focus on investments in technologies demonstrating GLOBALFOUNDRIES’ differentiation. The Company then decided to put its 7nm development program on hold indefinitely and to restructure certain aspects of the organization. As a result of putting the 7nm development program on an indefinite hold an impairment charge was taken for $494,060 (see Note 9 for further details). The impairment charge comprised primarily of charges to plant, property and equipment.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The company-wide transformation program resulted in restructuring charges amounting to $112,026 for the year ended December 31, 2018. These charges related to employee separation costs which include one-time termination benefits that were recognized as a liability at estimated fair value at the time of communication to employees. These restructuring charges were fully paid at December 31, 2018.

9. Impairment Charges

During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company announced the realignment of its leading-edge FinFET roadmap to shift development resources to the 14/12nm FinFET platform, and away from its 7nm FinFET development program which has been placed on indefinite hold. At December 31, 2018, the fabrication and other equipment related to the 7nm development program that could not be repurposed to other product lines was offered for sale. Immediately before the classification of the 7nm development program fabrication and other equipment as assets held for sale, the recoverable amount was estimated and a write-down of $431,914 was recognized during the year to reduce the carrying amount of the assets in the disposal group to their fair value less costs to sell. The Company also recorded impairment charges for 7nm specific intellectual property that had no future use.

In addition, the Company identified certain underutilized fabrication tools and also offered them for sale. These assets were no longer being depreciated while awaiting sale. The carrying values of these assets exceeded the recoverable values based on agreements to sell or a valuation report obtained from a third-party valuation firm.

The recoverable amount was determined on the basis of fair value less cost to sell and totaled $218,944 which was reclassified to assets held for sale as at December 31, 2018.

The Company recorded the following impairment charges:

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Equipment

   $ 431,914      $ 17,886      $ 22,672  

Equipment held for sale

     88,186        43,880         

Intellectual property and other

     62,146        2,184         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total impairment charges

   $ 582,246      $ 63,950      $ 22,672  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

10. Finance Expenses

 

     2018     2019     2020  

Interest on long-term debt

   $ 102,973     $ 159,114     $ 97,855  

Interest on lease obligations

     38,705       43,666       34,807  

Commitment fees and amortization of debt issuance costs

     19,611       23,457       18,366  

Capitalized interest

     (4,170     (332      

Accretion costs and other

     7,685       4,271       3,359  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Finance Expenses

   $ 164,804     $ 230,176     $ 154,387  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-33


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

11. Gain on Sale of a Fabrication Facility and Application Specific Integrated Circuit Business

For the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company recognized the following gain from sale of a fabrication facility and Application Specific Integrated Circuit (“ASIC”) business-related assets:

 

     2019  

Facility in Tampines, Singapore

   $ 196,554  

ASIC Business

     418,000  
  

 

 

 

Total gain on sale of a fabrication facility and ASIC business

   $ 614,554  
  

 

 

 

Facility in Tampines, Singapore

On January 31, 2019, the Company entered into an agreement with Vanguard International Semiconductor Corporation (“VIS”) to sell the Company’s facility in Tampines, Singapore for $236,000, including buildings, facilities, equipment and intellectual properties associated with the Company’s Micro Electro Mechanical Systems, or MEMS, business. Under the terms of the agreement, the Company continued to operate the facility through the end of 2019, providing a transition period to facilitate technology transfers for VIS and the Company’s remaining customers. The sale closed on December 31, 2019 and the Company recognized a gain upon the completion of the sale amounting to $196,554 after derecognition of net assets of $39,446. The following is the breakdown of the net assets that were derecognized:

 

     December 31,
2019
 

Property, plant and equipment

   $ 54,061  

Inventories

     1,908  

Receivables

     800  
  

 

 

 

Total Assets

     56,769  
  

 

 

 

Lease liabilities

     (9,681

Other current and noncurrent liabilities

     (6,739

Other

     (903
  

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

     (17,323
  

 

 

 

Net Assets

   $ 39,446  
  

 

 

 

ASIC Business

On May 20, 2019, the Company entered into an agreement with Marvell Technology Group Ltd. to sell certain ASIC assets, contracts, intellectual properties, inventories and employees. On November 5, 2019, the sale closed for a consideration of $555,977. The Company recognized a gain of $418,000 after derecognition of net assets of $124,067, and commission and termination costs of $13,900. Under the agreement, the Company will manufacture wafers for Marvell Technology Group Ltd for additional fees and the Company received advanced fees of $40,000 in 2019. As of December 31, 2020, $28,766 of advanced fees continue to be recorded in trade and other payables and other noncurrent liabilities.

 

F-34


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following is the breakdown of the net assets that were derecognized:

 

     December 31,
2019
 

Property, plant and equipment

   $ 18,894  

Intangible assets

     10,239  

Unbilled accounts receivable

     95,857  

Inventories

     30,285  

Other current and noncurrent assets

     8,039  
  

 

 

 

Total Assets

     163,314  
  

 

 

 

Lease liabilities

     (619

Deferred revenue

     (36,417

Other current and noncurrent liabilities

     (2,211
  

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

     (39,247
  

 

 

 

Net Assets

   $ 124,067  
  

 

 

 

12. Other Income, Net

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Gain on legal settlement

   $      $      $ 294,217  

Gain on remeasurement of existing equity interests (Note 16)

                   38,470  

Other(1)

     61,331        74,055        107,620  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other income, net

   $ 61,331      $ 74,055      $ 440,307  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Relate to gains on the sales of property, plant and equipment and certain intangible assets.

Gain on legal settlement

On October 28, 2019, the Company and a competitor (the “Competitor”) agreed to dismiss all pending patent litigation based on their respective patents and products. The Company and the Competitor also agreed to a broad life-of-patent cross-license to each other’s worldwide existing semiconductor manufacturing process patents as well as patents that will be filed during the next ten years. On April 10, 2020, under the terms of a settlement agreement, the Company received a settlement from the Competitor and recorded total gains of $294,217 related to this settlement for the year ended December 31, 2020.

13. Discontinued Operations

In 2018, the Company and the Chengdu Gaoxin Industry Investment Co., Ltd. agreed to cease operations of GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Chengdu) Integrated Circuit Manufacturing Co., Limited (“GFCD”) due to changes in market conditions that made it no longer financially feasible to continue to develop the project in Chengdu, China. The Company impaired the net assets of GFCD as the carrying value of the assets may not be recovered through use. The Company recorded an impairment charge totaling $127,403.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The results of GFCD are presented below:

 

     December 31,
2018
 

Net revenues

   $  

Cost of revenues

      

Gross loss

      

Research and development expenses

     15,375  

General and administrative expenses

     3,205  

Impairment charges

     127,403  
  

 

 

 

Loss of discontinued operations

     (145,983

Finance income

     144  

Finance expenses

     (2,126

Other expenses, net

     (54
  

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes from discontinued operations

     (148,019

Income tax expense

     (1
  

 

 

 

Total loss from discontinued operations

   $ (148,020
  

 

 

 

The major classes of assets of GFCD that were impaired as of December 31, 2018 are as follows:

 

     December 31,
2018
 

Inventories

   $ 751  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets

     1,967  

Property, plant and equipment

     119,841  

Intangible assets

     4,844  
  

 

 

 

Impairment charges related to discontinued operations

   $ 127,403  
  

 

 

 

GFCD has outstanding non-cancellable purchase commitments of $213,000 and $146,400 as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, which the Company does not anticipate will be fully remunerated. In 2019 and 2020, the Company continues to negotiate with vendors to settle these outstanding purchase commitments. As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has cash and restricted cash of $34,399 and $35,654, respectively, for future settlement with vendors. Payments to vendors are subject to approval of the minority shareholder. The Company has assessed and concluded that potential payments beyond the available cash and restricted cash amount in GFCD to be remote.

Below are the cash flows associated with discontinued operations:

 

     December 31,
2018
    December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Operating

   $ 1,396     $ (24,615   $ (5,192

Investing

     (13,660            

Financing

     22,621              
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (outflow) inflow

   $ 10,357     $ (24,615   $ (5,192
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-36


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

14. Property, Plant and Equipment

The Company has lease contracts for various facilities, plant, machinery, vehicles and other equipment. Before the adoption of IFRS 16 on January 1, 2019, the Company classified each of its leases (as lessee) at the inception date as either a finance lease or an operating lease. A lease was classified as a finance lease if it transferred substantially all of the risk and profit incidentals of the leased asset to the Company; otherwise it was classified as an operating lease.

Upon adoption of IFRS 16, the Company applied a single recognition and measurement approach for all leases that it is the lessee, except for leases with terms of 12 months or less, and leases of low value items. The Company recognized lease liabilities for lease payments and right of use (“ROU”) assets representing the right to use the underlying assets.

On January 1, 2019, the Company recognized total ROU assets of $358,518 with corresponding liabilities of $525,543 on the consolidated financial position, which includes $280,415 of pre-existing ROU assets and $417,850 of pre-existing lease liabilities.

The gross amount of assets recorded under ROU leases, which are included in property, plant and equipment amounted to $791,875 and $858,138 as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. The net carrying value of ROU leases amounted to $348,163 and $292,193 as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. Amortization of ROU assets is included in depreciation expense. Depreciation expense for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020 for all ROU assets was $39,822, $55,798 and $56,964, respectively.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

    Land and
Land
Improvements
    Building and
Leasehold
Improvements
    Equipment     Computer     Construction
in Progress
    Total  

As of December 31, 2018

  $ 76,427     $ 7,004,526     $ 21,848,513     $ 424,257     $ 711,733     $ 30,065,456  

Adoption of IFRS 16

    47,320       29,769       1,014                   78,103  

Additions(1)

    16       138,738       28,217       1,278       206,381       374,630  

Transfers from construction in progress

          287,965       379,135       17,235       (684,335      

Transfers from assets held for sale

          18,095       317,084             6,242       341,421  

Disposals

    (16,752     (148,204     (823,596     (38,996     (7,643     (1,035,191
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019

    107,011       7,330,889     $ 21,750,367       403,774       232,378       29,824,419  

Additions(1)

          15,016       31,494       276       570,576       617,362  

Transfers from construction in progress

          43,833       373,359       7,928       (425,120      

Transfers from assets held for sale

                75,158                   75,158  

Acquisition of subsidiaries

    9,362       57,426       167,509             76,491       310,788  

Disposals

    (11,926     (6,781     (358,502     (1,266     (3,538     (382,013
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

  $ 104,447     $ 7,440,383     $ 22,039,385     $ 410,712     $ 450,787     $ 30,445,714  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated Depreciation and Impairment

           

As of December 31, 2018

  $ 20,153     $ 3,129,286     $ 14,865,184     $ 331,225     $ 6,635     $ 18,352,483  

Additions(1)

    10,161       428,298       1,965,568       31,872             2,435,899  

Transfers from assets held for sale

          17,890       275,316                   293,206  

Impairments

                17,886                   17,886  

Disposals

    (2,405     (136,785     (722,738     (24,396           (886,324
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019

    27,909       3,438,689       16,401,216       338,701       6,635       20,213,150  

Additions(1)

    3,960       424,304       1,783,572       26,569             2,238,405  

Impairments

          5,331       18,786                   24,117  

Transfers from assets held for sale

                71,681                   71,681  

Disposals

    (582     (2,172     (323,916     (1,171           (327,841
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

  $ 31,287     $ 3,866,152     $ 17,951,339     $ 364,099     $ 6,635     $ 22,219,512  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net book value as of December 31, 2019

  $ 79,102     $ 3,892,200     $ 5,349,151     $ 65,073     $ 225,743     $ 9,611,269  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net book value as of December 31, 2020

  $ 73,160     $ 3,574,231     $ 4,088,046     $ 46,613     $ 444,152     $ 8,226,202  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The Company earned investment tax credits related to the Company’s construction of a wafer fabrication facility in Saratoga County, New York (which were netted against additions relating to Building and Leasehold Improvements and Equipment). These credits were generally earned based on when the related assets were placed in service. The Company recorded the investment tax credits as a reduction of property and equipment costs. As of December 31, 2019, and 2020, the investment tax credits included in property and equipment amounted to $326,262 and $259,969, respectively.

 

F-38


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Depreciation expenses on property, plant and equipment are as follows:

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Cost of revenues

   $ 2,498,835      $ 2,290,531      $ 2,087,376  

Research and development expenses

     154,838        105,113        121,078  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     29,497        40,255        29,951  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,683,170      $ 2,435,899      $ 2,238,405  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Identification of cash-generating units—The facilities and equipment utilized in the semiconductor manufacturing processes are highly integrated and inter-dependent in the production process. The recoverable amounts of the individual long-lived assets cannot be determined as the cash inflows are not largely independent of those from other assets. Therefore, the Company has concluded that each of its fabrication facilities constitute a separate CGU.

The Company has assessed indicators of impairment for its CGUs and performed impairment assessment during the fourth quarter of the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020. Based on this assessment the Company concluded there was no impairment of long-lived assets.

Assets pledged as security—Various assets have been pledged to secure borrowings under mortgages for the Company. Property, plant and equipment, inventories, and financial assets with carrying values of $4,984,595, $397,915, and $1,688, respectively, have been pledged to secure borrowings under mortgages for the Company. The Company is not allowed to pledge these assets as security for other borrowings or to sell them to other entities.

Impairment of Long-lived Assets

Substantially all of the long-lived assets are comprised of the Malta CGU, Dresden CGU and Singapore CGU. The recoverable amount of each CGU was estimated based on the fair value less cost to sell calculation using a discounted cash flow model. The free cash flows used in the discounted cash flow model are consistent with the financial budgets approved by senior management covering the initial five-year period. If necessary, free cash flow beyond the initial five-year period is extrapolated for future periods. The Dresden and Malta CGUs continue to invest in development expansion opportunities and thus, the Company has projected cash flows for the Dresden CGU through 2036 and for the Malta CGU through 2045 based on a 30-year life from the commencement of production at those locations. Cash flows beyond the initial five-year period for the Dresden and Malta CGUs are estimated assuming a 1-2% growth rate over forecast periods. Free cash flow for the Singapore CGU did not extend beyond the initial four-year period. The post-tax discount rate applied to the cash flow projections for identified CGUs is 8.0%. Terminal values were estimated based on guideline companies’ benchmark using a 9.0 - 11.0 times terminal year EBITDA included in the discounted cash flows for the Dresden, Malta and Singapore CGUs. The recoverable amounts exceeded the carrying amounts for the Dresden, Malta and Singapore CGUs, resulting in no impairment.

Key assumptions used in the fair value less cost to sell and sensitivity to changes in assumptions

The calculation of fair value less cost to sell for the CGUs is most sensitive to the following assumptions:

 

   

Revenues (pricing)

 

   

Cost

 

F-39


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

   

Volume

 

   

Discount rate

Sensitivity analysis

The hypothetical changes in the following table to assumptions used in the impairment review would, in isolation, have led to the recoverable value equaling the carrying value for Q4 2020.

 

     Dresden CGU     Malta CGU     Singapore CGU  

Revenues (pricing)

     (20.8 )%      (15.7 )%      (25.3 )% 

Costs

     34.8     32.4     44.2

Volume

     (51.9 )%      (30.5 )%      (59.3 )% 

Discount rate

     13.8     4.6     57.4

The semiconductor industry is subject to significant and rapid changes. However, the inputs used in the Company’s projections represent the Company’s best estimates based on the information available to us as of the issuance of the financial statements. Further information about the basis for the Company’s estimates follows:    

Revenues (pricing)—Management estimates selling prices by customer based on industry trends, historical and expected trends in cost reductions, customer experience and competitive pressures. The estimated selling prices are used, along with volume estimates, to forecast revenues. For example, a decrease in estimated average selling prices by 15.7%, in isolation, would result in the elimination of the passing margin for the Malta CGU.

Cost—Estimates are obtained from published indices for the countries from which materials are sourced, as well as data relating to specific commodities. Forecast figures are used if data is publicly available, otherwise past actual raw material price movements are used as an indicator of future price movements. Management has considered the possibility of greater than forecasted increases in raw material price inflation. This may occur if demand for material rises faster than supply. For example, an increase in the prices of raw materials and other inputs forecasted above by 32.4%, in isolation, would result in the elimination of the passing margin for the Malta CGU.

Volume—Estimates of customer volumes are made by management of each Fab based upon customer committed and forecasted orders. Senior management may adjust customer forecasted orders to reflect the uncertainty associated with these orders. The volume forecasts used to develop forecasted revenues are based on assumed volumes from the customers’ committed and forecasted orders combined with the anticipated production timing. For example, a decrease in volumes by 30.5%, in isolation, would result in the elimination of the passing margin for the Malta CGU.

Discount rate—The discount rate represents the current market assessment of the risks specific to each CGU, taking into consideration the time value of money and individual risks of the underlying assets that have not been incorporated in the cash flow estimates. The discount rate calculation is based on the specific circumstances of the Company and its operating units and is derived from its weighted average cost of capital (“WACC”). The WACC considers both debt and equity. The cost of equity is derived from the expected return on investment by the Company’s investors. The cost of debt is based on the interest-bearing borrowings the Company is obligated to service. The specific risk is incorporated by applying the Company’s beta factors. The beta factors are evaluated annually based on publicly available market data. For example, the discount rate used to calculate the recoverable amount of the Malta CGU was 8.0%. An increase of 4.6% to the 8.0% discount rate, in isolation, would result in the elimination of the passing margin for the Malta CGU.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

15. Goodwill and Intangible Assets

 

Cost

   Technology,
Licenses and
Similar Rights
    Software     Patents     Goodwill      Others      Total  

As of December 31, 2018

   $ 1,172,530     $ 258,463     $ 276,667     $      $ 131,200      $ 1,838,860  

Additions

     129,728       12,381             5,477               147,586  

Disposals

     (27,711           (11,841                   (39,552
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019

     1,274,547       270,844       264,826       5,477        131,200        1,946,894  

Additions

     192,507     12,323                610      205,440

Acquisitions of subsidiaries

           326             12,547               12,873  

Disposals

     (217,825     (4,192     (30,349                   (252,366
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

   $ 1,249,229     $ 279,301     $ 234,477     $ 18,024      $ 131,810      $ 1,912,841  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated Amortization

              

As of December 31, 2018

   $ 681,416     $ 216,590     $ 141,964     $      $ 57,290      $ 1,097,260  

Additions

     159,195       27,148       39,252              16,730        242,325  

Impairments

     2,184                                 2,184  

Disposals

     (21,497           (8,159                   (29,656
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019

     821,298       243,738       173,057              74,020        1,312,113  

Additions

     166,707       20,748       39,474              57,180        284,109  

Impairments

     (1,445                               (1,445

Disposals

     (201,674     (1,891     (26,313                   (229,878
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

   $ 784,886     $ 262,595     $ 186,218     $      $ 131,200      $ 1,364,899  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net book value as of December 31, 2019

   $ 453,249     $ 27,106     $ 91,769     $ 5,477      $ 57,180      $ 634,781  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net book value as of December 31, 2020

   $ 464,343     $ 16,706     $ 48,259     $ 18,024      $ 610      $ 547,942  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amortization expenses on intangible assets are as follows:

 

     2018      2019      2020  

Cost of revenues

   $ 101,904      $ 91,668      $ 99,581  

Research and development expenses

     114,114        104,226        99,397  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     48,736        46,431        85,131  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 264,754      $ 242,325      $ 284,109  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-41


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

16. Business Combinations and Acquisition of Non-Controlling Interest and Investments in Joint Ventures

The Company has the following investments and voting rights in joint ventures:

 

     Country of
Incorporation
   December 31,
2019
   December 31
2020

Silicon Manufacturing Partners Pte Ltd. (“SMP”)

   Singapore    49%    49%

Sensry GmbH (“Sensry”)

   Germany    46%    25%

Advanced Mask Technology Centre GmbH & Co. KG (“AMTC”)

   Germany    50%    N/A

Maskhouse Building Administration GmbH & Co. KG (“BAC”)

   Germany    50%    N/A

 

   

SMP is an independent foundry that fabricates semiconductor integrated circuits on silicon wafers using advanced production facilities and the propriety integrated circuit designs of its customers in the semiconductor industry.

 

   

Sensry manufactures customized industrial sensor modules.

 

   

AMTC operates a photomask facility in Dresden, Germany and provides photomasks for use in manufacturing microprocessors and other integrated circuits.

 

   

BAC owns the premises in which AMTC operates, and leases these to AMTC.

On January 1, 2020, the Company executed amendments to its joint venture agreement and limited partnership agreements related AMTC and BAC under which the terms of the agreements were extended to March 31, 2022 and the Company obtained the determining vote over changes in the business plans of AMTC and BAC. The Company has concluded that it has obtained control over the AMTC and BAC joint venture and has consolidated the joint venture effective January 1, 2020.

The Company evaluated whether the legal form of joint ventures gave the owning parties rights to the underlying assets and liabilities of the joint ventures and concluded that the Company only had access to its net investment (and not a specific share of the assets and liabilities). Further, the Company evaluated the associated joint ventures agreements to support the acquisition of output noting that the agreements allowed external third parties to acquire the output. Considering these factors, the Company has concluded that these entities would be classified as joint ventures. According to the provisions of IAS 28 (revised 2011) and IFRS 11, the joint ventures have been recognized through the equity method of accounting.

The following table presents the movement in investment in joint ventures:

 

     2019     2020  

Beginning balance

   $ 79,193     $ 77,331  

Share of profits for the period

     7,859       3,876  

Capital reduction

     (15,333     (50

Dividends declared during the period

     (2,564     (2,586

Reduction in investments due to the consolidation of AMTC and BAC

           (41,869

Additions during the period

     8,742        

Share of foreign exchange fluctuation reserves for the period

     (566      
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 77,331     $ 36,702  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

As part of a cost reduction strategy, the Company decided in 2019 to wind down its mask production operations at its Burlington, Vermont location and transfer those operations to its joint venture mask house,

 

F-42


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

AMTC in Dresden, Germany and increase its share of the joint venture mask house’s productive capacity. On January 1, 2020, the Company obtained control of the AMTC and BAC joint ventures through an amendment of the joint venture agreement granting the Company the determining vote over changes in the business plans of AMTC and BAC. The Company consolidated the joint venture effective January 1, 2020. No consideration was paid to the non-controlling shareholder as a result of the amendment to the joint venture agreement. The Company recognized a non-operating gain on remeasurement of existing equity interest of $38,470 upon the remeasurement of its previously held ownership interest to fair value, which was $86,896 and release of the foreign currency translation reserve related to its ownership interest of $6,553.

The Company has elected to measure the non-controlling interests in the acquiree at fair value.

The Company has made an assessment of the fair value of assets and liabilities of AMTC and BAC at the date control was obtained as follows:

 

     Fair value recognized on deemed acquisition  
         AMTC               BAC                 Total        

Assets:

      

Property, plant and equipment

   $ 243,974     $ 66,815     $ 310,789  

Intangible assets

     310       16       326  

Inventories

     7,720             7,720  

Receivables from government grants

     161             161  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets

     31,022       1,335       32,357  

Cash and cash equivalents

     1,812       2,321       4,133  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     284,999       70,487       355,486  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities:

      

Debt

   $ 179,217     $ 9,071     $ 188,288  

Deferred tax liabilities

     3,370       7,009       10,379  

Deferred income from government grants

     3,143       3,039       6,182  

Trade and other payables

     9,866       1,800       11,666  

Income taxes payable

     865             865  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     196,461       20,919       217,380  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total identifiable net assets acquired at fair value

     88,538       49,568       138,106  

Goodwill arising on acquisition

     5,498       7,009       12,507  

Less: Non-controlling interest measured at fair value

     (35,411     (28,306     (63,717
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fair value of equity interest held

   $ 58,625     $ 28,271     $ 86,896  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receivables, prepayments and other assets include the fair value of trade receivables amounting to $31,079. The gross amount of trade receivables is $31,079 and it is expected that the full contractual amounts will be collected.

The goodwill is attributed to the synergies expected to arise after the acquisition and is allocated to the Company’s mask house cash generating unit, AMTC. None of the goodwill recognized is expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The fair value of the non-controlling interest has been estimated based on a proportional allocation of the fair value of the net tangible assets based on a valuation obtained by the Company from a third party valuation firm. The fair value measurements are based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market. The fair value estimate is based on:

 

   

An assumed discount rate of 8.5% to 9.0%.

 

   

A terminal value, calculated based on the Gordon Growth Model with a perpetual growth rate of 3.0%.

During the year ended December 31, 2020, AMTC contributed $35,956 of net revenues after intercompany eliminations and $2,028 to loss before income taxes from operations of the Company, while BAC contributed $0 of revenue and $4,505 to loss before income taxes from operations of the Company.

The Company has allocated $3,289 in the statements of operations and comprehensive loss for the year ended December 31, 2020 to the non-controlling interest.

Analysis of cash flows on acquisition:

 

     AMTC      BAC      Total  

Net cash acquired with the subsidiary (included in cash flows from investing activities)

   $ 1,812      $ 2,321      $ 4,133  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash flow on acquisition

   $ 1,812      $ 2,321      $ 4,133  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

17. Income Taxes

For tax reporting purposes, the Company consolidates its entities under GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., a Cayman Islands entity as described in Note 1. Accordingly, the Company has presented the domestic portion of the disclosures below based on its country of domicile in the Cayman Islands.

As a Cayman Islands corporation, the Company’s domestic statutory income tax rate is 0.0%. The difference between the Company’s domestic statutory income tax rate and its (provision) benefit for income taxes is due to the effect of the tax rates in the other jurisdictions in which the Company operates. Principally, for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company is subject to United States’ federal and state taxes with a combined statutory tax rate of 22.24% and 22.05%, respectively; German corporation and trade taxes with a combined statutory tax rate of 31.58%; and Singapore’s statutory tax rate of 17%.

Income tax benefit (expense) consisted of the following:

 

     December 31,
2018
    December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Current income tax expense:

      

Current income tax expense

   $ (4,534   $ (6,205   $ (28,713

Adjustments in respect of current income tax of previous year

     540       103       98  

Deferred tax

      

Net operating and investment allowance carryforwards

     (33,876     (216,582     34,561  

Currency effect on non-monetary assets of subsidiary

     (7,608     8,961       43,155  

Other change in temporary differences

     29,032       (10,338     (36,834
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax benefit (expense) reported in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss

   $ (16,446   $ (224,061   $ 12,267  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-44


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

A reconciliation between tax benefit and accounting profit multiplied by the Company’s statutory rate of 0% is as follows:

 

     December 31,     December 31,     December 31,  
     2018     2019     2020  

Loss before income taxes

   $ (2,609,110   $ (1,147,125   $ (1,363,127

Tax at Enacted Statutory Rate

   $     $     $  

Foreign tax rate differential

     15,222       10,567       58,505  

Adjustments in respect to current income tax of previous years

     540       103       98  

Government grants exempt from tax

     23,555       20,094       12,950  

Deductible expense for tax purpose

     3,552       1,944       (8,033

Impact of unrecognized deferred tax assets

     (24,650     (246,465     (62,734

Non-deductible expenses for tax purposes

     (9,781     569        

Effects of foreign exchange gains (loss)

     (24,861     (10,347     40,256  

Impact of change in liability for uncertain tax positions

     (95     (77     8,922  

Withholding Tax

                 (33,504

Other effects

     72       (449     (4,193
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax benefit (expense)

   $ (16,446   $ (224,061   $ 12,267  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective income tax rate

     0.63     19.53     (0.90 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In 2019 and 2020, the Company assessed that it is probable that 100% of deferred tax assets can be realized in Singapore. The Company has determined that realization of deferred taxes associated with loss carryforwards is limited to reserves for uncertain tax positions in the United States that would generate future taxable income, and deferred tax assets resulting from consolidation of AMTC and BAC.

In 2019, a decrease in net deferred tax assets of $189,614 was recorded for the Company’s German subsidiary mainly due to a write-down of deferred tax assets on loss carryforwards because the Company has changed how the German operations are compensated from a cost-plus-reimbursement approach to a resale, or buy-sell compensation arrangement. The ability to forecast future profit under the new intercompany pricing approach is less certain compared to prior cost plus concept, which requires an incremental tax expense write-down of German deferred tax assets.

In 2020, Singapore recorded a tax benefit of $63,655 (included under “Foreign tax rate differential” of $(58,505) relating to a revaluation of deferred tax liabilities after satisfying investment conditions necessary for an extension of a lower tax rate incentive during the year. The conditions that were required for the reduced tax rate related to fixed asset investment, increased wafer production, targeted research projects, and increased employment.

In 2020, the Company recorded withholding tax amounting to $33,504, triggered primarily from a legal settlement.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are attributable as follows:

 

     December 31,     December 31,  
     2019     2020  

Accelerated depreciation on property, plant and equipment

   $ (746,817   $ (589,699

Losses, credits and investment allowances available for offsetting against future taxable income

     759,275       648,141  

Accrued expenses

     314,528       313,404  

Inventory

     62,863       67,692  

Other comprehensive income

     (571     (2,677

Currency effect

     (469     (718

Deferred income

     20,905       13,363  

Other

     (2,255     (14,362
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

   $ 407,459     $ 435,144  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The classification of the net deferred tax assets (liabilities) in the statements of financial position is as follows:

 

     December 31,     December 31,  
     2019     2020  

Deferred tax assets

   $ 408,050     $ 443,566  

Deferred tax liabilities

     (591     (8,422
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

   $ 407,459     $ 435,144  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total unrecognized deferred tax assets as of December 31, 2019 and 2020 was $2,959,136 and $3,231,522, respectively. The Company does not anticipate any significant changes to the total amounts of unrecognized deferred tax assets within the next 12 months of the reporting date.

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has accumulated corporate losses in Germany of $972,795 and $1,305,372, respectively, and trade tax losses in Germany of $694,346 and $998,114, respectively. Except for a fully deductible base amount, utilization of German net operating loss carryforwards is limited to 60% of taxable income in any one year. German net operating losses do not expire with the passage of time, but may forfeit partially or completely as a result of legal entity restructurings.

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has unutilized capital allowances on the property and equipment held in Singapore of $1,802,601 and $1,609,695, respectively, and unutilized tax losses available for carryforward of $58,484 and $58,484, respectively. Under Singapore tax law, unutilized capital allowances and unutilized tax losses are deductible to the extent of income available. Unutilized capital allowances and unutilized tax losses can be carried forward indefinitely subject to compliance with the conditions that there is no substantial change in shareholders and no change in the Company’s principal activities, where applicable. As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has investment allowances of $843,336 and $843,336, respectively in Singapore which can be carried forward indefinitely.

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has gross operating loss carryforwards in the United States of $7,593,319 and $8,042,617, respectively; $6,535,163 will expire in years 2029 through 2037. As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company has $847,636 and $908,287, respectively of California gross

 

F-46


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

operating loss carryforwards and, in the other states in which it operates, it has gross operating loss carryforwards of $830,555 and $912,259, respectively. The state carryforwards expire beginning in 2023. In addition, the Company has U.S. research and development tax credit carryforwards of $158,692 and $150,927 for the years December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, that will expire in years 2030 through 2033. The Company has California research and development tax credits of $16,687 and $15,046 as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, that do not expire. In addition, the Company has nonrefundable New York Empire Zone credit carryforwards of $1,115,806 and $1,122,132 as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, that do not expire. Six other states have research and development tax credits, Texas, Minnesota, Vermont, North Carolina, Massachusetts and New Jersey for which the Company has calculated a total credit carryforward of $9,262 and $9,218 for the years December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. These credits have a carryforward that expire between 2030 through 2039.

At December 31, 2019 and 2020, no deferred tax liabilities were recorded for taxes that would be payable on the undistributed earnings of certain of the Company’s subsidiaries as the Company is able to control the timing of the distributions and does not anticipate requiring any distributions for the foreseeable future.

A reconciliation of deferred taxes, net is as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Beginning balance

   $ 626,969     $ 407,459  

Tax expense recognized to consolidated statements of operations

     (217,959     40,882  

Tax benefit (expense) recognized to other comprehensive loss

     (1,081     (2,106

Tax benefit (expense) recognized from acquisition of subsidiaries

           (10,379

Uncertain tax positions and others

     (470     (712
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 407,459     $ 435,144  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company’s current tax receivables were $6,986 and $113, respectively, related to its subsidiaries in Europe.

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company’s current income tax payable of $37,057 and $30,609, respectively, is composed of $263 and $2,491, $9,206 and $11,836 and $27,632 and $16,282 for entities incorporated in Europe, the United States and Singapore, respectively. The current income tax payable amounts include the following uncertain tax provisions: $9,276 in the United States for both December 31, 2019 and 2020, and $25,118 and $16,175 in Singapore for December 31 2019 and 2020, respectively, for exposure arising from unutilized capital allowances and domestic related party transactions. Europe had no current income taxable amounts included in uncertain tax provisions for either December 31, 2019 or 2020.

 

F-47


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

18. Receivables, Prepayments and Other Assets

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Noncurrent:

     

Non-trade receivables

   $ 18,857      $ 11,993  

PILOT Bonds (Note 23)

     28,559        20,037  

Investments in equity instruments

     8,169        12,737  

Loans to related parties (Note 32)

     125,557         

Employee incentive credits (Note 21)

     22,057         

Investment tax credits (Note 21)

     19,178         

Other

     15,216        93  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 237,593      $ 44,860  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Current:

     

Trade receivables, other than related parties(2)

   $ 639,074      $ 767,257  

Non-trade receivables

     105,212        70,482  

Recoverable sales tax

     45,788        49,104  

Unbilled accounts receivable(1)

     956,663        62,226  

Prepaid expenses

     26,834        22,283  

Advances and deposits paid

     17,161        21,722  

Investment tax credits (Note 21)

     26,063        19,178  

Trade receivables from related parties (Note 32)

     7,921        7,455  

Loans to related parties (Note 32)

     49,213         

Amounts due from Related Parties

     1,309        1,279  

Other

     11,959        1,877  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,887,197      $ 1,022,863  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Unbilled accounts receivable represents amounts recognized on revenue contracts less associated advances and progress billings. These amounts will be billed in accordance with the agreed-upon contractual terms or upon shipment of products or rendering services.

(2)

The Company’s trade receivables, other than related parties, are all classified as current and are expected to be collected within one year. The Company’s provision for sales returns was not material for either for the years ended December 31, 2019 or 2020. See the table below for the aging of the Company’s trade receivables, other than related parties.

The following table presents the activities in unbilled accounts receivable as of December 31, 2019 and 2020:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Beginning balance

   $ 944,634     $ 956,663  

Revenue recognized during the year

     5,740,326       4,548,456  

Cumulative catch-up adjustment to revenue

           (315,308

Amounts invoiced

     (5,625,523     (5,127,585

Transferred as part of the sale of ASIC business

     (102,774      
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 956,663     $ 62,226  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-48


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Receivables neither past due nor impaired

   $ 603,182      $ 754,308  

Receivables past due—not impaired individually:

     

Less than 30 days

     26,032        12,706  

31 to 60 days

     1,752        198  

61 to 90 days

     5,033         

90 to 120 days

     3,075        45  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 639,074      $ 767,257  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

19. Inventories

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Work in progress

   $ 209,530     $ 930,107  

Raw materials and supplies

     285,586       232,407  

Inventory reserve

     (143,193     (242,995
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 351,923     $ 919,519  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table presents the movement in the inventory reserve:

 

     December 31,     December 31,  
     2019     2020  

Beginning balance

   $ 189,041     $ 143,193  

Additions(1)

     95,259       228,559  

Previously fully reserved inventory

    

Written-off and scrapped

     (80,676     (96,972

Elimination of reserve upon sale of inventory

     (60,431     (31,785
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 143,193     $ 242,995  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

This includes additional inventory reserve of $26,149 arising from the adjustment to cost of revenues recorded by the Company in 2020 in conjunction with the modification of its customer contracts as discussed in Note 4.

 

F-49


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

20. Other Financial Assets and Liabilities

The following foreign currency forward contracts are outstanding at December 31, 2019 and 2020 (in thousands, except average foreign currency/US$):

 

    Fair Value of Derivative Instruments                           

Derivative Instruments

  Other
Current
Financial
Assets
    Other
Noncurrent
Financial
Assets
    Other
Current
Financial
Liabilities
    Other
Noncurrent
Financial
Liabilities
    Notional
Amount
    Average
Foreign
Currency/
US$
    Average
Strike
Price
     Maturity  

Outstanding as of December 31, 2019:

                

Forward contracts:

                

Euro forward contracts (receive euros/pay US$)

  $ 2,447     $     $ (4,454   $     $ 666,733     $ 0.88              2020  

Singapore dollar forward contracts (receive Singapore$/pay US$)

    75             (534           396,516       1.36              2020  

Japanese yen forward contracts (receive Japanese yen/pay US$)

    4,276             (287           32,266       107.03              2020  

Interest rate swaps

          7,045                   749,425             1.4810% -  1.731%        2024 - 2026  

Cross currency swaps

          5,513                   743,058       0.90       4.098% -  6.725%        2024 - 2026  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        
  $ 6,798     $ 12,558     $ (5,275   $     $ 2,587,998         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        

Outstanding as of December 31, 2020:

                

Forward contracts:

                

Euro forward contracts (receive Euros/Pay US$)

  $ 28,489     $     $ (818   $     $ 594,169     $ 0.85              2021  

Singapore dollar forward contracts (receive Singapore$/Pay US$)

    13,266             (439           360,328       1.37              2021  

Japanese yen forward contracts (receive Japanese yen/Pay US$)

    444             (61           23,939       104.77              2021  

Interest rate swaps

                      (33,287     1,190,752             0.382% -  1.731%        2023 - 2026  

Cross currency swaps

          33,169                   566,497       0.89       3.8343% -  4.182%        2024 - 2026  

Commodity hedge

    8,335       885             (58     56,262       235.20          2021 - 2022  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        
  $ 50,534     $ 34,054     $ (1,318   $ (33,345   $ 2,791,947         
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

F-50


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following table presents the fair values and locations of these derivative instruments recorded in the consolidated statements of financial position:

 

     Fair Value of Derivative Instruments  
     Assets Derivatives      Liabilities Derivatives  
     Statement of
Financial Position
Location
     Fair Value      Statement of
Financial Position
Location
     Fair Value  

As of December 31, 2019:

           

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments

           

- foreign currency forward contracts

    
Other current financial
assets
 
 
   $ 5,181       
Other current financial
liabilities
 
 
   $ (4,968

- interest rate swaps

    
Other noncurrent
financial assets
 
 
     7,045       
Other noncurrent
financial liabilities
 
 
      

- cross currency swaps

    
Other noncurrent
financial assets
 
 
     5,513       
Other noncurrent
financial liabilities
 
 
      

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments

           

- foreign currency forward contracts

    
Other current financial
assets
 
 
     1,617       
Other current financial
liabilities
 
 
     (307
     

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total derivatives

      $ 19,356         $ (5,275
     

 

 

       

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020:

           

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments

           

- foreign currency forward contracts

    
Other current financial
assets
 
 
   $ 37,602       
Other current financial
liabilities
 
 
   $ (375

- interest rate swaps

    
Other noncurrent
financial assets
 
 
           
Other noncurrent
financial liabilities
 
 
     (33,287

- cross currency swaps

    
Other noncurrent
financial assets
 
 
     33,169       
Other noncurrent
financial liabilities
 
 
      

- commodity hedge

    
Other current financial
assets
 
 
     8,335       
Other current financial
liabilities
 
 
      
    
Other noncurrent
financial assets
 
 
     885       
Other noncurrent
financial liabilities
 
 
     (58

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments

           

- foreign currency forward contracts

    
Other current financial
assets
 
 
     4,597       
Other current financial
liabilities
 
 
     (943
     

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total derivatives

      $ 84,588         $ (34,663
     

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

F-51


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following table presents the effect of derivatives designated as hedging instruments on the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss (net of tax):

As of December 31, 2020, the estimated amount of loss from cash flow hedges currently retained in consolidated statements of comprehensive loss expected to be reclassified into consolidated statements of operations within the next 12 months is approximately $37,227.

 

    Amount of
Gains
(Losses)

Recognized in
Accumulated

OCI
on Derivatives
(effective
Portion)
    Amount of
Gains (Losses)
Reclassified
from

Accumulated
OCI to cost of
Property,
Plant and
Equipment
    Location of
Gains (Losses)
Reclassified from
Accumulated

OCI into Income
(Effective

Portion)
    Amounts of
Gains
(Losses)
Reclassified
from

Accumulated
OCI into
Income
(Effective
Portion)
    Location of Gains
(Losses) Recognized into
Income (Ineffective
Portion)
    Amount of
Gain
(Losses)
Recognized
into
income
(Ineffective
Portion)
 

Year ended December 31, 2018

           

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Forward currency

  $ 8,897     $ 7,102      

Cost of revenues and

operating expenses


 

  $ 15,978      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ 359  
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2019

           

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Forward currency

  $ 3,357     $ (310    
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $ (7,997    
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ (495

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Interest rate swaps

  $ 7,036     $      
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ 9  

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Cross currency swaps

  $ (716   $      
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $  
 

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2020

           

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Forward currency forward contracts

  $ 37,481     $ (470    
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $ 12,294      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ 40  

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Interest rate swaps

  $ (36,726   $       Finance expense     $      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ (277

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments— Cross currency swaps

  $ (23,001   $      
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $ 564  

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments – Commodity hedge

  $ 9,162     $      
Cost of revenues and
operating expenses
 
 
  $      
Selling, general and
administrative expenses
 
 
  $  

 

F-52


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following table presents the effect of derivatives not designated as hedging instruments on the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss:

 

     Location of Gains
(Losses) Recognized in
Income on Derivative
     Amount of Gains
(Losses) Recognized in
Income on Derivative
 

Year ended December 31, 2018

     

Derivatives not designed as hedging instruments—foreign currency forwards contracts

    

Selling, general and


administrative expenses

 

 

    

$(26,916)

 
     

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2019

     

Derivatives not designed as hedging instruments—foreign currency forwards contracts

    

Selling, general and


administrative expenses

 

 

    

$(14,240)

 
     

 

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2020

     

Derivatives not designed as hedging instruments—foreign currency forwards contracts

    

Selling, general and


administrative expenses

 

 

   $ 6,342  
     

 

 

 

21. Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Cash balances on hand and at banks

   $ 396,718      $ 347,879  

Investments in money market funds

     370,197        560,198  

Time deposits

     230,400         
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 997,315      $ 908,077  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Movements in cash and cash equivalents are presented in the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows.

The following are the reconciliation of assets and liabilities arising from financing activities:

 

    As of
December 31,
2018 Assets
(Liabilities)
    Cash Flows
(Inflows)/
Outflows
    Non-cash changes     As of
December 31,
2019 Assets
(Liabilities)
 
  Addition     Foreign
exchange
movement
    Others  

Restricted cash

  $ 6,363     $ 28,036     $     $     $     $ 34,399  

Government grants receivable(1)

    84,774       (161,353     204,043       (1,324       126,140  

Employee Incentive Credits(1)

    254,404       (146,501     22,154               130,057  

Investment tax credits

    55,977       (27,368     16,632               45,241  

Debt

    (3,204,142     525,160             (2,817     (47,368     (2,729,167

Lease obligations

    (417,850     65,858       (180,376     2,919       10,280       (519,169

Advance receipt from sale of equipment

    (36,300                             (36,300

Loan from shareholder

    (11,567,687     400,000                         (11,167,687

Non-controlling interest

    (79,000                             (79,000
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ (14,903,461   $ 683,832     $ 62,453     $ (1,222   $ (37,088   $ (14,195,486
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-53


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

    As of
December 31,
2019 Assets
(Liabilities)
    Cash Flows
(Inflows)/
Outflows
    Non-cash changes     As of
December 31,
2020 Assets
(Liabilities)
 
  Addition     Foreign
exchange
movement
    Others  
                                     
                                     
                                     

Restricted cash

  $ 34,399     $ 1,255     $     $     $     $ 35,654  

Government grants receivable(2)

    126,140       (177,322     80,065       720             29,603  

Employee Incentive Credits(2)

    130,057       (109,006     1,006                   22,057  

Investment tax credits

    45,241       (25,505     (558                 19,178  

Debt

    (2,729,167     483,072       (13,529     (64,473     (13,858     (2,337,955

Lease obligations

    (519,169     73,249       (623     (19,236     1,267       (464,512

Loan from shareholder

    (11,167,687     487,000                         (10,680,687
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ (14,080,186   $ 732,743     $ 66,361     $ (82,989   $ (12,591   $ (13,376,662
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Government grant receivable and the current portion of the employee incentive credits amounting to $126,140 and $108,000 (See Note 18), respectively, are reflected in the Receivables from government grants in the consolidated statements of financial position amounting to $234,140, as of December 31, 2019.

 

(2)

Government grant receivable and the current portion of the employee incentive credits amounting to $29,603 and $22,057 (See Note 18), respectively, are reflected in the Receivables from government grants in the consolidated statements of financial position amounting to $51,660, as of December 31, 2020.

Geographical concentration of cash and cash equivalents is as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

United States of America

   $ 521,148      $ 632,707  

Republic of Singapore

     400,902        207,031  

Federal Republic of Germany

     56,015        52,499  

Netherlands

     7,554        10,172  

United Kingdom

     1,962        2,238  

People’s Republic of China

     7,272        608  

United Arab Emirates

     283         

Others

     2,179        2,822  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 997,315      $ 908,077  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

22. Issued Capital and Reserves

Share Capital—On January 20, 2019, the Company accepted the surrender of 76,902,150 shares for no consideration from MIC. The Company cancelled the shares and transferred $1,538 from common shares to additional paid-in capital.

Additional Paid-In Capital—Additional paid-in capital represents the excess of assets less liabilities contributed to GLOBALFOUNDRIES by shareholders over the share capital issued in exchange for those contributions and share-based compensation charges for share-based payments.

 

F-54


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Reserves

All other reserves as stated in the consolidated statements of changes in equity:

Hedging Reserve—The cash flow hedge reserve contains the effective portion of the cash flow hedge relationships incurred as at the reporting date.

Foreign Currency Translation Reserve—The foreign currency translation reserve is used to record exchange differences arising from the translation of AMTC and BAC’s financial statements for consolidation purpose.

23. Long-Term Debt

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Noncurrent:

     

Term loans

   $ 2,042,254      $ 1,956,148  

Current:

     

Term loans

     686,913        381,807  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 2,729,167      $ 2,337,955  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The above balances are net of $27,638 and $19,106 of unamortized debt issuance costs for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

Movements in interest bearing borrowings during the reporting period were as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Opening balance

   $ 3,204,142     $ 2,729,167  

New loans and borrowings

     2,860,196       2,816,871  

Repayments

     (3,339,987     (3,283,861

Other

     4,816       75,778  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 2,729,167     $ 2,337,955  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Terms and Debt Repayment Schedule

The following table summarizes term loan facilities. The below arrangements are all considered to be secured with the exception of the Mubadala Treasury Holding Company Loan Facility, which is unsecured.

 

Description

  Currency    

Nominal Interest Rate

 

Interest
Payment
Terms

 

Principal
Payment
Terms

  Year
of
Maturity
    2019
Carrying
Amount
    2020
Carrying
Amount
 

2016 Tied Commercial Facility

    USD     LIBOR + 2.00%   Semi-annual   At Maturity     2020     $ 54,927     $  

2016 Commerzbank Term Loan

    USD     LIBOR + 2.00%   Semi-annual   At Maturity     2020       20,970        

2017 Barclays Term Loan

    USD     LIBOR + 2.00%   Semi-annual   At Maturity     2020       11,974        

PILOT Bonds

    USD     Variable Rate Note(1)   Monthly   Annually     2021       9,425       10,457  

2016 Atradius Credit Facilities

    USD     LIBOR + 0.80%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2021       78,716        

 

F-55


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Description

  Currency    

Nominal Interest Rate

 

Interest
Payment
Terms

 

Principal
Payment
Terms

  Year
of
Maturity
    2019
Carrying
Amount
    2020
Carrying
Amount
 

2016 Atradius Credit Facilities

    EUR     EURIBOR + 0.85%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2021       22,398        

Accounts Receivable Factoring

    USD     LIBOR +0.60%-0.90%   Monthly   Monthly     2022       143,814       86,944  

2018 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing(2)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.60%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2023       73,831       74,250  

2019 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing(3)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.75%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2024       83,374       83,812  

2019 USD Dresden Equipment Financing(4)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.75%   Semi-Annual   Semi-Annual     2024       37,157       35,473  

2018 IKB Term Loan

    EUR     EURIBOR + 2.50%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2024       11,199       12,240  

2020 USD Equipment Financing(5)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.90%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2025             58,539  

2019 EUR Dresden Equipment Financing(4)

    EUR     EURIBOR + 1.75%   Semi-Annual   Semi-Annual     2026       14,604       15,366  

TPI Loan

    EUR     2.60%   Quarterly   Monthly     2026             2,687  

USD Term Loan B

    USD     LIBOR + 4.75%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2026       6,509        

EUR Term Loan B

    EUR     EURIBOR + 5.00%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2026       3,186        

i. Park East Fishkill(6)

    USD     0.30%  

Monthly

 

Monthly

    2027       2,832       2,039  

Mubadala Treasury Holding Company Loan Facility

    USD     LIBOR + 2.25%  

Annual

 

Annual

    2020       111,997        
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current total

              686,913       381,807  
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent:

             

2016 Atradius Credit Facilities

    USD     LIBOR + 0.80%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2021       80,318        

2016 Atradius Credit Facilities

    EUR     EURIBOR + 0.85%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2021       22,398        

PILOT Bonds

    USD     Variable Rate Note   Annually   Annually     2021       10,292        

2018 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing(2)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.60%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2023       167,651       93,401  

2019 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing(3)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.75%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2024       273,999       190,186  

2019 USD Dresden Equipment Financing(4)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.75%   Semi-Annual   Semi-Annual     2024       225,321       179,779  

2018 IKB Term Loan

    EUR     EURIBOR + 2.50%   Semi-annual   Semi-annual     2024       44,586       36,815  

2020 USD Equipment Financing(5)

    USD     LIBOR + 1.90%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2025             211,382  

USD Term Loan A

    USD     LIBOR + 2.90%   Quarterly   Semi-Annual     2025             646,005  

EUR Term Loan A

    EUR     EURIBOR + 2.60%   Quarterly   Semi-Annual     2025             101,380  

 

F-56


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Description

  Currency    

Nominal Interest Rate

 

Interest
Payment
Terms

 

Principal
Payment
Terms

  Year
of
Maturity
    2019
Carrying
Amount
    2020
Carrying
Amount
 

2019 EUR Dresden Equipment Financing(4)

    EUR     EURIBOR + 1.75%   Semi-Annual   Semi-Annual     2026       464,722       474,522  

TPI Loan

    EUR     2.60%   At Maturity   At Maturity     2026             11,053  

USD Term Loan B

    USD     LIBOR + 4.75%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2026       515,595        

EUR Term Loan B

    EUR     EURIBOR + 5.00%   Quarterly   Quarterly     2026       223,381        

i. Park East Fishkill(6)

    USD     0.30%   Monthly   Monthly     2027       13,991       11,625  
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent total

              2,042,254       1,956,148  
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

            $ 2,729,167     $ 2,337,955  
           

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The interest rate for the 2013 PILOT bonds is reset on a weekly basis by the bank based on prevailing market conditions, not to exceed 12% per annum. The weighted average interest rates were 2.29% and 0.91% for 2019 and 2020, respectively.

 

(2)

On March 2, 2018, GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE, LTD. (“GFS”) entered into several Equipment Purchase and Lease Agreements with four banks to sell and leaseback certain semiconductor manufacturing equipment located in GFS’ Fabs in Singapore for a total of $375,000. The total minimum lease payments amount to $375,000, to be paid in equal quarterly installments through March 1, 2023.

 

(3)

On January 21, 2019, GFS entered into several Equipment Purchase Agreements and Lease Agreements with five banks to sell and leaseback certain semiconductor manufacturing equipment located in GFS’ Fabs in Singapore for a total of $425,000.

 

(4)

On October 31, 2019, the Company, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co., KG. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG. entered into a term facilities agreement with Bank of America Merrill Lynch International Designated Activity Company and ING Bank, a branch of ING-DIBA AG, as coordinating mandated lead arrangers, and Bank of America Merrill Lynch International Designated Activity Company as facility and security agent, which provides a maximum incremental facility commitment totaling $750,000 secured by certain qualifying equipment assets.

 

(5)

On April 23, 2020, GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE, LTD. (“GFS”) entered into several Equipment Purchase Agreements and Lease Agreements with four banks to sell and leaseback certain semiconductor manufacturing equipment located in GFS’ fabrication facilities in Singapore for a total of $300,000.

 

(6)

On September 1, 2017, the Company completed a sale and partial leaseback transaction of a portion of its facilities in East Fishkill, New York to i. Park East Fishkill LLC and ii. Park East Fishkill I LLC. Due to the Company’s ongoing involvement with the properties sold and leased back, the transaction has been accounted for as financing. The total transaction amounted to $22,950, which consists of $17,150 cash and buyer’s assumption of certain liabilities of $5,800.

 

F-57


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following table summarizes unutilized credit facilities available to the Company to maintain liquidity to fund operations:

 

            December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Citibank Revolving Credit Facility

     Committed      $ 239,153      $ 403,271  

Societe Generale Singapore Revolving Credit Facility

     Uncommitted        23,434        23,958  

JPMorgan Chase PILOT Letter of Credit

     Committed        23,042        12,211  

Societe Generale Singapore Factoring

     Committed        59,200        34,756  

Deutsche Bank

     Uncommitted        2,416        3,122  

Citibank—USD

     Uncommitted        570        780  

Mubadala Development Corporation Revolving Credit Facility

     Committed        400,000        400,000  

Mubadala Development Corporation Shareholder Loan

     Committed        52,500         
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 800,315      $ 878,098  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company’s interest-bearing loans and borrowings have certain financial covenants. Restrictive covenants in the Company’s credit facilities may prevent the Company from pursuing certain transactions or business strategies, including by limiting the Company’s ability to, in certain circumstances:

 

   

incur additional indebtedness;

 

   

pay dividends or make distributions;

 

   

acquire assets or make investments outside of the ordinary course of business;

 

   

sell, lease, license, transfer or otherwise dispose of assets;

 

   

enter into transactions with the Company’s affiliates;

 

   

create or permit liens;

 

   

guarantee indebtedness; and

 

   

engage in certain extraordinary transactions.

In addition, the Company’s interest-bearing loans and borrowings have certain change of control provisions that could be triggered if the Shareholder owns less than 51% of our voting securities and does not otherwise control the Company.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company is in compliance with the financial covenants.

24. Leases

The Company has various lease agreements for certain of its offices, facilities, and equipment. Leases may include one or more options to renew. Renewals are not in the determination of the lease term unless the renewals are deemed to be reasonably certain at lease commencement. The Company’s lease agreements do not contain any material residual value guarantees or material restrictive covenants. All leases were measured under a single criterion with the exception of those with terms not exceeding 12 months and low-value leases.

 

F-58


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The components of lease costs, lease term and discount rate are as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Amortization of right-of-use assets

   $ 55,798     $ 56,964  

Interest expense on lease liabilities

     43,666       34,807  

Short-term and low-value leases expense

     490       1,409  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net lease cost

   $ 99,954     $ 93,180  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
    

Weighted average remaining lease term

     7.48 years       7.35 years  

Weighted average discount rate

     7.99%       7.99%  

The following is a schedule, by years, of maturities of lease liabilities as of December 31, 2019 and 2020:

 

     December 31, 2019      December 31, 2020  
     Minimum
Lease
Payments
    Present
Value of
Payments
     Minimum
Lease
Payments
    Present
Value of
Payments
 

Within 1 year

   $ 169,803     $ 130,912      $ 165,621     $ 131,270  

2-5 years

     293,172       200,274        256,997       185,261  

After 5 years

     224,130       187,983        175,778       147,981  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
     687,105       519,169        598,396       464,512  

Less: amounts representing

         

finance charges

     (167,936            (133,484      
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Present value of minimum

         

lease payments

   $ 519,169     $ 519,169      $ 464,912     $ 464,512  
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent

     $ 388,257        $ 333,242  

Current

       130,912          131,270  
    

 

 

      

 

 

 
     $ 519,169        $ 464,512  
    

 

 

      

 

 

 

Supplemental cash flow information related to leases is as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Cash flows used in operating activities:

    

Payments of short-term and low-value leases

   $ (490   $ (1,409

Interest paid

     (43,666     (34,807

Cash flows used in financing activities:

    

Payment of lease obligations

     (65,858     (73,249

Note the Company adopted IFRS 16 in 2019.

 

F-59


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The following table summarizes the movement of right-of-use assets during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020 is as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Beginning balance

   $ 358,518     $ 348,163  

(Reductions) Additions

     45,443       994  

Amortization

     (55,798     (56,964
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 348,163     $ 292,193  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

25. Provisions

The movement in provision for asset retirement obligations during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020 is as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Beginning balance

   $ 347,370     $ 337,765  

Arising during the period

     889       14,888  

Accretion cost

     6,372       655  

Utilized

     (16,866      
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 337,765     $ 353,308  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

26. Deferred Income From Government Grants

The following table presents the movement in deferred income from government grants for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020:

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 

Beginning balance

   $ 253,715     $ 194,209  

Received/receivable during the period

     97,287       19,854  

Acquisition of subsidiaries

           6,182  

Released to the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss

     (156,793     (51,043
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 194,209     $ 169,202  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent

   $ 150,305     $ 128,697  

Current

     43,904       40,505  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 194,209     $ 169,202  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-60


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Government grants were recognized in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss as follows:

 

     December 31,
2018
     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Cost of revenues

   $ 174,618      $ 155,451      $ 49,025  

Research and development expenses

     4,971        1,342        2,018  

Selling, general and administrative

     37                
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total balance

   $ 179,626      $ 156,793      $ 51,043  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company has received government support in the form of investment grants. Certain investment grants are subject to forfeiture in declining amounts over the life of the agreement if the Company does not maintain agreed upon conditions specified in the relevant subsidy agreements. The Company continues to comply with the government grant conditions mainly relating to qualifying property, plant and equipment and employment levels.

27. Deferred Revenue

Deferred revenue comprises contract liabilities for payments received in advance of the satisfaction of performance obligations, as well as non-recurring engineering services.

 

     December 31,
2019
    December 31,
2020
 
    

Beginning deferred revenue balance

   $ 224,521     $ 144,562  

Cash receipts in advance of satisfaction of performance obligations

     204,885       122,168  

Released to the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss(1)

     (284,844     (160,537
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending deferred revenue balance

   $ 144,562     $ 106,193  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent

   $ 45,818     $ 12,112  

Current

     98,744       94,081  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 144,562     $ 106,193  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Of revenue released to the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, $127,821 and $73,435, respectively were included in the beginning balance of the deferred revenue.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

28. Trade and Other Payables

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Noncurrent:

     

Advances and deposits

   $ 133,425      $ 224,912  

Amounts payable for intangible assets

     41,990        109,451  

Other

     1,904        24,424  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 177,319      $ 358,787  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     

Current:

     

Payable to non-related parties

   $ 539,329      $ 414,547  

Accrued expenses

     325,682        215,405  

Accrued employee related expenses, bonuses and long-term incentive plan

     225,013        255,395  

Amounts payable for property, plant and equipment

     19,643        185,945  

Advances and deposits

     183,880        78,411  

Amounts payable for intangible assets

            49,844  

Payable to related parties

     27,562        10,793  

Interest payable

     8,115        3,272  

Other

     4,038        2,868  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,333,262      $ 1,216,480  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

29. Employee Benefit Plans

Retirement Savings Plans—The Company has a retirement savings plan, commonly known as a 401(k) plan, that allows participating employees in the United States to contribute a portion of their pre-tax salary up to Internal Revenue Service limits. The Company matches employee contributions dollar for dollar for the first 3% of participants’ contributions and 50 cents on each dollar of additional 3% of participants’ contributions, to a maximum of 4.5% of eligible compensation. The Company’s contributions to the 401(k) plan were $35,386, $33,809 and $31,986 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

The Company also has an employee benefits plan that requires the Company to make monthly contributions based on the statutory funding requirement into a Central Provident Fund (“CPF”) for substantially all Singapore citizens and permanent residents. The Company’s contributions under this plan was $24,986, $34,434 and $22,023 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

30. Commitments and Contingencies

Commitments—The Company’s unconditional purchase commitments are as follows:

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Contracts for capital expenditures

   $ 484,085      $ 952,604  

Contracts for operating expenditures

     677,037        1,044,560  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,161,122      $ 1,997,164  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Due within the next 12 months

   $ 826,460      $ 1,316,090  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-62


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

In addition to the above, the Company obtained letters of credit to primarily guarantee the PILOT bonds’ interest payments, payments for utility supplies and foreign statutory payroll related charges. The Company has obtained letters of credit of $56,571 and $36,211 at December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, and bank guarantees of $4,014 and $3,098 at December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

Leases of low-value items and short-term leases that do not meet the capitalization criteria under the Company’s lease policy are treated as operating expenses. The following summarizes the Company’s non-cancellable operating lease arrangements which were not capitalized and the minimum future rental payments under these arrangements:

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Within one year

   $ 490      $ 1,409  

After one year but not more than five years

     672        1,557  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,162      $ 2,966  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Company has a patent license agreement with LSI Technology Corporation (“LSI”) under which the parties grant to one another a license to use certain of each other’s patents. Under the terms of the patent license agreement, the Company may provide wafer capacity in lieu of payment for royalties. Such royalties under the patent license agreement are waived until such time the interest of LSI in SMP falls below 49%. In exchange, the Company has waived capacity shortfall obligations from LSI. Should the interest of LSI in SMP fall below 49%, the Company may be required to make royalty payments to LSI under this patent license agreement. The Company has not made any royalty payments to LSI. The patent license agreement continues for as long as the joint venture agreement between the parties remains.

Contingencies—From time to time, the Company is a party to claims that arise in the normal course of business. These claims include allegations of infringement of intellectual property rights of others as well as other claims of liability. In addition, the Company, on a case-by-case basis, includes intellectual property indemnification provisions in the terms of sale and technology licenses with third parties. The Company is also subject to various taxes in the different jurisdictions in which it operates. These include property, goods and services, and other non-income taxes. The Company accrues costs associated with these matters when they become probable and reasonably estimable. The Company does not believe it is probable that losses associated with these matters beyond those already recognized will be incurred in amounts that would be material to the consolidated statements of financial position or consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

 

F-63


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

31. Earnings Per Share

Basic and diluted loss per share have been calculated for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020 as follows:

 

    2018     2019     2020  
    (in thousands, except for share amounts)  

Net loss available to equity shareholder of the Company

     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

From continuing operations

  $ (2,626,026   $ (1,371,186   $ (1,350,860
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

From discontinued operations

  $ (75,490   $     $  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average common shares outstanding

    576,902,150       504,003,126       500,000,000  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic and diluted earnings per share:

     

From continuing operations

  $ (4.56   $ (2.72   $ (2.70
     

From discontinued operations

  $ (0.14   $ (0.00   $ (0.00
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total basic and diluted earnings per share attributable to equity shareholders

  $ (4.70   $ (2.72   $ (2.70
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020, there were 34,305,235, 32,560,289, and 22,286,278 share options outstanding, respectively, which were not included in the calculation of diluted earnings per share as their inclusion would have been anti-dilutive.

32. Related Party Disclosures

Related parties represent associated companies, the shareholder, directors and key management personnel of the Company and entities controlled, or significantly influenced by such parties. Pricing policies and terms of these transactions are approved by the audit, risk and compliance committee or the Company’s management, as applicable.

Below are the related parties which the Company has entered into transactions with:

 

Related Party Name    December 31,
2019
   December 31,
2020

SMP

   Joint venture    Joint venture

Mubadala Treasury Holding Company (“MTHC”)

   Shareholder entity    Shareholder entity

AMTC(1)

   Joint venture    N/A

BAC(1)

   Joint venture    N/A

Mubadala Technology

   Shareholder entity    Shareholder entity

 

(1)

Fully consolidated as of January 1, 2020.

Related parties represent associated companies, the shareholder, directors and key management personnel of the Company and entities controlled, or significantly influenced by such parties. Pricing policies and terms of these transactions are approved by the Company’s management.

 

F-64


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Balances with related parties included in the consolidated statements of financial positions are as follows:

 

     December 31, 2019      December 31, 2020  
     Due from
Related
Parties
     Due to
Related
Parties
     Due from
Related
Parties
     Due to
Related
Parties
 

SMP

   $ 9,045      $ 8,716      $  8,734      $  10,480  

Mubadala Treasury Holding Company (“MTHC”)

            111,997                

AMTC(1)

     165,698        18,496                

BAC(1)

     9,072                       

Mubadala Technology

     185        350               313  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total(2)

   $  184,000      $  139,559      $ 8,734      $ 10,793  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Loans made to a joint venture, AMTC, amounted to $165,698 in 2019. The current portion and noncurrent portion amounted to $47,952 and $117,746 in 2019, respectively. The loan carries a fixed interest rate of 4.0% and repayments are paid quarterly over eight years. Loans made to a joint venture, BAC, amounted to $9,072 in 2019. The current portion and noncurrent portion amounted to $1,261 and $7,811 in 2019, respectively. This loan carries a fixed interest rate of 5.081% and repayments are paid quarterly over five years. These loans were fully eliminated as a result of the consolidation of AMTC and BAC starting on January 1, 2020.

(2)

The total amounts of $184,000 and $8,734 due from related parties as of the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, has been included in receivables, prepayments and other assets (see Note 18). The amounts of $111,997 and $0 of the due to related parties balance as of the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, has been included in current portion of long-term debt (see Note 23). The remaining due to related parties’ balance of $27,562 and $10,793 for the years ended December 2019 and 2020, respectively, has been included in trade and other payables (see Note 28).

The following table presents the related party transactions included in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss:

 

     December 31,
2018
     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Purchases from:

        

SMP(1)

   $ 54,712      $ 61,950      $ 57,579  

AMTC

     131,990        124,196         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 186,702      $ 186,146      $ 57,579  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other transactions with:

        

SMP (reimbursement of expenses and contribution of tools)

   $ 55,829      $ 51,251      $  47,065  

AMTC

     7,517        27,527         

Mubadala Technology (reimbursement of expenses)

     3,851        496        618  

BAC

     152        263         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 67,349      $ 79,537      $ 47,683  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Purchases from SMP were primarily comprised of wafers.

 

F-65


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Terms and Conditions of Transactions with Related Parties

Outstanding balances at the year-end are unsecured and settlement occurs in cash. The Company has not recorded any allowance of receivables relating to amounts owed by related parties for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020. This assessment is undertaken each financial year through examining the financial position of the related party and the market in which the related party operates.

Transactions with Shareholder:

Shareholder Loan Agreement—The Company, as a borrower, entered into loan facilities with its shareholder in 2012 to 2016 (collectively the “Shareholder Loans”). The Shareholder Loans are non-interest bearing and principal repayment, in whole or in part, is entirely at the Company’s discretion as explicitly stated in the loan agreement. The Shareholder Loans are subordinated to any claims of other unsubordinated and subordinated creditors, including beneficiaries under guarantees issued, of the Company. The loans have no maturity date and remain outstanding until the loans are paid in full. Further, there are no contingent settlements in the agreements. Since the Shareholder Loans do not contain any contractual obligations to deliver cash, but rather allows the Company to make repayment at its absolute discretion and further prohibits the shareholder from demanding repayment, the Company treated the Shareholder Loans as equity.

The Company repaid $400,000 and $487,000 during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

Transactions with MTHC:

On June 5, 2019, the Company entered into a credit agreement with Morgan Stanley and several lenders, including MTHC. MTHC provided the Company facilities of $36,438 and EUR17,160. MTHC’s share of the debt issuance costs were $364 and EUR343. As of December 31, 2020, the Company has repaid the facilities.

Compensation of Key Management Personnel

The compensation of key management personnel during the following years were as follows:

 

     2019      2020  

Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

     

Short-term benefits

   $  3,329      $ 6,065  

Employees’ end of service benefits (on accrual basis)

     1,432        5,195  

Board of Directors

     784        800  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 5,545      $ 12,060  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

33. Share-Based Payments

In 2017, the Company approved the Share Incentive Plan, which is intended to attract and retain talented employees and align shareholder and employee interests. Share options under the Share Incentive Plan will be deemed vested shares over a five-year period.

 

F-66


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

In 2019, the Company offered to exchange the share options under the Share Incentive Plan with new share options under the “2018 Share Incentive Plan,” under which the Company may grant up to 25 million options to purchase shares in the Company with an exercise price of $10.00 per share. The options vest based on service over four or five years, depending on the timing of the grant and contingent upon a liquidity event (change in control or IPO) with the earliest vesting date on the one-year anniversary of a liquidity event. On April 19, 2019, the Company issued the share options subject to the tender offer.

The share options are effective for a term of ten years from the grant date. Because the vesting and exercisability of these share options are dependent on a qualified liquidity event, the Company had to assess the probability of such an event in order to determine the expenses related to the share-based payments for the period. Based on the Company’s assessment, the Company believes that a qualified liquidity event is not probable as of December 31, 2020 and therefore did not record any expense related to the share-based payments for the share options granted to the employees for the year ended December 31, 2020. The incremental expense from the awards exchanged under the tender offer was added to the amounts to be recognized in the future.

Upon the tender offer, the Company measured the pre-modification value of the old share options and compared that to the fair value of the new share options using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. The equity volatility was determined based on the historical volatilities of comparable publicly traded companies over a period equal to the expected average share-based payments life. The risk-free rate of interest was interpolated from the U.S. Constant Maturity Treasury rate curve to reflect the remaining expected life of share options.

The assumptions used to value the Company’s options granted during the period presented and their expected lives were as follows:

 

     December 31,  
     2018      2019      2020  

Expected dividend yield

     0.0%        0.0%        0.0%  

Expected volatility

     33.77%—35.08%        40.9%        43.5%  

Expected term

     6.5 years        6.0 years        5.5 years  

Risk-free interest rate

     2.43%—2.59%        1.59%—2.41%        0.32%—1.46%  

Estimated ordinary shares valuation

   $ 18.60—$18.84      $ 18.52—$20.48      $ 20.48—$24.62  

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the additional paid-in capital related to the share options amounted to $33,592, and $34,572, respectively. The share-based payment expenses amounted to $5,530, $0, and $980 for the years ended December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

The Company did not capitalize share-based compensation cost as part of the cost of an asset because the cost was insignificant.

 

F-67


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

     Number of
Share options
    Weighted average
exercise price per Share
 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2017

     37,099,995     $  21.54  

Granted

     5,843,623     $ 21.54  

Forfeited

     (8,638,383   $ 21.54  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2018

     34,305,235     $ 21.54  

Exchanged

     (18,837,010   $ 21.54  

Granted

     19,954,794     $ 10.00  

Forfeited

     (2,862,730   $ 17.69  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2019

     32,560,289     $ 14.80  

Granted

     5,078,456     $ 10.00  

Forfeited

     (15,352,467   $ 20.14  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2020

     22,286,278     $ 10.04  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table summarizes information about employees’ share options outstanding as of December 31, 2020:

 

Outstanding

 
Range of exercise prices    Number
Outstanding
     Weighted average remaining
contractual life (in years)
     Weighted average
Exercise price
 

$10.00—$26.00

     22,286,278        8.7      $  10.04  

The weighted average remaining contractual life is calculated based on the 10-year contract terms of the options. And the weighted average exercise price is calculated using the exercise price of the outstanding options, which pertain to the 2018 Share Incentive Plan.

As of December 31, 2018, 2019 and 2020, there was $93,675, $200,591, and $251,483, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation cost related to outstanding stock options.

As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the Company had 6,000,455 and 2,790,590 share options available for future grant.

34. Financial Risk Management Objectives and Policies

Capital Management—GLOBALFOUNDRIES has implemented a cash investment policy which determines the overall objectives of the Company’s investment strategy. This policy is aimed to ensure the preservation of capital and the maintenance of sufficient liquidity necessary to fund operations while balancing the needs for appropriate returns. The cash investment policy limits permissible investments and credit quality.

The primary objective of the Company’s capital management is to ensure that it maintains a healthy capital ratio in order to support its business and maximize shareholder value.

The Company manages its capital structure and makes adjustments to it in light of changes in economic conditions. There are no regulatory imposed requirements on the level of share capital which the Company has to maintain.

The Company monitors capital using a gearing ratio, which is net debt divided by total capital plus net debt. The Company’s policy is to keep the gearing ratio within a range to meet the business needs of the Company.

 

F-68


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The Company includes within net debt, interest bearing loans and borrowings and obligations under lease less bank balances and cash. Capital includes total equity including non-controlling interests less cumulative changes in fair value.

The Company’s interest-bearing loans and borrowings have certain financial covenants. Restrictive covenants in the Company’s credit facilities may prevent the Company from pursuing certain transactions or business strategies, including by limiting the Company’s ability to, in certain circumstances:

 

   

incur additional indebtedness;

 

   

pay dividends or make distributions;

 

   

acquire assets or make investments outside of the ordinary course of business;

 

   

sell, lease, license, transfer or otherwise dispose of assets;

 

   

enter into transactions with the Company’s affiliates;

 

   

create or permit liens;

 

   

guarantee indebtedness; and

 

   

engage in certain extraordinary transactions.

As of December 31, 2020, the Company is in compliance with the financial covenants.

Risks Arising from Financial Instruments—The main risks arising from the Company’s financial instruments are market risk (including foreign currency risk and interest rate risk), credit risk and liquidity risk. The Board of Directors reviews and approves policies for managing each of these risks which are summarized below.

Market Risk—Market price risk is the risk that the fair value of future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in market prices. Market prices comprise the following types of risk: interest rate risk, foreign currency risk and equity price risk.

Financial instruments affected by market risk include receivables, prepayments and other assets, cash and cash equivalents, restricted cash, interest bearing loans and borrowings, trade and other payables and derivative financial instruments.

The sensitivity analyses are prepared on the basis that the amount of net debt, the ratio of fixed to floating interest rates of the debt and derivatives and the proportion of financial instruments in foreign currencies are all constant and on the basis of the hedge designations in place at December 31, 2020.

The following assumptions are made in calculating the sensitivity analyses:

 

   

The consolidated statement of financial position sensitivity relates to derivatives.

 

   

The sensitivity of profit or loss in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income is the effect of the assumed changes in respective market risks. This is based on the financial assets and financial liabilities held at December 31, 2020 including the effect of hedge accounting.

Interest Rate Risk—The Company’s exposure to market risk for changes in interest rates relates primarily to interest-earning financial assets and interest-bearing financial liabilities. The Company’s interest-earning

 

F-69


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

financial assets are mostly highly liquid investments and consist of primarily money market funds and time deposits. As these financial assets are mainly short-term in nature, the Company’s exposure to mark-to-market risk is limited. The Company’s interest-bearing financial liabilities include fixed and floating rate loans and lease obligations. Floating rate loans bear interest at Base Rate or LIBOR or EURIBOR plus a premium, which is fixed. The Company uses pay-fixed / receive-float interest rate swaps to protect the Company against adverse fluctuations in interest rates and to reduce its exposure to variability in cash flows on the Company’s forecasted floating-rate debt facility to the extent that it is practicable and cost effective to do so.

At the reporting date, the interest rate profile of the Company’s interest-bearing financial instruments was:

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Fixed rate instruments:

     

Financial assets

   $ 230,400      $  

Financial liabilities

     535,992        491,916  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 766,392      $ 491,916  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Variable rate instruments:

     

Financial liabilities

   $ 2,712,344      $  2,310,551  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair Value Sensitivity Analysis for Fixed Rate Instruments—The Company does not account for any fixed rate financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, and the Company does not designate derivatives (interest rate swaps) as hedging instruments under a fair value hedge accounting model. Therefore, a change in market interest rates would not affect profit or loss.

Cash Flow Sensitivity Analysis for Variable Rate Instruments—The sensitivity of profit or loss in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income is the effect of the assumed changes in interest rates on the Company’s profit or loss for one year, based on the floating rate financial assets and financial liabilities held on December 31, 2020.

The following table demonstrates the sensitivity of profit or loss in the consolidated statement of operations to reasonably possible changes in interest rates, with all other variables held constant.

 

     Increase/
(Decrease)
in Percentages
    Effects on
Loss
before Tax
 

December 31, 2018

     10   $ 6,388  
     (10 %)      (6,388

December 31, 2019

     10   $ 2,164  
     (10 %)      (2,164

December 31, 2020

     10   $ 19,194  
     (10 %)      (19,194

Foreign Currency Risk—As a result of foreign operations, the Company has costs, assets and liabilities that are denominated in foreign currencies, primarily the Euro, the Japanese Yen and the Singapore Dollar. Therefore, movements in exchange rates could cause foreign currency denominated expenses to increase as a percentage of net revenue, affecting profitability and cash flows. The Company uses foreign currency forward contracts to reduce exposure to foreign currency fluctuations. The Company also incurs certain portion of its interest expense

 

F-70


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

in Euro, exposing the Company to exchange rate fluctuations between USD and EUR. The Company uses cross-currency swaps to reduce its exposure to variability from foreign exchange impacting cash flows arising from Company’s foreign currency denominated debt cash flows to the extent than it is practicable and cost effective to do so.

Exposure to Currency Risk—The Company’s exposure to foreign currency risk against financial assets and financial liabilities was as follows, based on notional amounts:

 

     EUR     JPY     SGD  

December 31, 2019

      

Receivables and prepayments

   $ 295,767     $ 426     $ 36,673  

Cash and cash equivalents

     46,388       3,930       33,664  

Loans and borrowings

     (94,589           17  

Trade and other payables

     (150,611     (15,942     (81,170
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 96,955     $ (11,586   $ (10,816
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

December 31, 2020

      

Receivables and prepayments

   $ 141,603     $ 353     $ 12,020  

Cash and cash equivalents

     54,043       2,150       8,531  

Loans and borrowings

     (26,992           42  

Trade and other payables

     (150,127     (13,820     (65,966
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 18,527     $ (11,317   $ (45,373
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following significant exchange rates applied during the year:

 

     $-EUR      $-JPY      $-SGD  

December 31, 2018

        

Closing rate

     1.1446        110.2800        1.3659  

Average

     1.1369        112.5300        1.3717  

December 31, 2019

        

Closing rate

     0.8929        108.8800        1.3487  

Average

     0.9017        109.1000        1.3587  

December 31, 2020

        

Closing rate

     0.8131        103.1900        1.3234  

Average

     0.8256        103.8800        1.3345  

 

F-71


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The objective of foreign currency forward contracts is to minimize the impact of foreign currency exchange rate movements on the Company’s operating results and on the cost of capital asset acquisitions. With all other variables held constant, and ignoring the offsetting impact on the underlying exposures being hedged, a 10% strengthening/weakening of the US dollar against the following currencies would results in gains/(losses) on the foreign exchange contracts in place at year end December 31, 2020, and would increase/(decrease) loss before taxes by the amounts shown below.

 

     Foreign
Currency
   Increase/
(Decrease) in
Percentages
    Effects on
Loss
before Tax
 

2018

   EUR      10   $ 90,435  
   EUR      (10 %)      (90,435
   JPY      10     5,146  
   JPY      (10 %)      (5,146
   SGD      10     36,556  
   SGD      (10 %)      (36,556

2019

   EUR      10   $ 65,830  
   EUR      (10 %)      (65,830
   JPY      10     3,172  
   JPY      (10 %)      (3,172
   SGD      10     39,995  
   SGD      (10 %)      (39,995

2020

   EUR      10   $ 62,000  
   EUR      (10 %)      (62,000
   JPY      10     2,431  
   JPY      (10 %)      (2,431
   SGD      10     37,308  
   SGD      (10 %)      (37,308

Credit Risk—Credit risk can be defined as the risk of suffering financial loss from financial instruments due to the failure by a counterparty to fulfill an obligation. Financial instruments that subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk include investments and cash equivalents and foreign exchange transactions. With respect to credit risk arising from the Company’s cash and cash equivalents, the Company’s exposure to credit risk arises from default of the counterparty, with a maximum exposure equal to the carrying amount of these instruments.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES has implemented a surplus cash policy. The objective of the policy is to ensure the preservation of capital and maintain sufficient liquidity necessary to fund operations while balancing the needs for appropriate returns, in that order. The surplus cash policy limits permissible investments, the concentration of investments and credit quality. The portfolio currently includes mainly investments in money market funds and time deposits. The Company invests in time deposits and certificates of deposit with banks having combined capital of not less than $500,000. All investments have a short-term rating of A1+, P1 or better and a long-term rating of AA-, Aa3 or better. The Company invests in money market funds that have a rating of A-1/P-1 or better.

With regards to foreign exchange transactions, the credit exposure is limited to the market value of the instruments. The Company requires netting agreements with its foreign exchange counterparties to minimize

 

F-72


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

credit risk. The Company transacts foreign currency with highly rated banks and financial institutions. The Company constantly positions its investment and foreign currency portfolio to respond appropriately to a significant reduction in a credit rating of any counterparty or investment issuer.

The Company generally does not require collateral to secure accounts receivable. The risk with respect to trade receivables is mitigated by credit evaluations the Company performs on the Company’s customers, the short duration of the Company’s payments terms for the significant majority of the Company’s customer contracts and by the diversification of the Company’s customer base. Accounts receivable from the Company’s largest customer totaled 22% and 17% of the accounts receivable balance as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. The Company also has one other customer that represented 15% and 16% of the total accounts receivable amount as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

The Company’s five largest customers account for approximately 60% and 63% of the outstanding trade receivables balance as of December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. These five customers account for approximately 55% and 51% of the Company’s revenue for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. The Company’s largest customer accounts for 27% and 21% of Company’s revenue for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively.

Exposure to Credit Risk—The carrying amount of financial assets represents the maximum credit exposure. The maximum exposure to credit risk at the reporting date was:

 

     December 31,
2019
     December 31,
2020
 

Receivables and prepayments

     

Trade receivables

   $ 646,995      $ 774,712  

Prepayments and other assets

     1,152,612        209,317  

Short-term deposits and money market funds

     600,597        560,198  

Cash in hand and at bank

     396,718        347,879  

Derivative financial assets

     19,356        84,588  

Receivables from government grants

     234,140        51,660  

Restricted cash

     34,399        35,654  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 3,084,817      $ 2,064,008  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The aging of financial assets including trade receivables is as follows:

 

            Past Due but Not Impaired  
     Total      Neither Past
Due Nor
Impaired
     < 30
Days
     31-90
Days
     91-120
Days
     Great than
120 Days
 

December 31, 2019

   $ 2,030,347      $ 1,994,555      $ 26,032      $ 6,785      $ 2,975      $  

December 31, 2020

   $ 1,041,389      $ 1,026,367      $ 14,795      $ 197      $ 30      $  

Liquidity Risk—The Company monitors its risk to a shortage of funds by monitoring its cash flow situation. Ongoing cash forecasting and review processes have been set up to determine the amount of external funding needed. The Company has set up a process of mid- and long-term financial planning. The Company’s financing structure, including maturities of debt, is determined in response to the financing requirements identified with the long-term business planning process.

 

F-73


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

The table below summarizes the maturity profile of the Company’s financial liabilities:

 

    Carrying
Value
    Contractual
Cash Flows
    1 Year or
Less
    1 to 5 Years     Greater than
5 Years
    Total  

December 31, 2019

           

Loans and borrowings

  $  2,729,167     $  3,265,853     $ 664,067     $ 1,700,974     $  900,812     $  3,265,853  

Lease obligations

    519,169       687,105       169,803       293,172       224,130       687,105  

Derivative financial liability

    5,275       5,275       5,275                   5,275  

Trade payables and other payables

    1,193,276       1,193,276       1,149,425       43,851             1,193,276  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  $ 4,446,887     $ 5,151,509     $ 1,988,570     $ 2,037,997     $ 1,124,942     $ 5,151,509  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

December 31, 2020

           

Loans and borrowings

  $ 2,337,955     $ 2,507,456     $ 447,490     $ 2,000,928     $ 59,038     $ 2,507,456  

Lease obligations

    464,512       597,996       165,621       256,997       175,778       598,396  

Derivative financial liability

    34,663       34,663       1,318       33,345             34,663  

Trade payables and other payables

    1,271,944       1,271,944       1,138,069       133,875             1,271,944  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  $ 4,109,074     $ 4,412,059     $ 1,752,498     $ 2,425,145     $ 234,816     $ 4,412,459  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In preparing the maturity profile, undiscounted payments are calculated based on contractually agreed interest rates where these are fixed, or, in the case of discounted liabilities for leases, where the interest rate is implicit in the financing arrangement. For variable interest arrangements undiscounted payments are determined based on the interest rate prevailing at the reporting date.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value—The Company uses the following hierarchy for determining and disclosing the fair value of financial instruments by valuation technique:

Level 1—Quoted (unadjusted) prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities

Level 2—Other techniques for which all inputs which have a significant effect on the recorded fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly

Level 3—Techniques which use inputs which have a significant effect on the recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data.

Time deposits and money market funds are primarily classified within Level 1 or Level 2 because time deposits and money market funds are valued primarily using quoted market prices of similar instruments or alternative pricing sources and models utilizing market observable inputs.

For assets and liabilities that are recognized at fair value on a recurring basis, the Company determines whether transfers have occurred between levels in the hierarchy by re-assessing categorization (based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement as a whole) at the end of each reporting period. Foreign currency forward contracts are classified within Level 2. The fair values of foreign currency forward contracts are determined using quantitative models that require the use of multiple market inputs, including interest rates, prices and maturity dates to generate pricing curves, which are used to value the positions. The market inputs are generally actively quoted and can be validated through external sources. For foreign currency forward contract asset and liability positions with maturity dates which fall between the dates of quoted prices, interpolation of rate or maturity scenarios are used in determining fair values.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

During the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2020, there were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements.

Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

The following table presents the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis:

 

     Fair Value Measurement at Reporting Date Using  
     Total      Quoted
Prices
Identical
Assets/
Liabilities
(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

December 31, 2019

           

Assets:

           

Cash equivalents:

           

Time deposits(1)

   $ 230,400      $      $ 230,400      $  

Money market funds(1)

     370,197        370,197                
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash equivalents

   $ 600,597      $ 370,197      $ 230,400      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Investments in equity instruments(2)

   $ 8,169      $      $      $ 8,169  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments in equity instruments

   $ 8,169      $      $      $ 8,169  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 6,798      $      $ 6,798      $  

Interest rate swaps

     7,045               7,045         

Cross currency swaps

     5,513               5,513         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(3)

   $ 19,356      $      $ 19,356      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Liabilities:

           

Derivatives—foreign currency forward contracts(4)

   $ 5,275      $      $ 5,275      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives

   $ 5,275      $      $ 5,275      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-75


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

     Fair Value Measurement at Reporting Date Using  
     Total      Quoted
Prices
Identical
Assets/
Liabilities
(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

December 31, 2020

           

Assets:

           

Cash equivalents:

           

Money market funds(1)

   $ 560,198      $ 560,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash equivalents

   $ 560,198      $ 560,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Investments in equity instruments(2)

   $ 12,737      $      $      $ 12,737  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments in equity instruments

   $ 12,737      $      $      $ 12,737  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 42,199      $      $ 42,199      $  

Cross currency swaps

     33,169               33,169         

Commodity hedge

     9,220               9,220         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(3)

   $ 84,588      $      $ 84,588      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
           

Liabilities:

           

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 1,318      $      $ 1,318      $  

Interest rate swaps

     33,287               33,287         

Commodity hedge

     58               58         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(4)

   $ 34,663      $      $ 34,663      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Included in cash and cash equivalents on the Company’s consolidated statements of financial position.

(2)

Included in current and noncurrent receivables, prepayments and other assets on the Company’s consolidated statements of financial position.

(3)

Included in other current and noncurrent financial assets on the Company’s consolidated statements of financial position.

(4)

Included in other current and noncurrent financial liabilities on the Company’s consolidated statements of financial position.

Assets Measured and Recorded at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

Certain assets and liabilities, such as non-marketable equity securities, equity method investments, intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, and other non-financial assets, are recorded at fair value only if an impairment or observable price adjustment is recognized in the current period. If an observable price adjustment or impairment is recognized on the Company’s non-marketable equity securities during the period, the Company will classify these assets as Level 3 within the fair value hierarchy based on the nature of the fair value inputs.

 

F-76


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

For the Company’s assets held for sale, the carrying amounts were $4,152 and $0 at December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively, and fair values amounted to $30,075 and $0 at December 31, 2019 and 2020, respectively. The Company determined the asset’s carrying value to be within a reasonable fair value range of estimates.

Financial Instruments Not Recorded at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

Financial instruments not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis include non-marketable equity securities (that have not been re-measured or impaired in the current period), grants receivable, loans receivable, lease obligations and the Company’s short-term and long-term debt.

The carrying and fair values of the Company’s financial instruments not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis are presented in the following table, classified according to the categories of loans and receivables (“LaR”) and financial liabilities at amortized cost (“FLAC”):

 

            December 31, 2019      December 31, 2020  

Financial Liabilities

   Category      Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value      Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value  

Trade and other payables

      $ 1,193,276      $ 1,193,276      $ 1,271,944      $ 1,271,944  

Other long-term debt

     FLAC        2,729,167        2,724,502        2,337,955        2,336,114  

Lease obligations

     FLAC        519,169        593,704        464,512        464,422  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 4,441,612      $ 4,511,482      $ 4,074,411      $ 4,072,480  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Estimated fair values of loans and borrowings is based on quoted prices for similar liabilities for which significant inputs are observable and represents a Level 2 valuation. The fair values are estimated based on the type of loan and maturity. The Company estimates the fair value using market interest rates for the Company’s debts with similar maturities.

35. Operating Segment Information

 

  (a)  

Operating segments, segment revenue, operating results

The Company’s chief operating decision-maker is the Company’s Chief Executive Officer who makes resource allocation decisions and assesses performance based on financial information presented on a consolidated basis. There are no segment managers who are held accountable by the chief operating decision-maker, or anyone else, for operations, operating results, and planning for levels or components below the consolidated unit level. Accordingly, the Company has determined that the Company has a single reportable segment and operating segment structure.

 

  (b)  

Revenue and non-current assets by geography and major customers’ representing at least 10% of revenue based on customer’s headquarters were as follows:

 

     For the years ended December 31,  

Revenue by Geography

   2018      2019      2020  

United States

   $ 4,408,710      $ 4,140,201      $ 3,368,262  

Europe, the Middle East, and Africa

     608,371        695,193        451,283  

Taiwan

     469,628        401,543        456,465  

China

     421,799        411,231        381,606  

Others

     287,531        164,620        192,889  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 6,196,039      $ 5,812,788      $ 4,850,505  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-77


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

Noncurrent Assets by Geography

   2019      2020  

United States

   $ 7,470,185      $ 5,843,023  

Germany

     1,406,962        1,404,202  

Singapore

     1,270,538        1,114,603  

Other

     415,063        495,461  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 10,562,748      $ 8,857,289  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-current assets include property, plant, equipment, right-of-use assets, intangible assets, investments in joint venture and associates, restricted cash (non-current) and receivables, prepayments and other assets (non-current).

 

     For the years ended December 31,  

Major Customer

   2018      2019      2020  
     Amount      %      Amount      %      Amount      %  

Customer A

   $ 1,675,039        27      $ 1,600,131        28      $ 1,000,750        21  

Customer B

     578,097        9        442,537        8        536,915        11  

36. Customer and Supplier Concentration

Significant customers and suppliers are those that account for greater than 10% of the Company’s revenues and purchases.

The Company earned a substantial portion of revenue from two customers in 2018, 2019 and 2020: Customer A amounted to 27%, 28% and 21% of total revenues, respectively, and Customer B amounted to 9%, 8%, and 11% of total revenues, respectively. As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the amounts due from Customer A included in accounts receivable were $143,585 and $129,895, respectively, and the amounts due from Customer B included in accounts receivable were $124,289 and $100,410, respectively. The loss of the significant customers or the failure to attract new customers could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition for the Company.

The Company purchased 33%, 42% and 52% of its SOI wafers, a key input into its products, from a single supplier in 2018, 2019 and 2020, respectively. As of December 31, 2019 and 2020, the net amount due to the supplier was $50,777 and $32,450 respectively. Any failure in the supplier’s ability to provide SOI wafers could materially and adversely affect the Company’s results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

37. Subsequent Events

The Company periodically assesses the estimated useful lives of our property, plant, and equipment. Based on the assessment of the longer product life cycles, the versatility of production equipment to provide better flexibility to meet changes in customer demands, and the ability to re-use production equipment over several technology cycles, the Company revised the estimated useful lives of its 200mm and 300mm production equipment from 5 and 8 years, respectively, to 10 years, beginning the first quarter of 2021. The impacts of the change in estimate are prospective and do not impact the periods presented.

In 2017, the Company and the local government of Chengdu, China (“CD”) entered into a set of agreements related to the establishment of a joint venture in Chengdu, China to establish and operate a greenfield wafer

 

F-78


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2018, 2019 AND 2020

(Dollars in thousands)

 

production site in Chengdu. The parties contemplated that the manufacturing operations would be implemented in two phases. Due to a variety of factors, including unanticipated market conditions, the manufacturing operations did not proceed as planned and the parties have been working to wind-down operations of the joint venture. On April 26, 2021, the Company received a claim from CD requesting that the Company share in CD’s alleged losses and related costs incurred to support the joint venture. The Company and CD are engaged in negotiations to settle the claim and the Company recorded an estimated provision of $34,000 in June 2021.

On April 28, 2021, International Business Machines (“IBM”) sent the Company a letter alleging for the first time that the Company did not fulfill the Company’s obligations under the contracts the Company entered into with IBM in 2014 associated with the Company’s acquisition of IBM’s Microelectronics business. IBM asserted that the Company engaged in fraudulent misrepresentations during the underlying negotiations, and claimed the Company owed them $2,500,000 in damages and restitution. The Company believes, based on discussions with legal counsel, that it has meritorious defenses against IBM’s claims and on June 7, 2021, the Company filed a complaint with the New York State Supreme Court seeking a declaratory judgment that the Company did not breach the relevant contracts. IBM subsequently filed its complaint with the New York State Supreme Court on June 8, 2021. The Company does not currently anticipate this proceeding to have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

On September 3, 2021, the Company entered into a loan agreement with a lender, which provided for loan facilities with maximum drawdown of SGD1,541,000 thousand (US$1,148,500) at fixed interest rates. The loan matures on June 1, 2041, with interest-only payments for the first five years and principal repayments commence thereafter, payable on a semi-annual basis. No amounts have been drawn down on the facility.

On September 12, 2021, the Company amended the authorized share capital from $30,000 divided into 3,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of $0.01 each; to $30,000 divided into 1,500,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of $0.02 each, and effected a 1-for-2 reverse share split to reclassify all 1,153,804,300, 1,000,000,000 and 1,000,000,000 of our ordinary shares outstanding as of December 31, 2018, 2019, and 2020 respectively, to 576,902,150, 500,000,000 and 500,000,000 ordinary shares, respectively, which was approved by the Company’s board of directors and sole shareholder on September 9, 2021. As a result, the accompanying consolidated financial statements and related notes to the consolidated financial statements give retroactive effect to the reverse share split for all periods presented.

38. Subsequent Event (Unaudited)

For purpose of this filing, the Company has evaluated the effects of subsequent events through October 4, 2021.

On October 1, 2021, the Company’s board approved the conversion of the Shareholder Loan to additional paid-in-capital, and October 3, 2021, the Company executed an agreement with Mubadala to convert the remaining $10,112,687 of the Shareholder Loan balance into additional paid-in-capital (“the Conversion”). The Conversion did not have an impact on shares outstanding or have any dilutive effects, as no additional shares were issued.

These consolidated financial statements were issued on behalf of the Company on October 4, 2021 by:

Thomas Caulfield, Chief Executive Officer

David Reeder, Senior Vice President—Finance and Chief Financial Officer

******

 

 

F-79


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands, except share amounts)

 

     Note      Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020     2021  

Net revenues

     3      $ 2,697,483     $ 3,038,186  

Cost of revenues

        3,058,108       2,708,171  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross profit (loss)

        (360,625     330,015  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Research and development expenses

        243,245       234,658  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

        209,559       293,289  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

        452,804       527,947  

Impairment charges

        1,672        
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other operating expenses

        1,672        
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from operations

        (815,101     (197,932

Finance income

        2,274       2,863  

Finance expenses

        (82,334     (57,911

Share of profit of joint ventures

     4        1,984       1,933  

Other income (expense), net

        395,169       (19,690
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes from operations

        (498,008     (270,737

Income tax expense

     5        (35,605     (30,481
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss for the period

      $ (533,613   $ (301,218
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to:

       

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

      $ (532,296   $ (299,454

Non-controlling interest

        (1,317     (1,764
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss for the period

      $ (533,613   $ (301,218
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to the equity holders of the Company:

       

Basic and diluted loss per share

     6      $ (1.06   $ (0.60

Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:

       

Items that may be reclassified subsequently to profit or loss:

       

Share of foreign exchange fluctuation reserve of Subsidiaries

              (4,994

Effective portion of changes in the fair value of cash flow hedges

        (74,499     (18,548

Income tax effect

     5        461       832  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        (74,038     (22,710

Items that will not be reclassified subsequently to profit and loss:

       

Remeasurement of existing equity interests

        6,553        

Share of foreign exchange fluctuation reserve of Subsidiaries

        516        
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

        (66,969     (22,710
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive loss for the period

      $ (600,582   $ (323,928
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to:

       

Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

      $ (599,265   $ (320,725

Non–controlling interest

        (1,317     (3,203
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive loss for the period

      $ (600,582   $ (323,928
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in the Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-80


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION

AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2020 AND JUNE 30, 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

     Note      December 31,     June 30,  
     2020     2021  

ASSETS

       

Noncurrent assets:

       

Property, plant and equipment, net

     7      $ 8,226,202     $ 8,290,481  

Goodwill and intangible assets, net

     8        547,942       471,103  

Investments in joint ventures

     4        36,702       37,942  

Other noncurrent financial assets

        34,054       20,094  

Deferred tax assets

        443,566       418,753  

Restricted cash

        1,583       1,203  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets

     9        44,860       148,767  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noncurrent assets

        9,334,909       9,388,343  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current assets:

       

Inventories, net

     10        919,519       1,005,320  

Other current financial assets

        50,534       22,227  

Receivables from government grants

        51,660       46,625  

Receivables, prepayments and other assets*

     9,13        1,022,863       1,129,308  

Restricted cash

        34,071        

Cash and cash equivalents

        908,077       804,688  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

        2,986,724       3,008,168  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

      $ 12,321,633     $ 12,396,511  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND EQUITY

       

Equity:

       

Share capital

Ordinary shares, $0.02 par value, 1,500,000 thousand shares authorized, 500,000 thousand shares issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021

      $ 10,000     $ 10,000  

Additional paid-in capital

        11,707,515       11,848,304  

Loan from shareholder

     13        10,680,687       10,554,687  

Accumulated deficit

        (15,218,509     (15,517,963

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

        (3,319     (24,590
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity attributable to the shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

        7,176,374       6,870,438  

Non-controlling interest

        65,128       61,925  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

        7,241,502       6,932,363  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent liabilities

       

Noncurrent portion of long-term debt

     11        1,956,148       1,794,155  

Noncurrent portion of finance lease obligations

        333,242       373,133  

Deferred tax liabilities

        8,422       10,182  

Noncurrent deferred revenue

        12,112       362,345  

Other noncurrent financial liabilities

        33,345       20,950  

Other noncurrent liabilities

     12        358,787       277,689  

Provisions

        353,308       350,895  

Noncurrent portion of deferred income from government grants

        128,697       128,583  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noncurrent liabilities

        3,184,061       3,317,932  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

       

Current portion of long-term debt

     11        381,807       381,690  

Current portion of lease obligations

        131,270       96,945  

Current portion of deferred income from government grants

        40,505       28,929  

Current deferred revenue

        94,081       169,808  

Other current financial liabilities

        1,318       18,180  

Trade and other payables*

     12,13        1,216,480       1,420,931  

Income tax payable

        30,609       29,733  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

        1,896,070       2,146,216  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

        5,080,131       5,464,148  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

      $ 12,321,633     $ 12,396,511  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

*

Includes amounts of related party transactions. See Note 13 for details.

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in the Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-81


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

    Equity Attributable to Shareholder of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.        
    Common Shares     Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Loan from
Shareholder
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Hedging
Reserve
    Foreign
Currency
Translation
Reserve
    Total     Non-
controlling
Interest
    Total
Equity
 
  Shares     Amount  

As of December 31, 2019

    500,000,000     $ 10,000     $ 11,706,535     $ 11,167,687     $ (13,870,938   $ 9,967     $ (4,121   $ 9,019,130     $     $ 9,019,130  

Acquisition of subsidiaries

                                                    63,717       63,717  

Repayment of loan from shareholder

                      (350,000                       (350,000           (350,000

Share-based payments

                980                               980             980  

Net loss

                            (532,296                 (532,296     (1,317     (533,613

Other comprehensive (loss) income

                                  (74,038     7,069       (66,969           (66,969
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of June 30, 2020

    500,000,000     $ 10,000     $ 11,707,515     $ 10,817,687     $ (14,403,234   $ (64,071   $ 2,948     $ 8,070,845     $ 62,400     $ 8,133,245  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2020

    500,000,000     $ 10,000     $ 11,707,515     $ 10,680,687     $ (15,218,509   $ (14,941   $ 11,622     $ 7,176,374     $ 65,128     $ 7,241,502  

Repayment of loan from shareholder

                      (126,000                       (126,000           (126,000

Share-based payments

                140,789                               140,789             140,789  

Net loss

                            (299,454                 (299,454     (1,764     (301,218

Other comprehensive loss

                                  (17,716     (3,555     (21,271     (1,439     (22,710
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of June 30, 2021

    500,000,000     $ 10,000     $ 11,848,304     $ 10,554,687     $ (15,517,963   $ (32,657   $ 8,067     $ 6,870,438     $ 61,925     $ 6,932,363  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Share amounts and per share data give retroactive effect to the reverse share split as described in the Subsequent Events footnote effective September 12, 2021.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-82


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

     Note    Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020     2021  

Cash flows from operating activities

       

Net loss

      $ (533,613   $ (301,218

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

       

Depreciation

   7      1,156,090       680,237  

Amortization of intangible assets

   8      128,473       104,430  

Finance income

        (2,274     (2,863

Finance expenses

        82,334       57,911  

Amortization of deferred income from government grants

        (27,134     (15,892

Share of profit of joint ventures

   4      (1,984     (1,933

Deferred income taxes

        1,693       33,210  

Foreign currency exchange net loss (gain)

        1,132       (364

Impairment charges

        1,672        

Gain on disposal of property, plant and equipment

        (45,338     (11,252

Gain on remeasurement of existing equity interests

        (38,470      

Gain on fair value of investment in equity instruments

              (2,531

Loss (gain) on derivatives

        211       (641

Share-based payments

        980       143,775  

Other operating activities

        (51,507     (7,110

Change in assets and liabilities:

       

Receivables, prepayments and other assets

        137,340       (245,964

Inventories

        28,705       (85,801

Trade and other payables

        (224,314     289,525  

Income tax payable

        (6,051     3,012  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 
        607,945       636,531  

Interest received

        3,062       363  

Interest paid

        (76,471     (50,918

Income tax received (paid)

        4,602       (3,886
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

        539,138       582,090  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities

       

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

        (186,776     (656,931

Payments from settlement of hedges

        (985     (2,265

Purchases of intangible assets

        (79,934     (68,499

Cash dividends received from equity accounted investees

        1,317       693  

Advances and proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

        81,020       264,713  

Advances and proceeds from sale of a fabrication facility and application specific integrated circuit business

        15,159        

Acquisition of subsidiaries

        4,133        
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

        (166,066     (462,289
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-83


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

     Note      Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020     2021  

Cash flows from financing activities

       

Repayments of shareholder loan

     13        (350,000     (126,000

Repayments of borrowings from shareholder

        (111,516      

Proceeds from borrowings

        1,724,342       265,275  

Payment of debt issuance costs

        (6,250     (722

Repayment of debt and finance lease obligations

        (1,600,216     (447,913

Proceeds from government grants

        244,139       50,652  

Decrease in restricted cash

        335       34,451  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities

        (99,166     (224,257
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

        (2,550     1,067  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

        271,356       (103,389

Cash and cash equivalents at the beginning of the period

        997,315       908,077  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at the end of the period

      $ 1,268,671     $ 804,688  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncash investing and financing activities:

       

Amounts payable for property, plant and equipment

      $ 71,395     $ 269,638  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment acquired through lease

      $ 1,731     $ 91,952  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts payable for intangible assets

      $ 91,894     $ 121,830  
     

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-84


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

1. CORPORATE INFORMATION

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (“GLOBALFOUNDRIES”) is an exempted company with limited liability incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands. The address of GLOBALFOUNDRIES’ registered office is P.O. Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104 Cayman Islands.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES and its subsidiaries (together referred to as the “Company”) is one of the world’s largest pure-play semiconductor foundries and offer a full range of mainstream wafer fabrication services and technologies. The Company manufactures a broad range of semiconductor devices, including microprocessors, mobile application processors, baseband processors, network processors, radio frequency modems, microcontrollers, power management units and microelectromechanical systems.

2. BASIS OF PREPARATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Statement of Compliance—The unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements of GLOBALFOUNDRIES as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021 and for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, have been prepared in accordance with International Accounting Standard (“IAS”) 34, Interim Financial Reporting.

The unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements do not include all the information and disclosures required in the annual consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, and should be read in conjunction with the Company’s annual consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2020.

The unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements were authorized by the Audit, Risk and Compliance Committee of GLOBALFOUNDRIES’ Board of Directors on September 8, 2021 to be issued and subsequent events have been evaluated for their potential effect on the unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements through September 13, 2021.

Significant Accounting Policies—The accounting policies (including accounting judgments, estimates and assumptions) adopted in the preparation of the unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements are consistent with those followed in the preparation of the Company’s annual consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2020, except for the following:

Recent Accounting Pronouncements, Adopted:

Amendments to IFRS 9, IAS 39, IFRS 7 and IFRS 16 Interest Rate Benchmark Reform (“IBOR reform”)

Phase 1 Amendments—On January 1, 2020, the Company adopted the Phase 1 amendments arising from the IBOR reform amendments issued in September 2019, which provides temporary relief from applying specific hedge accounting requirements to hedge relationships directly affected by IBOR reform, such that the effect is that IBOR reform should not generally cause hedge accounting to terminate.

Phase 2 Amendments—On January 1, 2021, the Company adopted the Phase 2 amendments arising from the IBOR reform issued in August 2020. The Phase 2 amendments address issues that arise from the implementation

 

F-85


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

of the IBOR reform, including the replacement of an interest rate benchmark with an alternative benchmark rate. The key reliefs provided to the Company are as follows:

 

   

financial instruments measured at amortized cost are allowed to account for changes in the basis for determining contractual cash flows as a direct consequence of the IBOR reform by updating the effective interest rate, provided that the new basis is economically equivalent to the previous basis, such that there is no immediate gain or loss recognized; and

 

   

most IFRS 9 hedge relationships that are directly affected by the IBOR reform are allowed to continue.

The Company has evaluated the extent to which its cash flow hedging relationships are subject to uncertainty driven by IBOR reform as of June 30, 2021. The Company’s hedged items and hedging instruments continue to be indexed to EURIBOR and LIBOR. These benchmark rates are quoted each day and the IBOR cash flows are exchanged with counterparties as usual. The Company has also evaluated the extent to which its loan and derivative contracts reference IBOR, whether such contracts will need to be amended as a result of IBOR reform. There has been communication about the IBOR reform with the counterparties. However, no amendment has been made to the Company’s existing IBOR-referenced loan and derivative contracts as of June 30, 2021.

As of June 30, 2021, there is still uncertainty about when and how replacement may occur with respect to the relevant hedged items and hedging instruments. Accordingly, the Company will continue to apply the Phase 1 amendments until the uncertainty arising from the IBOR reform with respect to the timing and the amount of the underlying cash flows that the Company is exposed to is no longer present. This uncertainty will not end until the Company’s contracts that reference IBOR are amended to specify the alternative benchmark rate and the relevant adjustment, if any. This will, in part, be dependent on the negotiation with the counterparties and the introduction of fall back clauses which have yet to be added to the Company’s contracts.

Earnings per share—Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit or loss attributable to equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year. Diluted income per share is calculated by dividing the profit attributable to equity holders of the Company by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding, adjusted for the effects of all dilutive potential ordinary shares. The weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding is increased by the number of additional ordinary shares that would have been issued by the Company assuming exercise of all options with exercise prices below the average market price for the year. The Company did not hold any dilutive instruments as of June 30, 2020 and 2021.

Significant accounting judgments, estimates and assumptions—The preparation of the unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements in conformity with IFRS requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of accounting policies and the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses as well as the disclosure of commitments and contingencies. Actual results may differ from these estimates and such differences may be material to the unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements.

Changes in estimates—We periodically assess the estimated useful lives of our property, plant, and equipment. Based on our assessment of the longer product life cycles, the versatility of production equipment to provide better flexibility to meet changes in customer demands, and the ability to re-use production equipment over several technology cycles, we revised the estimated useful lives of our 200mm and 300mm production equipment from 5 and 8 years, respectively, to 10 years, beginning the first quarter of 2021. As a

 

F-86


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

result, this benefited net loss for the period by approximately $310,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2021. This change increased the Company’s total basic and diluted earnings per share by approximately $0.62 for the six months ended June 30, 2021.

Risk and uncertainty—The Company is subject to risks and uncertainties as a result of the COVID-19 pandemic. The extent of the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on the Company’s business is highly uncertain and difficult to predict, as the response to the pandemic is rapidly evolving. While the Company did not experience a significant financial disruption from COVID-19 during the six months ended June 30, 2021, its business, financial condition, liquidity, and cash flow may subsequently be adversely affected, but it is impossible to predict the extent of any such impact as the circumstances rapidly evolve.

3. NET REVENUES

The following table presents the Company’s revenue disaggregated based on revenue source and timing of revenue recognition.

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020      2021  

Type of goods and services:

     

Wafer fabrication

   $ 2,542,251      $ 2,854,920  

Engineering and other pre-fabrication services

     155,232        183,266  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,697,483      $ 3,038,186  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Timing of revenue recognition:

     

Revenue recognized over time

   $ 2,670,741      $ 170,634  

Revenue recognized at a point in time

     26,742        2,867,552  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,697,483      $ 3,038,186  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

During the year ended December 31, 2020, due to operational and commercial reasons, the Company modified the cancellation terms of its contracts with customers that are applicable to wafer products. As a result, the Company no longer has an enforceable right to payment covering cost incurred plus a reasonable profit margin for work completed to date when a customer cancels its wafers purchase order at any stage of production. The change was effective to all wafer outstanding purchase orders as of the date of contract modification and future purchase orders thereafter. The contract modification had no impact to the originally agreed wafer volume, the related wafer price, and other terms and conditions of its existing contracts with customers. Likewise, the modification did not have an impact to its contracts to provide non-recurring engineering (“NRE”) services to the customers’ specifications. Therefore, the Company continuously recognizes revenue as it delivers the NRE service as a percentage of costs incurred over total expected costs.

Prior to the contract modification, the Company satisfied its performance obligations over time because of the customer’s contractual obligation to pay for work completed to date with a reasonable profit. The change in cancellation terms substantively modified the contracts with customers. As a result, the Company no longer meets the criteria to account for revenue recognition from contracts with customers over time on the outstanding purchase orders at the contract modification date and future orders thereafter. Consequently, the Company recognizes revenue on the impacted outstanding wafers orders and future orders at the point at which control of the wafers is transferred to the customer, which is determined to be at the point of wafer shipment from our facilities or delivery to the customer location, as determined by the agreed shipping terms.

 

F-87


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

4. INVESTMENTS IN JOINT VENTURES

The Company has the following investments and voting rights in joint ventures:

 

     Country of
Incorporation
   Ownership  
     December 31,
2020
    June 30,
2021
 

Silicon Manufacturing Partners Pte Ltd. (“SMP”)

   Singapore      49     49

Sensry GmbH (“Sensry”)

   Germany      25       25  

The following table presents the movement in investment in joint ventures:

 

     December 31,
2020
    June 30,
2021
 

Beginning balance

   $ 77,331     $ 36,702  

Share of profits for the period

     3,876       1,933  

Capital reduction

     (50      

Dividends declared during the period

     (2,586     (693

Disposal of investments in joint ventures

     (41,869      
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 36,702     $ 37,942  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

5. INCOME TAXES

The Company calculates its consolidated income tax benefit (expense) using the effective tax rate that would be applicable to each jurisdiction’s expected total annual earnings (loss). The tax benefit (expense) for the six months ended June 30, 2020, a total tax benefit (expense) of ($35,605), which was composed of $1,984, ($30,812) and ($6,777) for entities comprising the Europe, United States and Singapore regions, respectively.

The tax benefit (expense) for the six months ended June 30, 2021, the total tax benefit (expense) totaled ($30,481), which was composed of ($2,186), $0 and ($28,295) for entities comprising the Europe, the United States and Singapore regions, respectively.

A further tax benefit (expense) for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021 of $461 and $832, respectively, related to mark-to-market hedge gains (losses) is recorded in other comprehensive loss.

The United States tax provision for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021 was ($30,812) and $0, respectively.

The Singapore tax provision was a tax benefit (expense) of ($6,777) and ($28,295) for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively. The Singapore effective tax rate was 8.80% for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021.

 

F-88


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

6. EARNINGS PER SHARE

Basic and diluted loss per share have been calculated for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021 as follows:

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020     2021  
     (in thousands, except for share
amounts)
 

Net (loss) available to equity shareholder of the Company

   $ (532,296   $ (299,454

Weighted average common shares outstanding

     500,000,000       500,000,000  

Total basic and diluted EPS attributable to equity shareholders

   $ (1.06   $ (0.60
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

7. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

During the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, the Company acquired property, plant and equipment with costs of $222,196 and $748,471, respectively, excluding property, plant and equipment acquired through a business combination.

Property, plant and equipment with net book values of $25,355 and $3,955 were disposed by the Company during the six months ended June 30, 2020, and 2021, respectively. For the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, the Company recorded net gains on disposal of $45,338 and $11,252, respectively, in other income, net in the unaudited interim condensed consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive loss.

8. GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

During the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, the Company acquired intangible assets with costs of $68,936 and $27,598, respectively, excluding goodwill and intangible assets acquired through a business combination.

Intangible assets with net book values of $22,745 and $7 were disposed by the Company during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2021, respectively, and with no net gain or loss on disposal.

 

F-89


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

9. RECEIVABLES, PREPAYMENTS AND OTHER ASSETS

 

     December 31,
2020
     June 30,
2021
 

Noncurrent:

     

Advances and deposits paid

   $      $ 99,245  

Non-trade receivables**

     11,993        13,368  

PILOT Bonds

     20,037        20,037  

Investments in equity instruments

     12,737        16,097  

Other

     93        20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 44,860      $ 148,767  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Current:

     

Trade receivables, other than related parties

   $ 767,257      $ 895,223  

Prepaid expenses

     22,283        62,360  

Non-trade receivables**

     70,482        53,871  

Recoverable sales tax

     49,104        50,892  

Unbilled accounts receivable*

     62,226        43,891  

Advances and deposits paid

     21,722        14,867  

Trade receivables from related parties (Note 13)

     7,455        5,335  

Amounts due from related parties (Note 13)

     1,279        1,161  

Investment tax credits

     19,178         

Other

     1,877        1,708  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,022,863      $ 1,129,308  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

*

Unbilled accounts receivable represent revenue recognized on revenue contracts less associated advances and progress billings. These amounts will be billed in accordance with the agreed-upon contractual terms or upon shipment of products or rendering services.

**

Non-trade receivables include property tax credits receivable.

The following table summarized the activity in the Company’s unbilled accounts receivable during the year ended December 31, 2020 and six months ended June 30, 2021, respectively:

 

     December 31,
2020
    June 30,
2021
 
    

Beginning balance

   $ 956,663     $ 62,226  

Revenue recognized during the period

     4,548,456       18,428  

Cumulative catch-up adjustment to revenue

     (315,308      

Amounts invoiced

     (5,127,585     (42,763

Reclassification

           6,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 62,226     $ 43,891  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-90


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

10. INVENTORIES

The following table presents the activities in inventory reserve as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively:

 

     December 31,
2020
    June 30,
2021
 
    

Beginning balance

   $ 143,193     $ 242,995  

Additions

     228,559       93,881  

Previously fully reserved inventory

    

Written-off and scrapped

     (96,972     (20,130

Elimination of reserve upon sale of inventory

     (31,785     (181,905
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 242,995     $ 134,841  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-91


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

11. LONG TERM DEBT

The following table outlines the terms and amounts of the Company’s debt:

 

Particulars

 

Description

 

Currency

 

Nominal Interest Rate

 

Year

of
Maturity

  December 31,
2020

Carrying
Amount
    June 30,
2021

Carrying
Amount
 

Secured term loan

  PILOT Bonds   USD   Variable Rate Note   2021   $ 10,457     $ 10,457  

Secured term loan

  Accounts Receivable Factoring   USD   LIBOR + 0.90%   2022     86,944       87,101  

Secured term loan

  2018 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.60%   2023     74,250       74,459  

Secured term loan

  2019 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.75%   2024     83,812       84,032  

Secured term loan

  2019 USD Dresden Equipment Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.75%   2024     35,473       35,550  

Secured term loan

  2018 IKB Term Loan   EUR   EURIBOR + 2.50%   2024     12,240       11,847  

Secured term loan

  2020 USD Equipment Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.90%   2025     58,539       58,716  

Secured term loan

  2019 EUR Dresden Equipment Financing   EUR   EURIBOR + 1.75%   2026     15,366       14,848  

Secured term loan

  TPI Loan   EUR   2.60%   2026     2,687       2,621  

Secured term loan

  i. Park East Fishkill   USD   0.30%   2027     2,039       2,059  
         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Current total

            381,807       381,690  
         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent:

           

Secured term loan

  2018 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.60%   2023     93,401       56,119  

Secured term loan

  2019 USD Dresden Equipment Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.75%   2024     179,779       161,984  

Secured term loan

  2019 Tool Equipment Purchase and Lease Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.75%   2024     190,186       148,115  

Secured term loan

  2018 IKB Term Loan   EUR   EURIBOR + 2.50%   2024     36,815       29,687  

Secured term loan

  USD Term Loan A   USD   LIBOR + 2.90%   2025     646,005       646,405  

Secured term loan

  2020 USD Equipment Financing   USD   LIBOR + 1.90%   2025     211,382       181,982  

Secured term loan

  EUR Term Loan A   EUR   EURIBOR + 2.60%   2025     101,380       98,162  

Secured term loan

  2019 EUR Dresden Equipment Financing   EUR   EURIBOR + 1.75%   2026     474,522       451,627  

Secured term loan

  TPI Loan   EUR   2.60%   2026     11,053       9,400  

Secured term loan

  i. Park East Fishkill   USD   0.30%   2027     11,625       10,674  
         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncurrent total

            1,956,148       1,794,155  
         

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

          $ 2,337,955     $ 2,175,845  
         

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-92


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

The following table summarizes available unutilized credit facilities available to the Company to maintain liquidity necessary to fund operations:

 

            December 31,
2020
     June 30,
2021
 

Citibank Revolving Credit Facility

     Committed      $ 403,271      $ 406,955  

Societe Generale Singapore Revolving Credit Facility

     Uncommitted        23,958        23,503  

JPMorgan Chase PILOT Letter of Credit

     Committed        12,211        12,211  

Societe Generale Singapore Factoring

     Committed        34,756        4,599  

Deutsche Bank

     Uncommitted        3,122        3,305  

Citibank—USD

     Uncommitted        780        799  

Mubadala Treasury Holding Company LLC Revolving Credit Facility

     Committed        400,000        400,000  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 
      $ 878,098      $ 851,372  
     

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accounts Receivable Factoring—On February 17, 2021, the Company entered into agreements to amend and restate the terms of the original Accounts Receivable Factoring arrangements to factor certain of its accounts receivable up to a maximum outstanding amount of $91,700. The Company agreed to pay financing costs of LIBOR plus 0.90%.

12. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES

 

     December 31,
2020
     June 30,
2021
 

Noncurrent:

     

Advances and deposits

   $ 224,912      $ 190,989  

Payables for purchases of intangible assets

     109,451        77,668  

Other

     24,424        9,032  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 358,787      $ 277,689  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Current:

     

Payable to non-related parties

   $ 414,547      $ 529,142  

Amounts payable for property, plant and equipment

     185,945        269,638  

Accrued employee related expenses, bonuses and long-term incentive plan

     255,395        204,941  

Accrued expenses

     215,405        229,112  

Advances and deposits

     78,411        95,501  

Amounts payable for intangible assets

     49,844        44,162  

Payable to related parties (Note 13)

     10,793        9,081  

Interest payable

     3,272        2,491  

Other

     2,868        36,863  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,216,480      $ 1,420,931  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-93


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

13. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES

Balances with related parties disclosed in the unaudited interim condensed consolidated statements of financial positions are as follows:

 

     December 31, 2020      June 30, 2021  
     Due from
Related

Parties
     Due to
Related

Parties
     Due from
Related

Parties
     Due to
Related

Parties
 

SMP

   $ 8,734      $ 10,480      $ 6,496      $ 8,818  

Mubadala Technology

            313               263  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total*

   $ 8,734      $ 10,793      $ 6,496      $ 9,081  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

*

The total amounts of $8,734 and $6,496 due from related parties as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively, have been included in receivables, prepayments and other assets (see Note 9). The $10,793 and $9,081 of the due to related parties balances as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively, have been included in trade and other payables (see Note 12).

The following table presents the related party transactions included in the unaudited interim condensed consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss:

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30
 
     2020      2021  

Purchases from:

     

SMP*

   $ 31,029      $ 29,435  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other transactions with:

     

SMP (reimbursement of expenses and contribution of tools)

   $ 22,692      $ 21,948  

Mubadala Technology (reimbursement of expenses)

     19        161  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 22,711      $ 22,109  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

*

Purchases from SMP primarily comprised wafer purchases.

Transactions with Shareholder:

Shareholder Loan Agreement—The Company, as a borrower, entered into loan facilities with its shareholder in 2012 to 2016 (collectively the “Shareholder Loans”). The Shareholder Loans are non-interest bearing and principal repayment, in whole or in part, is entirely at the Company’s discretion as explicitly stated in the loan agreement. The Shareholder Loans are subordinated to any claims of other unsubordinated and subordinated creditors, including beneficiaries under guarantees issued, of the Company. The loans have no maturity date and remain outstanding until the loans are paid in full. Further, there are no contingent settlements in the agreements. Since the Shareholder Loans do not contain any contractual obligations to deliver cash, but rather allow the Company to make repayment at its absolute discretion and further prohibit the shareholder from demanding repayment, the Company treated the Shareholder Loans as equity.

The Company repaid $487,000 and $126,000 during the year ended December 31, 2020 and the six months ended June 30, 2021, respectively.

 

F-94


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

On July 7, 2021 and August 4, 2021, the Company has repaid an additional $225,000 and $217,000 respectively.

14. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

Commitments—The Company’s unconditional purchase commitments are as follows:

 

     December 31,
2020
     June 30,
2021
 

Contracts for capital expenditures

   $ 952,604      $ 1,655,175  

Contracts for operating expenditures

     1,044,560        3,048,408  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 1,997,164      $ 4,703,583  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Due within the next 12 months

   $ 1,316,090      $ 2,031,727  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

In addition to the above, the Company obtained letters of credit to primarily guarantee the PILOT bonds’ interest payments, payments for utility supplies and foreign statutory payroll related charges. The Company has available letters of credit facilities of $36,211 and $36,211 as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively, and has drawn down bank guarantees of $3,098 and $2,895 as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, respectively.

Leases of low value items and short-term leases that do not meet the capitalization criteria under the Company’s lease policy are treated as operating expenses. The following summarizes the Company’s non-cancellable operating lease arrangements which were not capitalized and the minimum future rental payments under these arrangements:

 

     December 31,
2020
     June 30,
2021
 

Within one year

   $ 1,409      $ 1,209  

After one year but not more than five years

     1,557        1,074  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 2,966      $ 2,283  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contingencies—From time to time, the Company is a party to claims that arise in the normal course of business. These claims include allegations of infringement of intellectual property rights of others as well as other claims of liability. In addition, the Company, on a case by case basis, includes intellectual property indemnification provisions in the terms of sale and technology licenses with third parties. The Company is also subject to various taxes in the different jurisdictions in which it operates. These include property, goods and services, and other non-income taxes. The Company accrues costs associated with these matters when they become probable and reasonably estimable. The Company does not believe it is probable that losses associated with these matters beyond those already recognized will be incurred in amounts that would be material to the unaudited interim condensed consolidated statements of financial position or unaudited interim condensed consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive loss.

On April 26, 2021, the Company received a claim from the Chengdu, China local government (“CD”) requesting that the Company share in CD’s alleged losses and related costs incurred to support the joint venture. The Company and CD are engaged in negotiations to settle the claim and the Company recorded an estimated provision of $34,000 in June 2021.

 

F-95


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

On April 28, 2021, International Business Machines (“IBM”) sent the Company a letter alleging for the first time that the Company did not fulfill the Company’s obligations under the contracts the Company entered into with IBM in 2014 associated with the Company’s acquisition of IBM’s Microelectronics business. IBM asserted that the Company engaged in fraudulent misrepresentations during the underlying negotiations, and claimed the Company owed them $2,500,000 in damages and restitution. On June 7, 2021, the Company filed a complaint with the New York State Supreme Court seeking a declaratory judgment that the Company did not breach the relevant contracts. IBM subsequently filed its complaint with the New York State Supreme Court on June 8, 2021. The Company believes, based on discussions with legal counsel, that it has meritorious defenses against IBM’s claims. The Company does not currently anticipate this proceeding to have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition, business and prospects.

15. FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

The following table presents the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis:

 

     Fair Value Measurement at Reporting Date Using  
     Total      Quoted
Prices
Identical
Assets/
Liabilities
(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

December 31, 2020

           

Assets:

           

Cash equivalents:

           

Money market funds(1)

   $ 560,198      $ 560,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash equivalents

   $ 560,198      $ 560,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investments in equity instruments(2)

   $ 12,737      $      $      $ 12,737  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments in equity instruments

   $ 12,737      $      $      $ 12,737  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 42,199      $      $ 42,199      $  

Cross currency swaps

     33,169               33,169         

Commodity hedge

     9,220               9,220         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(3)

   $ 84,588      $      $ 84,588      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

           

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 1,318      $      $ 1,318      $  

Interest rate swaps

     33,287               33,287         

Cross currency swaps

     58               58         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(4)

   $ 34,663      $      $ 34,663      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-96


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

     Fair Value Measurement at Reporting Date Using  
     Total      Quoted
Prices
Identical
Assets/
Liabilities
(Level 1)
     Significant
Other
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

June 30, 2021

           

Assets:

           

Cash equivalents:

           

Money market funds(1)

   $ 70,198      $ 70,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total cash equivalents

   $ 70,198      $ 70,198      $      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investments in equity instruments(2)

   $ 16,097      $ 1,031      $      $ 15,066  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total investments in equity instruments

   $ 16,097      $ 1,031      $      $ 15,066  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 3,937      $      $ 3,937      $  

Cross currency swaps

     17,334               17,334         

Commodity hedge

     21,050               21,050         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(3)

   $ 42,321      $      $ 42,321      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

           

Derivatives:

           

Foreign currency forward contracts

   $ 18,177      $      $ 18,177      $  

Interest rate swaps

     20,885               20,885         

Commodity hedge

     68               68         
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total derivatives(4)

   $ 39,130      $      $ 39,130      $  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Included in cash and cash equivalents on the Company’s unaudited interim condensed consolidated statement of financial position.

(2)

Included in current and noncurrent receivables, prepayments and other assets on the Company’s unaudited interim condensed consolidated statement of financial position.

(3)

Included in other current and noncurrent financial assets on the Company’s unaudited interim condensed consolidated statement of financial position.

(4)

Included in other current and noncurrent financial liabilities on the Company’s unaudited interim condensed consolidated statement of financial position.

During the year ended December 31, 2020 and the six months ended June 30, 2021, there were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements.

Assets Measured and Recorded at Fair Value on a Non-Recurring Basis

Certain assets and liabilities, such as equity method investments, intangible assets and property, plant and equipment, and other non-financial assets, are recorded at fair value only if an impairment or observable price adjustment is recognized in the current period.

 

F-97


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

Financial Instruments Not Recorded at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis

Financial instruments not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis include grants receivable, loans receivable, lease obligations and the Company’s short-term and long-term debt.

The carrying and fair values of the Company’s financial instruments not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis are presented in the following table, classified according to the categories of financial liabilities at amortized cost (“FLAC”):

 

     Category      December 31, 2020      June 30, 2021  

Financial Liabilities

   Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value      Carrying
Amount
     Fair Value  

Long-term debt

     FLAC      $ 2,337,955      $ 2,336,114      $ 2,175,845      $ 2,173,801  
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Estimated fair values of long-term debt are based on quoted prices for similar liabilities for which significant inputs are observable and represents a Level 2 valuation. The fair values are estimated based on the type of loan and their maturities. The Company estimates the fair value using market interest rates of debts with similar maturities.

16. SHARE-BASED PAYMENTS

In 2017, the Company approved the Share Incentive Plan, which was intended to attract and retain talented employees and align shareholder and employee interests. Share options under the Share Incentive Plan will be deemed vested shares over a five-year period.

In 2019, the Company offered to exchange the share options under the Share Incentive Plan with new share options under the “2018 Share Incentive Plan,” under which the Company granted up to 25 million options to purchase shares in the Company with an exercise price of $10.00 per share. The options vest over four or five years, depending on the timing of the grant. Options are settled in ordinary shares upon exercise. The options are not exercisable and do not vest until twelve months after the occurrence of a liquidity event. On April 19, 2019, the Company issued the share options subject to the tender offer.

The share options are effective for a term of ten years from the grant date. Because the vesting and exercisability of these share options are dependent on a qualified liquidity event, the Company had to assess the probability of such an event in order to determine the expenses related to the share-based payments for the period. On June 30, 2021, the Company deemed an IPO to be probable under IFRS, and recognized equity-settled share-based compensation expense of $140,789 based on the graded vesting of the awards outstanding as of the IPO probable date. The Company incurred $2,986 of payroll taxes associated with the share-based compensation expense.

The share options were valued using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. Upon the tender offer, the Company accounts for the modifications only if they are beneficial to the share option holders. The incremental fair value at the date of modification was estimated using the Black-Scholes option pricing model and will be recognized in addition to the grant-date fair value. The equity volatility was determined based on the historical volatilities of comparable publicly traded companies over a period equal to the expected average share-based payments life. The risk-free rate of interest was interpolated from the U.S. Constant Maturity Treasury rate curve to reflect the remaining expected life of share options.

 

F-98


Table of Contents

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

NOTES TO UNAUDITED INTERIM CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020 AND 2021

(dollars in thousands)

 

The assumptions used to value the Company’s options granted during the period presented and their expected lives were as follows:

 

    

December 31, 2020

  

June 30, 2021

Expected dividend yield

   0.0%    0.0%

Expected volatility

   43.5%    45.0%

Expected term

   5.5 years    4.5 years

Risk-free interest rate

   0.32%—1.46%    0.56%

Estimated common stock valuation

   $20.48—$24.62    $24.64—$26.04

As of June 30, 2021 there were 22,217,638 share options outstanding with exercise prices ranging from $10.00 to $26.00.

17. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

On September 3, 2021, the Company entered into a loan agreement with a lender, which provided for loan facilities with maximum drawdown of SGD1,541,000 thousand (US$1,148,500) at fixed interest rates. The loan matures on June 1, 2041, with interest-only payments for the first five years and principal repayments commence thereafter, payable on a semi-annual basis. No amounts have been drawn down on the facility.

On September 12, 2021, the Company amended the authorized share capital from $30,000 divided into 3,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of $0.01 each; to $30,000 divided into 1,500,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of $0.02 each, and effected a 1-for-2 reverse share split to reclassify all 1,000,000,000 of our ordinary shares outstanding as of December 31, 2020 and June 30, 2021, to 500,000,000 ordinary shares, which was approved by the Company’s board of directors and sole shareholder on September 9, 2021. As a result, the accompanying unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements and related notes to the unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements give retroactive effect to the reverse share split for all periods presented.

These unaudited interim condensed consolidated financial statements were issued on behalf of the Company on September 13, 2021 by:

Thomas Caulfield, Chief Executive Officer

David Reeder, Senior Vice President—Finance and Chief Financial Officer

******

 

F-99


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

Through and including            , 2021 (the 25th day after the date of this prospectus), all dealers effecting transactions in the ordinary shares, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This delivery requirement is in addition to a dealer’s obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as an underwriter and with respect to an unsold allotment or subscription.

 

LOGO

55,000,000 Ordinary Shares

 

Prospectus

 

            , 2021

 

MORGAN STANLEY   BofA SECURITIES   J.P. MORGAN
CITIGROUP     CREDIT SUISSE
DEUTSCHE BANK SECURITIES  

HSBC

 

JEFFERIES

BAIRD   COWEN   NEEDHAM & COMPANY   RAYMOND JAMES   WEDBUSH SECURITIES
DREXEL HAMILTON   SIEBERT WILLIAMS SHANK   IMI - INTESA SANPAOLO

 

 

 


Table of Contents

PART II

INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 6. Indemnification of Directors, Officers and Employees.

Cayman Islands law does not limit the extent to which a company’s articles of association may provide for indemnification of officers and directors, except to the extent any such provision may be held by the Cayman Islands courts to be contrary to public policy, such as to provide indemnification against civil fraud or the consequences or committing a crime. Under our post-offering memorandum and articles of association, which will become effective immediately prior to the completion of this offering, to the fullest extent permissible under Cayman Islands law every director and officer of our company shall be indemnified against all actions, proceedings, costs, charges, losses, damages and expenses incurred or sustained by him by reason of any act done or omitted in or about the execution of their duty in their respective offices or trusts.

Pursuant to the form of indemnification agreements filed as Exhibit 10.2 to this registration statement, we will agree to indemnify our directors and executive officers against certain liabilities and expenses that they incur in connection with claims made by reason of their being a director or officer of our company.

The Underwriting Agreement, the form of which to be filed as Exhibit 1.1 to this registration statement, will also provide for indemnification of us and our officers and directors.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling us pursuant to the foregoing provisions, we have been informed that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is therefore unenforceable.

Item 7. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.

We have, since January 1, 2018, granted to certain directors, officers, employees, consultants and advisors options to purchase and RSUs covering an aggregate of 32,510,776 of our ordinary shares, for options at a weighted average exercise price of $11.73 per share.

None of these transactions involved any underwriters’ underwriting discounts or commissions, or any public offering. We believe that each of the foregoing transactions was exempt from registration under the Securities Act in reliance on Regulation S or Rule 701 under the Securities Act or pursuant to Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act regarding transactions not involving a public offering.

Item 8. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.

(a) Exhibits

The exhibits of the registration statement are listed in the Exhibit Index to this registration statement and are incorporated herein by reference.

(b) Financial Statement Schedules

Schedules have been omitted because the information required to be set forth therein is not applicable or is shown in the financial statements or consolidated financial statements or the notes thereto.

Item 9. Undertakings.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the

 

II-1


Table of Contents

registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes:

(1) That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

(2) To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:

(a) To include any prospectus required by section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act;

(b) To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed with the SEC pursuant to Rule 424(b) (§230.424(b) of this chapter) if, in the aggregate, the changes in volume and price represent no more than 20% change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the “Calculation of Registration Fee” table in the effective registration statement; and

(c) To include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any material change to such information in the registration statement.

(3) To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering.

(4) To file a post-effective amendment to the registration statement to include any financial statements required by “8.A. of Form 20-F (17 CFR 249.220f)” at the start of any delayed offering or throughout a continuous offering. Financial statements and information otherwise required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act need not be furnished, provided that the registrant includes in the prospectus, by means of a post-effective amendment, financial statements required pursuant to this paragraph (a)(4) and other information necessary to ensure that all other information in the prospectus is at least as current as the date of those financial statements.

(5) That for purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the Registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4), or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.

(6) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

 

II-2


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

(a) Exhibits. The following exhibits are included herein or incorporated herein by reference:

The following documents are filed as part of this registration statement:

 

Exhibit
No.

  

Description of Exhibit

   1.1*    Form of Underwriting Agreement
   3.1**   

Form of Second Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Registrant (effective immediately prior to the completion of this offering)

   4.1**    Form of Shareholder’s Agreement among the Registrant and other parties thereto
   4.2**    Form of Registration Rights Agreement among the Registrant and other parties thereto
   5.1    Opinion of Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP regarding the validity of the ordinary shares being registered
 10.1**    2021 Share Incentive Plan
 10.2**    Form of Director and Officer Indemnification Agreement
 10.3†**    Materials Supply Agreement, dated April 25, 2017, between the Company and Soitec S.A.
 10.4†**    Addendum to Materials Supply Agreement, dated November 2, 2020, between the Company and Soitec S.A.
 10.5†**    Amended and Restated Exhibit 3 to the Long Term Addendum, dated July 1, 2021, between the Company and Soitec S.A.
 10.6**    Term Loan Facility Agreement, dated September 3, 2021, between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd., the Company and Economic Development Board
 10.7**    2017 Share Incentive Plan
 10.8**    2018 Share Incentive Plan
 10.9**    2021 Amendment of the GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. 2018 Share Incentive Plan Share Option Agreement
 10.10**    2021 Amendment of the GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. 2018 Share Incentive Plan
 10.11**    2021 Employee Stock Purchase Plan
 10.12    2019 Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement, dated October 18, 2019, between the Company and Citibank, N.A., London Branch and DBS Bank Ltd.
 10.13    2020 Amendment Agreement to Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement, dated November 11, 2020, between the Company and Bank of America, N.A., Citibank, N.A., DBS Bank Ltd. and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Intesa Sanpaolo S.p.A., London Branch, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., Deutsche Bank AG, ING Bank, Commerzbank AG and Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch
 10.14    2021 Amendment to Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement, dated October 13, 2021, between Bank of America, N.A., DBS Bank Ltd., Intesa Sanpaolo S.p.A., London Branch, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., Citibank, N.A., Deutsche Bank AG, Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, HSBC Bank USA, National Association and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC
 10.15    Share Purchase Agreement by and between the Company and Silver Lake, dated as of October 18, 2021
 16.1**    Letter from Ernst & Young LLP Regarding Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant
 21.1**    List of subsidiaries of the Registrant
 23.1    Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

II-3


Table of Contents

Exhibit
No.

  

Description of Exhibit

 23.2    Consent of Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1)
 24.1**    Powers of Attorney (included on signature page)

 

*

To be filed by amendment.

**

Previously filed.

Pursuant to Item 601(b)(10) of Regulation S-K, certain confidential portions of this exhibit have been omitted by means of marking such portions with asterisks [***] as the identified confidential information is both (i) not material and (ii) is the type that the registrant treats as private or confidential.

 

II-4


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the registrant certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form F-1 and has duly caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the city of Malta, New York, on October 19, 2021.

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

By:

 

 

/s/ Thomas Caulfield

 

Name: Dr. Thomas Caulfield

 

Title: Chief Executive Officer and Director

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities set forth below on October 19, 2021.

 

/s/ Thomas Caulfield

Name: Dr. Thomas Caulfield

  

Chief Executive Officer and Director

(principal executive officer)

*

Name: David Reeder

  

Chief Financial Officer

(principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Name: Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi

  

Director

*

Name: Ahmed Saeed Al Calily

  

Director

*

Name: Tim Breen

  

Director

*

Name: Glenda Dorchak

  

Director

 

II-5


Table of Contents

*

Name: Martin L. Edelman

  

Director

*

Name: David Kerko

  

Director

*

Name: Jack Lazar

  

Director

*

Name: Elissa E. Murphy

  

Director

*

Name: Carlos Obeid

  

Director

*By:

 

/s/ Thomas Caulfield

Name: Dr. Thomas Caulfield

Title: Attorney-in-Fact

 

II-6


Table of Contents

SIGNATURE OF AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE IN THE UNITED STATES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant’s duly authorized representative has signed this registration statement on Form F-1 in the city of Malta, New York, on October 19, 2021.

 

By:

 

/s/ Thomas Caulfield

 

Name: Dr. Thomas Caulfield

  Title: Authorized Representative in the United States

 

II-7

EX-5.1

Exhibit 5.1

 

LOGO

Our ref         JWT/646943-000001/68096881v2

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

PO Box 309, Ugland House

Grand Cayman, KY1-1104

Cayman Islands

19 October 2021

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

We have acted as counsel as to Cayman Islands law to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (the “Company”) in connection with the Company’s registration statement on Form F-1, including all amendments or supplements thereto, filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) under the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Act”) (including its exhibits, the “Registration Statement”), in connection with the initial public offering of an aggregate of 33,000,000 ordinary shares of US$0.02 par value each (the “Ordinary Shares”) in the capital of the Company, and the sale by the Selling Shareholders (as defined below) of 22,000,000 Ordinary Shares (and up to an additional 8,250,000 Ordinary Shares to cover the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares, if exercised). Such offering is being underwritten pursuant to an underwriting agreement (the “Underwriting Agreement”) among the Company, the selling shareholders named in Schedule I to the Underwriting Agreement, Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC, BofA Securities, Inc. and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as representatives of the several underwriters named in Schedule II thereto (collectively, the “Underwriters”). The Ordinary Shares to be issued by the Company are referred to as the “Offered Shares” and the Ordinary Shares to be sold by the Selling Shareholders are referred to as the “Sale Shares”, and together with the Offered Shares, the “Shares”.

This opinion letter is given in accordance with the terms of the Legal Matters section of the Registration Statement.

 

1

Documents Reviewed

We have reviewed originals, copies, drafts or conformed copies of the following documents:

 

1.1

The certificate of incorporation dated 7 October 2008, the certificate of incorporation on change of name dated 4 March 2009 and the amended and restated memorandum and articles of association of the Company as adopted on 17 March 2015 and amended by special resolution dated 12 September 2021 (the “Memorandum and Articles”).

 

LOGO


1.2

The minutes (the “Minutes”) of the meeting (the “Meeting”) of the board of directors of the Company held on 1 October 2021 and the corporate records of the Company maintained at its registered office in the Cayman Islands.

 

1.3

A certificate of good standing with respect to the Company issued by the Registrar of Companies (the “Certificate of Good Standing”).

 

1.4

A certificate from a director of the Company, a copy of which is attached to this opinion letter (the “Director’s Certificate”).

 

1.5

The Registration Statement.

 

1.6

A draft of the Underwriting Agreement.

 

2

Assumptions

The following opinions are given only as to, and based on, circumstances and matters of fact existing and known to us on the date of this opinion letter. These opinions only relate to the laws of the Cayman Islands which are in force on the date of this opinion letter. In giving the following opinions, we have relied (without further verification) upon the completeness and accuracy of the Director’s Certificate and the Certificate of Good Standing. We have also relied upon the following assumptions, which we have not independently verified:

 

2.1

The Underwriting Agreement has been or will be authorised and duly executed and unconditionally delivered by or on behalf of all relevant parties in accordance with all relevant laws (other than, with respect to the Company, the laws of the Cayman Islands).

 

2.2

The Underwriting Agreement is, or will be, legal, valid, binding and enforceable against all relevant parties in accordance with its terms under the laws of the State of New York (the “Relevant Law”) and all other relevant laws (other than, with respect to the Company, the laws of the Cayman Islands).

 

2.3

The choice of the Relevant Law as the governing law of the Underwriting Agreement has been made in good faith and would be regarded as a valid and binding selection which will be upheld by the courts of the State of New York and any other relevant jurisdiction (other than the Cayman Islands) as a matter of the Relevant Law and all other relevant laws (other than the laws of the Cayman Islands).

 

2.4

Copies of documents, conformed copies or drafts of documents provided to us are true and complete copies of, or in the final forms of, the originals, and translations of documents provided to us are complete and accurate.

 

2.5

All signatures, initials and seals are genuine.

 

2.6

No invitation has been or will be made by or on behalf of the Company to the public in the Cayman Islands to subscribe for any of the Shares.

 

2.7

There is no contractual or other prohibition (other than as arising under Cayman Islands law) binding on the Company prohibiting it from entering into and performing its obligations under the Underwriting Agreement or the Registration Statement.

 

2


2.8

No monies paid to or for the account of any party under the Underwriting Agreement or any property received or disposed of by any party to the Underwriting Agreement in each case in connection with the Underwriting Agreement or the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby represent or will represent proceeds of criminal conduct or criminal property or terrorist property (as defined in the Proceeds of Crime Act (As Revised) and the Terrorism Act (As Revised), respectively).

 

2.9

There is nothing contained in the minute book or corporate records of the Company (which we have not inspected) which would or might affect the opinions set out below.

Save as aforesaid we have not been instructed to undertake and have not undertaken any further enquiry or due diligence in relation to the transaction the subject of this opinion letter.

 

3

Opinions

Based upon, and subject to, the foregoing assumptions and the qualifications set out below, and having regard to such legal considerations as we deem relevant, we are of the opinion that:

 

3.1

The Company has been duly incorporated as an exempted company with limited liability and is validly existing and in good standing with the Registrar of Companies under the laws of the Cayman Islands.

 

3.2

Based solely on our inspection of the register of members of the Company as at 18 October 2021, the Selling Shareholders have valid title to the Sale Shares and the Sale Shares have been duly authorised, legally issued and are fully paid and non-assessable and there are no entries or notations indicating any third party interests, including any security interest as at the date hereof.

 

3.3

The Offered Shares to be offered and issued by the Company as contemplated by the Registration Statement and the Underwriting Agreement have been duly authorised for issue, and when issued and paid for in the manner described in the Underwriting Agreement and the Registration Statement and in accordance with the resolutions adopted by the board of directors of the Company, such Offered Shares will be legally issued, fully paid and non-assessable. As a matter of Cayman Islands law, a share is only issued when it has been entered in the register of members (shareholders).

 

3.4

The authorised share capital of the Company is US$30,000,000 divided into (i) 1,300,000,000 Ordinary Shares of a nominal or par value of US$0.02 each, and (ii) 200,000,000 Preferred Shares of a nominal or par value of US$0.02 each.

 

4

Qualifications

The opinions expressed above are subject to the following qualifications:

 

4.1

To maintain the Company in good standing with the Registrar of Companies under the laws of the Cayman Islands, annual filing fees must be paid and returns made to the Registrar of Companies within the time frame prescribed by law.

 

4.2

Under Cayman Islands law, the register of members (shareholders) is prima facie evidence of title to shares and this register would not record a third party interest in such shares. However, there are certain limited circumstances where an application may be made to a Cayman Islands court for a determination on whether the register of members reflects the correct legal position. Further, the Cayman Islands court has the power to order that the register of members maintained by a

 

3


  company should be rectified where it considers that the register of members does not reflect the correct legal position. As far as we are aware, such applications are rarely made in the Cayman Islands and there are no circumstances or matters of fact known to us on the date of this opinion letter which would properly form the basis for an application for an order for rectification of the register of members of the Company, but if such an application were made in respect of the Company’s Shares, then the validity of such shares may be subject to re-examination by a Cayman Islands court.

 

4.3

Except as specifically stated herein, we make no comment with respect to any representations and warranties which may be made by or with respect to the Company in any of the documents or instruments cited in this opinion letter or otherwise with respect to the commercial terms of the transactions the subject of this opinion letter.

 

4.4

In this opinion letter, the phrase “non-assessable” means, with respect to shares in the Company, that a shareholder shall not, solely by virtue of its status as a shareholder, be liable for additional assessments or calls on the shares by the Company or its creditors (except in exceptional circumstances, such as involving fraud, the establishment of an agency relationship or an illegal or improper purpose or other circumstances in which a court may be prepared to pierce or lift the corporate veil).

We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion letter as an exhibit to the Registration Statement and to the references to our firm under the headings “Legal Matters” and “Differences in Corporate Law” in the prospectus included in the Registration Statement. In providing our consent, we do not thereby admit that we are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Act or the Rules and Regulations of the Commission thereunder.

This opinion letter is addressed to you and may be relied upon by you, your counsel and purchasers of the Shares pursuant to the Registration Statement. This opinion letter is limited to the matters detailed herein and is not to be read as an opinion with respect to any other matter.

Yours faithfully

/s/ Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP

Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP

 

4


GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

PO Box 309, Ugland House

Grand Cayman

KY1-1104

Cayman Islands

19 October 2021

 

To:

Maples and Calder (Cayman) LLP

PO Box 309, Ugland House

Grand Cayman

KY1-1104

Cayman Islands

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (the “Company”)

I, the undersigned, being a director of the Company, am aware that you are being asked to provide an opinion letter (the “Opinion”) in relation to certain aspects of Cayman Islands law. Unless otherwise defined herein, capitalised terms used in this certificate have the respective meanings given to them in the Opinion. I hereby certify that:

 

1

The Memorandum and Articles remain in full force and effect and are unamended.

 

2

The Minutes are a true and correct record of the proceedings of the Meeting, which was duly convened and held, and at which a quorum was present throughout, in the manner prescribed in the Memorandum and Articles. The resolutions set out in the Minutes were duly passed in the manner prescribed in the Memorandum and Articles (including, without limitation, with respect to the disclosure of interests (if any) by directors of the Company) and have not been amended, varied or revoked in any respect.

 

3

The shareholders of the Company (the “Shareholders”) have not restricted the powers of the directors of the Company in any way.

 

4

The directors of the Company as at the date of the Minutes and at the date of this certificate were and are as follows: Ahmed Yahia Al Idrissi, Thomas Caulfield, Ahmed Saeed Al Calily, Tim Breen, Glenda Dorchak, Martin L. Edelman, David Kerko, Jack Lazar, Elissa E. Murphy and Carlos Obeid.

 

5

The authorised share capital of the Company is US$30,000,000 divided into (i) 1,300,000,000 Ordinary Shares of a nominal or par value of US$0.02 each, and (ii) 200,000,000 Preferred Shares of a nominal or par value of US$0.02 each.

 

6

The Company will receive money or money’s worth in consideration for the issue of the Offered Shares, and none of the Offered Shares were or will be issued for less than their par value.

 

7

The Company has not entered into any mortgages or charges over its property or assets other than those entered in the register of mortgages and charges of the Company.

 

5


8

The Underwriting Agreement will be duly executed and unconditionally delivered by an Authorized Officer (as defined in the Minutes) for and on behalf of the Company.

 

9

Prior to, at the time of, and immediately following the execution of the Underwriting Agreement, the Company was, or will be, able to pay its debts as they fell, or fall, due and has entered, or will enter, into the Underwriting Agreement for proper value and not with an intention to defraud or wilfully defeat an obligation owed to any creditor or with a view to giving a creditor a preference.

 

10

Each director of the Company considers the transactions contemplated by the Underwriting Agreement to be of commercial benefit to the Company and has acted in good faith in the best interests of the Company, and for a proper purpose of the Company, in relation to the transactions which are the subject of the Opinion.

 

11

To the best of my knowledge and belief, having made due inquiry, the Company is not the subject of legal, arbitral, administrative or other proceedings in any jurisdiction that would have a material adverse effect on the business, properties, financial condition, results of operations or prospects of the Company. Nor have the directors or Shareholders taken any steps to have the Company struck off or placed in liquidation, nor have any steps been taken to wind up the Company. Nor has any receiver been appointed over any of the Company’s property or assets.

 

12

The Company is not a central bank, monetary authority or other sovereign entity of any state and is not a subsidiary, direct or indirect, of any sovereign entity or state.

 

6


I confirm that you may continue to rely on this certificate as being true and correct on the day that you issue the Opinion unless I shall have previously notified you in writing personally to the contrary.

 

Signature:  

/s/ Tim Breen

Name:   Tim Breen
Title:   Director

 

7

EX-10.12

Exhibit 10.12

LOGO

EXECUTION VERSION

Dated 18 October 2019

among

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as the Company

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

- and -

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

as the Original Borrowers

THE ENTITIES NAMED AS GUARANTORS

CITIBANK, N.A., LONDON BRANCH

- and -

DBS BANK LTD.

as Arrangers and Bookrunners

- and -

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH

as Facility Agent

 

 

REVOLVING AND L/C FACILITIES AGREEMENT

 

 

 

WE OPERATE IN THE UK AND ITALY AS SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP, A LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIP ORGANISED IN THE UNITED STATES UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, WHICH LAWS LIMIT THE PERSONAL LIABILITY OF PARTNERS. SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS AUTHORISED AND REGULATED BY THE SOLICITORS REGULATION AUTHORITY (FIRM SRA NUMBER 211340). A LIST OF ALL PARTNERS’ NAMES, WHICH INCLUDES SOLICITORS AND REGISTERED FOREIGN LAWYERS, IS OPEN FOR INSPECTION AT THE ABOVE ADDRESS. EACH PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS ALSO A PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING LLP WHICH HAS OFFICES IN THE OTHER CITIES NOTED ABOVE.


CONTENTS

   Page  
1.   

DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

     1  
2.   

THE FACILITIES

     47  
3.   

PURPOSE

     50  
4.   

CONDITIONS OF UTILISATION

     51  
5.   

UTILISATION – LOANS

     53  
6.   

UTILISATION – LETTERS OF CREDIT

     54  
7.   

LETTERS OF CREDIT

     58  
8.   

OPTIONAL CURRENCIES

     63  
9.   

ANCILLARY FACILITIES

     64  
10.   

REPAYMENT

     69  
11.   

ILLEGALITY, VOLUNTARY PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION

     70  
12.   

MANDATORY PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION

     72  
13.   

RESTRICTIONS

     73  
14.   

INTEREST

     74  
15.   

INTEREST PERIODS

     75  
16.   

CHANGES TO THE CALCULATION OF INTEREST

     75  
17.   

FEES

     77  
18.   

TAX

     79  
19.   

INCREASED COSTS

     85  
20.   

OTHER INDEMNITIES

     87  
21.   

MITIGATION BY THE LENDERS

     88  
22.   

GUARANTEE AND INDEMNITY

     88  
23.   

COSTS AND EXPENSES

     96  
24.   

REPRESENTATIONS

     96  
25.   

INFORMATION COVENANTS

     97  
26.   

COVENANTS

     97  
27.   

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     98  
28.   

REMEDIES FOLLOWING DEFAULT

     98  
29.   

CHANGES TO THE LENDERS

     99  
30.   

DEBT PURCHASE TRANSACTIONS

     104  
31.   

CHANGES TO THE OBLIGORS

     105  
32.   

ROLE OF THE FACILITY AGENT, THE ARRANGERS, THE BOOKRUNNERS, THE ISSUING BANK AND OTHERS

     107  
33.   

CONDUCT OF BUSINESS BY THE FINANCE PARTIES

     117  
34.   

SHARING AMONG THE FINANCE PARTIES

     118  
35.   

PAYMENT MECHANICS

     119  
36.   

DATA PROTECTION

     124  
37.   

SET-OFF

     125  
38.   

NOTICES

     125  
39.   

CALCULATIONS AND CERTIFICATES

     129  
40.   

PARTIAL INVALIDITY

     129  
41.   

REMEDIES AND WAIVERS

     129  
42.   

AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS

     129  
43.   

CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION

     137  
44.   

CONFIDENTIALITY OF FUNDING RATES

     139  
45.   

DISCLOSURE OF LENDER DETAILS BY FACILITY AGENT

     141  
46.   

COUNTERPARTS

     141  
47.   

USA PATRIOT ACT

     141  
48.   

GOVERNING LAW

     141  
49.   

CONTRACTUAL RECOGNITION OF BAIL-IN

     142  
50.   

ENFORCEMENT

     142  

 

i


  

SCHEDULE 1 THE ORIGINAL PARTIES

     144  
  

Part A Original Guarantors

     144  
  

Part B Original Borrowers

     145  
  

Part C Original Lenders

     146  
  

SCHEDULE 2 CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

     147  
  

Part A Conditions Precedent to Financial Close

     147  
  

Part B Conditions Precedent required to be delivered by an Additional Guarantor

     150  
  

SCHEDULE 3 REQUESTS AND NOTICES

     152  
  

Part A Utilisation Request Loans

     152  
  

Part B Utilisation Request Letters of Credit

     153  
  

SCHEDULE 4 SPECIFIED TIMES

     156  
  

SCHEDULE 5 FORM OF TRANSFER CERTIFICATE

     158  
  

SCHEDULE 6 FORM OF ASSIGNMENT AGREEMENT

     161  
  

SCHEDULE 7 FORM OF ACCESSION DEED

     164  
  

SCHEDULE 8 FORM OF RESIGNATION LETTER

     166  
  

SCHEDULE 9 FORM OF COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE

     167  
  

SCHEDULE 10 FORM OF LETTER OF CREDIT

     168  
  

SCHEDULE 11 GUARANTEE LIMITATIONS IN GENERAL

     171  
  

SCHEDULE 12 REPRESENTATIONS

     172  
  

SCHEDULE 13 INFORMATION COVENANTS

     176  
  

SCHEDULE 14 AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

     179  
  

SCHEDULE 15 NEGATIVE COVENANTS

     181  
  

SCHEDULE 16 EVENTS OF DEFAULT

     184  
  

SCHEDULE 17 FORM OF CONFIDENTIALITY AGREEMENT

     187  
  

SCHEDULE 18 FORM OF INCREASE CONFIRMATION

     192  
  

SCHEDULE 19 FORMS OF NOTIFIABLE DEBT PURCHASE TRANSACTION NOTICE

     195  
  

Part A Form of Notice on entering into Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction

     195  
  

Part B Form of Notice on Termination of Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction / Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction ceasing to be with Sponsor Affiliate

     196  
  

SCHEDULE 20 EXISTING FINANCE LEASES AND CAPITAL LEASES

     197  
  

SCHEDULE 21 EXISTING INVESTMENT COMMITMENTS

     198  
  

Part A Existing loans and guarantees already made or committed to be made

     198  
  

Part B Other investments already committed

     198  
  

SCHEDULE 22 FORM OF ACCEPTABLE LETTER OF CREDIT

     199  

 

 

ii


THIS AGREEMENT is made on 18 October 2019

BETWEEN:

 

(1)

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC., an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with its registered office at Maples Corporate Services Limited, PO Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands (the “Company”);

 

(2)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part B (Original Borrowers) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) as the original borrowers (the “Original Borrowers”);

 

(3)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part A (Original Guarantors) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) as the original guarantors (the “Original Guarantors”);

 

(4)

CITIBANK, N.A., LONDON BRANCH and DBS BANK LTD. as arrangers and bookrunners (the “Arrangers” and “Bookrunners”);

 

(5)

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part C (Original Lenders) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) as lenders under the Revolving Facility (the “Original Revolving Lenders”);

 

(6)

CITIBANK, N.A. as lender under the Additional L/C Facility (the “Original Additional L/C Lender” and together with the Original Revolving Lenders, the “Original Lenders”); and

 

(7)

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH as facility agent of the other Finance Parties (the “Facility Agent”).

IT IS AGREED as follows:

 

1.

DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

 

1.1

Definitions

In this Agreement:

Acceptable Bank” means:

 

  (a)

a bank or financial institution which has a rating for its long-term unsecured and non-credit-enhanced debt obligations of BBB+ or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or Baa1 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or BBB+ or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd; or

 

  (b)

any other bank or financial institution approved by the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders) following a request in writing from the Company.

Acceptable Letter of Credit” means a first demand stand by letter of credit, substantially in the form of Schedule 22 (Form of Acceptable Letter of Credit) issued by an Acceptable Bank.

Acceptable Transferee” means a (i) bank or financial institution; or (ii) a trust, fund or other entity that is regularly engaged in, or established for the purposes of, making, purchasing or investing in loans, securities or other financial assets and which has been approved by the Company in its sole discretion (acting reasonably) provided that, unless as otherwise agreed by the Company at its sole discretion, the following shall be deemed not to be an Acceptable Transferee:

 

  (a)

at any time (other than when an Event of Default is continuing), a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor;

 

1


  (b)

at any time (other than (1) when an Event of Default is continuing or (2) in respect of a transfer or assignment to an Affiliate of the transferring or assigning Lender) but solely in respect of transfers and assignments of Additional L/C Facility Commitments, a bank or financial institution which has a rating for its long-term unsecured and non-credit-enhanced debt obligations of BBB- or lower by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or Baa3 or lower by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or BBB- or lower by Fitch Ratings Ltd;

 

  (c)

at any time, any Industry Competitor; and

 

  (d)

any person that is (or would, upon becoming a Lender, be) a Defaulting Lender at the time of such assignment, transfer or sub-participation (provided that, unless an Existing Lender has knowledge or is advised to the contrary, it shall be entitled to rely on a written statement from a New Lender in an Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate (as the case may be), that it is not, and will not become, a Defaulting Lender on the date on which it becomes a Lender under this Agreement).

Accession Deed” means an accession deed substantially in the form set out in Schedule 7 (Form of Accession Deed).

Additional Borrower” means a company which becomes an Additional Borrower in accordance with Clause 31.2 (Additional Borrowers).

Additional Guarantor” means a company which becomes an Additional Guarantor in accordance with Clause 31.4 (Additional Guarantors).

Additional Obligor” means an Additional Borrower or an Additional Guarantor.

Additional L/C Facility” means the letter of credit facility made or to be made available under this Agreement as described in paragraph (a)(i) of Clause 2.1 (The Facilities).

Additional L/C Facility Commitment” means:

 

  (a)

for the Original Additional L/C Lender, the amount set opposite its name in Part C (Original Lenders) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) under the heading Additional L/C Facility Commitments and the amount of any other Additional L/C Facility Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase); and

 

  (b)

for any other Lender, the amount in the Base Currency of any Additional L/C Facility Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase),

in each case, to the extent not cancelled, transferred or reduced under this Agreement.

Adjusted Group” means the Group excluding the Excluded Guarantor Companies.

Affiliate” means, in respect of any person, a Subsidiary of that person, a Holding Company of that person or any Subsidiary of that Holding Company.

Affiliate Investment” means any entity in which the Company has ownership, directly or indirectly, of not less than ten per cent. (10%) of the securities having ordinary voting power for the election of directors or other governing body of such entity.

Ancillary Commencement Date” means, in relation to an Ancillary Facility, the date on which that Ancillary Facility is first made available, which date shall be a Business Day within the Availability Period for the Revolving Facility.

Ancillary Commitment” means, in relation to an Ancillary Lender and an Ancillary Facility, the maximum Base Currency Amount which that Ancillary Lender has agreed (whether or not subject to satisfaction of conditions precedent) to make available from time to time under an Ancillary Facility and which has been authorised as such under Clause 9 (Ancillary Facilities), to the extent that amount is not cancelled or reduced under this Agreement or the Ancillary Documents relating to that Ancillary Facility.

 

2


Ancillary Document” means each document relating to or evidencing the terms of an Ancillary Facility.

Ancillary Facility” means any ancillary facility made available by an Ancillary Lender in accordance with Clause 9 (Ancillary Facilities).

Ancillary Lender” means each Lender (or Affiliate of a Lender) which makes available an Ancillary Facility in accordance with Clause 9 (Ancillary Facilities).

Ancillary Outstandings” means, at any time, in relation to an Ancillary Lender and an Ancillary Facility then in force the aggregate of the equivalents (as calculated by that Ancillary Lender) in the Base Currency of the following amounts outstanding under that Ancillary Facility:

 

  (a)

the principal amount under each overdraft facility and on-demand short term loan facility (net of any Available Credit Balance);

 

  (b)

the face amount of each guarantee, bond and letter of credit under that Ancillary Facility net of cash cover and as reduced in accordance with its terms; and

 

  (c)

the amount fairly representing the aggregate exposure (excluding interest and similar charges) of that Ancillary Lender under each other type of accommodation provided under that Ancillary Facility,

in each case as determined by such Ancillary Lender, acting reasonably in accordance with its normal banking practice and in accordance with the relevant Ancillary Document.

Applicable Law” means any constitution, statute, law, rule, regulation, ordinance, judgment, order, decree, Government Approval, or any published directive, guideline, requirement or other governmental restriction that has the force of law or any determination by, or interpretation of, any of the foregoing by any judicial authority, binding on a given person whether in effect as of the date hereof or as of any date thereafter, including all applicable Environmental Laws.

Approved Borrower” means, in relation to a Facility, any Borrower (other than the Company in respect of any Facility and GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. in respect of the Additional L/C Facility only) which has been approved by each Original Lender that is a Lender under that Facility in accordance with Clause 4.5 (Approved Borrowers).

Approved Accounting Principles” means, as the context may require, in the case of the Company, IFRS or, in the case of any other member of the Group, the accounting standards generally accepted in the jurisdiction of incorporation of the relevant member of the Group.

Article 55 BRRD” means Article 55 of Directive 2014/59/EU establishing a framework for the recovery and resolution of credit institutions and investment firms.

Assignment Agreement” means an agreement substantially in the form set out in Schedule 6 (Form of Assignment Agreement) or any other form agreed by the Facility Agent and the Company.

Auditor’s Determination” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(iv) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Authorised Officer” means, in respect of a person, the chairman or any other director of the board of directors, the chief executive officer, the chief financial officer, the general manager, the treasurer or any other duly authorised officer of such person.

 

3


Automatic Acceleration Event” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b) of Clause 28 (Remedies following Default).

Availability Period” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to the Revolving Facility, the period from and including the Signing Date to and including the date falling one month prior to the Final Maturity Date; and

 

  (b)

in relation to the Additional L/C Facility, the period from and including the Signing Date to and including the date falling one month prior to the Final Maturity Date.

Available Commitment” means, in relation to a Facility, the Commitment of a Lender under that Facility at any time minus subject to Clause 9.8 (Affiliates of Lenders as Ancillary Lenders) and as set out below:

 

  (a)

the Base Currency Amount of its participation in any outstanding Utilisations under that Facility and, in respect of the Revolving Facility, the Base Currency Amount of the aggregate of its (and its Affiliate’s) Ancillary Commitments; and

 

  (b)

in relation to any proposed Utilisation, the Base Currency Amount of its participation in any other Utilisations that are due to be made under that Facility on or before the proposed Utilisation Date and, in respect of the Revolving Facility, the Base Currency Amount of its (and its Affiliate’s) Ancillary Commitment in relation to any new Ancillary Facility that is due to be made available on or before the proposed Utilisation Date.

For the purposes of calculating a Lender’s Available Commitment in relation to any proposed Utilisation under that Facility, the following amounts shall not be deducted from that Lender’s Commitment under that Facility:

 

  (i)

that Lender’s participation in any Utilisations under that Facility that are due to be repaid or prepaid on or before the proposed Utilisation Date; and

 

  (ii)

that Lender’s (and its Affiliate’s) Ancillary Commitments under that Facility to the extent that they are due to be reduced or cancelled on or before the proposed Utilisation Date.

Available Credit Balance” means, in relation to an Ancillary Facility, credit balances on any account of any Borrower of that Ancillary Facility with the Ancillary Lender making available that Ancillary Facility to the extent that those credit balances are freely available to be set off by that Ancillary Lender against liabilities owed to it by that Borrower under that Ancillary Facility.

Available Facility” means, in relation to a Facility at any time, the aggregate of the Available Commitments under that Facility at such time.

Bail-In Action” means the exercise of any Write-down and Conversion Powers.

Bail-In Legislation” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to an EEA Member Country which has implemented, or which at any time implements, Article 55 BRRD, the relevant implementing law or regulation as described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule from time to time; and

 

  (b)

in relation to any state other than such an EEA Member Country or (to the extent that the United Kingdom is not such an EEA Member Country) the United Kingdom, any analogous law or regulation from time to time which requires contractual recognition of any Write-down and Conversion Powers contained in that law or regulation.

 

4


Bank Levy” means any amount payable by any Finance Party or any of their respective Affiliates on the basis of or in relation to its balance sheet or capital base or any part of it or its liabilities or minimum regulatory capital or any combination thereof (including, without limitation, the United Kingdom bank levy as set out in the Finance Act 2011 (as amended), the French taxe de risque systémique as set out in Article 235 ter ZE of the French Tax Code and the French taxe pour le financement du fonds de soutien aux collectivités territoriales as set out in Article 235 ter ZE bis of the French Tax Code, the German bank levy as set out in the German Restructuring Fund Act 2010 (Restrukturierungsfondsgesetz), the Dutch bankenbelasting as set out in the Dutch bank levy act (Wet bankenbelasting), the Austrian bank levy as set out in the Austrian Stability Duty Act (Stabilitätsgesetz), the Spanish bank levy (Impuesto sobre los Depósitos en las Entidades de Crédito) as set out in the Law 16/2012 of 27 December 2012, the Swedish bank levy as set out in the Swedish Act on state support to credit institutions (lag (2008:814) (as amended or replaced from time to time)) and any tax in any jurisdiction levied on a similar basis or for a similar purpose in force (or formally announced) as at the Signing Date.

Base Currency” means Dollars.

Base Currency Amount” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to a Utilisation, the amount specified in the Utilisation Request delivered by a Borrower for that Utilisation (or, if the amount requested is not denominated in the Base Currency, that amount converted into the Base Currency at the Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange on the date which is three (3) Business Days before the Utilisation Date or, if later, on the date the Facility Agent receives the Utilisation Request in accordance with the terms of this Agreement) and, in the case of a Letter of Credit, as adjusted under Clause 6.8 (Revaluation of Letters of Credit); and

 

  (b)

in relation to an Ancillary Commitment, the amount specified as such in the notice delivered to the Facility Agent by the Company pursuant to Clause 9.2 (Availability) (or, if the amount specified is not denominated in the Base Currency, that amount converted into the Base Currency at the Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange on the date which is three (3) Business Days before the Ancillary Commencement Date for that Ancillary Facility or, if later, the date the Facility Agent receives the notice of the Ancillary Commitment in accordance with the terms of this Agreement),

as adjusted to reflect any repayment, prepayment, consolidation or division of a Utilisation, or (as the case may be) cancellation or reduction of an Ancillary Facility.

Borrower” means an Original Borrower or an Additional Borrower unless it has ceased to be a Borrower in accordance with Clause 31 (Changes to the Obligors) and, in respect of an Ancillary Facility only, any Affiliate of a Borrower that becomes a borrower of that Ancillary Facility with the approval of the relevant Lender pursuant to Clause 9.9 (Affiliates of Borrowers).

Break Costs” means the amount (if any) by which:

 

  (a)

the interest (excluding the Margin) which a Lender should have received for the period from the date of receipt of all or any part of its participation in a Loan or Unpaid Sum to the last day of the current Interest Period in respect of that Loan or Unpaid Sum, had the principal amount or Unpaid Sum received been paid on the last day of that Interest Period;

exceeds:

 

  (b)

the amount which that Lender would be able to obtain by placing an amount equal to the principal amount or Unpaid Sum received by it on deposit with a leading bank for a period starting on the Business Day following receipt or recovery and ending on the last day of the current Interest Period.

 

5


Business Day” means:

 

  (a)

for the purposes of determining EURIBOR, a TARGET Day;

 

  (b)

for the purposes of determining LIBOR, a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which dealings in Dollar deposits are carried on in the London interbank market and on which banks are generally open for general business in London; and

 

  (c)

for the purposes of delivering any Utilisation Request or Renewal Request, identifying any Utilisation Date, issuing any Letters of Credit, funding any Utilisation (or calculating any amounts for the relevant Utilisation) and making any other payment, a day (other than a Saturday or Sunday) on which banks are open for general business in London, New York and Singapore provided that such day is a TARGET Day for payment or purchase of Euro;

 

  (c)

for all other purposes, a day (other than a Friday, Saturday or Sunday) on which banks are open for general business in London, New York, Abu Dhabi and Singapore.

Calculation Date” means each last day of the second quarter of a Financial Year and each last day of a Financial Year commencing with 31 December 2019.

Calculation Period” means any twelve (12) calendar month period ending on a Calculation Date (and including, for the avoidance of doubt, only one previous Calculation Date).

Capital Stock” means, of any person, any shares, interests, rights to purchase, warrants, options, debt securities, participations or other equivalents of or interests in (however designated), the common or preferred equity share capital of such person, including, without limitation, partnership interests, and any securities convertible into or exchangeable for any thereof (whether optionally or mandatorily).

Cash” means, at any time, cash at bank credited to an account in the name of a member of the Adjusted Group with an Acceptable Bank which is freely transferable into Dollars or Euro and immediately available (or immediately available upon the giving of notice and the expiry of the relevant notice period) to be applied in repayment or prepayment of the Facilities.

Cash Equivalent Investments” means at any time:

 

  (a)

certificates of deposit maturing within one (1) year after the relevant date of calculation and issued by an Acceptable Bank;

 

  (b)

any investment in marketable debt obligations issued or guaranteed by the government of the United States of America, the United Kingdom, the Emirate of Abu Dhabi, Japan, Singapore or any member state of the European Economic Area or any Participating Member State which has a credit rating of A- or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, A3 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or Aa3 or higher by Fitch Ratings Limited or by an instrumentality or agency of any of them having an equivalent credit rating, maturing within one (1) year after the relevant date of calculation and not convertible or exchangeable to any other security;

 

  (c)

commercial paper not convertible or exchangeable to any other security:

 

  (i)

for which a recognised trading market exists;

 

  (ii)

issued by an issuer incorporated in the United States of America, the United Kingdom, any Emirate of the United Arab Emirates, Japan, Singapore, any member state of the European Economic Area or any Participating Member State;

 

  (iii)

which matures within one (1) year after the relevant date of calculation; and

 

6


  (iv)

which has a credit rating of A-1 or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or P-1 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or F1 or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd, or, if no rating is available in respect of the commercial paper, the issuer of which has, in respect of its long-term unsecured and non-credit enhanced debt obligations, an equivalent rating;

 

  (d)

any investment in money market funds which (i) have assets with a credit rating of A-1 or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or P-1 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or F1 or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd, (ii) which invest substantially all their assets in securities of the types described in paragraphs (a) to (c) above and (iii) can be turned into cash on not more than thirty (30) days’ notice;

 

  (e)

any loan made to an entity which has a credit rating of A+ or higher by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services or A1 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service Limited or A+ or higher by Fitch Ratings Ltd;

 

  (f)

any letter of credit or other similar instrument issued by an Acceptable Bank providing for payment on first written demand, which shall be in the form of an Acceptable Letter of Credit; or

 

  (g)

any other debt security approved by the Facility Agent,

in each case, denominated either in Dollars, Euro or in any other currency which is freely convertible into Dollars or Euro and to which any member of the Group is alone (or together with other members of the Group) beneficially entitled at that time and which is not issued or guaranteed by any member of the Group or subject to any security (other than the normal security arising in favour of a clearing system due to the relevant investment being held in such clearing system).

Change of Control” means the occurrence of an event resulting in (i) an entity wholly owned (directly or indirectly) by the government of the Emirate of Abu Dhabi ceasing to Control the Company; or (ii) the Company ceasing to Control any Borrower.

China Investment” means the contribution of equipment and other assets to the China Joint Venture in exchange for, amongst other things, equity ownership rights in the China Joint Venture, provided that the China Joint Venture becomes a member of the Group and the aggregate value of such equipment and other assets does not exceed US$450,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies).

China Joint Venture” means the joint venture entity to be established between a member of the Group and the Government of Chongqing or the Government of Chengdu of the People’s Republic of China (and/or their respective affiliated entities and local partners).

Closing Date” means the date of first utilisation of the Facilities.

Closing Date Security Documents” means:

 

  (a)

the security confirmation agreement made between GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V. and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as the Pledgee, governed by the laws of the Netherlands;

 

  (b)

a German law governed confirmation and junior share and interest pledge agreement to be entered into among, inter alios, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES

 

7


  Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG as pledgors and Wilmington Trust, National Association as collateral trustee and pledgee regarding the pledge of all current and future shares and partnership interests (as the case may be) in GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG;

 

  (c)

the Singapore law governed supplemental share charge, supplemental to the share charge dated 30 October 2018 (as supplemented by the supplemental share charge dated 5 June 2019), entered into between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and the Collateral Agent; and

 

  (d)

the Reaffirmation Agreement.

Code” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986 and the regulations promulgated and rulings issued thereunder.

Collateral Trust Agreement” means the amended and restated collateral trust agreement dated 20 September 2018 (and as further amended, supplemented, amended and restated or otherwise modified from time to time) between, among others, the Company, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Borrower LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd., Morgan Stanley Senior Funding Inc. as administrative agent, Bank of America, N.A. as equipment financing global trustee and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as collateral trustee.

Commitment” means a Revolving Facility Commitment or an Additional L/C Facility Commitment.

Committed Debt Facilities” means revolving credit facilities providing for Financial Indebtedness maturing not later than three hundred sixty-five (365) calendar days after the date incurred (although any such revolving credit facilities availability period may be longer than one (1) year), whether unsecured or secured (including where structured as a securitisation or other asset backed financing) which are identified in the Compliance Certificate delivered in respect of the relevant Calculation Date pursuant to Clause 2 (Compliance Certificate) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) or, in respect of Clause 7 (Distribution) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants), as identified in any certificate signed by an Authorised Officer of the Company and delivered to the Facility Agent on the date of the proposed Distribution.

Compliance Certificate” means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 9 (Form of Compliance Certificate).

Confidentiality Undertaking” means a confidentiality undertaking substantially in a recommended form of the LMA set out in Schedule 17 (Form of Confidentiality Agreement) or in any other form agreed between the Company and the Facility Agent.

Control” means (a) the ownership, directly or indirectly, of more than fifty-one per cent. (51%) of the securities having ordinary voting power for the election of directors or other governing body of a company, corporation or other entity; or (b) the ability, directly or indirectly, to influence any decision of, or to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies (including operations and maintenance decisions) of, a person. The terms “Controlled by”, “under common Control with” and the term ‘‘Control’’ when used as a verb, shall have correlative meanings.

Corrupt Practices Laws” means, collectively (a) the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act 1977, 15 U.S.C. 78dd-178dd-3 (2000), as amended, and (b) any other applicable law, regulation, order, decree or directive having the force of law and relating to bribery, kick-backs or similar business practices.

 

8


Cross-stream Guarantee” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(i) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Debt Purchase Transaction” means, in relation to a person, a transaction where such person:

 

  (a)

purchases by way of assignment or transfer;

 

  (b)

enters into any sub-participation in respect of; or

 

  (c)

enters into any other agreement or arrangement having an economic effect substantially similar to a sub-participation in respect of,

any Commitment or amount outstanding under this Agreement.

Debt Service Coverage Ratio” means, in relation to any Calculation Period, the ratio of (a) EBITDA of the Adjusted Group to (b) Senior Debt Service for such period.

Declared Default” means the occurrence of an Automatic Acceleration Event or the occurrence of an Event of Default specified in Schedule 16 (Events of Default) which has resulted in a notice of acceleration being served by the Facility Agent declaring that all Utilisations under the Facilities shall become immediately due and payable.

Default” means an Event of Default or any event or circumstance which would (with the expiry of a grace period, the giving of notice, the making of any determination under the Finance Documents or any combination of any of the foregoing) be an Event of Default.

Defaulting Lender” means any Lender (other than a Lender which is a Sponsor Affiliate):

 

  (a)

which has failed to make its participation in a Loan under any Facility available (or has notified the Facility Agent or the Company (which has notified the Facility Agent) that it will not make its participation in a Loan available) by the Utilisation Date of that Loan in accordance with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation) or which has failed to provide cash collateral (or has notified the Issuing Bank or the Company (which has notified the Facility Agent) that it will not provide cash collateral) in accordance with Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover);

 

  (b)

which has otherwise rescinded or repudiated a Finance Document;

 

  (c)

which is an Issuing Bank which has failed to issue a Letter of Credit (or has notified the Facility Agent or the Company (which has notified the Facility Agent) that it will not issue a Letter of Credit) in accordance with Clause 6.5 (Issue of Letters of Credit) or which has failed to pay a claim (or has notified the Facility Agent or the Company (which has notified the Facility Agent) that it will not pay a claim) in accordance with (and as defined in) Clause 7.2 (Claims under a Letter of Credit); or

 

  (d)

with respect to which an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing,

unless, in the case of paragraphs (a) and (c) above:

 

  (i)

its failure to pay, or to issue a Letter of Credit is caused by:

 

  (A)

administrative or technical error; or

 

  (B)

a Disruption Event, and

payment is made within three (3) Business Days of its due date; or

 

9


  (ii)

the Lender is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question.

Designated Gross Amount” means the amount notified by the Company to the Facility Agent upon the establishment of a Multi-account Overdraft as being the maximum amount of Gross Outstandings that will, at any time, be outstanding under that Multi-account Overdraft.

Designated Net Amount” means the amount notified by the Company to the Facility Agent upon the establishment of a Multi-account Overdraft as being the maximum amount of Net Outstandings that will, at any time, be outstanding under that Multi-account Overdraft.

Disruption Event” means either or both of:

 

  (a)

a material disruption to those payment or communications systems or to those financial markets which are, in each case, required to operate in order for payments to be made in connection with the Facilities (or otherwise in order for the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents to be carried out) which disruption is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, any of the Parties; or

 

  (b)

the occurrence of any other event which results in a disruption (of a technical or systems-related nature) to the treasury or payments operations of a Party preventing that, or any other Party:

 

  (i)

from performing its payment obligations under the Finance Documents; or

 

  (ii)

from communicating with other Parties in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents,

and which (in either such case) is not caused by, and is beyond the control of, the Party whose operations are disrupted.

Distribution” means in relation to an entity a dividend or other distribution (whether in cash or in kind) made on or in respect of its share capital (or any class of its share capital) and any payment on any Shareholder Loans.

Dutch CS Security Documents” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (c) of Clause 26 (Covenants).

EBITDA” means:

 

  (a)

in respect of the Adjusted Group, the net income of the Adjusted Group on a consolidated basis for the testing period plus adding back interest expense, taxes, non-operating expenses and amortisation, depreciation and other non-cash items to the extent deducted and deducting interest income to the extent added; and

 

  (b)

in respect of any member of the Group, the net income of that member of the Group on an unconsolidated basis for the testing period (but excluding intra-Group items and investments in Subsidiaries) plus adding back interest expense, taxes, non-operating expenses and amortisation, depreciation and other non-cash items to the extent deducted and deducting interest income to the extent added.

EEA Member Country” means any member state of the European Union, Iceland, Liechtenstein and Norway.

 

10


Environment” means humans, animals, plants and all other living organisms including the ecological systems of which they form part and the following media:

 

  (a)

air (including, without limitation, air within natural or man-made structures, whether above or below ground);

 

  (b)

water (including, without limitation, territorial, coastal and inland waters, water under or within land and water in drains and sewers); and

 

  (c)

land (including, without limitation, land under water).

Environmental Law” means any applicable law or regulation which relates to:

 

  (a)

the pollution or protection of the Environment;

 

  (b)

the conditions of the workplace; or

 

  (c)

the generation, handling, storage, use, release or spillage of any substance which, alone or in combination with any other, is capable of causing harm to the Environment, including, without limitation, any waste.

Equity” means the amount of funding provided to the Company by its shareholders or their affiliates (other than members of the Group) either in the form of Capital Stock or Shareholder Loans, whether by way of cash or other assets.

EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule” means the document described as such and published by the Loan Market Association (or any successor person) from time to time.

EU Blocking Regulation” means European Union Regulation (EC) 2271/96, as amended, (or any law or regulation implementing such Regulation in any member state of the European Union or the United Kingdom) or any similar blocking or anti-boycott law, regulation or statute in force from time to time, including the German Blocking Regulation.

EU Obligor” means any Obligor subject to the EU Blocking Regulation.

EURIBOR” means in relation to any Loan denominated in Euro:

 

  (a)

the applicable Screen Rate as of the Specified Time for Euro and for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan; or

 

  (b)

as otherwise determined pursuant to Clause 16.1 (Unavailability of Screen Rate),

and if, in either case, that rate is less than zero, EURIBOR shall be deemed to be zero.

Event of Default” means any event or circumstance specified as such in Schedule 16 (Events of Default).

Excluded Guarantor Company” means an entity which satisfies the requirements of all the sub paragraphs below and which is nominated in writing by the Company as an Excluded Guarantor Company:

 

  (a)

it was not a member of the Group on 21 December 2016;

 

  (b)

it became a member of the Group after 21 December 2016 in accordance with an acquisition or investment permitted under Clause 6 (Acquisitions; Investments) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants);

 

11


  (c)

it is not a wholly owned member of the Group;

 

  (d)

by virtue of arrangements with its other shareholder(s), it could not provide a guarantee of the Facilities (whether limited or not); and

 

  (e)

the acquisition of, and any investment made in, such entity by other members of the Group was financed by Equity (or, if not financed by Equity, the Company has received Equity in an amount not less than the fair market value of such acquisition or investment).

Excluded Tax” means any Tax imposed on or calculated by reference to the net income received or receivable (but not any sum deemed to be received or receivable) by a Finance Party under the law of the jurisdiction in which that Finance Party is incorporated or if different, the jurisdiction (or jurisdictions) in which that Finance Party is treated as resident for tax purposes or the jurisdiction in which that Finance Party’s Facility Office, or other permanent establishment through which it acts in connection with this Agreement, is located in respect of amounts received or receivable in that jurisdiction.

Existing Facilities” means:

 

  (a)

the facilities agreement dated 29 December 2015 (as extended and amended on 20 December 2016, 22 December 2017 and 21 December 2018) with an aggregate commitment of up to US$50,000,000 between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. and Citibank N.A. (the “Existing Citibank Facility”);

 

  (b)

the banker’s guarantee facility with an aggregate amount of US$2,000,000 provided by Citibank N.A., Singapore to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.;

 

  (c)

the banker’s guarantee facility with an aggregate amount of US$5,000,000 provided by Deutsche Bank AG, Singapore to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.;

 

  (d)

the banker’s guarantee facility with an aggregate amount of S$37,000,000 provided by Société Générale Singapore Branch to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.;

 

  (e)

the First Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (f)

the US$1,030,180,000 credit agreement dated on the date of the First Common Terms Agreement between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and Citibank, N.A. as Ex-Im Facility Agent;

 

  (g)

the US$528,000,000 credit agreement dated on the date of the First Common Terms Agreement between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and Société Générale SA as Atradius Facility Agent;

 

  (h)

the Second Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (i)

the US$407,600,000 and EUR100,000,000 facility agreement dated on the date of the Second Common Terms Agreement between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., the Mandated Lead Arrangers (as defined therein) and ING Bank N.V. as Atradius Facility Agent;

 

  (j)

the US$361,000,000 facility agreement dated on the date of the Second Common Terms Agreement between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., the Mandated Lead Arrangers (as defined therein) and Commerzbank Finance & Covered Bond S.A. as Term Loan Facility Agent;

 

  (k)

the US$55,000,000 facility agreement dated on the date of the Second Common Terms Agreement between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., the Mandated Lead Arranger (as defined therein) and Société Générale SA as Tied Commercial Facility Agent;

 

12


  (l)

the US$225,000,000 facility agreement dated 4 August 2017 between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., the banks specified therein as Relevant Lenders (as defined in the Second Common Terms Agreement) and Barclays Bank PLC as Relevant Facility Agent (as defined in the Second Common Terms Agreement);

 

  (m)

the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (n)

the lease agreement dated on the date of the Third Common Terms Agreement between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited as Lessor, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (o)

the lease agreement dated on the date of the Third Common Terms Agreement between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and DBS Bank Ltd. as Lessor, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (p)

the lease agreement dated on the date of the Third Common Terms Agreement between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Bank of America, N.A., Singapore Branch as Lessor, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (q)

the lease agreement dated on the date of the Third Common Terms Agreement between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Oversea-Chinese Banking Corporation Limited as Lessor, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (r)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$25,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (s)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$75,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (t)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Bank of America, N.A., Singapore Branch as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$25,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (u)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Bank of America, N.A., Singapore Branch as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$75,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (v)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and DBS Bank Ltd. as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$50,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (w)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and DBS Bank Ltd. as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$100,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (x)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Mitsubishi UFJ Lease (Singapore) Pte. Ltd. as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$25,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

13


  (y)

the lease agreement dated 21 January 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd as Lessee and Oversea-Chinese Banking Corporation Limited as Lessor, in respect of equipment with a total purchase price of US$50,000,000, incorporating the Third Common Terms Agreement;

 

  (z)

the EUR50,000,000 facility agreement dated 6 June 2018 between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG and IKB Deutsche Industriebank AG as Lender;

 

  (aa)

the master agreement for receivables purchase with an aggregate commitment of US$150,000,000 dated as of 8 January 2018, between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd, a company incorporated and existing under the laws of the Republic of Singapore, as the Seller and Société Générale, Singapore Branch;

 

  (bb)

the master agreement for receivables purchase with an aggregate commitment of up to US$55,000,000 dated 8 January 2018 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. as the Seller and Société Générale, Singapore Branch;

 

  (cc)

the reimbursement agreement dated 29 June 2013 (and as amended on 5 June 2014) between GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. and JP Morgan Chase Bank N.A. for the issuance of a letter of credit in amount of US$32,570,521 (as of 5 June 2019);

 

  (dd)

the US$18,465,000 instalment purchase agreement dated 14 June 2016 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. and Cisco Systems Capital Corporation;

 

  (ee)

the US$21,580,519 lease agreement dated 31 August 2017 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC and I.Park East Fishkill I LLC;

 

  (ff)

the US$525,000,000 and EUR200,000,000 credit agreement dated 5 June 2019 between, amongst others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Borrower LLC as Borrowers, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., MUFG Bank, Ltd. and First Abu Dhabi Bank, UAE as Joint Lead Arrangers and Bookrunners and Wilmington Trust, National Association. as Collateral Agent; and

 

  (gg)

the US$25,000,000 facility agreement dated 25 March 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and Bank of America Merrill Lynch International Designated Activity Company (the “Existing BAML Facility”),

in each case as amended, restated or novated.

Existing Letter of Credit” means any letter of credit, bank guarantee, bond, instrument, agreement or assurance (or similar) under or in respect of any debt financing or arrangement made available to the Group or any existing debt (or issued on behalf of or pursuant to a guarantee or indemnity from the Group) and which is issued on behalf of the Group by a Lender (or an Affiliate of a Lender) which is an Issuing Bank under this Agreement, and which is designated in writing as an Existing Letter of Credit by such Issuing Bank which will provide such Letter of Credit and the Company.

Expiry Date” means, for a Letter of Credit, the last day of its Term.

Facility” means the Revolving Facility or the Additional L/C Facility.

Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange” means:

 

  (a)

the Facility Agent’s spot rate of exchange; or

 

  (b)

(if the Facility Agent does not have an available spot rate of exchange) any other publicly available spot rate of exchange selected by the Facility Agent (acting reasonably),

 

14


for the purchase of the relevant currency with the Base Currency in the London foreign exchange market at or about 11:00 a.m. on a particular day.

Facility Office” means:

 

  (a)

in respect of a Lender or Issuing Bank, the office or offices notified by that Lender or Issuing Bank to the Facility Agent in writing on or before the date it becomes a Lender or Issuing Bank (or, following that date, by not less than five (5) Business Days’ written notice) as the office or offices through which it will perform its obligations under this Agreement; or

 

  (b)

in respect of any other Finance Party, the office in the jurisdiction in which it is resident for tax purposes.

Fallback Interest Period” means one (1) calendar month.

FATCA” means:

 

  (a)

sections 1471 to 1474 of the Code or any associated regulations;

 

  (b)

any treaty, law or regulation of any other jurisdiction, or relating to an intergovernmental agreement between the US and any other jurisdiction, which (in either case) facilitates the implementation of any law or regulation referred to in paragraph (a) above; or

 

  (c)

any agreement pursuant to the implementation of any treaty, law or regulation referred to in paragraphs (a) or (b) above with the IRS, the US government or any governmental or taxation authority in any other jurisdiction.

FATCA Application Date” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to a “withholdable payment” described in section 1473(1)(A)(i) of the Code (which relates to payments of interest and certain other payments from sources within the US), 1 July 2014; or

 

  (b)

in relation to a “passthru payment” described in section 1471(d)(7) of the Code not falling within paragraph (a) above, the first date from which such payment may become subject to a deduction or withholding required by FATCA.

FATCA Deduction” means a deduction or withholding from a payment under a Finance Document required by FATCA.

FATCA Exempt Party” means a Party that is entitled to receive payments free from any FATCA Deduction.

Fee Letter” means:

 

  (a)

any letter or letters dated on or about the Signing Date between a Finance Party and the Company setting out any of the fees referred to in Clause 17 (Fees); and

 

  (b)

any agreement setting out fees payable to a Finance Party referred to in paragraph (h) of Clause 2.2 (Increase) Clause 17.4 (Fees payable in respect of Letters of Credit) or Clause 17.5 (Interest, commission and fees on Ancillary Facilities) or under any other Finance Document.

Fees” means any fees set out in any Fee Letter, together with any other fees due and payable to a Lender under or in connection with the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents including the waiver, amendment or modification of any provision thereof or any consent requested thereunder (but for the avoidance of doubt shall not include any costs or expenses due and payable to a Lender or the Facility Agent under any such provisions or any such transactions).

 

15


Final Maturity Date” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to the Additional L/C Facility, the date falling five (5) years after the Signing Date; and

 

  (b)

in relation to the Revolving Facility, the date falling five (5) years after the Signing Date.

Finance Documents” means:

 

  (a)

this Agreement;

 

  (b)

the Fee Letters;

 

  (c)

the Subordination Deed;

 

  (d)

each Accession Deed;

 

  (e)

any Ancillary Document;

 

  (f)

any Utilisation Request;

 

  (g)

the Collateral Trust Agreement;

 

  (h)

the Transaction Security Documents; and

 

  (i)

any other document from time to time designated as such by the Facility Agent and the Company.

Finance Lease” means any lease or hire purchase contract, a liability under which would, in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles, be treated as a balance sheet liability (other than a lease or hire purchase contract which would, in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles in force as at the Signing Date, have been treated as an operating lease).

Finance Parties” means the Lenders, the Facility Agent, any Issuing Bank, any Ancillary Lender, the Arrangers and the Bookrunners.

Financial Close” means the date on which the Facility Agent notifies the Company and the Lenders that all of the conditions precedent referred to in Part A (Conditions Precedent to Financial Close) of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent) have been satisfied or waived.

Financial Indebtedness” means any indebtedness for or in respect of:

 

  (a)

moneys borrowed;

 

  (b)

any amount raised by acceptance under any acceptance credit facility or dematerialised equivalent;

 

  (c)

any amount raised pursuant to any note purchase facility or the issue of bonds, notes, debentures, loan stock or any similar instrument;

 

  (d)

the amount of any liability in respect of Finance Leases;

 

  (e)

receivables sold or discounted (other than any receivables to the extent they are sold on a non-recourse basis);

 

16


  (f)

any amount raised under any other transaction (including any forward sale or purchase agreement) having the commercial effect of a borrowing and classified as borrowings in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles;

 

  (g)

the acquisition cost of any asset or service where such amount is unpaid more than two hundred seventy (270) days after the expiry of the due date thereof (after giving effect to the payment terms customarily allowed by the relevant supplier) save where the payment deferral results from the delayed or non-satisfaction of contract terms by the supplier or from the contract terms establishing payment schedules tied to total or partial contract completion and/or to the results of operational testing procedures;

 

  (h)

any Treasury Transaction entered into in connection with protection against or benefit from fluctuation in any rate or price (and, when calculating the value of any Treasury Transaction, only the marked-to-market value shall be taken into account);

 

  (i)

any counter-indemnity obligation in respect of a guarantee, indemnity, bond, standby or documentary letter of credit or any other instrument issued by a bank or financial institution (but not in the support of the performance by a member of the Group under any contract other than in respect of “Financial Indebtedness” falling within any of paragraphs (a) to (g) (inclusive) of this definition); and

 

  (j)

the amount of any liability in respect of any guarantee or indemnity for any of the items referred to in paragraphs (a) to (i) above,

but:

 

  (i)

excluding indebtedness owed by one member of the Group to another member of the Group (other than loans made by Non-Obligors to Obligors), Shareholder Loans, all pension provisions and all accounts payable in the ordinary course of business save as provided in paragraph (g) above; and

 

  (ii)

without any double counting.

Financial Statements” means, in respect of any person, the cashflow statement, balance sheet, profit and loss account and disclosure of material liabilities relating to such person.

Financial Year” means a financial year of the Company.

First Common Terms Agreement” means the common terms agreement dated 21 December 2012 (as amended and restated on 4 September 2014 and as amended and/or restated from time to time) between, among others, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas as Global Facility Agent, Export-Import Bank Of The United States as US Ex-Im Bank and Société Générale SA as Atradius Facility Agent.

Funding Rate” means any individual rate notified by a Lender to the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (d)(i) of Clause 16.4 (Cost of funds).

German Additional Guarantor” means an Additional Guarantor incorporated under the laws of Germany.

German Blocking Regulation” means section 7 of the German Foreign Trade Regulation (Außenwirtschaftsverordnung) (in connection with section 4 para 1 no 3 of the German Foreign Trade Act (Außenwirtschaftsgesetz)) or a similar anti-boycott statute.

German Borrower” means a Borrower incorporated in Germany.

 

17


German Qualifying Lender” means, in respect of interest payable by a German Borrower, a Lender which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to it under a Finance Document and is (a) lending through a Facility Office in Germany, or (b) a German Treaty Lender.

German Treaty Lender” means a Lender which:

 

  (a)

is treated as a resident of a German Treaty State for the purposes of the relevant German Treaty;

 

  (b)

does not carry on a business in Germany through a permanent establishment with which that Lender’s participation in the Loan is effectively connected; and

 

  (c)

fulfils any other conditions which must be fulfilled under the relevant German Treaty by residents of the relevant German Treaty State for such residents to obtain full exemption from Tax imposed on interest by the relevant German Treaty State, including the completion of any necessary procedural formalities.

German Treaty State” means a jurisdiction having an avoidance of double taxation agreement (a “German Treaty”) with Germany which makes provision for full exemption from Tax imposed by Germany on interest.

German GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles in Germany.

German GmbH Guarantor” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

German Original Obligor” means an Original Obligor incorporated under the laws of Germany.

GmbHG” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(i)(B) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Government Approval” means any consent, license, approval, registration, permit, sanction, filing or registration with or other authorisation or other action of any nature that is required to be granted or taken by or with any Governmental Authority.

Governmental Authority” means any national, state, county, city, town, village, municipal or other local governmental department, commission, board, bureau, agency, authority or instrumentality of any relevant nation or any political subdivision thereof, and any person or entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or administrative functions of or pertaining to any of the foregoing entities, including, without limitation, all commissions, boards, bureaus, arbitrators and arbitration panels, and any authority or other person or entity controlled by any of the foregoing.

Gross Outstandings” means, in relation to a Multi-account Overdraft, the Ancillary Outstandings of that Multi-account Overdraft but calculated on the basis that the words “(net of any Available Credit Balance)” in paragraph (a) of the definition of “Ancillary Outstandings” were deleted.

Group” means the Company and its Subsidiaries and “member of the Group” shall be construed accordingly.

Guarantor” means each Original Guarantor and each Additional Guarantor unless it has ceased to be a Guarantor in accordance with Clause 31 (Changes to the Obligors).

Historic Screen Rate” means, in relation to any Loan, the most recent applicable Screen Rate for the currency of that Loan and for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan and which is as of a day which is no more than three (3) calendar days before the Quotation Day.

 

18


Holding Company” means, in relation to a company or corporation, any other company or corporation in respect of which it is a Subsidiary.

IFRS” means international accounting standards within the meaning of IAS Regulation 1606/2002 to the extent applicable to the relevant Financial Statements.

Impaired Agent” means the Facility Agent at any time when:

 

  (a)

it has failed to make (or has notified a Party that it will not make) a payment required to be made by it under the Finance Documents by the due date for payment;

 

  (b)

the Facility Agent otherwise rescinds or repudiates a Finance Document; or

 

  (c)

(if the Facility Agent is also a Lender or an Issuing Bank) it is a Defaulting Lender under paragraph (a), (b) or (c) of the definition of “Defaulting Lender”; or

 

  (d)

an Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing with respect to the Facility Agent,

unless, in the case of paragraph (a) above:

 

  (i)

its failure to pay is caused by:

 

  (A)

administrative or technical error; or

 

  (B)

a Disruption Event; and

payment is made within three (3) Business Days of its due date; or

 

  (ii)

the Facility Agent is disputing in good faith whether it is contractually obliged to make the payment in question.

Increase Confirmation” means a confirmation substantially in the form set out in Schedule 18 (Form of Increase Confirmation).

Increase Lender” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 2.2 (Increase).

Industry Competitor” means any person or entity (a “Principal Competitor”) which is a competitor of the Group in any of the material activities of the Group or any person that is an Affiliate of or is acting on behalf of a Principal Competitor.

Information Package” means any written information concerning the Group which has been prepared by the Company and provided to the Finance Parties on a confidential basis in connection with the entry of the Company into the Facilities.

Insolvency Event” in relation to an entity means that the entity:

 

  (a)

is dissolved (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger);

 

  (b)

becomes insolvent or is unable to pay its debts or fails or admits in writing its inability generally to pay its debts as they become due;

 

  (c)

makes a general assignment, arrangement or composition with or for the benefit of its creditors;

 

19


  (d)

institutes or has instituted against it, by a regulator, supervisor, judicial manager or any similar official with primary insolvency, rehabilitative or regulatory jurisdiction over it in the jurisdiction of its incorporation or organisation or the jurisdiction of its head or home office, a proceeding seeking a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or any other relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or other similar law affecting creditors’ rights, or a petition is presented for its winding-up or liquidation by it or such regulator, supervisor or similar official;

 

  (e)

has instituted against it a proceeding seeking a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or any other relief under any bankruptcy or insolvency law or other similar law affecting creditors’ rights, or a petition is presented for its winding-up or liquidation, and, in the case of any such proceeding or petition instituted or presented against it, such proceeding or petition is instituted or presented by a person or entity not described in paragraph (d) above and:

 

  (i)

results in a judgment of insolvency or bankruptcy or the entry of an order for relief or the making of an order for its winding-up or liquidation; or

 

  (ii)

is not dismissed, discharged, stayed or restrained in each case within thirty (30) days of the institution or presentation thereof;

 

  (f)

has exercised in respect of it one or more of the stabilisation powers pursuant to Part 1 of the United Kingdom Banking Act 2009 and/or has instituted against it a bank insolvency proceeding pursuant to Part 2 of the United Kingdom Banking Act 2009 or a bank administration proceeding pursuant to Part 3 of the United Kingdom Banking Act 2009;

 

  (g)

has a resolution passed for its winding-up, official management, judicial management or liquidation (other than pursuant to a consolidation, amalgamation or merger);

 

  (h)

seeks or becomes subject to the appointment of an administrator, provisional liquidator, judicial manager, administrative receiver, conservator, receiver, trustee, custodian or other similar official for it or for all or substantially all its assets (other than, for so long as it is required by law or regulation not to be publicly disclosed, any such appointment which is to be made, or is made, by a person or entity described in paragraph (d) above);

 

  (i)

has a secured party take possession of all or substantially all its assets or has a distress, execution, attachment, sequestration or other legal process levied, enforced or sued on or against all or substantially all its assets and such secured party maintains possession, or any such process is not dismissed, discharged, stayed or restrained, in each case within thirty (30) days thereafter;

 

  (j)

causes or is subject to any event with respect to it which, under the applicable laws of any jurisdiction, has an analogous effect to any of the events specified in paragraphs (a) to (i) above; or

 

  (k)

takes any action in furtherance of, or indicating its consent to, approval of, or acquiescence in, any of the foregoing acts.

Interest Period” means each period determined under this Agreement by reference to which interest on a Loan or an overdue amount is calculated.

Interpolated Historic Screen Rate” means, in relation to any Loan, the rate (rounded to the same number of decimal places as the two relevant Screen Rates) which results from interpolating on a linear basis between:

 

  (a)

the most recent applicable Screen Rate for the longest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which is less than the Interest Period of that Loan; and

 

  (b)

the most recent applicable Screen Rate for the shortest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which exceeds the Interest Period of that Loan,

 

20


each for the currency of that Loan and each of which is as of a day which is no more than three (3) calendar days before the Quotation Day.

Interpolated Screen Rate” means, in relation to any Loan, the rate (rounded to the same number of decimal places as the two relevant Screen Rates) which results from interpolating on a linear basis between:

 

  (a)

the applicable Screen Rate for the longest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which is less than the Interest Period of that Loan; and

 

  (b)

the applicable Screen Rate for the shortest period (for which that Screen Rate is available) which exceeds the Interest Period of that Loan,

each as of the Specified Time for the currency of that Loan.

IRS” means the U.S. Internal Revenue Service.

Issuing Bank” means:

 

  (a)

in respect of the Additional L/C Facility, the Original Additional L/C Lender; and

 

  (b)

in respect of the Revolving Facility, any Lender which has become a Party as an Issuing Bank pursuant to Clause 6.10 (Appointment of additional Issuing Banks),

(and if there is more than one such Issuing Bank, such Issuing Banks shall be referred to, whether acting individually or together, as the “Issuing Bank”) provided that, in respect of a Letter of Credit issued or to be issued pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, the “Issuing Bank” shall be the Issuing Bank which has issued or agreed to issue that Letter of Credit.

L/C Proportion” means in relation to a Lender in respect of any Letter of Credit issued under a Facility, the proportion (expressed as a percentage) borne by that Lender’s Available Commitment under that Facility to the relevant Available Facility immediately prior to the issue of that Letter of Credit, adjusted to reflect any assignment or transfer under this Agreement to or by that Lender.

Legal Reservation” means:

 

  (a)

the principle that equitable remedies may be granted or refused at the discretion of a court and the limitation of enforcement by laws relating to insolvency, reorganisation and other laws generally affecting the rights of creditors;

 

  (b)

the time barring of claims under the Limitation Acts, the possibility that an undertaking to assume liability for or indemnify a person against non-payment of UK stamp duty may be void and defences of set-off or counterclaim;

 

  (c)

similar principles, rights and defences under the laws of any relevant jurisdiction; and

 

  (d)

any other matters which are set out as qualifications or reservations as to matters of law of general application in any legal opinion delivered to the Facility Agent in connection with this Agreement.

Lender” means:

 

  (a)

any Original Lender; or

 

  (b)

any person which becomes a Party as a “Lender” in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase) or Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders),

 

21


which in each case has not ceased to be a Party as such in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

Letter of Credit” means:

 

  (a)

a letter of credit, substantially in the form set out in Schedule 10 (Form of Letter of Credit) or in any other form requested by the Company and:

 

  (i)

in respect of the Additional L/C Facility, agreed by the Facility Agent with the prior consent of the Majority L/C Lenders and the relevant Issuing Bank; or

 

  (ii)

in respect of the Revolving Facility, agreed by the Facility Agent with the prior consent of the Majority RCF Lenders and the relevant Issuing Bank; or

 

  (b)

any guarantee, indemnity or other instrument in a form requested by a Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) and:

 

  (i)

in respect of the Additional L/C Facility, agreed by the Facility Agent with the prior consent of the Majority L/C Lenders and the relevant Issuing Bank; or

 

  (ii)

in respect of the Revolving Facility, agreed by the Facility Agent with the prior consent of the Majority RCF Lenders and the relevant Issuing Bank.

Leverage Ratio” means, in relation to any Calculation Date, the ratio of Senior Debt to Total Capitalisation on such date.

LIBOR” means, in relation to any Loan denominated in Dollars:

 

  (a)

the applicable Screen Rate as of the Specified Time for the currency of that Loan and for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan; or

 

  (b)

as otherwise determined pursuant to Clause 16.1 (Unavailability of Screen Rate),

and if, in either case, that rate is less than zero, LIBOR shall be deemed to be zero.

Limitation Acts” means the Limitation Act 1980 and the Foreign Limitation Periods Act 1984.

LMA” means the Loan Market Association.

Loan” means a loan made or to be made under the Revolving Facility or the principal amount outstanding for the time being of that loan.

Loan-To-Own/Distressed Investors” means any person whose principal business or material activity is in investment strategies whose primary purpose is the purchase of loans or other debt securities with the intention of owning the equity or gaining control of a business (directly or indirectly) (the “Specified Investment Strategies”), provided that:

 

  (a)

Affiliates or Related Funds of such persons:

 

  (i)

whose principal business is not, and who do not have as a material activity, a Specified Investment Strategy;

 

  (ii)

which are managed and controlled independently; and

 

  (iii)

where any information made available under the Finance Documents is not disclosed or otherwise made available to other Affiliates or Related Funds that are Loan to Own/Distressed Investors; and

 

22


  (b)

the Original Lenders,

shall not, in each case, be a Loan to Own/Distressed Investor.

Majority Lenders” means a Lender or Lenders whose Commitments aggregate more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Commitments (or if the Total Commitments have been reduced to zero, whose Commitments aggregated more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Commitments immediately prior to that reduction).

Majority L/C Lenders” means

 

  (a)

(for the purposes of paragraph (a) of Clause 42.1 (Required consents) in the context of a waiver in relation to a proposed Utilisation of the Additional L/C Facility (other than a Utilisation on the Closing Date) of the condition in Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent)), a Lender or Lenders whose Additional L/C Facility Commitments aggregate more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments; and

 

  (b)

(in any other case), a Lender or Lenders whose Additional L/C Facility Commitments aggregate more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments (or if the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments have been reduced to zero, whose Commitments aggregated more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments immediately prior to that reduction).

Majority RCF Lenders” means:

 

  (a)

(for the purposes of paragraph (a) of Clause 42.1 (Required consents) in the context of a waiver in relation to a proposed Utilisation of the Revolving Facility (other than a Utilisation on the Closing Date) of the condition in Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent)), a Lender or Lenders whose Revolving Facility Commitments aggregate more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Revolving Facility Commitments; and

 

  (b)

(in any other case), a Lender or Lenders whose Revolving Facility Commitments aggregate more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Revolving Facility Commitments (or if the Total Revolving Facility Commitments have been reduced to zero, whose Revolving Facility Commitments aggregated more than fifty per cent. (50%) of the Total Revolving Facility Commitments immediately prior to that reduction).

Management Determination” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(iii)(B) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Margin” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to any Revolving Facility Loan two point seven-five per cent. (2.75%) per annum;

 

  (b)

in relation to any Unpaid Sum relating or referable to a Facility, the rate per annum specified above for that Facility; and

 

  (c)

in relation to any other Unpaid Sum, the highest rate specified above.

Material Adverse Effect” means a material adverse effect on:

 

  (a)

the Obligors’ ability to pay any amounts due under the Finance Documents; or

 

  (b)

the business and financial condition of the Group taken as a whole.

Multi-account Overdraft” means an Ancillary Facility which is an overdraft facility comprising more than one account.

 

23


Net Assets” for the purposes of Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(i)(A) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Net Interest” means, in respect of the Adjusted Group on a consolidated basis, interest expense to the extent paid in cash less interest income to the extent received in cash during the relevant Calculation Period, determined in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles.

Net Outstandings” means, in relation to a Multi-account Overdraft, the Ancillary Outstandings of that Multi-account Overdraft.

New Lender” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 29.1 (Assignments and transfers by the Lenders).

Non-Acceptable L/C Lender” means a Lender which:

 

  (a)

is not an Acceptable Bank within the meaning of paragraph (a) of the definition of “Acceptable Bank” (other than (i) an Arranger, (ii) an Original Lender, (iii) an Affiliate of an Issuing Bank or (iii) a Lender which each relevant Issuing Bank (acting reasonably) has agreed is acceptable to it notwithstanding that fact);

 

  (b)

is a Defaulting Lender; or

 

  (c)

has failed to make (or has notified the Facility Agent that it will not make) a payment to be made by it under Clause 7.3 (Indemnities) or Clause 32.11 (Lenders’ indemnity to the Facility Agent) or any other payment to be made by it under the Finance Documents to or for the account of any other Finance Party in its capacity as Lender by the due date for payment unless the failure to pay falls within the description of any of those items set out at paragraphs (i)(A) and (i)(B) of the definition of “Defaulting Lender”.

Non-Obligors” means a member of the Group that is neither an Obligor nor an Excluded Guarantor Company.

Obligor” means a Borrower or a Guarantor.

Obligors’ Agent” means the Company, appointed to act on behalf of each Obligor in relation to the Finance Documents pursuant to Clause 2.4 (Obligors’ Agent).

Optional Currency” means a currency (other than the Base Currency) which complies with the conditions set out in Clause 4.3 (Conditions relating to Optional Currencies).

Original Obligor” means an Original Borrower or an Original Guarantor.

Other Borrower” means a Borrower other than the Company, a Singapore Borrower, a US Borrower or a German Borrower.

Other Qualifying Lender” means, in respect of interest payable by an Other Borrower, a Lender which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to that Lender in respect of an advance under a Finance Document and is (a) lending through a Facility Office in the jurisdiction in which the Other Borrower is resident for tax purposes; or (b) an Other Treaty Lender.

Other Treaty Lender” means a Lender which:

 

  (a)

is treated as a resident of the relevant Other Treaty State for the purposes of the relevant Other Treaty;

 

24


  (b)

does not carry on a business in the jurisdiction in which the relevant Borrower is resident for tax purposes through a permanent establishment with which that Lender’s participation in the Loan is effectively connected; and

 

  (c)

fulfils any other conditions which must be fulfilled under the relevant Other Treaty by residents of the relevant Other Treaty State for such residents to obtain full exemption from Tax imposed on interest by the jurisdiction in which the Borrower is resident for tax purposes, including the completion of any necessary procedural formalities.

Other Treaty State” means a jurisdiction having a double taxation agreement (an “Other Treaty”) with the jurisdiction in which the Borrower is resident for tax purposes which makes provision for full exemption from Tax imposed by that jurisdiction on interest.

Participating Member State” means any member state of the European Union that has the Euro as its lawful currency in accordance with legislation of the European Union relating to Economic and Monetary Union.

Party” means a party to this Agreement.

Payment Demand” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(iii) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

Permitted Disposal” means any of the following sales, leases, licences, transfers, or other disposals (each, a “disposition”) by a member of the Group:

 

  (a)

sales of inventory and product;

 

  (b)

leases of or other agreements relating to unused or underutilised production capacity in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (c)

agreements relating to dedication of production capacity to customers, in the form of leases or otherwise, or the licensing or other disposition of intellectual property or other property in connection with joint development or co-development arrangements or agreements or other licensing or disposition of intellectual property, in each case in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (d)

(A) dispositions of any of its assets that are (1) uneconomic or obsolete; (2) no longer used or useful or necessary in connection with the operation of its business; or (3) at the end of their useful life and that, to the extent necessary for the operation of its business, are replaced by other property or assets of equal value and utility as at the beginning of its useful life; or (B) dispositions of any intellectual property rights or interests provided that the aggregate consideration for such dispositions by members of the Group shall not exceed US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) in any Financial Year;

 

  (e)

dispositions of cash or Cash Equivalent Investments not otherwise prohibited under the Finance Documents;

 

  (f)

dispositions of assets in exchange for other assets comparable or superior as to type, value and quality;

 

  (g)

dispositions made with the prior consent of the Facility Agent;

 

  (h)

without limiting any other restrictions on any such transaction set forth herein, dispositions of receivables or inventory pursuant to (1) any securitisation, factoring or other working capital financing or (2) any financing permitted under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness” and any disposition required as part of a transaction permitted under paragraphs (f) or (j) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”;

 

25


  (i)

dispositions of the shares of, or other ownership interests in, any Obligor or other asset where the net proceeds of that disposition are applied within three (3) months (A) in permanent repayment of Financial Indebtedness secured on the asset which has been disposed of and/or (B) in permanent prepayment of any Facility or, at the option of the Company, the Facilities and other Financial Indebtedness (other than Shareholder Loans) of an Obligor or Obligors on a pro rata basis and/or (C) in reinvestment, if the asset comprises shares of, other ownership interests in, or assets of, an Obligor, in an Obligor or its assets or business and otherwise in any member of the Group or its assets or business, provided that if the disposing entity is a member of the Group that is not an Excluded Guarantor Company and the asset being disposed of is not an ownership interest in an Excluded Guarantor Company, such reinvestment shall not be permitted in the ownership interests in or the assets or business of an Excluded Guarantor Company;

 

  (j)

dispositions (A) from an Obligor to another Obligor, (B) from a Non-Obligor to another Non-Obligor, (C) from a Non-Obligor to an Obligor or (D) from an Obligor to a Non-Obligor;

 

  (k)

dispositions by Obligors which are permitted by Clause 6 (Acquisitions; Investments) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants);

 

  (l)

dispositions which are Permitted Security; or

 

  (m)

dispositions where the higher of the market value or consideration receivable (when aggregated with the higher of the market value or consideration receivable for any other dispositions, other than any disposition falling under any other paragraph of this definition of Permitted Disposal) does not exceed one per cent. (1.00%) of Total Assets of the Group in such Financial Year,

provided that no material disposition shall be a Permitted Disposal for the purposes of this definition unless made on arm’s length terms or better except for the following:

 

  (i)

dispositions permitted under paragraphs (j)(A) or (j)(B) above and paragraph (j)(D) above;

 

  (ii)

dispositions permitted under paragraph (k) to the extent comprising a Permitted Investment under paragraph (b) of such definition; and

 

  (iii)

an intra-Group Reorganisation permitted under Clause 3 (Merger) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants),

provided further that the aggregate of the difference between the market value of the assets disposed of pursuant to transactions under paragraphs (j)(D) and (k) which are not on arm’s length terms or better and the aggregate consideration therefor shall not exceed US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) in any Financial Year.

Permitted Indebtedness” means any Financial Indebtedness:

 

  (a)

incurred under or pursuant to the Finance Documents;

 

  (b)

owed by a member of the Group which is fully subordinated to the amounts owing to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents in accordance with the provisions of the Subordination Deed or otherwise on terms acceptable to the Finance Parties;

 

  (c)

incurred under or pursuant to (A) the Existing Facilities or (B) Finance Leases existing prior to the Signing Date to the extent that the aggregate Financial Indebtedness under such Finance Leases does not exceed the relevant amount described in Schedule 20 (Existing Finance Leases);

 

26


  (d)

incurred for the purpose of refinancing Financial Indebtedness existing on the Signing Date provided that the weighted average life to maturity of the new Financial Indebtedness is not shorter than that of the Financial Indebtedness being refinanced;

 

  (e)

consisting of revolving working capital indebtedness up to a maximum aggregate amount in respect of all of the Obligors of US$750,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) (less any Permitted Indebtedness outstanding under paragraph (h) below only, at such time) outstanding at any time and maturing not later than three hundred and sixty-five (365) calendar days after the date incurred (although any such revolving working capital facility availability period may be longer than one (1) year);

 

  (f)

incurred within ninety (90) calendar days of the completion of the acquisition of fixed or capital assets to finance or refinance the acquisition of such asset provided that such Financial Indebtedness only relates to the assets so acquired and the aggregate amount of all such Financial Indebtedness does not exceed US$250,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (g)

which is incurred pursuant to the operation of cash pooling, net balance or balance transfer arrangements made available to members of the Group provided that the aggregate amount owing by Non-Obligors to Obligors pursuant to such arrangements shall not exceed US$200,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (h)

arising in relation to the sale or disposal of receivables or inventory permitted under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Permitted Disposal” or secured on receivables or inventory provided that the aggregate amount of Financial Indebtedness outstanding at any time under all such securitisation, factoring and other working capital or other financing shall not exceed US$750,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (i)

arising under Treasury Transactions entered into on arm’s length terms and for non-speculative purposes in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (j)

under Finance Leases including sale and leaseback transactions in the ordinary course of business, provided that the aggregate capital value of all such assets so leased under outstanding leases by members of the Group does not exceed US$750,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time (less any Permitted Indebtedness outstanding under paragraph (f) of this definition only, at such time);

 

  (k)

arising under any Permitted Investment;

 

  (l)

guarantees, indemnities or counter-indemnity obligations incurred by an Obligor given in connection with Permitted Indebtedness or Financial Indebtedness that is otherwise permitted under Clause 5 (Financial Indebtedness) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) (including any guarantee, indemnity or counter-indemnity obligation which is within paragraphs (i) or (j) of the definition of “Financial Indebtedness” in respect of Financial Indebtedness of another Obligor) but, if in respect of a Non-Obligor, only as permitted under paragraph (b) of the definition of “Permitted Investment”;

 

  (m)

counter-indemnity obligations falling within paragraph (i) of the definition of “Financial Indebtedness” arising in the ordinary course of business and where the relevant guarantee, indemnity, bond, standby or documentary letter of credit or other instrument does not support or relate to Financial Indebtedness;

 

  (n)

incurred in connection with any financing or refinancing by or, insured, guaranteed or otherwise supported by, any export credit agency, any other governmental, quasi-governmental, multi-lateral, federal institution or agency, or any similar institution or agency where the terms of such financing or refinancing provide for the incurrence of such Financial Indebtedness by a subsidiary of the Company, provided that the aggregate amount of all such Financial Indebtedness does not exceed US$500,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

27


  (o)

incurred in connection with any financing or refinancing by or, insured guaranteed or otherwise supported by the European Investment Bank’s on-lending programme where the terms of such financing or refinancing provide for the incurrence of such Financial Indebtedness by a subsidiary of the Company, provided that the aggregate amount of all such Financial Indebtedness does not exceed US$100,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (p)

incurred by a wholly-owned direct Subsidiary of the Company as a co-borrower of Financial Indebtedness provided that: (A) such Financial Indebtedness is also incurred by the Company as a co-borrower, (B) the incurrence of such Financial Indebtedness by the Company is permitted pursuant to this Agreement, and (C) such Subsidiary does not carry out any manufacturing or trade activities or any other business activities (other than any activities reasonably necessary for maintaining its existence), does not have any material liabilities (other than as co-borrower of such Financial Indebtedness and obligations pursuant to the foregoing permitted business activities), and does not own any material assets (including Capital Stock, shares or other ownership interests in any company, corporation, partnership or other entity) other than as reasonably necessary for maintaining its existence; and

 

  (q)

(other than Financial Indebtedness described in paragraphs (a) to (p) above) which in aggregate does not exceed US$350,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time outstanding.

Permitted Investment” means any of the following:

 

  (a)

any acquisition or investment to the extent financed by Equity;

 

  (b)

without limiting Clause 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants), any acquisition from or investment (including any loan to, or guarantee in respect of, Financial Indebtedness of any other member of the Group) in another member of the Group provided that:

 

  (i)

the aggregate of (1) loans by Obligors to Non-Obligors and (2) guarantees by Obligors of Financial Indebtedness of Non-Obligors shall not exceed the sum of (x) US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) and (y) the amount of existing loans and guarantees made, or committed to be made, prior to the Signing Date and described in Part A of Schedule 21 (Existing Investment Commitments) (including any refinancing or replacement thereof up to the maximum amount thereof outstanding or committed as at the Signing Date) at any time; and

 

  (ii)

the aggregate of other investments made in Non-Obligors by Obligors after the Signing Date (other than (i) the China Investment; and (ii) investments already committed at the Signing Date and described in Part B of Schedule 21 (Existing Investment Commitments)) shall not exceed the aggregate of US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) in any Financial Year plus the aggregate of Equity contributed to the Group after the Signing Date and applied in such investments;

 

  (c)

any acquisition of or investments in cash or Cash Equivalent Investments;

 

  (d)

any acquisition of additional equity ownership interests in any existing Affiliate Investment;

 

28


  (e)

loans made to an employee or director of any member of the Group whether pursuant to a share option scheme or otherwise; provided that the amount of that loan when aggregated with the amount of all loans to employees and directors by any member of the Group shall not exceed US$10,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (f)

a loan, which does not constitute Financial Indebtedness, which is given or made in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (g)

any investment in an entity engaged in business reasonably related to the core business of the Group if such entity is made or becomes an Obligor within ninety (90) calendar days of such investment occurring;

 

  (h)

any acquisitions or investment which is provided for in paragraph (f) of the definition of “Permitted Disposals” or results from a transaction permitted under Clause 3 (Merger) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) (provided that such transaction is also in compliance with paragraph (b) of this definition);

 

  (i)

any refinancing, renewal or replacement of a loan or other investment outstanding on the Signing Date (up to the maximum amount thereof outstanding or committed as at the Signing Date); or

 

  (j)

acquisitions and investments not otherwise permitted by this definition, which will not cause a breach of Clause 9 (Nature of Business) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants), where the relevant consideration does not exceed in aggregate, for each Financial Year, one per cent. (1%) of Total Assets of the Group.

Permitted Security” means:

 

  (a)

any Security or Quasi-Security entered into pursuant to any Finance Document;

 

  (b)

any Security or Quasi-Security in respect of Finance Leases described in paragraph (c)(B) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”;

 

  (c)

any netting or set-off arrangement entered into in the ordinary course of the banking arrangements of the relevant member of the Group for the purpose of netting debit and credit balances, including under any cash pooling permitted under this Agreement, provided that the aggregate amount owing by Non-Obligors to Obligors under such arrangements shall not exceed US$200,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) at any time;

 

  (d)

any payment or close out netting or set-off arrangement, including section 6(f) of the 2002 ISDA Master Agreement or any provision which is similar in meaning and effect, under documentation for any Treasury Transaction entered into for the purpose of:

 

  (i)

hedging any risk to which any member of the Group is exposed in its ordinary course of business and for non-speculative purposes only; or

 

  (ii)

its interest rate or currency management operations which are carried out in the ordinary course of business and for non-speculative purposes only,

excluding, in each case, any Security or Quasi-Security under a credit support arrangement in relation to a Treasury Transaction;

 

  (e)

any Security or Quasi-Security in connection with:

 

  (i)

any securitisation, factoring or other working capital financing;

 

29


  (ii)

any financing permitted under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”; or

 

  (iii)

any disposal of receivables or inventory permitted under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Permitted Disposals”,

provided that any such Security or Quasi-Security is limited to Security or Quasi-Security over (A) the receivables or inventory that are the subject of the relevant financing, (B) shares or investments in any entity engaged solely in the business of effecting or facilitating any such financings and (C) any bank accounts or other assets of such entity;

 

  (f)

any Security arising by operation of law and in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (g)

any Security imposed by law for taxes that are not yet due or are being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings and for which appropriate reserves have been established in accordance with Approved Accounting Principles;

 

  (h)

any Security or Quasi-Security over or affecting any asset acquired after the Signing Date if:

 

  (i)

the Security or Quasi-Security was not created in contemplation of the acquisition of that asset;

 

  (ii)

the principal amount secured has not been increased in contemplation of or since the acquisition of that asset by a member of the Group; and

 

  (iii)

the Security or Quasi-Security is removed or discharged within three (3) months of the date of acquisition of such asset;

 

  (i)

any Security or Quasi-Security over or affecting any asset of any person which becomes a member of the Group after the date of this Agreement, where the Security or Quasi-Security is created prior to the date on which that person becomes a member of the Group, if:

 

  (i)

the Security or Quasi-Security was not created in contemplation of the acquisition of that person;

 

  (ii)

the principal amount secured has not increased in contemplation of or since the acquisition of that person; and

 

  (iii)

the Security or Quasi-Security is removed or discharged within three (3) calendar months of that person becoming a member of the Group;

 

  (j)

any Security or Quasi-Security arising under any retention of title, extended retention of title (verlängerter Eigentumsvorbehalt), hire purchase or conditional sale arrangement or arrangements having similar effect in respect of goods supplied in the ordinary course of business or, in the case of an extended retention of title arrangement, receivables resulting from the sale of such goods and on the supplier’s standard or usual terms and not arising as a result of any default or omission by any member of the Group;

 

  (k)

any Security or Quasi-Security in respect of Finance Lease obligations or sale and leaseback transactions in the ordinary course of business permitted pursuant to Clause 5 (Financial Indebtedness) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants);

 

  (l)

any Security in respect of purchase-money indebtedness entered into by a member of the Group (as described in paragraph (f) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”) provided that any such Security shall encumber only the assets acquired with or whose acquisition is refinanced by the proceeds of such indebtedness;

 

30


  (m)

any Security or Quasi-Security over any assets of any member of the Group securing any Financial Indebtedness (“Third Party Secured Debt”) provided that either:

 

  (i)

the same Security or Quasi-Security over the same assets has been provided to the Finance Parties and/or the Collateral Agent, as applicable, on a pari passu basis pursuant to the Collateral Trust Agreement and the Lenders have acceded thereto; or

 

  (ii)

each of the following is satisfied:

 

  (A)

the same Security or Quasi-Security over the same assets has been provided to the Finance Parties and/or the Collateral Agent, as applicable, on a pari passu basis and in form and substance satisfactory to the Lenders, and each such document is designated as a Finance Document;

 

  (B)

the Lenders and the providers of the Third Party Secured Debt, among others, have entered into a New York law-governed collateral trust agreement (or intercreditor agreement) in form and substance satisfactory to the Finance Parties acting reasonably and containing, among other things, any related appointment of a security agent or trustee in respect of the Security and Quasi-Security referred to in (A) above;

 

  (C)

the Facility Agent has customary legal opinions addressed to, or upon which reliance is permitted to, the Finance Parties in form and substance satisfactory to the Lenders from counsel to the Obligors (or, to the extent consistent with market practice in the relevant jurisdiction, counsel to the Finance Parties) with respect to the legal, valid, binding nature of the documents referred to in (A) above and the capacity and authority of any Obligor party thereto;

 

  (D)

the Facility Agent has received a certified copy of the resolution of the board of directors and shareholders resolution (to the extent required) of any Obligor party to the documents referred to in (A) above: (1) approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, such documents to which the relevant Obligor is party and resolving that it execute such documents, (2) authorising a specified person or persons to execute such documents to which the relevant Obligor is party on its behalf and (3) authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with such documents to which the relevant Obligor is party; and

 

  (E)

the Facility Agent has received a specimen of the signature of persons authorised by the resolutions referred to in paragraph (ii)(D) above and these are certified to be true and correct;

 

  (n)

any lien arising under the general terms and conditions of banks and Sparkassen (Allgemeine Geschäftsbedingungen der Banken und Sparkassen) or similar general terms and conditions of banks with whom any member of the Group maintains a banking relationship in the ordinary course of business;

 

  (o)

any landlord’s pledge (Vermieterpfandrecht) arising by operation of law under a lease in favour of the relevant third party landlord; or

 

  (p)

any Security or Quasi-Security over, or in respect of, any equipment or other assets of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC & CO. KG and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC & CO. KG in respect of Financial Indebtedness; or

 

31


  (q)

any Security or Quasi-Security securing Financial Indebtedness the principal amount of which (when aggregated with the principal amount of any other Financial Indebtedness which has the benefit of any Security or Quasi-Security other than any permitted under sub-paragraphs (a) to (p) above) does not exceed one per cent. (1.00%) of Total Assets of the Group at any time.

Projected Leverage Ratio” means, in relation to any Calculation Date falling on or prior to the Final Maturity Date, the ratio of projected Senior Debt to projected Total Capitalisation on such date (such projections in each case being made in the reasonable judgment of an authorised officer of the Company).

Prudent Industry Practice” means those practices, methods, equipment, specifications and standards of safety and performance, as the same may change from time to time, as are commonly used by foundries comparable to the relevant foundry operated by the Group as good, safe and prudent engineering practices in connection with the operation, maintenance, repair and use of electricity generation and other equipment and facilities, with commensurate standards of safety, performance, dependability, efficiency and economy.

Qualifying Lender” means:

 

  (a)

in respect of a Singapore Borrower, a Singapore Qualifying Lender;

 

  (b)

in respect of a US Borrower, a US Qualifying Lender;

 

  (c)

in respect of a German Borrower, a German Qualifying Lender; and

 

  (d)

in respect of interest payable by an Other Borrower, an Other Qualifying Lender.

Quarter Date” means each 31 March, 30 June, 30 September and 31 December.

Quasi-Security” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 1 (Negative Pledge) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants).

Quotation Day” means, in relation to any period for which an interest rate is to be determined:

 

  (a)

if the currency is the Base Currency, two (2) Business Days before the first day of that period;

 

  (b)

if the currency is Euros, two (2) TARGET Days before the first day of that period; or

 

  (c)

(for any other currency), two (2) Business Days before the first day of that period,

(unless market practice differs in the Relevant Market for that currency, in which case the Quotation Day will be determined by the Facility Agent in accordance with market practice in the Relevant Market (and if quotations would normally be given by leading banks in the Relevant Market on more than one (1) calendar day, the Quotation Day will be the last of those days)).

Reaffirmation Agreement” means a reaffirmation agreement in respect of the Collateral Trust Agreement dated on or about the date of this Agreement and executed by the relevant Obligors party to the Collateral Trust Agreement.

Reference Bank Quotation” means any quotation supplied to the Facility Agent by a Reference Bank.

Reference Bank Rate” means:

 

  (a)

the arithmetic mean of the rates (rounded upwards to four decimal places) as supplied to the Facility Agent at its request by the Reference Banks:

 

32


  (i)

in relation to LIBOR as either:

 

  (A)

if:

 

  (1)

the Reference Bank is a contributor to the applicable Screen Rate; and

 

  (2)

it consists of a single figure,

the rate (applied to the relevant Reference Bank and the relevant currency and period) which contributors to the applicable Screen Rate are asked to submit to the relevant administrator; or

 

  (B)

in any other case, the rate at which the relevant Reference Bank could fund itself in the relevant currency for the relevant period with reference to the unsecured wholesale funding market; or

 

  (ii)

in relation to EURIBOR:

 

  (A)

(other than where paragraph (B) below applies) as the rate at which the relevant Reference Bank believes one prime bank is quoting to another prime bank for interbank term deposits in Euro within the Participating Member States for the relevant period; or

 

  (B)

if different, as the rate (if any and applied to the relevant Reference Bank and the relevant period) which contributors to the applicable Screen Rate are asked to submit to the relevant administrator.

Reference Banks” means the principal London or other offices of such banks as may be appointed by the Facility Agent in consultation with the Company (provided any such bank has consented to be a Reference Bank for the purposes of this Agreement).

Related Fund” in relation to a fund (the “first fund”), means a fund which is managed or advised by the same investment manager or investment adviser as the first fund or, if it is managed by a different investment manager or investment adviser, a fund whose investment manager or investment adviser is an Affiliate of the investment manager or investment adviser of the first fund.

Relevant Market” means, in relation to the Base Currency, the London interbank market, and in relation to Euros, the European interbank market.

Renewal Request” means a written notice delivered to the Facility Agent in accordance with Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit).

Reorganisation” means a corporate reorganisation of one or more members of the Group whereby all or substantially all of the assets of one or more members of a Group are transferred to other members of the Group and the transferring entity or entities ceases or cease business or is or are dissolved.

Repeating Representations” means the representations set out in Schedule 12 (Representations) other than those set out in Clauses 4 (No Proceedings), 6 (No Default), 7 (Provision of Information), 8 (Solvency), 9 (Financial Statements), 11 (Applicable Laws), 13 (Taxes), 15 (Anti-Money Laundering), 16 (Immunity), 18 (Pari Passu Ranking) and 19 (Projections).

Replacement Lender” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 42.10 (Replacement of a Defaulting Lender).

Representative” means any delegate, agent, manager, administrator, nominee, attorney, trustee or custodian.

 

33


Resignation Letter” means a letter substantially in the form set out in Schedule 8 (Form of Resignation Letter).

Resolution Authority” means any body which has authority to exercise any Write-down and Conversion Powers.

Restricted Lender” means a Lender that notifies the Facility Agent that complying with a given Sanction would result in a violation of, a conflict with, or liability under the EU Blocking Regulation or any national law contemplating a similar anti-boycott regulation.

Retiring Guarantor” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 22.9 (Release of Guarantors’ right of contribution).

Revenues” means, in respect of a Calculation Period:

 

  (a)

in respect of the Company, the net revenues of the Company on a consolidated basis for that Calculation Period, as demonstrated by the consolidated Financial Statements for that period; and

 

  (b)

in respect of any other member of the Group, the net revenues of that member of the Group on an unconsolidated basis for that Calculation Period as demonstrated by the relevant consolidated Financial Statements for that period (but excluding intra-Group items and investments in Subsidiaries).

Revolving Facility” means the revolving credit facility made available under this Agreement as described in paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 2.1 (The Facilities).

Revolving Facility Commitment” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to an Original Lender, the amount in the Base Currency set opposite its name under the heading “Revolving Facility Commitment” in Part C (Original Lenders) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) and the amount of any other Revolving Facility Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase); and

 

  (b)

in relation to any other Lender, the amount in the Base Currency of any Revolving Facility Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase),

to the extent not cancelled, reduced or transferred by it under this Agreement.

Revolving Facility Loan” means a loan made or to be made under the Revolving Facility or the principal amount outstanding for the time being of that loan.

Revolving Facility Utilisation” means a Revolving Facility Loan or a Letter of Credit issued under the Revolving Facility.

Rollover Loan” means one or more Revolving Facility Loans:

 

  (a)

made or to be made on the same day that:

 

  (i)

a maturing Revolving Facility Loan is due to be repaid; or

 

  (ii)

a demand by the Facility Agent pursuant to a drawing in respect of a Letter of Credit issued under the Revolving Facility is due to be met;

 

34


  (b)

the aggregate amount of which is equal to or less than the amount of the maturing Revolving Facility Loan or the relevant claim in respect of that Letter of Credit issued under the Revolving Facility;

 

  (c)

in the same currency as the maturing Revolving Facility Loan (unless it arose as a result of the operation of Clause 8.2 (Unavailability of a currency)) or the relevant claim in respect of that Letter of Credit; and

 

  (d)

made or to be made to the same Borrower for the purpose of:

 

  (i)

refinancing that maturing Revolving Facility Loan; or

 

  (ii)

satisfying the relevant claim in respect of that Letter of Credit issued under the Revolving Facility.

Sanctions” means any international economic or trade sanctions adopted, administered or enforced from time to time by any of:

 

  (a)

the United Nations Security Council (the Council as a whole and not its individual members);

 

  (b)

the Office of Foreign Assets Control of the US Department of Treasury;

 

  (c)

the US Department of Commerce Bureau of Industry and Security;

 

  (d)

the US Department of State;

 

  (e)

the European Union (the Union as a whole and not its individual member states); or

 

  (f)

Her Majesty’s Treasury of the United Kingdom.

Screen Rate” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to LIBOR, the London interbank offered rate administered by ICE Benchmark Administration Limited (or any other person which takes over the administration of that rate) for the relevant currency and period displayed (before any correction, recalculation or republication by the administrator) on pages LIBOR01 or LIBOR02 of the Thomson Reuters screen (or any replacement Thomson Reuters page which displays that rate); and

 

  (b)

in relation to EURIBOR, the Euro interbank offered rate administered by the European Money Markets Institute (or any other person which takes over the administration of that rate) for the relevant period displayed (before any correction, recalculation or republication by the administrator) on page EURIBOR01 of the Thomson Reuters screen (or any replacement Thomson Reuters page which displays that rate),

or, in each case, on the appropriate page of such other information service which publishes that rate from time to time in place of Thomson Reuters. If such page or service ceases to be available, the Facility Agent may specify another page or service displaying the relevant rate after consultation with the Company.

Second Common Terms Agreement” means the common terms agreement dated 21 December 2016 (and as amended and/or restated from time to time) between, among others, the Borrower, ING Bank, N.V. as Global Facility Agent and Atradius Facility Agent and Société Générale SA as Tied Commercial Facility Agent.

Security” means a mortgage, charge, pledge, lien or other security interest securing any obligation of any person or any other agreement or arrangement having a similar effect.

 

35


Senior Debt” means, at any time, the aggregate outstanding principal or capital amount of all external, unsubordinated Financial Indebtedness of the Adjusted Group, calculated on a consolidated basis, except that:

 

  (a)

only the capitalised value of Finance Leases shall be included;

 

  (b)

the amount of a guarantee shall not be included, to the extent it relates to indebtedness already included in the calculation of Senior Debt;

 

  (c)

the aggregate amount of Cash and Cash Equivalent Investments held at such time shall be deducted other than any such Cash or Cash Equivalent Investments which would need to be counted to satisfy the covenant set out in paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) if it were to be tested at such time, in which case to the extent it would need to be so counted it will not be a deduction under this paragraph (c);

 

  (d)

Financial Indebtedness arising under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Financial Indebtedness” shall be excluded (except to the extent that it represents actual close out or early termination amounts due from the Company or another member of the Adjusted Group which has not been paid when due (or within any applicable grace period) and which are outstanding;

 

  (e)

Financial Indebtedness arising under paragraph (j) of the definition of “Financial Indebtedness” shall be excluded (but only in relation to Financial Indebtedness arising under paragraph (h) of the definition of “Financial Indebtedness”); and

 

  (f)

the aggregate outstanding principal amount of all loans from Non-Obligors to Obligors shall be included,

and so that no amount shall be included or excluded more than once.

Senior Debt Service” means the aggregate of:

 

  (a)

Net Interest for the relevant Calculation Period; and

 

  (b)

all scheduled repayments of principal under the terms of any external Financial Indebtedness of the Adjusted Group (other than any subordinated Financial Indebtedness payable solely from the proceeds of an issue of Capital Stock or Financial Indebtedness subordinated to at least the same extent as a Shareholder Loan or from the proceeds of a permitted Distribution made by the Company) falling due during that testing period:

 

  (i)

including, without limitation, all capital payments falling due in respect of any Finance Leases (to the extent not already included);

 

  (ii)

excluding any repayment or prepayment of any overdraft or revolving credit facility (including, without limitation, the Revolving Facility and any Ancillary Facility) falling due during that period and which is either capable of being simultaneously redrawn under the terms of the relevant facility or refinanced or replaced by drawings under another credit facility; and

 

  (iii)

excluding any repayment representing a lump-sum balloon repayment upon the maturity of any term Financial Indebtedness to the extent refinanced or replaced during that period by new Financial Indebtedness, Equity or other cash available to a member or members of the Group (provided that the repayment thereof would not cause the Company to breach its obligation under paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants)).

Separate Loan” has the meaning given to that term in Clause 10.1 (Repayment of Loans).

 

36


Shareholder Loans” means funding provided to the Company by its shareholders or their affiliates (other than members of the Group) in the form of subordinated shareholder debt or subordinated convertible debt, subject to one or more subordination agreements among the provider of such funding, the Facility Agent and the Company substantially in the form of the Subordination Deed or otherwise on terms acceptable to the Finance Parties, whether by way of cash or other assets.

Shareholders’ Equity” means “Shareholders’ Equity” as described in the Financial Statements of the Group.

Signing Date” means the date of this Agreement.

Singapore Borrower” means a Borrower resident for tax purposes in Singapore.

Singapore Qualifying Lender” means, in respect of interest payable by a Singapore Borrower, a Lender which is beneficially entitled to interest payable to it under a Finance Document and is:

 

  (a)

a Lender which:

 

  (i)

is a company resident in Singapore for Singapore tax purposes, or

 

  (ii)

is, or is lending through a Facility Office which is, a Singapore branch of a non-resident bank which is entitled to and has been granted a waiver, exemption or remission of Singapore withholding tax under the Income Tax Act Chapter 134 of Singapore or from the Inland Revenue Authority of Singapore on payments of interest to be made to it; or

 

  (b)

a Singapore Treaty Lender.

Singapore Treaty Lender” means a Lender which:

 

  (a)

is treated as a resident of a Singapore Treaty State for the purposes of the relevant Singapore Treaty;

 

  (b)

does not carry on a business in Singapore through a permanent establishment with which that Lender’s participation in the Loan is effectively connected; and

 

  (c)

fulfils any other conditions which must be fulfilled under the relevant Singapore Treaty by residents of the relevant Singapore Treaty State for such residents to obtain full exemption from Tax imposed on interest, including the completion of any necessary procedural formalities.

Singapore Treaty State” means a jurisdiction having an avoidance of double taxation agreement (a “Singapore Treaty”) with Singapore which makes provision for full exemption from Tax imposed by Singapore on interest.

Specified Time” means a day or a time determined in accordance with Schedule 4 (Specified Times).

Sponsor Affiliate” means any Affiliate of the Company that is not:

 

  (a)

a member of the Group; or

 

  (b)

any bank or financial institution which is regularly engaged in or established for the purpose of making purchasing or investing in loans, securities or other financial assets.

Subordinated Creditor” has the meaning given to such term in the Subordination Deed.

 

37


Subordination Deed” means the subordination deed to be entered into on or about the Signing Date in connection with the incurrence of any Shareholder Loans.

Subsidiary” means, as to any person, any other person that, at any time of determination (i) such first person owns directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, capital stock or other ownership interests having (in the absence of contingencies) ordinary voting power to elect at least a majority of the board of directors (or, persons performing similar functions) of such second person or (ii) is Controlled by such first person (save where the level of Control does not result in the second person being treated as a consolidated subsidiary in accordance with IFRS and consolidated with the Company for the purposes of its consolidated audited financial statements).

Super Majority Lenders” means, at any time, a Lender or Lenders:

 

  (a)

whose Commitments together aggregate more than sixty-six and two-thirds per cent. (6623%) of the Total Commitments; or

 

  (b)

if the Total Commitments have been reduced to zero, whose Commitments aggregated more than sixty-six and two-thirds per cent. (6623%) of the Total Commitments immediately before the reduction.

TARGET2” means the Trans-European Automated Real-time Gross Settlement Express Transfer payment system which utilises a single shared platform and which was launched on 19 November 2007.

TARGET Day” means any day on which TARGET2 is open for the settlement of payments in Euros.

Tax” means any tax, levy, impost, duty or other charge or withholding of a similar nature (including any penalty or interest payable in connection with any failure to pay or delay in paying any of the same).

Tax Credit” means a credit against, relief or remission for, or repayment of, any Tax.

Tax Deduction” means a deduction or withholding for or on account of Tax from a payment under a Finance Document, other than a FATCA Deduction.

Tax Payment” means either the increase in a payment made by an Obligor to a Finance Party under Clause 18.1 (Tax Gross-up) or a payment under Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity).

Term” means each period determined under this Agreement for which the Issuing Bank is under a liability under a Letter of Credit.

Third Common Terms Agreement” means the common terms agreement dated 2 March 2018 (as amended and/or restated from time to time) between (amongst others) GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd. as lessee and the original guarantors.

Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments” means the aggregate Additional L/C Facility Commitments, being $20,000,000 as at the Signing Date.

Total Assets” means at any time:

 

  (a)

in respect of the Group, the value of the Group’s gross assets on a consolidated basis, as shown in the latest consolidated financial statements of the Company provided pursuant to Clause 1 (Financial Statements) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants); and

 

  (b)

in respect of any member of the Group, the value of its gross assets on an unconsolidated basis, as shown in the latest consolidated financial statements of the Company provided pursuant to Clause 1 (Financial Statements) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) (but excluding intra-Group items and investments in Subsidiaries).

 

38


Total Capitalisation” means, at any date of determination, the sum of the following for the Adjusted Group on a consolidated basis, determined in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles and, for the purposes of the Leverage Ratio, as determined from the latest consolidated financial statements of the Company delivered pursuant to Clause 1 (Financial Statements) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) but adjusted to reflect (i) the amount of Senior Debt immediately prior to the date of determination and the amount of any Shareholders’ Equity (including Shareholder Loans) contributed or advanced to the Company since the date of such latest consolidated financial statements (to the extent not taken into account therein) and (ii) any transactions committed on the date of determination for the incurrence (in accordance with the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”) and/or prepayment or repayment of Senior Debt (and which shall include the transaction which has required, in accordance with the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness”, the relevant determination of Total Capitalisation to be made):

 

  (a)

Shareholders’ Equity (including Shareholder Loans); plus

 

  (b)

the amount of surplus and retained earnings of the Adjusted Group (or, in the case of a surplus or retained earnings deficit, minus the amount of such deficit); plus

 

  (c)

the Senior Debt.

Total Commitments” means the aggregate of the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments and the Total Revolving Facility Commitments of all the Lenders.

Total Revolving Facility Commitments” means the aggregate Revolving Facility Commitments, being $235,000,000 as at the Signing Date.

Transaction Security” means the Security created or expressed to be created in favour of the Collateral Trustee pursuant to the Transaction Security Documents.

Transaction Security Discharge Date” means the first date on which all of the Transaction Security has been released.

Transaction Security Documents” means:

 

  (a)

the deed of pledge of shares executed on 30 October 2018 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V. (as the Company);

 

  (b)

the deed of pledge of shares executed on 31 July 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V. (as the Company);

 

  (c)

the agreement and deed of pledge of cooperative membership interests executed on 30 October 2018 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC (as the Pledgors), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Cooperative);

 

  (d)

the agreement and deed of pledge of cooperative membership interests executed on 31 July 2019 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC (as the Pledgors), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Cooperative);

 

39


  (e)

the deed of pledge of shares executed on 30 October 2018 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V. (as the Company);

 

  (f)

the deed of pledge of shares executed on 31 July 2019, between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V. (as the Company);

 

  (g)

the German law governed share and interest pledge agreement dated 5 June 2019 and entered into among, inter alios, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V., GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG as pledgors and Wilmington Trust, National Association as collateral trustee and pledgee regarding the pledge of all current and future shares and partnership interests (as the case may be) in GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH, GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG, and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG (roll of deeds no. 188/2019 of the notary Dr. Carsten J. Angersbach in Frankfurt am Main);

 

  (h)

the Singapore law governed share charge dated 30 October 2018 (as supplemented by the supplemental share charge dated 5 June 2019), entered into between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and the Collateral Agent;

 

  (i)

the Closing Date Security Documents;

 

  (j)

the Dutch CS Security Documents;

 

  (k)

any other document entered into by any Obligor creating or expressed to create any Security over all or any part of its assets in respect of the obligations of any of the Obligors under any of the Finance Documents; and

 

  (l)

any other document entered into by any entity creating or expressed to create any Security over all or any part of its assets which forms part of the Collateral (as such term is defined in the Collateral Trust Agreement) for the purposes of the Collateral Trust Agreement and which the Lenders have the benefit of as secured creditors.

Transfer Certificate” means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 5 (Form of Transfer Certificate) or any other form agreed between the Facility Agent and the Company.

Transfer Date” means, in relation to an assignment or a transfer, the later of:

 

  (a)

the proposed Transfer Date specified in the relevant Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate; and

 

  (b)

the date on which the Facility Agent executes the relevant Assignment Agreement or Transfer Certificate.

Treasury Transaction” means any derivative transaction entered into in connection with protection against or benefit from fluctuation in any rate or price.

 

40


UK Bail-In Legislation” means (to the extent that the United Kingdom is not an EEA Member Country which has implemented, or implements, Article 55 BRRD) Part I of the United Kingdom Banking Act 2009 and any other law or regulation applicable in the United Kingdom relating to the resolution of unsound or failing banks, investment firms or other financial institutions or their affiliates (otherwise than through liquidation, administration or other insolvency proceedings).

Unpaid Sum” means any sum due and payable but unpaid by an Obligor under the Finance Documents.

Up-stream Guarantee” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (b)(i) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

US” and “United States” means the United States of America, its territories, possessions and other areas subject to the jurisdiction of the United States of America.

US Borrower” means a Borrower that is incorporated or organised under the laws of the United States of America, any state or territory thereof or the District of Columbia.

US Debtor Relief Laws” means the US Bankruptcy Code and all other liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, assignment for the benefit of creditors, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, judicial management or similar debtor relief laws of the United States from time to time in effect and affecting the rights of creditors generally.

US Guarantor” has the meaning given to that term in paragraph (c) of Clause 22.11 (Guarantee limitations).

US Obligor” means any US Borrower or US Guarantor.

US Qualifying Lender” means, in respect of amounts payable by a US Borrower, a Lender which, under the law in effect as of the date it became a party to this Agreement: (a) is entitled to a complete exemption from withholding of US federal income tax on interest payable to it under this Agreement; and (b) has supplied to the relevant US Borrower a properly completed and executed applicable US Tax Form evidencing such exemption.

US Tax Form” means:

 

  (a)

with respect to any Lender that is a US Person, a properly completed and executed IRS Form W-9, or any successor or other form prescribed by the IRS, certifying that such Lender is a US Person and is not subject to US backup withholding tax on payments made by US Obligor to such Lender under this Agreement;

 

  (b)

with respect to any Lender that is not a US Person:

 

  (i)

in the case of a Lender claiming the benefits of an exemption from or reduction in US federal withholding tax pursuant to a double taxation agreement between the US and the jurisdiction of which such Lender is or is treated as a resident, a properly completed and duly executed IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E, as applicable, or any successor or other form prescribed by the IRS, certifying that such Lender is exempt from or entitled to a reduced rate of US federal withholding tax under an applicable double taxation agreement or treaty on payments made by a US Obligor to such Lender under this Agreement;

 

  (ii)

in the case of a Lender claiming the benefits of an exemption from US federal withholding tax because payments made by a US Obligor otherwise subject to such withholding tax are effectively connected with the Lender’s conduct of a trade or business within the US, a properly completed and duly executed IRS Form W-8ECI, or any successor or other form prescribed by the IRS, certifying that such interest payments are effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the US;

 

41


  (iii)

in the case of a Lender claiming the benefits of the exemption from US federal withholding tax pursuant to Section 881(c) of the Code with respect to payments of portfolio interest made by a US Obligor to such Lender under this Agreement, (1) a certificate to the effect that such Lender is (x) not a “bank” referred to in Section 881(c)(3)(A) of the Code, (y) not a ten per cent. (10%) shareholder of any Obligor (within the meaning of Section 881(c)(3)(B) of the Code), and (z) not a controlled foreign corporation related to any Obligor (as such term is described in Section 881(c)(3)(C) of the Code), and (2) a properly completed and duly executed copy of IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E, as applicable, or any successor or other form prescribed by the IRS, certifying that such Lender is not a US Person; or

 

  (iv)

in the case of a Lender that is a (D) foreign intermediary or foreign flow-through entity for US federal income tax purposes, a properly completed and duly executed IRS Form W-8IMY or any successor or other form prescribed by the IRS, as a basis for claiming exemption from or reduction in US federal withholding tax on interest payments made by the relevant US Obligor to such Lender under this Agreement, together with any supplementary information such Lender is required to transmit with such form and, in the case of a non-qualified intermediary that is a Lender or a non-withholding Lender that is a foreign flow-through entity, with respect to each beneficiary or member of such Lender, two forms or certificates described in sub-clause (i), (ii) or (iii) above, as applicable; or

 

  (c)

any other form prescribed by Applicable Law as a basis for claiming exemption from or a reduction in US federal withholding tax, duly completed, together with such supplementary documentation as may be prescribed by Applicable Law to permit the US Obligor to determine the withholding or deduction required to be made.

Each Lender agrees that if any form or certification it previously delivered expires or becomes obsolete in any respect, it shall update such form or certification or promptly notify the US Obligor in writing of its legal inability to do so.

US Tax Obligor” means:

 

  (a)

the Company to the extent it is resident for tax purposes in the US; or

 

  (b)

an Obligor some or all of whose payments under the Finance Documents are from sources within the US for US federal income tax purposes.

USA Patriot Act” means the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, Public Law 107-56.

US Person” shall have the meaning specified in Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code for “United States person” and shall include any disregarded entity (for US federal income tax purposes) of any such person.

Utilisation” means a Loan or a Letter of Credit.

Utilisation Date” means the date of a Utilisation, being the date on which the relevant Loan is to be made or the relevant Letter of Credit is to be issued.

Utilisation Request” means a notice substantially in the relevant form set out in Schedule 3 (Requests and Notices).

VAT” means:

 

  (a)

any tax imposed in compliance with the Council Directive of 28 November 2006 on the common system of value added tax (EC Directive 2006/112); and

 

42


  (b)

any other tax of a similar nature, whether imposed in a member state of the European Union in substitution for, or levied in addition to, such tax referred to in paragraph (a) above, or imposed elsewhere.

Voting Rights” means, in relation to a Lender, any of its rights and obligations under any Finance Document, including all rights under this Agreement in relation to waivers, consents modifications and amendments and confirmations as to satisfaction of conditions precedent.

Write-down and Conversion Powers” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to any Bail-In Legislation described in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule from time to time, the powers described as such in relation to that Bail-In Legislation in the EU Bail-In Legislation Schedule;

 

  (b)

in relation to any other applicable Bail-In Legislation:

 

  (i)

any powers under that Bail-In Legislation to cancel, transfer or dilute shares issued by a person that is a bank or investment firm or other financial institution or affiliate of a bank, investment firm or other financial institution, to cancel, reduce, modify or change the form of a liability of such a person or any contract or instrument under which that liability arises, to convert all or part of that liability into shares, securities or obligations of that person or any other person, to provide that any such contract or instrument is to have effect as if a right had been exercised under it or to suspend any obligation in respect of that liability or any of the powers under that Bail-In Legislation that are related to or ancillary to any of those powers; and

 

  (ii)

any similar or analogous powers under that Bail-In Legislation; and

 

  (c)

in relation to any UK Bail-In Legislation:

 

  (i)

any powers under that UK Bail-In Legislation to cancel, transfer or dilute shares issued by a person that is a bank or investment firm or other financial institution or affiliate of a bank, investment firm or other financial institution, to cancel, reduce, modify or change the form of a liability of such a person or any contract or instrument under which that liability arises, to convert all or part of that liability into shares, securities or obligations of that person or any other person, to provide that any such contract or instrument is to have effect as if a right had been exercised under it or to suspend any obligation in respect of that liability or any of the powers under that UK Bail-In Legislation that are related to or ancillary to any of those powers; and

 

  (ii)

any similar or analogous powers under that UK Bail-In Legislation.

 

1.2

Construction

 

  (a)

Unless a contrary indication appears a reference in this Agreement to:

 

  (i)

a document in “agreed form” is a document which is previously agreed in writing by or on behalf of the Company and the Facility Agent or, if not so agreed, is in the form specified by the Facility Agent;

 

  (ii)

“assets” includes present and future properties, revenues and rights of every description;

 

  (iii)

“director” or “managing director” includes any statutory legal representative(s) (organschaftlicher Vertreter) of a person pursuant to the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation, including but not limited to, in relation to a person incorporated or established in Germany, a managing director (Geschäftsführer) or member of the board of directors (Vorstand);

 

43


  (iv)

a “Lender”, any “Finance Party”, the “Facility Agent”, any “Issuing Bank”, any “Obligor”, any “Party” or any other person shall be construed so as to include its successors in title, permitted assigns and permitted transferees to, or of, its rights and/or obligations under the Finance Documents;

 

  (v)

a “Finance Document” or any other agreement or instrument is a reference to that Finance Document or other agreement or instrument as amended (however fundamentally), novated, supplemented, extended, restated or replaced from time to time (whether or not such amendment, novation, supplement, extension, restatement or replacement contemplated as at the Signing Date), and including cases where the amendments concerned involve an increase, extension or other change (however great) to any facility or the grant of any additional facility (however great);

 

  (vi)

“guarantee” means (other than in Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity)) any guarantee, letter of credit, bond, indemnity or similar assurance against loss, or any obligation, direct or indirect, actual or contingent, to purchase or assume any indebtedness of any person or to make an investment in or loan to any person or to purchase assets of any person where, in each case, such obligation is assumed in order to maintain or assist the ability of such person to meet its indebtedness;

 

  (vii)

“include”, “includes” and “including” shall be construed without limitation;

 

  (viii)

“indebtedness” includes any obligation (whether incurred as principal or as surety) for the payment or repayment of money, whether present or future, actual or contingent;

 

  (ix)

the “Interest Period” of a Letter of Credit shall be construed as a reference to the Term of that Letter of Credit;

 

  (x)

a Lender’s “participation” in relation to a Letter of Credit, shall be construed as a reference to the relevant amount that is or may be payable by a Lender in relation to that Letter of Credit;

 

  (xi)

a “person” includes any individual, firm, company, corporation, government, state or agency of a state or any association, unincorporated organisation, trust, governmental authority, partnership (whether or not having separate legal personality) of two or more of the foregoing joint venture or other entity;

 

  (xii)

a “quarter” is a reference to each consecutive period of approximately three (3) calendar months in each Financial Year commencing on or about 1 January or as otherwise agreed in accordance with the terms hereof and “quarterly” shall be construed correspondingly;

 

  (xiii)

a “transferee” means a person to which another person seeks to assign and transfer all or part of its rights, benefits and obligations;

 

  (xiv)

a Utilisation made or to be made to a Borrower includes a Letter of Credit issued on its behalf;

 

  (xv)

a provision of law, statute or treaty is a reference to that provision as amended or re-enacted; and

 

  (xvi)

a time of day is a reference to London time except where specifically provided otherwise.

 

44


  (b)

The determination of the extent to which a rate is “for a period equal in length” to an Interest Period shall disregard any inconsistency arising from the last day of that Interest Period being determined pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

 

  (c)

References to paragraphs, Clauses and Schedules are references to paragraphs, clauses and schedules of this Agreement unless stated otherwise.

 

  (d)

Clause and Schedule headings are for ease of reference only.

 

  (e)

Unless a contrary indication appears, a term used in any other Finance Document or in any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document has the same meaning in that Finance Document or notice as in this Agreement.

 

  (f)

A Borrower providing “cash cover” for a Letter of Credit or an Ancillary Facility means a Borrower paying an amount in the currency of the Letter of Credit (or, as the case may be, Ancillary Facility) to an interest-bearing account in the name of the Borrower and the following conditions being met:

 

  (i)

the account is with the Issuing Bank or Ancillary Lender for which that cash cover is to be provided;

 

  (ii)

subject to paragraph (b) of Clause 7.6 (Regulation and consequences of cash cover provided by Borrower), until no amount is or may be outstanding under that Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility, withdrawals from the account may only be made to pay the relevant Finance Party amounts due and payable to it under this Agreement in respect of that Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility; and

 

  (iii)

if requested by the relevant Issuing Bank or Ancillary Lender (as the case may be), the Borrower has executed a security document over that account, in form and substance satisfactory to the Finance Party with which that account is held, creating a first ranking security interest over that account.

 

  (g)

A Default or an Event of Default is “continuing” if it has not been remedied or waived in writing by the Facility Agent.

 

  (h)

A Borrower “repaying” or “prepaying” a Letter of Credit or Ancillary Outstandings means:

 

  (i)

that Borrower providing cash cover for that Letter of Credit or in respect of the Ancillary Outstandings;

 

  (ii)

in the case of a Letter of Credit, that Borrower has made a payment of that amount under paragraph (b) of Clause 7.2 (Claims under a Letter of Credit) in respect of that Letter of Credit or that Borrower has made a reimbursement of that amount in respect of that Letter of Credit under Clause 7.3 (Indemnities);

 

  (iii)

the maximum amount payable under the Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility being reduced or cancelled in accordance with its terms;

 

  (iv)

the Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility (as the case may be) expires in accordance with its terms or is otherwise returned by the beneficiary to the Issuing Bank with its written confirmation that it is released and cancelled;

 

  (v)

a bank or financial institution having a long-term credit rating from any of Moody’s, S&P or Fitch at least equal to BBB+/Baa1 (as applicable or such other rating as the Facility Agent and the applicable Issuing Bank or Ancillary Lender (as the case may be) may agree), or by any other institution satisfactory to the applicable Issuing Bank having issued an unconditional and irrevocable guarantee, indemnity, counter-indemnity or similar assurance against financial loss in respect of all amounts due under that Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility (as the case may be); or

 

45


  (vi)

the Issuing Bank or Ancillary Lender being satisfied that it has no further liability under that Letter of Credit or Ancillary Facility,

and the amount by which a Letter of Credit is, or Ancillary Outstandings are, repaid or prepaid under paragraphs (i) to (v) above is the amount of the relevant cash cover, payment, reduction, cancellation or assurance.

 

  (i)

An amount borrowed includes any amount utilised by way of Letter of Credit or under an Ancillary Facility.

 

  (j)

A Lender funding its participation in a Utilisation includes a Lender participating in a Letter of Credit.

 

  (k)

Amounts outstanding under this Agreement include amounts outstanding under or in respect of any Letter of Credit.

 

  (l)

An outstanding amount of a Letter of Credit at any time is the maximum amount that is or may be payable by the relevant Borrower in respect of that Letter of Credit at that time.

 

  (m)

A Borrower’s obligation on Utilisations becoming “due and payable” includes the Borrower repaying any Letter of Credit in accordance with paragraph (h) above.

 

  (n)

The singular includes the plural and vice versa.

 

  (o)

Except where specifically provided otherwise, each of the permissions included in the definitions of Permitted Disposals, Permitted Security, Permitted Indebtedness and Permitted Investments are separate and if any disposition, Security or Quasi-Security, Financial Indebtedness or acquisition or investment could fall within more than one paragraph of the relevant definition then the Company shall select which paragraph it shall fall into and it shall not reduce or use a basket under any other paragraph.

 

  (p)

For all purposes under the Finance Documents, in connection with any division or plan of division under Delaware law (or any comparable event under a different jurisdiction’s laws):

 

  (i)

if any asset, right, obligation or liability of any Person becomes the asset, right, obligation or liability of a different Person, then it shall be deemed to have been transferred from the original Person to the subsequent Person; and

 

  (ii)

if any new Person comes into existence, such new Person shall be deemed to have been organized on the first date of its existence by the holders of its shares at such time.

 

1.3

Currency Symbols and Definitions

 

  (a)

EUR”, “” and “Euro” means the single currency of the Participating Member States.

 

  (b)

USD”, “US$” and “Dollars” denote the lawful currency of the United States of America.

 

1.4

Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999

 

  (a)

A person who is not a Party has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 to enforce or enjoy the benefit of any term or condition of this Agreement unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document.

 

46


  (b)

Subject to paragraph (a) of Clause 42.4 (Other exceptions) but otherwise notwithstanding any term of any Finance Document, the consent of any person who is not a Party is not required to rescind or vary this Agreement at any time.

 

1.5

Fluctuations in exchange rates

For the avoidance of doubt, for the purposes of Schedule 12 (Representations), Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants), Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) or Schedule 16 (Events of Default) (and, in each case, the related definitions) but excluding any Event of Default resulting from a breach of Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) (and related definitions), a reference to an amount (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) shall be determined by reference to the rate of exchange on the date of incurrence or making of a particular disposal, acquisition, investment, lease, loan, debt or guarantee or taking any other relevant action and any subsequent exchange rate fluctuation shall not cause an Event of Default or the breach of any provision of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants), Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) or misrepresentation in respect of any provision of Schedule 12 (Representations).

 

1.6

Calculation of baskets

If any of the baskets set forth in the definitions of Permitted Disposal, Permitted Investment or Permitted Security are exceeded solely as a result of fluctuations to Total Assets as set out in the financial statements delivered after the time when such baskets were calculated in connection with the relevant activity, such basket(s) will not be deemed to have been exceeded solely as a result of such fluctuations.

 

2.

THE FACILITIES

 

2.1

The Facilities

 

  (a)

Subject to the terms of this Agreement, the Lenders make available to the Company:

 

  (i)

a letter of credit facility in an aggregate amount the Base Currency Amount of which is equal to the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments; and

 

  (ii)

a multicurrency revolving credit facility in an aggregate amount the Base Currency Amount of which is equal to the Total Revolving Facility Commitments.

 

  (b)

The Revolving Facility will be available to the Company and each Approved Borrower under the Revolving Facility.

 

  (c)

The Additional L/C Facility will be available to the Company, GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. and each Approved Borrower under the Additional L/C Facility.

 

  (d)

Subject to the terms of this Agreement and the Ancillary Documents, an Ancillary Lender may make all or part of its Revolving Facility Commitment available to any Borrower as an Ancillary Facility.

 

2.2

Increase

 

  (a)

The Company may by giving prior notice to the Facility Agent after the effective date of a cancellation of:

 

  (i)

the Available Commitments of a Defaulting Lender in accordance with Clause 11.6 (Right of cancellation in relation to a Defaulting Lender); or

 

  (ii)

the Commitments of a Lender in accordance with:

 

47


  (A)

Clause 11.1 (Illegality); or

 

  (B)

paragraph (a) of Clause 11.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender or Issuing Bank),

request that the Commitments relating to any Facility be increased (and the Commitments relating to that Facility shall be so increased) in an aggregate amount up to the amount of the Available Commitments or Commitments relating to that Facility so cancelled as follows:

 

  (C)

the increased Commitments will be assumed by one or more Lenders or other banks or financial institutions (each an “Increase Lender”) selected by the Company (each of which shall not be a member of the Group and which is further acceptable to the Facility Agent (acting reasonably)) and each of which confirms in writing (whether in the relevant Increase Confirmation or otherwise) its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations of a Lender corresponding to that part of the increased Commitments which it is to assume, as if it had been an Original Lender in respect of those Commitments;

 

  (D)

each of the Obligors and any Increase Lender shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights against one another as the Obligors and the Increase Lender would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender in respect of that part of the increased Commitments which it is to assume;

 

  (E)

each Increase Lender shall become a Party as a “Lender” hereunder and any Increase Lender and each of the other Finance Parties shall assume obligations towards one another and acquire rights against one another as that Increase Lender and those Finance Parties would have assumed and/or acquired had the Increase Lender been an Original Lender in respect of that part of the increased Commitments which it is to assume;

 

  (F)

the Commitments of the other Lenders shall continue in full force and effect; and

 

  (G)

any increase in the Commitments relating to a Facility shall take effect on the date specified by the Company in the notice referred to above or any later date on which the Facility Agent executes an otherwise duly completed Increase Confirmation delivered to it by the relevant Increase Lender.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall, subject to paragraph (c) below, as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt by it of a duly completed Increase Confirmation appearing on its face to comply with the terms of this Agreement and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, execute that Increase Confirmation.

 

  (c)

The Facility Agent shall only be obliged to execute an Increase Confirmation delivered to it by an Increase Lender once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assumption of the increased Commitments by that Increase Lender, the completion of which the Facility Agent shall promptly notify to the Company and the Increase Lender.

 

  (d)

The consent of the relevant Issuing Bank is required for an increase in the Total Revolving Facility Commitments or the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments (as applicable).

 

48


  (e)

Each Increase Lender, by executing the Increase Confirmation, confirms (for the avoidance of doubt) that the Facility Agent has authority to execute on its behalf any amendment or waiver that has been approved by or on behalf of the requisite Lender or Lenders in accordance with this Agreement on or prior to the date on which the increase becomes effective in accordance with this Agreement and that it is bound by that decision to the same extent as it would have been had it been an Original Lender.

 

  (f)

The Company shall promptly on demand pay the Facility Agent the amount of all reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) reasonably incurred by it in connection with any increase in Commitments under this Clause 2.2.

 

  (g)

The Increase Lender shall, on the date upon which the increase takes effect, pay to the Facility Agent (for its own account) a fee in an amount equal to the fee which would be payable under Clause 29.4 (Assignment or transfer fee) if the increase was a transfer pursuant to Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) and if the Increase Lender was a New Lender.

 

  (h)

The Company may pay to the Increase Lender a fee in the amount and at the times agreed between the Company and the Increase Lender in a Fee Letter.

 

  (i)

Neither the Facility Agent nor any Lender shall have any obligation to find an Increase Lender and in no event shall any Lender whose Commitment is replaced by an Increase Lender be required to pay or surrender any of the fees received by such Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents.

 

  (j)

Clause 29.5 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders) shall apply mutatis mutandis in this Clause 2.2 in relation to an Increase Lender as if references in that Clause to:

 

  (i)

an “Existing Lender” were references to all the Lenders immediately prior to the relevant increase;

 

  (ii)

the “New Lender” were references to that “Increase Lender”; and

 

  (iii)

a “re-transfer” and “re-assignment” were references to respectively a “transfer” and “assignment”.

 

2.3

Finance Parties’ rights and obligations

 

  (a)

The obligations of each Finance Party under the Finance Documents are several. Failure by a Finance Party to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents does not affect the obligations of any other Party under the Finance Documents. No Finance Party is responsible for the obligations of any other Finance Party under the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

The rights of each Finance Party under or in connection with the Finance Documents are separate and independent rights and any debt arising under the Finance Documents to a Finance Party from an Obligor is a separate and independent debt in respect of which a Finance Party shall be entitled to enforce its rights in accordance with paragraph (c) below. The rights of each Finance Party include any debt owing to that Finance Party under the Finance Documents and, for the avoidance of doubt, any part of a Loan or any other amount owed by an Obligor which relates to a Finance Party’s participation in a Facility or its role under a Finance Document (including any such amount payable to the Facility Agent on its behalf) is a debt owing to that Finance Party by that Obligor.

 

  (c)

A Finance Party may, except as specifically provided in the Finance Documents, separately enforce its rights under or in connection with the Finance Documents.

 

49


2.4

Obligors’ Agent

 

  (a)

Each Obligor (other than the Company) by its execution of this Agreement or an Accession Deed irrevocably appoints the Company (acting through one or more authorised signatories) to act on its behalf as its agent in relation to the Finance Documents and irrevocably authorises:

 

  (i)

the Company on its behalf to supply all information concerning itself contemplated by this Agreement to the Finance Parties and to give all notices and instructions (including, in the case of a Borrower, Utilisation Requests), to execute on its behalf any other agreement and to effect the relevant amendments, supplements and variations capable of being given, made or effected by any Obligor notwithstanding that they may affect the Obligor, without further reference to or the consent of that Obligor; and

 

  (ii)

each Finance Party to give any notice, demand or other communication to that Obligor pursuant to the Finance Documents to the Company,

and in each case the Obligor shall be bound as though the Obligor itself had given the notices and instructions (including, without limitation, any Utilisation Requests) or executed or made the agreements or effected the amendments, supplements or variations, or received the relevant notice, demand or other communication. For this purpose each Obligor incorporated in Germany releases the Company to the fullest extent possible from the restrictions of Section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch).

 

  (b)

Every act, omission, agreement, undertaking, settlement, waiver, amendment, supplement, variation, notice or other communication given or made by the Obligors’ Agent or given to the Obligors’ Agent under any Finance Document on behalf of another Obligor or in connection with any Finance Document (whether or not known to any other Obligor and whether occurring before or after such other Obligor became an Obligor under any Finance Document) shall be binding for all purposes on that Obligor as if that Obligor had expressly made, given or concurred with it. In the event of any conflict between any notices or other communications of the Obligors’ Agent and any other Obligor, those of the Obligors’ Agent shall prevail.

 

3.

PURPOSE

 

3.1

Purpose

 

  (a)

Each Borrower shall apply all amounts borrowed by it under the Revolving Facility in or towards the general corporate and working capital purposes of the Group including, without restriction:

 

  (i)

refinancing and/or repayment or replacement of any existing revolving credit facilities or other existing debt or credit arrangements (including, without limitation, letters of credit, bank guarantees and other similar bond or instruments);

 

  (ii)

financing or refinancing any transaction costs, taxes, original issue discount, premium, repayment costs, break costs, fees, flex and any other costs or expenses; and/or

 

  (iii)

financing or refinancing existing indebtedness of the Group and any associated fees, costs, taxes or expenses (including any breakage costs, issue discount, redemption premium, make whole costs and other fees) related to or incurred or charged in connection therewith and related financing costs and/or the Finance Documents; and/or

 

50


  (iv)

any capital expenditure of the Group; and/or

 

  (v)

any acquisitions of any assets, shares or businesses permitted under this Agreement.

 

  (b)

Each Borrower shall only request Letters of Credit to be issued under the Additional L/C Facility in connection with the general corporate and working capital purposes of the Group or any other activities in the ordinary course of business of any member of the Group.

 

3.2

Monitoring

No Finance Party is bound to monitor or verify the application of any amount borrowed pursuant to this Agreement.

 

4.

CONDITIONS OF UTILISATION

 

4.1

Initial conditions precedent

 

  (a)

The Lenders will only be obliged to comply with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation) or Clause 6.5 (Issue of Letters of Credit) in relation to any Utilisation to be advanced on the Closing Date if on or before that Utilisation Date, the Facility Agent has received all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part A of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent) in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Facility Agent (acting upon the instructions of (A) each of the Original Lenders under the Revolving Facility and (B) each of the Original Lenders under the Additional L/C Facility), or the Facility Agent has (acting upon the instructions of each of the relevant Original Lenders) waived the requirement of receipt of such documents or evidence which have not been received and the Facility Agent shall notify the Company and the Lenders promptly upon being so satisfied.

 

  (b)

Other than to the extent that the Majority L/C Lenders or Majority RCF Lenders (as applicable) notify the Facility Agent in writing to the contrary before the Facility Agent gives a notification described in paragraph (a) above, the Lenders under the relevant Facility authorise (but do not require) the Facility Agent to give that notification. The Facility Agent shall not be liable for any damages, costs or losses whatsoever as a result of giving any such notification.

 

4.2

Further conditions precedent

Subject to Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent), the Lenders will only be obliged to comply with Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ participation), if on the date of the Utilisation Request and on the proposed Utilisation Date:

 

  (a)

other than in the case of a Rollover Loan, no Default is continuing or would result from the proposed Utilisation;

 

  (b)

in the case of a Rollover Loan, no Event of Default is continuing; and

 

  (c)

other than in the case of a Rollover Loan, the Repeating Representations are true and accurate in all material respects by reference to the facts and circumstances then subsisting.

 

4.3

Conditions relating to Optional Currencies

 

  (a)

A currency will constitute an Optional Currency in relation to a Utilisation if:

 

  (i)

it is Euro; or

 

  (ii)

it:

 

51


  (A)

is readily available in the amount required and freely convertible into the Base Currency in the wholesale market for that currency on the Quotation Day and the Utilisation Date for that Utilisation;

 

  (B)

has been requested of the Facility Agent at least five (5) Business Days prior to the date of the relevant Utilisation Request; and

 

  (C)

has been approved by the Facility Agent (in both its capacity as such and acting on the instructions of all the Lenders under the relevant Facility) on or prior to receipt by the Facility Agent of the relevant Utilisation Request for that Utilisation.

 

  (b)

If the Facility Agent has received a written request from the Company for a currency to be approved under paragraph (a)(ii)(C) above, the Facility Agent will confirm to the Company by the Specified Time:

 

  (i)

whether or not each of it and the relevant Lenders have granted their approval; and

 

  (ii)

if approval has been granted, the minimum amount for any subsequent Utilisation in that currency.

 

4.4

Maximum number of Utilisations

 

  (a)

A Borrower (or the Company) may not deliver a Utilisation Request if as a result of the proposed Utilisation:

 

  (i)

more than twenty (20) Letters of Credit would be outstanding in respect of the Additional L/C Facility; or

 

  (ii)

more than twelve (12) Utilisations would be outstanding in respect of the Revolving Facility.

 

  (b)

Any Loan made by a single Lender under Clause 8.2 (Unavailability of a currency) shall not be taken into account in this Clause 4.4.

 

  (c)

Any Separate Loan shall not be taken into account in this Clause 4.4.

 

4.5

Approved Borrowers

 

  (a)

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, no Borrower (other than the Company or GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. in respect of the Additional L/C Facility only) may utilise a Facility unless each Original Lender that is a Lender in respect of that Facility upon submission of the relevant Utilisation Request has notified the Company and the Facility Agent in writing (an “Approval Notice”) that it has obtained all necessary internal or external approvals to lend to that Borrower or otherwise participate in any Utilisation under that Facility by or on behalf of that Borrower.

 

  (b)

An Approval Notice shall not be duly completed unless it identifies the relevant Borrower to be approved and the Facility to which such approval relates.

 

  (c)

The delivery of an Approval Notice shall be in each Original Lender’s sole discretion.

 

  (d)

Once the Facility Agent has, in respect of a Borrower received Approval Notices in respect of that Borrower from each Original Lender that is a Lender under the relevant Facility, the relevant Borrower shall be an Approved Borrower in respect of that Facility and the Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Company and the Lenders that such Borrower is an Approved Borrower under that Facility.

 

52


  (e)

This Clause 4.5 shall not apply to the establishment or utilisation of any Ancillary Facility.

 

5.

UTILISATION – LOANS

 

5.1

Delivery of a Utilisation Request

Subject to the terms of this Agreement, a Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) may utilise the Revolving Facility by delivering to the Facility Agent a duly completed Utilisation Request not later than the Specified Time.

 

5.2

Completion of a Utilisation Request

 

  (a)

Each Utilisation Request is irrevocable and will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless:

 

  (i)

it identifies the Facility to be utilised, which shall be the Revolving Facility;

 

  (ii)

it identifies the Borrower, which shall be the Company or an Approved Borrower under the Revolving Facility;

 

  (iii)

the proposed Utilisation Date is a Business Day which falls within the Availability Period applicable to that Facility;

 

  (iv)

the currency and amount of the Loan(s) comply with Clause 5.3 (Currency and Amount); and

 

  (v)

the proposed Interest Period complies with Clause 15 (Interest Periods).

 

  (b)

Multiple Loans may be requested in a Utilisation Request where the proposed Utilisation Date is the Closing Date. Only one Loan may be requested in each subsequent Utilisation Request.

 

5.3

Currency and amount

 

  (a)

The currency specified in a Utilisation Request must be the Base Currency or an Optional Currency.

 

  (b)

The amount of a proposed Utilisation must be:

 

  (i)

if the currency selected is the Base Currency, not less than US$ 1,000,000 (and thereafter in integral multiples of $1,000,000) or, if less, the Available Facility;

 

  (ii)

if the currency selected is Euro, not less than EUR 1,000,000 (and thereafter in integral multiples of €1,000,000) or, if less, the Available Facility; or

 

  (iii)

if the currency selected is an Optional Currency, the minimum amount specified by the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (b)(ii) of Clause 4.3 (Conditions relating to Optional Currencies) or, if less, the Available Facility.

 

5.4

Lenders’ participation

 

  (a)

Subject to the terms of this Agreement, and subject to Clause 4.5 (Approved Borrowers) and Clause 10.1 (Repayment of Loans), each Lender shall make available its participation in each Loan through its Facility Office if on the date of the Utilisation Request each of the conditions in Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent) is satisfied or waived.

 

53


  (b)

Other than as set out in paragraph (c) below, the amount of each Lender’s participation in each Loan under a Facility will be equal to the proportion borne by its Available Commitment to the Available Facility in respect of that Facility immediately prior to making the Loan.

 

  (c)

If a Revolving Facility Utilisation is made to repay Ancillary Outstandings, each Lender’s participation in that Utilisation will be in an amount (as determined by the Facility Agent) which will result as nearly as possible in the aggregate amount of its participation in the Revolving Facility Utilisations then outstanding bearing the same proportion to the aggregate amount of the Revolving Facility Utilisations then outstanding as its Revolving Facility Commitment bears to the Total Revolving Facility Commitments.

 

  (d)

The Facility Agent shall determine the Base Currency Amount of each Revolving Facility Loan which is to be made in an Optional Currency and notify each Lender of the amount, currency and the Base Currency Amount of each Loan, the amount of its participation in that Loan and, if different, the amount of that participation to be made available in accordance with Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent) by the Specified Time.

 

  (e)

The Facility Agent shall notify each Lender of the amount of such Lender’s participation in each Loan by the Specified Time on the date falling three (3) Business Days before the proposed Utilisation Date.

 

5.5

Limitations on Utilisations

 

  (a)

The maximum aggregate Base Currency Amount of all Letters of Credit issued under:

 

  (i)

the Revolving Facility shall not exceed the Total Revolving Facility Commitments; and

 

  (ii)

the Additional L/C Facility shall not exceed the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments.

 

  (b)

The maximum aggregate amount of the Ancillary Commitments of all the Lenders shall not at any time exceed the Total Revolving Facility Commitments.

 

5.6

Cancellation of Commitment

 

  (a)

The Additional L/C Facility Commitments that are unutilised at the end of the Availability Period for the Additional L/C Facility shall be immediately cancelled at that time.

 

  (b)

The Revolving Facility Commitments that are unutilised at the end of the Availability Period for the Revolving Facility shall be immediately cancelled at that time.

 

6.

UTILISATION – LETTERS OF CREDIT

 

6.1

The Facilities

 

  (a)

The Additional L/C Facility shall only be utilised by way of Letters of Credit.

 

  (b)

The Revolving Facility may be utilised by way of Letters of Credit.

 

  (c)

Other than Clause 5.5 (Limitations on Utilisations), Clause 5 (Utilisation – Loans) does not apply to utilisations by way of Letters of Credit.

 

  (d)

In determining the amount of the Available Facility and a Lender’s L/C Proportion of a proposed Letter of Credit for the purposes of this Agreement the Available Commitment of a Lender will be calculated ignoring (i) any cash cover provided for outstanding Letters of Credit and (ii) repayment of Letters of Credit by way of the issuance of an unconditional and irrevocable guarantee, indemnity, counter-indemnity or similar assurance against financial loss in accordance with paragraph (h)(v) of Clause 1.2 (Construction).

 

54


6.2

Delivery of a Utilisation Request for Letters of Credit

A Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) may request a Letter of Credit to be issued by delivery to the Facility Agent of a duly completed Utilisation Request not later than the Specified Time.

 

6.3

Completion of a Utilisation Request for Letters of Credit

Each Utilisation Request for a Letter of Credit is irrevocable and will not be regarded as having been duly completed unless:

 

  (a)

it specifies that it is for a Letter of Credit;

 

  (b)

it identifies the Borrower of the Letter of Credit, which shall be:

 

  (i)

the Company;

 

  (ii)

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. (in respect of the Additional L/C Facility only); or

 

  (iii)

an Approved Borrower under the relevant Facility;

 

  (c)

it identifies the Facility to be utilised;

 

  (d)

it identifies the Issuing Bank which has agreed to issue the Letter of Credit;

 

  (e)

the proposed Utilisation Date is a Business Day within the Availability Period applicable to the Facility;

 

  (f)

the currency and amount of the Letter of Credit comply with Clause 6.4 (Currency and amount);

 

  (g)

the form of Letter of Credit is attached;

 

  (h)

the Expiry Date of the Letter of Credit falls on or before the Final Maturity Date in relation to the relevant Facility (unless cash cover is provided in respect of such Letter of Credit prior to the Final Maturity Date); and

 

  (i)

the delivery instructions for the Letter of Credit are specified.

 

6.4

Currency and amount

 

  (a)

The currency specified in a Utilisation Request must be the Base Currency or an Optional Currency.

 

  (b)

Subject to paragraph (a) of Clause 5.5 (Limitations on Utilisations), the amount of the proposed Letter of Credit must be an amount whose Base Currency Amount is not more than the Available L/C Facility or the Available Revolving Facility (as applicable) and which is:

 

  (i)

if the currency selected is the Base Currency, a minimum of US$ 50,000 or, if less, that Available Facility;

 

  (ii)

if the currency selected is the Base Currency, a minimum of EUR 50,000 or, if less, that Available Facility; or

 

55


  (iii)

if the currency selected is an Optional Currency, the minimum amount specified by the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (b)(ii) of Clause 4.3 (Conditions relating to Optional Currencies) or, if less, that Available Facility.

 

6.5

Issue of Letters of Credit

 

  (a)

If the conditions set out in this Agreement have been met, the Issuing Bank shall issue the Letter of Credit on the Utilisation Date.

 

  (b)

Subject to Clause 4.1 (Initial conditions precedent) and Clause 4.5 (Approved Borrowers), the Issuing Bank will only be obliged to comply with paragraph (a) above, if on the date of the Utilisation Request or Renewal Request and on the proposed Utilisation Date:

 

  (i)

in the case of a Letter of Credit to be renewed in accordance with Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit), no Event of Default is continuing and, in the case of any other Utilisation, no Default is continuing or would result from the proposed Utilisation; and

 

  (ii)

other than in the case of a Letter of Credit to be renewed in accordance with Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit), the Repeating Representations to be made by each Obligor are true in all material respects by reference to the facts and circumstances then subsisting.

 

  (c)

The amount of each Lender’s participation in each Letter of Credit issued under a Facility will be equal to its L/C Proportion in respect of that Facility.

 

  (d)

The Facility Agent shall determine the Base Currency Amount of each Letter of Credit which is to be issued in an Optional Currency and shall notify the Issuing Bank and each Lender under the relevant Facility of the details of the requested Letter of Credit and its participation in that Letter of Credit by the Specified Time.

 

  (e)

The Issuing Bank has no duty to enquire of any person whether or not any of the conditions set out in paragraph (b) above have been met. The Issuing Bank may assume that those conditions have been met unless it is expressly notified to the contrary by the Facility Agent. The Issuing Bank will have no liability to any person for issuing a Letter of Credit based on such assumption.

 

  (f)

The Issuing Bank is solely responsible for the form of the Letter of Credit that it issues. The Facility Agent has no duty to monitor the form of that document.

 

  (g)

Subject to paragraph (i) of Clause 32.7 (Rights and discretions), each of the Issuing Bank and the Facility Agent shall provide the other with any information reasonably requested by the other that relates to a Letter of Credit and its issue.

 

  (h)

The Issuing Bank may issue a Letter of Credit in the form of a SWIFT message or other form of communication customary in the relevant market but has no obligation to do so.

 

6.6

Renewal of a Letter of Credit

 

  (a)

A Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) may request that any Letter of Credit issued on behalf of that Borrower be renewed by delivery to the Facility Agent of a Renewal Request in substantially similar form to a Utilisation Request for a Letter of Credit by the Specified Time.

 

  (b)

The Finance Parties shall treat any Renewal Request in the same way as a Utilisation Request for a Letter of Credit except that the condition set out in paragraph (g) of Clause 6.3 (Completion of a Utilisation Request for Letters of Credit) shall not apply.

 

56


  (c)

The terms of each renewed Letter of Credit shall be the same as those of the relevant Letter of Credit immediately prior to its renewal, except that:

 

  (i)

its amount may be less than the amount of the Letter of Credit immediately prior to its renewal; and

 

  (ii)

its Term shall start on the date which was the Expiry Date of the Letter of Credit immediately prior to its renewal (unless such relevant Letter of Credit expires on a business day after the stated Expiry Date in accordance with its terms, in which case the Term of such new Letter of Credit shall expire on such later date), and shall end on the proposed Expiry Date specified in the Renewal Request.

 

  (d)

Subject to paragraph (e) below, if the conditions set out in this Agreement have been met, the Issuing Bank shall amend and re-issue any Letter of Credit pursuant to a Renewal Request.

 

  (e)

Where a new Letter of Credit is to be issued to replace by way of renewal an existing Letter of Credit in accordance with this Clause 6.7, the applicable Issuing Bank is not required to issue that new Letter of Credit until the Letter of Credit being replaced has been returned to the Issuing Bank or the Issuing Bank is (acting reasonably) satisfied either that it will be returned to it or otherwise that no liability can arise under it.

 

6.7

Reduction of a Letter of Credit

 

  (a)

If, on the proposed Utilisation Date of a Letter of Credit issued under a Facility, any Lender under that Facility is a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and:

 

  (i)

that Lender has failed to provide cash collateral to the Issuing Bank in accordance with Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover); and

 

  (ii)

the Borrower of that proposed Letter of Credit has not exercised its right to provide cash cover to the Issuing Bank in accordance with paragraph (g) of Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover),

the Issuing Bank may reduce the amount of that Letter of Credit by an amount equal to the amount of the participation of that Non-Acceptable L/C Lender in respect of that Letter of Credit and that Non-Acceptable L/C Lender shall be deemed not to have any participation (or obligation to indemnify the Issuing Bank) in respect of that Letter of Credit for the purposes of the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

The Issuing Bank shall notify the Facility Agent and the Company of each reduction made pursuant to this Clause 6.7.

 

  (c)

This Clause 6.7 shall not affect the participation of each other Lender in that Letter of Credit.

 

6.8

Revaluation of Letters of Credit

 

  (a)

If any Letters of Credit are denominated in an Optional Currency, the Facility Agent shall at six-monthly intervals after the date of this Agreement, recalculate the Base Currency Amount of each Letter of Credit by notionally converting into the Base Currency the outstanding amount of that Letter of Credit on the basis of the Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange on the date of calculation.

 

57


  (b)

The Company shall, if requested by the Facility Agent within ten (10) days of any calculation under paragraph (a) above, ensure that within five (5) Business Days sufficient Revolving Facility Utilisations or Letters of Credit issued under the Additional L/C Facility (as applicable) are prepaid to prevent the Base Currency Amount of the Utilisations exceeding the Total Revolving Facility Commitments (after deducting the total Ancillary Commitments) or the Total Additional L/C Facility Commitments by more than five per cent. (5%) following any adjustment to a Base Currency Amount under paragraph (a) above.

 

6.9

Reduction or expiry of Letter of Credit

If the amount of any Letter of Credit is wholly or partially reduced or it is repaid or prepaid or it expires prior to its Expiry Date, the relevant Issuing Bank and the Borrower that requested (or on behalf of which the Company requested) the issue of that Letter of Credit shall promptly notify the Facility Agent of the details upon becoming aware of them.

 

6.10

Appointment of additional Issuing Banks

Any Lender which has agreed to the Company’s request to be an Issuing Bank for the purposes of this Agreement and a relevant Facility shall become a Party as an Issuing Bank in respect of the relevant Facility upon notifying the Facility Agent and the Company that it has so agreed to be an Issuing Bank.

 

6.11

Effect of Final Maturity Date

Each Letter of Credit shall be repaid by the Borrower of that Letter of Credit (or the Company on its behalf) on the Final Maturity Date applicable to the relevant Facility, (or such earlier date in accordance with this Agreement) provided that if any Letter of Credit has an Expiry Date ending on or after the Final Maturity Date applicable to the applicable Facility, without prejudice to the repayment obligation in Clause 6.8 (Revaluation of Letters of Credit), on such Final Maturity Date each such Letter of Credit shall be repaid unless, in the case of a Letter of Credit with an Expiry Date falling after such Final Maturity Date:

 

  (a)

the relevant Issuing Bank agrees that such Letter of Credit shall continue as between that Issuing Bank, and the relevant Borrower on a bilateral basis and not as part of or under the Finance Documents subject to the provision by the relevant Borrower of (i) a back-to-back guarantee or similar instrument in respect of such Letter of Credit or (ii) cash cover or other collateral in relation to such Letter of Credit, in each case, on terms acceptable to the Issuing Bank (acting reasonably) and/or (iii) completion of replacement financing documentation in form and substance satisfactory to the relevant Issuing Bank and the relevant Borrower; and

 

  (b)

save for any rights and obligations against any other Finance Party under the Finance Documents arising prior to such Final Maturity Date applicable to the relevant Facility, no rights and obligations in respect of the Letter of Credit shall, as between the Finance Parties, continue, any cash cover or other collateral provided by any Lender in relation to such Letter of Credit shall be released on the Final Maturity Date, and, in such circumstances, from the Final Maturity Date paragraph (b) of Clause 7.3 (Indemnities) and Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender) shall not apply to any such Letter of Credit or to any claim made or purported to be made under a Letter of Credit made after the Final Maturity Date applicable to the relevant Facility.

 

7.

LETTERS OF CREDIT

 

7.1

Immediately payable

If a Letter of Credit or any amount outstanding under a Letter of Credit is expressed to be immediately payable, the Borrower that requested (or on behalf of which the Company requested) the issue of that Letter of Credit shall repay or prepay that amount immediately.

 

58


7.2

Claims under a Letter of Credit

 

  (a)

Each Borrower irrevocably and unconditionally authorises the Issuing Bank to pay any claim made or purported to be made under a Letter of Credit requested by it (or requested by the Company on its behalf) and which appears on its face to be in order (in this Clause 7.2, a “claim”).

 

  (b)

Each Borrower shall within five (5) Business Days of demand pay to the Facility Agent for the relevant Issuing Bank an amount equal to the amount of any claim or, provided that no Declared Default has occurred, may elect to have that claim converted into a Loan under the Revolving Facility (whereupon the relevant Borrower shall (unless it notifies the Facility Agent otherwise) be deemed to have delivered a duly completed Utilisation Request for the relevant currency and amount and such Utilisation Request shall be deemed to comply with all applicable requirements of this Agreement).

 

  (c)

Each Borrower acknowledges that the Issuing Bank:

 

  (i)

is not obliged to carry out any investigation or seek any confirmation from any other person before paying a claim; and

 

  (ii)

deals in documents only and will not be concerned with the legality of a claim or any underlying transaction or any available set-off, counterclaim or other defence of any person.

 

  (d)

The obligations of a Borrower under this Clause 7 will not be affected by:

 

  (i)

the sufficiency, accuracy or genuineness of any claim or any other document; or

 

  (ii)

any incapacity of, or limitation on the powers of, any person signing a claim or other document.

 

7.3

Indemnities

 

  (a)

Subject to Clause 7.2 above, each Borrower shall immediately on demand indemnify the Issuing Bank against any cost, loss or liability incurred by the Issuing Bank (otherwise than by reason of the Issuing Bank’s gross negligence or wilful misconduct) in acting as the Issuing Bank under any Letter of Credit requested by (or on behalf of) that Borrower.

 

  (b)

Each Lender under the relevant Facility shall (according to its L/C Proportion) immediately on demand indemnify the Issuing Bank against any cost, loss or liability incurred by the Issuing Bank (otherwise than by reason of the Issuing Bank’s gross negligence or wilful misconduct) in acting as the Issuing Bank under any Letter of Credit issued under that Facility (unless the Issuing Bank has been reimbursed by an Obligor pursuant to a Finance Document).

 

  (c)

The Borrower which requested (or on behalf of which the Company requested) a Letter of Credit shall immediately on demand reimburse any Lender for any payment it makes to the Issuing Bank under this Clause 7.3 in respect of that Letter of Credit.

 

  (d)

The obligations of each Lender or Borrower under this Clause 7 are continuing obligations and will extend to the ultimate balance of sums payable by that Lender or Borrower in respect of any Letter of Credit issued under the relevant Facility, regardless of any intermediate payment or discharge in whole or in part.

 

  (e)

If a Borrower has provided cash cover in respect of a Lender’s participation in a Letter of Credit, the Issuing Bank shall seek reimbursement from that cash cover before making a demand of that Lender under paragraph (b) above. Any recovery made by an Issuing Bank pursuant to that cash cover will reduce that Lender’s liability under paragraph (b) above.

 

59


  (f)

The obligations of any Lender or Borrower under this Clause will not be affected by any act, omission, matter or thing which, but for this Clause, would reduce, release or prejudice any of its obligations under this Clause (without limitation and whether or not known to it or any other person) including:

 

  (i)

any time, waiver or consent granted to, or composition with, any Obligor, any beneficiary under a Letter of Credit or any other person;

 

  (ii)

the release of any other Obligor or any other person under the terms of any composition or arrangement with any creditor or any member of the Group;

 

  (iii)

the taking, variation, compromise, exchange, renewal or release of, or refusal or neglect to perfect, take up or enforce, any rights against, or security over assets of, any Obligor, any beneficiary under a Letter of Credit or other person or any non-presentation or non-observance of any formality or other requirement in respect of any instrument (other than the relevant Letter of Credit) or any failure to realise the full value of any security;

 

  (iv)

any incapacity or lack of power, authority or legal personality of or dissolution or change in the members or status of an Obligor, any beneficiary under a Letter of Credit or any other person;

 

  (v)

any amendment (however fundamental) or replacement of a Finance Document, any Letter of Credit or any other document or security;

 

  (vi)

any unenforceability, illegality or invalidity of any obligation of any person under any Finance Document, any Letter of Credit or any other document or security; or

 

  (vii)

any insolvency or similar proceedings.

 

7.4

Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover

 

  (a)

If, at any time, a Lender under the Revolving Facility or the Additional L/C Facility (as applicable) is a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender, an Issuing Bank which has issued a Letter of Credit under any Facility in respect of which such Non-Acceptable L/C Lender is a Lender (a “Relevant L/C”), by notice to that Lender, request that Lender to pay and that Lender shall pay, on or prior to the date falling five (5) Business Days after the request by the Issuing Bank, an amount equal to that Lender’s L/C Proportion of:

 

  (i)

the outstanding amount of the Relevant L/C; or

 

  (ii)

in the case of a proposed Relevant L/C, the amount of that proposed Relevant L/C,

 

  and

in the currency of that Relevant L/C to an interest-bearing account held in the name of that Lender with the Issuing Bank.

 

  (b)

The Non-Acceptable L/C Lender to whom a request has been made in accordance with paragraph (a) above shall enter into a security document or other form of collateral arrangement over the account, in form and substance satisfactory to the Issuing Bank, as collateral for any amounts due and payable under this Agreement by that Lender to the Issuing Bank in respect of that Relevant L/C.

 

  (c)

Subject to paragraph (f) below, withdrawals from such an account may only be made to pay the Issuing Bank amounts due and payable to it under this Agreement by the Non-Acceptable L/C Lender in respect of that Relevant L/C until no amount is or may be outstanding under that Relevant L/C.

 

60


  (d)

Each Lender shall notify the Facility Agent and the Company:

 

  (i)

on the date of this Agreement or on any later date on which it becomes such a Lender in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase) or Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders) whether it is a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender; and

 

  (ii)

as soon as practicable upon becoming aware of the same, that it has become a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender,

 

  and an indication in Part C (Original Lenders) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties), in a Transfer Certificate, in an Assignment Agreement or in an Increase Confirmation to that effect will constitute a notice under paragraph (i) above to the Facility Agent and, upon delivery in accordance with Clause 29.9 (Copy of Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Increase Confirmation to Company), to the Company.

 

  (e)

Any notice received by the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (d) above shall constitute notice to the Issuing Bank of that Lender’s status and the Facility Agent shall, upon receiving each such notice, promptly notify the Issuing Bank of that Lender’s status as specified in that notice.

 

  (f)

Notwithstanding paragraph (c) above, a Lender which has provided cash collateral in accordance with this Clause 7.4 may, by notice to the Issuing Bank, request that an amount equal to the amount provided by it as collateral in respect of the Relevant L/C (together with any accrued interest) be returned to it:

 

  (i)

to the extent that such cash collateral has not been applied in satisfaction of any amount due and payable under this Agreement by that Lender to the Issuing Bank in respect of the Relevant L/C;

 

  (ii)

if:

 

  (A)

it ceases to be a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender;

 

  (B)

its obligations in respect of the Relevant L/C are transferred to a New Lender in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; or

 

  (C)

an Increase Lender has agreed to undertake that Lender’s obligations in respect of the Relevant L/C in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; and

 

  (iii)

if no amount is due and payable by that Lender in respect of a Relevant L/C,

 

  and the Issuing Bank shall pay that amount to the Lender within five (5) Business Days of that Lender’s request (and shall cooperate with the Lender in order to procure that the relevant security or collateral arrangement is released and discharged).

 

  (g)

To the extent that a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender fails to provide cash collateral (or notifies the Issuing Bank that it will not provide cash collateral) in accordance with this Clause 7.4 in respect of a proposed Relevant L/C, the Issuing Bank shall promptly notify the Company (with a copy to the Facility Agent) and the Borrower of that proposed Relevant L/C may, at any time before the proposed Utilisation Date of that Relevant L/C, provide cash cover to an account with the Issuing Bank in an amount equal to that Lender’s L/C Proportion of the amount of that proposed Relevant L/C.

 

61


7.5

Requirement for cash cover from Borrower

 

  If:

 

  (a)

a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender fails to provide cash collateral (or notifies the Issuing Bank that it will not provide cash collateral) in accordance with Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover) in respect of a Relevant L/C that has been issued;

 

  (b)

the Issuing Bank notifies the Company (with a copy to the Facility Agent) that it requires the Borrower of the Relevant L/C to provide cash cover to an account with the Issuing Bank in an amount equal to that Lender’s L/C Proportion of the outstanding amount of that Relevant L/C; and

 

  (c)

that Borrower has not already provided such cash cover which is continuing to stand as collateral,

then that Borrower shall provide such cash cover within five (5) Business Days of the notice referred to in paragraph (b) above.

 

7.6

Regulation and consequences of cash cover provided by Borrower

 

  (a)

Any cash cover provided by a Borrower pursuant to Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover) or Clause 7.5 (Requirement for cash cover from Borrower) may be funded out of the Revolving Facility.

 

  (b)

Notwithstanding paragraph (f) of Clause 1.2 (Construction), the relevant Borrower may request that an amount equal to the cash cover (together with any accrued interest) provided by it pursuant to Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover) or Clause 7.5 (Requirement for cash cover from Borrower) be returned to it:

 

  (i)

to the extent that such cash cover has not been applied in satisfaction of any amount due and payable under this Agreement by that Borrower to the Issuing Bank in respect of a Letter of Credit;

 

  (ii)

if:

 

  (A)

the relevant Lender ceases to be a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender;

 

  (B)

the relevant Lender’s obligations in respect of the relevant Letter of Credit are transferred to a New Lender in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; or

 

  (C)

an Increase Lender has agreed to undertake the relevant Lender’s obligations in respect of the relevant Letter of Credit in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; and

 

  (iii)

if no amount is due and payable by the relevant Lender in respect of the relevant Letter of Credit,

and the Issuing Bank shall pay that amount to that Borrower within five (5) Business Days of that Borrower’s request.

 

  (c)

To the extent that a Borrower has provided cash cover pursuant to Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover) or Clause 7.5 (Requirement for cash cover from Borrower), the relevant Lender’s L/C Proportion in respect

 

62


  of that Letter of Credit will remain (but that Lender’s obligations in relation to that Letter of Credit may be satisfied in accordance with paragraph (f)(ii) of Clause 1.2 (Construction)). However the relevant Borrower’s obligation to pay any Letter of Credit fee in relation to the relevant Letter of Credit to the Facility Agent (for the account of that Lender) in accordance with paragraph (a) of Clause 17.4 (Fees payable in respect of Letters of Credit) will be reduced proportionately as from the date on which it provides that cash cover (and for so long as the relevant amount of cash cover continues to stand as collateral).

 

  (d)

The relevant Issuing Bank shall promptly notify the Facility Agent of the extent to which a Borrower provides cash cover pursuant to Clause 7.4 (Cash collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover) or Clause 7.5 (Requirement for cash cover from Borrower) and of any change in the amount of cash cover so provided.

 

7.7

Rights of contribution

No Obligor will be entitled to any right of contribution or indemnity from any Finance Party in respect of any payment it may make under this Clause 7.

 

7.8

Lender as Issuing Bank

A Lender which is also an Issuing Bank shall be treated as a separate entity in those capacities and capable, as a Lender, of contracting with itself as an Issuing Bank.

 

7.9

Existing Letters of Credit

Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement to the contrary, a Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) may by notice in writing to the Facility Agent (including in any Utilisation Request) require that any Existing Letter of Credit be deemed a Letter of Credit issued and established under the Additional L/C Facility and with effect from the date specified in such notice (being a date falling within the Availability Period of the Additional L/C Facility) that any such Existing Letter of Credit shall be a Letter of Credit for all purposes under this Agreement, subject only to the Facility Agent having received notification in writing from the Original Additional L/C Lender that it agrees to the Existing Letter of Credit being a Letter of Credit issued under the Additional L/C Facility for all purposes under this Agreement.

 

8.

OPTIONAL CURRENCIES

 

8.1

Selection of currency

A Borrower (or the Company on its behalf) shall select the currency of a Utilisation in a Utilisation Request.

 

8.2

Unavailability of a currency

If before the Specified Time on any Quotation Day:

 

  (a)

a Lender notifies the Facility Agent that the Optional Currency requested is not readily available to it in the amount required; or

 

  (b)

a Lender notifies the Facility Agent that compliance with its obligation to participate in a Loan in the proposed Optional Currency would contravene a law or regulation applicable to it,

the Facility Agent will give notice to the relevant Borrower or the Company to that effect by the Specified Time on that day. In this event, any Lender that gives notice pursuant to this Clause 8.2 will be required to participate in the Loan in the Base Currency (in an amount equal to that Lender’s proportion of the Base Currency Amount, or in respect of a Rollover Loan, an amount equal to that Lender’s proportion of the Base Currency Amount of the Rollover Loan that is due to be made) and its participation will be treated as a separate Loan denominated in the Base Currency during that Interest Period.

 

63


8.3

Facility Agent’s calculations

Each Lender’s participation in a Loan will be determined in accordance with paragraph (b) of Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ Participation).

 

9.

ANCILLARY FACILITIES

 

9.1

Type of Facility

An Ancillary Facility may be by way of:

 

  (a)

an overdraft facility;

 

  (b)

a guarantee, bonding, documentary or stand-by letter of credit facility;

 

  (c)

a short term loan facility;

 

  (d)

a derivatives facility;

 

  (e)

a foreign exchange facility; or

 

  (f)

any other facility or accommodation required in connection with the business of the Group and which is agreed by the Company with an Ancillary Lender.

 

9.2

Availability

 

  (a)

If the Company and a Lender agree and except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Lender may provide all or part of its Revolving Facility Commitment as an Ancillary Facility.

 

  (b)

An Ancillary Facility shall not be made available unless, not later than three (3) Business Days prior to the Ancillary Commencement Date for an Ancillary Facility, the Facility Agent has received from the Company:

 

  (i)

a notice in writing of the establishment of an Ancillary Facility and specifying:

 

  (A)

the proposed Facility to be utilised, which shall be the Revolving Facility;

 

  (B)

the proposed Borrower(s) which may use the Ancillary Facility;

 

  (C)

the proposed Ancillary Commencement Date and expiry date of the Ancillary Facility;

 

  (D)

the proposed type of Ancillary Facility to be provided;

 

  (E)

the proposed Ancillary Lender;

 

  (F)

the proposed Ancillary Commitment, the maximum amount of the Ancillary Facility and, in the case of a Multi-account Overdraft, its Designated Gross Amount and its Designated Net Amount; and

 

  (G)

the proposed currency of the Ancillary Facility (if not denominated in the Base Currency); and

 

64


  (ii)

any other information which the Facility Agent may reasonably request in connection with the Ancillary Facility.

 

  (c)

The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Ancillary Lender and the other Lenders of the establishment of an Ancillary Facility.

 

  (d)

Subject to compliance with paragraph (b) above:

 

  (i)

the Lender concerned will become an Ancillary Lender; and

 

  (ii)

the Ancillary Facility will be available,

 

  with

effect from the date agreed by the Company and the Ancillary Lender.

 

9.3

Terms of Ancillary Facilities

 

  (a)

Except as provided below, the terms of any Ancillary Facility will be those agreed by the Ancillary Lender and the Company.

 

  (b)

Those terms:

 

  (i)

must be based upon normal commercial terms at that time (except as varied by this Agreement);

 

  (ii)

may allow only Borrowers (or Affiliates of Borrowers nominated pursuant to Clause 9.9 (Affiliates of Borrowers)) to use the Ancillary Facility;

 

  (iii)

may not allow the Ancillary Outstandings to exceed the Ancillary Commitment;

 

  (iv)

may not allow a Lender’s Ancillary Commitment to exceed that Lender’s Available Commitment relating to the Revolving Facility (before taking into account the effect of the Ancillary Facility on the Available Commitment under the Revolving Facility); and

 

  (v)

must require that the Ancillary Commitment is reduced to zero, and that all Ancillary Outstandings are repaid not later than the Final Maturity Date applicable to the applicable Facility (or such earlier date as the Commitment of the relevant Ancillary Lender (or its Affiliate) is reduced to zero).

 

  (c)

If there is any inconsistency between any term of an Ancillary Facility and any term of this Agreement, this Agreement shall prevail except for:

 

  (i)

Clause 39.3 (Day count convention) which shall not prevail for the purposes of calculating fees, interest or commission relating to an Ancillary Facility;

 

  (ii)

an Ancillary Facility comprising more than one account where the terms of the Ancillary Documents shall prevail to the extent required to permit the netting of balances on those accounts; and

 

  (iii)

where the relevant term of this Agreement would be contrary to, or inconsistent with, the law governing the relevant Ancillary Document, in which case that term of this Agreement shall not prevail.

 

  (d)

Interest, commission and fees on Ancillary Facilities are dealt with in Clause 17.5 (Interest, commission and fees on Ancillary Facilities).

 

65


9.4

Repayment of Ancillary Facility

 

  (a)

An Ancillary Facility shall cease to be available on the Final Maturity Date applicable to the Revolving Facility or such earlier date on which its expiry date occurs or on which it is cancelled in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

  (b)

If an Ancillary Facility expires in accordance with its terms the Ancillary Commitment of the Ancillary Lender shall be reduced to zero.

 

  (c)

No Ancillary Lender may demand repayment or prepayment of any Ancillary Outstandings prior to the expiry date of the relevant Ancillary Facility unless:

 

  (i)

the Total Revolving Facility Commitments have been cancelled in full or all outstanding Utilisations under the Revolving Facility have become due and payable in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

 

  (ii)

it becomes unlawful in any applicable jurisdiction for the Ancillary Lender to perform any of its obligations as contemplated by this Agreement or to fund, issue or maintain its participation in its Ancillary Facility (or it becomes unlawful for any Affiliate of the Ancillary Lender for the Ancillary Lender to do so); or

 

  (iii)

both:

 

  (A)

the Available Commitments relating to the Revolving Facility; and

 

  (B)

the notice of the demand given by the Ancillary Lender,

 

  would not prevent the relevant Borrower funding the repayment of those Ancillary Outstandings in full by way of Revolving Facility Utilisation.

 

  (d)

If a Utilisation is made to repay Ancillary Outstandings in full, the relevant Ancillary Commitment shall be reduced to zero.

 

9.5

Limitation on Ancillary Outstandings

Each Borrower shall procure that:

 

  (a)

the Ancillary Outstandings under any Ancillary Facility shall not exceed the Ancillary Commitment applicable to that Ancillary Facility; and

 

  (b)

in relation to a Multi-account Overdraft:

 

  (i)

the Ancillary Outstandings shall not exceed the Designated Net Amount applicable to that Multi-account Overdraft; and

 

  (ii)

the Gross Outstandings shall not exceed the Designated Gross Amount applicable to that Multi-account Overdraft.

 

9.6

Adjustment for Ancillary Facilities upon acceleration

 

  (a)

In this Clause 9.6:

 

  (i)

Outstandings” means, in relation to a Lender, the aggregate of the equivalent in the Base Currency of:

 

  (A)

its participation in each Utilisation under the Revolving Facility then outstanding under the Revolving Facility (together with the aggregate amount of all accrued interest, fees and commission owed to it as a Lender under the Revolving Facility); and

 

66


  (B)

if the Lender is also an Ancillary Lender, the Ancillary Outstandings in respect of an Ancillary Facility under the Revolving Facility provided by that Ancillary Lender (or by its Affiliate) (together with the aggregate amount of all accrued interest, fees and commission owed to it (or to its Affiliate) as an Ancillary Lender in respect of the Ancillary Facility); and

 

  (ii)

Total Outstandings” means the aggregate of all Outstandings under the Revolving Facility.

 

  (b)

If the Facility Agent exercises any of its rights under Clause 28 (Remedies following Default) (other than declaring Utilisations to be due on demand), each Lender and each Ancillary Lender shall promptly adjust (by making or receiving (as the case may be) corresponding transfers of rights and obligations under the Finance Documents relating to Outstandings) their claims in respect of amounts outstanding to them under the Revolving Facility and each Ancillary Facility to the extent necessary to ensure that after such transfers the Outstandings of each Lender bear the same proportion to the Total Outstandings as such Lender’s relevant Commitment bears to the Total Revolving Facility Commitments, each as at the date the Facility Agent exercises the relevant right(s) under Clause 28 (Remedies following Default).

 

  (c)

If an amount outstanding under an Ancillary Facility is a contingent liability and that contingent liability becomes an actual liability or is reduced to zero after the original adjustment is made under paragraph (b) above, then each Lender and Ancillary Lender will make a further adjustment (by making or receiving (as the case may be) corresponding transfers of rights and obligations under the Finance Documents relating to Outstandings to the extent necessary) to put themselves in the position they would have been in had the original adjustment been determined by reference to the actual liability or, as the case may be, zero liability and not the contingent liability.

 

  (d)

Any transfer of rights and obligations relating to Outstandings made pursuant to this Clause 9.6 shall be made for a purchase price in cash, payable at the time of transfer, in an amount equal to those Outstandings (less any accrued interest, fees and commission to which the transferor will remain entitled to receive notwithstanding that transfer, pursuant to Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement)).

 

  (e)

Prior to the application of the provisions of paragraph (b) above, an Ancillary Lender that has provided a Multi-account Overdraft shall set-off any Available Credit Balance on any account comprised in that Multi-account Overdraft.

 

  (f)

All calculations to be made pursuant to this Clause 9.6 shall be made by the Facility Agent based upon information provided to it by the Lenders and Ancillary Lenders and the Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange.

 

  (g)

This Clause 9.6 shall not oblige any Lender to accept the transfer of a claim relating to an amount outstanding under an Ancillary Facility which is not denominated (pursuant to the relevant Finance Document) in either the Base Currency, a currency which has been an Optional Currency for the purpose of any Utilisation or in another currency which is acceptable to that Lender.

 

9.7

Information

Each Borrower and each Ancillary Lender shall, promptly upon request by the Facility Agent, supply the Facility Agent with any information relating to the operation of an Ancillary Facility (including the Ancillary Outstandings) as the Facility Agent may reasonably request from time to time. Each Borrower consents to all such information being released to the Facility Agent and the other Finance Parties.

 

67


9.8

Affiliates of Lenders as Ancillary Lenders

 

  (a)

Subject to the terms of this Agreement, an Affiliate of a Lender under the Revolving Facility may become an Ancillary Lender. In such case, the Lender under the Revolving Facility and its Affiliate shall be treated as a single Lender whose Revolving Facility Commitment is the amount set out opposite the relevant Lender’s name in Part C (Original Lenders) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) and/or the amount of any Revolving Facility Commitment transferred to or assumed by that Lender under this Agreement, to the extent (in each case) not cancelled, reduced or transferred by it under this Agreement.

 

  (b)

The Company shall specify any relevant Affiliate of a Lender in any notice delivered by the Company to the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (b)(i) of Clause 9.2 (Availability).

 

  (c)

If a Lender assigns all of its rights and benefits or transfers all of its rights and obligations to a New Lender, its Affiliate shall cease to have any obligations under this Agreement or any Ancillary Document.

 

  (d)

Where this Agreement or any other Finance Document imposes an obligation on an Ancillary Lender and the relevant Ancillary Lender is an Affiliate of a Lender which is not a party to that document, the relevant Lender shall ensure that the obligation is performed by its Affiliate.

 

9.9

Affiliates of Borrowers

 

  (a)

Subject to the terms of this Agreement, an Affiliate incorporated in Germany, Singapore or the US of a Borrower may with the approval of the relevant Ancillary Lender become a borrower with respect to an Ancillary Facility.

 

  (b)

The Company shall specify any relevant Affiliate of a Borrower in any notice delivered by the Company to the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (b)(i) of Clause 9.2 (Availability).

 

  (c)

If a Borrower ceases to be a Borrower under this Agreement in accordance with Clause 31.3 (Resignation of a Borrower), its Affiliate shall cease to have any rights under this Agreement or any Ancillary Document.

 

  (d)

Where this Agreement or any other Finance Document imposes an obligation on a Borrower under an Ancillary Facility and the relevant Borrower is an Affiliate of a Borrower which is not a party to that document, the relevant Borrower shall ensure that the obligation is performed by its Affiliate.

 

  (e)

Any reference in this Agreement or any other Finance Document to a Borrower being under no obligations (whether actual or contingent) as a Borrower under such Finance Document shall be construed to include a reference to any Affiliate of a Borrower being under no obligations under any Finance Document or Ancillary Document.

 

9.10

Revolving Facility Commitment amounts

Notwithstanding any other term of this Agreement, each Lender shall ensure that at all times its Commitment in respect of the Revolving Facility is not less than:

 

  (a)

its Ancillary Commitment; or

 

  (b)

the Ancillary Commitment of its Affiliate.

 

68


9.11

Amendments and Waivers – Ancillary Facilities

No amendment or waiver of a term of any Ancillary Facility shall require the consent of any Finance Party other than the relevant Ancillary Lender unless such amendment or waiver itself relates to or gives rise to a matter which would require an amendment of, or waiver under, this Agreement (including, for the avoidance of doubt, under this Clause 9). In such a case, Clause 42 (Amendments and Waivers) will apply.

 

9.12

Continuation of Ancillary Facilities

 

  (a)

Each Ancillary Facility shall be repaid or prepaid and cancelled on the Final Maturity Date (or such earlier date in accordance with this Agreement), provided that a Borrower and an Ancillary Lender may, as between themselves only, agree that any Ancillary Facilities will continue to remain available following the Final Maturity Date applicable to the relevant Facility or, as the case may be, the date the relevant Commitments are otherwise cancelled under this Agreement.

 

  (b)

If any arrangement contemplated in paragraph (a) above is to occur, each relevant Borrower and the Ancillary Lender shall each confirm that to be the case in writing to the Facility Agent. Upon such Final Maturity Date or, as the case may be, date of cancellation, any such facility shall continue as between the said entities and not as part of, or under, the Finance Documents. Save for any rights and obligations against any Finance Party under the Finance Documents arising prior to such Final Maturity Date or, as the case may be, date of cancellation, no such rights or obligations in respect of such Ancillary Facility shall, as between the Finance Parties, continue.

 

10.

REPAYMENT

 

10.1

Repayment of Loans

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, each Borrower which has drawn a Loan shall repay that Loan on the last day of its Interest Period.

 

  (b)

Without prejudice to each Borrower’s obligation under paragraph (a) above, if:

 

  (i)

one or more Loans are to be made available to a Borrower:

 

  (A)

on the same day that a maturing Loan is due to be repaid by that Borrower;

 

  (B)

in the same currency as the maturing Loan (unless it arose as a result of the operation of Clause 8.2 (Unavailability of a currency)); and

 

  (C)

in whole or in part for the purpose of refinancing the maturing Loan; and

 

  (ii)

the proportion borne by each Lender’s participation in the maturing Loan to the amount of that maturing Loan is the same as the proportion borne by that Lender’s participation in the new Loans to the aggregate amount of those new Loans,

the aggregate amount of the new Loans shall, unless the relevant Borrower or the Company notifies the Facility Agent to the contrary in the relevant Utilisation Request, be treated as if applied in or towards repayment of the maturing Loan so that:

 

  (A)

if the amount of the maturing Loan exceeds the aggregate amount of the new Loans:

 

69


  (1)

the relevant Borrower will only be required to make a payment under Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent) in an amount in the relevant currency equal to that excess; and

 

  (2)

each Lender’s participation in the new Loans shall be treated as having been made available and applied by the Borrower in or towards repayment of that Lender’s participation in the maturing Loan and that Lender will not be required to make a payment under Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent) in respect of its participation in the new Revolving Facility Loans; and

 

  (B)

if the amount of the maturing Loan is equal to or less than the aggregate amount of the new Loans:

 

  (1)

the relevant Borrower will not be required to make a payment under Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent); and

 

  (2)

each Lender will be required to make a payment under Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent) in respect of its participation in the new Loans only to the extent that its participation in the new Loans exceeds that Lender’s participation in the maturing Loan and the remainder of that Lender’s participation in the new Loans shall be treated as having been made available and applied by the Borrower in or towards repayment of that Lender’s participation in the maturing Loan.

 

  (c)

At any time when a Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, the maturity date of each of the participations of that Lender in the Loans then outstanding will be automatically extended to the last day of the relevant Availability Period and will be treated as separate Loans (the “Separate Loans”) denominated in the currency in which the relevant participations are outstanding.

 

  (d)

A Borrower to whom a Separate Loan is outstanding may prepay that Loan by giving not less than five (5) Business Days’ prior notice to the Facility Agent. The Facility Agent will forward a copy of a prepayment notice received in accordance with this paragraph (d) to the Defaulting Lender concerned as soon as practicable on receipt.

 

  (e)

Interest in respect of a Separate Loan will accrue for successive Interest Periods selected by the Borrower by the time and date specified by the Facility Agent (acting reasonably) and will be payable by that Borrower to the Facility Agent (for the account of that Defaulting Lender) on the last day of each Interest Period of that Loan.

 

  (f)

The terms of this Agreement relating to Loans generally shall continue to apply to Separate Loans other than to the extent inconsistent with paragraphs (c) to (e) above, in which case those paragraphs shall prevail in respect of any Separate Loan.

 

11.

ILLEGALITY, VOLUNTARY PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION

 

11.1

Illegality

 

  (a)

If, in any applicable jurisdiction, it becomes unlawful (including, for the avoidance of doubt, as a result of a breach of Sanctions) for a Lender to perform any of its obligations as contemplated by the Finance Documents or to fund or maintain its participation in any Loan:

 

  (i)

such Lender shall promptly notify the Facility Agent upon becoming aware of that event, the Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Company thereof;

 

70


  (ii)

unless the Company has exercised its rights under Clause 42.8 (Replacement of Lender) to replace that Lender, each Available Commitment of that Lender will be immediately cancelled; and

 

  (iii)

the relevant Borrower shall repay that Lender’s participation in the Utilisations on the last day of the relevant Interest Period for each such Utilisation occurring after the Facility Agent has notified the Company or, if earlier, the date specified by the Lender in the notice delivered to the Facility Agent (being no earlier than the last day of any applicable grace period permitted by law), in each case, together with all accrued and unpaid interest and fees, any Break Costs and all other amounts payable to that Lender under this Agreement relating to such Utilisation and that Lender’s participation in that Facility and that Lender’s corresponding Commitment(s) shall be cancelled in the amount of the participations repaid.

 

  (b)

If any Obligor is in breach of any Sanctions, such Obligor shall, promptly upon becoming aware of that event, notify the Facility Agent, who shall notify the Lenders of such breach.

 

11.2

Illegality in relation to Issuing Bank

If it becomes unlawful for an Issuing Bank to issue or leave outstanding any Letter of Credit or it becomes unlawful for any Affiliate of an Issuing Bank for that Issuing Bank to do so then:

 

  (a)

that Issuing Bank shall promptly notify the Facility Agent upon becoming aware of that event;

 

  (b)

upon the Facility Agent notifying the Company, the Issuing Bank shall not be obliged to issue any Letter of Credit under the relevant Facility;

 

  (c)

the Company shall procure that the relevant Borrower shall use its best endeavours to procure the release of each Letter of Credit issued by that Issuing Bank and outstanding at such time on or before the date specified by the Issuing Bank in the notice delivered to the Facility Agent (being no earlier than the last day of any applicable grace period permitted by law); and

 

  (d)

unless any other Lender is or has become an Issuing Bank pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, the relevant Facility shall cease to be available for the issue of Letters of Credit.

 

11.3

Voluntary cancellation

The Company or any Borrower may, if it gives the Facility Agent not less than ten (10) days’ prior notice, cancel the whole or any part (being a minimum amount of US$1,000,000) of an Available Facility. Any cancellation under this Clause 11.2 shall reduce the Commitments of the Lenders under the relevant Facility rateably.

 

11.4

Voluntary prepayment of Utilisations

A Borrower to which a Utilisation has been made may, if it or the Company gives the Facility Agent not less than five (5) Business Days’ (or such shorter period as the Majority L/C Lenders or Majority RCF Lenders, as applicable, may agree) prior notice, prepay the whole or any part of a Utilisation (but if in part, being an amount that reduces the Base Currency Amount of the Utilisation by a minimum amount of $1,000,000).

 

11.5

Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender or Issuing Bank

 

  (a)

If:

 

  (i)

any sum payable to any Lender by an Obligor is required to be increased under paragraph (c) of Clause 18.1 (Tax Gross-up); or

 

71


  (ii)

any Lender or Issuing Bank claims indemnification from the Company or an Obligor under Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity) or Clause 19.1 (Increased costs),

the Company may, whilst the circumstance giving rise to the requirement for that increase or indemnification continues, give the Facility Agent notice:

 

  (A)

(if such circumstances relate to a Lender) of cancellation of the Commitments of that Lender and its intention to procure the repayment of that Lender’s participation in the Utilisations; or

 

  (B)

(if such circumstances relate to the Issuing Bank) of repayment of any outstanding Letter of Credit issued by it and cancellation of its appointment as an Issuing Bank under this Agreement in relation to any Letters of Credit to be issued in the future; or

 

  (C)

its intention to replace such Lender in accordance with Clause 42.8 (Replacement of Lender).

 

  (b)

On receipt of a notice referred to in paragraph (a) above in relation to a Lender, the Commitment(s) of that Lender shall immediately be reduced to zero.

 

  (c)

On the last Business Day of the relevant Interest Period for each Loan which ends after the Company has given notice under paragraph (a) above in relation to a Lender (or, if earlier, the date specified by the Company in that notice), each Borrower to which a Utilisation is outstanding shall repay that Lender’s participation in that Utilisation together with all interest and other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents.

 

  (d)

In the case of a prepayment pursuant to this Clause 11.5, the remaining Lenders shall, in good faith, provide all commercially reasonable assistance to the Company in exploring alternative sources of bank and other financing to replace any such affected Lender.

 

11.6

Right of cancellation in relation to a Defaulting Lender

 

  (a)

If any Lender becomes a Defaulting Lender, the Company may, at any time whilst the Lender continues to be a Defaulting Lender, give the Facility Agent ten (10) Business Days’ notice of cancellation of each Available Commitment of that Lender.

 

  (b)

On the notice referred to in paragraph (a) above becoming effective, each Available Commitment of the Defaulting Lender shall immediately be reduced to zero.

 

  (c)

The Facility Agent shall as soon as practicable after receipt of a notice referred to in paragraph (a) above, notify all the Lenders.

 

12.

MANDATORY PREPAYMENT AND CANCELLATION

 

12.1

Change of Control

If a Change of Control occurs, then:

 

  (a)

the Company shall promptly notify the Facility Agent upon becoming aware of such Change of Control and the Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Lenders (the date of such notification being, the “Notification Date”);

 

  (b)

each Lender under any Facility shall have the right by notice in writing to be received by the Facility Agent within sixty (60) calendar days (unless such Lender has earlier waived the right to be prepaid) of the Notification Date to elect for its Commitments to be cancelled and its participation in all outstanding Utilisations and its Ancillary Outstandings to be prepaid (“Change of Control Election”); and

 

72


  (c)

if any Lender makes a Change of Control Election, its Available Commitments shall automatically be cancelled on and as of the date of such election without further action by any of the Parties and its participation in all outstanding Utilisations and its Ancillary Outstandings, together with accrued interest, Break Costs and all other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents in respect of such participation shall become due and payable on the date falling ninety (90) calendar days after the Notification Date.

 

13.

RESTRICTIONS

 

13.1

Notices of cancellation or prepayment

Any notice of cancellation, prepayment, authorisation or other election given by any Party under Clause 11 (Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation) shall (subject to the terms of those Clauses) be irrevocable and, unless a contrary indication appears in this Agreement, shall specify the date or dates upon which the relevant cancellation or prepayment is to be made and the amount of that cancellation or prepayment, provided that, for the avoidance of doubt, conditional notices shall be permitted.

 

13.2

Interest and other amounts

Any prepayment under this Agreement shall be made together with accrued interest on the amount prepaid and, subject to applicable Break Costs, without premium or penalty.

 

13.3

Reborrowing of Revolving Facility and Additional L/C Facility

Unless a contrary indication appears in this Agreement, any part of the Revolving Facility or the Additional L/C Facility which is prepaid or repaid may be reborrowed in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

13.4

Prepayment in accordance with Agreement

No Borrower shall repay or prepay all or any part of the Utilisations or cancel all or any part of the Commitments except at the times and in the manner expressly provided for in this Agreement.

 

13.5

No reinstatement of Commitments

Subject to Clause 2.2 (Increase), no amount of the Total Commitments cancelled under this Agreement may be subsequently reinstated.

 

13.6

Facility Agent’s receipt of notices

If the Facility Agent receives a notice under Clause 11 (Illegality, voluntary prepayment and cancellation), it shall promptly forward a copy of that notice or election to either the Company or the affected Lender, as appropriate.

 

13.7

Effect of repayment and prepayment on Commitments

If all or part of any Lender’s participation in a Loan under a Facility is repaid or prepaid and is not available for redrawing other than by operation of Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent), an amount of that Lender’s Commitment (equal to the amount of the participation which is repaid or prepaid) in respect of that Facility will be deemed to be cancelled on the date of repayment or prepayment.

 

73


13.8

Application of prepayments

Any prepayment of a Utilisation (other than a prepayment pursuant to Clause 11.1 (Illegality), Clause 11.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender or Issuing Bank) or Clause 12.1 (Change of Control)) shall be applied pro rata to each Lender’s participation in that Loan.

 

14.

INTEREST

 

14.1

Calculation of interest

The rate of interest on each Loan for each Interest Period is the percentage rate per annum which is the aggregate of the applicable:

 

  (a)

Margin; and

 

  (b)

LIBOR or, in relation to any Loan in Euro, EURIBOR.

 

14.2

Payment of interest

Except where it is provided to the contrary in this Agreement, the Borrower to which a Loan has been made shall pay accrued interest on that Loan on the last day of each Interest Period for that Loan.

 

14.3

Default interest

 

  (a)

If an Obligor fails to pay any amount payable by it under a Finance Document on its due date, interest shall accrue on the overdue amount from the due date up to the date of actual payment (both before and after judgment) at a rate which, subject to paragraph (b) below, is one per cent. (1.0%) per annum higher than the rate which would have been payable if the overdue amount had, during the period of non-payment, constituted a Loan in the currency of the overdue amount for successive Interest Periods, each of a duration selected by the Facility Agent (acting reasonably). Any interest accruing under this Clause 14.3 shall be immediately payable by the Obligor on demand by the Facility Agent.

 

  (b)

If any overdue amount consists of all or part of a Loan which became due on a day which was not the last day of an Interest Period relating to that Loan:

 

  (i)

the first Interest Period for that overdue amount shall have a duration equal to the unexpired portion of the current Interest Period relating to that Loan; and

 

  (ii)

the rate of interest applying to the overdue amount during that first Interest Period shall be one per cent. (1.0%) per annum higher than the rate which would have applied if the overdue amount had not become due.

 

  (c)

Default interest (if unpaid) arising on an overdue amount will be compounded with the overdue amount at the end of each Interest Period applicable to that overdue amount but will remain immediately due and payable.

 

14.4

Notification of rates of interest

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the relevant Lenders and the relevant Borrower (or the Company) of the determination of a rate of interest under this Agreement.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the relevant Borrower (or the Company) of each Funding Rate relating to a Loan.

 

74


15.

INTEREST PERIODS

 

15.1

Selection

 

  (a)

A Borrower (or the Company on behalf of a Borrower) may select an Interest Period for a Loan in the Utilisation Request for that Loan.

 

  (b)

Subject to this Clause 15, a Borrower (or the Company) may select an Interest Period of one (1), two (2), three (3) or six (6) Months or any other period agreed between the Company and the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions of all the Lenders in relation to the relevant Loan).

 

  (c)

An Interest Period for a Loan shall not extend beyond the Final Maturity Date applicable to its Facility.

 

  (d)

Each Interest Period for a Loan shall start on the Utilisation Date.

 

  (e)

A Loan has one Interest Period only.

 

15.2

Non-Business Days

If an Interest Period would otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period will instead end on the next Business Day in that calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not).

 

16.

CHANGES TO THE CALCULATION OF INTEREST

 

16.1

Unavailability of Screen Rate

 

  (a)

Interpolated Screen Rate: If no Screen Rate is available for LIBOR or, if applicable, EURIBOR for the Interest Period of a Loan, the applicable LIBOR or EURIBOR shall be the Interpolated Screen Rate for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan.

 

  (b)

Shortened Interest Period: If no Screen Rate is available for LIBOR or, if applicable, EURIBOR for:

 

  (i)

the currency of a Loan; or

 

  (ii)

the Interest Period of a Loan and it is not possible to calculate the Interpolated Screen Rate,

the Interest Period of that Loan shall (if it is longer than the applicable Fallback Interest Period) be shortened to the applicable Fallback Interest Period and the applicable LIBOR or EURIBOR for that shortened Interest Period shall be determined pursuant to the relevant definition.

 

  (c)

Shortened Interest Period and Historic Screen Rate: If the Interest Period of a Loan is, after giving effect to paragraph (b) above, either the applicable Fallback Interest Period or shorter than the applicable Fallback Interest Period and, in either case, no Screen Rate is available for LIBOR or, if applicable, EURIBOR for:

 

  (i)

the currency of that Loan; or

 

  (ii)

the Interest Period of that Loan and it is not possible to calculate the Interpolated Screen Rate,

the applicable LIBOR or EURIBOR shall be the Historic Screen Rate for that Loan.

 

75


  (d)

Shortened Interest Period and Interpolated Historic Screen Rate: If paragraph (c) above applies but no Historic Screen Rate is available for the Interest Period of the Loan, the applicable LIBOR or EURIBOR shall be the Interpolated Historic Screen Rate for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan.

 

  (e)

Reference Bank Rate: If paragraph (d) above applies but it is not possible to calculate the Interpolated Historic Screen Rate, the Interest Period of that Loan shall, if it has been shortened pursuant to paragraph (b) above, revert to its previous length and the applicable LIBOR or EURIBOR shall be the Reference Bank Rate as of the Specified Time for the currency of that Loan and for a period equal in length to the Interest Period of that Loan.

 

  (f)

If LIBOR or EURIBOR (as applicable) is no longer available or in place of LIBOR or EURIBOR (as applicable) the lending market has adopted a common alternative reference rate, then subject to consent from the Company, the Facility Agent may specify that such common alternative reference rate be used.

 

  (g)

Cost of funds: If either (A) paragraph (e) above applies but no Reference Bank Rate is available for Dollars or Euros (as applicable) for the relevant Interest Period or (B) paragraph (f) above is applicable, there shall be no LIBOR or EURIBOR (as applicable) for that Loan and Clause 16.4 (Cost of funds) shall apply to that Loan for that Interest Period.

 

16.2

Calculation of Reference Bank Rate

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, if LIBOR or EURIBOR is to be determined on the basis of a Reference Bank Rate but a Reference Bank does not supply a quotation by the Specified Time, the Reference Bank Rate shall be calculated on the basis of the quotations of the remaining Reference Banks.

 

  (b)

If at or about noon on the Quotation Day, none or only one of the Reference Banks supplies a quotation, there shall be no Reference Bank Rate for the relevant Interest Period.

 

16.3

Market disruption

If before close of business in London (17:00 London time) on the Quotation Day for the relevant Interest Period, the Facility Agent receives notifications from a Lender or Lenders (whose participations in a Loan exceed fifty-one per cent. (51.0%) of that Loan) that the cost to it or them of funding its or their participations in that Loan from the wholesale market for Dollars would be in excess of LIBOR, or if applicable, for Euros would be in excess of EURIBOR, then Clause 16.4 (Cost of funds) shall apply to that Loan for the relevant Interest Period.

 

16.4

Cost of funds

 

  (a)

If this Clause 16.4 applies, the rate of interest on each Lender’s share of the relevant Loan for the relevant Interest Period shall be the percentage rate per annum which is the sum of:

 

  (i)

the applicable Margin; and

 

  (ii)

the rate notified to the Facility Agent by that Lender as soon as practicable and in any event by the close of business on the date falling two (2) Business Days after the relevant Quotation Day (or, if earlier, on the date falling two (2) Business Days prior to the date on which interest is due to be paid in respect of that Interest Period), to be that which expresses as a percentage rate per annum the cost to that Lender of funding its participation in that Loan from whatever source it may reasonably select.

 

  (b)

If this Clause 16.4 applies and the Facility Agent or the Company so requires, the Facility Agent and the Company shall enter into negotiations (for a period of not more than sixty (60) calendar days) with a view to agreeing a substitute basis for determining the rate of interest.

 

76


  (c)

Any alternative basis agreed pursuant to paragraph (b) above shall, with the prior consent of all the Lenders and the Company, be binding on all Parties.

 

  (d)

If this Clause 16.4 applies pursuant to Clause 16.3 (Market disruption) and:

 

  (i)

a Lender’s Funding Rate is less than LIBOR in relation to any Loan in Dollars or, EURIBOR, in relation to any Loan in Euro; or

 

  (ii)

a Lender does not supply a quotation by the time specified in paragraph (a)(ii) above,

the cost to that Lender of funding its participation in that Loan for that Interest Period shall be deemed, for the purposes of paragraph (a) above, to be LIBOR in relation to any Loan in Dollars or, EURIBOR, in relation to a Loan in Euro.

 

16.5

Notification to Company

If Clause 16.4 (Cost of funds) applies the Facility Agent shall, as soon as is practicable, notify the Company.

 

16.6

Break Costs

 

  (a)

The Company shall, within three (3) Business Days of demand by a Finance Party, pay to that Finance Party its Break Costs attributable to all or any part of a Loan or Unpaid Sum being paid by that Borrower on a day other than the last day of an Interest Period for that Loan or Unpaid Sum.

 

  (b)

Each Lender shall, as soon as reasonably practicable after a demand by the Facility Agent, provide a certificate confirming the amount of its Break Costs for any Interest Period in which they accrue.

 

17.

FEES

 

17.1

Commitment Fee

 

  (a)

The Company must pay (or procure that an Obligor pays) to the Facility Agent (for the account of each Lender) a fee in the relevant currency computed at:

 

  (i)

the rate of zero-point-fifty-five per cent. (0.55%) on that Lender’s Available Commitment under the Additional L/C Facility for the Availability Period applicable to the Additional L/C Facility; and

 

  (ii)

the rate of zero-point-fifty-five per cent. (0.55%) on that Lender’s Available Commitment under the Revolving Facility for the Availability Period applicable to the Revolving Facility.

 

  (b)

The accrued commitment fee is payable on the last day of each successive period of three (3) Months which ends during the relevant Availability Period, on the last day of the relevant Availability Period and, if cancelled in full, on the cancelled amount of the relevant Lender’s Commitment at the time the cancellation is effective.

 

  (c)

For the avoidance of doubt, no commitment fee is payable:

 

  (i)

to the Facility Agent (for the account of a Lender) on any Available Commitment of that Lender for any day on which that Lender is a Defaulting Lender; or

 

  (ii)

in respect of a Facility, prior to the date on which Financial Close occurs for that Facility, or if Financial Close does not occur in respect of that Facility.

 

77


17.2

Upfront fee

The Company shall pay (or procure that an Obligor pays) to the relevant Finance Parties for their own account fees in the amount and manner agreed under the relevant Fee Letter. No fee under this Clause 17.2 shall be due and payable in respect of a Facility until the date on which Financial Close occurs in respect of that Facility.

 

17.3

Facility Agent fees

The Company shall pay (or procure that an Obligor pays) to the Facility Agent (for its own account) the fees in the amount and at the time agreed in the Fee Letter entered or to be entered into between the Company and the Facility Agent. No fee under this Clause 17.3 shall be due and payable in respect of a Facility until the first date on which Financial Close occurs in respect of a Facility.

 

17.4

Fees payable in respect of Letters of Credit

 

  (a)

The Company or each Borrower shall pay to an Issuing Bank under the Revolving Facility a fronting fee at the rate agreed between the Company and that Issuing Bank on the outstanding amount which is counter-indemnified by the other Lenders of each Letter of Credit requested by it for the period from the issue of that Letter of Credit until its Expiry Date.

 

  (b)

The Company or each Borrower shall pay to the Facility Agent (for the account of each Lender under the relevant Facility) a Letter of Credit fee in the Base Currency (computed at the rate equal to (i) the Margin applicable to a Revolving Facility Loan for a Letter of Credit issued under the Revolving Facility or (ii) one hundred and fifteen (115) basis points for a Letter of Credit issued under the Additional L/C Facility) on the outstanding amount of each Letter of Credit requested by it for the period from the issue of that Letter of Credit until its Expiry Date. Subject to paragraph (c) of Clause 7.6 (Regulation and consequences of cash cover provided by Borrower), this fee shall be distributed according to each Lender’s L/C Proportion of that Letter of Credit.

 

  (c)

The accrued fronting fee and Letter of Credit fee on a Letter of Credit shall be payable quarterly in arrears on each Quarter Date starting on the date of issue of that Letter of Credit and ending on the Expiry Date for that Letter of Credit. If the outstanding amount of a Letter of Credit is reduced, any fronting fee and Letter of Credit fee accrued in respect of the amount of that reduction shall be payable on the day that that reduction becomes effective.

 

  (d)

If a Borrower provides cash cover in respect of any Letter of Credit:

 

  (i)

the fronting fee payable to the Issuing Bank and (subject to paragraph (c) of Clause 7.6 (Regulation and consequences of cash cover provided by Borrower)), the Letter of Credit fee payable for the account of each Lender shall continue to be payable until the expiry of the Letter of Credit; and

 

  (ii)

each Borrower shall be entitled to withdraw interest accrued on the cash cover to pay the fees described in paragraph (i) above.

 

17.5

Interest, commission and fees on Ancillary Facilities

The rate and time of payment of interest, commission, fees and any other remuneration in respect of each Ancillary Facility shall be determined by agreement between the relevant Ancillary Lender and the Borrower of that Ancillary Facility based upon normal market rates and terms.

 

78


18.

TAX

 

18.1

Tax Gross–up

 

  (a)

The Obligors shall make all payments to be made by them under the Finance Documents without any Tax Deduction, unless a Tax Deduction is required by law.

 

  (b)

Each Obligor shall promptly upon becoming aware that it must make a Tax Deduction (or that there is any change in the rate or the basis of a Tax Deduction) notify the Facility Agent accordingly. Similarly, a Lender or Issuing Bank shall notify the Facility Agent on becoming so aware in respect of a payment payable to that Lender or Issuing Bank. If the Facility Agent receives such notification from a Lender or Issuing Bank it shall notify the Company.

 

  (c)

If a Tax Deduction is required by law to be made by an Obligor, the amount of the payment due from that Obligor shall be increased to an amount which (after making any Tax Deduction) leaves an amount equal to the payment which would have been due if no Tax Deduction had been required.

 

  (d)

A payment by or in respect of a Singapore Borrower shall not be increased under paragraph (c) above by reason of a Tax Deduction on account of Tax imposed by Singapore if on the date on which the payment falls due:

 

  (i)

the payment could have been made to the relevant Lender without a Tax Deduction if the Lender had been a Singapore Qualifying Lender, but on that date that Lender is not or has ceased to be a Singapore Qualifying Lender other than as a result of any change after the date it became a Lender under this Agreement in (or in the interpretation, administration, or application of) any law or Treaty or any published practice or published concession of any relevant taxing authority; or

 

  (ii)

the relevant Lender is a Singapore Treaty Lender and the Obligor making the payment is able to demonstrate that the payment could have been made to the Lender without a Tax Deduction had that Lender complied with its obligations under paragraph (j) below.

 

  (e)

A payment by or in respect of a US Borrower shall not be increased under paragraph (c) above by reason of a Tax Deduction on account of Tax imposed by the US if on the date on which the payment falls due, the payment could have been made to the relevant Lender without a Tax Deduction if it were a US Qualifying Lender, but on that date the Lender is not or has ceased to be a US Qualifying Lender other than as a result of any change after the date such Lender first became a Lender under this Agreement in (or in the interpretation, administration, or application of) any law or double taxation agreement.

 

  (f)

A payment by or in respect of a German Borrower shall not be increased under paragraph (c) above by reason of a Tax Deduction on account of Tax imposed by Germany if on the date on which the payment falls due:

 

  (i)

the payment could have been made to the relevant Lender without a Tax Deduction if the Lender had been a German Qualifying Lender, but on that date that Lender is not or has ceased to be a German Qualifying Lender other than as a result of any change after the date it became a Lender under this Agreement in (or in the interpretation, administration, or application of) any law or Treaty or any published practice or published concession of any relevant taxing authority; or

 

  (ii)

the relevant Lender is a German Treaty Lender, the Obligor making the payment is able to demonstrate that the payment could have been made to the Lender without the Tax Deduction had that Lender complied with its obligations under paragraph (j) below.

 

79


  (g)

A payment by or in respect of an Other Borrower shall not be increased under paragraph (c) above by reason of a Tax Deduction on account of Tax imposed by the jurisdiction in which the Borrower is resident for tax purposes if, on the date the payment falls due:

 

  (i)

the payment could have been made to the relevant Lender without a Tax Deduction if the Lender had been an Other Qualifying Lender, but on that date the Lender is not or has ceased to be an Other Qualifying Lender other than as a result of any change after the date such Lender first became a Lender under this Agreement in (or in the interpretation, administration, or application of) any law or double taxation agreement; or

 

  (ii)

the relevant Lender is an Other Treaty Lender and the Obligor making the payment is able to demonstrate that the payment could have been made to the Lender without the Tax Deduction had that Lender complied with its obligation under paragraph (j) below.

 

  (h)

If an Obligor is required to make a Tax Deduction, that Obligor shall make that Tax Deduction and any payment required in connection with that Tax Deduction within the time allowed and in the minimum amount required by law.

 

  (i)

Within thirty (30) calendar days of an Obligor making either a Tax Deduction or a payment required in connection with a Tax Deduction, such Obligor shall deliver to the Facility Agent for the relevant Lender evidence reasonably satisfactory to such Lender that the Tax Deduction has been made or (as applicable) the appropriate payment has been paid to the relevant taxing authority.

 

  (j)

A Lender and each Obligor which makes a payment to which that Lender is entitled shall co-operate in completing any procedural formalities necessary for that Obligor to obtain any authorisations necessary to make that payment without a Tax Deduction.

 

18.2

Tax Indemnity

 

  (a)

If any Finance Party suffers any loss, liability or cost for or on account of any Tax on or in relation to any sum received or receivable under any Finance Document or if any liability in respect of any such sum is asserted, imposed, levied or assessed against any such person, the Company shall upon demand of the Facility Agent promptly reimburse such person for or, as applicable, indemnify such person against, such payment, loss, liability or cost.

 

  (b)

Paragraph (a) above shall not apply:

 

  (i)

with respect to any Excluded Tax assessed on the Finance Party; or

 

  (ii)

to the extent the loss, liability or cost:

 

  (A)

is compensated under Clause 18.1 (Tax Gross-up), Clause 18.5 (Stamp Taxes) or Clause 18.6 (VAT) (or would have been so compensated but for the exclusions therein);

 

  (B)

relates to a FATCA Deduction required to be made by a Party; or

 

  (C)

is in respect of or relates to any Bank Levy (or any payment attributable to, or liability arising as a consequence of, a Bank Levy).

 

80


  (c)

A Finance Party making, or intending to make a claim under paragraph (a) above, shall promptly notify the Facility Agent of the event which will give, or has given, rise to the claim following which the Facility Agent shall notify the Company.

 

  (d)

A Finance Party shall, on receiving a payment from an Obligor under this Clause 18.2, notify the Facility Agent.

 

18.3

Tax Credit

If an Obligor makes a Tax Payment and the relevant Finance Party determines that:

 

  (a)

a Tax Credit is attributable to an increased payment of which that Tax Payment forms part, to that Tax Payment or to a Tax Deduction in consequence of which that Tax Payment was required; and

 

  (b)

that Finance Party (or another member of a fiscal group of which that Finance Party forms part) has obtained and utilised that Tax Credit,

that Finance Party shall pay an amount to that Obligor which that Finance Party determines will leave it (taking into account a Tax Credit of the fiscal group of which that Finance Party forms part) (after that payment) in the same after-Tax position as it would have been in had the Tax Payment not been required to be made by that Obligor.

 

18.4

Lender Status Confirmation

 

  (a)

Each Lender which is not an Original Lender shall indicate, in the documentation which it executes on becoming a Party as a Lender, and for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without liability to any Obligor, which of the following categories it falls in:

 

  (i)

in respect of a Lender to a Singapore Borrower:

 

  (A)

a Singapore Qualifying Lender (other than a Singapore Treaty Lender);

 

  (B)

a Singapore Treaty Lender; or

 

  (C)

not a Singapore Qualifying Lender;

 

  (ii)

in respect of a Lender to a US Borrower:

 

  (A)

a US Qualifying Lender; or

 

  (B)

not a US Qualifying Lender;

 

  (iii)

in respect of a Lender to a German Borrower:

 

  (A)

a German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender);

 

  (B)

a German Treaty Lender; or

 

  (C)

not a German Qualifying Lender; or

 

  (iv)

in respect of a Lender to an Other Borrower:

 

  (A)

an Other Qualifying Lender (other than an Other Treaty Lender);

 

  (B)

an Other Treaty Lender; or

 

  (C)

not an Other Qualifying Lender.

 

81


  (b)

If such a Lender fails to indicate its status in accordance with this Clause 18.4 then that Lender shall be treated for the purposes of this Agreement (including by each Obligor) as if it is not a Qualifying Lender until such time as it notifies the Facility Agent which category applies (and the Facility Agent, upon receipt of such notification, shall inform the Company). For the avoidance of doubt, the documentation which a Lender executes on becoming a Party as a Lender shall not be invalidated by any failure of a Lender to comply with this Clause 18.4.

 

18.5

Stamp Taxes

The Company shall pay and, within five (5) Business Days of written demand, indemnify each Finance Party against any cost, loss or liability that Finance Party incurs in relation to all stamp duty, registration and other similar Taxes payable in respect of any Finance Document other than as a result of a Finance Party assigning or transferring any of its rights or obligations under any Finance Document.

 

18.6

VAT

 

  (a)

All amounts set out, or expressed to be payable under a Finance Document by any Party to a Finance Party which (in whole or part) constitute the consideration for a supply or supplies for VAT purposes shall be deemed to be exclusive of any VAT which is chargeable on such supply or supplies, and accordingly, subject to paragraph (b) below, if VAT is or becomes chargeable on any supply made by any Finance Party to any Party under a Finance Document and such Finance Party is required to account to the relevant tax authority for VAT, that Party shall pay to the Finance Party (in addition to and at the same time as paying the consideration for such supply) an amount equal to the amount of the VAT (and such Finance Party shall promptly provide an appropriate VAT invoice to such Party).

 

  (b)

If VAT is or becomes chargeable on any supply made by any Finance Party (the “Supplier”) to any other Finance Party (the “Recipient”) under a Finance Document, and any Party other than the Recipient (the “Relevant Party”) is required by the terms of any Finance Document to pay an amount equal to the consideration for such supply to the Supplier (rather than being required to reimburse the Recipient in respect of that consideration):

 

  (i)

(where the Supplier is the person required to account to the relevant tax authority for the VAT) the Relevant Party shall also pay to the Supplier (in addition to and at the same time as paying such amount) an amount equal to the amount of such VAT. The Recipient will (where this paragraph (i) applies) promptly pay to the Relevant Party an amount equal to any credit or repayment the Recipient receives from the relevant tax authority which the Recipient reasonably determines relates to the VAT chargeable on that supply; and

 

  (ii)

(where the Recipient is the person required to account to the relevant tax authority for the VAT) the Relevant Party must promptly, following demand from the Recipient, pay to the Recipient an amount equal to the VAT chargeable on that supply but only to the extent that the Recipient reasonably determines that it or any member of the group of which it is a member for VAT purposes is not entitled to credit or repayment from the relevant tax authority in respect of that VAT.

 

  (c)

Where a Finance Document requires any Party to reimburse or indemnify a Finance Party for any cost or expense, that Party shall reimburse or indemnify (as the case may be) such Finance Party for the full amount of such cost or expense including such part thereof as represents VAT, save to the extent that such Finance Party reasonably determines that it or any other member of any group of which it is a member for VAT purposes is entitled to credit or repayment in respect of such VAT from the relevant tax authority.

 

82


  (d)

Any reference in this Clause 18.6 (VAT) to any Party shall, at any time when such Party is treated as a member of a group for VAT purposes, include (where appropriate and unless the context otherwise requires) a reference to the person who is treated at that time as making the supply, or (as appropriate) receiving the supply, under the grouping rules (provided for in Article 11 of Council Directive 2006/112/EC (or as implemented by the relevant member state of the EU) or any other similar provision in any jurisdiction which is not a member state of the EU) so that a reference to a Party shall be construed as a reference to that Party or the relevant group or unity (or fiscal unity) of which that Party is a member for VAT purposes at the relevant time or the relevant representative member (or head) of that group or unity (or fiscal unity) at the relevant time (as the case may be).

 

  (e)

In relation to any supply made by a Finance Party to any Party under a Finance Document, if reasonably requested by such Finance Party, that Party must promptly provide such Finance Party with details of that Party’s VAT registration and such other information as is reasonably requested in connection with such Finance Party’s VAT reporting requirements in relation to such supply.

 

  (f)

Notwithstanding paragraphs (a) through (e) above, no Borrower is required to pay VAT if such VAT is solely due because a Finance Party has voluntarily opted to subject a payment to VAT, unless the Borrower is able to claim such VAT as input VAT. The Borrower shall cooperate and provide any reasonable information in respect of such claim for refund as input VAT.

 

18.7

FATCA Information

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, each Party shall, within ten (10) Business Days of a reasonable request by another Party:

 

  (i)

confirm to that other Party whether it is:

 

  (A)

a FATCA Exempt Party; or

 

  (B)

not a FATCA Exempt Party;

 

  (ii)

supply to that other Party such forms, documentation and other information relating to its status under FATCA as that other Party reasonably requests for the purposes of that other Party’s compliance with FATCA; and

 

  (iii)

supply to that other Party such forms, documentation and other information relating to its status as that other Party reasonably requests for the purposes of that other Party’s compliance with any other law, regulation, or exchange of information regime.

 

  (b)

If a Party confirms to another Party pursuant to paragraph (a)(i) above that it is a FATCA Exempt Party and it subsequently becomes aware that it is not or has ceased to be a FATCA Exempt Party, that Party shall notify that other Party reasonably promptly.

 

  (c)

Paragraph (a) above shall not oblige any Finance Party to do anything, and paragraph (a)(iii) above shall not oblige any other Party to do anything, which would or might in its reasonable opinion constitute a breach of:

 

  (i)

any law or regulation;

 

  (ii)

any fiduciary duty; or

 

  (iii)

any duty of confidentiality.

 

83


  (d)

If a Party fails to confirm whether or not it is a FATCA Exempt Party or to supply forms, documentation or other information requested in accordance with paragraph (a)(i) or (ii) above (including, for the avoidance of doubt, where paragraph (c) above applies), then such Party shall be treated for the purposes of the Finance Documents (and payments under them) as if it is not a FATCA Exempt Party until such time as the Party in question provides the requested confirmation, forms, documentation or other information.

 

  (e)

If the Company is a US Tax Obligor or the Facility Agent reasonably believes that its obligations under FATCA or any other applicable law or regulation require the supply to the Facility Agent of any of the items referred to in (A) or (B) of this paragraph (e), each Lender shall, within ten (10) Business Days of:

 

  (i)

where the Company is a US Tax Obligor and the relevant Lender is an Original Lender, the Signing Date;

 

  (ii)

where the Company is a US Tax Obligor on a Transfer Date and the relevant Lender is a New Lender, the relevant Transfer Date; or

 

  (iii)

where the Company is not a US Tax Obligor, the date of a request from the Facility Agent,

supply to the Facility Agent:

 

  (A)

a withholding certificate on Form W-8, Form W-9 or any other relevant form; or

 

  (B)

any withholding statement or other document, authorisation or waiver as the Facility Agent may require to certify or establish the status of such Lender under FATCA or that other law or regulation.

 

  (f)

The Facility Agent shall provide any withholding certificate, withholding statement, document, authorisation or waiver it receives from a Lender pursuant to paragraph (e) above to the Company.

 

  (g)

If any withholding certificate, withholding statement, document, authorisation or waiver provided to the Facility Agent by a Lender pursuant to paragraph (e) above is or becomes materially inaccurate or incomplete, that Lender shall promptly update it and provide such updated withholding certificate, withholding statement, document, authorisation or waiver to the Facility Agent unless it is unlawful for the Lender to do so (in which case the Lender shall promptly notify the Facility Agent). The Facility Agent shall provide any such updated withholding certificate, withholding statement, document, authorisation or waiver to the Company.

 

  (h)

The Facility Agent may rely on any withholding certificate, withholding statement, document, authorisation or waiver it receives from a Lender pursuant to paragraph (e) or (g) above without further verification. The Facility Agent shall not be liable for any action taken by it under or in connection with paragraph (e), (f) or (g) above.

 

18.8

FATCA Deduction

 

  (a)

Each Party may make any FATCA Deduction it is required to make by FATCA, and any payment required in connection with that FATCA Deduction, and no Party shall be required to increase any payment in respect of which it makes such a FATCA Deduction or otherwise compensate the recipient of the payment for that FATCA Deduction.

 

  (b)

Each Party shall promptly, upon becoming aware that it must make a FATCA Deduction (or that there is any change in the rate or the basis of such FATCA Deduction), notify the Party to whom it is making the payment and, in addition, shall notify the Company and the Facility Agent and the Facility Agent shall notify the other Finance Parties.

 

84


19.

INCREASED COSTS

 

19.1

Increased costs

 

  (a)

Subject to Clause 19.3 (Exceptions), the Company shall, within five (5) Business Days of a demand by the Facility Agent, pay for the account of a Finance Party the amount of any Increased Costs incurred by that Finance Party or any of its Affiliates as a result of:

 

  (i)

the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) any law or legally binding regulation; or

 

  (ii)

compliance with any law or legally binding regulation made after the Signing Date.

 

  (b)

In this Agreement:

 

  (i)

Increased Costs” means:

 

  (A)

a reduction in the rate of return from a Facility or on a Finance Party’s (or its Affiliate’s) overall capital;

 

  (B)

an additional or increased cost; or

 

  (C)

a reduction of any amount due and payable under any Finance Document,

which is incurred or suffered by a Finance Party or any of its Affiliates to the extent that it is attributable to that Finance Party having entered into its Commitment or an Ancillary Commitment or funding or performing its obligations under any Finance Document or Letter of Credit.

 

  (ii)

CRD IV” means:

 

  (A)

Regulation (EU) No 575/2013 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 26 June 2013 on prudential requirements for credit institutions and investment firms and amending Regulation (EU) No. 648/2012; and

 

  (B)

Directive 2013/36/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 26 June 2013 on access to the activity of credit institutions and the prudential supervision of credit institutions and investment firms, amending Directive 2002/87/EC and repealing Directives 2006/48/EC and 2006/49/EC,

and any law, rule or guidance by which CRD IV is implemented.

 

  (iii)

CRD IV Costs” means any Increased Cost which is attributable to or results from the implementation or application of, or compliance with, the changes implemented under CRD IV.

 

19.2

Increased Cost claims

 

  (a)

A Finance Party intending to make a claim pursuant to Clause 19.1 (Increased costs) shall notify the Facility Agent of the event giving rise to the claim, following which the Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Company.

 

  (b)

Each Finance Party shall, as soon as practicable after a demand by the Company (delivered via the Facility Agent), provide a certificate confirming:

 

85


  (i)

the amount of its Increased Costs; and

 

  (ii)

the calculation of such amount.

 

19.3

Exceptions

Clause 19.1 (Increased costs) does not apply to the extent:

 

  (a)

any Increased Cost is:

 

  (i)

compensated under Clause 18.1 (Tax Gross-up), Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity), Clause 18.5 (Stamp Taxes) or Clause 18.6 (VAT) (or would have been so compensated but for the exclusions therein);

 

  (ii)

attributable to a FATCA Deduction required to be made by a Party;

 

  (iii)

attributable to an Excluded Tax;

 

  (iv)

attributable to any Bank Levy (or any payment attributable to, or liability arising as a consequence of, a Bank Levy);

 

  (v)

attributable to the wilful breach by the relevant Finance Party or its Affiliates of any law or regulation;

 

  (vi)

attributable to the implementation or application of or compliance with the “International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards, a Revised Framework” published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (“BCBS”) in June 2004 in the form existing on the Signing Date (but excluding any amendment arising out of Basel III or CRD IV) (“Basel II”) or any other law or regulation which implements Basel II (whether such implementation, application or compliance is by a government, regulator, Finance Party or any of its Affiliates);

 

  (vii)

attributable to the implementation or application of or compliance with the agreements on capital requirements, a leverage ratio and liquidity standards contained in “Basel III: A global regulatory framework for more resilient banks and banking systems”, “Basel III: “International framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring” and “Guidance for national authorities operating the countercyclical capital buffer” published by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision on 16 December 2010, each as amended, supplemented and restated (“Basel III”) or any other law or regulation which implements Basel III (whether such implementation, application or compliance is by a government, regulator, Finance Party or any of its affiliates) (“Basel III Costs”) or CRD IV Costs unless a Finance Party delivers to the Company a statement certifying that, to the best of its knowledge, it is that Finance Party’s general policy to seek to recover such Basel III Costs or CRD IV Costs, as applicable, in relation to similar facilities with other similar borrowers. If a Finance Party has delivered such duly signed statement, it will not be required to provide any further evidence or substantiate its policy concerning Basel III Costs and CRD IV Costs; or

 

  (viii)

attributable to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act or any request, rule guideline or directive thereunder or issued in connection therewith unless a Finance Party delivers to the Company a statement certifying that, to the best of its knowledge, it is that Finance Party’s general policy to seek to recover such costs in relation to similar facilities. If a Finance Party has delivered such duly signed statement, it will not be required to provide any further evidence or substantiate its policy concerning the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and all requests, rules, guidelines or directives thereunder or issued in connection therewith; or

 

86


  (b)

the relevant Finance Party does not notify the Facility Agent of its intention to make a claim within ninety (90) days after the date of which that Finance Party becomes aware of the relevant Increased Cost.

 

20.

OTHER INDEMNITIES

 

20.1

Currency indemnity

 

  (a)

If any sum due from an Obligor under the Finance Documents (a “Sum”), or any order, judgment or award given or made in relation to a Sum, has to be converted from the currency (the “First Currency”) in which that Sum is payable into another currency (the “Second Currency”) for the purpose of:

 

  (i)

making or filing a claim or proof against that Obligor; or

 

  (ii)

obtaining or enforcing an order, judgment or award in relation to any litigation or arbitration proceedings against that Obligor,

that Obligor shall, as an independent obligation, within five (5) Business Days of written demand, indemnify each Finance Party to whom that Sum is due against any cost, loss or liability arising out of or as a result of the currency conversion including any discrepancy between (A) the rate of exchange used to convert that Sum from the First Currency into the Second Currency and (B) the rate or rates of exchange available to that person at the time of its receipt of that Sum.

 

  (b)

Each Obligor waives any right it may have in any jurisdiction to pay any amount under the Finance Documents in a currency or currency unit other than that in which it is expressed to be payable.

 

20.2

Other indemnities

The Company shall (or shall procure that an Obligor will), within five (5) Business Days of written demand, indemnify the Arrangers, and each other Finance Party against any cost, loss or liability incurred by it as a result of:

 

  (a)

the occurrence of any Event of Default;

 

  (b)

a failure by an Obligor to pay any amount due under a Finance Document on its due date;

 

  (c)

funding, or making arrangements to fund, its participation in a Loan requested by the Company or a Borrower in a Utilisation Request but not made by reason of the operation of any one or more of the provisions of this Agreement (other than by reason of default or negligence by that Finance Party alone); or

 

  (d)

issuing or making arrangements to issue a Letter of Credit requested by the Company or a Borrower in a Utilisation Request but not issued by reason of the operation of any one or more of the provisions of this Agreement (other than by reason of default or negligence by that Finance Party alone); or

 

  (e)

a Utilisation (or part of a Utilisation) not being prepaid in accordance with a notice of prepayment given by a Borrower or the Company, including any loss (other than in the case of paragraph (c) above, loss of Margin) or expense on account of funds borrowed, contracted for or utilised to fund any amount payable under any Finance Document or Utilisation.

 

87


20.3

Indemnity to the Facility Agent

Subject to Clause 23 (Costs and Expenses), the Company shall promptly, and in any event within five (5) Business Days, indemnify the Facility Agent against:

 

  (a)

any reasonable and documented cost, loss or liability (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) incurred by the Facility Agent as a direct result of:

 

  (i)

instructing lawyers, accountants, tax advisers, surveyors, a financial adviser or other professional advisers or experts whilst investigating any event which it reasonably believes is a Default or in responding to a waiver request; or

 

  (ii)

acting or relying on any notice, request or instruction which it reasonably believes to be genuine, correct and appropriately authorised; and

 

  (b)

any cost, loss or liability incurred in connection with claims of third parties (other than Finance Parties) by the Facility Agent (otherwise than by reason of the Facility Agent’s gross negligence or wilful misconduct).

 

21.

MITIGATION BY THE LENDERS

 

21.1

Mitigation

 

  (a)

Each Lender shall, in consultation with the Company, take all reasonable steps to mitigate any circumstances which arise and which would result in any Facility ceasing to be available or any amount becoming payable under or pursuant to, or cancelled pursuant to, any of Clause 11.1 (Illegality), (or, in respect of the Issuing Bank, Clause 11.2 (Illegality in relation to Issuing Bank), Clause 18.1 (Tax Gross-up), Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity) or Clause 19 (Increased Costs) including by transferring its rights and obligations under the Finance Documents to another Affiliate or Facility Office or and/or taking reasonable steps to secure the benefit of any Tax Credit.

 

  (b)

Paragraph (a) above does not in any way limit the obligations of any Obligor under the Finance Documents.

 

21.2

Limitation of liability

 

  (a)

The Company shall promptly indemnify each Lender for all reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) incurred by that Lender as a result of steps taken by it under Clause 21.1 (Mitigation).

 

  (b)

A Lender is not obliged to take any steps under Clause 21.1 (Mitigation) if, in the opinion of that Lender (acting reasonably), to do so might be prejudicial to it.

 

22.

GUARANTEE AND INDEMNITY

 

22.1

Guarantee and Indemnity

Each Guarantor irrevocably and unconditionally jointly and severally:

 

  (a)

guarantees to each Finance Party punctual performance by each other Obligor of all that Obligor’s obligations under the Finance Documents (including, without limitation, all amounts which, but for any US Debtor Relief Law, would become due and payable and all interest accruing after the commencement of any proceeding under a US Debtor Relief Law at the rate provided for in the relevant Finance Document, whether or not allowed in any such proceeding);

 

88


  (b)

undertakes with each Finance Party that whenever another Obligor does not pay any amount when due under or in connection with any Finance Document, that Guarantor shall immediately on demand pay that amount as if it was the principal obligor; and

 

  (c)

agrees with each Finance Party that if any obligation guaranteed by it is or becomes unenforceable, invalid or illegal, it will, as an independent and primary obligation, indemnify that Finance Party immediately on demand against any cost, loss or liability it incurs as a result of an Obligor not paying any amount which would, but for such unenforceability, invalidity or illegality, have been payable by it under any Finance Document on the date when it would have been due. The amount payable by a Guarantor under this indemnity will not exceed the amount it would have had to pay under this Clause 22 if the amount claimed had been recoverable on the basis of a guarantee.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, upon any Automatic Acceleration Event any presentment, demand, protest or notice of any kind required by the foregoing clauses are expressly waived

 

22.2

Continuing guarantee

This guarantee is a continuing guarantee and will extend to the ultimate balance of sums payable by any Obligor under the Finance Documents, regardless of any intermediate payment or discharge in whole or in part.

 

22.3

Reinstatement

If any discharge, release or arrangement (whether in respect of the obligations of any Obligor or any security for those obligations or otherwise) is made by a Finance Party in whole or in part on the basis of any payment, security or other disposition which is avoided or must be restored in insolvency, liquidation, administration, judicial management or otherwise, without limitation, then the liability of each Guarantor under this Clause 22 will continue or be reinstated as if the discharge, release or arrangement had not occurred.

 

22.4

Waiver of defences

The obligations of each Guarantor under this Clause 22 will not be affected by an act, omission, matter or thing which, but for this Clause 22, would reduce, release or prejudice any of its obligations under this Clause 22 (without limitation and whether or not known to it or any Finance Party) including:

 

  (a)

any time, waiver or consent granted to, or composition with, any Obligor or other person;

 

  (b)

the release of any other Obligor or any other person under the terms of any composition or arrangement with any creditor of any member of the Group;

 

  (c)

the taking, variation, compromise, exchange, renewal or release of, or refusal or neglect to perfect, take up or enforce, any rights against, or security over assets of, any Obligor or other person or any non-presentation or non-observance of any formality or other requirement in respect of any instrument or any failure to realise the full value of any security;

 

  (d)

any incapacity or lack of power, authority or legal personality of or dissolution or change in the members or status of an Obligor or any other person;

 

  (e)

any amendment, novation, supplement, extension, restatement (however fundamental and whether or not more onerous) or replacement of a Finance Document or any other document or security including without limitation any change in the purpose of, any extension of or increase in any facility or the addition of any new facility under any Finance Document or other document or security;

 

89


  (f)

any unenforceability, illegality or invalidity of any obligation of any person under any Finance Document or any other document or security; or

 

  (g)

any insolvency or similar proceedings.

 

22.5

Guarantor intent

Without prejudice to the generality of Clause 22.4 (Waiver of defences), each Guarantor expressly confirms that it intends that this guarantee shall extend from time to time to any (however fundamental) variation, increase, extension or addition of or to any of the Finance Documents and/or any facility or amount made available under any of the Finance Documents for the purposes of or in connection with any of the following: business acquisitions of any nature; increasing working capital; enabling investor distributions to be made; carrying out restructurings; refinancing existing facilities; refinancing any other indebtedness; making facilities available to new borrowers; any other variation or extension of the purposes for which any such facility or amount might be made available from time to time; and any fees, costs and/or expenses associated with any of the foregoing.

 

22.6

Immediate recourse

Each Guarantor waives any right it may have of first requiring any Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) to proceed against or enforce any other rights or security or claim payment from any person before claiming from that Guarantor under this Clause 22. This waiver applies irrespective of any law or any provision of a Finance Document to the contrary.

 

22.7

Appropriations

Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full, each Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) may:

 

  (a)

refrain from applying or enforcing any other moneys, security or rights held or received by that Finance Party (or any trustee or agent on its behalf) in respect of those amounts, or apply and enforce the same in such manner and order as it sees fit (whether against those amounts or otherwise) and no Guarantor shall be entitled to the benefit of the same; and

 

  (b)

hold in an interest-bearing suspense account any moneys received from any Guarantor or on account of any Guarantor’s liability under this Clause 22.

 

22.8

Deferral of Guarantors’ rights

Until all amounts which may be or become payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been irrevocably paid in full and unless the Facility Agent otherwise directs, no Guarantor will exercise any rights which it may have by reason of performance by it of its obligations under the Finance Documents or by reason of any amount being payable, or liability arising, under this Clause 22:

 

  (a)

to be indemnified by an Obligor;

 

  (b)

to claim any contribution from any other guarantor of any Obligor’s obligations under the Finance Documents;

 

90


  (c)

to take the benefit (in whole or in part and whether by way of subrogation or otherwise) of any rights of the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents or of any other guarantee or security taken pursuant to, or in connection with, the Finance Documents by any Finance Party;

 

  (d)

to bring legal or other proceedings for an order requiring any Obligor to make any payment, or perform any obligation, in respect of which any Guarantor has given a guarantee, undertaking or indemnity under Clause 22.1 (Guarantee and indemnity);

 

  (e)

to exercise any right of set-off against any Obligor; and/or

 

  (f)

to claim or prove as a creditor of any Obligor in competition with any Finance Party.

If a Guarantor receives any benefit, payment or distribution in relation to such rights it shall hold that benefit, payment or distribution to the extent necessary to enable all amounts which may be or become payable to the Finance Parties by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents to be repaid in full on trust for the Finance Parties and shall promptly pay or transfer the same to the Facility Agent or as the Facility Agent may direct for application in accordance with Clause 35 (Payment mechanics).

 

22.9

Release of Guarantors’ right of contribution

If any Guarantor (a “Retiring Guarantor”) ceases to be a Guarantor in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents for the purpose of any sale or other disposal of that Retiring Guarantor then on the date such Retiring Guarantor ceases to be a Guarantor:

 

  (a)

that Retiring Guarantor is released by each other Guarantor from any liability (whether past, present or future and whether actual or contingent) to make a contribution to any other Guarantor arising by reason of the performance by any other Guarantor of its obligations under the Finance Documents; and

 

  (b)

each other Guarantor waives any rights it may have by reason of the performance of its obligations under the Finance Documents to take the benefit (in whole or in part and whether by way of subrogation or otherwise) of any rights of the Finance Parties under any Finance Document or of any other security taken pursuant to, or in connection with, any Finance Document where such rights or security are granted by or in relation to the assets of the Retiring Guarantor.

 

22.10

Additional security

This guarantee is in addition to and is not in any way prejudiced by any other guarantee or security now or subsequently held by any Finance Party.

 

22.11

Guarantee limitations

 

  (a)

General

With respect to any Additional Guarantor, this guarantee is subject to any limitations set out in the Accession Deed applicable to such Additional Guarantor.

 

  (b)

Germany

Any guarantee owing by a Guarantor incorporated and existing as a German limited liability company (Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung) (“German GmbH Guarantor”), shall be subject to the following limitations:

 

91


  (i)

To the extent that a guarantee secures amounts which are owed by direct or indirect shareholder(s) of a German GmbH Guarantor (“Up-stream Guarantee”) or its affiliated companies (verbundenes Unternehmen) within the meaning of section 15 of the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz) (other than directly or indirectly wholly-owned subsidiaries of that German GmbH Guarantor) (“Cross-stream Guarantee”) (save for any guarantees in respect of funds to the extent they are on-lent to, or letters of credit issued for the benefit of, that German GmbH Guarantor or its directly or indirectly wholly-owned subsidiaries, and such amount on-lent or letters of credit are still outstanding), this guarantee shall not be enforced at the time of the respective Payment Demand (as defined below) if and to the extent the German GmbH Guarantor demonstrates to the satisfaction of the Facility Agent (acting reasonably) that the enforcement would have the effect of:

 

  (A)

causing the relevant German GmbH Guarantor’s net assets (the “Net Assets”) to be reduced below zero; or (if its Net Assets are already below zero) causing such amount to be further reduced,

 

  (B)

and thereby affecting its assets required for the maintenance of its stated share capital (Stammkapital) pursuant to sections 30, 31 German Limited Liability Company Act (Gesetz betreffend die Gesellschaften mit beschränkter Haftung, “GmbHG”) (as applicable at the time of enforcement).

 

  (ii)

The value of the Net Assets shall be determined in accordance with German GAAP consistently applied by the relevant German GmbH Guarantor in preparing its unconsolidated balance sheets (Jahresabschluss according to Section 42 GmbHG, Sections 242, 264 German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch)) in the previous years, provided that for the purposes of the calculation of the Net Assets, the following balance sheet items shall be adjusted as follows:

 

  (A)

the amount of any increase of the stated share capital (Erhöhung des Stammkapitals) after the Signing Date that has been effected without the prior written consent of the Facility Agent, shall be deducted from the stated share capital;

 

  (B)

loans and other contractual liabilities incurred by the relevant German GmbH Guarantor in wilful or negligent violation of the provisions of this Agreement, shall be disregarded;

 

  (C)

the costs of the Auditor’s Determination (as defined below), shall be taken into account either as a reduction of assets or as an increase of liabilities;

 

  (D)

the amounts which pursuant to Section 268 paragraph 8 of the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch) must not be distributed to the shareholders of the German GmbH Guarantor shall be deducted from the Net Assets.

 

  (iii)

The limitations set out in paragraph (b)(i) above only apply if within twenty (20) Business Days following receipt of a notice from the Facility Agent stating that the Facility Agent demands payment under the guarantee against the relevant German GmbH Guarantor (the “Payment Demand”), the managing director(s) of such German GmbH Guarantor has (have) confirmed in writing to the Facility Agent:

 

92


  (A)

to what extent the guarantee is an Up-stream Guarantee or a Cross-stream Guarantee as described in paragraph (b)(i) above; and

 

  (B)

which amount of such Up-stream Guarantee and/or Cross-stream Guarantee cannot be enforced as the respective German GmbH Guarantor’s Net Assets are below zero or such enforcement would cause such German GmbH Guarantor’s Net Assets to be reduced below zero, and such confirmation is supported by an up-to-date balance sheet of such German GmbH Guarantor together with a detailed calculation of the amount of such German GmbH Guarantor’s Net Assets taking into account the adjustments and obligations set forth in paragraph (b)(ii) above (the “Management Determination”). The Facility Agent shall then be entitled to enforce the guarantee in an amount which would, in accordance with the Management Determination, not cause the German GmbH Guarantor’s Net Assets to be reduced below zero.

 

  (iv)

Following the Facility Agent’s receipt of the Management Determination, the relevant German GmbH Guarantor shall deliver to the Facility Agent within thirty (30) Business Days of a written request from the Facility Agent an up-to-date balance sheet of the German GmbH Guarantor, drawn-up by an auditor of international standard and reputation appointed by the relevant German GmbH Guarantor together with a detailed calculation of the amount of the Net Assets of the relevant company taking into account the adjustments and obligations set forth in paragraph (b)(ii) above (the “Auditors Determination”). The Facility Agent shall then be entitled to enforce the guarantee in an amount which would, in accordance with the Auditor’s Determination, not cause the German GmbH Guarantor’s Net Assets to be reduced below zero.

 

  (v)

Each German GmbH Guarantor shall within three (3) calendar months after receipt of the Payment Demand and of a written request from the Facility Agent realise, to the extent legally permitted and commercially reasonable, any assets that are (i) shown in the balance sheet with a book value (Buchwert) that is substantially lower than the market value of the assets and (ii) not required for continuing its business, if, as a result of the enforcement of the guarantee, its Net Assets would be reduced below zero. After the expiry of such three (3) calendar months period the German GmbH Guarantor shall, within ten (10) Business Days, notify the Facility Agent of the net amount of the proceeds from the sale and submit a statement setting forth a new calculation of the amount of the Net Assets of the German GmbH Guarantor taking into account such proceeds. Such calculation shall, upon the Facility Agent’s request, be confirmed by the auditors referred to in paragraph (iv) above within a period of thirty (30) Business Days following the request.

 

  (vi)

The restrictions set forth in paragraph (b)(i) above shall not apply, if and to the extent:

 

  (A)

the relevant German GmbH Guarantor has failed to comply with its obligations pursuant to paragraphs (iii) through (v) above;

 

  (B)

the relevant German GmbH Guarantor is a party to a profit and loss sharing agreement (Gewinnabführungsvertrag) and/or a domination agreement (Beherrschungsvertrag) where the relevant German GmbH Guarantor is the dominated entity (beherrschtes Unternehmen) and/or the entity being obliged to share its profits with the other party of such profit and loss sharing agreement, unless a restriction or limitation is necessary in order to avoid a violation of the capital maintenance requirement as set out in section 30, paragraph 1 of the GmbHG; or

 

  (C)

the relevant German GmbH Guarantor holds, at the time when a payment is made under the guarantee, a fully recoverable indemnity or claim for refund (vollwertiger Gegenleistungs- oder Rückgewähranspruch) against the relevant shareholder covering at least the relevant amount enforced under the guarantee.

 

93


  (vii)

If there will be available any high court rulings holding that the granting of an Up-stream Guarantee and/or Cross-stream Guarantee may, in case of the enforcement of such guarantee, trigger any liability of the German GmbH Guarantor’s directors pursuant to Section 64 sentence 3 GmbHG, the Facility Agent shall, upon request of the respective German GmbH Guarantor’s directors and on the condition that the debt structure is (to the extent legally possible) further improved, e.g. through a push down of loans to the level of the relevant German GmbH Guarantor, enter into negotiations and consider (acting reasonably) whether to make appropriate adjustments to this provisions to avoid any personal liability of the managing directors pursuant to Section 64 sentence 3 GmbHG, resulting solely from the granting of such guarantee by the managing directors and not from any other personal misconduct of the German GmbH Guarantor’s directors.

 

  (viii)

This limitation shall apply mutatis mutandis to a Guarantor organised and existing as a partnership organised under any law with a German limited liability company (Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung) as unlimited partner, provided that in such case and for the purpose of this limitation only any reference to such Guarantor’s net assets (Reinvermögen) shall be deemed to be a reference to the net assets (Reinvermögen), and any reference to an unlawful payment by such German GmbH Guarantor shall be deemed to be a reference of an unlawful payment, of any unlimited partner which is a German limited liability company (Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung).

 

  (c)

United States

Each Guarantor incorporated, formed or organised under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia (each, a “US Guarantor”), and by its acceptance of the guarantee under this Clause 22, the Facility Agent and each other Finance Party, hereby confirms that it is the intention of all such persons that the guarantee under this Clause 22 and the obligations of each US Guarantor under this Clause 22 not constitute a fraudulent transfer or conveyance or unlawful financial assistance for purposes of Title 11 of the United States Code entitled Bankruptcy, as amended, or any successor thereof, the Uniform Fraudulent Conveyance Act, the Uniform Fraudulent Transfer Act or any similar federal or state law to the extent applicable to the guarantee under this Clause 22 and the obligations of each US Guarantor under this Clause 22. To effectuate the foregoing intention, the Facility Agent, the other Finance Parties and each such US Guarantor hereby irrevocably agree that the obligations of each US Guarantor under this Clause 22 shall be limited to the maximum amount as will, after giving effect to any collections from rights to receive contribution from or payments made by or on behalf of any other Guarantor in respect of the obligations of such other Guarantor under this Clause 22, result in the obligations of such Guarantor under its guarantee not constituting a fraudulent transfer or conveyance. The Company acknowledges that it will receive, directly or indirectly, a portion of the proceeds of the Loans under this Agreement and each US Guarantor acknowledges that it will derive substantial direct and indirect benefits from the transactions contemplated by this Agreement (including the making of the Loans thereunder).

 

22.12

Acknowledgement regarding any Supported QFCs

 

  (a)

To the extent that the Finance Documents provide support, through a guarantee or otherwise, for any Hedge Agreement or any other agreement or instrument that is a QFC (such support “QFC Credit Support” and each such QFC, a “Supported QFC”) the Parties acknowledge and agree as follows with respect to the resolution power of the Federal Deposit Insurance

 

94


  Corporation under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act and Title II of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (together with the regulations promulgated thereunder, the “US Special Resolution Regimes”) in respect of such Supported QFC and QFC Credit Support.

 

  (b)

In the event a Covered Entity that is party to a Supported QFC (each, a “Covered Party”) becomes subject to a proceeding under a US Special Resolution Regime, the transfer of such Supported QFC and the benefit of such QFC Credit Support (and any interest and obligation in or under such Supported QFC and such QFC Credit Support, and any rights in property securing such Supported QFC or such QFC Credit Support) from such Covered Party will be effective to the same extent as the transfer would be effective under the US Special Resolution Regime if the Supported QFC and such QFC Credit Support (and any such interest, obligation and rights in property) were governed by the laws of the United States or a state of the United States. In the event a Covered Party or a BHC Act Affiliate of a Covered Party becomes subject to a proceeding under a US Special Resolution Regime, Default Rights under the Finance Documents that might otherwise apply to such Supported QFC or any QFC Credit Support that may be exercised against such Covered Party are permitted to be exercised to no greater extent than such Default Rights could be exercised under the US Special Resolution Regime if the Supported QFC and the Finance Documents were governed by the laws of the United States or a state of the United States. Without limitation of the foregoing, it is understood and agreed that rights and remedies of the Parties with respect to a Defaulting Lender shall in no event affect the rights of any Covered Party with respect to a Supported QFC or any QFC Credit Support.

 

  (c)

As used in this Clause 22.12, the following terms have the following meanings:

BHC Act Affiliate” of a Party means an “affiliate” (as such term is defined under, and interpreted in accordance with, section 2(k) of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (12 U.S.C. 1841(k))) of such Party.

Covered Entity” means any of the following:

 

  (i)

a “covered entity” as that term is defined in, and interpreted in accordance with, section 252.82(b) of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations (12 C.F.R. § 252.82(b));

 

  (ii)

a “covered bank” as that term is defined in, and interpreted in accordance with section 47.3(b) of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations (12 C.F.R. § 47.3(b)); or

 

  (iii)

a “covered FSI” as that term is defined in, and interpreted in accordance with, section 382.2(b) of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations (12 C.F.R. § 382.2(b)).

Default Right” has the meaning assigned to that term in, and shall be interpreted in accordance with, sections 252.81, 47.2 or 382.1 (as applicable) of Title 12 of the Code of Federal Regulations (12 C.F.R. §§ 252.81, 47.2 or 382.1, as applicable).

Hedge Agreement” means (a) any and all rate swap transactions, basis swaps, credit derivative transactions, forward rate transactions, commodity swaps, commodity options, forward commodity contracts, equity or equity index swaps or options, bond or bond price or bond index swaps or options or forward bond or forward bond price or forward bond index transactions, interest rate options, forward foreign exchange transactions, cap transactions, floor transactions, collar transactions, currency swap transactions, cross-currency rate swap transactions, currency options, spot contracts, or any other similar transactions or any combination of any of the foregoing (including any options to enter into any of the foregoing),

 

95


whether or not any such transaction is governed by or subject to any master agreement, and (b) any and all transactions of any kind, and the related confirmations, which are subject to the terms and conditions of, or governed by, any form of master agreement published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc., any International Foreign Exchange Master Agreement or any other master agreement (any such master agreement, together with any related schedules, a “Master Agreement”), including any such obligations or liabilities under any Master Agreement.

QFC” has the meaning assigned to the term “qualified financial contract” in, and shall be interpreted in accordance with, section 210(c)(8)(D) of Title II of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (12 U.S.C. 5390(c)(8)(D)).

 

23.

COSTS AND EXPENSES

 

23.1

Transaction Expenses

 

  (a)

The Company shall pay (without double counting), on the date of Financial Close in respect of the relevant Facility (or at such earlier or other dates as may be specified in any relevant Fee Letter), the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank, any Arranger and any Bookrunner in accordance with, and subject to, the commitment letter(s) and/or mandate letter(s) and/or fee letter(s) entered into by the Company with the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank, such Arranger and such Bookrunner the amount of all reasonable and documented pre-agreed costs and expenses (including legal fees (up to any pre-agreed cap) but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) incurred by any of them in connection with the negotiation, preparation, printing, administration, execution and syndication of:

 

  (i)

this Agreement and any other documents referred to in this Agreement; and

 

  (ii)

any other Finance Documents executed after the Signing Date and prior to the Closing Date.

 

  (b)

The Company shall pay (without double counting) within thirty (30) days after the entry into of any further Finance Document, entered into at its request, the amount of all reasonable and documented pre-agreed costs and expenses (including legal fees (up to any pre-agreed cap) but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) incurred by the Facility Agent in negotiating, preparing and executing such further Finance Document.

 

23.2

Amendment Costs

If (a) the Company requests an amendment, waiver or consent; or (b) an amendment is required pursuant to Clause 35.10 (Change of Currency) the Company shall, within five (5) Business Days of written demand, reimburse the Facility Agent for the amount of all pre-approved reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) incurred by the Facility Agent in responding to, evaluating, negotiating or complying with that request or requirement.

 

23.3

Enforcement Costs

The Company shall, within five (5) Business Days of written demand, pay to each Finance Party the amount of all documented costs and expenses (including legal fees) incurred by that Finance Party in connection with the enforcement of, or the preservation of any rights under, any Finance Document.

 

24.

REPRESENTATIONS

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, the Company will make the representations set out in Schedule 12 (Representations) to the Finance Parties, in respect of itself and in respect of each other Obligor, and each other Obligor makes the following representations to each Finance Party in respect of itself at the times set out in Schedule 12 (Representations).

 

96


  (b)

The representations set out in Clause 10 (Sanctions) and Clause 14 (Corrupt Practices Laws) of Schedule 12 (Representations) shall:

 

  (i)

be made with respect to a EU Obligor; or

 

  (ii)

apply for the benefit of a Restricted Lender,

in each case, only to the extent that giving or having the benefit of, as applicable, such representations and warranties would not result in any violation of, conflict with or liability under the EU Blocking Regulation.

 

25.

INFORMATION COVENANTS

The undertakings set out in Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) remain in force from the Signing Date for so long as any amount is outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.

 

26.

COVENANTS

 

  (a)

The undertakings set out in Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) remain in force from the Signing Date for so long as any amount is outstanding under any Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.

 

  (b)

The undertakings set out in Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) remain in force from the Signing Date for so long as any amount is outstanding under any Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.

 

  (c)

The Company shall procure that, within sixty (60) days after the Signing Date, the following deeds are entered into:

 

  (i)

a deed of pledge of shares between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V. (as the Company);

 

  (ii)

an agreement and deed of pledge of cooperative membership interests between GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC (as the Pledgors), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Cooperative); and

 

  (iii)

a deed of pledge of shares between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as the Pledgor), Wilmington Trust, National Association (as the Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V. (as the Company),

(together the “Dutch CS Security Documents”).

 

  (d)

Promptly following the date on which the Dutch CS Security Documents (and in any event within five (5) Business Days of such date) are entered into, the Company shall procure that the Facility Agent is provided with:

 

  (i)

a certified copy of the relevant updated members / shareholders register (as applicable) reflecting the Dutch CS Security Documents set out in paragraphs (c)(i), (c)(ii) and (c)(iii) above;

 

97


  (ii)

a certified copy of its updated register of mortgages and charges reflecting the Dutch CS Security Document set out in paragraph (c)(ii) above; and

 

  (iii)

a copy of the Dutch CS Security Documents along with a customary legal opinion from Hogan Lovells as to Dutch law (dated the same date as the Dutch CS Security Documents), in form reasonably satisfactory to the Original Lenders.

 

27.

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

Each of the events or circumstances set out in Schedule 16 (Events of Default) shall be an Event of Default.

 

28.

REMEDIES FOLLOWING DEFAULT

 

  (a)

On and at any time after the occurrence of an Event of Default that is continuing, the Facility Agent may, and shall, if so instructed by the Super Majority Lenders, by notice to the Company declare:

 

  (i)

the Total Commitments and/or Ancillary Commitments to be cancelled, whereupon they shall be so cancelled;

 

  (ii)

all or any part of the Utilisations, together with accrued interest thereon, any fees and any amounts payable under the Finance Documents to be immediately due and payable whereupon they shall become so due and payable;

 

  (iii)

that all or part of the Utilisations be payable on demand, at which time they shall immediately become payable on demand by the Facility Agent on the instructions of the Super Majority Lenders;

 

  (iv)

that cash cover in respect of each Letter of Credit is immediately due and payable at which time it shall become immediately due and payable;

 

  (v)

that cash cover in respect of each Letter of Credit is payable on demand at which time it shall immediately become due and payable on demand by the Facility Agent on the instructions of the Super Majority Lenders;

 

  (vi)

all or any part of the amounts (or cash cover in relation to those amounts) outstanding under the Ancillary Facilities to be immediately due and payable, at which time they shall become immediately due and payable; and/or

 

  (vii)

all or any part of the amounts (or cash cover in relation to those amounts) outstanding under the Ancillary Facilities to be payable on demand, whereupon they shall immediately become payable on demand by the Facility Agent.

 

  (b)

If an Event of Default under Clause 5 (Insolvency Events) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) shall occur in a U.S. court of competent jurisdiction (an “Automatic Acceleration Event”) in respect of a Borrower, then without notice to such Borrower or any other person, or any other act by the Facility Agent or any other person, the Total Commitments shall automatically terminate and the principal of the Loans to such Borrower, together with all accrued interest thereon, cash cover in respect of each Letter of Credit issued for the account of such Borrower, and all other amounts owed by such Borrower under the Finance Documents shall become immediately due and payable without presentment, demand, protest or notice of any kind, all of which are expressly waived.

 

98


29.

CHANGES TO THE LENDERS

 

29.1

Assignments and transfers by the Lenders

Subject to this Clause 29 and to Clause 30 (Debt Purchase Transactions), a Lender (the “Existing Lender”) may on giving ten (10) Business Days prior notice to the Company and the Facility Agent:

 

  (a)

assign any of its rights; or

 

  (b)

transfer by novation any of its rights and obligations,

under the Finance Documents to an Acceptable Transferee (the “New Lender”).

 

29.2

Company consent

 

  (a)

The prior written consent of the Company is required for an assignment or transfer by an Existing Lender (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed), unless:

 

  (i)

such assignment or transfer is to another Lender;

 

  (ii)

such assignment or transfer is to an Affiliate or a Related Fund of an Existing Lender; or

 

  (iii)

an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing at the time of such transfer or assignment,

and such assignment or transfer does not affect the rights of the Obligors.

 

  (b)

Any sub-participation or sub-contract that is not effected such that the Existing Lender remains lender of record of such Loan and retains its Voting Rights, liabilities and obligations under the Finance Documents shall be deemed to be a transfer to which the provisions of Clause 29.1 (Assignments and transfers by the Lenders), this Clause 29.2 and Clause 29.3 (Other conditions of assignment or transfer) shall apply (other than in respect any requirement to comply with Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) or Clause 29.7 (Procedure for assignment)).

 

29.3

Other conditions of assignment or transfer

 

  (a)

The consent of the relevant Issuing Bank (if any) is required for any assignment or transfer by an Existing Lender of any of its rights and/or obligations under the Revolving Facility or the Additional L/C Facility (in each case, if applicable).

 

  (b)

Unless the Company and the Facility Agent otherwise agree, an assignment or transfer of part (but not the entirety) of an Existing Lender’s Commitment or rights and obligations under this Agreement must be in a minimum amount of US$10,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies).

 

  (c)

An assignment or transfer in respect of any Facility will only be effective on:

 

  (i)

receipt by the Facility Agent (whether in the Assignment Agreement, Transfer Certificate or otherwise) of written confirmation from the New Lender (in form and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent) that the New Lender will assume the same obligations to the other Finance Parties as it would have been under if it was an Original Lender;

 

  (ii)

performance by the Facility Agent of all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to such assignment to a New Lender, the completion of which the Facility Agent shall promptly notify to the Existing Lender and the New Lender;

 

99


  (iii)

(in the case of a transfer only) the procedure set out in Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) and the restrictions otherwise set out in this Clause 29 are complied with; and

 

  (iv)

(in the case of an assignment only) the procedure set out in Clause 29.7 (Procedure for assignment) and the restrictions otherwise set out in this Clause 29 are complied with.

 

  (d)

If:

 

  (i)

a Lender assigns or transfers any of its rights or obligations under the Finance Documents or changes its Facility Office; and

 

  (ii)

as a result of circumstances existing at the date the assignment, transfer or change occurs, an Obligor would be obliged to make a payment to the New Lender or Lender acting through its new Facility Office under Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity), Clause 19 (Increased Costs) or any other Tax provision of this Agreement,

then the New Lender or Lender acting through its new Facility Office is only entitled to receive payment under Clause 18.2 (Tax Indemnity), Clause 19 (Increased Costs) or other Tax provision of this Agreement to the same extent as the Existing Lender or Lender acting through its previous Facility Office would have been if the assignment, transfer, novation, sub-participation, sub-contract, trust or other change had not occurred.

 

  (e)

Each New Lender, by executing the relevant Transfer Certificate or Assignment Agreement, confirms (for the avoidance of doubt) that the Facility Agent has authority to execute on its behalf any amendment or waiver that has been approved by or on behalf of the requisite Lender or Lenders in accordance with this Agreement on or prior to the date on which the transfer or assignment becomes effective in accordance with this Agreement and that it is bound by that decision to the same extent as the Existing Lender would have been had it remained a Lender.

 

29.4

Assignment or transfer fee

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, the New Lender shall, on the date upon which an assignment or transfer takes effect, pay to the Facility Agent (for its own account) a fee of US$ 3,000. No Obligor shall be responsible for bearing any of the costs of any assignment, novation, transfer, sale of any participation or securitisation.

 

  (b)

No fee is payable pursuant to paragraph (a) above if the Facility Agent (in its absolute discretion) agrees that no fee is payable.

 

29.5

Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders

 

  (a)

Unless expressly agreed to the contrary, an Existing Lender makes no representation or warranty and assumes no responsibility to a New Lender for:

 

  (i)

the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of the Finance Documents or any other documents;

 

  (ii)

the financial condition of any Obligor;

 

  (iii)

the performance and observance by any Obligor of its obligations under the Finance Documents or any other documents; or

 

100


  (iv)

the accuracy of any statements (whether written or oral) made in or in connection with any Finance Document or any other document,

and any representations or warranties implied by law are excluded.

 

  (b)

Each New Lender confirms to the Existing Lender and the other Finance Parties that it:

 

  (i)

has made (and shall continue to make) its own independent investigation and assessment of the financial condition and affairs of each Obligor and its related entities in connection with its participation in this Agreement and has not relied exclusively on any information provided to it by the Existing Lender or any other Finance Party in connection with any Finance Document; and

 

  (ii)

will continue to make its own independent appraisal of the creditworthiness of each Obligor and its related entities whilst any amount is or may be outstanding under the Finance Documents or any Commitment is in force.

 

  (c)

Nothing in any Finance Document obliges an Existing Lender to:

 

  (i)

accept a re-transfer or re-assignment from a New Lender of any of the rights and obligations assigned or transferred under this Clause 29; or

 

  (ii)

support any losses directly or indirectly incurred by the New Lender by reason of the non-performance by any Obligor of its obligations under the Finance Documents or otherwise.

 

29.6

Procedure for transfer

 

  (a)

Subject to the conditions set out in Clause 29.2 (Company consent) and Clause 29.3 (Other conditions of assignment or transfer) a transfer is effected in accordance with paragraph (c) below when the Facility Agent executes an otherwise duly completed Transfer Certificate delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender and the Facility Agent makes a corresponding entry in the Register pursuant to Clause 29.8. The Facility Agent shall, subject to paragraph (b) below, as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt by it of a duly completed Transfer Certificate appearing on its face to comply with the terms of this Agreement and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, execute that Transfer Certificate.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall only be obliged to execute a Transfer Certificate delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender and make a corresponding entry in the Register once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the transfer to such New Lender.

 

  (c)

Subject to Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement), on the Transfer Date:

 

  (i)

to the extent that in the Transfer Certificate the Existing Lender seeks to transfer by novation its rights and obligations under the Finance Documents, each of the Obligors and the Existing Lender shall be released from further obligations towards one another under the Finance Documents and their respective rights against one another under the Finance Documents shall be cancelled (being the “Discharged Rights and Obligations”);

 

  (ii)

each of the Obligors and the New Lender shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights against one another which differ from the Discharged Rights and Obligations only insofar as that Obligor or other member of the Group and the New Lender have assumed and/or acquired the same in place of that Obligor and the Existing Lender;

 

101


  (iii)

the Facility Agent, the Arrangers, the Bookrunners, the New Lender, the other Lenders, the Issuing Bank and any relevant Ancillary Lender shall acquire the same rights and assume the same obligations between themselves as they would have acquired and assumed had the New Lender been an Original Lender with the rights, and/or obligations acquired or assumed by it as a result of the transfer and to that extent the Facility Agent, the Arrangers, the Bookrunners, the Issuing Bank and any relevant Ancillary Lender and the Existing Lender shall each be released from further obligations to each other under the Finance Documents; and

 

  (iv)

the New Lender shall become a Party as a “Lender”.

 

29.7

Procedure for assignment

 

  (a)

Subject to the conditions set out in Clause 29.2 (Company consent) and Clause 29.3 (Other conditions of assignment or transfer) an assignment may be effected in accordance with paragraph (c) below when the Facility Agent executes an otherwise duly completed Assignment Agreement delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender. The Facility Agent shall, subject to paragraph (b) below, as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt by it of a duly completed Assignment Agreement appearing on its face to comply with the terms of this Agreement and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, execute that Assignment Agreement.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall only be obliged to execute an Assignment Agreement delivered to it by the Existing Lender and the New Lender once it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assignment to such New Lender.

 

  (c)

Subject to Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement), on the Transfer Date:

 

  (i)

the Existing Lender will assign absolutely to the New Lender its rights under the Finance Documents expressed to be the subject of the assignment in the Assignment Agreement;

 

  (ii)

the Existing Lender will be released from the obligations (the “Relevant Obligations”) expressed to be the subject of the release in the Assignment Agreement; and

 

  (iii)

the New Lender shall become a Party as a “Lender” and will be bound by obligations equivalent to the Relevant Obligations.

 

  (d)

Lenders may utilise procedures other than those set out in this Clause 29.7 to assign their rights under the Finance Documents (but not, without the consent of the relevant Obligor or unless in accordance with Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer), to obtain a release by that Obligor from the obligations owed to that Obligor by the Lenders nor the assumption of equivalent obligations by a New Lender) provided that they comply with the conditions set out in Clause 29.2 (Company consent) and Clause 29.3 (Other conditions of assignment or transfer).

 

29.8

The Register

The Facility Agent, acting solely for this purpose as a non-fiduciary agent of the Obligors, shall maintain at one of its offices a copy of each Transfer Certificate delivered to it and a register (the “Register”) for the recordation of the names and addresses of each Lender and the Commitments of and obligations owing to each Lender. Without limitation of any other provision of this Clause 29, no transfer of an interest in a Loan or Commitment hereunder shall be effective unless and until recorded in the Register. The entries in the Register shall be conclusive absent manifest error and each Obligor, the Agent and each Lender shall treat each person whose name is recorded in the Register as a Lender notwithstanding any notice to the contrary.

 

102


29.9

Copy of Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Increase Confirmation to Company

The Facility Agent shall, as soon as reasonably practicable after it has executed a Transfer Certificate, an Assignment Agreement or an Increase Confirmation, send to the Company a copy of that Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Increase Confirmation.

 

29.10

Security over Lenders’ rights

In addition to the other rights provided to Lenders under this Clause 29, each Lender may without consulting with or obtaining consent from any Obligor, at any time charge, assign or otherwise create Security in or over (whether by way of collateral or otherwise) all or any of its rights under any Finance Document to secure obligations of that Lender including, without limitation:

 

  (a)

any charge, assignment or other Security to secure obligations to a federal reserve or central bank; and

 

  (b)

any charge, assignment or other Security granted to any holders (or trustee or representatives of holders) of obligations owed, or securities issued, by that Lender as security for those obligations or securities,

except that no such charge, assignment or Security shall:

 

  (i)

release a Lender from any of its obligations under the Finance Documents or substitute the beneficiary of the relevant charge, assignment or Security for the Lender as a party to any of the Finance Documents; or

 

  (ii)

require any payments to be made by an Obligor other than or in excess of, or grant to any person any more extensive rights than, those required to be made or granted to the relevant Lender under the Finance Documents.

 

29.11

Pro rata interest settlement

 

  (a)

In respect of any transfer pursuant to Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) or any assignment pursuant to Clause 29.7 (Procedure for assignment) the Transfer Date of which, in each case, is not on the last day of an Interest Period):

 

  (i)

any interest or fees in respect of the relevant participation which are expressed to accrue by reference to the lapse of time shall continue to accrue in favour of the Existing Lender up to but excluding the Transfer Date (“Accrued Amounts”) and shall become due and payable to the Existing Lender (without further interest accruing on them) on the last day of the current Interest Period (or, if the Interest Period is longer than six (6) Months, on the next of the dates which falls at six Monthly intervals after the first day of that Interest Period); and

 

  (ii)

the rights assigned or transferred by the Existing Lender will not include the right to the Accrued Amounts so that, for the avoidance of doubt:

 

  (A)

when the Accrued Amounts become payable, those Accrued Amounts will be payable for the account of the Existing Lender; and

 

  (B)

the amount payable to the New Lender on that date will be the amount which would, but for the application of this Clause 29.11, have been payable to it on that date, but after deduction of the Accrued Amounts.

 

103


  (b)

In this Clause 29.11 references to “Interest Period” shall be construed to include a reference to any other period for accrual of fees.

 

  (c)

An Existing Lender which retains the right to the Accrued Amounts pursuant to this Clause 29.11 but which does not have a Commitment shall be deemed not to be a Lender for the purposes of ascertaining whether the agreement of any specified group of Lenders has been obtained to approve any request for a consent, waiver, amendment or other vote of Lenders under the Finance Documents.

 

30.

DEBT PURCHASE TRANSACTIONS

 

30.1

Prohibition on Debt Purchase Transactions

The Company shall not, and shall procure that each other member of the Group shall not, enter into any Debt Purchase Transaction or be a party to a Debt Purchase Transaction of the type referred to in paragraph (b) or (c) of the definition of “Debt Purchase Transaction”.

 

30.2

Disenfranchisement on Debt Purchase Transactions entered into by Sponsor Affiliates

 

  (a)

For so long as a Sponsor Affiliate:

 

  (i)

beneficially owns a Commitment; or

 

  (ii)

has entered into a sub-participation agreement relating to a Commitment or other agreement or arrangement having a substantially similar economic effect and such agreement or arrangement has not been terminated,

in ascertaining:

 

  (A)

the Majority Lenders, Majority L/C Lenders, Majority RCF Lenders or the Super Majority Lenders; or

 

  (B)

whether:

 

  (1)

any given percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of the Total Commitments; or

 

  (2)

the agreement of any specified group of Lenders,

has been obtained to approve any request for a consent, waiver, amendment or other vote under the Finance Documents such Commitment shall be deemed to be zero; and such Sponsor Affiliate or the person with whom it has entered into such sub-participation, other agreement or arrangement shall be deemed not to be a Lender for the purposes of paragraphs (A) and (B) above (unless in the case of a person not being a Sponsor Affiliate it is a Lender by virtue otherwise than by beneficially owning the relevant Commitment).

 

  (b)

Each Lender shall, unless such Debt Purchase Transaction is an assignment or transfer, promptly notify the Facility Agent in writing if it knowingly enters into a Debt Purchase Transaction with a Sponsor Affiliate (a “Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction”), such notification to be substantially in the form set out in Part A (Form of Notice on entering into Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction) of Schedule 19 (Forms of Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction Notice).

 

104


  (c)

A Lender shall promptly notify the Facility Agent if a Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction to which it is a party:

 

  (i)

is terminated; or

 

  (ii)

ceases to be with a Sponsor Affiliate or a member of the Group,

such notification to be substantially in the form set out in Part B (Form of Notice on Termination of Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction / Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction ceasing to be with Sponsor Affiliate) of Schedule 19 (Forms of Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction Notice).

 

  (d)

Each Sponsor Affiliate that is a Lender agrees that:

 

  (i)

in relation to any meeting or conference call to which all the Lenders are invited to attend or participate, it shall not attend or participate in the same if so requested by the Facility Agent (acting reasonably) or, unless the Facility Agent (acting reasonably) otherwise agrees, be entitled to receive the agenda or any minutes of the same; and

 

  (ii)

in its capacity as Lender, unless the Facility Agent otherwise agrees, it shall not be entitled to receive any report or other document prepared at the behest of, or on the instructions of, the Facility Agent or one or more of the Lenders.

 

30.3

Debt Purchase Transactions with Subordinated Lenders

Each Subordinated Lender (as defined in Clause 35.12 (Subordinated Lenders)) agrees that to the extent and for so long as its Commitment, participation in any Utilisation or sub-participation or other agreement or arrangement relating to a Commitment, including, without limitation, following a Debt Purchase Transaction, could result in the subordination of claims of any other Lender under the Facilities pursuant to any law regarding the subordination of shareholder loans or prejudice or adversely affect the Transaction Security or guarantee and indemnity pursuant to Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) (or their enforceability) in any way, the relevant Subordinated Lender shall not be a secured or guaranteed party (however described) under and for the purposes of any Finance Document and no amount owing to it under any Finance Document shall be secured by the Transaction Security Documents (unless the subordination ceases to apply or subsequently or at the same time applies to the Lenders generally (other than where such subordination of the Lenders generally is caused by a Debt Purchase Transaction by a Subordinated Lender)).

 

31.

CHANGES TO THE OBLIGORS

 

31.1

Transfer by Obligors

Subject to this Clause 31, an Obligor (other than the Company and any Borrower) may transfer by novation its rights and obligations to another Obligor incorporated in the same jurisdiction of the transferring Obligor without the prior consent of the Finance Parties, provided that such transfer does not cause a breach of Clause 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants).

 

31.2

Additional Borrowers

 

  (a)

Subject to compliance with the provisions of paragraphs (c) and (d) of Clause 5 (“Know your customer” checks) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants), the Company may request that any of its wholly owned Subsidiaries becomes a Borrower. That Subsidiary shall become a Borrower if:

 

  (i)

it is incorporated in Germany or in the same jurisdiction as an existing Borrower in respect of the relevant Facility or otherwise if all the Lenders under that Facility approve the addition of that Subsidiary (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed provided that such approval shall, for the avoidance of doubt, be subject to inclusion of tax gross-up provisions in respect of such Borrower which are acceptable to each Lender (to the extent required));

 

105


  (ii)

the Company and that Subsidiary deliver to the Facility Agent a duly completed and executed Accession Deed;

 

  (iii)

the Subsidiary is (or becomes) a Guarantor on or prior to becoming a Borrower;

 

  (iv)

the Company confirms that no Default is continuing or would occur as a result of that Subsidiary becoming an Additional Borrower; and

 

  (v)

the Facility Agent has received all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part B of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent) in relation to that Additional Borrower, each in form and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent (acting reasonably).

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall notify the Company and the Lenders promptly upon being satisfied that it has received (in form and substance satisfactory to it (acting reasonably)) all the documents and other evidence listed Part B of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent).

 

  (c)

Other than to the extent that the relevant Majority Lenders notify the Facility Agent in writing to the contrary before the Facility Agent gives the notification described in paragraph (b) above, the Lenders authorise (but do not require) the Facility Agent to give that notification. The Facility Agent shall not be liable for any damages, costs or losses whatsoever as a result of giving any such notification.

 

31.3

Resignation of a Borrower

 

  (a)

The Company may request that a Borrower ceases to be a Borrower by delivering to the Facility Agent a Resignation Letter.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall accept a Resignation Letter and notify the Company and the other Finance Parties of its acceptance if:

 

  (i)

the Company has confirmed that no Default is continuing or would result from the acceptance of the Resignation Letter;

 

  (ii)

the Borrower is under no actual or contingent obligations as a Borrower under any Finance Documents; and

 

  (iii)

where the Borrower is also a Guarantor (unless its resignation has been accepted in accordance with Clause 31.5 (Resignation of a Guarantor)), its obligations in its capacity as Guarantor continue to be legal, valid, binding and enforceable and in full force and effect (subject to the Legal Reservations) and the amount guaranteed by it as a Guarantor is not decreased (and the Company has confirmed this is the case).

 

  (c)

Upon notification by the Facility Agent to the Company of its acceptance of the resignation of a Borrower, that company shall cease to be a Borrower and shall have no further rights or obligations under the Finance Documents as a Borrower.

 

  (d)

The Facility Agent may, at the cost and expense of the Company, require a legal opinion from counsel to the Facility Agent confirming the matters set out in paragraph (b)(iii) above and the Facility Agent shall be under no obligation to accept a Resignation Letter until it has obtained such opinion in form and substance satisfactory to it.

 

106


31.4

Additional Guarantors

 

  (a)

Subject to compliance with the provisions of paragraphs (c) and (d) of Clause 5 (“Know your customer” checks) of (Information Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants), the Company may request that any of its Subsidiaries become an Additional Guarantor. That Subsidiary shall become an Additional Guarantor if:

 

  (i)

the Company delivers to the Facility Agent a duly completed and executed Accession Deed; and

 

  (ii)

the Facility Agent has received all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part B of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent) in relation to that Additional Guarantor, each in form and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent (acting reasonably).

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall notify the Company and the Lenders promptly upon being satisfied that it has received (in form and substance satisfactory to it (acting reasonably)) all the documents and other evidence listed in Part B of Schedule 2 (Conditions Precedent).

 

31.5

Resignation of a Guarantor

 

  (a)

The Company may request that a Guarantor (other than the Company or any Borrower) ceases to be a Guarantor by delivering to the Facility Agent a Resignation Letter which shall include confirmations that:

 

  (i)

immediately following such resignation (and taking such resignation into account) there will be compliance with the requirements of Clause 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants); and

 

  (ii)

no Default is continuing or would result from the acceptance of such Resignation Letter.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall accept a Resignation Letter and notify the Company and the Lenders of its acceptance if no payment is then due from the resigning Guarantor under its guarantee obligations.

 

31.6

Repetition of Representations

Delivery of an Accession Deed constitutes confirmation by the Company and the Additional Guarantor that the representations referred to in Clause 21 (Times When Representations Made) of Schedule 12 (Representations) in respect of the relevant Subsidiary are true and correct in relation to it as at the date of delivery as if made by reference to the facts and circumstances then existing.

 

32.

ROLE OF THE FACILITY AGENT, THE ARRANGERS, THE BOOKRUNNERS, THE ISSUING BANK AND OTHERS

 

32.1

Appointment of the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

Each Finance Party (other than the Facility Agent) irrevocably appoints the Facility Agent to act as its agent under and in connection with the Finance Documents including, without limitation, as the Secured Debt Representative under and as defined in the Collateral Trust Agreement in respect of this Agreement.

 

  (b)

Each Finance Party irrevocably authorises the Facility Agent on its behalf to:

 

  (i)

perform the duties and to exercise the rights, powers, authorities and discretions that are specifically given to the Facility Agent under the Finance Documents, together with any other such rights, powers, authorities and discretions as are reasonably incidental thereto; and

 

107


  (ii)

enter into and deliver each Finance Document expressed to be entered into by the Facility Agent.

 

  (c)

Each Finance Party (other than the Facility Agent) hereby relieves the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law, in each case to the extent legally possible to it. A Finance Party that is barred by its constitutional documents or by-laws from granting such exemption shall notify the Facility Agent accordingly.

 

  (d)

All provisions of this Clause 32 applicable to the Facility Agent shall apply to the Facility Agent in its capacity as Secured Debt Representative under the Collateral Trust Agreement and all the benefits and indemnities (including, without limitation, any hold harmless or exculpatory provisions) applicable to the Facility Agent under this Agreement and the Finance Documents shall extend to the Facility Agent acting in such capacity.

 

32.2

Instructions

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent shall:

 

  (i)

unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document, exercise or refrain from exercising any right, power, authority or discretion vested in it as Facility Agent (including as a Secured Debt Representative under and as defined in the Collateral Trust Agreement) in accordance with any instructions given to it by:

 

  (A)

all Lenders if the relevant Finance Document stipulates the matter is an all Lender decision;

 

  (B)

the Super Majority Lenders if the relevant Finance Document stipulates the matter is a Super Majority Lender decision;

 

  (C)

the Majority L/C Lenders if the relevant Finance Document stipulates the matter is a Majority L/C Lender decision;

 

  (D)

the Majority RCF Lenders if the relevant Finance Document stipulates the matter is a Majority RCF Lender decision; and

 

  (E)

in all other cases, the Majority Lenders (including, without limitation, in respect of decisions of the requisite lenders under the Collateral Trust Agreement); and

 

  (ii)

not be liable for any act (or omission) if it acts (or refrains from acting) in accordance with paragraph (i) above.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall be entitled to request instructions, or clarification of any instruction, from the Majority Lenders (or, if the relevant Finance Document stipulates the matter is a decision for any other Lender or group of Lenders, from that Lender or group of Lenders) as to whether, and in what manner, it should exercise or refrain from exercising any right, power, authority or discretion and the Facility Agent may refrain from acting unless and until it receives any such instructions or clarification that it has requested.

 

  (c)

Save in the case of decisions stipulated to be a matter for any other Lender or group of Lenders under the relevant Finance Document and unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document, any instructions given to the Facility Agent by the Majority Lenders shall override any conflicting instructions given by any other Parties and will be binding on all Finance Parties.

 

108


  (d)

The Facility Agent may refrain from acting in accordance with any instructions of any Lender or group of Lenders until it has received any indemnification and/or security that it may in its discretion require (which may be greater in extent than that contained in the Finance Documents and which may include payment in advance) for any cost, loss or liability which it may incur in complying with those instructions.

 

  (e)

In the absence of instructions, the Facility Agent may act (or refrain from acting) as it considers to be in the best interest of the Lenders.

 

  (f)

The Facility Agent is not authorised to act on behalf of a Lender (without first obtaining that Lender’s consent) in any legal or arbitration proceedings relating to any Finance Document.

 

32.3

Duties of the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent’s duties under the Finance Documents are solely of a mechanical and administrative nature; the Facility Agent shall not have by reason of this Agreement, any other Finance Document a fiduciary relationship or any implied duties under any agency doctrine under Applicable Law in respect of any of the Lenders.

 

  (b)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, the Facility Agent shall promptly forward to a Party the original or a copy of any document which is delivered to the Facility Agent for that Party by any other Party.

 

  (c)

Without prejudice to Clause 29.9 (Copy of Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Increase Confirmation to Company) and paragraph (e) of Clause 7.4 (Cash Collateral by Non-Acceptable L/C Lender and Borrower’s option to provide cash cover), paragraph (b) above shall not apply to any Transfer Certificate, any Assignment Agreement or any Increase Confirmation.

 

  (d)

Except where a Finance Document specifically provides otherwise, the Facility Agent is not obliged to review or check the adequacy, accuracy or completeness of any document it forwards to another Party.

 

  (e)

If the Facility Agent receives notice from a Party referring to this Agreement, describing a Default and stating that the circumstance described is a Default, it shall promptly notify the other Finance Parties.

 

  (f)

If the Facility Agent is aware of the non-payment of any principal, interest, commitment fee or other fee payable to a Finance Party (other than the Facility Agent, the Arrangers or the Bookrunners) under this Agreement, it shall promptly notify the other Finance Parties.

 

  (g)

The Facility Agent shall have only those duties, obligations and responsibilities expressly specified in the Finance Documents to which it is expressed to be a party (and no others shall be implied).

 

32.4

Role of the Arrangers and Bookrunners

Except as specifically provided in the Finance Documents, the Arrangers and the Bookrunners have no obligations of any kind to any other Party under or in connection with any Finance Document.

 

32.5

No fiduciary duties

 

  (a)

In performing its functions and duties under the Finance Documents, the Facility Agent shall act solely as agent of the Lenders pursuant to the Finance Documents and does not assume and shall not be deemed to have assumed any obligation toward or relationship of agency, trust or fiduciary with or for the Company or any other person.

 

109


  (b)

Neither the Facility Agent, nor any Arranger or Bookrunner, nor the Issuing Bank shall be bound to account to any Lender for any sum or the profit element of any sum received by it for its own account.

 

32.6

Business with the Group

The Facility Agent, the Arrangers, the Bookrunners, the Issuing Bank and each Ancillary Lender may accept deposits from, lend money to and generally engage in any kind of lending or other business with any person including the Company, any other member of the Group and any party to any Finance Document.

 

32.7

Rights and discretions

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent and the Issuing Bank may:

 

  (i)

rely on any representation, communication, notice or document (including, without limitation, any notice given by a Lender pursuant to paragraphs (b) or (c) of Clause 30.2 (Disenfranchisement on Debt Purchase Transactions entered into by Sponsor Affiliates or members of the Group)) believed by it to be genuine, correct and appropriately authorised;

 

  (ii)

assume that:

 

  (A)

any instructions received by it from the Majority Lenders, any Lenders or any group of Lenders are duly given in accordance with the terms of the Finance Documents; and

 

  (B)

unless it has received notice of revocation, that those instructions have not been revoked; and

 

  (iii)

rely on a certificate from any person:

 

  (A)

as to any matter of fact or circumstance which might reasonably be expected to be within the knowledge of that person; or

 

  (B)

to the effect that such person approves of any particular dealing, transaction, step, action or thing,

as sufficient evidence that that is the case and, in the case of paragraph (A) above, may assume the truth and accuracy of that certificate.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent may assume (unless it has received notice to the contrary in its capacity as Facility Agent) that:

 

  (i)

no Default has occurred (unless it has actual knowledge of a Default arising under Clause 1 (Non-Payment) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default);

 

  (ii)

any right, power, authority or discretion vested in any Party or any group of Lenders has not been exercised;

 

  (iii)

any notice or request made by the Company (other than a Utilisation Request) is made on behalf of and with the consent and knowledge of all the Obligors; and

 

110


  (iv)

no Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction:

 

  (A)

has been entered into;

 

  (B)

has been terminated; or

 

  (C)

has ceased to be with a Sponsor Affiliate.

 

  (c)

Subject to Clause 20.3 (Indemnity to the Facility Agent) and Clause 23 (Costs and Expenses), the Facility Agent may engage and pay for the advice or services of any lawyers, accountants, tax advisers, surveyors or other professional advisers or experts.

 

  (d)

Without prejudice to the generality of paragraph (c) above or paragraph (e) below but subject to Clause 20.3 (Indemnity to the Facility Agent) and Clause 23 (Costs and Expenses), the Facility Agent may at any time engage and pay for the services of any lawyers to act as independent counsel to the Facility Agent (and so separate from any lawyers instructed by the Lenders) if the Facility Agent in its reasonable opinion deems this to be desirable.

 

  (e)

The Facility Agent may rely on the advice or services of any lawyers, accountants, tax advisers, surveyors or other professional advisers or experts (whether obtained by the Facility Agent or by any other Party) and shall not be liable for any damages, costs or losses to any person, any diminution in value or any liability whatsoever arising as a result of its so relying.

 

  (f)

The Facility Agent may act in relation to the Finance Documents through its officers, employees and agents and the Facility Agent shall not:

 

  (i)

be liable for any error of judgment made by any such person; or

 

  (ii)

be bound to supervise, or be in any way responsible for, any loss incurred by reason of misconduct, omission or default on the part of any such person,

unless such error or such loss was directly caused by the Facility Agent’s gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

 

  (g)

Unless a Finance Document expressly provides otherwise the Facility Agent may disclose to any other Party any information it reasonably believes it has received as agent under this Agreement.

 

  (h)

Without prejudice to the generality of paragraph (g) above, the Facility Agent:

 

  (i)

may disclose; and

 

  (ii)

on the written request of the Company, the Majority RCF Lenders or the Majority L/C Lenders (as applicable) shall, as soon as reasonably practicable, disclose,

the identity of a Defaulting Lender to the Company and to the other Finance Parties.

 

  (i)

Notwithstanding any other provision of any Finance Document to the contrary, none of the Facility Agent, any Arranger, any Bookrunner or the Issuing Bank is obliged to do or omit to do anything if it would, or might in its reasonable opinion, constitute a breach of any law or regulation or a breach of a fiduciary duty or duty of confidentiality. In particular, and for the avoidance of doubt, nothing in any Finance Document shall be construed so as to constitute an obligation of the Facility Agent, the Arranger, any Bookrunner or the Issuing Bank to perform any services which it would not be entitled to render pursuant to the provisions of the German Act on Rendering Legal Services (Rechtsdienstleistungsgesetz) or pursuant to the provisions of the German Tax Advisory Act (Steuerberatungsgesetz) or any other services that require an express official approval, licence or registration, unless the Facility Agent, such Arranger, such Bookrunner or the Issuing Bank (as the case may be) holds the required approval, licence or registration.

 

111


  (j)

Notwithstanding any provision of any Finance Document to the contrary, the Facility Agent is not obliged to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of its duties, obligations or responsibilities or the exercise of any right, power, authority or discretion if it has grounds for believing the repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against, or security for, such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it.

 

32.8

Responsibility for documentation

None of the Facility Agent, any Arranger, any Bookrunner, the Issuing Bank or any Ancillary Lender is responsible or liable for:

 

  (a)

the adequacy, accuracy or completeness of any information (whether oral or written) supplied by the Facility Agent, an Arranger, a Bookrunner, the Issuing Bank or any Ancillary Lender an Obligor or any other person in or in connection with any Finance Document or the Information Package or the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document;

 

  (b)

the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of any Finance Document or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document; or

 

  (c)

any determination as to whether any information provided or to be provided to any Finance Party is non-public information the use of which may be regulated or prohibited by applicable law or regulation relating to insider dealing or otherwise.

 

32.9

No duty to monitor

The Facility Agent shall not be bound to enquire:

 

  (a)

whether or not any Default has occurred;

 

  (b)

as to the performance, default or any breach by any Party of its obligations under any Finance Document; or

 

  (c)

whether any other event specified in any Finance Document has occurred.

 

32.10

Exclusion of liability

 

  (a)

Without limiting paragraph (b) below (and without prejudice to any other provision of any Finance Document excluding or limiting the liability of the Facility Agent), the Issuing Bank or any Ancillary Lender), none of the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank, nor any Ancillary Lender will be liable (including, without limitation, for negligence or any other category of liability whatsoever) for:

 

  (i)

any damages, costs or losses to any person, any diminution in value, or any liability whatsoever arising as a result of taking or not taking any action under or in connection with any Finance Document, unless directly caused by its gross negligence or wilful misconduct;

 

  (ii)

exercising, or not exercising, any right, power, authority or discretion given to it by, or in connection with, any Finance Document or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with, any Finance Document; or

 

112


  (iii)

without prejudice to the generality of paragraphs (i) and (ii) above, any damages, costs or losses to any person, any diminution in value or any liability whatsoever arising as a result of:

 

  (A)

any act, event or circumstance not reasonably within its control; or

 

  (B)

the general risks of investment in, or the holding of assets in, any jurisdiction,

including (in each case and without limitation) such damages, costs, losses, diminution in value or liability arising as a result of: nationalisation, expropriation or other governmental actions; any regulation, currency restriction, devaluation or fluctuation; market conditions affecting the execution or settlement of transactions or the value of assets (including any Disruption Event); breakdown, failure or malfunction of any third party transport, telecommunications, computer services or systems; natural disasters or acts of God; war, terrorism, insurrection or revolution; or strikes or industrial action.

 

  (b)

No Party (other than the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank or an Ancillary Lender (as applicable)) may take any proceedings against any officer, employee or agent of the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank or an Ancillary Lender in respect of any claim it might have against the Facility Agent, or in respect of any act or omission of any kind by that officer, employee or agent in relation to any Finance Document and any officer, employee or agent of the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank or an Ancillary Lender may rely on this Clause subject to Clause 1.4 (Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act) and the provisions of the Third Parties Act.

 

  (c)

The Facility Agent will not be liable for any delay (or any related consequences) in crediting an account with an amount required under the Finance Documents to be paid by the Facility Agent if the Facility Agent has taken all necessary steps as soon as reasonably practicable to comply with the regulations or operating procedures of any recognised clearing or settlement system used by the Facility Agent for that purpose.

 

  (d)

Nothing in this Agreement shall oblige the Facility Agent, any Arranger or any Bookrunner to carry out:

 

  (i)

any “know your customer” or other checks in relation to any person; or

 

  (ii)

any check on the extent to which any transaction contemplated by this Agreement might be unlawful for any Lender or for any Affiliate of any Lender,

on behalf of any Lender and each Lender confirms to the Facility Agent, the Arrangers and the Bookrunners that it is solely responsible for any such checks it is required to carry out and that it may not rely on any statement in relation to such checks made by the Facility Agent, the Arrangers or the Bookrunners.

 

  (e)

Without prejudice to any provision of any Finance Document excluding or limiting the Facility Agent’s liability, any liability of the Facility Agent arising under or in connection with any Finance Document shall be limited to the amount of actual loss which has been finally judicially determined to have been suffered (as determined by reference to the date of default of the Facility Agent or, if later, the date on which the loss arises as a result of such default) but without reference to any special conditions or circumstances known to the Facility Agent at any time which increase the amount of that loss. In no event shall the Facility Agent be liable for any loss of profits, goodwill, reputation, business opportunity or anticipated saving, or for special, punitive, indirect or consequential damages, whether or not the Facility Agent has been advised of the possibility of such loss or damages.

 

113


32.11

Lenders’ indemnity to the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

Save to the extent that the same are recovered from the Company or any other Obligor, each Lender shall, from time to time on demand by the Facility Agent, indemnify the Facility Agent, in the proportion that its share of the Total Commitments at the time of such demand bears to the aggregate amount of the Total Commitments at the time of such demand (or, if the Total Commitments are then zero, its share of the Total Commitments immediately prior to their reduction to zero), against any and all costs, claims, losses, expenses (including legal fees) and liabilities together with any VAT thereon which the Facility Agent may incur, otherwise than by reason of its own gross negligence or wilful misconduct, in acting in its capacity as Facility Agent under the Finance Documents or otherwise in the performance of its obligations thereunder.

 

  (b)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, the Company shall (or shall procure that an Obligor will) within five (5) Business Days of written demand, reimburse any Lender for any payment that Lender makes to the Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (a) above.

 

  (c)

Paragraph (b) above shall not apply to the extent that the indemnity payment in respect of which a Lender claims reimbursement relates to:

 

  (i)

a liability of the Facility Agent to the Company or an Obligor; or

 

  (ii)

a dispute between the Facility Agent and one or more other Finance Parties.

 

32.12

Resignation of the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent may resign and appoint one of its Affiliates acting through an office in the same jurisdiction as Facility Agent by giving notice to the Lenders and the Company.

 

  (b)

Alternatively, the Facility Agent may resign by giving not less than forty-five (45) days’ prior written notice to the Lenders and the Company, in which case the Majority Lenders (after consultation with the Company) may appoint a successor Facility Agent.

 

  (c)

If the Majority Lenders have not appointed a successor Facility Agent in accordance with paragraph (b) above within twenty (20) days after notice of resignation was given, the retiring Facility Agent may appoint a successor Facility Agent with, so long as no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Company’s prior approval (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed) during the period of such notice, but if no successor is appointed, the Facility Agent may appoint such a successor itself.

 

  (d)

Notwithstanding the above, if there is failure to appoint a successor to the Facility Agent following the expiry of the relevant notice period, the Facility Agent shall be entitled to apply to a court of competent jurisdiction to seek its release from its appointment and the appointment of a successor.

 

  (e)

The retiring Facility Agent shall, at its own cost, make available to the successor Facility Agent such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Facility Agent may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as Facility Agent under the Finance Documents.

 

  (f)

The Facility Agent’s resignation notice shall only take effect upon the appointment of a successor and provided that such successor has acceded to the Collateral Trust Agreement as Secured Debt Representative in respect of the Facilities.

 

114


  (g)

Upon the appointment of a successor, the retiring Facility Agent shall be discharged from any further obligation in respect of the Finance Documents (other than its obligations under paragraph (e) above) but shall remain entitled to the benefit of Clause 20.3 (Indemnity to the Facility Agent) and this Clause 32 (and any agency fees for the account of the retiring Facility Agent shall cease to accrue from (and shall be payable on) that date). Any successor and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original Party.

 

  (h)

The Facility Agent shall resign in accordance with paragraph (b) above (and, to the extent applicable, shall use reasonable endeavours to appoint a successor Facility Agent pursuant to paragraph (c) above) if on or after the date which is three (3) months before the earliest FATCA Application Date relating to any payment to the Facility Agent under the Finance Documents, either:

 

  (i)

the Facility Agent fails to respond to a request under Clause 18.7 (FATCA Information) and the Company or a Lender reasonably believes that the Facility Agent will not be (or will have ceased to be) a FATCA Exempt Party on or after that FATCA Application Date;

 

  (ii)

the information supplied by the Facility Agent pursuant to Clause 18.7 (FATCA Information) indicates that the Facility Agent will not be (or will have ceased to be) a FATCA Exempt Party on or after that FATCA Application Date; or

 

  (iii)

the Facility Agent notifies the Company and the Lenders that the Facility Agent will not be (or will have ceased to be) a FATCA Exempt Party on or after that FATCA Application Date,

and (in each case) the Company or a Lender reasonably believes that a Party will be required to make a FATCA Deduction that would not be required if the Facility Agent were a FATCA Exempt Party, and the Company or that Lender, by notice to the Facility Agent, requires it to resign.

 

32.13

Replacement of the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

After consultation with the Company, the Majority Lenders may, by giving not less than forty-five (45) days’ prior written notice to the Facility Agent (or, at any time the Facility Agent is an Impaired Agent, by giving any shorter notice determined by the Majority Lenders) replace the Facility Agent by appointing a successor Facility Agent).

 

  (b)

The retiring Facility Agent shall (at its own cost if it is an Impaired Agent and otherwise at the expense of the Lenders) make available to the successor Facility Agent such documents and records and provide such assistance as the successor Facility Agent may reasonably request for the purposes of performing its functions as Facility Agent under the Finance Documents.

 

  (c)

The appointment of the successor Facility Agent shall take effect on the date specified in the notice from the Majority Lenders to the retiring Facility Agent and provided that such successor has acceded to the Collateral Trust Agreement as Secured Debt Representative in respect of the Facilities. As from this date, the retiring Facility Agent shall be discharged from any further obligation in respect of the Finance Documents (other than its obligations under paragraph (b) above) but shall remain entitled to the benefit of Clause 20.3 (Indemnity to the Facility Agent) and this Clause 32 (and any agency fees for the account of the retiring Facility Agent shall cease to accrue from (and shall be payable on) that date).

 

  (d)

Any successor Facility Agent and each of the other Parties shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such successor had been an original Party.

 

115


32.14

Confidentiality

 

  (a)

In acting as agent for the Finance Parties, the Facility Agent shall be regarded as acting through its agency division which shall be treated as a separate entity from any other of its divisions or departments.

 

  (b)

If information is received by another division or department of the Facility Agent, it may be treated as confidential to that division or department and the Facility Agent shall not be deemed to have notice of it.

 

32.15

Relationship with the Lenders

 

  (a)

Subject to Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement), the Facility Agent may treat the person shown in its records as Lender at the opening of business (in the place of the Facility Agent’s principal office as notified to the Finance Parties from time to time) as the Lender acting through its Facility Office:

 

  (i)

entitled to or liable for any payment due under any Finance Document on that day; and

 

  (ii)

entitled to receive and act upon any notice, request, document or communication or make any decision or determination under any Finance Document made or delivered on that day,

unless it has received not less than five (5) Business Days’ prior notice from that Lender to the contrary in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

  (b)

Any Lender may by notice to the Facility Agent appoint a person to receive on its behalf all notices, communications, information and documents to be made or despatched to that Lender under the Finance Documents. Such notice shall contain the address, fax number and (where communication by electronic mail or other electronic means is permitted under Clause 38.6 (Electronic communication)) electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the transmission of information by that means (and, in each case, the department or officer, if any, for whose attention communication is to be made) and be treated as a notification of a substitute address, fax number, electronic mail address (or such other information), department and officer by that Lender for the purposes of Clause 38.2 (Addresses) and paragraph (a)(ii) of Clause 38.6 (Electronic communication) and the Facility Agent shall be entitled to treat such person as the person entitled to receive all such notices, communications, information and documents as though that person were that Lender.

 

32.16

Credit appraisal by the Lenders, Issuing Bank and Ancillary Lenders

 

  (a)

Without affecting the responsibility of any Obligor for information supplied by it or on its behalf in connection with any Finance Document, each Lender, Issuing Bank and each Ancillary Lender confirms to the Facility Agent, Issuing Bank, each Ancillary Lender, each Arranger and each Bookrunner that it has been, and will continue to be, solely responsible for making its own independent appraisal and investigation of all risks arising under or in connection with any Finance Document including but not limited to:

 

  (i)

the financial condition, status and nature of each member of the Group;

 

  (ii)

the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability of any Finance Document and any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document;

 

116


  (iii)

whether that Lender, Issuing Bank or Ancillary Lenders has recourse, and the nature and extent of that recourse, against any Party or any of its respective assets under or in connection with any Finance Document, the transactions contemplated by the Finance Documents or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document; and

 

  (iv)

the adequacy, accuracy or completeness of the Information Package and any other information provided by the Facility Agent, any Party or by any other person under or in connection with any Finance Document, the transactions contemplated by any Finance Document or any other agreement, arrangement or document entered into, made or executed in anticipation of, under or in connection with any Finance Document.

 

32.17

Deduction from amounts payable by the Facility Agent

If any Party owes an amount to the Facility Agent under the Finance Documents the Facility Agent may, after giving notice to that Party, deduct an amount not exceeding that amount from any payment to that Party which the Facility Agent would otherwise be obliged to make under the Finance Documents and apply the amount deducted in or towards satisfaction of the amount owed. For the purposes of the Finance Documents that Party shall be regarded as having received any amount so deducted.

 

32.18

Role of Reference Banks

 

  (a)

No Reference Bank is under any obligation to provide a quotation or any other information to the Facility Agent.

 

  (b)

No Reference Bank will be liable for any action taken by it under or in connection with any Finance Document, or for any Reference Bank Quotation, unless directly caused by its gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

 

  (c)

No Party (other than the relevant Reference Bank) may take any proceedings against any officer, employee or agent of any Reference Bank in respect of any claim it might have against that Reference Bank or in respect of any act or omission of any kind by that officer, employee or agent in relation to any Finance Document, or to any Reference Bank Quotation, and any officer, employee or agent of each Reference Bank may rely on this Clause 32.18 subject to Clause 1.4 (Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act) and the provisions of the Third Parties Act.

 

32.19

Third party Reference Banks

A Reference Bank which is not a Party may rely on Clause 32.18 (Role of Reference Banks), paragraph (a) of Clause 42.4 (Other exceptions) and Clause 44 (Confidentiality of Funding Rates) subject to Clause 1.4 (Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act) and the provisions of the Third Parties Act.

 

33.

CONDUCT OF BUSINESS BY THE FINANCE PARTIES

No provision of this Agreement will:

 

  (a)

interfere with the right of any Finance Party to arrange its affairs (tax or otherwise) in whatever manner it thinks fit;

 

  (b)

oblige any Finance Party to investigate or claim any credit, relief, remission or repayment available to it or the extent, order and manner of any claim; or

 

  (c)

oblige any Finance Party to disclose any information relating to its affairs (tax or otherwise) or any computations in respect of Tax.

 

117


34.

SHARING AMONG THE FINANCE PARTIES

 

34.1

Payments to Finance Parties

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, if a Finance Party (a “Recovering Finance Party”) receives or recovers any amount on account of any liability of the Company or any other Obligor under any Finance Document, whether directly or indirectly, whether by exercising a right of set-off, combination of accounts, banker’s lien or counterclaim or by enforcing or exercising any other right or remedy under any Finance Document (including any payment required by applicable law to made to such Recovering Finance Party notwithstanding the terms of this Clause 34.1) or other than in accordance with Clause 35 (Payment mechanics) (a “Recovered Amount”) and applies that amount to a payment due under the Finance Documents then:

 

  (i)

the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three (3) Business Days, notify details of the receipt or recovery to the Facility Agent;

 

  (ii)

the Facility Agent shall determine whether the receipt or recovery is in excess of the amount the Recovering Finance Party would have been paid had the receipt or recovery been received or made by the Facility Agent and distributed in accordance with Clause 35 (Payment mechanics) (without taking account of any Tax which would be imposed on the Facility Agent in relation to the receipt, recovery or distribution); and

 

  (iii)

the Recovering Finance Party shall, within three (3) Business Days of demand by the Facility Agent, pay to the Facility Agent an amount (the “Sharing Payment”) equal to such receipt or recovery less any amount which the Facility Agent determines may be retained by the Recovering Finance Party as its share of any payment to be made, in accordance with Clause 35.6 (Partial payments) so as to ensure that no Finance Party receives more than its pro rata share of any amount received or recovered from the Recovering Finance Party.

 

  (b)

Paragraph (a) above shall not apply to any amount received or recovered by an Issuing Bank or an Ancillary Lender in respect of any cash cover provided for the benefit of that Issuing Bank or that Ancillary Lender.

 

34.2

Redistribution of payments

The Facility Agent shall treat the Sharing Payment as if it had been paid by the relevant Obligor and distribute it between the Finance Parties (other than the Recovering Finance Party) (the “Sharing Finance Parties”) in accordance with Clause 35.6 (Partial payments) towards the obligations of that Obligor to the Sharing Finance Parties.

 

34.3

Recovering Finance Party’s rights

On a distribution by the Facility Agent under Clause 34.2 (Redistribution of payments) of a payment received by a Recovering Finance Party from an Obligor, as between the relevant Obligor and the Recovering Finance Party, an amount of the Recovered Amount equal to the Sharing Payment will be treated as not having been paid by that Obligor.

 

34.4

Reversal of redistribution

If any part of the Sharing Payment received or recovered by a Recovering Finance Party becomes repayable and is repaid by that Recovering Finance Party, then:

 

  (a)

each Sharing Finance Party shall, upon request of the Facility Agent, pay to the Facility Agent for the account of that Recovering Finance Party an amount equal to the appropriate part of its share of the Sharing Payment (together with an amount as is necessary to reimburse that Recovering Finance Party for its proportion of any interest on the Sharing Payment which that Recovering Finance Party is required to pay) (the “Redistributed Amount”); and

 

118


  (b)

as between the relevant Obligor and each relevant Sharing Finance Party, an amount equal to the relevant Redistributed Amount will be treated as not having been paid by that Obligor.

 

34.5

Exceptions

 

  (a)

This Clause 34 shall not apply to the extent that the Recovering Finance Party would not, after making any payment pursuant to this Clause, have a valid and enforceable claim against the relevant Obligor.

 

  (b)

A Recovering Finance Party is not obliged to share with any other Finance Party any amount which the Recovering Finance Party has received or recovered as a result of taking legal or arbitration proceedings, if:

 

  (i)

it notified the other Finance Party of the legal or arbitration proceedings; and

 

  (ii)

the other Finance Party had an opportunity to participate in those legal or arbitration proceedings but did not do so as soon as reasonably practicable having received notice and did not take separate legal or arbitration proceedings.

 

  (c)

The provisions of Clause 34.1 (Payments to Finance Parties) shall not apply to any payments under this Agreement that are contemplated to be applied to the outstanding Utilisations on other than a pro rata basis including, for the avoidance of doubt, any prepayments made pursuant to Clause 11.1 (Illegality), Clause 12.1 (Change of Control) and Clause 11.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender).

 

  (d)

This Clause 34 is subject to the provisions of Clause 35.12 (Subordinated Lenders).

 

34.6

Ancillary Lenders

 

  (a)

This Clause 34 shall not apply to any receipt or recovery by a Lender in its capacity as an Ancillary Lender at any time prior to the Facility Agent exercising any of its rights under Clause 28 (Remedies following Default).

 

  (b)

Following the exercise by the Facility Agent of any of its rights under Clause 28 (Remedies following Default), this Clause 34 shall apply to all receipts or recoveries by Ancillary Lenders except to the extent that the receipt or recovery represents a reduction of the Gross Outstandings of a Multi-account Overdraft to or towards an amount equal to its Net Outstandings.

 

35.

PAYMENT MECHANICS

 

35.1

Payments to the Facility Agent

 

  (a)

On each date on which a Finance Document (excluding a payment under the terms of an Ancillary Document) requires an amount to be paid by an Obligor or a Lender, that Obligor or Lender (as the case may be) shall (unless a contrary indication appears in a Finance Document) make the same available to the Facility Agent for value on the due date at the time and in such funds specified by the Facility Agent as being customary at the time for settlement of transactions in the relevant currency in the place of payment.

 

  (b)

Payment shall be made to such account in the principal financial centre of the country of that currency (or, in relation to Euro, in a principal financial centre in such Participating Member State or London, as specified by the Facility Agent) and with such bank as the Facility Agent, in each case, specifies.

 

119


35.2

Distributions by the Facility Agent

Each payment received by the Facility Agent under the Finance Documents for another Party shall, subject to Clause 35.3 (Distributions to an Obligor) and Clause 35.4 (Clawback and pre-funding), be made available by the Facility Agent as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt to the Party entitled to receive payment in accordance with this Agreement (in the case of a Lender, for the account of its Facility Office), to such account as that Party may notify to the Facility Agent by not less than seven (7) calendar days’ notice with a bank specified by that Party in the principal financial centre of the country of that currency (or, in relation to Euro, in the principal financial centre of a Participating Member State or London, as specified by that Party).

 

35.3

Distributions to an Obligor

The Facility Agent may (with the consent of the Obligor or in accordance with Clause 37 (Set-Off)) apply any amount received by it for that Obligor in or towards payment (on the date and in the currency and funds of receipt) of any amount due from that Obligor under the Finance Documents or in or towards purchase of any amount of any currency to be so applied.

 

35.4

Clawback and pre-funding

 

  (a)

Where a sum is to be paid to the Facility Agent under any Finance Document for any other person, the Facility Agent is not obliged to pay that sum to that other person (or to enter into or perform any related exchange contract) until it has been able to establish to its satisfaction that it has actually received that sum.

 

  (b)

Unless paragraph (c) below applies, if the Facility Agent pays an amount to another Party and it proves to be the case that the Facility Agent had not actually received that amount, then the Party to whom that amount (or the proceeds of any related exchange contract) was paid by the Facility Agent shall on demand refund the same to the Facility Agent (together with interest on that amount from the date of payment to the date of receipt by the Facility Agent, calculated by the Facility Agent to reflect its cost of funds).

 

  (c)

If the Facility Agent has notified the Lenders that it is willing to make available amounts for the account of a Borrower before receiving funds from the Lenders then if and to the extent that the Facility Agent does so but it proves to be the case that it does not then receive funds from a Lender in respect of a sum which it paid to a Borrower:

 

  (i)

the Facility Agent shall notify the Company of that Lender’s identity and the Borrower to whom that sum was made available shall on demand refund it to the Facility Agent; and

 

  (ii)

the Lender by whom those funds should have been made available or, if that Lender fails to do so, the Borrower to whom that sum was made available, shall on demand pay to the Facility Agent the amount (as certified by the Facility Agent) which will indemnify the Facility Agent against any funding cost incurred by it as a result of paying out that sum before receiving those funds from that Lender.

 

35.5

Impaired Agent

 

  (a)

If, at any time, the Facility Agent becomes an Impaired Agent, an Obligor or a Lender which is required to make a payment under the Finance Documents to the Facility Agent in accordance with Clause 35.1 (Payments to the Facility Agent) may instead either:

 

  (i)

pay that amount direct to the required recipient(s); or

 

120


  (ii)

if in its absolute discretion it considers that it is not reasonably practicable to pay that amount direct to the required recipient(s), pay that amount or the relevant part of that amount to an interest-bearing account held with an Acceptable Bank within the meaning of paragraph (a) of the definition of “Acceptable Bank” and in relation to which no Insolvency Event has occurred and is continuing, in the name of the Obligor or the Lender making the payment (the “Paying Party”) and designated as a trust account for the benefit of the Party or Parties beneficially entitled to that payment under the Finance Documents (the “Recipient Party” or “Recipient Parties”).

 

  (b)

All interest accrued on the amount standing to the credit of the trust account shall be for the benefit of the Recipient Party or Recipient Parties pro rata to their respective entitlements.

 

  (c)

A Party which has made a payment in accordance with this Clause 35.5 shall be discharged of the relevant payment obligation under the Finance Documents and shall not take any credit risk with respect to the amounts standing to the credit of the trust account.

 

  (d)

Promptly upon the appointment of a successor Agent in accordance with Clause 32.13 (Replacement of the Facility Agent), each Paying Party shall (other than to the extent that that Party has given an instruction pursuant to paragraph (e) below) give all requisite instructions to the bank with whom the trust account is held to transfer the amount (together with any accrued interest) to the successor Agent for distribution to the relevant Recipient Party or Recipient Parties in accordance with Clause 35.2 (Distributions by the Facility Agent).

 

  (e)

A Paying Party shall, promptly upon request by a Recipient Party and to the extent:

 

  (i)

that it has not given an instruction pursuant to paragraph (d) above; and

 

  (ii)

that it has been provided with the necessary information by that Recipient Party,

give all requisite instructions to the bank with whom the trust account is held to transfer the relevant amount (together with any accrued interest) to that Recipient Party.

 

35.6

Partial Payments

 

  (a)

If the Facility Agent at any time receives a payment or payments (as the case may be) properly for the account of the Lenders under any Facility, and such payments are, when aggregated, insufficient to discharge the aggregate of all amounts then due and payable by the Obligors under that Facility, such Facility Agent shall apply such payment or payments, as applicable, towards the obligations of the Obligors under the Finance Documents in respect of that Facility in the following order (subject to Clause 35.12 (Subordinated Lenders)):

 

  (i)

first, in or towards payment pro rata of any unpaid fees, costs and expenses of the Facility Agent, the Issuing Bank (other than any amount under Clause 7.2 (Claims under a Letter of Credit) or, to the extent relating to the reimbursement of a claim (as defined in Clause 7 (Letters of Credit)), Clause 7.3 (Indemnities)) under the Finance Documents in respect of that Facility;

 

  (ii)

secondly, in or towards payment pro rata of any accrued interest, fee or commission due but unpaid under those Finance Documents in respect of that Facility;

 

  (iii)

thirdly, in or towards payment pro rata of any principal due but unpaid under those Finance Documents and any amount due but unpaid under Clause 7.2 (Claims under a Letter of Credit) and Clause 7.3 (Indemnities) in each case, in respect of that Facility; and

 

  (iv)

fourthly, in or towards payment pro rata of any other sum due but unpaid under the Finance Documents in respect of that Facility.

 

121


  (b)

The Facility Agent shall, if so directed by the Finance Parties in respect of the relevant Facility, vary the order set out in paragraphs (a)(ii) to (iv) above.

 

  (c)

Paragraphs (a) and (b) above shall override any instruction or appropriation made by an Obligor.

 

35.7

No Set–Off by the Obligors

All payments to be made by an Obligor under the Finance Documents shall be calculated and be made without (and free and clear of any deduction for) set–off or counterclaim.

 

35.8

Business Days

 

  (a)

Any payment or calculation under the Finance Documents which is due to be made on or as of a day that is not a Business Day shall be made on the next Business Day in the same calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not) and for the purposes of this Clause, “Business Day” means the Business Day applicable to the relevant payor or the person making the determination.

 

  (b)

During any extension of the due date for payment of any principal or Unpaid Sum under this Agreement interest is payable on the principal or Unpaid Sum at the rate payable on the original due date.

 

35.9

Currency of account

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraphs (b) to (e) of this Clause 35.9, the Base Currency is the currency of account and payment for any sum due from an Obligor under any Finance Document.

 

  (b)

A repayment of a Utilisation or Unpaid Sum or a part of a Utilisation or Unpaid Sum shall be made in the currency in which that Utilisation or Unpaid Sum is denominated, pursuant to this Agreement, on its due date.

 

  (c)

Each payment of interest shall be made in the currency in which the sum in respect of which the interest is payable was denominated, pursuant to this Agreement, when that interest accrued.

 

  (d)

Each payment in respect of costs, expenses or Taxes shall be made in the currency in which the costs, expenses or Taxes are incurred.

 

  (e)

Any amount expressed to be payable in a currency other than the Base Currency shall be paid in that other currency.

 

35.10

Change of currency

 

  (a)

Unless otherwise prohibited by law, if more than one currency or currency unit are at the same time recognised by the central bank of any country as the lawful currency of that country, then:

 

  (i)

any reference in the Finance Documents to, and any obligations arising under the Finance Documents in, the currency of that country shall be translated into, or paid in, the currency or currency unit of that country designated by the Facility Agent (after consultation with the Company); and

 

  (ii)

any translation from one currency or currency unit to another shall be at the official rate of exchange recognised by the central bank for the conversion of that currency or currency unit into the other, rounded up or down by the Facility Agent (acting reasonably).

 

122


  (b)

If a change in any currency of a country occurs, this Agreement will, to the extent the Facility Agent (acting reasonably and after consultation with the Company) specifies to be necessary, be amended to comply with any generally accepted conventions and market practice in the Relevant Market and otherwise to reflect the change in currency.

 

35.11

Disruption to payment systems etc.

If either the Facility Agent determines (in its discretion) that a Disruption Event has occurred or the Facility Agent is notified by the Company that a Disruption Event has occurred:

 

  (a)

the Facility Agent may, and shall if requested to do so by the Company, consult with the Company with a view to agreeing with the Company such changes to the operation or administration of the Facilities as the Facility Agent may deem necessary in the circumstances;

 

  (b)

the Facility Agent shall not be obliged to consult with the Company in relation to any changes mentioned in paragraph (a) above if, in its opinion, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances and, in any event, shall have no obligation to agree to such changes;

 

  (c)

the Facility Agent may consult with the Finance Parties in relation to any changes mentioned in paragraph (a) above but shall not be obliged to do so if, in its opinion, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances;

 

  (d)

any such changes agreed upon by the Facility Agent and the Company shall (whether or not it is finally determined that a Disruption Event has occurred) be binding upon the Parties as an amendment to (or, as the case may be, waiver of) the terms of the Finance Documents notwithstanding the provisions of Clause 42 (Amendments and Waivers);

 

  (e)

the Facility Agent shall not be liable for any damages, costs or losses to any person, any diminution in value or any liability whatsoever (including, without limitation for negligence, gross negligence or any other category of liability whatsoever but not including any claim based on the fraud of the Facility Agent) arising as a result of its taking, or failing to take, any actions pursuant to or in connection with this Clause 35.11; and

 

  (f)

the Facility Agent shall notify the Finance Parties of all changes agreed pursuant to paragraph (d) above.

 

35.12

Subordinated Lenders

 

  (a)

In this Clause 35.12:

Distributed Amount” means the amount distributed or paid to the Finance Parties or to the Facility Agent on behalf of the Finance Parties (or any of them) by the person responsible for the distribution of the assets (including any payments) of an Obligor which is insolvent or otherwise subject to insolvency or similar proceedings.

Maximum Amount” means the amount which would, but for any reduction or prohibition of payment or other distribution due to the relationship between any Subordinated Lender and an Obligor, have been distributed or distributable to the Finance Parties or to the Facility Agent on behalf of the relevant Finance Parties (or any of them).

Shortfall Amount” means the amount by which the Maximum Amount exceeds the Distributed Amount.

 

123


Subordinated Lender” means any Lender which has a relationship with an Obligor which leads to a reduction or prohibition of payment (including payments in form of an insolvency quota) or other distribution (including the proceeds from the enforcement of any Transaction Security) by that Obligor (including any administrator or insolvency administrator) to that Lender, including, without limitation, by reason of that Lender: (i) being a member of the Group, Sponsor Affiliate or Affiliate of any of those mentioned before; or (ii) having acquired (directly or indirectly) any Commitment, participation in any Utilisation and/or any other participation rights (including by way of sub-participation) in any Facility and/or any other rights and obligations under the Finance Documents from a member of the Group, Sponsor Affiliate or Affiliate of any of those mentioned before in accordance with Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders) or otherwise.

 

  (b)

If the Distributed Amount is less than the Maximum Amount, then, (b) upon application of the Distributed Amount (or any part thereof) pursuant to Clause 35.6 (Partial payments) towards the discharge of the obligations of an Obligor under the Finance Documents (including principal, interest, fees and commissions), the amount which would otherwise be required to be applied towards any such obligations under the Finance Documents owed to a Subordinated Lender shall be reduced by the Shortfall Amount attributable to that Subordinated Lender and such amount shall in addition be applied towards the discharge of the obligations (including principal, interest, fees, commission) towards the other Finance Parties pro rata in accordance with Clause 35.6 (Partial payments).

 

  (c)

Any risk of a shortfall between the Maximum Amount and the Distributed Amount (whether arising from the prohibition and/or reduction of payments to the Subordinated Lender and/or from any contestation (Anfechtung) under applicable law) shall for all purposes of the Finance Documents be borne by the relevant Subordinated Lender.

 

  (d)

A Subordinated Lender shall not have the benefit, but only the obligations, of any sharing provisions under the Finance Documents, including under Clause 34 (Sharing among the Finance Parties), and shall not be entitled to receive any payment, and the Facility Agent shall not be required to make any payment to any Subordinated Lender under or in connection with the Finance Documents in respect of the Shortfall Amount.

 

  (e)

Each Equitably Subordinated Lender agrees that to the extent an Equitably Subordinated Lender’s Commitment, participation in any Loan or sub-participation or other agreement or arrangement relating to a Commitment, including, without limitation, following a Debt Purchase Transaction could result in the subordination of claims of any other Lenders under the Facilities pursuant to any law regarding subordination of shareholder loans or prejudice or adversely affect the Transaction Security or guarantee and indemnity provided pursuant to Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) (or their enforceability) in any way it shall be deemed not to be a secured party under any Transaction Security Documents and shall not benefit from the guarantee and/or indemnity provided pursuant to Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) and no amount owing to it under any Finance Document shall be deemed secured by the Transaction Security Documents.

 

36.

DATA PROTECTION

Where any of the Finance Parties (the “Processor”) has been supplied by any Obligor with personal data of third party individuals (which may include, but is not limited to, the identity of the Borrowers and the Guarantors and directors, officers, employees and agents thereof) to fulfil its “know your customer” or anti-money laundering obligations, such Obligor confirms that:

 

  (a)

it has provided such individuals with the information as is required under data protection legislation, which includes but is not limited to: the identity of the Processor, the purpose for processing, how the Processor and/or such individuals might exercise their rights under the legislation and that the Processor as a global corporate may transfer their data to countries that do not offer the same level of protection as England or a member of the European Union;

 

124


  (b)

it has obtained the consent of such individual to the collection, processing, use and disclosure of his or her personal data by the Processor as required under applicable data protection legislation; and

 

  (c)

it shall notify the Processor promptly upon becoming aware of the withdrawal by the relevant individual of such consent.

 

37.

SET-OFF

 

  (a)

At any time when an Event of Default is continuing (but not at any other time), a Finance Party may set-off any matured obligation due from an Obligor under the Finance Documents (to the extent beneficially owned by that Finance Party) against any matured obligation owed by that Finance Party to that Obligor, regardless of the place of payment, booking branch or currency of either obligation. If the obligations are in different currencies, the Finance Party may convert either obligation at a market rate of exchange in its usual course of business for the purpose of the set-off. Such Finance Party shall promptly notify the Facility Agent and the Company in writing of any set-off made pursuant to this Clause 37.

 

  (b)

Any credit balances taken into account by an Ancillary Lender when operating a net limit in respect of any overdraft under an Ancillary Facility shall on enforcement of the Finance Documents be applied first in reduction of the overdraft provided under that Ancillary Facility in accordance with its terms.

 

38.

NOTICES

 

38.1

Communications in writing

Any communication to be made under or in connection with any Finance Document shall be made in writing and, unless otherwise stated, may be made by fax or letter.

 

38.2

Addresses

The address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention the communication is to be made) of each Party for any communication or document to be made or delivered under or in connection with any Finance Document is:

 

  (a)

in the case of the Company and the Facility Agent, that identified with its name below:

 

  Company   
  Address:    c/o Maples Corporate Services Limited
     P.O. Box 309, Ugland House
     Grand Cayman KY1-1104
     Cayman Islands
  Fax:    +1 345 949 8080
  with a copy to:   
  Address:    GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.
     400 Stone Break Rd. Ext.,
     Malta
     NY 12020
     USA
  Email:    legal.notices@globalfoundries.com
  Attention:    General Counsel

 

125


  Facility Agent   
  Address:    EMEA Loans Agency
     Citibank Europe Plc, UK Branch
     5th Floor, Citigroup Centre
     25 Canada Square
     Canary Wharf
     London E14 5LB
  Tel:    +44 20 7500 4402
  Fax:    +44 20 7492 3980

 

  (b)

in the case of each Lender, each Issuing Bank, each Ancillary Lender or any other Obligor, that notified in writing to the Facility Agent on or prior to the date on which it becomes a Party or any substitute address or fax number or department or officer as the Party may notify to the Facility Agent (or the Facility Agent may notify to the other Parties, if a change is made by the Facility Agent) by not less than seven (7) calendar days’ notice.

 

38.3

Delivery

 

  (a)

Any communication or document made or delivered by one person to another under or in connection with any Finance Document will only be effective:

 

  (i)

if by way of fax, when received in legible form; or

 

  (ii)

if by way of letter, when it has been left at the relevant address or seven (7) calendar days after being deposited in the post postage prepaid in an envelope addressed to it at that address,

and, if a particular department or officer is specified as part of its address details provided under Clause 38.2 (Addresses), if addressed to that department or officer.

 

  (b)

Any communication or document to be made or delivered to the Facility Agent will be effective only when actually received by the Facility Agent and then only if it is expressly marked for the attention of the department or officer identified with the Facility Agent’s signature below (or any substitute department or officer as the Facility Agent shall specify for this purpose).

 

  (c)

All notices from or to an Obligor in respect of any Finance Document shall be sent through the Facility Agent.

 

38.4

Notification of address and fax number

Promptly upon changing its own address or fax number, the Facility Agent shall notify the other Parties.

 

38.5

Communication when Agent is Impaired Agent

If the Facility Agent is an Impaired Agent the Parties may, instead of communicating with each other through the Facility Agent, communicate with each other directly and (while the Facility Agent is an Impaired Agent) all the provisions of the Finance Documents which require communications to be made or notices to be given to or by the Facility Agent shall be varied so that communications may be made and notices given to or by the relevant Parties directly. This provision shall not operate after a replacement Facility Agent has been appointed.

 

126


38.6

Electronic communication

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, any communication to be made between the Facility Agent and another Party may be made by electronic mail or other electronic means, if the Facility Agent and the relevant Party:

 

  (i)

agree that, unless and until notified to the contrary, this is to be an accepted form of communication (and the inclusion of electronic mail addresses in this Agreement or in any Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Accession Deed shall constitute such agreement);

 

  (ii)

notify each other in writing of their electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the transmission of information by that means; and

 

  (iii)

notify each other of any change to their address or any other such information supplied by them.

 

  (b)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, any electronic communication made between the Facility Agent and another Party will be effective only when actually received in readable form by the other and in the case of any electronic communication made by another Party to the Facility Agent only if it is addressed in such a manner as the Facility Agent shall specify for this purpose.

 

  (c)

It is hereby acknowledged that the Facility Agent will make information available to the Finance Parties by posting the information on IntraLinks or another similar electronic system (the “Platform”). Each Finance Party hereunder agrees that any document or notice posted on the Platform by the Facility Agent shall be deemed to have been delivered to the Finance Parties provided that the Facility Agent has notified each of the other Finance Parties that a new posting has been made. Each Party agrees that, to the extent reasonably practicable, any document delivered to the Facility Agent for purposes of compliance with any provision of this Agreement or for dissemination to any other Party shall be delivered to the Facility Agent in electronic form capable of being posted to the Platform. Each of the Parties understands and acknowledges that:

 

  (i)

the distribution of materials and other communications through an electronic medium is not necessarily secure and that there are confidentiality and other risks associated with such distribution and agrees and assumes the risks are associated with such electronic distribution, except to the extent caused by the wilful misconduct or gross negligence of the Facility Agent;

 

  (ii)

the Platform is provided “as is” and “as available” and neither the Facility Agent nor any of its affiliates warrants the accuracy or completeness of the information contained on the Platform or the adequacy of the Platform and each expressly disclaims liability for errors or omissions in the information contained on the Platform; and

 

  (iii)

no warranty of any kind, express, implied or statutory, including any warranty of merchantability, fitness for a particular purpose, non-infringement of third-party rights or freedom from viruses or other code defects is made by the Facility Agent or any of its affiliates in connection with the information contained on the Platform.

 

38.7

Use of websites

 

  (a)

The Company may satisfy its obligation under this Agreement to deliver any information in relation to those Lenders who accept this method of communication (the “Website Lenders”) by posting this information onto an electronic website designated by the Company and the Facility Agent (the “Designated Website”) if:

 

  (i)

the Facility Agent expressly agrees (after consultation with each of the relevant Lenders) that it will accept communication of the information by this method;

 

127


  (ii)

both the Company and the Facility Agent are aware of the address of and any relevant password specifications for the Designated Website; and

 

  (iii)

the information is in a format previously agreed between the Company and the Facility Agent.

If any Lender does not agree to the delivery of information electronically (a “Paper Form Lender”), then the Facility Agent shall notify the Company accordingly, and the Company shall supply the information to the Facility Agent (in sufficient copies for each Paper Form Lender) in paper form. In any event the Company shall supply the Facility Agent with at least one copy in paper form of any information required to be provided by it.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent shall supply each Website Lender with the address of and any relevant password specifications for the Designated Website following designation of that website by the Company and the Facility Agent.

 

  (c)

The Company shall promptly upon becoming aware of its occurrence notify the Facility Agent if:

 

  (i)

the Designated Website cannot be accessed due to technical failure;

 

  (ii)

the password specifications for the Designated Website change;

 

  (iii)

any new information which is required to be provided under this Agreement is posted onto the Designated Website;

 

  (iv)

any existing information which has been provided under this Agreement and posted onto the Designated Website is amended; or

 

  (v)

the Company becomes aware that the Designated Website or any information posted onto the Designated Website is or has been infected by any electronic virus or similar software.

If the Company notifies the Facility Agent under paragraph (c)(i) or paragraph (c)(v) above, all information to be provided by the Company under this Agreement after the date of that notice shall be supplied in paper form unless and until the Facility Agent and each Website Lender is satisfied that the circumstances giving rise to the notification are no longer continuing.

 

  (d)

Any Website Lender may request, through the Facility Agent, one (1) paper copy of any information required to be provided under this Agreement which is posted onto the Designated Website. The Company shall comply with any such request within ten (10) Business Days.

 

38.8

English language

 

  (a)

Any notice given under or in connection with any Finance Document must be in English.

 

  (b)

All other documents provided under or in connection with any Finance Document must be:

 

  (i)

in English; or

 

128


  (ii)

if not in English, and if so required by the Facility Agent, accompanied by a certified English translation (at the expense of the Company) and, in this case, the English translation will prevail unless the document is a constitutional, statutory or other official document.

 

39.

CALCULATIONS AND CERTIFICATES

 

39.1

Accounts

In any litigation or arbitration proceedings arising out of or in connection with a Finance Document, the entries made in the accounts maintained by a Finance Party are prima facie evidence of the matters to which they relate.

 

39.2

Certificates and determinations

Any certification or determination by a Finance Party of a rate or amount under any Finance Document is prima facie evidence of the matters to which it relates.

 

39.3

Day count convention

Any interest, commission or fee accruing under a Finance Document will accrue from day to day and is calculated on the basis of the actual number of days elapsed and a year of three hundred and sixty (360) calendar days or, in any case where the practice in the Relevant Market differs, in accordance with that market practice.

 

40.

PARTIAL INVALIDITY

If, at any time, any provision of a Finance Document is or becomes illegal, invalid or unenforceable in any respect under any law of any jurisdiction, neither the legality, validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions nor the legality, validity or enforceability of such provision under the law of any other jurisdiction will in any way be affected or impaired.

 

41.

REMEDIES AND WAIVERS

No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, on the part of any Finance Party, any right or remedy under a Finance Document shall operate as a waiver of any such right or remedy or constitute an election to affirm any Finance Document. No election to affirm any Finance Document on the part of any Finance Party shall be effective unless it is in writing. No single or partial exercise of any right or remedy shall prevent any further or other exercise or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies provided in each Finance Document are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

 

42.

AMENDMENTS AND WAIVERS

 

42.1

Required consents

 

  (a)

Subject to Clause 42.2 (All Lender matters), Clause 42.3 (Super Majority matters) and Clause 42.4 (Other exceptions), any term of the Finance Documents may be amended, waived or modified only with the consent of the Majority Lenders and the Company and any such amendment, waiver or modification will be binding on all Parties.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent may effect, on behalf of any Finance Party, any amendment or waiver permitted by this Clause 42.

 

  (c)

Without prejudice to the generality of paragraphs (c), (d) and (e) of Clause 32.7 (Rights and discretions), the Facility Agent may engage, pay for and rely on the services of lawyers in determining the consent level required for and effecting any amendment, waiver or consent under this Agreement.

 

129


  (d)

Each Obligor agrees to any such amendment or waiver permitted by this Clause 42 which is agreed to by the Company. This includes any amendment or waiver which would, but for this paragraph (d), require the consent of all of the Guarantors.

 

  (e)

Paragraph (c) of Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement) shall apply to this Clause 42.

 

42.2

All Lender matters

Subject to Clause 42.5 (Replacement of Screen Rate) and Clause 42.6 (Structural Adjustment), an amendment, waiver or consent of, or determination under, or in relation to, any term of any Finance Document that has the effect of changing or which relates to:

 

  (a)

the definition of “EU Obligor”, “Majority Lenders”, “Majority L/C Lenders”, “Majority RCF Lenders”, “Restricted Lender”, “Super Majority Lenders” or “Sanctions” in Clause 1.1 (Definitions);

 

  (b)

permitting the Borrowers or Guarantors to assign its rights or delegate its duties under this Agreement other than in accordance with Clause 31 (Changes to the Obligors);

 

  (c)

an extension to the date of payment of any amount under the Finance Documents (other than in relation to Clause 10 (Repayment), Clause 11 (Illegality, Voluntary Prepayment and Cancellation) and Clause 12 (Mandatory prepayment and cancellation) or as permitted in accordance with paragraph (e) of Clause 42.3 (Super Majority matters));

 

  (d)

a reduction in the Margin or a reduction in the amount of any payment of principal or interest of any Utilisation;

 

  (e)

a change in currency of payment of any amount under the Finance Documents;

 

  (f)

other than as contemplated by Clause 2.2 (Increase), an increase in any Commitment or the Total Commitments, an extension of any Availability Period or any requirement that a cancellation of Commitments reduces the Commitments of the Lenders rateably under the relevant Facility;

 

  (g)

any provision which expressly requires the consent of all the Lenders;

 

  (h)

paragraph (b) of Clause 24 (Representations) and Clauses 10 (Sanctions) and 18 (Pari Passu Ranking) of Schedule 12 (Representations) hereto, Clauses 3 (Compliance with Laws), 10 (Pari Passu Ranking), paragraph (b) of Clause 11 (Sanctions) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants), or Clause 5 (Insolvency Events) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) in respect of any Borrower only; or

 

  (i)

Clause 2.3 (Finance Parties’ rights and obligations), Clause 11.1 (Illegality), Clause 13.8 (Application of prepayments), Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders) (to the extent further restricting the rights of the Lenders to assign, transfer or sub-participate their rights or obligations under the Finance Documents), Clause 34 (Sharing among the Finance Parties), Clause 36 (Data Protection), this Clause 42.2 and Clause 48 (Governing law),

shall not be made, or given, without the prior consent of all the Lenders.

 

130


42.3

Super Majority matters

Subject to Clause 42.5 (Replacement of Screen Rate) and Clause 42.6 (Structural Adjustment), an amendment, waiver or consent of, or determination under, or in relation to, any term of any Finance Document that has the effect of changing or which relates to:

 

  (a)

Clause 5 (Insolvency Events) in respect of an Obligor (other than any Borrower) or Clause 10 (Repudiation) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default);

 

  (b)

Clause 2 (Breach of Other Obligations) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) hereto to the extent attributable to any breach of Clauses 1 (Financial Statements), 4 (Notification of Default) or Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants), Clause 1 (Maintenance of Existence) or 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants), 1 (Negative Pledge), 2 (Disposals), Clause 3 (Merger), 5 (Financial Indebtedness), 6 (Acquisitions; Investments), 7 (Distribution) or 9 (Nature of Business) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) hereto;

 

  (c)

Clause 3 (Misrepresentation) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) hereto to the extent attributable to any breach of Clauses 1 (Status; Power), 2 (Legality; Validity and Enforceability), 3 (Authorisations), 4 (No Proceedings), 5 (Non-Conflict), 8 (Solvency), 10 (Sanctions), 14 (Corrupt Practices Laws) and 17 (Private and Commercial Purposes) of Schedule 12 (Representations) hereto;

 

  (d)

any waiver of any Event of Default or a Default arising under or relating to any provisions referred to in paragraphs (a), (b) and (c) above;

 

  (e)

any waiver of an Event of Default or Default arising under Clause 1 (Non-Payment) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) hereto, including the postponement of any relevant payment due under this Agreement or decrease or forgiveness of any relevant amount due;

 

  (f)

(other than as expressly permitted by the provisions of any Finance Document) the nature or scope of the guarantee and indemnity granted under Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity);

 

  (g)

the release of any guarantee and indemnity granted under Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity);

 

  (h)

any provision which expressly requires the consent of the Super Majority Lenders; and

 

  (i)

any amendment or waiver having the effect of any of the foregoing,

shall not be made, or given, without the prior consent of the Super Majority Lenders.

 

42.4

Other exceptions

 

  (a)

An amendment or waiver which relates to the rights or obligations of the Facility Agent, the Arrangers, the Bookrunners, any Issuing Bank or any Ancillary Lender (each in their capacity as such) may not be effected without the consent of the Facility Agent, the Arrangers, the Bookrunners, such Issuing Bank or such Ancillary Lender, as the case may be.

 

131


  (b)

Notwithstanding Clause 42.2 (All Lender matters) and Clause 42.3 (Super Majority matters) any amendment or waiver (other than an amendment or waiver to which Clause 42.6 (Structural Adjustment) applies or would, but for this paragraph (b), apply) which:

 

  (i)

relates only to the rights or obligations applicable to a particular Loan, Facility or class of Lender; and

 

  (ii)

does not materially and adversely affect the rights or interests of Lenders in respect of any other Loan or Facility or another class of Lender,

may be made in accordance with this Clause 42 but as if references in this Clause 42 to the specified proportion of Lenders (including, for the avoidance of doubt, all the Lenders) whose consent would, but for this paragraph (b), be required for that amendment or waiver were to be that proportion of the Lenders participating in that particular Loan or forming part of that particular class of Lenders.

 

42.5

Replacement of Screen Rate

Subject to paragraph (a) of Clause 42.4 (Other exceptions) if any Screen Rate is not available for a currency which can be selected for a Loan, any amendment or waiver which relates to providing for another benchmark rate to apply in relation to that currency in place of that Screen Rate (or which relates to aligning any provision of a Finance Document to the use of that other benchmark rate) may be made with the consent of the Majority Lenders and the Company.

 

42.6

Structural Adjustment

 

  (a)

In this Agreement:

 

  (i)

Adjustment” means:

 

  (A)

the introduction of a New Tranche into the Finance Documents;

 

  (B)

an increase in any Existing Tranche; or

 

  (C)

an extension of the Availability Period applicable to the Revolving Facility.

 

  (ii)

Consequential Amendment” means, in relation to a Major Structural Adjustment, a Minor Structural Adjustment or a Payables Reduction, any amendment, waiver or consent of, or in relation to, any Finance Document consequential on, or required to implement or reflect, that Major Structural Adjustment, Minor Structural Adjustment or Payables Reduction.

 

  (iii)

Existing Tranche” means any Commitment in respect of, and any Loan made under, an existing Facility.

 

  (iv)

Facilities Amount” means at any time, the then aggregate (without double counting) of the amount in the Base Currency (as determined by the Agent by reference to the Facility Agent’s Spot Rate of Exchange) of:

 

  (A)

the amounts borrowed and not repaid or prepaid; and

 

  (B)

the committed financial accommodation available (or potentially available),

under the Finance Documents and, in the case of paragraph (B) above, by reference to the application, at that time, of any relevant limitation on the potential amount of that financial accommodation.

 

  (v)

Facilities Increase” means, in relation to an Adjustment, the extent to which the Facilities Amount immediately after that Adjustment would (as a result of that Adjustment and after taking account of any repayment of any Utilisation, or any cancellation of any Commitment, to be effected at the same time as, or immediately following that Adjustment) exceed the Facilities Amount immediately before that Adjustment.

 

132


  (vi)

Major Structural Adjustment” means an amendment, waiver or consent that is not a Minor Structural Adjustment and that results in, or is intended to result in:

 

  (A)

an Adjustment where the indebtedness in respect of any New Tranche introduced into the Finance Documents ranks pari passu with the indebtedness in respect of the Facilities;

 

  (B)

the introduction of a New Tranche into the Finance Documents where the indebtedness in respect of that New Tranche ranks junior to the indebtedness in respect of the Facilities;

 

  (C)

the transfer of an Existing Tranche (or any participation in an Existing Tranche) into any New Tranche described in paragraph (A) or paragraph (B) above; or

 

  (D)

a change in currency of any Existing Tranche or of any amount payable under any Finance Document.

 

  (vii)

Minor Structural Adjustment” means an amendment, waiver or consent that results in, or is intended to result in:

 

  (A)

an Adjustment which would not result in a Facilities Increase or a change in currency of an Existing Tranche or of any amount payable under any Finance Document and where the indebtedness in respect of any New Tranche introduced pursuant to that Adjustment ranks pari passu with, or junior to, the indebtedness in respect of the Facilities; or

 

  (B)

the transfer of an Existing Tranche (or any participation in an Existing Tranche) into any New Tranche introduced pursuant to paragraph (A) above where each Lender which has an Existing Tranche (or a participation in that Existing Tranche) has the opportunity (but not the obligation) to transfer that Existing Tranche (or that participation) into that New Tranche.

 

  (viii)

New Tranche” means any additional tranche, loan, facility or commitment.

 

  (ix)

Payables Reduction” means an amendment, waiver or consent that results in, or is intended to result in:

 

  (A)

an extension to the date of payment of any amount under the Finance Documents; or

 

  (B)

a reduction in the Margin or a reduction in the amount of any payment of principal, interest, fees or commission payable.

 

  (b)

If any amendment, waiver or consent is a Major Structural Adjustment, Minor Structural Adjustment or Payables Reduction (or, in each case, a Consequential Amendment relating to it) and would otherwise require the prior consent of all the Lenders pursuant to Clause 42.2 (All Lender matters) or Clause 42.3 (Super Majority matters), that amendment, waiver or consent may be made with the consent of the Company and:

 

  (i)

in the case of a Major Structural Adjustment (or a Consequential Amendment relating to it):

 

  (A)

each Lender that assumes a New Tranche or an increased Existing Tranche, whose Existing Tranche (or participation) is being transferred, whose Commitment is subject to an extended Availability Period or that has an Existing Tranche (or participation), or is owed any amount, which is subject, in each case, to a change in currency; and

 

133


  (B)

the Majority Lenders;

 

  (ii)

in the case of a Minor Structural Adjustment (or a Consequential Amendment relating to it):

 

  (A)

each Lender that assumes a New Tranche or an increased Existing Tranche, whose Existing Tranche (or participation) is being transferred or whose Commitment is subject to an extended Availability Period; and

 

  (B)

the Majority Lenders; or

 

  (iii)

in the case of a Payables Reduction (or a Consequential Amendment relating to it):

 

  (A)

each Lender to whom any amount is owing in respect of which the date of payment is being extended or which is being reduced or whose Margin, fee or commission is being reduced; and

 

  (B)

the Majority Lenders.

 

42.7

Excluded Commitments

 

  (a)

If any Lender fails to respond to a request for a consent, waiver, amendment of or in relation to any term of any Finance Document or any other vote of Lenders under the terms of this Agreement within fifteen (15) Business Days of that request being made (unless, the Company and the Facility Agent agree to a longer time period in relation to any request):

 

  (i)

its Commitment(s) shall not be included for the purpose of calculating the Total Commitments under the relevant Facility/ies when ascertaining whether any relevant percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of Total Commitments has been obtained to approve that request; and

 

  (ii)

its status as a Lender shall be disregarded for the purpose of ascertaining whether the agreement of any specified group of Lenders has been obtained to approve that request.

 

  (b)

A Restricted Lender shall not have voting rights in relation to a specific vote of Lenders under the terms of this Agreement where the amendment or waiver relates to Clauses 10 (Sanctions) and/or 14 (Corrupt Practices Laws) of Schedule 12 (Representations) and/or Clause 11 (Sanctions) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) to the extent that such Restricted Lender does not have the benefit of such provisions, and in such case:

 

  (i)

its Commitment(s) shall not be included for the purpose of calculating the Total Commitments under the relevant Facility/ies when ascertaining whether any relevant percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of Total Commitments has been obtained; and

 

  (ii)

its status as Lender shall be disregarded for the purpose of ascertaining whether the agreement of any specified group of Lenders has been obtained.

 

42.8

Replacement of Lender

 

  (a)

The Company may, in the circumstances set out in paragraph (a) of Clause 11.1 (Illegality) or Clause 11.4 (Right of cancellation and repayment in relation to a single Lender), on ten (10) Business Days’ prior notice to the Facility Agent and that Lender, replace that Lender by

 

134


  requiring that Lender to (and, to the extent permitted by law, that Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations under the Finance Documents to a Lender or other Acceptable Transferee which is acceptable (in the case of any transfer of a Revolving Facility Commitment) to the relevant Issuing Bank and which:

 

  (i)

provides all “know your customer” information required by the Facility Agent in accordance with paragraph (b) of Clause 29.6 (Procedure for Transfer) or paragraph (b) of Clause 29.7 (Procedure for Assignment); and

 

  (ii)

confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations of the transferring Lender in accordance with Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders),

for a purchase price in cash or other cash payment payable at the time of the transfer equal to the outstanding principal amount of such Lender’s participation in the outstanding Utilisations and all accrued interest and/or Letter of Credit fees (to the extent that the Facility Agent has not given a notification under Clause 29.11 (Pro rata interest settlement)), Break Costs and other amounts payable in relation thereto under the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

The replacement of a Lender pursuant to paragraph (a) above shall be subject to the following conditions:

 

  (i)

the Company shall have no right to replace the Facility Agent;

 

  (ii)

neither the Facility Agent nor any Lender shall have any obligation to find a Replacement Lender;

 

  (iii)

the transfer must take place no later than ninety (90) calendar days after the notice referred to in paragraph (a) above;

 

  (iv)

in no event shall the Lender replaced under paragraph (a) above be required to pay or surrender any of the fees received by such Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents; and

 

  (v)

an Obligor shall pay (at the time of the relevant transfer under this Clause) to the transferring Lender the amount of its reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocation of overhead or internal costs) incurred by it in effecting such transfer.

 

42.9

Disenfranchisement of Defaulting Lenders

 

  (a)

In ascertaining:

 

  (i)

the Majority Lenders, Majority L/C Lenders, Majority RCF Lenders or the Super Majority Lenders; or

 

  (ii)

whether:

 

  (A)

any given percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of the Total Commitments under the relevant Facility/ies; or

 

  (B)

the agreement of any specified group of Lenders,

 

135


has been obtained to approve any request for a consent, waiver, amendment or other vote of Lenders under the Finance Documents, each Defaulting Lender’s Commitment(s) shall not be included for the purpose of calculating the Total Commitments under the relevant Facility/ies when ascertaining whether any relevant percentage (including, for the avoidance of doubt, unanimity) of Total Commitments has been obtained to approve that request and such Defaulting Lender’s status as a Lender shall be disregarded for the purpose of ascertaining whether the agreement of any specified group of Lenders has been obtained to approve that request.

 

  (b)

For the purposes of this Clause 42.9, the Facility Agent may assume that the following Lenders are Defaulting Lenders:

 

  (i)

any Lender which has notified the Facility Agent that it has become a Defaulting Lender;

 

  (ii)

any Lender in relation to which it is aware that any of the events or circumstances referred to in paragraphs (a) or (b) of the definition of “Defaulting Lender” has occurred,

unless it has received notice to the contrary from the Lender concerned (together with any supporting evidence reasonably requested by the Facility Agent) or the Facility Agent is otherwise aware that the Lender has ceased to be a Defaulting Lender.

 

42.10

Replacement of a Defaulting Lender

 

  (a)

The Company may, at any time a Lender has become and continues to be a Defaulting Lender, by giving ten (10) Business Days’ prior written notice to such Lender and the Facility Agent, replace such Lender by requiring such Lender to (and such Lender shall) transfer pursuant to Clause 29 (Changes to the Lenders) all (and not part only) of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a Lender or other bank or financial institution (a “Replacement Lender”) selected by the Company, and which (unless the Facility Agent is an Impaired Agent) is acceptable to the Facility Agent (acting reasonably), which confirms its willingness to assume and does assume all the obligations or all the relevant obligations of the transferring Lender (including the assumption of the transferring Lender’s participations or unfunded participations (as the case may be) on the same basis as the transferring Lender) for a purchase price in cash payable at the time of transfer equal to the outstanding principal amount of such Lender’s participation in the outstanding Loans and all accrued interest, Break Costs and other amounts payable in relation thereto under the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

Any transfer of rights and obligations of a Defaulting Lender pursuant to this Clause shall be subject to the following conditions:

 

  (i)

the Company shall have no right to replace the Facility Agent;

 

  (ii)

neither the Facility Agent nor the Defaulting Lender shall have any obligation to the Company to find a Replacement Lender;

 

  (iii)

the transfer must take place no later than ninety (90) calendar days after the notice referred to in paragraph (a) above;

 

  (iv)

in no event shall the Defaulting Lender be required to pay or surrender to the Replacement Lender any of the fees received by the Defaulting Lender pursuant to the Finance Documents; and

 

  (v)

the Company shall pay (at the time of the relevant transfer under this Clause) to the Defaulting Lender the amount of its reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocation of overhead or internal costs) incurred by it in effecting such transfer.

 

136


43.

CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION

 

43.1

Confidentiality

Save as permitted pursuant to the terms of the Finance Documents, any information, reports or documents furnished pursuant to the Finance Documents to the Finance Parties shall be kept confidential by the recipient and the Finance Parties agree not to disclose to any third party any of the information, reports or documents supplied by, or on behalf of, the Company under the Finance Documents without the prior consent of the Company (such consent not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

43.2

Exceptions

 

  (a)

The provisions of Clause 43.1 (Confidentiality) shall not apply:

 

  (i)

to any information disclosed by a Finance Party to another Finance Party;

 

  (ii)

to any information which has already become public knowledge;

 

  (iii)

to prohibit disclosure of any information to the extent that the recipient is required to disclose the same pursuant to any law or order of any court or order of any governmental agency or regulatory or self-regulatory body or securities exchange with whose instructions the recipient habitually complies or by any applicable regulations;

 

  (iv)

to prohibit the supply of any information to its Affiliates and any of its or their officers, directors, employees, auditors, insurance advisors, tax advisors or professional advisers of any of the Finance Parties, a potential transferee, assignee or sub-participant if (A) in respect of any such Affiliate, auditor, insurance advisor, tax advisor or professional advisor, potential transferee, assignee or sub-participant, it has signed a Confidentiality Agreement or otherwise agreed to keep information confidential on terms reasonably acceptable to the Company; or (B) in respect of any other person, that person is informed of its confidential nature and that some or all of such information may be price-sensitive information;

 

  (v)

to prohibit the supply of any information to any insurer (solely in respect of credit risk insurance for a lending transaction) provided that (A) the relevant Lender will give prior notification of such proposed disclosure to the Company but, for the avoidance of doubt, will not be required to disclose the identity of such insurer, and (B) the relevant Lender confirms to the Company prior to such disclosure that the relevant insurer has entered into a confidentiality agreement with it on substantially the same terms as the Confidentiality Undertaking or as otherwise agreed with the Company;

 

  (vi)

to any information disclosed to any person to whom or for whose benefit that Finance Party charges, assigns or otherwise creates Security (or may do so) pursuant to Clause 29.10 (Security over Lenders’ rights); or

 

  (vii)

to any third party who has signed a confidentiality agreement on terms reasonably acceptable to the Company.

 

  (b)

The Finance Parties will not be precluded in any manner or in any way from providing, arranging or participating in any financing for, providing advisory or other services to third parties in, or acting as principal in, transactions which may involve the Company, any member of the Group or any other party, provided that the relevant Finance Party does not disclose any Confidential Information in connection therewith.

 

137


43.3

Disclosure to numbering service providers

 

  (a)

Any Finance Party may disclose to any national or international numbering service provider appointed by that Finance Party to provide identification numbering services in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors the following information:

 

  (i)

names of Obligors;

 

  (ii)

country of domicile of Obligors;

 

  (iii)

place of incorporation of Obligors;

 

  (iv)

the Signing Date;

 

  (v)

Clause 48 (Governing law);

 

  (vi)

the names of the Facility Agent and the Arrangers;

 

  (vii)

date of each amendment and restatement of this Agreement;

 

  (viii)

amounts of, and names of, the Facilities (and any tranches);

 

  (ix)

amount of Total Commitments;

 

  (x)

currencies of the Facilities;

 

  (xi)

type of Facilities;

 

  (xii)

ranking of Facilities;

 

  (xiii)

Final Maturity Date for Facilities;

 

  (xiv)

changes to any of the information previously supplied pursuant to paragraphs (i) to (xiii) above; and

 

  (xv)

such other information agreed between such Finance Party and the Company,

to enable such numbering service provider to provide its usual syndicated loan numbering identification services.

 

  (b)

The Parties acknowledge and agree that each identification number assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by a numbering service provider and the information associated with each such number may be disclosed to users of its services in accordance with the standard terms and conditions of that numbering service provider.

 

  (c)

Each Obligor represents that none of the information set out in paragraphs (i) to (xv) of paragraph (a) above is, nor will at any time be, unpublished price-sensitive information.

 

  (d)

The Facility Agent shall notify the Company and the other Finance Parties of:

 

  (i)

the name of any numbering service provider appointed by the Facility Agent in respect of this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors; and

 

  (ii)

the number or, as the case may be, numbers assigned to this Agreement, the Facilities and/or one or more Obligors by such numbering service provider.

 

138


43.4

Entire agreement

This Clause 43 constitutes the entire agreement between the Parties in relation to the obligations of the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents regarding Confidential Information and supersedes any previous agreement, whether express or implied, regarding Confidential Information.

 

43.5

Inside information

Each of the Finance Parties acknowledges that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation including securities law relating to insider dealing and market abuse and each of the Finance Parties undertakes not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose.

 

43.6

Notification of disclosure

Each of the Finance Parties agrees (to the extent permitted by law and regulation) to inform the Company:

 

  (a)

of the circumstances of any disclosure of Confidential Information made pursuant to paragraph (a)(iii) of Clause 43.2 (Exceptions) except where such disclosure is made to any of the persons referred to in that paragraph during the ordinary course of its supervisory or regulatory function; and

 

  (b)

upon becoming aware that Confidential Information has been disclosed in breach of this Clause 43.

 

43.7

Survival of Obligations

The obligations in this Clause 43 are continuing and, in particular, shall survive and remain binding on each Finance Party for a period of two (2) years from the earlier of:

 

  (a)

the date on which all amounts payable by the Obligors under or in connection with the Finance Documents have been paid in full and all Commitments have been cancelled or otherwise cease to be available; and

 

  (b)

the date on which such Finance Party otherwise ceases to be a Finance Party.

 

44.

CONFIDENTIALITY OF FUNDING RATES

 

44.1

Confidentiality and disclosure

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent and each Obligor agree to keep each Funding Rate confidential and not to disclose it to anyone, save to the extent permitted by paragraphs (b) and (c) below.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent may disclose:

 

  (i)

any Funding Rate to the relevant Borrower pursuant to Clause 14.4 (Notification of rates of interest); and

 

  (ii)

any Funding Rate to any person appointed by it to provide administration services in respect of one or more of the Finance Documents to the extent necessary to enable such service provider to provide those services if the service provider to whom that information is to be given has entered into a confidentiality agreement substantially in the form of the LMA Master Confidentiality Undertaking for Use With Administration/Settlement Service Providers or such other form of confidentiality undertaking agreed between the Facility Agent and the relevant Lender.

 

139


  (c)

The Facility Agent may disclose any Funding Rate, and each Obligor may disclose any Funding Rate, to:

 

  (i)

any of its Affiliates and any of its or their officers, directors, employees, professional advisers, auditors, partners and Representatives if any person to whom that Funding Rate is to be given pursuant to this paragraph (i) is informed in writing of its confidential nature and that it may be price-sensitive information except that there shall be no such requirement to so inform if the recipient is subject to professional obligations to maintain the confidentiality of that Funding Rate or is otherwise bound by requirements of confidentiality in relation to it;

 

  (ii)

any person to whom information is required or requested to be disclosed by any court of competent jurisdiction or any governmental, banking, taxation or other regulatory authority or similar body, the rules of any relevant stock exchange or pursuant to any applicable law or regulation if the person to whom that Funding Rate is to be given is informed in writing of its confidential nature and that it may be price-sensitive information except that there shall be no requirement to so inform if, in the opinion of the Facility Agent or the relevant Obligor, as the case may be, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances;

 

  (iii)

any person to whom information is required to be disclosed in connection with, and for the purposes of, any litigation, arbitration, administrative or other investigations, proceedings or disputes if the person to whom that Funding Rate is to be given is informed in writing of its confidential nature and that it may be price-sensitive information except that there shall be no requirement to so inform if, in the opinion of the Facility Agent or the relevant Obligor, as the case may be, it is not practicable to do so in the circumstances; and

 

  (iv)

any person with the consent of the relevant Lender.

 

44.2

Related obligations

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent and each Obligor acknowledge that each Funding Rate is or may be price-sensitive information and that its use may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation including securities law relating to insider dealing and market abuse and the Facility Agent and each Obligor undertake not to use any Funding Rate for any unlawful purpose.

 

  (b)

The Facility Agent and each Obligor agree (to the extent permitted by law and regulation) to inform the relevant Lender:

 

  (i)

of the circumstances of any disclosure made pursuant to paragraph (c)(i) of Clause 44.1 (Confidentiality and disclosure) except where such disclosure is made to any of the persons referred to in that paragraph during the ordinary course of its supervisory or regulatory function; and

 

  (ii)

upon becoming aware that any information has been disclosed in breach of this Clause 44.

 

44.3

No Event of Default

No Event of Default will occur under Clause 2 (Breach of Other Obligations) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) by reason only of an Obligor’s failure to comply with this Clause 44.

 

140


45.

DISCLOSURE OF LENDER DETAILS BY FACILITY AGENT

 

45.1

Supply of Lender details to the Company

The Facility Agent shall provide to the Company, within five (5) Business Days of a request by the Company (but no more frequently than once per calendar quarter), a list (which may be in electronic form) setting out the names of the Lenders as at the date of that request, their respective Commitments, the address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention any communication is to be made) of each Lender for any communication to be made or document to be delivered under or in connection with the Finance Documents, the electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the transmission of information by electronic mail or other electronic means to and by each Lender to whom any communication under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be made by that means and the account details of each Lender for any payment to be distributed by the Facility Agent to that Lender under the Finance Documents.

 

45.2

Supply of Lender details at Company’s direction

 

  (a)

The Facility Agent shall, at the request of the Company, disclose the identity of the Lenders and the details of the Lenders’ Commitments to any:

 

  (i)

other Party or any other person if that disclosure is made to facilitate, in each case, a refinancing of the Financial Indebtedness arising under the Finance Documents or a material waiver or amendment of any term of any Finance Document; and

 

  (ii)

member of the Group.

 

  (b)

Subject to paragraph (c) below, the Company shall procure that the recipient of information disclosed pursuant to paragraph (a) above shall keep such information confidential and shall not disclose it to anyone and shall ensure that all such information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to the recipient’s own confidential information.

 

  (c)

The recipient may disclose such information to any of its officers, directors, employees, professional advisers, auditors and partners as it shall consider appropriate if any such person is informed in writing of its confidential nature, except that there shall be no such requirement to so inform if that person is subject to professional obligations to maintain the confidentiality of the information or is otherwise bound by duties of confidentiality in relation to the information.

 

46.

COUNTERPARTS

Each Finance Document may be executed in any number of counterparts, and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of the Finance Document.

 

47.

USA PATRIOT ACT

Each Lender hereby notifies each Obligor that pursuant to the requirements of the USA Patriot Act, such Lender is required to obtain, verify and record information that identifies such Obligor, which information includes the name and address of such Obligor and other information that will allow such Lender to identify such Obligor in accordance with the USA Patriot Act

 

48.

GOVERNING LAW

This Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

141


49.

CONTRACTUAL RECOGNITION OF BAIL-IN

Notwithstanding any other term of any Finance Document or any other agreement, arrangement or understanding between the Parties, each Party acknowledges and accepts that any liability of any Party to any other Party under or in connection with the Finance Documents may be subject to Bail-In Action by the relevant Resolution Authority and acknowledges and accepts to be bound by the effect of:

 

  (a)

any Bail-In Action in relation to any such liability, including (without limitation):

 

  (i)

a reduction, in full or in part, in the principal amount, or outstanding amount due (including any accrued but unpaid interest) in respect of any such liability;

 

  (ii)

a conversion of all, or part of, any such liability into shares or other instruments of ownership that may be issued to, or conferred on, it; and

 

  (iii)

a cancellation of any such liability; and

 

  (b)

a variation of any term of any Finance Document to the extent necessary to give effect to any Bail-In Action in relation to any such liability.

 

50.

ENFORCEMENT

 

50.1

Jurisdiction of English courts

The Parties agree that the courts of England shall have exclusive jurisdiction to hear and determine any suit, action or proceedings and to settle any dispute, controversy or claim arising out of or in connection with this Agreement (including a dispute, controversy or claim regarding the existence, validity or termination of this Agreement or any non-contractual obligation arising out of or in connection with this Agreement) (a “Dispute”).

 

50.2

Appropriate forum

Each of the Parties hereby irrevocably and unconditionally submit and consent to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of England in respect of any Dispute and agree not to claim that any such court is not a convenient or appropriate forum.

 

50.3

Non–exclusive submission

Notwithstanding Clause 50.1 (Jurisdiction of English courts) and Clause 50.2 (Appropriate forum) above, no Finance Party shall be prevented from taking proceedings relating to a Dispute in any other courts with jurisdiction. To the extent allowed by law, the Finance Parties may take concurrent proceedings in any number of jurisdictions.

 

50.4

Service of Process

 

  (a)

Without prejudice to any other mode of service allowed under any relevant law, each Obligor (other than an Obligor incorporated in England and Wales):

 

  (i)

confirms that it has irrevocably appointed Law Debenture Corporate Services Limited of Fifth Floor, 100 Wood Street, London EC2V 7EX, United Kingdom as its agent for service of process in relation to any proceedings before the English courts in connection with any Finance Document; and

 

  (ii)

agrees that failure by an agent for service of process to notify the relevant Obligor of the process will not invalidate the proceedings concerned.

 

142


  (b)

If any person appointed as an agent for service of process is unable for any reason to act as agent for service of process, the Company (on behalf of all the Obligors) must promptly (and in any event within ninety (90) days of such event taking place) appoint another agent on terms acceptable to the Facility Agent. Failing this, the Facility Agent may appoint another agent for this purpose.

THIS AGREEMENT has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement.

 

143


SCHEDULE 1

THE ORIGINAL PARTIES

Part A

Original Guarantors

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC & Co. KG

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC & Co. KG

 

4.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

5.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

 

6.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V.

 

7.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

8.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

 

9.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH

 

10.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

 

11.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH

 

12.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Cooperatief U.A.

 

13.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V.

 

14.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

 

144


Part B

Original Borrowers

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

 

145


Part C

Original Lenders

 

Name of Original Lenders   

Revolving Facility

Commitments

    

Additional L/C Facility

Commitments

 

Bank of America, N.A.

   $ 25,000,000        —    

Citibank, N.A.

   $ 70,000,000      $ 20,000,000  

DBS Bank Ltd.

   $ 90,000,000        —    

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

   $ 50,000,000        —    
    

 

 

Total Commitments

   $ 235,000,000      $ 20,000,000  
    

 

 

 

146


SCHEDULE 2

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

Part A

Conditions Precedent to Financial Close

 

1.

Finance Documents

Copies of each of the following Finance Documents duly executed and delivered by each of the parties thereto:

 

  (a)

this Agreement;

 

  (b)

the Subordination Deed;

 

  (c)

any applicable Fee Letters; and

 

  (d)

the Closing Date Security Documents.

 

2.

Obligors

 

  (a)

A copy of the constitutional documents of each Original Obligor (including for any German Original Obligor (i) an up-to-date electronic chronological commercial register extract (elektronischer chronologischer Handelsregisterausdruck), its articles of association (Satzung) or partnership agreement (Gesellschaftsvertrag), as applicable, as well as copies of any by-laws and (iii) if applicable, its list of shareholders).

 

  (b)

A copy of a good standing certificate with respect to each US Obligor, issued as of a recent date by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of each US Obligor’s jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation.

 

  (c)

A copy of a resolution of in respect of any Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor), its board of directors or board of managers, as applicable:

 

  (i)

approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which it is a party and resolving that it execute the Finance Documents to which it is a party;

 

  (ii)

authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Finance Documents to which it is a party on its behalf;

 

  (iii)

authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices (including, if relevant, any Utilisation Request) to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents to which it is a party;

 

  (iv)

authorising the Company to act as obligors’ agent in connection with the Finance Documents.

 

  (d)

A specimen of the signature of person(s) authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (c) above or otherwise.

 

  (e)

If required, a copy of a resolution of the holders of the issued shares and/or interests, as applicable in each Original Obligor (and/or, if applicable, by the supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) and/or advisory board (Beirat) of such German Original Obligor), approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which the Original Obligor is a party.

 

147


  (f)

A certificate of each Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor) (signed by an Authorised Officer) confirming that borrowing, securing or guaranteeing, as appropriate, the Total Commitments would not cause any borrowing, securing, guaranteeing or similar limit binding on such Original Obligor to be exceeded.

 

  (g)

A certificate of an Authorised Officer of the relevant Original Obligor certifying that each copy document relating to it specified in this paragraph 2 of Part A of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the Signing Date.

 

  (h)

A certificate of good standing of the Company as issued by the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands and dated within thirty (30) days of the date of this Agreement.

 

  (i)

A certified copy of the updated register of mortgages and charges of the Company, updated to reflect any Security granted by the Company pursuant to the Finance Documents.

 

3.

Legal Opinions

 

  (a)

A legal opinion of the following legal advisers to the Arrangers, as to the enforceability of the Finance Documents:

 

  (i)

Clifford Chance LLP as to the law of England & Wales;

 

  (ii)

Clifford Chance LLP as to New York law;

 

  (iii)

Clifford Chance Pte. Ltd. as to Singaporean law;

 

  (iv)

Clifford Chance Deutschland LLP as to German law,

each in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Original Lenders.

 

  (b)

A legal opinion of the following legal advisers to the Company and the Original Guarantors:

 

  (i)

Shearman & Sterling LLP as to German law;

 

  (ii)

Maples and Calder as to Cayman Islands law;

 

  (iii)

Dentons Rodyk & Davidson LLP as to Singaporean law;

 

  (iv)

Hogan Lovells International LLP as to Dutch law; and

 

  (v)

Richards, Layton & Finger, P.A. as to Delaware law,

each in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Original Lenders.

 

4.

Other documents and evidence

 

  (a)

Evidence that the Existing BAML Facility and the Existing Citibank Facility have each been repaid and cancelled in full.

 

  (b)

Evidence that any process agent referred to in Clause 50.4 (Service of Process) has accepted its appointment.

 

148


  (c)

Copies of (A) the audited and consolidated financial statements and unaudited consolidating income statement and balance sheet for the financial year ended 31 December 2018 for the Company; (B) the unaudited and consolidated financial statements and unaudited consolidating income statement and balance sheet for the quarter ended 30 June 2019 for the Company and (C) the audited and consolidated financial statements for the financial year ended 31 December 2018 for GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd..

 

  (d)

A certificate substantially in the form of Schedule 9 (Form of Compliance Certificate) confirming compliance with Clause 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) and the financial covenants, in each case, as of 30 June 2019.

 

5.

Fees, Costs and Expenses

Evidence that the fees, costs and expenses then due from the Company pursuant to Clause 17 (Fees) have been paid or will be paid by or on the date of Financial Close in form and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent or the Facility Agent has waived the requirement of receipt of such evidence.

 

6.

Ancillary Collateral Trust Agreement Documentation

 

  (a)

The Reaffirmation Agreement.

 

  (b)

An additional secured debt designation in respect of the Collateral Trust Agreement executed by the Company.

 

149


Part B

Conditions Precedent required to be delivered by an Additional Guarantor

 

1.

An Accession Deed, duly executed by the Additional Guarantor and the Company.

 

2.

A copy of the constitutional documents of the Additional Guarantor. (including for any German Additional Guarantor (i) an up-to-date electronic chronological commercial register extract (elektronischer chronologischer Handelsregisterausdruck), its articles of association (Satzung) or partnership agreement (Gesellschaftsvertrag), as applicable, as well as copies of any by-laws and (iii) if applicable, its list of shareholders and including, in the case of a German Additional Guarantor in the form a partnership with limited liability (Kommanditgesellschaft), the constitutional documents of its general partner).

 

3.

A copy of a good standing certificate with respect to each Additional Guarantor whose jurisdiction of organization is a state of the U.S. or the District of Columbia, issued as of a recent date by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of such Additional Guarantor’s jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation

 

4.

A copy of a resolution of the board of directors or similar managing body of the Additional Guarantor (other than in respect of a German Additional Guarantor):

 

  (a)

approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Accession Deed and the Finance Documents and resolving that it execute the Accession Deed;

 

  (b)

authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Accession Deed on its behalf; and

 

  (c)

authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all other documents and notices to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Finance Documents.

 

5.

A specimen of the signature of person(s) authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph 4 above or otherwise.

 

6.

If required, a copy of a resolution of the holders of the issued shares and/ or interest of the Additional Guarantor (and/or, if applicable, by the supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) and/or advisory board (Beirat) of such German Additional Guarantor), approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents to which the Additional Guarantor is a party.

 

7.

A certificate of the Additional Guarantor (other than in respect of a German Additional Guarantor) (signed by a director or chief financial officer) confirming that guaranteeing the Total Commitments would not cause any guaranteeing or similar limit binding on it to be exceeded.

 

8.

A certificate of an Authorised Officer of the Additional Guarantor certifying that each copy document listed in this Part B of Schedule 2 is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Accession Deed.

 

9.

If available in the English language, the latest annual audited Financial Statements of the Additional Guarantor.

 

10.

A legal opinion of the legal advisers to the Facility Agent in England.

 

11.

If the Additional Guarantor is incorporated or formed in a jurisdiction other than England and Wales, a legal opinion of the legal advisers to the Facility Agent (or, if consistent with market practice, the legal advisers to the Obligors) in the jurisdiction in which the Additional Guarantor is incorporated.

 

150


12.

If the proposed Additional Guarantor is incorporated in a jurisdiction other than England and Wales, evidence that the process agent specified in Clause 50.4 (Service of Process) has accepted its appointment in relation to the proposed Additional Guarantor.

 

151


SCHEDULE 3

REQUESTS AND NOTICES

Part A

Utilisation Request

Loans

From: GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. (as the “Company”)

To: [•] as Facility Agent

Dated: [•]

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Utilisation Request. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Utilisation Request unless given a different meaning in this Utilisation Request.

 

2.

We wish to borrow an Loan on the following terms:

 

Proposed Utilisation Date:    [●] (or, if that is not a Business Day under this Agreement, the next Business Day under this Agreement)
Facility:    Revolving Facility
Borrower:    [Company] / [Approved Borrower]
Currency of Loan    [Dollars] / [Euros]
Total Amount:    [●] or, if less, the Available Facility
Interest Period:    [●]

 

3.

We confirm that each condition specified in Clause 4.2 (Further conditions precedent) of the Facilities Agreement is satisfied on the date of this Utilisation Request.

 

4.

The proceeds of this Loan should be credited to [insert account details for the relevant account].

 

5.

This Utilisation Request is irrevocable.

 

Yours faithfully
 

 

authorised signatory for
GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

152


Part B

Utilisation Request

Letters of Credit

From: [Borrower]/[Company]*

To: [•] as Facility Agent

Dated:

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Utilisation Request. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Utilisation Request unless given a different meaning in this Utilisation Request.

 

2.

We wish to arrange for a Letter of Credit to be issued by the Issuing Bank specified below (which has agreed to do so) on the following terms:

 

(a)    Borrower:    [Company] / [•]1
(b)    Issuing Bank:    [•]
(c)    Proposed Utilisation Date:    [•] (or, if that is not a Business Day, the next Business Day)
(d)    Facility to be utilised:    [Revolving Facility / Additional L/C Facility]
(e)    Currency of Letter of Credit:    [•]
(f)    Amount:    [•] or, if less, the Available Facility in relation to the [Revolving Facility / Additional L/C Facility]
(g)    Beneficiary:    [•]
(h)    Term:    [•]
(i)    Expiry Date:    [•]

 

3.

We confirm that each condition specified in paragraph (b) of Clause 6.5 (Issue of Letters of Credit) of the Facilities Agreement is satisfied on the date of this Utilisation Request.

 

4.

We attach a copy of the proposed Letter of Credit.

 

5.

The purpose of this proposed Letter of Credit is [].

 

6.

This Utilisation Request is irrevocable.

 

1 

This may be the Company, GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc. (for an L/C to be issued under the Additional L/C Facility only) or shall otherwise be an Approved Borrower.

 

153


7.

[Specify delivery instructions].

 

154


Yours faithfully
 

 

authorised signatory for
[Borrower] / [Company]

NOTES:

 

*

Amend as appropriate. The Utilisation Request can be given by the Borrower or by the Company.

 

155


SCHEDULE 4

SPECIFIED TIMES

PART I

Loans

 

     Loans in USD    Loans in EUR    Loans in other currencies
Facility Agent notifies the Company if a currency is approved as an Optional Currency in accordance with Clause 4.3 (Conditions relating to Optional Currencies).          U-4 as soon as possible
Delivery of a duly completed Utilisation Request in accordance with Clause 5.1 (Delivery of a Utilisation Request).   

U-3

 

10:00am London time

  

U-3

 

10:00am London time

  

U-3

 

10:00am London time

Facility Agent notifies the relevant Lenders of the Loan in accordance with paragraph (e) of Clause 5.4 (Lenders’ Participation).    U-3 as soon as possible    U-3 as soon as possible    U-3 as soon as possible
LIBOR or EURIBOR is fixed.    Quotation Day as of 11:00am London time    Quotation Day as of 11:00am Brussels time in respect of EURIBOR    Quotation Day as of 11:00am London time
Reference Bank Rate calculated by reference to available quotations in accordance with Clause 16.2 (Calculation of Reference Bank Rate).    Quotation Day as soon as possible    Quotation Day as soon as possible    Quotation Day as soon as possible

 

“U” =    date of utilisation or, if applicable, in the case of a Loan that has already been borrowed, the first day of the relevant Interest Period for that Loan.
“U – X” =    X Business Days prior to the proposed date of utilisation or, if applicable, in the case of a Loan that has already been borrowed, the first day of the relevant Interest Period for that Loan.

 

156


PART II

Letters of Credit

 

     Letters of Credit
Delivery of a duly completed Utilisation Request (Clause 6.2 (Delivery of a Utilisation Request for Letters of Credit))   

U-3

 

10:00am London time

Facility Agent determines (in relation to a Utilisation) the Base Currency Amount of the Letter of Credit if required under paragraph (d) of Clause 6.5 (Issue of Letters of Credit) and notifies the relevant Issuing Bank and Lenders of the Letter of Credit in accordance with paragraph (d) of Clause 6.5 (Issue of Letters of Credit).   

U-3

 

12:00pm London time

Delivery of duly completed Renewal Request (Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit))   

U-3

 

10:00am London time

 

“U” =    date of utilisation, or, if applicable, in the case of a Letter of Credit to be renewed in accordance with Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit), the first day of the proposed term of the renewed Letter of Credit
“U-X” =    Business Days prior to date of utilisation or, if applicable, in the case of a Letter of Credit to be renewed in accordance with Clause 6.6 (Renewal of a Letter of Credit), the first day of the proposed term of the renewed Letter of Credit

 

157


SCHEDULE 5

FORM OF TRANSFER CERTIFICATE

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

[The Existing Lender] (the “Existing Lender”) and [The New Lender] (the “New Lender”)

Dated:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Transfer Certificate. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Transfer Certificate unless given a different meaning in this Transfer Certificate.

 

2.

We refer to Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) of the Facilities Agreement:

 

  (a)

The Existing Lender and the New Lender agree to the Existing Lender transferring to the New Lender by novation all or part of the Existing Lender’s Commitment, rights and obligations referred to in the Schedule in accordance with Clause 29.6 (Procedure for transfer) of the Facilities Agreement.

 

  (b)

The proposed Transfer Date is [•].

 

  (c)

The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 38.2 (Addresses) of the Facilities Agreement are set out in the Schedule.

 

3.

The New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender’s obligations set out in paragraph (c) of Clause 29.5 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders) of the Facilities Agreement.

 

4.

The New Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is:

 

  (a)

in respect of a Lender to a Singapore Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a Singapore Qualifying Lender (other than a Singapore Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a Singapore Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not a Singapore Qualifying Lender];

 

  (b)

in respect of a Lender to a US Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a US Qualifying Lender];

 

  (ii)

[not a US Qualifying Lender];

 

  (c)

in respect of a Lender to a German Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a German Treaty Lender];

 

158


  (iii)

[not a German Qualifying Lender];

 

  (d)

in respect of a Lender to an Other Borrower:

 

  (i)

[an Other Qualifying Lender (other than an Other Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[an Other Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not an Other Qualifying Lender].2

 

5.

The New Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a Sponsor Affiliate.

 

6.

The New Lender expressly confirms that it [can/cannot] exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of Clause 32.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent).

 

7.

[The New Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender.]

 

8.

[The New Lender confirms that it is not a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor or an Industry Competitor.]

 

9.

This Transfer Certificate may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Transfer Certificate.

 

10.

This Transfer Certificate and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

11.

This Transfer Certificate has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this transfer Certificate.

 

 

2 

Delete as applicable—each New Lender is required to confirm which of these eight categories it falls within.

 

159


THE SCHEDULE

Commitment/rights and obligations to be transferred

[insert relevant details]

[Facility office address, fax number and attention details for notices and account details for payments]

 

[Existing Lender]    [New Lender]   
By:    By:   

This Transfer Certificate is accepted as a Transfer Certificate for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement by the Facility Agent and the Transfer Date is confirmed as [ ].

[Facility Agent]

By:

 

160


SCHEDULE 6

FORM OF ASSIGNMENT AGREEMENT

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent, and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. as Company, for and on behalf of each Obligor

 

From:

[The Existing Lender] (the “Existing Lender”) and [The New Lender] (the “New Lender”)

Dated:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is an Assignment Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Assignment Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Assignment Agreement.

 

2.

We refer to Clause 29.7 (Procedure for assignment) of the Facilities Agreement:

 

  (a)

The Existing Lender assigns absolutely to the New Lender all the rights of the Existing Lender under the Facilities Agreement and the other Finance Documents which relate to that portion of the Existing Lender’s Commitment(s) and participations in Loans under the Facilities Agreement as specified in the Schedule.

 

  (b)

The Existing Lender is released from all the obligations of the Existing Lender which correspond to that portion of the Existing Lender’s Commitment(s) and participations in Loans under the Facilities Agreement specified in the Schedule.

 

  (c)

The New Lender becomes a Party as a Lender and is bound by obligations equivalent to those from which the Existing Lender is released under paragraph (b) above.

 

3.

The proposed Transfer Date is [                ].

 

4.

On the Transfer Date the New Lender becomes Party to the relevant Finance Documents as a Lender.

 

5.

The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices of the New Lender for the purposes of Clause 38.2 (Addresses) of the Facilities Agreement are set out in the Schedule.

 

6.

The New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender’s obligations set out in paragraph (c) of Clause 29.5 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders) of the Facilities Agreement.

 

7.

The New Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is:

 

  (a)

in respect of a Lender to a Singapore Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a Singapore Qualifying Lender (other than a Singapore Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a Singapore Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not a Singapore Qualifying Lender];

 

  (b)

in respect of a Lender to a US Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a US Qualifying Lender];

 

161


  (ii)

[not a US Qualifying Lender];

 

  (c)

in respect of a Lender to a German Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a German Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not a German Qualifying Lender];

 

  (d)

in respect of a Lender to an Other Borrower:

 

  (i)

[an Other Qualifying Lender (other than an Other Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[an Other Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not an Other Qualifying Lender].3

 

8.

[The New Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a member of the Group/Sponsor Affiliate.]

 

9.

The New Lender expressly confirms that it [can/cannot] exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of Clause 32.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent).

 

10.

[The New Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender.]

 

11.

[The New Lender confirms that it is not a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor or an Industry Competitor.]

 

12.

This Assignment Agreement acts as notice to the Facility Agent (on behalf of each Finance Party) and, upon delivery in accordance with Clause 29.9 (Copy of Transfer Certificate, Assignment Agreement or Increase Confirmation to Company) of the Facilities Agreement, to the Company (on behalf of each Obligor) of the assignment referred to in this Assignment Agreement.

 

13.

This Assignment Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Assignment Agreement.

 

14.

This Assignment Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

15.

This Assignment Agreement has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Assignment Agreement.

 

 

3 

Delete as applicable—each New Lender is required to confirm which of these eight categories it falls within.

 

162


THE SCHEDULE

Rights to be assigned and obligations to be released and undertaken

[insert relevant details]

[Facility office address, fax number and attention details for notices and account details for payments]

 

[Existing Lender]    [New Lender]   
By:    By:   

This Assignment Agreement is accepted by the Facility Agent and the Transfer Date is confirmed as [ ].

Signature of this Assignment Agreement by the Facility Agent constitutes confirmation by each of them of receipt of notice of the assignment referred to herein, which notice the Facility Agent receives on behalf of each Finance Party.

[Facility Agent]

By:

 

163


SCHEDULE 7

FORM OF ACCESSION DEED

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

[Subsidiary] and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

Dated:

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This deed (the “Accession Deed”) shall take effect as a Accession Deed for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Accession Deed unless given a different meaning in this Accession Deed.

 

2.

[Subsidiary] agrees to become an Additional [Borrower / Guarantor] and to be bound by the terms of the Facilities Agreement as an Additional [Borrower / Guarantor] pursuant to [Clause 31.2 (Additional Borrowers) / Clause 31.4 (Additional Guarantors)] of the Facilities Agreement. [Subsidiary] is a company duly incorporated under the laws of [name of relevant jurisdiction] and is a [limited liability company/specify other entity] and registered number [•].

 

3.

[Subsidiary’s] administrative details for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement and the other Finance Documents are as follows:

Address:       [•]

Fax No.:       [•]

Attention:     [•]

 

4.

[Subsidiary] intends to give a guarantee, indemnity or other assurance against loss in respect of liabilities under the following document(s):

[Insert details (date, parties and description) of relevant documents]

the “Relevant Documents”.

 

5.

[Insert details of any applicable guarantee limitations required in accordance with Schedule 11 (Guarantee limitations in general)]

 

6.

As of the date of this Accession Deed, [Subsidiary] makes the representations set out under Clauses 1 (Status; Power), 2 (Legality; Validity and Enforceability), 3 (Authorisations), 4 (No Proceedings), 5 (Non-Conflict), 8 (Solvency), 10 (Sanctions), 11 (Applicable Laws), 12 (Choice of Law), 17 (Private and Commercial Purposes) and 18 (Pari Passu Ranking) of the Facilities Agreement in respect of itself.

 

7.

This Accession Deed and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

164


THIS ACCESSION DEED has been signed on behalf of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and executed as a deed by [Subsidiary] and is delivered on the date stated above.

 

[Subsidiary]      )
EXECUTED AS A DEED      )
By: [Subsidiary]     
       Director
       Director/Secretary
OR     
[Subsidiary]      )
EXECUTED AS A DEED      )
By: [Subsidiary]     
       Signature of Director
       Name of Director
in the presence of     
       Signature of Witness
       Name of Witness
       Address of Witness
      
      
       Occupation of Witness
OR     
[Subsidiary]      )
EXECUTED AS A DEED      )
By: [Subsidiary]     
       Signature of Authorised Signatory
       Name of Authorised Signatory
       [Signature of Authorised Signatory]
       [Name of Authorised Signatory]
GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.     
      
By:     

 

165


SCHEDULE 8

FORM OF RESIGNATION LETTER

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

[Resigning Guarantor] and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

Dated:

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Resignation Letter. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Resignation Letter unless given a different meaning in this Resignation Letter.

 

2.

Pursuant to [Clause 31.3 (Resignation of a Borrower) / Clause 31.5 (Resignation of a Guarantor)], we request that [resigning Obligor] be released from its obligations as a [Borrower / Guarantor] under the Facilities Agreement and the Finance Documents.

 

3.

We confirm that:

 

  (a)

no Default is continuing or would result from the acceptance of this request;

 

  (b)

no amount is currently due and payable and unpaid by [resigning Obligor]; and

 

  (c)

the aggregate EBITDA and Revenues of the Non-Obligors would not exceed twenty per cent. (20%) of the EBITDA and Revenues of the Adjusted Group, respectively, for the twelve calendar (12) month period ending on [specify test date] as a result of acceptance of this request (where the Revenues of the Adjusted Group means the Revenues of the Group calculated on a consolidated basis excluding the aggregate Revenues of the Excluded Guarantor Companies); and

 

  (d)

the aggregate Total Assets of the Non-Obligors would not exceed twenty per cent. (20%) of the Total Assets of the Adjusted Group on [specify test date] as a result of acceptance of this request (where the Total Assets of the Adjusted Group means the Total Assets of the Group calculated on a consolidated basis excluding the aggregate Total Assets of the Excluded Guarantor Companies).

 

4.

This Resignation Letter and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

   GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.    [Resigning Obligor]
   By:    By:

 

166


SCHEDULE 9

FORM OF COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

Dated:

Dear Sirs

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Compliance Certificate. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning when used in this Compliance Certificate unless given a different meaning in this Compliance Certificate.

 

2.

[We confirm that as at [specify test date], the Company is in compliance with the financial covenants set out in Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) of the Facilities Agreement and the Schedule hereto attaches calculations confirming this.]

 

3.

We confirm that:

 

  (a)

the aggregate EBITDA and Revenues of the Non-Obligors would not exceed twenty per cent. (20%) of the EBITDA and Revenues of the Adjusted Group, respectively, for the twelve (12) calendar month period ending on [specify test date] (where Revenues of the Adjusted Group means Revenues of the Group calculated on a consolidated basis excluding the aggregate Revenues of the Excluded Guarantor Companies); and

 

  (b)

the aggregate Total Assets of the Non-Obligors would not exceed twenty per cent. (20%) of the Total Assets of the Adjusted Group on [specify test date] (where the Total Assets of the Adjusted Group means the Total Assets of the Group calculated on a consolidated basis excluding the aggregate Total Assets of the Excluded Guarantor Companies).

 

4.

We confirm that the Group’s current Committed Debt Facilities are as follows:

 

    Ref.   

Committed Debt Facilities

  

Available and Undrawn Amounts as at

[specify test date]

         [•]    [•]
         [•]    [•]

 

Signed   

 

  
   Authorised Officer   
   of   
   GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.   

 

167


SCHEDULE 10

FORM OF LETTER OF CREDIT

To:    [Beneficiary] (the “Beneficiary”)

Date

Irrevocable Standby Letter of Credit no. [•]

At the request of [•], [Issuing Bank] (the “Issuing Bank”) issues this irrevocable standby Letter of Credit (“Letter of Credit”) in your favour on the following terms and conditions:

 

1.

Definitions

In this Letter of Credit:

Business Day” means a day (other than a Saturday or a Sunday) on which banks are open for general business in [London].*

Demand” means a demand for a payment under this Letter of Credit in the form of the schedule to this Letter of Credit.

Expiry Date” means [•].

Total L/C Amount” means [•].

 

2.

Issuing Bank’s agreement

 

  (a)

The Beneficiary may request a drawing or drawings under this Letter of Credit by giving to the Issuing Bank a duly completed Demand. A Demand must be received by the Issuing Bank by no later than [•] p.m. ([London] time) on the Expiry Date.

 

  (b)

Subject to the terms of this Letter of Credit, the Issuing Bank unconditionally and irrevocably undertakes to the Beneficiary that, within [ten (10)] Business Days of receipt by it of a Demand, it must pay to the Beneficiary the amount demanded in that Demand.

 

  (c)

The Issuing Bank will not be obliged to make a payment under this Letter of Credit if as a result the aggregate of all payments made by it under this Letter of Credit would exceed the Total L/C Amount.

 

3.

Expiry

 

  (a)

The Issuing Bank will be released from its obligations under this Letter of Credit on the date (if any) notified by the Beneficiary to the Issuing Bank as the date upon which the obligations of the Issuing Bank under this Letter of Credit are released.

 

  (b)

Unless previously released under paragraph (a) above, on [•] p.m.([London] time) on the Expiry Date the obligations of the Issuing Bank under this Letter of Credit will cease with no further liability on the part of the Issuing Bank except for any Demand validly presented under the Letter of Credit that remains unpaid.

 

  (c)

When the Issuing Bank is no longer under any further obligations under this Letter of Credit, the Beneficiary must return the original of this Letter of Credit to the Issuing Bank.

 

168


4.

Payments

All payments under this Letter of Credit shall be made in [] and for value on the due date to the account of the Beneficiary specified in the Demand.

 

5.

Delivery of Demand

Each Demand shall be in writing, and, unless otherwise stated, may be made by letter, fax or telex and must be received in legible form by the Issuing Bank at its address and by the particular department or office (if any) as follows:

[

]

 

6.

Assignment

The Beneficiary’s rights under this Letter of Credit may not be assigned or transferred.

 

7.

ISP 98

Except to the extent it is inconsistent with the express terms of this Letter of Credit, this Letter of Credit is subject to the International Standby Practices (ISP 98), International Chamber of Commerce Publication No. 590.

 

8.

Governing Law

This Letter of Credit and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it are governed by English law.

 

9.

Jurisdiction

The courts of England have exclusive jurisdiction to settle any dispute arising out of or in connection with this Letter of Credit (including a dispute relating to any non-contractual obligation arising out of or in connection with this Letter of Credit).

Yours faithfully

[Issuing Bank]

By:

NOTES:

 

*

This may need to be amended depending on the currency of payment under the Letter of Credit.

 

169


SCHEDULE

FORM OF DEMAND

To:    [ISSUING BANK]

[Date]

Dears Sirs

Standby Letter of Credit no. [•] issued in favour of [BENEFICIARY]

(the “Letter of Credit”)

We refer to the Letter of Credit. Terms defined in the Letter of Credit have the same meaning when used in this Demand.

 

1.

We certify that the sum of [•] is due [and has remained unpaid for at least [•] Business Days] [under [set out underlying contract or agreement]]. We therefore demand payment of the sum of [•].

 

2.

Payment should be made to the following account:

Name:

Account Number:

Bank:

 

3.

The date of this Demand is not later than the Expiry Date.

Yours faithfully

 

(Authorised Signatory)     (Authorised Signatory)
   

            For

[BENEFICIARY]

 

170


SCHEDULE 11

GUARANTEE LIMITATIONS IN GENERAL

In determining what guarantees will be provided in support of a Facility the following matters will be taken into account. Guarantees shall be limited to the extent that they would otherwise:

 

1.

result in any breach of general statutory limitations, capital maintenance, financial assistance, corporate benefit, fraudulent preference, “thin capitalisation” rules, retention of title claims, regulatory restrictions and similar principles;

 

2.

require any consent by law, statute, the terms of any applicable contract, instrument or constitutional document or otherwise from the minority shareholders in, or any relevant corporate body of, any member of the Group which is not wholly owned (directly or indirectly) by another member of the Group, provided that the relevant company and the Company have used reasonable endeavours to obtain such consent and it has not been obtained;

 

3.

result in a risk to the officers of the relevant grantor of a guarantee of contravention of any statutory duty in such capacity or their fiduciary duties and/or which could reasonably be expected to result in personal, civil or criminal liability on the part of any such director or officer;

 

4.

result in stamp duty, notarisation, registration or other applicable fees, taxes and duties that are disproportionate to the benefit of increasing the guaranteed amount and the maximum guaranteed amount shall be limited accordingly; or

 

5.

would have a material adverse effect (i) on the ability of the relevant member of the Group to conduct its operations and business in the ordinary course as otherwise permitted by this Agreement; or (ii) on the tax arrangements of the Group or any member of the Group, provided that, in each case, the relevant member of the Group shall use reasonable endeavours to overcome such obstacle. The guaranteed obligations will be limited where necessary to prevent any material additional tax liability of any member of the Group.

 

171


SCHEDULE 12

REPRESENTATIONS

 

1.

Status; Power

 

  (a)

It is duly organised, formed or incorporated and validly existing and, if applicable in the relevant jurisdiction, in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of formation or incorporation and has the power to conduct its business as currently conducted.

 

  (b)

It and each of its Subsidiaries has the power and authority and is duly authorised to enter into and comply with the Finance Documents to which it is a party.

 

2.

Legality, Validity and Enforceability

 

  (a)

Subject to the Legal Reservations, the obligations expressed to be assumed by it in each Finance Document to which it is a party are legal, valid, binding and enforceable obligations.

 

  (b)

The Finance Documents to which it is a party are admissible in evidence in its jurisdiction of incorporation.

 

3.

Authorisations

All authorisations required to enable the lawful entry into and compliance with the Finance Documents to which it is a party have been obtained or effected and are in full force and effect or will be obtained or effected and will be in full force and effect on the date such authorisations are required by the Finance Documents and/or as a matter of law.

 

4.

No Proceedings

No litigation, arbitration or administrative proceedings (to the best of its knowledge and belief) have been started or are pending or threatened against it which could reasonably be expected to be adversely determined and, if adversely determined, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

5.

Non-Conflict

The entry into and performance by it of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Finance Documents do not conflict with:

 

  (a)

in any material respect, its constitutional documents;

 

  (b)

in any material respect, any law, rule, regulation or order; or

 

  (c)

to the extent such conflict has a Material Adverse Effect, any agreements binding on it or any of its subsidiaries (which are Obligors) or any of its or their assets.

 

6.

No Default

No Default is continuing or will result from the entry into, or the performance of any transaction contemplated by, any Finance Document to which it is a party.

 

7.

Provision of Information

 

  (a)

To the best of is knowledge and belief after such enquiry as it considers prudent, the factual information contained in the Information Package was correct in all material respects as at the date on which the relevant information was provided.

 

172


  (b)

Subject to any subsequent disclosure, the Information Package did not omit to state any material fact and no information has been given or withheld that results in the information contained in the Information Package, taken as a whole, being untrue or misleading in any material respect.

 

8.

Solvency

On the Signing Date (or, in the case of an Additional Guarantor, but only in respect of such Additional Guarantor, on the date that it becomes an Additional Guarantor) no formal legal proceedings or other formal procedure or step as described in paragraph (b) of Clause 5 (Insolvency Events) of Schedule 16 (Events of Default) has been taken and is current (and has not been stayed or dismissed), other than such proceedings or steps that are frivolous or vexatious.

 

9.

Financial Statements

The most recent consolidated Financial Statements of the Company delivered in accordance herewith were prepared in accordance with Approved Accounting Principles, consistently applied, and fairly represent its consolidated financial position as at the end of, and consolidated results of operations for, the period to which they relate.

 

10.

Sanctions

Neither it nor, to its actual knowledge, any of its directors or officers are currently subject to any Sanctions.

 

11.

Applicable Laws

Without limiting Clause 14 (Corrupt Practices Laws) of Schedule 12 (Representations), it is in compliance in all material respects with all applicable laws.

 

12.

Choice of Law

Subject to any Legal Reservations, the choice of law under the Finance Documents is enforceable against it and foreign judgments rendered against it as a result of such choice of law would be recognised and enforceable in its jurisdiction of incorporation.

 

13.

Taxes

 

  (a)

To the best of its knowledge, it has filed or caused to be filed all Tax returns and Tax information returns that are required to have been filed by it in any jurisdiction and has paid in full all Taxes due and payable on such returns and all other Taxes payable by it, to the extent that such Taxes have become due and payable, except for filings and Taxes that are being contested by it in good faith;

 

  (b)

All required stamp duties, registration fees, filing costs and other charges in connection with the execution, delivery, filing, recording, perfection, priority and/or admissibility in evidence of any Finance Document payable as of the date that this representation is given have been paid in full or an appropriate exemption therefrom has been obtained and all such filings, recordings or other acts have been made or will be duly made within the required time periods for so doing; and

 

  (c)

 

  (i)

in respect of a payment made by the Company, no Tax Deduction is required to be made by the Company from any payment it may make to any Finance Party under any of the Finance Documents.

 

173


  (ii)

in respect of a payment made by a Borrower other than the Company, no Tax Deduction is required to be made by such Borrower from any payment it may make to any Finance Party under any of the Finance Documents which is a Qualifying Lender.

 

14.

Corrupt Practices Laws

Neither it nor, to its actual knowledge, any of its directors or officers, acting on its behalf, has used any corporate funds for any unlawful contribution, gift, entertainment or other unlawful expense relating to political activity; made any direct or indirect unlawful payment to any foreign or domestic government official or employee from corporate funds; or made any bribe, rebate, payoff, influence payment, kickback or other payment prohibited under any Corrupt Practices Laws applicable to it concerning such payments or gifts and it has instituted and maintains policies and procedures designed to prevent violations of applicable anti-bribery and corruption laws and regulations.

 

15.

Anti-Money Laundering

Its operations are and have been conducted at all times in compliance with the applicable financial record keeping and reporting requirements and anti-money laundering statutes in its jurisdiction of incorporation and in all other jurisdictions in which it conducts business (collectively “Anti-Money Laundering Laws”) and no action, suit or proceeding by or before any court or governmental agency, authority or body or any arbitration involving it with respect to Anti-Money Laundering Laws is pending and, to its knowledge, no such actions, suits or proceedings are threatened or contemplated.

 

16.

Immunity

Subject to the Legal Reservations, neither it nor its respective assets has any, or is entitled to claim or assert any, right of immunity on the grounds of sovereignty or otherwise from jurisdiction of any court, suit, set-off, legal proceedings generally, attachment before judgment, attachment in aid of execution or other attachment or execution of judgment under the applicable laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation or any other jurisdiction in which its assets are located in connection with any action to enforce any Finance Document.

 

17.

Private and Commercial Purposes

The execution, delivery and performance by it of each Finance Document to which it is a party are private and commercial acts performed for private and commercial purposes.

 

18.

Pari Passu Ranking

Its payment obligations under the Finance Documents rank at least pari passu in right of payment with all its other unsecured and unsubordinated creditors (subject to applicable law).

 

19.

Projections

Each of the financial and operating projections provided to any of the Finance Parties by or on behalf of the Company and contained in the Information Package:

 

  (a)

was prepared with due care and in good faith;

 

  (b)

represents a good faith, reasonable estimate as of the date such projection was provided, based on reasonable assumptions (where such assumptions are not stated to have been provided by a third party) as to all matters affecting the estimates therein; and

 

  (c)

was prepared on a basis substantially consistent with its Financial Statements.

 

174


20.

Pension Liabilities

The Company and each other Obligor maintains and funds its pension schemes (if any) in accordance with all applicable laws in all material respects where failure to do so has or would reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

21.

Times When Representations Made

 

  (a)

All the representations in this Schedule 12 are made by the Company in respect of itself and each other Obligor on the Signing Date to the Finance Parties.

 

  (b)

The Repeating Representations are deemed to be made by (i) the Company on each Utilisation Date under this Agreement in respect of itself and, where applicable, in respect of each other Obligor to the Finance Parties and (ii) each other Obligor on each Utilisation Date under this Agreement in respect of itself to the Finance Parties.

 

  (c)

The Repeating Representations are deemed to be made by the Company on the last day of each Interest Period under this Agreement in respect of itself and, where applicable, in respect of each other Obligor to the Finance Parties.

 

  (d)

If a member of the Group becomes an Additional Obligor after the Signing Date, the representations set out under Clauses 1 (Status; Power) to 5 (Non Conflict) (inclusive), 8 (Solvency), 10 (Sanctions) to 12 (Choice of Law) (inclusive), 17 (Private and Commercial Purposes) and 18 (Pari Passu Ranking) will be made by the Company in respect of such Additional Obligor and by such Additional Obligor on the day on which it becomes (or it is proposed that it becomes) an Additional Obligor.

 

  (e)

The representations set out in Clause 9 (Financial Statements) are deemed given in respect of the most recent consolidated Financial Statements of the Company delivered in accordance with this Agreement on the date of such delivery.

 

  (f)

Each representation deemed to be made after the Signing Date shall be deemed to be made by reference to the facts and circumstances existing at the date the representation is deemed to be made.

 

175


SCHEDULE 13

INFORMATION COVENANTS

 

1.

Financial Statements

 

  (a)

The Company shall provide to the Facility Agent (with sufficient copies for each Lender):

 

  (i)

as soon as they are available, but in any event, within one hundred and twenty (120) calendar days after the end of each of its Financial Years, the audited and consolidated Financial Statements and unaudited consolidating income statement and balance sheet for that Financial Year for the Company; and

 

  (ii)

as soon as they are available, but in any event, within ninety (90) calendar days after the end of each of the first three quarters of each of its Financial Years, unaudited and consolidated Financial Statements and unaudited consolidating income statement and balance sheet for that quarter for the Company.

 

2.

Compliance Certificate

 

  (a)

The Company shall provide the Facility Agent (with sufficient copies for each Lender), together with:

 

  (i)

the most recent Financial Statements delivered pursuant to (a)(i) of Clause 1 (Financial Statements) above; and

 

  (ii)

Financial Statements in respect of the second quarter of its Financial Year delivered pursuant to (a)(ii) of Clause 1 (Financial Statements) above,

a Compliance Certificate setting out (in reasonable detail) computations as to compliance with Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants) and Clause 7 (Guarantor Coverage) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) with respect to the relevant Calculation Date and the Calculation Period ending on such date.

 

  (b)

Each Compliance Certificate shall be signed by an Authorised Officer of the Company.

 

3.

Information; Miscellaneous

The Company shall supply to the Facility Agent (with sufficient copies for each Lender):

 

  (a)

all material documents required by applicable law or regulation to be dispatched by the Company to its creditors generally at the same time as they are dispatched;

 

  (b)

promptly upon becoming aware of them, the details of any litigation, arbitration or administrative proceedings which are current, threatened in writing or pending against any member of the Group, and which could reasonably be expected to be adversely determined and, if adversely determined, could reasonably be expected to have a Material Adverse Effect; and

 

  (c)

promptly on request, such further information regarding the financial condition, business and operations of any member of the Group as any Finance Party (through the Facility Agent) may reasonably request.

 

176


4.

Notification of Default

 

  (a)

The Company shall notify the Facility Agent of any Default (and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it) promptly (and in any event within fourteen (14) calendar days) upon becoming aware of its occurrence.

 

  (b)

Promptly upon a request by the Facility Agent, the Company shall provide to the Facility Agent a certificate signed by an Authorised Officer of the Company on its behalf certifying that no Default is continuing (or if a Default is continuing, specifying the Default and the steps, if any, being taken to remedy it).

 

5.

Know your customer” checks

 

  (a)

If:

 

  (i)

the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) any law or regulation made after the Signing Date;

 

  (ii)

any change in the status of an Obligor or the composition of its shareholders after the Signing Date; or

 

  (iii)

a proposed assignment or transfer pursuant to this Agreement by a Lender or the Facility Agent of any of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a party that is not a Lender prior to such assignment or transfer,

obliges the Facility Agent or any Lender (or, in the case of sub-paragraph (iii) above, any prospective new Lender) to comply with “know your customer” or similar identification procedures in circumstances where the necessary information is not already available to it, each Obligor shall promptly upon the request of the Facility Agent or any Lender supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Facility Agent (for itself or on behalf of any Lender) or any Lender (for itself or, in the case of the event described in sub-paragraph (iii) above, on behalf of any prospective new Lender) in order for the Facility Agent, such Lender or, in the case of the event described in sub-paragraph (iii) above, any prospective new Lender to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

Each Lender shall promptly upon the request of the Facility Agent supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Facility Agent (for itself) in order for the Facility Agent to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.

 

  (c)

The Company shall, by not less than ten (10) Business Days’ prior written notice to the Facility Agent, notify the Facility Agent (which shall promptly notify the Lenders) of its intention to request that one of its Subsidiaries becomes an Additional Guarantor pursuant to Clause 31.4 (Additional Guarantors).

 

  (d)

Following the giving of any notice pursuant to paragraph (iii) above, if the accession of such Additional Guarantor obliges the Facility Agent or any Lender to comply with “know your customer” or similar identification procedures in circumstances where the necessary information is not already available to it, the Company shall promptly upon the request of the Facility Agent or any Lender supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Facility Agent (for itself or on behalf of any Lender) or any Lender (for itself or on behalf of any prospective new Lender) in order for the Facility Agent or such Lender or any prospective new Lender to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary “know your customer” or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the accession of such Subsidiary to this Agreement as an Additional Guarantor.

 

177


6.

Financial Covenants

 

  (a)

On each Calculation Date:

 

  (i)

the Debt Service Coverage Ratio shall be at least 1.1:1.0; and

 

  (ii)

the Obligors hold at least US$350,000,000 (less the aggregate of available and undrawn amounts under any Committed Debt Facilities) in Cash or Cash Equivalent Investments.

 

  (b)

The covenants contained in this Clause 6 will be tested semi-annually by reference to the consolidated Financial Statements of the Company for the relevant Calculation Period with such adjustments as are necessary to determine the consolidated position of the Adjusted Group from such consolidated Financial Statements, unless the annual Financial Statements of the Company for all of the relevant period are available, in which case those annual consolidated Financial Statements shall be used instead.

 

  (c)

The components of each definition used in this Clause 6 will be calculated in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles.

 

7.

Change of Financial Year

The Company shall not change its financial year end (other than due to it being a 52-week financial year or moving to a calendar year basis).

 

8.

Acquisition, Merger or Reorganisation

The Company shall provide the Facility Agent with not less than thirty (30) calendar days prior notice (or, if shorter, such period of notice (if any) as the Company shall determine shall be the maximum notice that can be given without breaching legal, regulatory or confidentiality restrictions applicable to the relevant transaction) of the consummation of any material proposed acquisition, merger or Reorganisation (other than a transaction between Obligors, between Non-Obligors or between Obligors and Non-Obligors where the resulting entity or entities are each an Obligor), together with sufficient information (subject to applicable confidentiality requirements) regarding the proposed terms thereof to allow the Facility Agent to determine (acting reasonably) compliance with this Agreement.

 

178


SCHEDULE 14

AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS

 

1.

Maintenance of Existence

Save in accordance with any transaction permitted under Clause 3 (Merger) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants), each Obligor shall at all times preserve and maintain:

 

  (a)

its legal existence under applicable laws of the jurisdiction in which it is incorporated; and

 

  (b)

its qualifications to do business in full force and effect in the jurisdiction in which it is incorporated or in which the transaction of its business as conducted or proposed to be conducted makes such qualification necessary.

 

2.

Authorisations

Each Obligor shall promptly obtain, comply with in all material respects and do all that is necessary to maintain in full force and effect any authorisation required under any applicable law or regulation to enable it to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents and to ensure the legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility in evidence in its jurisdiction of incorporation of any Finance Document.

 

3.

Compliance with Laws

Each Obligor shall comply with all applicable laws to which it may be subject if failure to so comply would have or would be reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

4.

Books, Records and Inspections; Accounting and Audit Matters

 

  (a)

The Company shall maintain adequate management information and cost control systems and shall keep proper books of record and account adequate to reflect fairly the financial condition and results of its operations and shall implement and maintain all internal management and accounting practices and controls necessary to ensure compliance with and to Corrupt Practices Laws.

 

  (b)

The Company shall maintain copies of the books of records and accounts of each other Obligor at its offices and, subject to applicable safety procedures, upon reasonable notice at reasonable times and on no more than one occasion per year, unless an Event of Default is continuing (in which case, on any number of occurrences), shall give access to (or procure access to) any Finance Party (and any of its officers and designated representatives) to its property and its books of records and accounts and documents and such copies of the books of records and accounts of each other Obligor.

 

  (c)

Each Obligor shall, subject to applicable safety procedures, upon reasonable notice and at reasonable times, if a Default or Event of Default is continuing, give access to any Finance Party (and any of its officers and designated representatives) to its books of records and accounts and documents to the extent reasonably considered relevant in the context of such Default or Event of Default.

 

5.

Taxes

Each Obligor shall ensure payment of all Taxes when due, except where the payment of such Taxes is being contested in good faith by the Obligor with appropriate reserves established in accordance with the Approved Accounting Principles and where such contest does not and could not reasonably be expected to result in a Material Adverse Effect.

 

179


6.

Proper Legal Form

Each Obligor shall take all action within its control required to ensure that each Finance Document to which it is a party:

 

  (a)

is in proper legal form under applicable laws of the jurisdiction in which it is incorporated and (if different) of the jurisdiction by which it is governed; and

 

  (b)

(subject to the guarantee limitations in the case of the Obligors) is capable of enforcement in its jurisdiction of incorporation and such other jurisdiction (if applicable) without further action on the part of any Finance Party.

 

7.

Guarantor Coverage

The Company shall ensure that the aggregate EBITDA, Revenues and Total Assets of the Non-Obligors does not exceed twenty per cent. (20%) of the EBITDA, Revenues and Total Assets of the Adjusted Group, respectively, where the Revenues and Total Assets of the Adjusted Group means the Revenues and Total Assets of the Group calculated on a consolidated basis excluding the aggregate Revenues and Total Assets of the Excluded Guarantor Companies.

 

8.

Insurance

The Company shall procure that the members of the Group shall obtain and maintain insurance in respect of their business and assets, from financially sound and reputable insurers and in amounts and with coverages, deductibles and indemnities that are, in each case, consistent with Prudent Industry Practice.

 

9.

Rights to Property

One or more members of the Group has and shall maintain such other rights to use the assets necessary to carry on the Group’s business as it is currently being conducted and as conducted from time to time.

 

10.

Pari Passu Ranking

Each Obligor shall take all actions necessary to ensure that its payment obligations under the Finance Documents rank at least pari passu in right of payment with the claims of all its other unsecured and unsubordinated creditors (subject to applicable law).

 

11.

Sanctions

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, each Borrower shall ensure that proceeds of the Facilities made available to it will not directly nor indirectly be lent, contributed or otherwise made available to any person (whether or not related to such Borrower):

 

  (i)

for the purpose of financing the activity of any person currently subject to Sanctions;

 

  (ii)

for the benefit of any country currently subject to Sanctions; or

 

  (iii)

for the benefit of any person in any country currently subject to Sanctions,

in a manner that would result in a violation of Sanctions applicable to such Borrower.

 

  (b)

The covenants in paragraph (a) above shall (A) be made by a EU Obligor or (B) apply for the benefit of a Restricted Lender only to the extent that giving, complying with or having the benefit of, as applicable, such covenants and undertakings would not result in any violation of, conflict with or liability under the EU Blocking Regulation.

 

180


SCHEDULE 15

NEGATIVE COVENANTS

The Company shall procure that:

 

1.

Negative Pledge

 

  (a)

Except for Permitted Security, no member of the Group shall create or permit to subsist any Security securing Financial Indebtedness over any of its assets.

 

  (b)

Except for Permitted Security, no member of the Group shall:

 

  (i)

sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its assets on terms whereby they are or may be leased to or re-acquired by any member of the Group;

 

  (ii)

sell, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its receivables on recourse terms;

 

  (iii)

enter into any arrangement under which money or the benefit of a bank or other account may be applied, set-off or made subject to a combination of accounts; or

 

  (iv)

enter into any other preferential arrangement having a similar effect,

in circumstances where the arrangement or transaction is entered into primarily as a method of raising Financial Indebtedness or of financing the acquisition of an asset, each such arrangement being “Quasi-Security”.

 

2.

Disposals

No member of the Group shall sell, lease, license, transfer or otherwise dispose of any asset (each, a “disposition”) other than Permitted Disposals.

 

3.

Merger

No member of the Adjusted Group shall enter into any amalgamation, demerger, merger or Reorganisation other than:

 

  (a)

under an intra-Adjusted Group amalgamation, demerger, merger or Reorganisation on a solvent basis not involving an Obligor or, if it involves an Obligor, where paragraph (b) below is satisfied in relation to such Obligor;

 

  (b)

in the case of an Obligor, where the Obligor is the surviving entity and such transaction does not adversely affect the ability of that Obligor to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents, the validity and enforceability of the Finance Documents against that Obligor or any right or remedy of the Finance Parties in respect of the Finance Documents;

 

  (c)

in the case of a Guarantor, where the Guarantor is not the surviving entity, but where the surviving entity becomes a Guarantor within thirty (30) calendar days of the consummation of such transaction and where such event and accession does not materially adversely affect the ability of such Guarantor to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents;

 

  (d)

where it involves either (A) only Non-Obligors and would be either a permitted disposal under Clause 2 (Disposals) above or a permitted investment of the type described in paragraph (b) of the definition of “Permitted Investment” or (B) an Obligor and would be a permitted disposal under Clause 2 (Disposals) above; or

 

  (e)

any other transaction approved by the Facility Agent.

 

181


4.

Immunity

In any proceedings, no Obligor shall claim or assert for itself or any of its material assets any immunity (including claims of sovereign immunity) as against any Finance Party from suit, execution, attachment or other legal process, whether through service of notice, attachment prior to judgment, attachment in aid of execution, execution or otherwise.

 

5.

Financial Indebtedness

 

  (a)

Subject to paragraph (b) below, no member of the Adjusted Group shall incur any Financial Indebtedness, except to the extent that, on the date of the incurrence of any Financial Indebtedness (taking into account the incurrence of such Financial Indebtedness) the Leverage Ratio and Projected Leverage Ratio are not greater than forty per cent. (40%).

 

  (b)

The incurrence of Financial Indebtedness described at paragraphs (b), (g) (but only to the extent Cash belonging to an Obligor is pooled with that of any other member of the Adjusted Group), (i), (l), or (m) of the definition of “Permitted Indebtedness” shall not require compliance with, or be included in the calculation of, the Leverage Ratio or Projected Leverage Ratio.

 

6.

Acquisitions; Investments

No member of the Adjusted Group shall acquire assets or make any investments on or after the Signing Date outside of the ordinary course of its business (it being understood that acquisitions or investments consisting of strategic acquisitions, joint ventures or partnerships, in each case related to the acquiror’s or investor’s business shall be deemed to be within the ordinary course of the acquiror’s or investor’s business) other than any Permitted Investment.

 

7.

Distribution

The Company shall not pay any Distribution unless, on the date of such Distribution:

 

  (a)

after giving effect to such Distribution, the Obligors would hold at least US$350,000,000 (less the aggregate of available and undrawn amounts under any Committed Debt Facilities) in Cash or Cash Equivalent Investments;

 

  (b)

the Debt Service Coverage Ratio as at the most recent Calculation Date was at least 1.3:1.0;

 

  (c)

no Default has occurred and is continuing (or would occur as a result of such Distribution); and

 

  (d)

such Distribution is made in compliance with applicable law.

 

8.

Corporate Documents; Capital Structure

 

  (a)

No Obligor shall amend or modify its constitutional documents or modify its legal form, except for any amendment or modification:

 

  (i)

in connection with any transaction permitted Clause 3 (Merger) of this Schedule; or

 

  (ii)

that does not materially and adversely affect the rights of the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents.

 

  (b)

Each Obligor shall promptly provide the Facility Agent with written notice of any change of its name or principal place of business.

 

182


9.

Nature of Business

No material change shall be made to the general nature of the business of the Company or the Group from that carried on at the Signing Date.

 

183


SCHEDULE 16

EVENTS OF DEFAULT

The Company shall procure that:

 

1.

Non-Payment

 

  (a)

Either Borrower or the Company does not pay on the due date any amount of principal, interest or Fees payable under the Finance Documents (unless its failure to pay is caused by administrative or technical error or a Disruption Event and payment is made within three (3) Business Days of its due date).

 

  (b)

Either Borrower or the Company does not pay any amount (other than principal, interest or Fees) payable to the Finance Parties under the Finance Documents within ten (10) Business Days after becoming due.

 

2.

Breach of Other Obligations

 

  (a)

An Obligor fails to comply with any obligation set out in Clause 6 (Financial Covenants) of Schedule 13 (Information Covenants), Clauses 1 (Maintenance of Existence) and 3 (Compliance with Laws) (to the extent relating to any Sanctions, anti-bribery or anti-money laundering laws) of Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) and 7 (Distribution) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) hereto.

 

  (b)

An Obligor fails to comply with any obligation set out in Schedule 13 (Information Covenants), Schedule 14 (Affirmative Covenants) and Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants) hereto (other than those referred to in Clause 1 (Non-Payment) and paragraph (a) above) which is not remedied within thirty (30) calendar days after the earlier of:

 

  (i)

the date on which the Company becomes, or reasonably should have been, aware thereof; and

 

  (ii)

the date on which the Company receives written notice thereof from the Facility Agent.

 

  (c)

An Obligor fails to comply with any provision of the Finance Documents (other than those referred to in Clause 1 (Non-Payment) or paragraphs (a) and (b) above) which is not remedied within forty-five (45) calendar days after the earlier of:

 

  (i)

the date on which the Company becomes, or reasonably should have been, aware thereof; and

 

  (ii)

the date on which the Company receives written notice thereof from the Facility Agent.

 

  (d)

A Subordinated Creditor fails to comply with any provision of the Subordination Deed which is not remedied within forty-five (45) calendar days after the earlier of:

 

  (i)

the date on which such Subordinated Creditor becomes, or reasonably should have been, aware thereof; and

 

  (ii)

the date on which Subordinated Creditor receives written notice thereof from the Facility Agent.

 

184


3.

Misrepresentation

Any representation made (or deemed to be made in accordance with Clause 21 (Times When Representations Made) of Schedule 12 (Representations)) by an Obligor under this Agreement is false or misleading in any material respect when made or repeated and, if the condition that renders such representation false or misleading is capable of being rectified, such condition is not rectified for a period of thirty (30) calendar days after the earlier of:

 

  (a)

the date the Company or, as applicable, the relevant Obligor, became aware, or reasonably should have become aware, of such misrepresentation; and

 

  (b)

the date on which the Facility Agent gives notice thereof to the relevant Obligor.

 

4.

Cross-default

Any Financial Indebtedness of a member of the Adjusted Group (other than Financial Indebtedness under the Finance Documents or the Shareholder Loans) in excess of:

 

  (a)

US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) is not paid when due (or after giving effect to any applicable grace period); or

 

  (b)

US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) is declared to be due and payable prior to its specified maturity as a result of an event of default (howsoever described).

 

5.

Insolvency Events

 

  (a)

An Obligor is unable or admits inability to pay its debts as they fall due or a Borrower incorporated in Germany is overindebted within the meaning of section 19 of the German Insolvency Code (Insolvenzordnung).

 

  (b)

Any formal legal proceedings or other formal procedure or step (or any analogous procedure or step is taken in any jurisdiction) is taken in relation to:

 

  (i)

the suspension of payments, a moratorium of any indebtedness, winding-up, dissolution, administration, judicial management or Reorganisation of any Obligor;

 

  (ii)

a composition, compromise, assignment or similar arrangement with any creditor of any Obligor (excluding the Finance Parties in their capacity as such under, and acting in accordance with this Agreement); or

 

  (iii)

the appointment of a liquidator, receiver, administrative receiver, administrator, compulsory manager, judicial manager or other similar officer in respect of any Obligor or its assets,

and, in each case, in the event such procedure or step is initiated by any person other than an Obligor, such procedure or step is not stayed or dismissed within sixty (60) calendar days of commencement, provided that this shall not include an event arising as a consequence of a transaction permitted under paragraph (b) of Clause 3 (Merger) of Schedule 15 (Negative Covenants).

 

  (c)

The occurrence of any creditors’ process affecting material assets of any Obligor which is not discharged within sixty (60) calendar days.

 

185


6.

Illegality

It is or becomes unlawful for an Obligor to perform or otherwise comply with one or more of its material obligations under any Finance Document.

 

7.

Invalidity; Unenforceability

Subject to any Legal Reservations, any material obligation of an Obligor under the Finance Documents is rendered invalid or unenforceable or is claimed by an Obligor not to be valid or enforceable and, such event is not remedied within thirty (30) calendar days after the earlier of (i) the date the Company or, as applicable, the relevant Obligor, became aware, or reasonably should have become aware, thereof and (ii) the date on which the Facility Agent gives notice thereof to the relevant Obligor.

 

8.

Consents

Any authorisation required to be maintained pursuant to the Finance Documents is not obtained or effected, is revoked or is not renewed, and any such circumstance has or would be reasonably likely to have a Material Adverse Effect.

 

9.

Judgment

A judgment against any Obligor in excess of US$50,000,000 (or its equivalent in any other currency or currencies) is rendered by a court or tribunal, is not subject to appeal and is not paid within ninety (90) calendar days of the date of its entry (subject to an extension of thirty (30) calendar days beyond any stay of the execution of such judgment within sixty (60) calendar days of its entry).

 

10.

Repudiation

The Company or any other Obligor repudiates any of its respective obligations under any Finance Document to which it is a party.

 

11.

Declared Company

Any Borrower incorporated in Singapore is declared by the Minister of Finance of Singapore to be a company to which Part IX of the Companies Act, Chapter 50 of Singapore applies.

 

186


SCHEDULE 17

FORM OF CONFIDENTIALITY AGREEMENT

This document is intended to be used with all LMA Facility Agreements whether or not they contain the

new LMA Confidentiality Undertaking.

For the avoidance of doubt, this document is in a non-binding, recommended form. Its intention is to be used as a starting point for negotiation only. Individual parties are free to depart from its terms and should always satisfy themselves of the regulatory implications of its use.

LMA CONFIDENTIALITY LETTER (SELLER). A SEPARATE LMA CONFIDENTIALITY LETTER

IS AVAILABLE FOR USE BETWEEN A SELLER’S AGENT/BROKER AND A PURCHASER’S

AGENT/BROKER.

THE CONFIDENTIALITY PROVISIONS CONTAINED IN THIS LETTER HAVE BEEN PRODUCED

SPECIFICALLY FOR THE SECONDARY TRADING OF LOANS. THIS LETTER SHOULD NOT

THEREFORE BE USED FOR PRIMARY SYNDICATION. A SEPARATE LMA CONFIDENTIALITY

LETTER IS AVAILABLE FOR USE WITH PRIMARY SYNDICATION.

[Letterhead of Seller]

Date: [             ]

To:

 

      [insert name of Potential Purchaser]

Re:    The Agreement

 

Company:    (the “Company”)   
Date:      
Amount:      
Agent:      

Dear Sirs

We understand that you are considering acquiring an interest in the Agreement which, subject to the Agreement, may be by way of novation, assignment, the entering into, whether directly or indirectly, of a sub-participation or any other transaction under which payments are to be made or may be made by reference to one or more Finance Documents and/or one or more Obligors or by way of investing in or otherwise financing, directly or indirectly, any such novation, assignment, sub-participation or other transaction (the “Acquisition”). In consideration of us agreeing to make available to you certain information, by your signature of a copy of this letter you agree as follows:

 

187


1.

Confidentiality Undertaking

You undertake (a) to keep all Confidential Information confidential and not to disclose it to anyone, save to the extent permitted by paragraph 2 below and to ensure that all Confidential Information is protected with security measures and a degree of care that would apply to your own confidential information, and (b) until the Acquisition is completed to use the Confidential Information only for the Permitted Purpose.

 

2.

Permitted Disclosure

We agree that you may disclose:

 

2.1

to any of your Affiliates and any of your or their officers, directors, employees, professional advisers and auditors such Confidential Information as you shall consider appropriate if any person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given pursuant to this paragraph 2.1 is informed in writing of its confidential nature and that some or all of such Confidential Information may be price-sensitive information, except that there shall be no such requirement to so inform if the recipient is subject to professional obligations to maintain the confidentiality of the information or is otherwise bound by requirements of confidentiality in relation to the Confidential Information;

 

2.2

subject to the requirements of the Agreement, to any person:

 

  (a)

to (or through) whom you assign or transfer (or may potentially assign or transfer) all or any of your rights and/or obligations which you may acquire under the Agreement such Confidential Information as you shall consider appropriate if the person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given pursuant to this sub-paragraph (a) of paragraph 2.2 has delivered a letter to you in equivalent form to this letter;

 

  (b)

with (or through) whom you enter into (or may potentially enter into) any sub-participation in relation to, or any other transaction under which payments are to be made or may be made by reference to the Agreement or any Obligor such Confidential Information as you shall consider appropriate if the person to whom the Confidential Information is to be given pursuant to this sub-paragraph (b) of paragraph 2.2 has delivered a letter to you in equivalent form to this letter;

 

  (c)

to whom information is required or requested to be disclosed by any governmental, banking, taxation or other regulatory authority or similar body, the rules of any relevant stock exchange or pursuant to any applicable law or regulation such Confidential Information as you shall consider appropriate; and

 

2.3

notwithstanding paragraphs 2.1 and 2.2 above, Confidential Information to such persons to whom, and on the same terms as, a Finance Party is permitted to disclose Confidential Information under the Agreement, as if such permissions were set out in full in this letter and as if references in those permissions to Finance Party were references to you.

 

3.

Notification of Disclosure

You agree (to the extent permitted by law and regulation) to inform us:

 

3.1

of the circumstances of any disclosure of Confidential Information made pursuant to sub-paragraph (c) of paragraph 2.2 above except where such disclosure is made to any of the persons referred to in that paragraph during the ordinary course of its supervisory or regulatory function; and

 

3.2

upon becoming aware that Confidential Information has been disclosed in breach of this letter.

 

188


4.

Return of Copies

If you do not enter into the Acquisition and we so request in writing, you shall return or destroy all Confidential Information supplied to you by us and destroy or permanently erase (to the extent technically practicable) all copies of Confidential Information made by you and use your reasonable endeavours to ensure that anyone to whom you have supplied any Confidential Information destroys or permanently erases (to the extent technically practicable) such Confidential Information and any copies made by them, in each case save to the extent that you or the recipients are required to retain any such Confidential Information by any applicable law, rule or regulation or by any competent judicial, governmental, supervisory or regulatory body or in accordance with internal policy, or where the Confidential Information has been disclosed under sub-paragraph (c) of paragraph 2.2 above.

 

5.

Continuing Obligations

The obligations in this letter are continuing and, in particular, shall survive and remain binding on you until (a) if you become a party to the Agreement as a Lender of record, the date on which you become such a party to the Agreement; (b) if you enter into the Acquisition but it does not result in you becoming a party to the Agreement as a Lender of record, the date falling [twelve (12)] months after the date on which all of your rights and obligations contained in the documentation entered into to implement that Acquisition have terminated; or (c) in any other case the date falling [twelve (12)] months after the date of your final receipt (in whatever manner) of any Confidential Information.

 

6.

No Representation, Consequences of Breach, etc.

You acknowledge and agree that:

 

6.1

neither we, nor any member of the Group nor any of our or their respective officers, employees or advisers (each a “Relevant Person”) (i) make any representation or warranty, express or implied, as to, or assume any responsibility for, the accuracy, reliability or completeness of any of the Confidential Information or any other information supplied by us or the assumptions on which it is based or (ii) shall be under any obligation to update or correct any inaccuracy in the Confidential Information or any other information supplied by us or be otherwise liable to you or any other person in respect of the Confidential Information or any such information; and

 

6.2

we or members of the Group may be irreparably harmed by the breach of the terms of this letter and damages may not be an adequate remedy; each Relevant Person may be granted an injunction or specific performance for any threatened or actual breach of the provisions of this letter by you.

 

7.

Entire Agreement: No Waiver, Amendments, etc.

 

7.1

This letter constitutes the entire agreement between us in relation to your obligations regarding Confidential Information and supersedes any previous agreement, whether express or implied, regarding Confidential Information.

 

7.2

No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, any right or remedy under this letter will operate as a waiver of any such right or remedy or constitute an election to affirm this letter. No election to affirm this letter will be effective unless it is in writing. No single or partial exercise of any right or remedy will prevent any further or other exercise or the exercise of any other right or remedy under this letter.

 

7.3

The terms of this letter and your obligations under this letter may only be amended or modified by written agreement between us.

 

8.

Inside Information

You acknowledge that some or all of the Confidential Information is or may be price-sensitive information and that the use of such information may be regulated or prohibited by applicable legislation including securities law relating to insider dealing and market abuse and you undertake not to use any Confidential Information for any unlawful purpose.

 

189


9.

Nature of Undertakings

The undertakings given by you under this letter are given to us and are also given for the benefit of the Company and each other member of the Group.

 

10.

Third Party Rights

 

10.1

Subject to this paragraph 10 and to paragraphs 6 and 9, a person who is not a party to this letter has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 (the “Third Parties Act”) to enforce or to enjoy the benefit of any term of this letter.

 

10.2

The Relevant Persons may enjoy the benefit of the terms of paragraphs 6 and 9 subject to and in accordance with this paragraph 10 and the provisions of the Third Parties Act.

 

10.3

Notwithstanding any provisions of this letter, the parties to this letter do not require the consent of any Relevant Person to rescind or vary this letter at any time.

 

11.

Governing Law and Jurisdiction

 

11.1

This letter (including the agreement constituted by your acknowledgement of its terms) (the “Letter”) and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it (including any non-contractual obligations arising out of the negotiation of the transaction contemplated by this Letter) are governed by English law.

 

11.2

The courts of England have non-exclusive jurisdiction to settle any dispute arising out of or in connection with this Letter (including a dispute relating to any non-contractual obligation arising out of or in connection with either this Letter or the negotiation of the transaction contemplated by this Letter).

 

12.

Definitions

In this letter (including the acknowledgement set out below) terms defined in the Agreement shall, unless the context otherwise requires, have the same meaning and:

Confidential Information” means all information relating to the Company, any Obligor, the Group, the Finance Documents, [the/a] Facility and/or the Acquisition which is provided to you in relation to the Finance Documents or [the/a] Facility by us or any of our affiliates or advisers, in whatever form, and includes information given orally and any document, electronic file or any other way of representing or recording information which contains or is derived or copied from such information but excludes information that:

 

  (a)

is or becomes public information other than as a direct or indirect result of any breach by you of this letter; or

 

  (b)

is identified in writing at the time of delivery as non-confidential by us or our advisers; or

 

  (c)

is known by you before the date the information is disclosed to you by us or any of our affiliates or advisers or is lawfully obtained by you after that date, from a source which is, as far as you are aware, unconnected with the Group and which, in either case, as far as you are aware, has not been obtained in breach of, and is not otherwise subject to, any obligation of confidentiality.

Group” means the Company and its subsidiaries for the time being (as such term is defined in the Companies Act 2006).

 

190


Permitted Purpose” means considering and evaluating whether to enter into the Acquisition.

Please acknowledge your agreement to the above by signing and returning the enclosed copy.

 

Yours faithfully
 

 

For and on behalf of
[Seller]
To:    [Seller]

The Company and each other member of the Group

We acknowledge and agree to the above:

 

 

 

For and on behalf of

[Potential Purchaser]

 

191


SCHEDULE 18

FORM OF INCREASE CONFIRMATION

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent, [[•] as Issuing Bank]4 and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. as Company, for and on behalf of each Obligor

From: [the Increase Lender] (the “Increase Lender”)

Dated:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This agreement (the “Agreement”) shall take effect as an Increase Confirmation for the purpose of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this Agreement unless given a different meaning in this Agreement.

 

2.

We refer to Clause 2.2 (Increase) of the Facilities Agreement.

 

3.

The Increase Lender agrees to assume and will assume all of the obligations corresponding to the Commitment specified in the Schedule (the “Relevant Commitment”) as if it had been an Original Lender under the Facilities Agreement in respect of the Relevant Commitment(s).

 

4.

The proposed date on which the increase in relation to the Increase Lender and the Relevant Commitment is to take effect (the “Increase Date”) is [ ].

 

5.

On the Increase Date, the Increase Lender becomes party to the relevant Finance Documents as a Lender.

 

6.

The Facility Office and address, fax number and attention details for notices to the Increase Lender for the purposes of Clause 38.2 (Addresses) of the Facilities Agreement are set out in the Schedule.

 

7.

The Increase Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Lenders’ obligations referred to in paragraph (j) of Clause 2.2 (Increase) of the Facilities Agreement.

 

8.

The Increase Lender confirms, for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without liability to any Obligor, that it is:

 

  (a)

in respect of a Lender to a Singapore Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a Singapore Qualifying Lender (other than a Singapore Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a Singapore Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not a Singapore Qualifying Lender];

 

  (b)

in respect of a Lender to a US Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a US Qualifying Lender];

 

  (ii)

[not a US Qualifying Lender];

 

4 

Only if there is an Issuing Bank in respect of the applicable Facility.

 

192


  (c)

in respect of a Lender to a German Borrower:

 

  (i)

[a German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[a German Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not a German Qualifying Lender];

 

  (d)

in respect of a Lender to an Other Borrower:

 

  (i)

[an Other Qualifying Lender (other than an Other Treaty Lender)];

 

  (ii)

[an Other Treaty Lender];

 

  (iii)

[not an Other Qualifying Lender].5

 

9.

The Increase Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a Sponsor Affiliate.

 

10.

The Increase Lender expressly confirms that it [can/cannot] exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of Clause 32.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent).

 

11.

[The Increase Lender confirms that it [is / is not] a Non-Acceptable L/C Lender.]

 

12.

[The Increase Lender confirms that it is not a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor or an Industry Competitor.]

 

13.

This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Agreement.

 

14.

This Agreement and any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with it governed by English law.

 

15.

This Agreement has been entered into on the date stated at the beginning of this Agreement.

 

5 

Delete as applicable—each Increase Lender is required to confirm which of these eight categories it falls within.

 

193


SCHEDULE

Relevant Commitment/rights and obligations

[insert relevant details]

[Facility office address, fax number and attention details for notices and account details for payments]

[Increase Lender]    

By:    

This Agreement is accepted as an Increase Confirmation for the purposes of the Facilities Agreement by the Facility Agent and the Increase Date is confirmed as [ ].

[Facility Agent]

By:

[Issuing Bank]

By:

 

194


SCHEDULE 19

FORMS OF NOTIFIABLE DEBT PURCHASE TRANSACTION NOTICE

Part A

Form of Notice on entering into Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

[The Lender]

Dated:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to paragraph (b) of Clause 30.2 (Disenfranchisement on Debt Purchase Transactions entered into by Sponsor Affiliates or members of the Group) of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this notice unless given a different meaning in this notice.

 

2.

We have entered into a Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction.

 

3.

The Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction referred to in paragraph 2 above relates to the amount of our Commitment(s) as set out below.

 

Commitment

   Amount of our Commitment to which Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction relates (Base Currency)

Additional L/C Facility Commitment

   [insert amount (of that Commitment) to which the relevant Debt Purchase Transaction applies]

Revolving Facility Commitment

   [insert amount (of that Commitment) to which the relevant Debt Purchase Transaction applies]

[Lender]

By:

 

195


Part B

Form of Notice on Termination of Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction / Notifiable Debt Purchase

Transaction ceasing to be with Sponsor Affiliate

 

To:

[•] as Facility Agent

 

From:

[The Lender]

Dated:

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated [•] 2019 (the “Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to paragraph (c) of Clause 30.2 (Disenfranchisement on Debt Purchase Transactions entered into by Sponsor Affiliates or members of the Group) of the Facilities Agreement. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning in this notice unless given a different meaning in this notice.

 

2.

A Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction which we entered into and which we notified you of in a notice dated [•] has [terminated / ceased to be with a Sponsor Affiliate].6

 

3.

The Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction referred to in paragraph 2 above relates to the amount of our Commitment(s) as set out below.

 

Commitment

   Amount of our Commitment to which Notifiable Debt Purchase Transaction relates (Currency)

Additional L/C Facility Commitment

   [insert amount (of that Commitment) to which the relevant Debt Purchase Transaction applies]

Revolving Facility Commitment

   [insert amount (of that Commitment) to which the relevant Debt Purchase Transaction applies]

[Lender]

By:

 

6 

Delete as applicable.

 

196


SCHEDULE 20

EXISTING FINANCE LEASES AND CAPITAL LEASES

 

As of June 30, 2019 for existing Finance Leases

      
Description of Finance Lease    Total Amount
(US$ ‘000)
 

Germany:

  

Dresden EVCI original & extension

     54,983  

Dresden EVCII original and extension

     60,304  

Dresden M1_GasFarm_Original_new

     21,143  

Dresden M2_GasFarm Amendment

     31,120  

United States:

  

F8_GasFarm

     17,707  

F8_GasFarm ext2

     49,128  

F8_GasFarm 3O2

     245  

F8_GasFarm LN2

     241  

F8_TDC Purifier

     6,372  

F8_UPGR 16x Equip flow

     5,330  

F8_UPGR He flow

     222  

F8_Con BGY 1 BGY 2

     1,488  

F8_Hydrogen Amend6

     5,002  

F8_Oxygen Amend6

     2,946  

F8_Waste System

     402  

F8_Tank Upgrade Amend9

     715  

F8_US Bulk Gas Yard 3

     69,300  

Singapore:

  

SNP Elect Gases FAB7 Phase1

     2,415  

SNP Bulk Gases

     18,339  

SNP Elect Gases FAB7 Phase7Ca

     21,135  

SNP Elect Gases FAB7 Phase7Cb

     625  

SNP SOXAL

     37,743  
  

 

 

 

TOTAL FINANCE LEASE OBLIGATIONS

     406,905  
  

 

 

 

 

197


SCHEDULE 21

EXISTING INVESTMENT COMMITMENTS

Part A

Existing loans and guarantees already made or committed to be made

[None as at the Signing Date]

Part B

Other investments already committed

[None as at the Signing Date]

 

198


SCHEDULE 22

FORM OF ACCEPTABLE LETTER OF CREDIT

 

To:

[Beneficiary]

IRREVOCABLE STANDBY LETTER OF CREDIT NO. [•]

We hereby establish our irrevocable standby Letter of Credit No. [•] (the “Letter of Credit”) in favour of [•] (the “Beneficiary”) at the request of [•], a company organized and existing under the laws of [•] (the “Principal”), in the maximum aggregate sum of [•]) (such amount being the “Stated Amount”), effective immediately and expiring as provided in paragraph 3 of this Letter of Credit, unless otherwise extended.

 

1.

A drawing hereunder may be made on any Business Day prior to the expiration of this Letter of Credit by delivering no later than [11:00 a.m. (London time)] on [such Business Day], to [Name and Address of Issuing Bank] (the “Issuing Bank”) (or at such other address as may be designated by the Issuing Bank in a written notice delivered to the Beneficiary), [(i)] a drawing statement of the Beneficiary, in the form of Annex 1 attached hereto, appropriately completed and duly signed by an authorized officer of the Beneficiary, [and (ii) a draft in the form of Annex 2 attached hereto].

 

2.

We hereby agree to honour a drawing hereunder made in strict conformity with the terms and conditions of this Letter of Credit by transferring in immediately available funds in the amount specified in the drawing statement delivered to us in connection with such drawing request to such account at such bank as is specified in such drawing statement delivered to us pursuant to, and in accordance with, paragraph 1 hereof, by [1:00 p.m. (London time)], on [the Business Day] following the date of receipt of such drawing request.

 

3.

This Letter of Credit shall expire at the close of banking hours at our office in [same address of Issuing Bank as specified above], on the date which is [one (1) year] from the date hereof (the “Stated Expiration Date”); [provided, however, that the Stated Expiration Date shall be automatically extended for a period of [one (1) year] effective upon the Stated Expiration Date and each [annual] anniversary of the Stated Expiration Date (each such annual anniversary date being referred to herein as the “New Stated Expiration Date”)] unless, at least [sixty (60) days] prior to the Stated Expiration Date [or any such New Stated Expiration Date, as the case may be,] we notify the Beneficiary (with a copy to the Principal) by [registered mail or similar overnight courier service at the above addresses], that this Letter of Credit shall not be extended beyond the Stated Expiration Date [or the New Stated Expiration Date, as the case may be]. If the Beneficiary is so notified, the Beneficiary may at any time on or before the Stated Expiration Date [or the applicable New Stated Expiration Date, as the case may be,] draw the full amount available hereunder.

 

4.

If a demand for payment made hereunder does not, in any instance, conform to the terms and conditions of this Letter of Credit, we shall give prompt notice to the person delivering such drawing request that the demand for payment was not effective in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Letter of Credit, stating the reasons therefor, and that we will upon instructions from such person hold any documents at his disposal or return the same to him. Upon being notified that the drawing request was not effected in conformity with this Letter of Credit, the person who submitted the drawing request may attempt to correct any such non-conforming drawing request, provided conforming documents are presented by the Stated Expiration Date [or the applicable New Stated Expiration Date, as the case may be].

 

5.

Partial and multiple drawings are permitted under this Letter of Credit.

 

6.

Under no circumstances shall we be obliged to honour any drawing request which does not comply with the terms and conditions set forth herein, and the maximum liability with respect to any request for payment made hereunder shall be the Stated Amount. Upon the payment by us of the amount specified in a drawing statement presented to us in connection with any drawing request hereunder, we shall be fully discharged of our obligations in respect of such drawing request.

 

199


7.

As used herein, “Business Day” shall mean [a day when banks are open for business in [•]].

 

8.

This Letter of Credit is irrevocable and shall not be assigned by us or by the Beneficiary.

 

9.

The Beneficiary shall have no obligation under or in connection with this Letter of Credit to make any payment or reimbursement to us with respect to any drawing hereunder or otherwise.

 

10.

This Letter of Credit is subject to the International Standby Practices (ISP98), International Chamber of Commerce Publication No. 590. This Letter of Credit shall be deemed to be a contract made under the laws of [England and Wales] and shall, as to matters not governed by the International Standby Practices (ISP98), be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of [England and Wales].

 

11.

This is not a contract of guarantee and all payments which are to be made by us hereunder will be made free and clear of and without deduction for or as a result of any set-off or counterclaim or the raising of any defense which would be available to the Principal.

 

12.

In the case of any drawing, as of the date any drawing is honoured, the Stated Amount shall automatically be reduced by an amount equal to 100% of such drawing. Reductions in the Stated Amount resulting from any drawing shall not be reinstated.

 

13.

This Letter of Credit sets forth in full our undertaking, and such undertaking shall not in any way be modified, amended, amplified or limited by reference to any document, instrument or agreement referred to herein, except for Annex 1 [and Annex 2] hereto and the notices referred to herein, and any such reference shall not be deemed to incorporate herein by reference any document, instrument or agreement except for Annex 1 [and Annex 2] hereto.

Yours faithfully,

[Issuing Bank]

By:

 

200


ANNEX 1

DRAWING STATEMENT UNDER IRREVOCABLE STANDBY LETTER OF CREDIT

NO. [•]

_________________, 20__

[Issuing Bank]

Attention:

 

Re:

Irrevocable Standby Letter of Credit No. [•]

Ladies and Gentlemen:

The undersigned is making a drawing under the above-referenced Letter of Credit and hereby certifies to you as follows:

 

1.

The person signing on behalf of the undersigned is a duly authorized officer of the undersigned.

 

2.

The undersigned hereby makes demand under the above-referenced Letter of Credit for $[•], which amount is not in excess of the Stated Amount. Such amount is to be transferred to [insert wire transfer instructions for appropriate account with the Beneficiary].

 

3.

The undersigned has concurrently presented to you its draft drawn in the amount specified in paragraph 2 above. The date of the draft is the date of this certificate, which is not later than the Stated Expiration Date [or the applicable New Stated Expiration Date, as the case may be].

All terms used herein which are defined in the Letter of Credit have the same meanings when used herein.

[Beneficiary]

as Beneficiary

By:

 

201


ANNEX 2

DRAFT UNDER IRREVOCABLE STANDBY LETTER OF CREDIT

NO. [•]

_________________, 20__

At sight pay to [•] at [Account Information] the amount of $[•] drawn on [Issuing Bank], as issuer of Irrevocable Standby Letter of Credit No. [•], dated _________, 20__.

[________________________]

By: __________________________

Authorised Signatory

 

202


EXECUTION PAGES

 

THE COMPANY
GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.
By:    
Name:   Douglas Devine
Title:   CFO

 

THE ORIGINAL GUARANTORS
GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dreseden Module One LLC

By:    
Name:   Dr. Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   SVP and General Manager

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LIMITED LIABILITY
COMPANY & CO. KG
represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dreseden Module One LLC
By:    
Name:   Dr. Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   SVP and General Manager

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.
By:    
Name:   Douglas Devine
Title:   Director

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.
By:    
Name:   Douglas Devine
Title:   CFO

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES NETHERLANDS HOLDING B.V.
By:    
Name:   Cheryl Peck
Title:   Director

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES MANAGEMENT SERVICES LIMITED LIABILITY
COMPANY & CO. KG
represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dreseden Module Two LLC
By:    
Name:   Dr. Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   SVP and General Manager

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LLC
By:    
Name:   Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   Manager

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE HOLDING GMBH
By:    
Name:   Dr. Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)
GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LLC
By:    
Name:   Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   Manager
GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO HOLDING GMBH
By:    
Name:   Dr. Thomas Morgenstern
Title:   Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (NETHERLANDS) COÖPERATIEF U.A.
By:         By:    
Name:   James Doyle     Name:   Cheryl Peck
Title:   Board Member A     Title:   Board Member B

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


GLOBALFOUNDRIES NETHERLANDS B.V.

By:    
Name:  

Cheryl Peck

Title:  

Director

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

By:    
Name:  

James Doyle

Title:  

Director

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE ORIGINAL BORROWERS

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

By:    
Name:  

Douglas Devine

Title:  

CFO

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

By:    
Name:  

Douglas Devine

Title:  

Director

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

By:    
Name:  

Douglas Devine

Title:  

CFO

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE ARRANGERS

 

DBS BANK LTD.
By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


CITIBANK, N.A., LONDON BRANCH

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE BOOKRUNNERS

 

DBS BANK LTD.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


CITIBANK N.A., LONDON BRANCH

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE ORIGINAL REVOLVING LENDERS

 

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


CITIBANK, N.A.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


DBS BANK LTD.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE ORIGINAL ADDITIONAL L/C LENDER

 

CITIBANK, N.A.

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]


THE FACILITY AGENT

 

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH

By:    
Name:  

 

[GF 2019 – RCF and LC Signature Page]

EX-10.13

Exhibit 10.13

 

LOGO

 

Dated 11 NOVEMBER 2020

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as the Company

THE COMPANIES LISTED IN SCHEDULE 1

together with the Company, as Obligors

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS LISTED IN SCHEDULE 2

as New Lenders

- and -

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH

as Agent

 

 

AMENDMENT AGREEMENT

relating to a Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

dated 18 October 2019

 

 

 

WE OPERATE IN THE UK AND ITALY AS SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP, A LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIP ORGANISED IN THE UNITED STATES UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, WHICH LAWS LIMIT THE PERSONAL LIABILITY OF PARTNERS. SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS AUTHORISED AND REGULATED BY THE SOLICITORS REGULATION AUTHORITY (FIRM SRA NUMBER 211340). A LIST OF ALL PARTNERS’ NAMES, WHICH INCLUDES SOLICITORS AND REGISTERED FOREIGN LAWYERS, IS OPEN FOR INSPECTION AT THE ABOVE ADDRESS. EACH PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS ALSO A PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING LLP WHICH HAS OFFICES IN THE OTHER CITIES NOTED ABOVE.

 


EXECUTION VERSION

 

CONTENTS

 

1.

  

Definitions and Interpretation

     2  

2.

  

Effective Date

     2  

3.

  

Representations

     3  

4.

  

Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement

     3  

5.

  

New Lender Confirmations

     3  

6.

  

Guarantee Confirmation

     4  

7.

  

Costs and Expenses

     4  

8.

  

Miscellaneous

     4  

9.

  

Governing Law

     4  
SCHEDULE 1 The Obligors      6  
SCHEDULE 2 The Lenders      7  
SCHEDULE 3 Conditions Precedent      8  
SCHEDULE 4 Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement      10  
SIGNATORIES      14  

 


EXECUTION VERSION

 

THIS AMENDMENT AGREEMENT is made on 11 November 2020

BETWEEN:

 

(1)

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC., an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with its registered office at Maples Corporate Services Limited, PO Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands (the “Company”);

 

(2)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part A (Original Borrowers) of Schedule 1 (The Obligors) as the original borrowers (the “Original Borrowers”);

 

(3)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part B (Original Guarantors) of Schedule 1 (The Obligors) as the original guarantors (the “Original Guarantors”);

 

(4)

BANK OF AMERICA, N.A., (the “Increasing Lender”);

 

(5)

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part B (New Lenders) Schedule 2 (The Lenders) as the new lenders (the “New Lenders”); and

 

(6)

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH as facility agent of the other Finance Parties (the “Facility Agent”).

WHEREAS:

 

(A)

The Company, the Original Borrowers, the Original Guarantors, the Facility Agent and the financial institutions named therein as Original Lenders entered into a revolving and L/C facilities agreement originally dated 18 October 2019 pursuant to which the Lenders made available to the Original Borrowers a Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount of $235,000,000 and a L/C Facility in an aggregate amount of $20,000,000 (each as defined therein) (the “Original Facilities Agreement”).

 

(B)

Pursuant to an upsize request letter dated on or about the date of this Amendment Agreement between the Company and the Facility Agent, the Company has requested that the Existing Lenders (as defined therein) consent to an upsize of the Commitments available under the Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount not to exceed $162,500,000 (the “Upsize Request Letter”).

 

(C)

Pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter, the Increasing Lender and the New Lenders confirmed their intention to participate in the upsize to the Revolving Facility described therein.

 

(D)

The Facility Agent, for itself and on behalf of the Finance Parties, and the Obligors have agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement in order to amend the terms of the Original Facilities Agreement in accordance with the amendments set out in the Upsize Request Letter in the manner set out below.

 

(E)

The Facility Agent has been authorised to enter into this Amendment Agreement by the requisite Existing Lenders pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter.

 

(F)

The Increasing Lender has agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement to confirm the amount of additional Commitment confirmed by the Company pursuant to the Form of Response (as defined in the Upsize Request Letter) which was submitted by the Increasing Lender.

 

(G)

The New Lenders have agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement and become “Lenders” under and in accordance with the Original Facilities Agreement (as amended by this Amendment Agreement).

 

1


EXECUTION VERSION

 

NOW IT IS HEREBY AGREED:

 

1.

DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

 

1.1

Definitions

In this Amendment Agreement:

Amended Facilities Agreement” means the Original Facilities Agreement, as amended by this Amendment Agreement.

Effective Date” means the date on which the “Effective Time” (as defined in the Upsize Request Letter) occurs.

 

1.2

Incorporation of defined terms

 

  (a)

Unless a contrary indication appears, a term defined in the Original Facilities Agreement has the same meaning when used herein.

 

  (b)

The principles of construction set out in Clause 1 (Definitions and Interpretation) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall also apply in the interpretation hereof as if expressly set out herein with each reference to the “Agreement” being deemed to be a reference to this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.3

Clauses

In this Amendment Agreement, any reference to a “Clause” or a “Schedule” is, unless the context otherwise requires, a Clause of or a Schedule to this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.4

Third party rights

Unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document, a person who is not a party to this Amendment Agreement has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 to enforce or to enjoy the benefit of any term of this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.5

Designation

In accordance with the Original Facilities Agreement, each of the Company and the Facility Agent designate this Amendment Agreement as a Finance Document.

 

2.

EFFECTIVE DATE

Subject to:

 

  (a)

no Event of Default having occurred which is continuing; and

 

  (b)

the representations and warranties set out in Clause 3 (Representations) of this Amendment Agreement being true and accurate,

the amendments to the Original Facilities Agreement referred to in Clause 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement) shall take effect on the Effective Date in accordance with their terms. If the Effective Date has not occurred by (and including) 11.59 p.m. on 31 December 2020 (or such later date as the Facility Agent acting on the instructions of the Finance Parties may agree) none of the amendments referred to in Clause 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement) will take effect.

 

2


EXECUTION VERSION

 

3.

REPRESENTATIONS

On the date of this Amendment Agreement and at the Effective Date, the Company and each Obligor confirm that the Repeating Representations to be made by it are true in all material respects.

 

4.

AMENDMENTS TO ORIGINAL FACILITIES AGREEMENT

 

4.1

With effect from the Effective Date, the Original Facilities Agreement shall be amended as set out in Schedule 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement).

 

4.2

With effect from the Effective Date, the Total Revolving Facility Commitments shall be increased by $162,500,000 to $397,500,000 such that:

 

  (a)

each New Lender will become a Lender under the Amended Facilities Agreement with a Revolving Facility Commitment as set out in the relevant column opposite its name in Part B (New Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders);

 

  (b)

each Original Lender will remain an Original Lender under the Amended Facilities Agreement with a Revolving Facility Commitment as set out opposite its name in Part A (Original Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders), such amount including any additional Commitment assumed by it pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter; and

 

  (c)

each New Lender shall become a party to the Amended Facilities Agreement any other relevant Finance Document as a “Lender”, and will assume the same rights and obligations to the other Finance Parties as if it had been party to the Amended Facilities Agreement as an “Original Lender”.

 

4.3

Subject to the terms of this Amendment Agreement, the Original Facilities Agreement will remain in full force and effect and as from the Effective Date references in the Original Facilities Agreement to “this Agreement”, “hereunder”, “herein” and like terms or to any provision of the Original Facilities Agreement shall be construed as a reference to the Original Facilities Agreement, or such provision, as amended by this Amendment Agreement.

 

4.4

Except as otherwise provided in this Amendment Agreement, the Finance Documents remain in full force and effect.

 

5.

NEW LENDER CONFIRMATIONS

 

5.1

Subject to Clause 5.2 below, each New Lender confirms for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor that it can exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of clause 28.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

5.2

Notwithstanding Clause 5.1 above, each of Commerzbank AG and Deutsche Bank AG in their capacity as New Lenders confirm for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor that it cannot exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of clause 28.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

5.3

Each New Lender confirms for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor that:

 

  (a)

it is not a Sponsor Affiliate; and

 

  (b)

it is not a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor or an Industry Competitor.

 

3


EXECUTION VERSION

 

5.4

Each New Lender listed in Part B (New Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders) confirms, for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor, that its status for the purpose of clause 18.4 (Lender status confirmation) of the Amended Facilities Agreement is as set out against its name in that Part B.

 

5.5

Each New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender’s obligations set out in paragraph (c) of clause 25.5 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

5.6

Each New Lender has delivered to the Facility Agent its Facility Office details and address, email address, fax number and attention details for notices for the purposes of clause 34.2 (Addressees) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

6.

GUARANTEE CONFIRMATION

Each Obligor hereby represents, warrants and confirms to and for the benefit of each Finance Party on the date hereof and on the Effective Date that all guarantee and indemnity obligations of it pursuant to Clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall:

 

  (a)

remain in full force and effect notwithstanding any amendments to the Original Facilities Agreement contemplated by this Amendment Agreement; and

 

  (b)

extend to any new obligations assumed by any Obligor under the Finance Documents as a result of the Upsize Request Letter or this Amendment Agreement.

 

7.

COSTS AND EXPENSES

The Company shall within five (5) Business Days of demand pay to the Facility Agent the amount of all pre-approved reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) payable pursuant to Clause 23.2 (Amendment costs) in connection with this Amendment Agreement.

 

8.

MISCELLANEOUS

 

8.1

Clauses 38 (Notices), 40 (Partial Invalidity) and 50 (Enforcement) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall be deemed incorporated in this Amendment Agreement (with such conforming amendments as the context requires) as if set out herein with each reference to the “Agreement” being deemed to be a reference to this Amendment Agreement.

 

8.2

Any signature (including, without limitation, (x) any electronic symbol or process attached to, or associated with, a contract or other record and adopted by a person with the intent to sign, authenticate or accept such contract or record and (y) any facsimile, E-pencil or .pdf signature) to this Amendment Agreement through electronic means, shall have the same legal validity and enforceability as a manually executed signature or use of a paper-based record-keeping system to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law.

 

8.3

This Amendment Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Amendment Agreement. Delivery of a counterpart of this Amendment Agreement by e-mail attachment or telecopy shall be an effective mode of delivery.

 

9.

GOVERNING LAW

This Letter is governed by and shall be construed in accordance with English law. Any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with this Letter are governed by English law.

 

4


EXECUTION VERSION

 

AS WITNESS the hands of the duly authorised representatives of the parties hereto the day and year first above written.

 

5


SCHEDULE 1

THE OBLIGORS

Part A – The Original Borrowers

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

Part B – Original Guarantors

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

4.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

5.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

 

6.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V.

 

7.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

8.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

 

9.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH

 

10.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

 

11.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH

 

12.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Cooperatief U.A.

 

13.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands B.V.

 

14.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

 

6


SCHEDULE 2

THE LENDERS

Part A – The Original Lenders

 

Name of Original Lender    Revolving Facility
Commitments as
at the Effective
Date
 

Bank of America, N.A.

   $ 40,000,000  

Citibank, N.A.

   $ 70,000,000  

DBS Bank Ltd.

   $ 90,000,000  

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

   $ 50,000,000  

Part B – New Lenders

 

Name of New Lender    Revolving
Facility
Commitments
as at the
Effective Date
     Lender Status Confirmation

Intesa Sanpaolo S.P.A., London Branch

   $ 25,000,000      Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender
Not a US Qualifying Lender
Not a German Qualifying Lender

Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc.

   $ 25,000,000      Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender
A US Qualifying Lender
A German Treaty Lender

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 50,000,000     

Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender

A US Qualifying Lender

A German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)

ING Bank, A Branch of ING-DIBA AG

   $ 12,500,000      Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender
A US Qualifying Lender
A German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)

Commerzbank AG

   $ 10,000,000      A Singapore Treaty Lender
A US Qualifying Lender
A German Qualifying Lender (other than a German Treaty Lender)

Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch

   $ 25,000,000      Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender
A US Qualifying Lender
A German Treaty Lender

 

7


SCHEDULE 3

Conditions Precedent

 

1.

Corporate Formalities

 

  (a)

A copy of the constitutional documents of each Original Obligor (including for any German Original Obligor (i) an up-to-date electronic chronological commercial register extract (elektronischer chronologischer Handelsregisterausdruck), (ii) its articles of association (Satzung) or partnership agreement (Gesellschaftsvertrag), as applicable, as well as copies of any by-laws and (iii) if applicable, its list of shareholders).

 

  (b)

A copy of a good standing certificate with respect to each US Obligor, issued as of a recent date by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of each US Obligor’s jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation.

 

  (c)

A copy of a resolution of in respect of any Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor), its board of directors or board of managers, as applicable:

 

  (i)

approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Amendment Agreement and resolving that it execute such document;

 

  (ii)

authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Amendment Agreement on its behalf; and

 

  (iii)

authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (d)

A specimen of the signature of person(s) authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (c) above or otherwise.

 

  (e)

If required, a copy of a resolution of the holders of the issued shares and/or interests, as applicable in each Original Obligor (and/or, if applicable, by the supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) and/or advisory board (Beirat) of such German Original Obligor), approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (f)

A certificate of each Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor) (signed by an Authorised Officer) confirming that borrowing, securing or guaranteeing, as appropriate, the Total Commitments would not cause any borrowing, securing, guaranteeing or similar limit binding on such Original Obligor to be exceeded.

 

  (g)

A certificate of an Authorised Officer of the relevant Original Obligor certifying that each copy document relating to it specified in this paragraph 1 of this Schedule 3 (Conditions Precedent) is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (h)

A certificate of good standing of the Company as issued by the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands and dated within thirty (30) days of the Amendment Agreement.

 

2.

Legal Opinions

 

  (a)

A legal opinion of Clifford Chance LLP as to the law of England & Wales, as to the enforceability of the Amendment Agreement, in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Original Lenders and the New Lenders.

 

8


  (b)

A legal opinion of the following legal advisers to the Company and the Original Obligors:

 

  (i)

Shearman & Sterling LLP as to German law;

 

  (ii)

Maples and Calder as to Cayman Islands law;

 

  (iii)

Dentons Rodyk & Davidson LLP as to Singaporean law;

 

  (iv)

Hogan Lovells International LLP as to Dutch law; and

 

  (v)

Richards, Layton & Finger, P.A. as to Delaware law,

each in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Original Lenders and the New Lenders.

 

9


SCHEDULE 4

Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement

 

(1)

In Clause 1.1 (Definitions) of the Original Facilities Agreement:

 

  (a)

adding the following new definitions such that they appear listed in this clause in alphabetical order:

“”2020 Upsize” means the upsize of the Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount of up to $162,500,000 which became effective on the Effective Date.”

“”Amendment Agreement” means the amendment agreement relating to this Agreement dated ___ November 2020 between, amongst others, the Company and the Facility Agent.”;

“”Collateral Trustee” means the security agent under the Collateral Trust Agreement.”;

Creditor Representative” has the meaning given to that term in the Collateral Trust Agreement.”;

“”Effective Date” has the meaning given to that term in the Amendment Agreement.”; and

“”Increasing Lender” means each Lender (which is not an Original Lender) which participates in the 2020 Upsize, for so long as it holds the Commitment assumed by it pursuant to the 2020 Upsize.”;

 

  (b)

deleting the definition of “Collateral Trust Agreement” and replacing it with “means, the security trust deed (as amended, supplemented, amended and restated or otherwise modified from time to time) between, among others, the Company, the Facility Agent, the entities named therein as debtors and the Collateral Trustee.”;

 

  (c)

deleting the references to “Collateral Agent” from paragraphs (m)(i) and (m)(ii)(A) of the definition of “Permitted Security” and replacing them with “Collateral Trustee”;

 

  (d)

deleting the definition of “Reaffirmation Agreement” and replacing it with “means the reaffirmation agreement dated 17 October 2019 in respect of the collateral trust agreement dated 20 September 2018 between, among others, the Company and Wilmington Trust, National Association as collateral trustee, and executed by the relevant Obligors party to that collateral trust agreement.”;

 

  (e)

deleting the definition of “Restricted Lender” and replacing it with “means a Lender that notifies the Facility Agent that it is to be regarded as a Lender in respect of whom complying with a given Sanction may result in a violation of, a conflict with, or liability under the EU Blocking Regulation or any national law contemplating a similar anti-boycott regulation for the purpose of this Agreement.”;

 

  (f)

deleting paragraph (a) of the definition of “Revolving Facility Commitment” and replacing it with “in relation to an Original Lender or an Increasing Lender, the amount in the Base Currency set opposite its name under the heading “Revolving Facility Commitments” in Part D (Commitments following the Effective Date) of Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) and the amount of any other Revolving Facility Commitment transferred to it under this Agreement or assumed by it in accordance with Clause 2.2 (Increase); and”; and

 

10


  (g)

deleting the definition of “Total Revolving Facility Commitments” and replacing it with “means the aggregate Revolving Facility Commitments, being $397,500,000 as at the Effective Date”.

 

(2)

In Clause 1.2 (Construction) of the Original Facilities Agreement, adding a new paragraph (q) which reads as follows:

“Any reference in this Agreement to a “Secured Debt Representative” shall be construed as a reference to a “Creditor Representative.”

 

(3)

In Clause 4.5 (Approved Borrowers) of the Original Facilities Agreement:

 

  (a)

in paragraphs (a) and (d) only, adding “and each Increasing Lender” after each occurrence of “each Original Lender”; and

 

  (b)

in paragraph (c) only, adding “or each Increasing Lender’s (as applicable)” after “each Original Lender’s”.

 

(4)

In Clause 9.8 (Affiliates of Lenders as Ancillary Lenders) of the Original Facilities Agreement including a new paragraph (e) as follows:

“Prior to becoming an Ancillary Lender, such Affiliate of a Lender shall accede to (i) this Agreement as a Lender and (ii) to the Collateral Trust Agreement as a Senior Facility Provider (as defined therein) by delivering to the Collateral Trustee a duly completed accession undertaking in the form scheduled to the Collateral Trust Agreement.”

 

(5)

In Clause 9.9 (Affiliates of Borrowers) of the Original Facilities Agreement, including a new paragraph (f) as follows:

“No later than contemporaneously with the date on which it becomes a Borrower with respect to an Ancillary Facility, such Affiliate shall accede to the Collateral Trust Agreement as a Debtor (as defined therein) if not already party thereto in such capacity.”;

 

(6)

Clause 42.5 (Replacement of Screen Rate) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall be deleted and replaced with:

 

  “(a)

Subject to Clause 42.4 (Other exceptions), any amendment or waiver which relates to:

 

  (i)

providing for the use of a Replacement Benchmark; and

 

  (ii)

 

  (A)

aligning any provision of any Finance Document to the use of that Replacement Benchmark;

 

  (B)

enabling that Replacement Benchmark to be used for the calculation of interest under this Agreement (including, without limitation, any consequential changes required to enable that Replacement Benchmark to be used for the purposes of this Agreement);

 

  (C)

implementing market conventions applicable to that Replacement Benchmark;

 

  (D)

providing for appropriate fallback (and market disruption) provisions for that Replacement Benchmark; or

 

11


  (E)

adjusting the pricing to reduce or eliminate, to the extent reasonably practicable, any transfer of economic value from one Party to another as a result of the application of that Replacement Benchmark (and if any adjustment or method for calculating any adjustment has been formally designated, nominated or recommended by the Relevant Nominating Body, the adjustment shall be determined on the basis of that designation, nomination or recommendation),

may be made with the consent of the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders) and the Company.

 

  (b)

If, as at 30 September 2021, or, in the event that the regulators publicly announce that the deadline for LIBOR transition for cash products, including loans, will be amended to a date beyond 31 December 2021 (the “Revised Regulatory Deadline”), the date falling three (3) months prior to the Revised Regulatory Deadline, this Agreement provides that the rate of interest for a Loan in Dollars is to be determined by reference to the Screen Rate for LIBOR the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders) and the Company shall enter into negotiations in good faith with a view to agreeing the use of a Replacement Benchmark in relation to Dollars in place of that Screen Rate from and including a date no later than 31 December 2021 or, if applicable, the Revised Regulatory Deadline.

Relevant Nominating Body” means any applicable central bank, regulator or other supervisory authority or a group of them, or any working group or committee sponsored or chaired by, or constituted at the request of, any of them or the Financial Stability Board.

Replacement Benchmark” means a benchmark rate which is:

 

  (a)

formally designated, nominated or recommended as the replacement for a Screen Rate by:

 

  (i)

the administrator of that Screen Rate; or

 

  (ii)

any Relevant Nominating Body,

and if replacements have, at the relevant time, been formally designated, nominated or recommended under both paragraphs, the “Replacement Benchmark” will be the replacement under paragraph (ii) above;

 

  (b)

in the opinion of the Majority Lenders and the Company, generally accepted in the international or any relevant domestic syndicated loan markets as the appropriate successor to a Screen Rate; or

 

  (c)

in the opinion of the Majority Lenders and the Company, an appropriate successor to a Screen Rate.”.

 

(7)

In Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) of the Original Facilities Agreement there shall be a new Part D (Commitments following the Effective Date) inserted which shall read as follows:

 

12


Part D

Commitments following the Effective Date

 

Name of Lender    Revolving
Facility
Commitments
     Additional L/
C Facility
Commitments
 

Bank of America, N.A.

   $ 40,000,000        —    

Citibank, N.A.

   $ 70,000,000      $ 20,000,000  

Commerzbank AG

   $ 10,000,000        —    

Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch

   $ 25,000,000        —    

DBS Bank Ltd.

   $ 90,000,000        —    

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 50,000,000        —    

ING Bank, A Branch of ING-DIBA AG

   $ 12,500,000        —    

Intesa Sanpaolo S.P.A., London Branch

   $ 25,000,000        —    

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

   $ 50,000,000        —    

Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc.

   $ 25,000,000        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commitments

   $ 397,500,000      $ 20,000,000  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

13


SIGNATORIES

THE COMPANY

 

 

Name: David Reeder

Title: CFO

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as Company

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE ORIGINAL BORROWERS

 

 

Name: David Reeder

Title: CFO

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as an Original Borrower

 

 

Name: Theodore Castro

Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

as an Original Borrower

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar

Title: Secretary

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

as an Original Borrower

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE ORIGINAL GUARANTORS
 

 

Name: David Reeder
Title: CFO

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Theodore Castro
Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Secretary

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Dirk Gasse
Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES NETHERLANDS HOLDING B.V.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES MANAGEMENT SERVICES LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE HOLDING GMBH

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO HOLDING GMBH

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

     

 

Name: Carmine Joseph Mele

   

Name: Dirk Gasse

Title: Management Board Member A

   

Title: Management Board Member B

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (NETHERLANDS) COÖPERATIEF U.A.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Dirk Gasse

Title: Director

GLOBALFOUNDRIES NETHERLANDS B.V.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Michael Cadigan

Title: Director

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE NEW LENDERS

COMMERZBANK AG

 

By:    
Name:  

 

By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


CREDIT SUISSE AG, CAYMAN ISLANDS BRANCH
By:    
  Name:
  Title: Authorized Signatory

 

By:

   
  Name:
  Title: Authorized Signatory

 

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


DEUTSCHE BANK AG
By:    
Name:
By:    
Name:  

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


ING BANK, A BRANCH OF ING-DIBA AG
By:    
Name:

 

By:    
Name:

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


INTESA SANPAOLO S.P.A., LONDON BRANCH
By:    
Name:

 

By:    
Name:

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


MORGAN STANLEY SENIOR FUNDING, INC.

By:    
Name:

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE INCREASING LENDER
BANK OF AMERICA, N.A.
By:    
Name:

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE FACILITY AGENT

 

 

 

Name:

For and on behalf of

Citibank Europe Plc, UK Branch

in its capacity as Facility Agent

(acting on the instructions of the requisite Lenders)

[Signature Page – Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]

EX-10.14

Exhibit 10.14

 

LOGO

Execution Version

Dated October 13, 2021

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as the Company

THE COMPANIES LISTED IN SCHEDULE 1

together with the Company, as Obligors

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS LISTED IN SCHEDULE 2

as New Lenders

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS LISTED IN SCHEDULE 2

as Increasing Lenders

HSBC SECURITIES (USA), INC.

as Sustainability Structuring Agent

- and -

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH

as Facility Agent

 

 

AMENDMENT AGREEMENT

relating to a Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement

originally dated 18 October 2019

 

 

 

WE OPERATE IN THE UK AND ITALY AS SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP, A LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIP ORGANISED IN THE UNITED STATES UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE, WHICH LAWS LIMIT THE PERSONAL LIABILITY OF PARTNERS. SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS AUTHORISED AND REGULATED BY THE SOLICITORS REGULATION AUTHORITY (FIRM SRA NUMBER 211340). A LIST OF ALL PARTNERS’ NAMES, WHICH INCLUDES SOLICITORS AND REGISTERED FOREIGN LAWYERS, IS OPEN FOR INSPECTION AT THE ABOVE ADDRESS. EACH PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING (LONDON) LLP IS ALSO A PARTNER OF SHEARMAN & STERLING LLP WHICH HAS OFFICES IN THE OTHER CITIES NOTED ABOVE.


CONTENTS

 

1.

  

Definitions and Interpretation

     2  

2.

  

Effective Date

     2  

3.

  

Representations

     3  

4.

  

Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement

     3  

5.

  

New Lender Confirmations

     4  

6.

  

Guarantee and security Confirmation

     4  

7.

  

Conditions subsequent

     5  

8.

  

Costs and Expenses

     5  

9.

  

Miscellaneous

     6  
10.   

Governing Law

     6  

SCHEDULE 1 The Obligors

     7  

SCHEDULE 2 The Lenders

     8  

SCHEDULE 3 Conditions Precedent

     9  

SCHEDULE 4 Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement

     11  

SIGNATORIES

     17  


THIS AMENDMENT AGREEMENT is made on 13 October 2021

BETWEEN:

 

(1)

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC., an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with its registered office at Maples Corporate Services Limited, PO Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands (the “Company”);

 

(2)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part A (Original Borrowers) of Schedule 1 (The Obligors) as the original borrowers (the “Original Borrowers”);

 

(3)

THE ENTITIES listed in Part B (Original Guarantors) of Schedule 1 (The Obligors) as the original guarantors (the “Original Guarantors”);

 

(4)

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part A (Increasing Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders) (the “Increasing Lenders”);

 

(5)

THE FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS listed in Part B (New Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders) as the new lenders (the “New Lenders”);

 

(6)

CITIBANK EUROPE PLC, UK BRANCH as facility agent of the other Finance Parties (the “Facility Agent”); and

 

(7)

HSBC SECURITIES (USA), INC. as Sustainability Structuring Agent (as defined in the Amended Facilities Agreement (as defined below)).

WHEREAS:

 

(A)

The Company, the Original Borrowers, the Original Guarantors, the Facility Agent and the financial institutions named therein as Original Lenders entered into a revolving and L/C facilities agreement originally dated 18 October 2019 pursuant to which the Lenders made available to the Original Borrowers a Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount of $235,000,000 and a L/C Facility in an aggregate amount of $20,000,000 (each as defined therein) (the “2019 Facilities Agreement”, and as amended pursuant to the 2020 Amendment Agreement (as defined below) the “Original Facilities Agreement”).

 

(B)

The Company and, among others, the Facility Agent entered into an amendment agreement dated 11 November 2020 (the “2020 Amendment Agreement”) relating to the 2019 Facilities Agreement. Pursuant to the 2020 Amendment Agreement the Increasing Lender and the New Lenders (each as defined therein) agreed to upsize the Commitments available under the Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount not to exceed $162,500,000.

 

(C)

Pursuant to an upsize request letter dated on or about the date of this Amendment Agreement between the Company and the Facility Agent, the Company has requested that the Existing Lenders (as defined therein) consent to a further upsize of the Commitments available under the Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount not to exceed $625,000,000 (the “Upsize Request Letter”).

 

(D)

Pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter, the Increasing Lenders and the New Lenders confirmed their intention to participate in the upsize to the Revolving Facility described therein.

 

(E)

The Facility Agent, for itself and on behalf of the Finance Parties, and the Obligors have agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement in order to amend the terms of the Original Facilities Agreement in accordance with Clause 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement).

 

(F)

The Facility Agent has been authorised to enter into this Amendment Agreement by the requisite Existing Lenders pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter.

 

1


(G)

The Increasing Lenders have agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement to confirm the amount of additional Commitment confirmed by the Company pursuant to the Form of Response (as defined in the Upsize Request Letter) which was submitted by each Increasing Lender.

 

(G)

The New Lenders have agreed to enter into this Amendment Agreement and become “Lenders” under and in accordance with the Original Facilities Agreement (as amended by this Amendment Agreement).

 

NOW

IT IS HEREBY AGREED:

 

1.

DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

 

1.1

Definitions

In this Amendment Agreement:

Amended Facilities Agreement” means the Original Facilities Agreement, as amended by this Amendment Agreement.

Effective Date” means the date on which the “Effective Time” (as defined in the Upsize Request Letter) occurs.

 

1.2

Incorporation of defined terms

 

  (a)

Unless a contrary indication appears, a term defined in the Original Facilities Agreement has the same meaning when used herein.

 

  (b)

The principles of construction set out in clause 1 (Definitions and Interpretation) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall also apply in the interpretation hereof as if expressly set out herein with each reference to the “Agreement” being deemed to be a reference to this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.3

Clauses

In this Amendment Agreement, any reference to a “Clause” or a “Schedule” is, unless the context otherwise requires, a Clause of or a Schedule to this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.4

Third party rights

Unless expressly provided to the contrary in a Finance Document, a person who is not a party to this Amendment Agreement has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 to enforce or to enjoy the benefit of any term of this Amendment Agreement.

 

1.5

Designation

In accordance with the Original Facilities Agreement, each of the Company and the Facility Agent designate this Amendment Agreement as a Finance Document.

 

2.

EFFECTIVE DATE

Subject to:

 

  (a)

no Event of Default having occurred which is continuing; and

 

2


  (b)

the representations and warranties set out in Clause 3 (Representations) of this Amendment Agreement being true and accurate, the amendments to the Original Facilities Agreement referred to in Clause 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement) shall take effect on the Effective Date in accordance with their terms. If the Effective Date has not occurred by (and including) 11.59 p.m. on 31 January 2022 (or such later date as the Facility Agent acting on the instructions of the Finance Parties may agree) none of the amendments referred to in Clause 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement) will take effect.

 

3.

REPRESENTATIONS

On the date of this Amendment Agreement and at the Effective Date, the Company and each Obligor confirm that the Repeating Representations to be made by it are true in all material respects.

 

4.

AMENDMENTS TO ORIGINAL FACILITIES AGREEMENT

 

4.1

With effect from the Effective Date, the Original Facilities Agreement shall be amended as set out in Schedule 4 (Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement).

 

4.2

With effect from the Effective Date, the Total Revolving Facility Commitments shall be increased by $625,000,000 to $1,000,000,000 such that:

 

  (a)

each New Lender will become a Lender under the Amended Facilities Agreement with a Revolving Facility Commitment as set out in the relevant column opposite its name in Part B (New Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders);

 

  (b)

each Increasing Lender will remain a Lender under the Amended Facilities Agreement with a Revolving Facility Commitment as set out opposite its name in Part A (Increasing Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders), such amount including any additional Commitment assumed by it pursuant to the Upsize Request Letter;

 

  (c)

each New Lender shall become a party to the Amended Facilities Agreement, any other relevant Finance Document as a “Lender” and will assume the same rights and obligations to the other Finance Parties as if it had been party to the Amended Facilities Agreement as an “Original Lender”; and

 

  (d)

the Revolving Facility Commitments of Commerzbank AG and ING Bank, A Branch of ING-DIBA AG shall be reduced to zero notwithstanding the requirements of Clause 11.3 (Voluntary cancellation) to provide ten Business Days’ notice and to reduce the Commitments of the Lenders under the Revolving Facility rateably.

 

4.3

To the extent any Revolving Facility Loans are outstanding on the Effective Date, the relevant Borrower shall prepay the participations of Commerzbank AG and ING Bank, A Branch of ING-DIBA AG under those Revolving Facility Loans in full (together with all accrued interest, Break Costs and all other amounts accrued under the Finance Documents in respect of such participation) notwithstanding the requirements of Clause 11.4 (Voluntary prepayment of Utilisations) to provide 5 Business Days’ notice and Clause 13.8 (Application of prepayments) for any prepayment to be applied pro rata to each Lenders’ participation in that Loan.

 

4.4

Subject to the terms of this Amendment Agreement, the Original Facilities Agreement will remain in full force and effect and as from the Effective Date references in the Original Facilities Agreement to “this Agreement”, “hereunder”, “herein” and like terms or to any provision of the Original Facilities Agreement shall be construed as a reference to the Original Facilities Agreement, or such provision, as amended by this Amendment Agreement.

 

3


4.5

Except as otherwise provided in this Amendment Agreement, the Finance Documents remain in full force and effect.

 

5.

NEW LENDER CONFIRMATIONS

 

5.1

Each New Lender confirms for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor that it can exempt the Facility Agent from the restrictions pursuant to section 181 of the German Civil Code (Bürgerliches Gesetzbuch) and similar restrictions applicable to it pursuant to any other law as provided for in paragraph (c) of clause 32.1 (Appointment of the Facility Agent) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

5.2

Each New Lender confirms for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor that:

 

  (a)

it is not a Sponsor Affiliate; and

 

  (b)

it is not a Loan-to-Own/Distressed Investor or an Industry Competitor.

 

5.3

Each New Lender listed in Part B (New Lenders) of Schedule 2 (The Lenders) confirms, for the benefit of the Facility Agent and without any liability to any Obligor, that its status for the purpose of clause 18.4 (Lender status confirmation) of the Amended Facilities Agreement is as set out against its name in that Part B.

 

5.4

Each New Lender expressly acknowledges the limitations on the Existing Lender’s obligations set out in paragraph (c) of clause 29.5 (Limitation of responsibility of Existing Lenders) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

5.5

Each New Lender has delivered to the Facility Agent its Facility Office details and address, email address, fax number and attention details for notices for the purposes of clause 38.2 (Addressees) of the Amended Facilities Agreement.

 

6.

GUARANTEE AND SECURITY CONFIRMATION

Each Obligor hereby represents, warrants, reaffirms and confirms to and for the benefit of each Finance Party on the date hereof and on the Effective Date that:

 

  (a)

the Security granted by the Obligors pursuant to the Transaction Security Documents will secure, without limitation, all of the obligations of the Obligors under the Finance Documents notwithstanding the amendments to the Original Facilities Agreement contemplated by this Amendment Agreement and extend to any new obligations assumed by any Obligor under the Finance Documents as a result of the Upsize Request Letter or this Amendment Agreement;

 

  (b)

that the execution and delivery of the Upsize Request Letter or this Amendment Agreement shall not operate as a waiver of any right, power or remedy of the Facility Agent or any secured party under any Transaction Security Document or serve to effect a novation of the obligations of the Obligors; and

 

  (c)

the guarantee and indemnity obligations of it pursuant to clause 22 (Guarantee and Indemnity) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall:

 

  (i)

remain in full force and effect notwithstanding any amendments to the Original Facilities Agreement contemplated by this Amendment Agreement; and

 

  (ii)

extend to any new obligations assumed by any Obligor under the Finance Documents as a result of the Upsize Request Letter or this Amendment Agreement.

 

4


7.

CONDITIONS SUBSEQUENT

The Company shall procure that, within ninety (90) days after the Effective Date:

 

  (a)

the following security documents are entered into:

 

  (i)

a Dutch law second ranking pledge relating to the Dutch law deed of pledge of shares dated 28 January 2021 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as Pledgor), the Security Agent (as Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V. (as Company);

 

  (ii)

a Dutch law second ranking pledge relating to the Dutch law agreement and deed of pledge of cooperative membership interests dated 28 January 2021 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and GLOBALFOUNDRIES Investments LLC (as Pledgors), the Security Agent (as Pledgee) and GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Coöperatief U.A. (as Cooperative),

(the documents set out in paragraphs (i) and (ii) above together, being the “Dutch Supplemental CS Security Documents”); and

 

  (iii)

a Singapore law governed supplemental share security between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and the Security Agent relating to the Singapore share charge dated 28 January 2021 between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. and the Security Agent (the “Singapore Supplemental CS Security Document” and, together with the Dutch Supplemental CS Security Documents, the “Supplemental CS Security Documents”).

 

  (b)

the Facility Agent is provided with:

 

  (i)

a copy of each of the relevant Supplemental CS Security Documents;

 

  (ii)

a legal opinion of Clifford Chance Pte. Ltd. as to the enforceability of the Singapore Supplemental CS Security Document in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Lenders;

 

  (iii)

a legal opinion of the following legal advisors to the Company and the Original Guarantors:

 

  (A)

Maples and Calder as to Cayman Islands law;

 

  (B)

Hogan Lovells LLP as to Dutch Law,

each in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Lenders;

 

  (iv)

a certified copy of the relevant updated members / shareholders register (as applicable) reflecting the Dutch Supplemental CS Security Documents; and

 

  (v)

a certified copy of the updated register of mortgages and charges of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. reflecting the entry of the Singapore Supplemental CS Security Document.

 

8.

COSTS AND EXPENSES

The Company shall within five (5) Business Days of demand pay to the Facility Agent the amount of all pre-approved reasonable and documented costs and expenses (including legal fees but excluding any allocations of overhead or internal costs) payable pursuant to clause 23.2 (Amendment costs) of the Original Facilities Agreement in connection with this Amendment Agreement.

 

5


9.

MISCELLANEOUS

 

9.1

Clauses 38 (Notices), 40 (Partial Invalidity) and 50 (Enforcement) of the Original Facilities Agreement shall be deemed incorporated in this Amendment Agreement (with such conforming amendments as the context requires) as if set out herein with each reference to the “Agreement” being deemed to be a reference to this Amendment Agreement.

 

9.2

Any signature (including, without limitation, (x) any electronic symbol or process attached to, or associated with, a contract or other record and adopted by a person with the intent to sign, authenticate or accept such contract or record and (y) any facsimile, E-pencil or .pdf signature) to this Amendment Agreement through electronic means, shall have the same legal validity and enforceability as a manually executed signature or use of a paper-based record-keeping system to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law.

 

9.3

This Amendment Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and this has the same effect as if the signatures on the counterparts were on a single copy of this Amendment Agreement. Delivery of a counterpart of this Amendment Agreement by e-mail attachment or telecopy shall be an effective mode of delivery.

 

10.

GOVERNING LAW

This Letter is governed by and shall be construed in accordance with English law. Any non-contractual obligations arising out of or in connection with this Letter are governed by English law.

AS WITNESS the hands of the duly authorised representatives of the parties hereto the day and year first above written.

 

6


SCHEDULE 1

THE OBLIGORS

Part A – The Original Borrowers

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

Part B – Original Guarantors

 

1.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc.

 

2.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

3.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

4.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Singapore Pte. Ltd.

 

5.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. Inc.

 

6.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Netherlands Holding B.V.

 

7.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Management Services Limited Liability Company & Co. KG

 

8.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

 

9.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One Holding GmbH

 

10.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

 

11.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two Holding GmbH

 

12.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (Netherlands) Cooperatief U.A.

 

13.

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

 

7


SCHEDULE 2

THE LENDERS

Part A – Increasing Lenders

 

Name of Increasing Lender    Revolving Facility
Commitments as
at the Effective
Date
 

Bank of America, N.A.

   $ 118,000,000  

DBS Bank Ltd.

   $ 118,000,000  

Intesa Sanpaolo S.P.A., London Branch

   $ 118,000,000  

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

   $ 118,000,000  

Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc.

   $ 118,000,000  

Citibank, N.A.

   $ 90,000,000  

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 90,000,000  

Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch

   $ 90,000,000  

Part B – New Lenders

 

Name of New Lender    Revolving Facility
Commitments as at the
Effective Date
   Lender Status Confirmation
HSBC Bank USA, National Association    $90,000,000   

Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender

A US Qualifying Lender

A German Treaty Lender

First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC    $50,000,000   

Not a Singapore Qualifying Lender

Not a US Qualifying Lender

Not a German Qualifying Lender

 

8


SCHEDULE 3

Conditions Precedent

 

1.

Corporate Formalities

 

  (a)

A copy of the constitutional documents of each Original Obligor (including for any German Original Obligor (i) an up-to-date electronic chronological commercial register extract (elektronischer chronologischer Handelsregisterausdruck), (ii) its articles of association (Satzung) or partnership agreement (Gesellschaftsvertrag), as applicable, as well as copies of any by-laws and (iii) if applicable, its list of shareholders).

 

  (b)

A copy of a good standing certificate with respect to each US Obligor, issued as of a recent date by the Secretary of State or other appropriate official of each US Obligor’s jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation.

 

  (c)

A copy of a resolution of in respect of any Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor), its board of directors or board of managers, as applicable:

 

  (i)

approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Amendment Agreement and resolving that it execute such document;

 

  (ii)

authorising a specified person or persons to execute the Amendment Agreement on its behalf; and

 

  (iii)

authorising a specified person or persons, on its behalf, to sign and/or despatch all documents and notices to be signed and/or despatched by it under or in connection with the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (d)

A specimen of the signature of person(s) authorised by the resolution referred to in paragraph (c) above or otherwise.

 

  (e)

If required, a copy of a resolution of the holders of the issued shares and/or interests, as applicable in each Original Obligor (and/or, if applicable, by the supervisory board (Aufsichtsrat) and/or advisory board (Beirat) of such German Original Obligor), approving the terms of, and the transactions contemplated by, the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (f)

A certificate of each Original Obligor (other than in respect of a German Original Obligor) (signed by an Authorised Officer) confirming that borrowing, securing or guaranteeing, as appropriate, the Total Commitments would not cause any borrowing, securing, guaranteeing or similar limit binding on such Original Obligor to be exceeded.

 

  (g)

A certificate of an Authorised Officer of the relevant Original Obligor certifying that each copy document relating to it specified in this paragraph 1 of this Schedule 3 (Conditions Precedent) is correct, complete and in full force and effect as at a date no earlier than the date of the Amendment Agreement.

 

  (h)

A certificate of good standing of the Company as issued by the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands and dated within thirty (30) days of the Amendment Agreement.

 

2.

Legal Opinions

 

  (a)

A legal opinion of Clifford Chance LLP as to the law of England & Wales, as to the enforceability of the Amendment Agreement, in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Increasing Lenders and the New Lenders.

 

  (b)

A legal opinion of the following legal advisers to the Company and the Original Obligors:

 

9


  (i)

Shearman & Sterling LLP as to German law;

 

  (ii)

Maples and Calder as to Cayman Islands law;

 

  (iii)

Dentons Rodyk & Davidson LLP as to Singaporean law;

 

  (iv)

Hogan Lovells International LLP as to Dutch law; and

 

  (v)

Richards, Layton & Finger, P.A. as to Delaware law,

each in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Increasing Lenders and the New Lenders.

 

10


SCHEDULE 4

Amendments to Original Facilities Agreement

 

(1)

On the front page, adding:

“- and -

HSBC SECURITIES (USA), INC.

as Sustainability Structuring Agent”

 

(2)

In the parties clause:

 

  (a)

adding:

 

  “(8)

HSBC SECURITIES (USA), INC. as sustainability structuring agent (the “Sustainability Structuring Agent”).”; and

 

  (b)

deleting “and” at the end of paragraph (6) thereof and the replacing the full stop at the end of paragraph (7) thereof with “; and”.

 

(3)

In Clause 1.1 (Definitions) of the Original Facilities Agreement:

 

  (a)

adding the following new definitions such that they appear listed in this clause in alphabetical order:

“”2021 Amendment Agreement” means the amendment agreement relating to this Agreement dated ___ October 2021 between, amongst others, the Company and the Facility Agent.”;

“”2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date” means the date of the 2021 Amendment Agreement.”;

2021 Effective Date” has the meaning given to the term “Effective Date” in the 2021 Amendment Agreement.”;

“”2021 Upsize” means the upsize of the Revolving Facility in an aggregate amount of up to $625,000,000 which became effective on the 2021 Effective Date.”;

ESG KPIs” means the relevant environmental, social and governance key performance indicators which apply to the Group as defined in Schedule 23 (Sustainability Target Values), as the same may be amended from time to time by the Company and subject to the consent of the Majority Lenders.”;

“”Sustainability Adjustment” has the meaning given to that term in the definition of “Margin”.”;

“”Sustainability Certificate” means the certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 24 (Form of Sustainability Certificate).”;

“”Sustainability Target Value” means in respect of a Financial Year, the value or percentage specified opposite an ESG KPI for that Financial Year in Schedule 23 (Sustainability Target Values), as the same may be updated from time to time by the Company and subject to the consent of the Majority Lenders.”;

 

11


  (b)

deleting the definition of “Change of Control” and replacing it with:

“”Change of Control” means the occurrence of an event resulting in (i) an entity wholly owned (directly or indirectly) by the government of the Emirate of Abu Dhabi ceasing to Control the Company; or (ii) the Company ceasing to Control any Borrower, other than (in the case of paragraph (i) only) pursuant to a public offering (and/or international and/or domestic private placement to institutional investors) on any stock exchange of the shares of common stock or common equity interests of the Company (or any holding company of the Company), whether by the issuance of new common stock or equity interests or the sale of existing common stock or equity interests, which occurs on a date following 18 months after the 2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date.”;

 

  (c)

deleting the definition of “Final Maturity Date” and replacing it with:

“”Final Maturity Date” means:

 

  (a)

in relation to the Additional L/C Facility, the date falling five (5) years after the 2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date;

 

  (b)

in relation to the Revolving Facility, the date falling five (5) years after the 2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date.”;

 

  (d)

deleting the definition of “Increasing Lender” and replacing it with:

““Increasing Lender” means each Lender (which is not an Original Lender) which participates in the 2020 Upsize or the 2021 Upsize, for so long as it holds the Commitments assumed by it pursuant to the 2020 Upsize and/or the 2021 Upsize (as applicable).”;

 

  (e)

deleting paragraph (a) of the definition of “Margin” and replacing it with:

“(a) in relation to any Revolving Facility Loan means 2.25% per annum, commencing on the 2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date, and subject to Clause 14.5 (Sustainability), as adjusted (if at all) (the “Sustainability Adjustment”) in accordance with the grid set out below relating to the Sustainability Target Value achieved by the Group with respect to the ESG KPIs for the immediately preceding Financial Year (as evidenced by the Sustainability Certificate relating to the immediately preceding Financial Year):

 

Sustainability Target Value

  

Applicable Margin (per annum) per
ESG KPI

ESG KPI 1

  

ESG KPI met = minus 0.025%

ESG KPI not met = plus 0.025%

ESG KPI 2

  

ESG KPI met = minus 0.025%

ESG KPI is <20% = plus 0.025%

ESG KPI 3

  

ESG KPI met = minus 0.025%

ESG KPI is £170 = plus 0.025%

 

  (f)

deleting the definition of “Total Revolving Facility Commitments” and replacing it with “means the aggregate Revolving Facility Commitments, being $1,000,000,000 as at the Effective Date”.

 

12


(4)

Deleting subparagraphs (i) and (ii) of paragraph (a) of Clause 17.1 (Commitment Fee) and replacing them with:

 

  (i)

in relation to the Additional L/C Facility, 20.0% of the applicable Margin for the Availability Period applicable to the Additional L/C Facility; and

 

  (ii)

in relation to the Revolving Facility, 20.0% of the applicable Margin for the Availability Period applicable to the Revolving Facility.

 

(5)

Adding a new Clause 14.5 (Sustainability), as follows:

 

  (a)

The Company shall supply to the Facility Agent and each Lender, within 180 days after the end of every Financial Year, commencing with the Financial Year ending on 31 December 2021:

 

  (i)

a duly completed Sustainability Certificate signed by an authorised signatory of the Company; and

 

  (ii)

information in reasonable detail on the ESG KPIs and the Group’s performance in respect of the ESG KPIs for the relevant Financial Year and, to the extent applicable for the relevant ESG KPI, independent verification or a negative assurance statement from any auditing or consulting firm designated from time to time by the Borrower (or any replacement firm thereof as designated from time to time by the Borrower);

 

  (b)

The Margin will be adjusted by the Sustainability Adjustment (if at all) for that Financial Year and any such adjustment to take effect from the date which is three (3) Business Days after the Company has delivered a Sustainability Certificate and the information referred to in Clause 14.5 (a)(ii).

 

  (c)

No Event of Default will occur by reason only of a failure by the Company to not meet any ESG KPI or comply with this Clause 14.5.

 

(6)

Deleting paragraph (b) of Clause 15.1 (Selection) and replacing with:

 

  (b)

Subject to this Clause 15, a Borrower (or the Company) may select an Interest Period of one (1), three (3) or six (6) Months or any other period agreed between the Company and the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions of all the Lenders in relation to the relevant Loan).

 

(7)

Adding a new paragraph 17.1(d), as follows:

In addition to the times specified in Clause 17.1(b) above, the accrued commitment fee is also payable on the 2021 Effective Date to Lenders with Commitments immediately prior to the occurrence of the 2021 Effective Date.

 

(8)

Adding a new Clause 32.20 (Amounts paid in error), as follows:

 

  (a)

If the Agent pays an amount to another Party and the Agent notifies that Party that such payment was an Erroneous Payment then the Party to whom that amount was paid by the Agent shall on demand refund the same to the Agent together with interest on that amount from the date of payment to the date of receipt by the Agent, calculated by the Agent to reflect its cost of funds.

 

  (b)

Neither:

 

  (i)

the obligations of any Party to the Agent; nor

 

  (ii)

the remedies of the Agent,

 

13


(whether arising under this Clause 32.30 or otherwise) which relate to an Erroneous Payment will be affected by any act, omission, matter or thing (including, without limitation, any obligation pursuant to which an Erroneous Payment is made) which, but for this paragraph (b), would reduce, release, preclude or prejudice any such obligation or remedy (whether or not known by the Agent or any other Party).

 

  (c)

All payments to be made by a Party to the Agent (whether made pursuant to this Clause 32.30 or otherwise) which relate to an Erroneous Payment shall be calculated and be made without (and free and clear of any deduction for) set-off or counterclaim.

 

  (d)

In this Agreement, “Erroneous Payment” means a payment of an amount by the Agent to another Party which the Agent determines (in its sole discretion) was made in error.”

 

(9)

Adding a new Clause 32.21 (Sustainability Structuring Agent), as follows:

“The Company appoints the Sustainability Structuring Agent as sustainability structuring agent in connection with the provisions relating to environmental, social and governance requirements in accordance with the terms of the mandate letter dated on or around the 2021 Amendment Agreement Signing Date between the Sustainability Structuring Agent and the Company.”

 

(10)

In Schedule 1 (The Original Parties) of the Original Facilities Agreement there shall be a new Part D (Commitments following the 2021 Effective Date) inserted which shall read as follows:

Part D

Commitments following the 2021 Effective Date

 

Name of Lender    Revolving Facility
Commitments
     Additional L/C Facility
Commitments
 

Bank of America, N.A.

   $ 118,000,000        —    

Citibank, N.A.

   $ 90,000,000      $ 20,000,000  

Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch

   $ 90,000,000        —    

DBS Bank Ltd.

   $ 118,000,000        —    

Deutsche Bank AG

   $ 90,000,000        —    

First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC

   $ 50,000,000        —    

HSBC Bank USA, National Association

   $ 90,000,000        —    

Intesa Sanpaolo S.P.A., London Branch

   $ 118,000,000        —    

JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

   $ 118,000,000        —    

Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc.

   $ 118,000,000        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
        

Total Commitments

   $ 1,000,000,000      $ 20,000,000  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
        

 

(11)

Adding a new Schedule 23 (Sustainability Target Values), as follows:

 

14


SCHEDULE 23

SUSTAINABILITY TARGET VALUES

ESG KPIs

 

ESG KPIs

   Initial Score     Sustainability Target Value  
     2020     2021     2022     2023     2024     2025  

ESG KPI 1

     N/A       2,000       15,000       45,000       64,000       80,000  

ESG KPI 2

    
20% Women /
Minorities
 
 
   


>25%

Women /
Minorities

 

 
 

   


>25%

Women /
Minorities

 

 
 

   


>25%

Women /
Minorities

 

 
 

   


>25%

Women /
Minorities

 

 
 

   


>35%

Women /
Minorities

 

 
 

ESG KPI 3

    



170

(RBA
average after closure
audit)

 

 
 
 

    ³180       ³180       ³180       ³180       ³180  

In this Schedule 23 (Sustainability Target Values):

 

(a)

“ESG KPI 1” means reductions measured in MTCE (Metric Tons of Carbon Equivalents) of greenhouse gas emissions on an annualised basis achieved by greenhouse gas emissions projects implemented by the Group.

 

(b)

“ESG KPI 2” means the percentage of the Company’s board of directors that do not identify as male or come from an underrepresented minority.

 

(c)

“ESG KPI 3” means the average validated assessment program score in respect of Responsible Business Alliance (RBA) Audits.

 

(12)

Adding a new Schedule 24 (Form of Sustainability Certificate), as follows:

SCHEDULE 24

FORM OF SUSTAINABILITY CERTIFICATE

From:    [•] as the Company

Dated:    [•] 2021

GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. – Revolving and L/C Facilities Agreement dated [•] 2019 (the

“Facilities Agreement”)

 

1.

We refer to the Facilities Agreement. This is a Sustainability Certificate. Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement have the same meaning when used in this Sustainability Certificate unless given a different meaning in this Sustainability Certificate.

 

2.

We confirm that in respect of [year], the ESG KPIs are as follows:

 

  a.

ESG KPI 1 equal to [ and therefore is [equal to or above] / [below] the applicable Sustainability Target Value for [year];

 

15


  b.

ESG KPI 2 equal to [ and therefore is [equal to or above] / [below] the applicable Sustainability Target Value for [year];

 

  c.

ESG KPI 3 equal to [ and therefore is [equal to or above] / [below] the applicable Sustainability Target Value for [year];

and in accordance with Clause 14.5 of the Facilities Agreement, the Margin shall be [•] per cent, per annum.

 

3.

The Borrower confirms that the ESG KPIs referred to in paragraph 2 above have been calculated using substantially the same methodology as that used to set the Sustainability Target Value [and to the extent applicable, [the relevant independent verification or negative assurance statement is attached] / [reasonable detail of determination of ESG KPI to be attached]].1

 

Signed  

 

 

Authorised Signatory for

and on behalf of

  [Company]

 

1 

Reasonable detail of determination of ESG KPI not required where independent verification or negative assurance statement is attached.

 

16


SIGNATORIES

THE COMPANY

 

 

 

Name: David Reeder
Title: CFO
For and on behalf of GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC. as Company  

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE ORIGINAL BORROWERS
 

 

Name: David Reeder
Title: CFO

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as an Original Borrower

 

 

 

Name: Theodore Castro
Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

as an Original Borrower

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar

Title: Secretary

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

as an Original Borrower

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE ORIGINAL GUARANTORS
 

 

Name: David Reeder
Title: CFO

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Theodore Castro
Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES SINGAPORE PTE. LTD.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Secretary

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. INC.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module One LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Dirk Gasse
Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES NETHERLANDS HOLDING B.V.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES MANAGEMENT SERVICES LIMITED LIABILITY

COMPANY & CO. KG

represented by its general partner GLOBALFOUNDRIES Dresden Module Two LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE ONE HOLDING GMBH

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Manager

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Samak L. Azar
Title: Managing Director (Geschäftsführer)

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES DRESDEN MODULE TWO HOLDING GMBH

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


 

 

     

 

Name: Carmine Joseph Mele

   

Name: Dirk Gasse

Title: Management Board Member A

   

Title: Management Board Member B

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES (NETHERLANDS) COÖPERATIEF U.A.

as an Original Guarantor

 

 

 

Name: Michael Cadigan

Title: Director

For and on behalf of

GLOBALFOUNDRIES U.S. 2 LLC

as an Original Guarantor

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE NEW LENDERS

 

FIRST ABU DHABI BANK PJSC
By:    
Name:  

 

By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


HSBC BANK USA, NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE INCREASING LENDERS
BANK OF AMERICA, N.A.
By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


CITIBANK, N.A.

By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


CREDIT SUISSE AG, CAYMAN ISLANDS BRANCH

By:    
Name:  
Title:  
By:    
Name:  
Title:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


DBS BANK LTD.

By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


DEUTSCHE BANK AG

By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


INTESA SANPAOLO S.P.A., LONDON BRANCH

By:    
Name:  
By:    
Name:  

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


JPMORGAN CHASE BANK, N.A.
By:    
Name:
By:    
Name:

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


MORGAN STANLEY SENIOR FUNDING, INC.
By:    
Name:

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE FACILITY AGENT
 
Name:

For and on behalf of

Citibank Europe Plc, UK Branch

in its capacity as Facility Agent

(acting on the instructions of the requisite Lenders)

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]


THE SUSTAINABILITY STRUCTURING AGENT
 

 

Name:

For and on behalf of

HSBC Securities (USA), Inc.

 

[Signature Page – 2021 Amendment Agreement (2019 RCF)]

EX-10.15

Exhibit 10.15

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

SHARE PURCHASE AGREEMENT

October 18, 2021

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

         Page  

1.     Purchase and Sale of Shares

     1  

1.1

  Sale and Issuance of Ordinary Shares      1  

1.2

  Closing      1  

2.     Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Company

     1  

2.1

  Organization, Good Standing and Qualification      1  

2.2

  Authorization      2  

2.3

  Valid Issuance of Ordinary Shares; No Consent      2  

2.4

  Compliance with Other Instruments      2  

2.5

  Description of Share Capital      2  

2.6

  Registration Statement      3  

2.7

  Brokers or Finders      3  

2.8

  Private Placement      3  

2.9

  Most Favored Nation      3  

2.10

  Matters Related to Immunity      4  

2.11

  Legality      4  

2.12

  Removal of Restrictive Legends      4  

3.     Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Investors

     4  

3.1

  Organization, Good Standing and Qualification      4  

3.2

  Authorization      4  

3.3

  Purchase Entirely for Own Account      4  

3.4

  Disclosure of Information      5  

3.5

  Investment Experience      5  

3.6

  Accredited Investor      5  

3.7

  Brokers or Finders      5  

3.8

  Restricted Securities      5  

3.9

  Legends      5  

4. Conditions of each Investor’s Obligations at Closing

     6  

4.1

  Representations and Warranties      6  

4.2

  Public Offering Shares      6  

4.3

  Absence of Injunctions, Decrees, Etc      6  

5. Conditions of the Company’s Obligations at Closing

     6  

5.1

  Representations, Warranties and Covenants      6  

5.2

  Public Offering Shares      6  

5.3

  Absence of Injunctions, Decrees, Etc      6  

6.     Termination

     6  

7.     Miscellaneous

     6  

7.1

  Publicity      6  

7.2

  Survival of Warranties, Representations and Covenants      7  

7.3

  Successors and Assigns      7  

7.4

  Governing Law      7  

7.5

  Counterparts      7  

 

i


7.6

  Notices      7  

7.7

  Brokers or Finders      8  

7.8

  Amendments and Waivers      8  

7.9

  Severability      8  

7.10

  Entire Agreement      8  

7.11

  Specific Performance      8  

7.12

  No Recourse.      9  

7.13

  Submission to Jurisdiction      9  

 

 

ii


GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.

SHARE PURCHASE AGREEMENT

THIS SHARE PURCHASE AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”) is made as of October 18, 2021, by and between GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., a Cayman Islands exempted company (the “Company”), Silver Lake Partners VI Cayman, L.P., a Cayman Islands limited partnership (“SL Cayman”) and Silver Lake Technology Investors VI Cayman (AIV II), L.P., a Cayman Islands limited partnership (“SLTI Cayman” and together with SL Cayman, the “Investors”).

THE PARTIES HEREBY AGREE AS FOLLOWS:

1. Purchase and Sale of Shares.

1.1 Sale and Issuance of Ordinary Shares. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the Investors agree to purchase from the Company, and the Company agrees to sell and issue to SL Cayman and SLTI Cayman, ordinary shares of the Company, par value $0.02 per share (the “Ordinary Shares”), at a price per share equal to the per share initial public offering price (before underwriting discounts and expenses) in the Qualified IPO (as defined below) (the “IPO Price”). The Company agrees to sell and issue to SL Cayman Ordinary Shares equal to $69,540,000 divided by the IPO Price and to sell and issue to SLTI Cayman Ordinary Shares equal to $5,460,000 divided by the IPO Price, such number of shares rounded down to the nearest whole share (with the total purchase price correspondingly reduced for such fractional share amount). The Ordinary Shares to be issued and sold to the Investors pursuant to this Agreement are referred to as the “Shares.” “Qualified IPO” shall mean the issuance and sale of Ordinary Shares by the Company, pursuant to an Underwriting Agreement to be entered into by and among the Company, certain selling shareholders and certain underwriters (the “Underwriters”), in connection with the Company’s initial public offering pursuant to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-260003) (the “Registration Statement”) and/or any related registration statements (the “Underwriting Agreement”), in an amount such that the aggregate gross proceeds of Ordinary Shares issued and sold by the Company pursuant to this Agreement and the Underwriting Agreement, taken together (and for the avoidance of doubt, excluding Ordinary Shares sold by any shareholder of the Company), is at least $1,250,000,000 (before underwriting discounts and fees and expenses).

1.2 Closing. The purchase and sale of the Shares shall take place at the location and at the time immediately subsequent to the closing of the Qualified IPO (which time and place are designated as the “Closing”). At the Closing, each Investor shall make payment of the purchase price of the Shares to be purchased by it by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account specified by the Company against delivery to such Investor of such Shares registered in the name of such Investor, which Shares shall be uncertificated shares.

2. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Company. The Company hereby represents and warrants to the Investors that as of the date hereof and as of the date of the Closing:

2.1 Organization, Good Standing and Qualification.

(a) The Company is an exempted company with limited liability duly incorporated, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the Cayman Islands and has all requisite corporate power and authority to carry on its business as now conducted.


(b) The Company is duly qualified to transact business and is in good standing in each jurisdiction in which it is required to be so qualified or in good standing, except where the failure to so qualify or be in good standing would not be material and adverse to the Company.

2.2 Authorization. All corporate action on the part of the Company, its officers, directors and shareholders necessary for the authorization, execution and delivery of this Agreement, the performance of all obligations of the Company under this Agreement, and the authorization, issuance, sale and delivery of the Shares being sold hereunder has been taken, and this Agreement constitutes a valid and legally binding obligation of the Company, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except (i) as limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, and other laws of general application affecting enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and (ii) as limited by laws relating to the availability of specific performance, injunctive relief, or other equitable remedies.

2.3 Valid Issuance of Ordinary Shares; No Consent. The Shares being purchased by the Investors hereunder, when issued, sold and delivered in accordance with the terms of this Agreement for the consideration expressed herein, will be duly and validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable and will be free of liens, encumbrances and restrictions on transfer (including preemptive and other similar rights) other than restrictions on transfer absent registration under applicable securities laws. The issuance of the Shares is not subject to any preemptive or similar rights. No consent, approval, order or authorization of, or registration, qualification, designation, declaration or filing with, any governmental authority on the part of the Company is required in connection with the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, except any filings required by applicable U.S. state “blue sky” securities laws, rules and regulations.

2.4 Compliance with Other Instruments.

(a) The Company is not in violation or default of any provision of its Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association (“Charter”), as amended.

(b) Except as would not be material to the Company, the Company is not in violation or default of any instrument, judgment, order, writ, decree or contract to which it is a party or by which it is bound, or, to its knowledge, of any provision of any statute, rule or regulation applicable to the Company. The execution, delivery and performance of this Agreement, and the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement will not (i) result in any material violation or default or be in conflict with or constitute, with or without the passage of time and giving of notice, either a material default under any such provision, instrument, judgment, order, writ, decree or contract or an event that results in the creation of any material lien, charge or encumbrance upon any assets of the Company or the suspension, revocation, impairment, forfeiture, or nonrenewal of any material permit, license, authorization, or approval applicable to the Company, its business or operations or any of its assets or properties, (ii) result in any violation or default of its Charter, or (iii) result in any material violation of any law, statute, rule or regulation, or of any judgment or order of any court, arbitrator or governmental or regulatory authority, in each case applicable to the Company.

(c) The Company hereby represents, warrants and covenants to the Investors that the Shares will not represent more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of the Company immediately following the consummation of the transaction contemplated under Section 1 of this Agreement.

2.5 Description of Share Capital. (a) As of the date of this Agreement, the capitalization of the Company as set forth in the preliminary prospectus (as defined in the Underwriting Agreement) and Prospectus (as defined in the Underwriting Agreement) under the caption “Capitalization” is accurate and complete in all material respects.

 

2


(b) As of the date of the Closing, the statements set forth in the preliminary prospectus (as defined in the Underwriting Agreement) and Prospectus (as defined in the Underwriting Agreement) under the caption “Description of Share Capital,” insofar as they purport to constitute a summary of the terms of the Company’s share capital, are accurate, complete and fair in all material respects.

2.6 Registration Statement. The Registration Statement, and any amendment thereto, including any information deemed to be included therein pursuant to the rules and regulations of the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), complied (or, in the case of amendments filed after the date of this Agreement, will comply) as of its filing date in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder, and did not (or, in the case of amendments filed after the date hereof, will not) contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading. As of the date it is declared effective by the SEC, the Registration Statement, as so amended, and any related registration statements, will comply in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder, and will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading. Any preliminary prospectus included in the Registration Statement or any amendment thereto, any free writing prospectus related to the Registration Statement and any final prospectus related to the Registration Statement filed pursuant to Rule 424 promulgated under the Securities Act, in each case as of its date, will comply in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, and will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary in order to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

2.7 Brokers or Finders. The Company has not engaged any brokers, finders or agents such that the Investors will incur, directly or indirectly, as a result of any action taken by the Company, any liability for brokerage or finders’ fees or agents’ commissions or any similar charges in connection with the sale of the Shares contemplated by this Agreement.

2.8 Private Placement. Assuming the accuracy of the representations, warranties and covenants of the Investors set forth in Section 3 of this Agreement, no registration under the Securities Act is required for the offer and sale of the Shares by the Company to the Investors under this Agreement, and neither the Company nor any authorized agent acting on its behalf will take any action hereafter that would require such a registration.

2.9 Most Favored Nation. During the period from the date of this Agreement through the Closing, if the Company shall have entered into any additional, or modified any existing, agreements or arrangements with any existing or future investors in the Company that have the effect of issuing and/or selling Ordinary Shares or securities convertible into Ordinary Shares on terms and conditions that are more favorable to such investor in any respect than the terms and conditions of this Agreement in respect of the Investors, then the Company shall promptly advise the Investors of such fact (and the relevant terms and conditions) and (unless otherwise agreed by the Company and the Investors) this Agreement, without any further action of the Company or the Investors, shall be deemed automatically amended and modified to include such more favorable terms and conditions such that the Investors shall

 

3


receive the benefit of such more favorable terms and conditions. As of the date hereof, there are no such agreements or arrangements in place with any existing or future investors in the Company that have the effect of issuing and/or selling Ordinary Shares or securities convertible into Ordinary Shares on terms and conditions that are more favorable to such investor in any respect than the terms and conditions of this Agreement in respect of the Investors.

2.10 Matters Related to Immunity. The Company acknowledges and agrees that, in connection with this Agreement, it is acting in a commercial capacity and not as part of the instrumentality of a government to achieve a public function.

2.11 Legality. The legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility into evidence of any of the Registration Statement, this Agreement or the Shares in any jurisdiction in which the Company is organized or does business is not dependent upon such document being submitted into, filed or recorded with any court or other authority in any such jurisdiction on or before the date hereof or that any tax, imposition or charge be paid in any such jurisdiction on or in respect of any such document.

2.12 Removal of Restrictive Legends. In the event that the Shares become registered under the Securities Act or are eligible to be transferred without restriction in accordance with Rule 144 under the Securities Act, the Company shall (x) instruct the Company’s transfer agent to issue new uncertificated (book-entry) instruments representing the Shares, which shall not contain such portion of the above legend that is no longer applicable, (y) take all actions with the Company’s transfer agent reasonably requested by each Investor to permit such un-legended Shares to be deposited into the account(s) specified by such Investor to the Company in writing, and (z) instruct the Company’s transfer agent to cause such Shares to be assigned the same CUSIP as the Ordinary Shares; provided that, such Investor delivers a customary representation letter to the extent requested by the Company’s transfer agent.

3. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Investors. Each Investor hereby represents and warrants to the Company as follows:

3.1 Organization, Good Standing and Qualification. Each of SL Cayman and SLTI Cayman is an exempted limited partnership duly formed, registered, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of the Cayman Islands.

3.2 Authorization. Each Investor has full power and authority to enter into this Agreement, and this Agreement constitutes a valid and legally binding obligation of such Investor, enforceable in accordance with its terms except (i) as limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium and other laws of general application affecting enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and (ii) as limited by laws relating to the availability of specific performance, injunctive relief, or other equitable remedies.

3.3 Purchase Entirely for Own Account. By each Investor’s execution of this Agreement, such Investor hereby confirms, that the Shares to be received by such Investor will be acquired for investment for such Investor’s own account, not as a nominee or agent, and not with a view to the distribution of any part thereof, and that such Investor has no present intention of selling, granting any participation in, or otherwise distributing the same, except as permitted by applicable federal or state securities laws. By executing this Agreement, each Investor further represents that such Investor does not have any contract, undertaking, agreement or arrangement with any person to sell, transfer or grant participations to such person or to any third person, with respect to any of the Shares, except as permitted to be assigned pursuant to Section 7.3.

 

4


3.4 Disclosure of Information. Each Investor believes it has received all the information it considers necessary or appropriate for deciding whether to purchase the Shares. Each Investor further represents that it has had an opportunity to ask questions and receive answers from the Company regarding the terms and conditions of the offering of the Shares and the business, properties, prospects and financial condition of the Company. The foregoing, however, does not limit or modify the representations, warranties and covenants of the Company in Section 2 of this Agreement or the right of such Investor to rely thereon.

3.5 Investment Experience. Each Investor is an investor in securities of companies in the development stage and acknowledges that it is able to fend for itself, can bear the economic risk of its investment, and has such knowledge and experience in financial or business matters that it is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the investment in the Shares. Each Investor also represents it has not been organized for the purpose of acquiring the Shares.

3.6 Accredited Investor. Each Investor is an “accredited investor” within the meaning of Regulation D, Rule 501(a), promulgated by the SEC under the Securities Act, as presently in effect.

3.7 Brokers or Finders. Each Investor has not engaged any brokers, finders or agents such that the Company will incur, directly or indirectly, as a result of any action taken by such Investor, any liability for brokerage or finders’ fees or agents’ commissions or any similar charges in connection with the sale of the Shares contemplated by this Agreement.

3.8 Restricted Securities. Each Investor understands that the Shares will be characterized as “restricted securities” under the federal securities laws inasmuch as they are being acquired from the Company in a transaction not involving a public offering and that under such laws and applicable regulations such securities may be resold without registration under the Securities Act, only in certain limited circumstances. In this connection, each Investor represents that it is familiar with Rule 144 promulgated under the Securities Act, as presently in effect, and understands the resale limitations imposed thereby and by the Securities Act.

3.9 Legends. Each Investor understands that the Shares may bear one or all of the following legends:

(a) “THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED HEREBY HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “ACT”), OR UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY OTHER JURISDICTIONS. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED OR RESOLD EXCEPT AS PERMITTED UNDER THE ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS (PURSUANT TO REGISTRATION OR EXEMPTION THEREFROM). INVESTORS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT THEY MAY BE REQUIRED TO BEAR THE FINANCIAL RISKS OF THIS INVESTMENT FOR AN INDEFINITE PERIOD OF TIME. THE ISSUER OF THESE SECURITIES MAY REQUIRE AN OPINION OF COUNSEL IN FORM AND SUBSTANCE SATISFACTORY TO THE ISSUER TO THE EFFECT THAT ANY PROPOSED TRANSFER OR RESALE IS IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS.”

(b) Any legend required by applicable state “blue sky” securities laws, rules and regulations.

 

5


4. Conditions of each Investors Obligations at Closing. The obligations of the Investors under subsection 1.1 of this Agreement are subject to the fulfillment on or before the Closing of each of the following conditions.

4.1 Representations and Warranties. The representations, warranties and covenants of the Company contained in Section 2 of this Agreement shall be true on and as of the Closing, except for representations that are provided as of a particular date, which shall be true and correct as of such dates.

4.2 Public Offering Shares. The Underwriters shall have closed, prior to the closing of the purchase of the Shares by the Investors hereunder, on their purchase of the Firm Shares (as defined in the Underwriting Agreement) pursuant to the Registration Statement and Underwriting Agreement.

4.3 Absence of Injunctions, Decrees, Etc. During this period from the date of this Agreement to immediately prior to the Closing, no governmental authority of competent jurisdiction shall have enacted, issued, promulgated, enforced or entered any decision, injunction, decree, ruling, law or order permanently enjoining or otherwise prohibiting or making illegal the consummation of the transactions contemplated at the Closing.

5. Conditions of the Companys Obligations at Closing. The obligations of the Company under subsection 1.1 of this Agreement are subject to the fulfillment on or before the Closing of each of the following conditions.

5.1 Representations, Warranties and Covenants. The representations, warranties and covenants of the Investors contained in Section 3 shall be true on and as of the Closing.

5.2 Public Offering Shares. The Qualified IPO shall have closed immediately prior to the purchase of the Shares by the Investors hereunder.

5.3 Absence of Injunctions, Decrees, Etc. During this period from the date of this Agreement to immediately prior to the Closing, no governmental authority of competent jurisdiction shall have enacted, issued, promulgated, enforced or entered any decision, injunction, decree, ruling, law or order permanently enjoining or otherwise prohibiting or making illegal the consummation of the transactions contemplated at the Closing.

6. Termination. This Agreement shall terminate (i) at any time upon the written consent of the Company and the Investors, (ii) upon the withdrawal by the Company of the Registration Statement, or (iii) on November 30, 2021 if the Closing has not occurred.

7. Miscellaneous.

7.1 Publicity. On or before October 19, 2021, the Company shall file an amendment to the Registration Statement including the preliminary prospectus which, among other things, will describe the transactions contemplated in this Agreement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no party shall issue any press release or make any other public announcement, including any website posting or social media post, that includes the name or any logo or brand name of any party, or discloses the terms of this Agreement or the fact that an Investor has made or proposes to make an investment in the Company, except as may be required by law (including the requirements of the SEC and the listing rules of any applicable securities exchange) or with the prior written consent of the other party. Each party will provide reasonable advance notice to the other parties prior to making any disclosure of this Agreement or the terms hereof in any filings made with the SEC, and will provide the other party with reasonable opportunity to review and comment on such proposed disclosures. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Investors may use the Company’s current logo or logos in connection with describing its portfolio or this investment on its webpages and in its promotional materials.

 

6


7.2 Survival of Warranties, Representations and Covenants. The warranties, representations and covenants of the Company and the Investors contained in or made pursuant to this Agreement shall survive the execution and delivery of this Agreement and the Closing and shall in no way be affected by any investigation of the subject matter thereof made by or on behalf of the Investors or the Company.

7.3 Successors and Assigns. This Agreement, and any and all rights, duties and obligations hereunder, shall not be assigned, transferred, delegated or sublicensed by the Investors without the prior written consent of the Company; provided, however, that the Shares and the rights, duties and obligations of each Investor hereunder may be assigned to an Affiliate of such Investor without the prior written consent of the Company but any such assignment shall not relieve such Investor of its duties and obligations hereunder. Any attempt by an Investor without such permission to assign, transfer, delegate or sublicense any rights, duties or obligations that arise under this Agreement in a manner that is not permitted by the foregoing sentence to be made without such permission shall be void. Subject to the foregoing and except as otherwise provided herein, the provisions of this Agreement shall inure to the benefit of, and be binding upon, the successors, assigns, heirs, executors and administrators of the parties hereto. No provision of this Agreement is intended, or shall be interpreted, to provide or create any third-party beneficiary rights or any other rights of any kind or nature whatsoever in any person other than the parties hereto and their respective successors and permitted assigns and the Non-Recourse Parties (as defined herein).

7.4 Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed in all respects by the internal laws of the State of New York, without regard to principles of conflicts of law.

7.5 Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be enforceable against the parties actually executing such counterparts, and all of which together shall constitute one instrument. The words “execution,” “signed,” “signature,” “delivery,” and words of like import in or relating to this Agreement or any document to be signed in connection with this Agreement shall be deemed to include electronic signatures, deliveries or the keeping of records in electronic form, each of which shall be of the same legal effect, validity or enforceability as a manually executed signature, physical delivery thereof or the use of a paper-based recordkeeping system, as the case may be, and the parties hereto consent to conduct the transactions contemplated hereunder by electronic means.

7.6 Notices. All notices and other communications required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be mailed by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, sent by facsimile or electronic mail (if to the Investors) or otherwise delivered by hand, messenger or courier service addressed:

(a) if to the Investors, to each Investor’s address or electronic mail address as shown on such Investor’s signature page to this Agreement, with a copy (which shall not constitute notice) to Kenneth Wallach and Hui Lin, Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP, 425 Lexington Avenue, New York, New York 10017.

(b) if to the Company, to GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc., 400 Stonebreak Road Extension, Malta, NY 12020, Attention: General Counsel (email: legal.notices@gf.com), or at such other current address or electronic mail address as the Company shall have furnished to the Investors, with a copy (which shall not constitute notice) to David Lopez and Adam Fleisher, Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP, One Liberty Plaza, New York, New York 10006.

 

7


Each such notice or other communication shall for all purposes of this Agreement be treated as effective or having been given (i) if delivered by hand, messenger or courier service, when delivered (or if sent via a nationally-recognized overnight courier service, freight prepaid, specifying next-business-day delivery, one business day after deposit with the courier), or (ii) if sent via mail, at the earlier of its receipt or five days after the same has been deposited in a regularly-maintained receptacle for the deposit of the United States mail, addressed and mailed as aforesaid, or (iii) if sent via electronic mail, when directed to the relevant electronic mail address, if sent during normal business hours of the recipient, or if not sent during normal business hours of the recipient, then on the recipient’s next business day.

7.7 Brokers or Finders. The Company shall indemnify and hold harmless the Investors from any liability for any commission or compensation in the nature of a brokerage or finder’s fee or agent’s commission (and the costs and expenses of defending against such liability or asserted liability) for which each Investor or any of its constituent partners, members, officers, directors, employees or representatives is responsible to the extent such liability is attributable to any inaccuracy or breach of the representations, warranties and covenants contained in Section 2.7, and the Investors agree to indemnify and hold harmless the Company from any liability for any commission or compensation in the nature of a brokerage or finder’s fee or agent’s commission (and the costs and expenses of defending against such liability or asserted liability) for which the Company or any of its constituent partners, members, officers, directors, employees or representatives is responsible to the extent such liability is attributable to any inaccuracy or breach of the representations, warranties and covenants contained in Section 3.7.

7.8 Amendments and Waivers. Any term of this Agreement may be amended and the observance of any term of this Agreement may be waived (either generally or in a particular instance and either retroactively or prospectively), only with the written consent of the Company and the Investors.

7.9 Severability. If any provision of this Agreement becomes or is declared by a court of competent jurisdiction to be illegal, unenforceable or void, portions of such provision, or such provision in its entirety, to the extent necessary, shall be severed from this Agreement, and such court will replace such illegal, void or unenforceable provision of this Agreement with a valid and enforceable provision that will achieve, to the extent possible, the same economic, business and other purposes of the illegal, void or unenforceable provision. The balance of this Agreement shall be enforceable in accordance with its terms.

7.10 Entire Agreement. This Agreement and the documents referred to herein constitute the entire agreement among the parties. No party shall be liable or bound to any other party in any manner with regard to the subjects hereof or thereof by any warranties, representations or covenants except as specifically set forth herein or therein.

7.11 Specific Performance. The parties to this Agreement hereby acknowledge and agree that the Company would be irreparably injured by a breach of this Agreement by the Investors, and each Investor would be irreparably injured by a breach of this Agreement by the Company, and that money damages are an inadequate remedy for an actual or threatened breach of this Agreement because of the difficulty of ascertaining the amount of damage that will be suffered by the aggrieved party in the event that this agreement is breached. Therefore, each of the parties to this Agreement agree to the granting of specific performance of this Agreement and injunctive or other equitable relief in favor of the aggrieved party as a remedy for any such breach, without proof of actual damages, and the parties to this Agreement further waive any requirement for the securing or posting of any bond in connection with any

 

8


such remedy. Such remedy shall not be deemed to be the exclusive remedy for breach of this Agreement, but shall be in addition to all other remedies available at law or in equity to the aggrieved party. If any term, provision, covenant or restriction of this Agreement is held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, void or unenforceable, the remainder of the terms, provisions, covenants and restrictions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated.

7.12 No Recourse.

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, each Investor’s liability for any liability, loss, damage or recovery of any kind (including special, exemplary, consequential, indirect or punitive damages or damages arising from loss of profits, business opportunities or goodwill, diminution in value or any other losses or damages, whether at law, in equity, in contract, in tort or otherwise) arising under or in connection with any breach of this Agreement (whether willfully, intentionally, unintentionally or otherwise) or in respect of any oral representations made or alleged to have been made in connection herewith shall be no greater than an amount equal to the total purchase price payable by such Investor in respect of the Shares plus any reasonable and documented out-of-pocket expenses the Company may recover in connection with any claim therefor following the determination in a final, non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction that such Investor has so breached this Agreement, and such Investor shall have no further liability or obligation relating to or arising out of this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby in excess of such amount.

(b) This Agreement may only be enforced against, and any claims or causes of action that may be based upon, arise out of or relate to this Agreement, or the negotiation, execution or performance of this Agreement, may only be made against, the entities that are expressly identified as parties hereto, including entities that become parties hereto after the date hereof or that agree in writing for the benefit of the Company to be bound by the terms of this Agreement applicable to each Investor, and no former, current or future equityholders, controlling persons, directors, officers, employees, agents or affiliates of any party hereto or any former, current or future equityholder, controlling person, director, officer, employee, general or limited partner, member, manager, advisor, agent or affiliates of any of the foregoing (each, a “Non-Recourse Party”) shall have any liability for any obligations or liabilities of the parties to this Agreement or for any claim (whether in tort, contract or otherwise) based on, in respect of, or by reason of, the transactions contemplated hereby or in respect of any representations made or alleged to be made in connection herewith. Without limiting the rights of any party against the other parties hereto, in no event shall any party or any of its affiliates seek to enforce this Agreement against, make any claims for breach of this Agreement against, or seek to recover monetary damages from any Non-Recourse Party.

7.13 Submission to Jurisdiction. (a) The Company hereby submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the U.S. federal and New York state courts in the Borough of Manhattan in The City of New York in any suit or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby. The Company waives, to the fullest extent permitted by law, any objection which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of venue of any such suit or proceeding in such courts. The Company agrees that final judgment in any such suit, action or proceeding brought in such court shall be conclusive and binding upon the Company and may be enforced in any court to the jurisdiction of which Company is subject by a suit upon such judgment.

[Remainder of page intentionally left blank]

 

9


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Share Purchase Agreement as of the date first above written.

 

GLOBALFOUNDRIES INC.
By:  

/s/ Thomas Caulfield

Name:   Thomas Caulfield
Title:   Chief Executive Officer
Address:   400 Stonebreak Road Extension,
  Malta, NY 12020

 

10


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Share Purchase Agreement as of the date first above written.

 

INVESTORS:
SILVER LAKE PARTNERS VI CAYMAN, L.P.
BY:   SILVER LAKE TECHNOLOGY ASSOCIATES VI CAYMAN, L.P.
BY:   SILVER LAKE (OFFSHORE) AIV GP VI, LTD.
By:  

/s/ Kenneth Hao

Name:   Kenneth Hao
Title:   Director
Address:   55 Hudson Yards
  550 West 34th Street
  40th Floor
  New York, NY 10001
Email:   Andy.Schader@SilverLake.com
  Jennifer.Gautier@SilverLake.com
SILVER LAKE PARTNERS VI CAYMAN (AIV II), L.P.
BY:   SILVER LAKE TECHNOLOGY ASSOCIATES VI CAYMAN, L.P.
BY:   SILVER LAKE (OFFSHORE) AIV GP VI, LTD.
By:  

/s/ Kenneth Hao

Name:   Kenneth Hao
Title:   Director
Address:   55 Hudson Yards
  550 West 34th Street
  40th Floor
  New York, NY 10001
Email:   Andy.Schader@SilverLake.com
  Jennifer.Gautier@SilverLake.com

 

11

EX-23.1

Exhibit 23.1

CONSENT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption “Experts” and to the use of our report dated August 6, 2021, except for the fourth and fifth paragraphs of Note 37, as to which the date is September 13, 2021, in the Registration Statement (Form F-1 No. 333-260003) and related Prospectus of GLOBALFOUNDRIES Inc. for the registration of its ordinary shares.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

San Jose, California

October 18, 2021